doc: string2 not expanded, don't imply otherwise
[exim.git] / doc / doc-docbook / spec.xfpt
... / ...
CommitLineData
1. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2. This is the primary source of the Exim Manual. It is an xfpt document that is
3. converted into DocBook XML for subsequent conversion into printing and online
4. formats. The markup used herein is "standard" xfpt markup, with some extras.
5. The markup is summarized in a file called Markup.txt.
6.
7. WARNING: When you use the .new macro, make sure it appears *before* any
8. adjacent index items; otherwise you get an empty "paragraph" which causes
9. unwanted vertical space.
10. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
11
12.include stdflags
13.include stdmacs
14
15. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16. This outputs the standard DocBook boilerplate.
17. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18
19.docbook
20
21. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22. These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
23. Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
24. PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
25. processors.
26. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27
28.literal xml
29<?sdop
30 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
31 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
32 toc_chapter_blanks="yes,yes"
33 table_warn_overflow="overprint"
34?>
35.literal off
36
37. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38. This generate the outermost <book> element that wraps then entire document.
39. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40
41.book
42
43. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
44. These definitions set some parameters and save some typing.
45. Update the Copyright year (only) when changing content.
46. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
47
48.set previousversion "4.89"
49.include ./local_params
50
51.set ACL "access control lists (ACLs)"
52.set I "&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;"
53
54.macro copyyear
552017
56.endmacro
57
58. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
59. Additional xfpt markup used by this document, over and above the default
60. provided in the xfpt library.
61. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
62
63. --- Override the &$ flag to automatically insert a $ with the variable name
64
65.flag &$ $& "<varname>$" "</varname>"
66
67. --- Short flags for daggers in option headings. They will always be inside
68. --- an italic string, but we want the daggers to be roman.
69
70.flag &!! "</emphasis>&dagger;<emphasis>"
71.flag &!? "</emphasis>&Dagger;<emphasis>"
72
73. --- A macro for an Exim option definition heading, generating a one-line
74. --- table with four columns. For cases when the option name is given with
75. --- a space, so that it can be split, a fifth argument is used for the
76. --- index entry.
77
78.macro option
79.arg 5
80.oindex "&%$5%&"
81.endarg
82.arg -5
83.oindex "&%$1%&"
84.endarg
85.itable all 0 0 4 8* left 6* center 6* center 6* right
86.row "&%$1%&" "Use: &'$2'&" "Type: &'$3'&" "Default: &'$4'&"
87.endtable
88.endmacro
89
90. --- A macro for the common 2-column tables. The width of the first column
91. --- is suitable for the many tables at the start of the main options chapter;
92. --- the small number of other 2-column tables override it.
93
94.macro table2 196pt 254pt
95.itable none 0 0 2 $1 left $2 left
96.endmacro
97
98. --- A macro that generates .row, but puts &I; at the start of the first
99. --- argument, thus indenting it. Assume a minimum of two arguments, and
100. --- allow up to four arguments, which is as many as we'll ever need.
101
102.macro irow
103.arg 4
104.row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3" "$4"
105.endarg
106.arg -4
107.arg 3
108.row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3"
109.endarg
110.arg -3
111.row "&I;$1" "$2"
112.endarg
113.endarg
114.endmacro
115
116. --- Macros for option, variable, and concept index entries. For a "range"
117. --- style of entry, use .scindex for the start and .ecindex for the end. The
118. --- first argument of .scindex and the only argument of .ecindex must be the
119. --- ID that ties them together.
120
121.macro cindex
122&<indexterm role="concept">&
123&<primary>&$1&</primary>&
124.arg 2
125&<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
126.endarg
127&</indexterm>&
128.endmacro
129
130.macro scindex
131&<indexterm role="concept" id="$1" class="startofrange">&
132&<primary>&$2&</primary>&
133.arg 3
134&<secondary>&$3&</secondary>&
135.endarg
136&</indexterm>&
137.endmacro
138
139.macro ecindex
140&<indexterm role="concept" startref="$1" class="endofrange"/>&
141.endmacro
142
143.macro oindex
144&<indexterm role="option">&
145&<primary>&$1&</primary>&
146.arg 2
147&<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
148.endarg
149&</indexterm>&
150.endmacro
151
152.macro vindex
153&<indexterm role="variable">&
154&<primary>&$1&</primary>&
155.arg 2
156&<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
157.endarg
158&</indexterm>&
159.endmacro
160
161.macro index
162.echo "** Don't use .index; use .cindex or .oindex or .vindex"
163.endmacro
164. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
165
166
167. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
168. The <bookinfo> element is removed from the XML before processing for Ascii
169. output formats.
170. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
171
172.literal xml
173<bookinfo>
174<title>Specification of the Exim Mail Transfer Agent</title>
175<titleabbrev>The Exim MTA</titleabbrev>
176<date>
177.fulldate
178</date>
179<author><firstname>Exim</firstname><surname>Maintainers</surname></author>
180<authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
181<revhistory><revision>
182.versiondatexml
183 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
184</revision></revhistory>
185<copyright><year>
186.copyyear
187 </year><holder>University of Cambridge</holder></copyright>
188</bookinfo>
189.literal off
190
191
192. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
193. This chunk of literal XML implements index entries of the form "x, see y" and
194. "x, see also y". However, the DocBook DTD doesn't allow <indexterm> entries
195. at the top level, so we have to put the .chapter directive first.
196. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
197
198.chapter "Introduction" "CHID1"
199.literal xml
200
201<indexterm role="variable">
202 <primary>$1, $2, etc.</primary>
203 <see><emphasis>numerical variables</emphasis></see>
204</indexterm>
205<indexterm role="concept">
206 <primary>address</primary>
207 <secondary>rewriting</secondary>
208 <see><emphasis>rewriting</emphasis></see>
209</indexterm>
210<indexterm role="concept">
211 <primary>Bounce Address Tag Validation</primary>
212 <see><emphasis>BATV</emphasis></see>
213</indexterm>
214<indexterm role="concept">
215 <primary>Client SMTP Authorization</primary>
216 <see><emphasis>CSA</emphasis></see>
217</indexterm>
218<indexterm role="concept">
219 <primary>CR character</primary>
220 <see><emphasis>carriage return</emphasis></see>
221</indexterm>
222<indexterm role="concept">
223 <primary>CRL</primary>
224 <see><emphasis>certificate revocation list</emphasis></see>
225</indexterm>
226<indexterm role="concept">
227 <primary>delivery</primary>
228 <secondary>failure report</secondary>
229 <see><emphasis>bounce message</emphasis></see>
230</indexterm>
231<indexterm role="concept">
232 <primary>dialup</primary>
233 <see><emphasis>intermittently connected hosts</emphasis></see>
234</indexterm>
235<indexterm role="concept">
236 <primary>exiscan</primary>
237 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
238</indexterm>
239<indexterm role="concept">
240 <primary>failover</primary>
241 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
242</indexterm>
243<indexterm role="concept">
244 <primary>fallover</primary>
245 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
246</indexterm>
247<indexterm role="concept">
248 <primary>filter</primary>
249 <secondary>Sieve</secondary>
250 <see><emphasis>Sieve filter</emphasis></see>
251</indexterm>
252<indexterm role="concept">
253 <primary>ident</primary>
254 <see><emphasis>RFC 1413</emphasis></see>
255</indexterm>
256<indexterm role="concept">
257 <primary>LF character</primary>
258 <see><emphasis>linefeed</emphasis></see>
259</indexterm>
260<indexterm role="concept">
261 <primary>maximum</primary>
262 <seealso><emphasis>limit</emphasis></seealso>
263</indexterm>
264<indexterm role="concept">
265 <primary>monitor</primary>
266 <see><emphasis>Exim monitor</emphasis></see>
267</indexterm>
268<indexterm role="concept">
269 <primary>no_<emphasis>xxx</emphasis></primary>
270 <see>entry for xxx</see>
271</indexterm>
272<indexterm role="concept">
273 <primary>NUL</primary>
274 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
275</indexterm>
276<indexterm role="concept">
277 <primary>passwd file</primary>
278 <see><emphasis>/etc/passwd</emphasis></see>
279</indexterm>
280<indexterm role="concept">
281 <primary>process id</primary>
282 <see><emphasis>pid</emphasis></see>
283</indexterm>
284<indexterm role="concept">
285 <primary>RBL</primary>
286 <see><emphasis>DNS list</emphasis></see>
287</indexterm>
288<indexterm role="concept">
289 <primary>redirection</primary>
290 <see><emphasis>address redirection</emphasis></see>
291</indexterm>
292<indexterm role="concept">
293 <primary>return path</primary>
294 <seealso><emphasis>envelope sender</emphasis></seealso>
295</indexterm>
296<indexterm role="concept">
297 <primary>scanning</primary>
298 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
299</indexterm>
300<indexterm role="concept">
301 <primary>SSL</primary>
302 <see><emphasis>TLS</emphasis></see>
303</indexterm>
304<indexterm role="concept">
305 <primary>string</primary>
306 <secondary>expansion</secondary>
307 <see><emphasis>expansion</emphasis></see>
308</indexterm>
309<indexterm role="concept">
310 <primary>top bit</primary>
311 <see><emphasis>8-bit characters</emphasis></see>
312</indexterm>
313<indexterm role="concept">
314 <primary>variables</primary>
315 <see><emphasis>expansion, variables</emphasis></see>
316</indexterm>
317<indexterm role="concept">
318 <primary>zero, binary</primary>
319 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
320</indexterm>
321
322.literal off
323
324
325. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
326. This is the real start of the first chapter. See the comment above as to why
327. we can't have the .chapter line here.
328. chapter "Introduction"
329. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
330
331Exim is a mail transfer agent (MTA) for hosts that are running Unix or
332Unix-like operating systems. It was designed on the assumption that it would be
333run on hosts that are permanently connected to the Internet. However, it can be
334used on intermittently connected hosts with suitable configuration adjustments.
335
336Configuration files currently exist for the following operating systems: AIX,
337BSD/OS (aka BSDI), Darwin (Mac OS X), DGUX, Dragonfly, FreeBSD, GNU/Hurd,
338GNU/Linux, HI-OSF (Hitachi), HI-UX, HP-UX, IRIX, MIPS RISCOS, NetBSD, OpenBSD,
339OpenUNIX, QNX, SCO, SCO SVR4.2 (aka UNIX-SV), Solaris (aka SunOS5), SunOS4,
340Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX, formerly DEC-OSF1), Ultrix, and Unixware.
341Some of these operating systems are no longer current and cannot easily be
342tested, so the configuration files may no longer work in practice.
343
344There are also configuration files for compiling Exim in the Cygwin environment
345that can be installed on systems running Windows. However, this document does
346not contain any information about running Exim in the Cygwin environment.
347
348The terms and conditions for the use and distribution of Exim are contained in
349the file &_NOTICE_&. Exim is distributed under the terms of the GNU General
350Public Licence, a copy of which may be found in the file &_LICENCE_&.
351
352The use, supply or promotion of Exim for the purpose of sending bulk,
353unsolicited electronic mail is incompatible with the basic aims of the program,
354which revolve around the free provision of a service that enhances the quality
355of personal communications. The author of Exim regards indiscriminate
356mass-mailing as an antisocial, irresponsible abuse of the Internet.
357
358Exim owes a great deal to Smail 3 and its author, Ron Karr. Without the
359experience of running and working on the Smail 3 code, I could never have
360contemplated starting to write a new MTA. Many of the ideas and user interfaces
361were originally taken from Smail 3, though the actual code of Exim is entirely
362new, and has developed far beyond the initial concept.
363
364Many people, both in Cambridge and around the world, have contributed to the
365development and the testing of Exim, and to porting it to various operating
366systems. I am grateful to them all. The distribution now contains a file called
367&_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_&, in which I have started recording the names of
368contributors.
369
370
371.section "Exim documentation" "SECID1"
372. Keep this example change bar when updating the documentation!
373
374.new
375.cindex "documentation"
376This edition of the Exim specification applies to version &version() of Exim.
377Substantive changes from the &previousversion; edition are marked in some
378renditions of the document; this paragraph is so marked if the rendition is
379capable of showing a change indicator.
380.wen
381
382This document is very much a reference manual; it is not a tutorial. The reader
383is expected to have some familiarity with the SMTP mail transfer protocol and
384with general Unix system administration. Although there are some discussions
385and examples in places, the information is mostly organized in a way that makes
386it easy to look up, rather than in a natural order for sequential reading.
387Furthermore, the manual aims to cover every aspect of Exim in detail, including
388a number of rarely-used, special-purpose features that are unlikely to be of
389very wide interest.
390
391.cindex "books about Exim"
392An &"easier"& discussion of Exim which provides more in-depth explanatory,
393introductory, and tutorial material can be found in a book entitled &'The Exim
394SMTP Mail Server'& (second edition, 2007), published by UIT Cambridge
395(&url(http://www.uit.co.uk/exim-book/)).
396
397This book also contains a chapter that gives a general introduction to SMTP and
398Internet mail. Inevitably, however, the book is unlikely to be fully up-to-date
399with the latest release of Exim. (Note that the earlier book about Exim,
400published by O'Reilly, covers Exim 3, and many things have changed in Exim 4.)
401
402.cindex "Debian" "information sources"
403If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you will find information about
404Debian-specific features in the file
405&_/usr/share/doc/exim4-base/README.Debian_&.
406The command &(man update-exim.conf)& is another source of Debian-specific
407information.
408
409.cindex "&_doc/NewStuff_&"
410.cindex "&_doc/ChangeLog_&"
411.cindex "change log"
412As the program develops, there may be features in newer versions that have not
413yet made it into this document, which is updated only when the most significant
414digit of the fractional part of the version number changes. Specifications of
415new features that are not yet in this manual are placed in the file
416&_doc/NewStuff_& in the Exim distribution.
417
418Some features may be classified as &"experimental"&. These may change
419incompatibly while they are developing, or even be withdrawn. For this reason,
420they are not documented in this manual. Information about experimental features
421can be found in the file &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
422
423All changes to the program (whether new features, bug fixes, or other kinds of
424change) are noted briefly in the file called &_doc/ChangeLog_&.
425
426.cindex "&_doc/spec.txt_&"
427This specification itself is available as an ASCII file in &_doc/spec.txt_& so
428that it can easily be searched with a text editor. Other files in the &_doc_&
429directory are:
430
431.table2 100pt
432.row &_OptionLists.txt_& "list of all options in alphabetical order"
433.row &_dbm.discuss.txt_& "discussion about DBM libraries"
434.row &_exim.8_& "a man page of Exim's command line options"
435.row &_experimental.txt_& "documentation of experimental features"
436.row &_filter.txt_& "specification of the filter language"
437.row &_Exim3.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 2 to release 3"
438.row &_Exim4.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 3 to release 4"
439.row &_openssl.txt_& "installing a current OpenSSL release"
440.endtable
441
442The main specification and the specification of the filtering language are also
443available in other formats (HTML, PostScript, PDF, and Texinfo). Section
444&<<SECTavail>>& below tells you how to get hold of these.
445
446
447
448.section "FTP and web sites" "SECID2"
449.cindex "web site"
450.cindex "FTP site"
451The primary site for Exim source distributions is currently the University of
452Cambridge's FTP site, whose contents are described in &'Where to find the Exim
453distribution'& below. In addition, there is a web site and an FTP site at
454&%exim.org%&. These are now also hosted at the University of Cambridge. The
455&%exim.org%& site was previously hosted for a number of years by Energis
456Squared, formerly Planet Online Ltd, whose support I gratefully acknowledge.
457
458.cindex "wiki"
459.cindex "FAQ"
460As well as Exim distribution tar files, the Exim web site contains a number of
461differently formatted versions of the documentation. A recent addition to the
462online information is the Exim wiki (&url(http://wiki.exim.org)),
463which contains what used to be a separate FAQ, as well as various other
464examples, tips, and know-how that have been contributed by Exim users.
465
466.cindex Bugzilla
467An Exim Bugzilla exists at &url(https://bugs.exim.org). You can use
468this to report bugs, and also to add items to the wish list. Please search
469first to check that you are not duplicating a previous entry.
470
471
472
473.section "Mailing lists" "SECID3"
474.cindex "mailing lists" "for Exim users"
475The following Exim mailing lists exist:
476
477.table2 140pt
478.row &'exim-announce@exim.org'& "Moderated, low volume announcements list"
479.row &'exim-users@exim.org'& "General discussion list"
480.row &'exim-dev@exim.org'& "Discussion of bugs, enhancements, etc."
481.row &'exim-cvs@exim.org'& "Automated commit messages from the VCS"
482.endtable
483
484You can subscribe to these lists, change your existing subscriptions, and view
485or search the archives via the mailing lists link on the Exim home page.
486.cindex "Debian" "mailing list for"
487If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you may wish to subscribe to
488the Debian-specific mailing list &'pkg-exim4-users@lists.alioth.debian.org'&
489via this web page:
490.display
491&url(http://lists.alioth.debian.org/mailman/listinfo/pkg-exim4-users)
492.endd
493Please ask Debian-specific questions on this list and not on the general Exim
494lists.
495
496.section "Bug reports" "SECID5"
497.cindex "bug reports"
498.cindex "reporting bugs"
499Reports of obvious bugs can be emailed to &'bugs@exim.org'& or reported
500via the Bugzilla (&url(https://bugs.exim.org)). However, if you are unsure
501whether some behaviour is a bug or not, the best thing to do is to post a
502message to the &'exim-dev'& mailing list and have it discussed.
503
504
505
506.section "Where to find the Exim distribution" "SECTavail"
507.cindex "FTP site"
508.cindex "distribution" "ftp site"
509The master ftp site for the Exim distribution is
510.display
511&*ftp://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim*&
512.endd
513The file references that follow are relative to the &_exim_& directories at
514these sites. There are now quite a number of independent mirror sites around
515the world. Those that I know about are listed in the file called &_Mirrors_&.
516
517Within the &_exim_& directory there are subdirectories called &_exim3_& (for
518previous Exim 3 distributions), &_exim4_& (for the latest Exim 4
519distributions), and &_Testing_& for testing versions. In the &_exim4_&
520subdirectory, the current release can always be found in files called
521.display
522&_exim-n.nn.tar.gz_&
523&_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2_&
524.endd
525where &'n.nn'& is the highest such version number in the directory. The two
526files contain identical data; the only difference is the type of compression.
527The &_.bz2_& file is usually a lot smaller than the &_.gz_& file.
528
529.cindex "distribution" "signing details"
530.cindex "distribution" "public key"
531.cindex "public key for signed distribution"
532The distributions will be PGP signed by an individual key of the Release
533Coordinator. This key will have a uid containing an email address in the
534&'exim.org'& domain and will have signatures from other people, including
535other Exim maintainers. We expect that the key will be in the "strong set" of
536PGP keys. There should be a trust path to that key from Nigel Metheringham's
537PGP key, a version of which can be found in the release directory in the file
538&_nigel-pubkey.asc_&. All keys used will be available in public keyserver pools,
539such as &'pool.sks-keyservers.net'&.
540
541At time of last update, releases were being made by Phil Pennock and signed with
542key &'0x403043153903637F'&, although that key is expected to be replaced in 2013.
543A trust path from Nigel's key to Phil's can be observed at
544&url(https://www.security.spodhuis.org/exim-trustpath).
545
546Releases have also been authorized to be performed by Todd Lyons who signs with
547key &'0xC4F4F94804D29EBA'&. A direct trust path exists between previous RE Phil
548Pennock and Todd Lyons through a common associate.
549
550The signatures for the tar bundles are in:
551.display
552&_exim-n.nn.tar.gz.asc_&
553&_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2.asc_&
554.endd
555For each released version, the log of changes is made separately available in a
556separate file in the directory &_ChangeLogs_& so that it is possible to
557find out what has changed without having to download the entire distribution.
558
559.cindex "documentation" "available formats"
560The main distribution contains ASCII versions of this specification and other
561documentation; other formats of the documents are available in separate files
562inside the &_exim4_& directory of the FTP site:
563.display
564&_exim-html-n.nn.tar.gz_&
565&_exim-pdf-n.nn.tar.gz_&
566&_exim-postscript-n.nn.tar.gz_&
567&_exim-texinfo-n.nn.tar.gz_&
568.endd
569These tar files contain only the &_doc_& directory, not the complete
570distribution, and are also available in &_.bz2_& as well as &_.gz_& forms.
571
572
573.section "Limitations" "SECID6"
574.ilist
575.cindex "limitations of Exim"
576.cindex "bang paths" "not handled by Exim"
577Exim is designed for use as an Internet MTA, and therefore handles addresses in
578RFC 2822 domain format only. It cannot handle UUCP &"bang paths"&, though
579simple two-component bang paths can be converted by a straightforward rewriting
580configuration. This restriction does not prevent Exim from being interfaced to
581UUCP as a transport mechanism, provided that domain addresses are used.
582.next
583.cindex "domainless addresses"
584.cindex "address" "without domain"
585Exim insists that every address it handles has a domain attached. For incoming
586local messages, domainless addresses are automatically qualified with a
587configured domain value. Configuration options specify from which remote
588systems unqualified addresses are acceptable. These are then qualified on
589arrival.
590.next
591.cindex "transport" "external"
592.cindex "external transports"
593The only external transport mechanisms that are currently implemented are SMTP
594and LMTP over a TCP/IP network (including support for IPv6). However, a pipe
595transport is available, and there are facilities for writing messages to files
596and pipes, optionally in &'batched SMTP'& format; these facilities can be used
597to send messages to other transport mechanisms such as UUCP, provided they can
598handle domain-style addresses. Batched SMTP input is also catered for.
599.next
600Exim is not designed for storing mail for dial-in hosts. When the volumes of
601such mail are large, it is better to get the messages &"delivered"& into files
602(that is, off Exim's queue) and subsequently passed on to the dial-in hosts by
603other means.
604.next
605Although Exim does have basic facilities for scanning incoming messages, these
606are not comprehensive enough to do full virus or spam scanning. Such operations
607are best carried out using additional specialized software packages. If you
608compile Exim with the content-scanning extension, straightforward interfaces to
609a number of common scanners are provided.
610.endlist
611
612
613.section "Run time configuration" "SECID7"
614Exim's run time configuration is held in a single text file that is divided
615into a number of sections. The entries in this file consist of keywords and
616values, in the style of Smail 3 configuration files. A default configuration
617file which is suitable for simple online installations is provided in the
618distribution, and is described in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& below.
619
620
621.section "Calling interface" "SECID8"
622.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "command line interface"
623Like many MTAs, Exim has adopted the Sendmail command line interface so that it
624can be a straight replacement for &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& or
625&_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& when sending mail, but you do not need to know anything
626about Sendmail in order to run Exim. For actions other than sending messages,
627Sendmail-compatible options also exist, but those that produce output (for
628example, &%-bp%&, which lists the messages on the queue) do so in Exim's own
629format. There are also some additional options that are compatible with Smail
6303, and some further options that are new to Exim. Chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&
631documents all Exim's command line options. This information is automatically
632made into the man page that forms part of the Exim distribution.
633
634Control of messages on the queue can be done via certain privileged command
635line options. There is also an optional monitor program called &'eximon'&,
636which displays current information in an X window, and which contains a menu
637interface to Exim's command line administration options.
638
639
640
641.section "Terminology" "SECID9"
642.cindex "terminology definitions"
643.cindex "body of message" "definition of"
644The &'body'& of a message is the actual data that the sender wants to transmit.
645It is the last part of a message, and is separated from the &'header'& (see
646below) by a blank line.
647
648.cindex "bounce message" "definition of"
649When a message cannot be delivered, it is normally returned to the sender in a
650delivery failure message or a &"non-delivery report"& (NDR). The term
651&'bounce'& is commonly used for this action, and the error reports are often
652called &'bounce messages'&. This is a convenient shorthand for &"delivery
653failure error report"&. Such messages have an empty sender address in the
654message's &'envelope'& (see below) to ensure that they cannot themselves give
655rise to further bounce messages.
656
657The term &'default'& appears frequently in this manual. It is used to qualify a
658value which is used in the absence of any setting in the configuration. It may
659also qualify an action which is taken unless a configuration setting specifies
660otherwise.
661
662The term &'defer'& is used when the delivery of a message to a specific
663destination cannot immediately take place for some reason (a remote host may be
664down, or a user's local mailbox may be full). Such deliveries are &'deferred'&
665until a later time.
666
667The word &'domain'& is sometimes used to mean all but the first component of a
668host's name. It is &'not'& used in that sense here, where it normally refers to
669the part of an email address following the @ sign.
670
671.cindex "envelope, definition of"
672.cindex "sender" "definition of"
673A message in transit has an associated &'envelope'&, as well as a header and a
674body. The envelope contains a sender address (to which bounce messages should
675be delivered), and any number of recipient addresses. References to the
676sender or the recipients of a message usually mean the addresses in the
677envelope. An MTA uses these addresses for delivery, and for returning bounce
678messages, not the addresses that appear in the header lines.
679
680.cindex "message" "header, definition of"
681.cindex "header section" "definition of"
682The &'header'& of a message is the first part of a message's text, consisting
683of a number of lines, each of which has a name such as &'From:'&, &'To:'&,
684&'Subject:'&, etc. Long header lines can be split over several text lines by
685indenting the continuations. The header is separated from the body by a blank
686line.
687
688.cindex "local part" "definition of"
689.cindex "domain" "definition of"
690The term &'local part'&, which is taken from RFC 2822, is used to refer to that
691part of an email address that precedes the @ sign. The part that follows the
692@ sign is called the &'domain'& or &'mail domain'&.
693
694.cindex "local delivery" "definition of"
695.cindex "remote delivery, definition of"
696The terms &'local delivery'& and &'remote delivery'& are used to distinguish
697delivery to a file or a pipe on the local host from delivery by SMTP over
698TCP/IP to another host. As far as Exim is concerned, all hosts other than the
699host it is running on are &'remote'&.
700
701.cindex "return path" "definition of"
702&'Return path'& is another name that is used for the sender address in a
703message's envelope.
704
705.cindex "queue" "definition of"
706The term &'queue'& is used to refer to the set of messages awaiting delivery,
707because this term is in widespread use in the context of MTAs. However, in
708Exim's case the reality is more like a pool than a queue, because there is
709normally no ordering of waiting messages.
710
711.cindex "queue runner" "definition of"
712The term &'queue runner'& is used to describe a process that scans the queue
713and attempts to deliver those messages whose retry times have come. This term
714is used by other MTAs, and also relates to the command &%runq%&, but in Exim
715the waiting messages are normally processed in an unpredictable order.
716
717.cindex "spool directory" "definition of"
718The term &'spool directory'& is used for a directory in which Exim keeps the
719messages on its queue &-- that is, those that it is in the process of
720delivering. This should not be confused with the directory in which local
721mailboxes are stored, which is called a &"spool directory"& by some people. In
722the Exim documentation, &"spool"& is always used in the first sense.
723
724
725
726
727
728
729. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
730. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
731
732.chapter "Incorporated code" "CHID2"
733.cindex "incorporated code"
734.cindex "regular expressions" "library"
735.cindex "PCRE"
736.cindex "OpenDMARC"
737A number of pieces of external code are included in the Exim distribution.
738
739.ilist
740Regular expressions are supported in the main Exim program and in the
741Exim monitor using the freely-distributable PCRE library, copyright
742&copy; University of Cambridge. The source to PCRE is no longer shipped with
743Exim, so you will need to use the version of PCRE shipped with your system,
744or obtain and install the full version of the library from
745&url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre).
746.next
747.cindex "cdb" "acknowledgment"
748Support for the cdb (Constant DataBase) lookup method is provided by code
749contributed by Nigel Metheringham of (at the time he contributed it) Planet
750Online Ltd. The implementation is completely contained within the code of Exim.
751It does not link against an external cdb library. The code contains the
752following statements:
753
754.blockquote
755Copyright &copy; 1998 Nigel Metheringham, Planet Online Ltd
756
757This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
758the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free Software
759Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or (at your option) any later
760version.
761This code implements Dan Bernstein's Constant DataBase (cdb) spec. Information,
762the spec and sample code for cdb can be obtained from
763&url(http://www.pobox.com/~djb/cdb.html). This implementation borrows
764some code from Dan Bernstein's implementation (which has no license
765restrictions applied to it).
766.endblockquote
767.next
768.cindex "SPA authentication"
769.cindex "Samba project"
770.cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
771Client support for Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& is provided
772by code contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux. Server support was contributed by
773Tom Kistner. This includes code taken from the Samba project, which is released
774under the Gnu GPL.
775.next
776.cindex "Cyrus"
777.cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
778.cindex "&'pwauthd'& daemon"
779Support for calling the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& and &'saslauthd'& daemons is provided
780by code taken from the Cyrus-SASL library and adapted by Alexander S.
781Sabourenkov. The permission notice appears below, in accordance with the
782conditions expressed therein.
783
784.blockquote
785Copyright &copy; 2001 Carnegie Mellon University. All rights reserved.
786
787Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
788modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
789are met:
790
791.olist
792Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
793notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
794.next
795Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
796notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in
797the documentation and/or other materials provided with the
798distribution.
799.next
800The name &"Carnegie Mellon University"& must not be used to
801endorse or promote products derived from this software without
802prior written permission. For permission or any other legal
803details, please contact
804.display
805 Office of Technology Transfer
806 Carnegie Mellon University
807 5000 Forbes Avenue
808 Pittsburgh, PA 15213-3890
809 (412) 268-4387, fax: (412) 268-7395
810 tech-transfer@andrew.cmu.edu
811.endd
812.next
813Redistributions of any form whatsoever must retain the following
814acknowledgment:
815
816&"This product includes software developed by Computing Services
817at Carnegie Mellon University (&url(http://www.cmu.edu/computing/)."&
818
819CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO
820THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY
821AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY BE LIABLE
822FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES
823WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN
824AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING
825OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.
826.endlist
827.endblockquote
828
829.next
830.cindex "Exim monitor" "acknowledgment"
831.cindex "X-windows"
832.cindex "Athena"
833The Exim Monitor program, which is an X-Window application, includes
834modified versions of the Athena StripChart and TextPop widgets.
835This code is copyright by DEC and MIT, and their permission notice appears
836below, in accordance with the conditions expressed therein.
837
838.blockquote
839Copyright 1987, 1988 by Digital Equipment Corporation, Maynard, Massachusetts,
840and the Massachusetts Institute of Technology, Cambridge, Massachusetts.
841
842All Rights Reserved
843
844Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software and its
845documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby granted,
846provided that the above copyright notice appear in all copies and that
847both that copyright notice and this permission notice appear in
848supporting documentation, and that the names of Digital or MIT not be
849used in advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
850software without specific, written prior permission.
851
852DIGITAL DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING
853ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL
854DIGITAL BE LIABLE FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR
855ANY DAMAGES WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS,
856WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION,
857ARISING OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS
858SOFTWARE.
859.endblockquote
860
861.next
862.cindex "opendmarc" "acknowledgment"
863The DMARC implementation uses the OpenDMARC library which is Copyrighted by
864The Trusted Domain Project. Portions of Exim source which use OpenDMARC
865derived code are indicated in the respective source files. The full OpenDMARC
866license is provided in the LICENSE.opendmarc file contained in the distributed
867source code.
868
869.next
870Many people have contributed code fragments, some large, some small, that were
871not covered by any specific licence requirements. It is assumed that the
872contributors are happy to see their code incorporated into Exim under the GPL.
873.endlist
874
875
876
877
878
879. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
880. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
881
882.chapter "How Exim receives and delivers mail" "CHID11" &&&
883 "Receiving and delivering mail"
884
885
886.section "Overall philosophy" "SECID10"
887.cindex "design philosophy"
888Exim is designed to work efficiently on systems that are permanently connected
889to the Internet and are handling a general mix of mail. In such circumstances,
890most messages can be delivered immediately. Consequently, Exim does not
891maintain independent queues of messages for specific domains or hosts, though
892it does try to send several messages in a single SMTP connection after a host
893has been down, and it also maintains per-host retry information.
894
895
896.section "Policy control" "SECID11"
897.cindex "policy control" "overview"
898Policy controls are now an important feature of MTAs that are connected to the
899Internet. Perhaps their most important job is to stop MTAs being abused as
900&"open relays"& by misguided individuals who send out vast amounts of
901unsolicited junk, and want to disguise its source. Exim provides flexible
902facilities for specifying policy controls on incoming mail:
903
904.ilist
905.cindex "&ACL;" "introduction"
906Exim 4 (unlike previous versions of Exim) implements policy controls on
907incoming mail by means of &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs). Each list is a
908series of statements that may either grant or deny access. ACLs can be used at
909several places in the SMTP dialogue while receiving a message from a remote
910host. However, the most common places are after each RCPT command, and at the
911very end of the message. The sysadmin can specify conditions for accepting or
912rejecting individual recipients or the entire message, respectively, at these
913two points (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). Denial of access results in an SMTP
914error code.
915.next
916An ACL is also available for locally generated, non-SMTP messages. In this
917case, the only available actions are to accept or deny the entire message.
918.next
919When Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension, facilities are
920provided in the ACL mechanism for passing the message to external virus and/or
921spam scanning software. The result of such a scan is passed back to the ACL,
922which can then use it to decide what to do with the message.
923.next
924When a message has been received, either from a remote host or from the local
925host, but before the final acknowledgment has been sent, a locally supplied C
926function called &[local_scan()]& can be run to inspect the message and decide
927whether to accept it or not (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). If the message
928is accepted, the list of recipients can be modified by the function.
929.next
930Using the &[local_scan()]& mechanism is another way of calling external scanner
931software. The &%SA-Exim%& add-on package works this way. It does not require
932Exim to be compiled with the content-scanning extension.
933.next
934After a message has been accepted, a further checking mechanism is available in
935the form of the &'system filter'& (see chapter &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&). This
936runs at the start of every delivery process.
937.endlist
938
939
940
941.section "User filters" "SECID12"
942.cindex "filter" "introduction"
943.cindex "Sieve filter"
944In a conventional Exim configuration, users are able to run private filters by
945setting up appropriate &_.forward_& files in their home directories. See
946chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& (about the &(redirect)& router) for the
947configuration needed to support this, and the separate document entitled
948&'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'& for user details. Two different kinds
949of filtering are available:
950
951.ilist
952Sieve filters are written in the standard filtering language that is defined
953by RFC 3028.
954.next
955Exim filters are written in a syntax that is unique to Exim, but which is more
956powerful than Sieve, which it pre-dates.
957.endlist
958
959User filters are run as part of the routing process, described below.
960
961
962
963.section "Message identification" "SECTmessiden"
964.cindex "message ids" "details of format"
965.cindex "format" "of message id"
966.cindex "id of message"
967.cindex "base62"
968.cindex "base36"
969.cindex "Darwin"
970.cindex "Cygwin"
971Every message handled by Exim is given a &'message id'& which is sixteen
972characters long. It is divided into three parts, separated by hyphens, for
973example &`16VDhn-0001bo-D3`&. Each part is a sequence of letters and digits,
974normally encoding numbers in base 62. However, in the Darwin operating
975system (Mac OS X) and when Exim is compiled to run under Cygwin, base 36
976(avoiding the use of lower case letters) is used instead, because the message
977id is used to construct file names, and the names of files in those systems are
978not always case-sensitive.
979
980.cindex "pid (process id)" "re-use of"
981The detail of the contents of the message id have changed as Exim has evolved.
982Earlier versions relied on the operating system not re-using a process id (pid)
983within one second. On modern operating systems, this assumption can no longer
984be made, so the algorithm had to be changed. To retain backward compatibility,
985the format of the message id was retained, which is why the following rules are
986somewhat eccentric:
987
988.ilist
989The first six characters of the message id are the time at which the message
990started to be received, to a granularity of one second. That is, this field
991contains the number of seconds since the start of the epoch (the normal Unix
992way of representing the date and time of day).
993.next
994After the first hyphen, the next six characters are the id of the process that
995received the message.
996.next
997There are two different possibilities for the final two characters:
998.olist
999.oindex "&%localhost_number%&"
1000If &%localhost_number%& is not set, this value is the fractional part of the
1001time of reception, normally in units of 1/2000 of a second, but for systems
1002that must use base 36 instead of base 62 (because of case-insensitive file
1003systems), the units are 1/1000 of a second.
1004.next
1005If &%localhost_number%& is set, it is multiplied by 200 (100) and added to
1006the fractional part of the time, which in this case is in units of 1/200
1007(1/100) of a second.
1008.endlist
1009.endlist
1010
1011After a message has been received, Exim waits for the clock to tick at the
1012appropriate resolution before proceeding, so that if another message is
1013received by the same process, or by another process with the same (re-used)
1014pid, it is guaranteed that the time will be different. In most cases, the clock
1015will already have ticked while the message was being received.
1016
1017
1018.section "Receiving mail" "SECID13"
1019.cindex "receiving mail"
1020.cindex "message" "reception"
1021The only way Exim can receive mail from another host is using SMTP over
1022TCP/IP, in which case the sender and recipient addresses are transferred using
1023SMTP commands. However, from a locally running process (such as a user's MUA),
1024there are several possibilities:
1025
1026.ilist
1027If the process runs Exim with the &%-bm%& option, the message is read
1028non-interactively (usually via a pipe), with the recipients taken from the
1029command line, or from the body of the message if &%-t%& is also used.
1030.next
1031If the process runs Exim with the &%-bS%& option, the message is also read
1032non-interactively, but in this case the recipients are listed at the start of
1033the message in a series of SMTP RCPT commands, terminated by a DATA
1034command. This is so-called &"batch SMTP"& format,
1035but it isn't really SMTP. The SMTP commands are just another way of passing
1036envelope addresses in a non-interactive submission.
1037.next
1038If the process runs Exim with the &%-bs%& option, the message is read
1039interactively, using the SMTP protocol. A two-way pipe is normally used for
1040passing data between the local process and the Exim process.
1041This is &"real"& SMTP and is handled in the same way as SMTP over TCP/IP. For
1042example, the ACLs for SMTP commands are used for this form of submission.
1043.next
1044A local process may also make a TCP/IP call to the host's loopback address
1045(127.0.0.1) or any other of its IP addresses. When receiving messages, Exim
1046does not treat the loopback address specially. It treats all such connections
1047in the same way as connections from other hosts.
1048.endlist
1049
1050
1051.cindex "message sender, constructed by Exim"
1052.cindex "sender" "constructed by Exim"
1053In the three cases that do not involve TCP/IP, the sender address is
1054constructed from the login name of the user that called Exim and a default
1055qualification domain (which can be set by the &%qualify_domain%& configuration
1056option). For local or batch SMTP, a sender address that is passed using the
1057SMTP MAIL command is ignored. However, the system administrator may allow
1058certain users (&"trusted users"&) to specify a different sender address
1059unconditionally, or all users to specify certain forms of different sender
1060address. The &%-f%& option or the SMTP MAIL command is used to specify these
1061different addresses. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of trusted
1062users, and the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of allowing untrusted
1063users to change sender addresses.
1064
1065Messages received by either of the non-interactive mechanisms are subject to
1066checking by the non-SMTP ACL, if one is defined. Messages received using SMTP
1067(either over TCP/IP, or interacting with a local process) can be checked by a
1068number of ACLs that operate at different times during the SMTP session. Either
1069individual recipients, or the entire message, can be rejected if local policy
1070requirements are not met. The &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
1071&<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) is run for all incoming messages.
1072
1073Exim can be configured not to start a delivery process when a message is
1074received; this can be unconditional, or depend on the number of incoming SMTP
1075connections or the system load. In these situations, new messages wait on the
1076queue until a queue runner process picks them up. However, in standard
1077configurations under normal conditions, delivery is started as soon as a
1078message is received.
1079
1080
1081
1082
1083
1084.section "Handling an incoming message" "SECID14"
1085.cindex "spool directory" "files that hold a message"
1086.cindex "file" "how a message is held"
1087When Exim accepts a message, it writes two files in its spool directory. The
1088first contains the envelope information, the current status of the message, and
1089the header lines, and the second contains the body of the message. The names of
1090the two spool files consist of the message id, followed by &`-H`& for the
1091file containing the envelope and header, and &`-D`& for the data file.
1092
1093.cindex "spool directory" "&_input_& sub-directory"
1094By default all these message files are held in a single directory called
1095&_input_& inside the general Exim spool directory. Some operating systems do
1096not perform very well if the number of files in a directory gets large; to
1097improve performance in such cases, the &%split_spool_directory%& option can be
1098used. This causes Exim to split up the input files into 62 sub-directories
1099whose names are single letters or digits. When this is done, the queue is
1100processed one sub-directory at a time instead of all at once, which can improve
1101overall performance even when there are not enough files in each directory to
1102affect file system performance.
1103
1104The envelope information consists of the address of the message's sender and
1105the addresses of the recipients. This information is entirely separate from
1106any addresses contained in the header lines. The status of the message includes
1107a list of recipients who have already received the message. The format of the
1108first spool file is described in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>&.
1109
1110.cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
1111Address rewriting that is specified in the rewrite section of the configuration
1112(see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&) is done once and for all on incoming addresses,
1113both in the header lines and the envelope, at the time the message is accepted.
1114If during the course of delivery additional addresses are generated (for
1115example, via aliasing), these new addresses are rewritten as soon as they are
1116generated. At the time a message is actually delivered (transported) further
1117rewriting can take place; because this is a transport option, it can be
1118different for different forms of delivery. It is also possible to specify the
1119addition or removal of certain header lines at the time the message is
1120delivered (see chapters &<<CHAProutergeneric>>& and
1121&<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
1122
1123
1124
1125.section "Life of a message" "SECID15"
1126.cindex "message" "life of"
1127.cindex "message" "frozen"
1128A message remains in the spool directory until it is completely delivered to
1129its recipients or to an error address, or until it is deleted by an
1130administrator or by the user who originally created it. In cases when delivery
1131cannot proceed &-- for example, when a message can neither be delivered to its
1132recipients nor returned to its sender, the message is marked &"frozen"& on the
1133spool, and no more deliveries are attempted.
1134
1135.cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
1136.cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
1137An administrator can &"thaw"& such messages when the problem has been
1138corrected, and can also freeze individual messages by hand if necessary. In
1139addition, an administrator can force a delivery error, causing a bounce message
1140to be sent.
1141
1142.oindex "&%timeout_frozen_after%&"
1143.oindex "&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&"
1144There are options called &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& and
1145&%timeout_frozen_after%&, which discard frozen messages after a certain time.
1146The first applies only to frozen bounces, the second to any frozen messages.
1147
1148.cindex "message" "log file for"
1149.cindex "log" "file for each message"
1150While Exim is working on a message, it writes information about each delivery
1151attempt to its main log file. This includes successful, unsuccessful, and
1152delayed deliveries for each recipient (see chapter &<<CHAPlog>>&). The log
1153lines are also written to a separate &'message log'& file for each message.
1154These logs are solely for the benefit of the administrator, and are normally
1155deleted along with the spool files when processing of a message is complete.
1156The use of individual message logs can be disabled by setting
1157&%no_message_logs%&; this might give an improvement in performance on very busy
1158systems.
1159
1160.cindex "journal file"
1161.cindex "file" "journal"
1162All the information Exim itself needs to set up a delivery is kept in the first
1163spool file, along with the header lines. When a successful delivery occurs, the
1164address is immediately written at the end of a journal file, whose name is the
1165message id followed by &`-J`&. At the end of a delivery run, if there are some
1166addresses left to be tried again later, the first spool file (the &`-H`& file)
1167is updated to indicate which these are, and the journal file is then deleted.
1168Updating the spool file is done by writing a new file and renaming it, to
1169minimize the possibility of data loss.
1170
1171Should the system or the program crash after a successful delivery but before
1172the spool file has been updated, the journal is left lying around. The next
1173time Exim attempts to deliver the message, it reads the journal file and
1174updates the spool file before proceeding. This minimizes the chances of double
1175deliveries caused by crashes.
1176
1177
1178
1179.section "Processing an address for delivery" "SECTprocaddress"
1180.cindex "drivers" "definition of"
1181.cindex "router" "definition of"
1182.cindex "transport" "definition of"
1183The main delivery processing elements of Exim are called &'routers'& and
1184&'transports'&, and collectively these are known as &'drivers'&. Code for a
1185number of them is provided in the source distribution, and compile-time options
1186specify which ones are included in the binary. Run time options specify which
1187ones are actually used for delivering messages.
1188
1189.cindex "drivers" "instance definition"
1190Each driver that is specified in the run time configuration is an &'instance'&
1191of that particular driver type. Multiple instances are allowed; for example,
1192you can set up several different &(smtp)& transports, each with different
1193option values that might specify different ports or different timeouts. Each
1194instance has its own identifying name. In what follows we will normally use the
1195instance name when discussing one particular instance (that is, one specific
1196configuration of the driver), and the generic driver name when discussing
1197the driver's features in general.
1198
1199A &'router'& is a driver that operates on an address, either determining how
1200its delivery should happen, by assigning it to a specific transport, or
1201converting the address into one or more new addresses (for example, via an
1202alias file). A router may also explicitly choose to fail an address, causing it
1203to be bounced.
1204
1205A &'transport'& is a driver that transmits a copy of the message from Exim's
1206spool to some destination. There are two kinds of transport: for a &'local'&
1207transport, the destination is a file or a pipe on the local host, whereas for a
1208&'remote'& transport the destination is some other host. A message is passed
1209to a specific transport as a result of successful routing. If a message has
1210several recipients, it may be passed to a number of different transports.
1211
1212.cindex "preconditions" "definition of"
1213An address is processed by passing it to each configured router instance in
1214turn, subject to certain preconditions, until a router accepts the address or
1215specifies that it should be bounced. We will describe this process in more
1216detail shortly. First, as a simple example, we consider how each recipient
1217address in a message is processed in a small configuration of three routers.
1218
1219To make this a more concrete example, it is described in terms of some actual
1220routers, but remember, this is only an example. You can configure Exim's
1221routers in many different ways, and there may be any number of routers in a
1222configuration.
1223
1224The first router that is specified in a configuration is often one that handles
1225addresses in domains that are not recognized specially by the local host. These
1226are typically addresses for arbitrary domains on the Internet. A precondition
1227is set up which looks for the special domains known to the host (for example,
1228its own domain name), and the router is run for addresses that do &'not'&
1229match. Typically, this is a router that looks up domains in the DNS in order to
1230find the hosts to which this address routes. If it succeeds, the address is
1231assigned to a suitable SMTP transport; if it does not succeed, the router is
1232configured to fail the address.
1233
1234The second router is reached only when the domain is recognized as one that
1235&"belongs"& to the local host. This router does redirection &-- also known as
1236aliasing and forwarding. When it generates one or more new addresses from the
1237original, each of them is routed independently from the start. Otherwise, the
1238router may cause an address to fail, or it may simply decline to handle the
1239address, in which case the address is passed to the next router.
1240
1241The final router in many configurations is one that checks to see if the
1242address belongs to a local mailbox. The precondition may involve a check to
1243see if the local part is the name of a login account, or it may look up the
1244local part in a file or a database. If its preconditions are not met, or if
1245the router declines, we have reached the end of the routers. When this happens,
1246the address is bounced.
1247
1248
1249
1250.section "Processing an address for verification" "SECID16"
1251.cindex "router" "for verification"
1252.cindex "verifying address" "overview"
1253As well as being used to decide how to deliver to an address, Exim's routers
1254are also used for &'address verification'&. Verification can be requested as
1255one of the checks to be performed in an ACL for incoming messages, on both
1256sender and recipient addresses, and it can be tested using the &%-bv%& and
1257&%-bvs%& command line options.
1258
1259When an address is being verified, the routers are run in &"verify mode"&. This
1260does not affect the way the routers work, but it is a state that can be
1261detected. By this means, a router can be skipped or made to behave differently
1262when verifying. A common example is a configuration in which the first router
1263sends all messages to a message-scanning program, unless they have been
1264previously scanned. Thus, the first router accepts all addresses without any
1265checking, making it useless for verifying. Normally, the &%no_verify%& option
1266would be set for such a router, causing it to be skipped in verify mode.
1267
1268
1269
1270
1271.section "Running an individual router" "SECTrunindrou"
1272.cindex "router" "running details"
1273.cindex "preconditions" "checking"
1274.cindex "router" "result of running"
1275As explained in the example above, a number of preconditions are checked before
1276running a router. If any are not met, the router is skipped, and the address is
1277passed to the next router. When all the preconditions on a router &'are'& met,
1278the router is run. What happens next depends on the outcome, which is one of
1279the following:
1280
1281.ilist
1282&'accept'&: The router accepts the address, and either assigns it to a
1283transport, or generates one or more &"child"& addresses. Processing the
1284original address ceases,
1285.oindex "&%unseen%&"
1286unless the &%unseen%& option is set on the router. This option
1287can be used to set up multiple deliveries with different routing (for example,
1288for keeping archive copies of messages). When &%unseen%& is set, the address is
1289passed to the next router. Normally, however, an &'accept'& return marks the
1290end of routing.
1291
1292Any child addresses generated by the router are processed independently,
1293starting with the first router by default. It is possible to change this by
1294setting the &%redirect_router%& option to specify which router to start at for
1295child addresses. Unlike &%pass_router%& (see below) the router specified by
1296&%redirect_router%& may be anywhere in the router configuration.
1297.next
1298&'pass'&: The router recognizes the address, but cannot handle it itself. It
1299requests that the address be passed to another router. By default the address
1300is passed to the next router, but this can be changed by setting the
1301&%pass_router%& option. However, (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router
1302must be below the current router (to avoid loops).
1303.next
1304&'decline'&: The router declines to accept the address because it does not
1305recognize it at all. By default, the address is passed to the next router, but
1306this can be prevented by setting the &%no_more%& option. When &%no_more%& is
1307set, all the remaining routers are skipped. In effect, &%no_more%& converts
1308&'decline'& into &'fail'&.
1309.next
1310&'fail'&: The router determines that the address should fail, and queues it for
1311the generation of a bounce message. There is no further processing of the
1312original address unless &%unseen%& is set on the router.
1313.next
1314&'defer'&: The router cannot handle the address at the present time. (A
1315database may be offline, or a DNS lookup may have timed out.) No further
1316processing of the address happens in this delivery attempt. It is tried again
1317next time the message is considered for delivery.
1318.next
1319&'error'&: There is some error in the router (for example, a syntax error in
1320its configuration). The action is as for defer.
1321.endlist
1322
1323If an address reaches the end of the routers without having been accepted by
1324any of them, it is bounced as unrouteable. The default error message in this
1325situation is &"unrouteable address"&, but you can set your own message by
1326making use of the &%cannot_route_message%& option. This can be set for any
1327router; the value from the last router that &"saw"& the address is used.
1328
1329Sometimes while routing you want to fail a delivery when some conditions are
1330met but others are not, instead of passing the address on for further routing.
1331You can do this by having a second router that explicitly fails the delivery
1332when the relevant conditions are met. The &(redirect)& router has a &"fail"&
1333facility for this purpose.
1334
1335
1336.section "Duplicate addresses" "SECID17"
1337.cindex "case of local parts"
1338.cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
1339.cindex "duplicate addresses"
1340Once routing is complete, Exim scans the addresses that are assigned to local
1341and remote transports, and discards any duplicates that it finds. During this
1342check, local parts are treated as case-sensitive. This happens only when
1343actually delivering a message; when testing routers with &%-bt%&, all the
1344routed addresses are shown.
1345
1346
1347
1348.section "Router preconditions" "SECTrouprecon"
1349.cindex "router" "preconditions, order of processing"
1350.cindex "preconditions" "order of processing"
1351The preconditions that are tested for each router are listed below, in the
1352order in which they are tested. The individual configuration options are
1353described in more detail in chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&.
1354
1355.ilist
1356The &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& options can specify that
1357the local parts handled by the router may or must have certain prefixes and/or
1358suffixes. If a mandatory affix (prefix or suffix) is not present, the router is
1359skipped. These conditions are tested first. When an affix is present, it is
1360removed from the local part before further processing, including the evaluation
1361of any other conditions.
1362.next
1363Routers can be designated for use only when not verifying an address, that is,
1364only when routing it for delivery (or testing its delivery routing). If the
1365&%verify%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is verifying an
1366address.
1367Setting the &%verify%& option actually sets two options, &%verify_sender%& and
1368&%verify_recipient%&, which independently control the use of the router for
1369sender and recipient verification. You can set these options directly if
1370you want a router to be used for only one type of verification.
1371Note that cutthrough delivery is classed as a recipient verification for this purpose.
1372.next
1373If the &%address_test%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is
1374run with the &%-bt%& option to test an address routing. This can be helpful
1375when the first router sends all new messages to a scanner of some sort; it
1376makes it possible to use &%-bt%& to test subsequent delivery routing without
1377having to simulate the effect of the scanner.
1378.next
1379Routers can be designated for use only when verifying an address, as
1380opposed to routing it for delivery. The &%verify_only%& option controls this.
1381Again, cutthrough delivery counts as a verification.
1382.next
1383Individual routers can be explicitly skipped when running the routers to
1384check an address given in the SMTP EXPN command (see the &%expn%& option).
1385.next
1386If the &%domains%& option is set, the domain of the address must be in the set
1387of domains that it defines.
1388.next
1389.vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
1390.vindex "&$local_part$&"
1391.vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
1392If the &%local_parts%& option is set, the local part of the address must be in
1393the set of local parts that it defines. If &%local_part_prefix%& or
1394&%local_part_suffix%& is in use, the prefix or suffix is removed from the local
1395part before this check. If you want to do precondition tests on local parts
1396that include affixes, you can do so by using a &%condition%& option (see below)
1397that uses the variables &$local_part$&, &$local_part_prefix$&, and
1398&$local_part_suffix$& as necessary.
1399.next
1400.vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
1401.vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
1402.vindex "&$home$&"
1403If the &%check_local_user%& option is set, the local part must be the name of
1404an account on the local host. If this check succeeds, the uid and gid of the
1405local user are placed in &$local_user_uid$& and &$local_user_gid$& and the
1406user's home directory is placed in &$home$&; these values can be used in the
1407remaining preconditions.
1408.next
1409If the &%router_home_directory%& option is set, it is expanded at this point,
1410because it overrides the value of &$home$&. If this expansion were left till
1411later, the value of &$home$& as set by &%check_local_user%& would be used in
1412subsequent tests. Having two different values of &$home$& in the same router
1413could lead to confusion.
1414.next
1415If the &%senders%& option is set, the envelope sender address must be in the
1416set of addresses that it defines.
1417.next
1418If the &%require_files%& option is set, the existence or non-existence of
1419specified files is tested.
1420.next
1421.cindex "customizing" "precondition"
1422If the &%condition%& option is set, it is evaluated and tested. This option
1423uses an expanded string to allow you to set up your own custom preconditions.
1424Expanded strings are described in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
1425.endlist
1426
1427
1428Note that &%require_files%& comes near the end of the list, so you cannot use
1429it to check for the existence of a file in which to lookup up a domain, local
1430part, or sender. However, as these options are all expanded, you can use the
1431&%exists%& expansion condition to make such tests within each condition. The
1432&%require_files%& option is intended for checking files that the router may be
1433going to use internally, or which are needed by a specific transport (for
1434example, &_.procmailrc_&).
1435
1436
1437
1438.section "Delivery in detail" "SECID18"
1439.cindex "delivery" "in detail"
1440When a message is to be delivered, the sequence of events is as follows:
1441
1442.ilist
1443If a system-wide filter file is specified, the message is passed to it. The
1444filter may add recipients to the message, replace the recipients, discard the
1445message, cause a new message to be generated, or cause the message delivery to
1446fail. The format of the system filter file is the same as for Exim user filter
1447files, described in the separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail
1448filtering'&.
1449.cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
1450(&*Note*&: Sieve cannot be used for system filter files.)
1451
1452Some additional features are available in system filters &-- see chapter
1453&<<CHAPsystemfilter>>& for details. Note that a message is passed to the system
1454filter only once per delivery attempt, however many recipients it has. However,
1455if there are several delivery attempts because one or more addresses could not
1456be immediately delivered, the system filter is run each time. The filter
1457condition &%first_delivery%& can be used to detect the first run of the system
1458filter.
1459.next
1460Each recipient address is offered to each configured router in turn, subject to
1461its preconditions, until one is able to handle it. If no router can handle the
1462address, that is, if they all decline, the address is failed. Because routers
1463can be targeted at particular domains, several locally handled domains can be
1464processed entirely independently of each other.
1465.next
1466.cindex "routing" "loops in"
1467.cindex "loop" "while routing"
1468A router that accepts an address may assign it to a local or a remote
1469transport. However, the transport is not run at this time. Instead, the address
1470is placed on a list for the particular transport, which will be run later.
1471Alternatively, the router may generate one or more new addresses (typically
1472from alias, forward, or filter files). New addresses are fed back into this
1473process from the top, but in order to avoid loops, a router ignores any address
1474which has an identically-named ancestor that was processed by itself.
1475.next
1476When all the routing has been done, addresses that have been successfully
1477handled are passed to their assigned transports. When local transports are
1478doing real local deliveries, they handle only one address at a time, but if a
1479local transport is being used as a pseudo-remote transport (for example, to
1480collect batched SMTP messages for transmission by some other means) multiple
1481addresses can be handled. Remote transports can always handle more than one
1482address at a time, but can be configured not to do so, or to restrict multiple
1483addresses to the same domain.
1484.next
1485Each local delivery to a file or a pipe runs in a separate process under a
1486non-privileged uid, and these deliveries are run one at a time. Remote
1487deliveries also run in separate processes, normally under a uid that is private
1488to Exim (&"the Exim user"&), but in this case, several remote deliveries can be
1489run in parallel. The maximum number of simultaneous remote deliveries for any
1490one message is set by the &%remote_max_parallel%& option.
1491The order in which deliveries are done is not defined, except that all local
1492deliveries happen before any remote deliveries.
1493.next
1494.cindex "queue runner"
1495When it encounters a local delivery during a queue run, Exim checks its retry
1496database to see if there has been a previous temporary delivery failure for the
1497address before running the local transport. If there was a previous failure,
1498Exim does not attempt a new delivery until the retry time for the address is
1499reached. However, this happens only for delivery attempts that are part of a
1500queue run. Local deliveries are always attempted when delivery immediately
1501follows message reception, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for
1502better behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example,
1503causing quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file).
1504.next
1505.cindex "delivery" "retry in remote transports"
1506Remote transports do their own retry handling, since an address may be
1507deliverable to one of a number of hosts, each of which may have a different
1508retry time. If there have been previous temporary failures and no host has
1509reached its retry time, no delivery is attempted, whether in a queue run or
1510not. See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for details of retry strategies.
1511.next
1512If there were any permanent errors, a bounce message is returned to an
1513appropriate address (the sender in the common case), with details of the error
1514for each failing address. Exim can be configured to send copies of bounce
1515messages to other addresses.
1516.next
1517.cindex "delivery" "deferral"
1518If one or more addresses suffered a temporary failure, the message is left on
1519the queue, to be tried again later. Delivery of these addresses is said to be
1520&'deferred'&.
1521.next
1522When all the recipient addresses have either been delivered or bounced,
1523handling of the message is complete. The spool files and message log are
1524deleted, though the message log can optionally be preserved if required.
1525.endlist
1526
1527
1528
1529
1530.section "Retry mechanism" "SECID19"
1531.cindex "delivery" "retry mechanism"
1532.cindex "retry" "description of mechanism"
1533.cindex "queue runner"
1534Exim's mechanism for retrying messages that fail to get delivered at the first
1535attempt is the queue runner process. You must either run an Exim daemon that
1536uses the &%-q%& option with a time interval to start queue runners at regular
1537intervals, or use some other means (such as &'cron'&) to start them. If you do
1538not arrange for queue runners to be run, messages that fail temporarily at the
1539first attempt will remain on your queue for ever. A queue runner process works
1540its way through the queue, one message at a time, trying each delivery that has
1541passed its retry time.
1542You can run several queue runners at once.
1543
1544Exim uses a set of configured rules to determine when next to retry the failing
1545address (see chapter &<<CHAPretry>>&). These rules also specify when Exim
1546should give up trying to deliver to the address, at which point it generates a
1547bounce message. If no retry rules are set for a particular host, address, and
1548error combination, no retries are attempted, and temporary errors are treated
1549as permanent.
1550
1551
1552
1553.section "Temporary delivery failure" "SECID20"
1554.cindex "delivery" "temporary failure"
1555There are many reasons why a message may not be immediately deliverable to a
1556particular address. Failure to connect to a remote machine (because it, or the
1557connection to it, is down) is one of the most common. Temporary failures may be
1558detected during routing as well as during the transport stage of delivery.
1559Local deliveries may be delayed if NFS files are unavailable, or if a mailbox
1560is on a file system where the user is over quota. Exim can be configured to
1561impose its own quotas on local mailboxes; where system quotas are set they will
1562also apply.
1563
1564If a host is unreachable for a period of time, a number of messages may be
1565waiting for it by the time it recovers, and sending them in a single SMTP
1566connection is clearly beneficial. Whenever a delivery to a remote host is
1567deferred,
1568.cindex "hints database" "deferred deliveries"
1569Exim makes a note in its hints database, and whenever a successful
1570SMTP delivery has happened, it looks to see if any other messages are waiting
1571for the same host. If any are found, they are sent over the same SMTP
1572connection, subject to a configuration limit as to the maximum number in any
1573one connection.
1574
1575
1576
1577.section "Permanent delivery failure" "SECID21"
1578.cindex "delivery" "permanent failure"
1579.cindex "bounce message" "when generated"
1580When a message cannot be delivered to some or all of its intended recipients, a
1581bounce message is generated. Temporary delivery failures turn into permanent
1582errors when their timeout expires. All the addresses that fail in a given
1583delivery attempt are listed in a single message. If the original message has
1584many recipients, it is possible for some addresses to fail in one delivery
1585attempt and others to fail subsequently, giving rise to more than one bounce
1586message. The wording of bounce messages can be customized by the administrator.
1587See chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>& for details.
1588
1589.cindex "&'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line"
1590Bounce messages contain an &'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line that lists the
1591failed addresses, for the benefit of programs that try to analyse such messages
1592automatically.
1593
1594.cindex "bounce message" "recipient of"
1595A bounce message is normally sent to the sender of the original message, as
1596obtained from the message's envelope. For incoming SMTP messages, this is the
1597address given in the MAIL command. However, when an address is expanded via a
1598forward or alias file, an alternative address can be specified for delivery
1599failures of the generated addresses. For a mailing list expansion (see section
1600&<<SECTmailinglists>>&) it is common to direct bounce messages to the manager
1601of the list.
1602
1603
1604
1605.section "Failures to deliver bounce messages" "SECID22"
1606.cindex "bounce message" "failure to deliver"
1607If a bounce message (either locally generated or received from a remote host)
1608itself suffers a permanent delivery failure, the message is left on the queue,
1609but it is frozen, awaiting the attention of an administrator. There are options
1610that can be used to make Exim discard such failed messages, or to keep them
1611for only a short time (see &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
1612&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
1613
1614
1615
1616
1617
1618. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1619. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1620
1621.chapter "Building and installing Exim" "CHID3"
1622.scindex IIDbuex "building Exim"
1623
1624.section "Unpacking" "SECID23"
1625Exim is distributed as a gzipped or bzipped tar file which, when unpacked,
1626creates a directory with the name of the current release (for example,
1627&_exim-&version()_&) into which the following files are placed:
1628
1629.table2 140pt
1630.irow &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_& "contains some acknowledgments"
1631.irow &_CHANGES_& "contains a reference to where changes are &&&
1632 documented"
1633.irow &_LICENCE_& "the GNU General Public Licence"
1634.irow &_Makefile_& "top-level make file"
1635.irow &_NOTICE_& "conditions for the use of Exim"
1636.irow &_README_& "list of files, directories and simple build &&&
1637 instructions"
1638.endtable
1639
1640Other files whose names begin with &_README_& may also be present. The
1641following subdirectories are created:
1642
1643.table2 140pt
1644.irow &_Local_& "an empty directory for local configuration files"
1645.irow &_OS_& "OS-specific files"
1646.irow &_doc_& "documentation files"
1647.irow &_exim_monitor_& "source files for the Exim monitor"
1648.irow &_scripts_& "scripts used in the build process"
1649.irow &_src_& "remaining source files"
1650.irow &_util_& "independent utilities"
1651.endtable
1652
1653The main utility programs are contained in the &_src_& directory, and are built
1654with the Exim binary. The &_util_& directory contains a few optional scripts
1655that may be useful to some sites.
1656
1657
1658.section "Multiple machine architectures and operating systems" "SECID24"
1659.cindex "building Exim" "multiple OS/architectures"
1660The building process for Exim is arranged to make it easy to build binaries for
1661a number of different architectures and operating systems from the same set of
1662source files. Compilation does not take place in the &_src_& directory.
1663Instead, a &'build directory'& is created for each architecture and operating
1664system.
1665.cindex "symbolic link" "to build directory"
1666Symbolic links to the sources are installed in this directory, which is where
1667the actual building takes place. In most cases, Exim can discover the machine
1668architecture and operating system for itself, but the defaults can be
1669overridden if necessary.
1670
1671
1672.section "PCRE library" "SECTpcre"
1673.cindex "PCRE library"
1674Exim no longer has an embedded PCRE library as the vast majority of
1675modern systems include PCRE as a system library, although you may need
1676to install the PCRE or PCRE development package for your operating
1677system. If your system has a normal PCRE installation the Exim build
1678process will need no further configuration. If the library or the
1679headers are in an unusual location you will need to either set the PCRE_LIBS
1680and INCLUDE directives appropriately,
1681or set PCRE_CONFIG=yes to use the installed &(pcre-config)& command.
1682If your operating system has no
1683PCRE support then you will need to obtain and build the current PCRE
1684from &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre/).
1685More information on PCRE is available at &url(http://www.pcre.org/).
1686
1687.section "DBM libraries" "SECTdb"
1688.cindex "DBM libraries" "discussion of"
1689.cindex "hints database" "DBM files used for"
1690Even if you do not use any DBM files in your configuration, Exim still needs a
1691DBM library in order to operate, because it uses indexed files for its hints
1692databases. Unfortunately, there are a number of DBM libraries in existence, and
1693different operating systems often have different ones installed.
1694
1695.cindex "Solaris" "DBM library for"
1696.cindex "IRIX, DBM library for"
1697.cindex "BSD, DBM library for"
1698.cindex "Linux, DBM library for"
1699If you are using Solaris, IRIX, one of the modern BSD systems, or a modern
1700Linux distribution, the DBM configuration should happen automatically, and you
1701may be able to ignore this section. Otherwise, you may have to learn more than
1702you would like about DBM libraries from what follows.
1703
1704.cindex "&'ndbm'& DBM library"
1705Licensed versions of Unix normally contain a library of DBM functions operating
1706via the &'ndbm'& interface, and this is what Exim expects by default. Free
1707versions of Unix seem to vary in what they contain as standard. In particular,
1708some early versions of Linux have no default DBM library, and different
1709distributors have chosen to bundle different libraries with their packaged
1710versions. However, the more recent releases seem to have standardized on the
1711Berkeley DB library.
1712
1713Different DBM libraries have different conventions for naming the files they
1714use. When a program opens a file called &_dbmfile_&, there are several
1715possibilities:
1716
1717.olist
1718A traditional &'ndbm'& implementation, such as that supplied as part of
1719Solaris, operates on two files called &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&.
1720.next
1721.cindex "&'gdbm'& DBM library"
1722The GNU library, &'gdbm'&, operates on a single file. If used via its &'ndbm'&
1723compatibility interface it makes two different hard links to it with names
1724&_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&, but if used via its native interface, the
1725file name is used unmodified.
1726.next
1727.cindex "Berkeley DB library"
1728The Berkeley DB package, if called via its &'ndbm'& compatibility interface,
1729operates on a single file called &_dbmfile.db_&, but otherwise looks to the
1730programmer exactly the same as the traditional &'ndbm'& implementation.
1731.next
1732If the Berkeley package is used in its native mode, it operates on a single
1733file called &_dbmfile_&; the programmer's interface is somewhat different to
1734the traditional &'ndbm'& interface.
1735.next
1736To complicate things further, there are several very different versions of the
1737Berkeley DB package. Version 1.85 was stable for a very long time, releases
17382.&'x'& and 3.&'x'& were current for a while, but the latest versions are now
1739numbered 4.&'x'&. Maintenance of some of the earlier releases has ceased. All
1740versions of Berkeley DB can be obtained from
1741&url(http://www.sleepycat.com/).
1742.next
1743.cindex "&'tdb'& DBM library"
1744Yet another DBM library, called &'tdb'&, is available from
1745&url(http://download.sourceforge.net/tdb). It has its own interface, and also
1746operates on a single file.
1747.endlist
1748
1749.cindex "USE_DB"
1750.cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
1751Exim and its utilities can be compiled to use any of these interfaces. In order
1752to use any version of the Berkeley DB package in native mode, you must set
1753USE_DB in an appropriate configuration file (typically
1754&_Local/Makefile_&). For example:
1755.code
1756USE_DB=yes
1757.endd
1758Similarly, for gdbm you set USE_GDBM, and for tdb you set USE_TDB. An
1759error is diagnosed if you set more than one of these.
1760
1761At the lowest level, the build-time configuration sets none of these options,
1762thereby assuming an interface of type (1). However, some operating system
1763configuration files (for example, those for the BSD operating systems and
1764Linux) assume type (4) by setting USE_DB as their default, and the
1765configuration files for Cygwin set USE_GDBM. Anything you set in
1766&_Local/Makefile_&, however, overrides these system defaults.
1767
1768As well as setting USE_DB, USE_GDBM, or USE_TDB, it may also be
1769necessary to set DBMLIB, to cause inclusion of the appropriate library, as
1770in one of these lines:
1771.code
1772DBMLIB = -ldb
1773DBMLIB = -ltdb
1774.endd
1775Settings like that will work if the DBM library is installed in the standard
1776place. Sometimes it is not, and the library's header file may also not be in
1777the default path. You may need to set INCLUDE to specify where the header
1778file is, and to specify the path to the library more fully in DBMLIB, as in
1779this example:
1780.code
1781INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/include/db-4.1
1782DBMLIB=/usr/local/lib/db-4.1/libdb.a
1783.endd
1784There is further detailed discussion about the various DBM libraries in the
1785file &_doc/dbm.discuss.txt_& in the Exim distribution.
1786
1787
1788
1789.section "Pre-building configuration" "SECID25"
1790.cindex "building Exim" "pre-building configuration"
1791.cindex "configuration for building Exim"
1792.cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
1793.cindex "&_src/EDITME_&"
1794Before building Exim, a local configuration file that specifies options
1795independent of any operating system has to be created with the name
1796&_Local/Makefile_&. A template for this file is supplied as the file
1797&_src/EDITME_&, and it contains full descriptions of all the option settings
1798therein. These descriptions are therefore not repeated here. If you are
1799building Exim for the first time, the simplest thing to do is to copy
1800&_src/EDITME_& to &_Local/Makefile_&, then read it and edit it appropriately.
1801
1802There are three settings that you must supply, because Exim will not build
1803without them. They are the location of the run time configuration file
1804(CONFIGURE_FILE), the directory in which Exim binaries will be installed
1805(BIN_DIRECTORY), and the identity of the Exim user (EXIM_USER and
1806maybe EXIM_GROUP as well). The value of CONFIGURE_FILE can in fact be
1807a colon-separated list of file names; Exim uses the first of them that exists.
1808
1809There are a few other parameters that can be specified either at build time or
1810at run time, to enable the same binary to be used on a number of different
1811machines. However, if the locations of Exim's spool directory and log file
1812directory (if not within the spool directory) are fixed, it is recommended that
1813you specify them in &_Local/Makefile_& instead of at run time, so that errors
1814detected early in Exim's execution (such as a malformed configuration file) can
1815be logged.
1816
1817.cindex "content scanning" "specifying at build time"
1818Exim's interfaces for calling virus and spam scanning software directly from
1819access control lists are not compiled by default. If you want to include these
1820facilities, you need to set
1821.code
1822WITH_CONTENT_SCAN=yes
1823.endd
1824in your &_Local/Makefile_&. For details of the facilities themselves, see
1825chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
1826
1827
1828.cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
1829.cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
1830If you are going to build the Exim monitor, a similar configuration process is
1831required. The file &_exim_monitor/EDITME_& must be edited appropriately for
1832your installation and saved under the name &_Local/eximon.conf_&. If you are
1833happy with the default settings described in &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&,
1834&_Local/eximon.conf_& can be empty, but it must exist.
1835
1836This is all the configuration that is needed in straightforward cases for known
1837operating systems. However, the building process is set up so that it is easy
1838to override options that are set by default or by operating-system-specific
1839configuration files, for example to change the name of the C compiler, which
1840defaults to &%gcc%&. See section &<<SECToverride>>& below for details of how to
1841do this.
1842
1843
1844
1845.section "Support for iconv()" "SECID26"
1846.cindex "&[iconv()]& support"
1847.cindex "RFC 2047"
1848The contents of header lines in messages may be encoded according to the rules
1849described RFC 2047. This makes it possible to transmit characters that are not
1850in the ASCII character set, and to label them as being in a particular
1851character set. When Exim is inspecting header lines by means of the &%$h_%&
1852mechanism, it decodes them, and translates them into a specified character set
1853(default is set at build time). The translation is possible only if the operating system
1854supports the &[iconv()]& function.
1855
1856However, some of the operating systems that supply &[iconv()]& do not support
1857very many conversions. The GNU &%libiconv%& library (available from
1858&url(http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv/)) can be installed on such
1859systems to remedy this deficiency, as well as on systems that do not supply
1860&[iconv()]& at all. After installing &%libiconv%&, you should add
1861.code
1862HAVE_ICONV=yes
1863.endd
1864to your &_Local/Makefile_& and rebuild Exim.
1865
1866
1867
1868.section "Including TLS/SSL encryption support" "SECTinctlsssl"
1869.cindex "TLS" "including support for TLS"
1870.cindex "encryption" "including support for"
1871.cindex "SUPPORT_TLS"
1872.cindex "OpenSSL" "building Exim with"
1873.cindex "GnuTLS" "building Exim with"
1874Exim can be built to support encrypted SMTP connections, using the STARTTLS
1875command as per RFC 2487. It can also support legacy clients that expect to
1876start a TLS session immediately on connection to a non-standard port (see the
1877&%tls_on_connect_ports%& runtime option and the &%-tls-on-connect%& command
1878line option).
1879
1880If you want to build Exim with TLS support, you must first install either the
1881OpenSSL or GnuTLS library. There is no cryptographic code in Exim itself for
1882implementing SSL.
1883
1884If OpenSSL is installed, you should set
1885.code
1886SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1887TLS_LIBS=-lssl -lcrypto
1888.endd
1889in &_Local/Makefile_&. You may also need to specify the locations of the
1890OpenSSL library and include files. For example:
1891.code
1892SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1893TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/local/openssl/lib -lssl -lcrypto
1894TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/openssl/include/
1895.endd
1896.cindex "pkg-config" "OpenSSL"
1897If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1898.code
1899SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1900USE_OPENSSL_PC=openssl
1901.endd
1902.cindex "USE_GNUTLS"
1903If GnuTLS is installed, you should set
1904.code
1905SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1906USE_GNUTLS=yes
1907TLS_LIBS=-lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1908.endd
1909in &_Local/Makefile_&, and again you may need to specify the locations of the
1910library and include files. For example:
1911.code
1912SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1913USE_GNUTLS=yes
1914TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/gnu/lib -lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1915TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/gnu/include
1916.endd
1917.cindex "pkg-config" "GnuTLS"
1918If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1919.code
1920SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1921USE_GNUTLS=yes
1922USE_GNUTLS_PC=gnutls
1923.endd
1924
1925You do not need to set TLS_INCLUDE if the relevant directory is already
1926specified in INCLUDE. Details of how to configure Exim to make use of TLS are
1927given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
1928
1929
1930
1931
1932.section "Use of tcpwrappers" "SECID27"
1933
1934.cindex "tcpwrappers, building Exim to support"
1935.cindex "USE_TCP_WRAPPERS"
1936.cindex "TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME"
1937.cindex "tcp_wrappers_daemon_name"
1938Exim can be linked with the &'tcpwrappers'& library in order to check incoming
1939SMTP calls using the &'tcpwrappers'& control files. This may be a convenient
1940alternative to Exim's own checking facilities for installations that are
1941already making use of &'tcpwrappers'& for other purposes. To do this, you
1942should set USE_TCP_WRAPPERS in &_Local/Makefile_&, arrange for the file
1943&_tcpd.h_& to be available at compile time, and also ensure that the library
1944&_libwrap.a_& is available at link time, typically by including &%-lwrap%& in
1945EXTRALIBS_EXIM. For example, if &'tcpwrappers'& is installed in &_/usr/local_&,
1946you might have
1947.code
1948USE_TCP_WRAPPERS=yes
1949CFLAGS=-O -I/usr/local/include
1950EXTRALIBS_EXIM=-L/usr/local/lib -lwrap
1951.endd
1952in &_Local/Makefile_&. The daemon name to use in the &'tcpwrappers'& control
1953files is &"exim"&. For example, the line
1954.code
1955exim : LOCAL 192.168.1. .friendly.domain.example
1956.endd
1957in your &_/etc/hosts.allow_& file allows connections from the local host, from
1958the subnet 192.168.1.0/24, and from all hosts in &'friendly.domain.example'&.
1959All other connections are denied. The daemon name used by &'tcpwrappers'&
1960can be changed at build time by setting TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME in
1961&_Local/Makefile_&, or by setting tcp_wrappers_daemon_name in the
1962configure file. Consult the &'tcpwrappers'& documentation for
1963further details.
1964
1965
1966.section "Including support for IPv6" "SECID28"
1967.cindex "IPv6" "including support for"
1968Exim contains code for use on systems that have IPv6 support. Setting
1969&`HAVE_IPV6=YES`& in &_Local/Makefile_& causes the IPv6 code to be included;
1970it may also be necessary to set IPV6_INCLUDE and IPV6_LIBS on systems
1971where the IPv6 support is not fully integrated into the normal include and
1972library files.
1973
1974Two different types of DNS record for handling IPv6 addresses have been
1975defined. AAAA records (analogous to A records for IPv4) are in use, and are
1976currently seen as the mainstream. Another record type called A6 was proposed
1977as better than AAAA because it had more flexibility. However, it was felt to be
1978over-complex, and its status was reduced to &"experimental"&.
1979Exim used to
1980have a compile option for including A6 record support but this has now been
1981withdrawn.
1982
1983
1984
1985.section "Dynamically loaded lookup module support" "SECTdynamicmodules"
1986.cindex "lookup modules"
1987.cindex "dynamic modules"
1988.cindex ".so building"
1989On some platforms, Exim supports not compiling all lookup types directly into
1990the main binary, instead putting some into external modules which can be loaded
1991on demand.
1992This permits packagers to build Exim with support for lookups with extensive
1993library dependencies without requiring all users to install all of those
1994dependencies.
1995Most, but not all, lookup types can be built this way.
1996
1997Set &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& to the directory into which the modules will be
1998installed; Exim will only load modules from that directory, as a security
1999measure. You will need to set &`CFLAGS_DYNAMIC`& if not already defined
2000for your OS; see &_OS/Makefile-Linux_& for an example.
2001Some other requirements for adjusting &`EXTRALIBS`& may also be necessary,
2002see &_src/EDITME_& for details.
2003
2004Then, for each module to be loaded dynamically, define the relevant
2005&`LOOKUP_`&<&'lookup_type'&> flags to have the value "2" instead of "yes".
2006For example, this will build in lsearch but load sqlite and mysql support
2007on demand:
2008.code
2009LOOKUP_LSEARCH=yes
2010LOOKUP_SQLITE=2
2011LOOKUP_MYSQL=2
2012.endd
2013
2014
2015.section "The building process" "SECID29"
2016.cindex "build directory"
2017Once &_Local/Makefile_& (and &_Local/eximon.conf_&, if required) have been
2018created, run &'make'& at the top level. It determines the architecture and
2019operating system types, and creates a build directory if one does not exist.
2020For example, on a Sun system running Solaris 8, the directory
2021&_build-SunOS5-5.8-sparc_& is created.
2022.cindex "symbolic link" "to source files"
2023Symbolic links to relevant source files are installed in the build directory.
2024
2025If this is the first time &'make'& has been run, it calls a script that builds
2026a make file inside the build directory, using the configuration files from the
2027&_Local_& directory. The new make file is then passed to another instance of
2028&'make'&. This does the real work, building a number of utility scripts, and
2029then compiling and linking the binaries for the Exim monitor (if configured), a
2030number of utility programs, and finally Exim itself. The command &`make
2031makefile`& can be used to force a rebuild of the make file in the build
2032directory, should this ever be necessary.
2033
2034If you have problems building Exim, check for any comments there may be in the
2035&_README_& file concerning your operating system, and also take a look at the
2036FAQ, where some common problems are covered.
2037
2038
2039
2040.section 'Output from &"make"&' "SECID283"
2041The output produced by the &'make'& process for compile lines is often very
2042unreadable, because these lines can be very long. For this reason, the normal
2043output is suppressed by default, and instead output similar to that which
2044appears when compiling the 2.6 Linux kernel is generated: just a short line for
2045each module that is being compiled or linked. However, it is still possible to
2046get the full output, by calling &'make'& like this:
2047.code
2048FULLECHO='' make -e
2049.endd
2050The value of FULLECHO defaults to &"@"&, the flag character that suppresses
2051command reflection in &'make'&. When you ask for the full output, it is
2052given in addition to the short output.
2053
2054
2055
2056.section "Overriding build-time options for Exim" "SECToverride"
2057.cindex "build-time options, overriding"
2058The main make file that is created at the beginning of the building process
2059consists of the concatenation of a number of files which set configuration
2060values, followed by a fixed set of &'make'& instructions. If a value is set
2061more than once, the last setting overrides any previous ones. This provides a
2062convenient way of overriding defaults. The files that are concatenated are, in
2063order:
2064.display
2065&_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2066&_OS/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2067&_Local/Makefile_&
2068&_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2069&_Local/Makefile-_&<&'archtype'&>
2070&_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2071&_OS/Makefile-Base_&
2072.endd
2073.cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
2074.cindex "building Exim" "operating system type"
2075.cindex "building Exim" "architecture type"
2076where <&'ostype'&> is the operating system type and <&'archtype'&> is the
2077architecture type. &_Local/Makefile_& is required to exist, and the building
2078process fails if it is absent. The other three &_Local_& files are optional,
2079and are often not needed.
2080
2081The values used for <&'ostype'&> and <&'archtype'&> are obtained from scripts
2082called &_scripts/os-type_& and &_scripts/arch-type_& respectively. If either of
2083the environment variables EXIM_OSTYPE or EXIM_ARCHTYPE is set, their
2084values are used, thereby providing a means of forcing particular settings.
2085Otherwise, the scripts try to get values from the &%uname%& command. If this
2086fails, the shell variables OSTYPE and ARCHTYPE are inspected. A number
2087of &'ad hoc'& transformations are then applied, to produce the standard names
2088that Exim expects. You can run these scripts directly from the shell in order
2089to find out what values are being used on your system.
2090
2091
2092&_OS/Makefile-Default_& contains comments about the variables that are set
2093therein. Some (but not all) are mentioned below. If there is something that
2094needs changing, review the contents of this file and the contents of the make
2095file for your operating system (&_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&) to see what the
2096default values are.
2097
2098
2099.cindex "building Exim" "overriding default settings"
2100If you need to change any of the values that are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2101or in &_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&, or to add any new definitions, you do not
2102need to change the original files. Instead, you should make the changes by
2103putting the new values in an appropriate &_Local_& file. For example,
2104.cindex "Tru64-Unix build-time settings"
2105when building Exim in many releases of the Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX,
2106formerly DEC-OSF1) operating system, it is necessary to specify that the C
2107compiler is called &'cc'& rather than &'gcc'&. Also, the compiler must be
2108called with the option &%-std1%&, to make it recognize some of the features of
2109Standard C that Exim uses. (Most other compilers recognize Standard C by
2110default.) To do this, you should create a file called &_Local/Makefile-OSF1_&
2111containing the lines
2112.code
2113CC=cc
2114CFLAGS=-std1
2115.endd
2116If you are compiling for just one operating system, it may be easier to put
2117these lines directly into &_Local/Makefile_&.
2118
2119Keeping all your local configuration settings separate from the distributed
2120files makes it easy to transfer them to new versions of Exim simply by copying
2121the contents of the &_Local_& directory.
2122
2123
2124.cindex "NIS lookup type" "including support for"
2125.cindex "NIS+ lookup type" "including support for"
2126.cindex "LDAP" "including support for"
2127.cindex "lookup" "inclusion in binary"
2128Exim contains support for doing LDAP, NIS, NIS+, and other kinds of file
2129lookup, but not all systems have these components installed, so the default is
2130not to include the relevant code in the binary. All the different kinds of file
2131and database lookup that Exim supports are implemented as separate code modules
2132which are included only if the relevant compile-time options are set. In the
2133case of LDAP, NIS, and NIS+, the settings for &_Local/Makefile_& are:
2134.code
2135LOOKUP_LDAP=yes
2136LOOKUP_NIS=yes
2137LOOKUP_NISPLUS=yes
2138.endd
2139and similar settings apply to the other lookup types. They are all listed in
2140&_src/EDITME_&. In many cases the relevant include files and interface
2141libraries need to be installed before compiling Exim.
2142.cindex "cdb" "including support for"
2143However, there are some optional lookup types (such as cdb) for which
2144the code is entirely contained within Exim, and no external include
2145files or libraries are required. When a lookup type is not included in the
2146binary, attempts to configure Exim to use it cause run time configuration
2147errors.
2148
2149.cindex "pkg-config" "lookups"
2150.cindex "pkg-config" "authenticators"
2151Many systems now use a tool called &'pkg-config'& to encapsulate information
2152about how to compile against a library; Exim has some initial support for
2153being able to use pkg-config for lookups and authenticators. For any given
2154makefile variable which starts &`LOOKUP_`& or &`AUTH_`&, you can add a new
2155variable with the &`_PC`& suffix in the name and assign as the value the
2156name of the package to be queried. The results of querying via the
2157&'pkg-config'& command will be added to the appropriate Makefile variables
2158with &`+=`& directives, so your version of &'make'& will need to support that
2159syntax. For instance:
2160.code
2161LOOKUP_SQLITE=yes
2162LOOKUP_SQLITE_PC=sqlite3
2163AUTH_GSASL=yes
2164AUTH_GSASL_PC=libgsasl
2165AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
2166AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI_PC=heimdal-gssapi
2167.endd
2168
2169.cindex "Perl" "including support for"
2170Exim can be linked with an embedded Perl interpreter, allowing Perl
2171subroutines to be called during string expansion. To enable this facility,
2172.code
2173EXIM_PERL=perl.o
2174.endd
2175must be defined in &_Local/Makefile_&. Details of this facility are given in
2176chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
2177
2178.cindex "X11 libraries, location of"
2179The location of the X11 libraries is something that varies a lot between
2180operating systems, and there may be different versions of X11 to cope
2181with. Exim itself makes no use of X11, but if you are compiling the Exim
2182monitor, the X11 libraries must be available.
2183The following three variables are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&:
2184.code
2185X11=/usr/X11R6
2186XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2187XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib
2188.endd
2189These are overridden in some of the operating-system configuration files. For
2190example, in &_OS/Makefile-SunOS5_& there is
2191.code
2192X11=/usr/openwin
2193XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2194XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib -R$(X11)/lib
2195.endd
2196If you need to override the default setting for your operating system, place a
2197definition of all three of these variables into your
2198&_Local/Makefile-<ostype>_& file.
2199
2200.cindex "EXTRALIBS"
2201If you need to add any extra libraries to the link steps, these can be put in a
2202variable called EXTRALIBS, which appears in all the link commands, but by
2203default is not defined. In contrast, EXTRALIBS_EXIM is used only on the
2204command for linking the main Exim binary, and not for any associated utilities.
2205
2206.cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
2207There is also DBMLIB, which appears in the link commands for binaries that
2208use DBM functions (see also section &<<SECTdb>>&). Finally, there is
2209EXTRALIBS_EXIMON, which appears only in the link step for the Exim monitor
2210binary, and which can be used, for example, to include additional X11
2211libraries.
2212
2213.cindex "configuration file" "editing"
2214The make file copes with rebuilding Exim correctly if any of the configuration
2215files are edited. However, if an optional configuration file is deleted, it is
2216necessary to touch the associated non-optional file (that is,
2217&_Local/Makefile_& or &_Local/eximon.conf_&) before rebuilding.
2218
2219
2220.section "OS-specific header files" "SECID30"
2221.cindex "&_os.h_&"
2222.cindex "building Exim" "OS-specific C header files"
2223The &_OS_& directory contains a number of files with names of the form
2224&_os.h-<ostype>_&. These are system-specific C header files that should not
2225normally need to be changed. There is a list of macro settings that are
2226recognized in the file &_OS/os.configuring_&, which should be consulted if you
2227are porting Exim to a new operating system.
2228
2229
2230
2231.section "Overriding build-time options for the monitor" "SECID31"
2232.cindex "building Eximon"
2233A similar process is used for overriding things when building the Exim monitor,
2234where the files that are involved are
2235.display
2236&_OS/eximon.conf-Default_&
2237&_OS/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2238&_Local/eximon.conf_&
2239&_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2240&_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'archtype'&>
2241&_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2242.endd
2243.cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
2244As with Exim itself, the final three files need not exist, and in this case the
2245&_OS/eximon.conf-<ostype>_& file is also optional. The default values in
2246&_OS/eximon.conf-Default_& can be overridden dynamically by setting environment
2247variables of the same name, preceded by EXIMON_. For example, setting
2248EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH in the environment overrides the value of
2249LOG_DEPTH at run time.
2250.ecindex IIDbuex
2251
2252
2253.section "Installing Exim binaries and scripts" "SECID32"
2254.cindex "installing Exim"
2255.cindex "BIN_DIRECTORY"
2256The command &`make install`& runs the &(exim_install)& script with no
2257arguments. The script copies binaries and utility scripts into the directory
2258whose name is specified by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting in &_Local/Makefile_&.
2259.cindex "setuid" "installing Exim with"
2260The install script copies files only if they are newer than the files they are
2261going to replace. The Exim binary is required to be owned by root and have the
2262&'setuid'& bit set, for normal configurations. Therefore, you must run &`make
2263install`& as root so that it can set up the Exim binary in this way. However, in
2264some special situations (for example, if a host is doing no local deliveries)
2265it may be possible to run Exim without making the binary setuid root (see
2266chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for details).
2267
2268.cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
2269Exim's run time configuration file is named by the CONFIGURE_FILE setting
2270in &_Local/Makefile_&. If this names a single file, and the file does not
2271exist, the default configuration file &_src/configure.default_& is copied there
2272by the installation script. If a run time configuration file already exists, it
2273is left alone. If CONFIGURE_FILE is a colon-separated list, naming several
2274alternative files, no default is installed.
2275
2276.cindex "system aliases file"
2277.cindex "&_/etc/aliases_&"
2278One change is made to the default configuration file when it is installed: the
2279default configuration contains a router that references a system aliases file.
2280The path to this file is set to the value specified by
2281SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& (&_/etc/aliases_& by default).
2282If the system aliases file does not exist, the installation script creates it,
2283and outputs a comment to the user.
2284
2285The created file contains no aliases, but it does contain comments about the
2286aliases a site should normally have. Mail aliases have traditionally been
2287kept in &_/etc/aliases_&. However, some operating systems are now using
2288&_/etc/mail/aliases_&. You should check if yours is one of these, and change
2289Exim's configuration if necessary.
2290
2291The default configuration uses the local host's name as the only local domain,
2292and is set up to do local deliveries into the shared directory &_/var/mail_&,
2293running as the local user. System aliases and &_.forward_& files in users' home
2294directories are supported, but no NIS or NIS+ support is configured. Domains
2295other than the name of the local host are routed using the DNS, with delivery
2296over SMTP.
2297
2298It is possible to install Exim for special purposes (such as building a binary
2299distribution) in a private part of the file system. You can do this by a
2300command such as
2301.code
2302make DESTDIR=/some/directory/ install
2303.endd
2304This has the effect of pre-pending the specified directory to all the file
2305paths, except the name of the system aliases file that appears in the default
2306configuration. (If a default alias file is created, its name &'is'& modified.)
2307For backwards compatibility, ROOT is used if DESTDIR is not set,
2308but this usage is deprecated.
2309
2310.cindex "installing Exim" "what is not installed"
2311Running &'make install'& does not copy the Exim 4 conversion script
2312&'convert4r4'&. You will probably run this only once if you are
2313upgrading from Exim 3. None of the documentation files in the &_doc_&
2314directory are copied, except for the info files when you have set
2315INFO_DIRECTORY, as described in section &<<SECTinsinfdoc>>& below.
2316
2317For the utility programs, old versions are renamed by adding the suffix &_.O_&
2318to their names. The Exim binary itself, however, is handled differently. It is
2319installed under a name that includes the version number and the compile number,
2320for example &_exim-&version()-1_&. The script then arranges for a symbolic link
2321called &_exim_& to point to the binary. If you are updating a previous version
2322of Exim, the script takes care to ensure that the name &_exim_& is never absent
2323from the directory (as seen by other processes).
2324
2325.cindex "installing Exim" "testing the script"
2326If you want to see what the &'make install'& will do before running it for
2327real, you can pass the &%-n%& option to the installation script by this
2328command:
2329.code
2330make INSTALL_ARG=-n install
2331.endd
2332The contents of the variable INSTALL_ARG are passed to the installation
2333script. You do not need to be root to run this test. Alternatively, you can run
2334the installation script directly, but this must be from within the build
2335directory. For example, from the top-level Exim directory you could use this
2336command:
2337.code
2338(cd build-SunOS5-5.5.1-sparc; ../scripts/exim_install -n)
2339.endd
2340.cindex "installing Exim" "install script options"
2341There are two other options that can be supplied to the installation script.
2342
2343.ilist
2344&%-no_chown%& bypasses the call to change the owner of the installed binary
2345to root, and the call to make it a setuid binary.
2346.next
2347&%-no_symlink%& bypasses the setting up of the symbolic link &_exim_& to the
2348installed binary.
2349.endlist
2350
2351INSTALL_ARG can be used to pass these options to the script. For example:
2352.code
2353make INSTALL_ARG=-no_symlink install
2354.endd
2355The installation script can also be given arguments specifying which files are
2356to be copied. For example, to install just the Exim binary, and nothing else,
2357without creating the symbolic link, you could use:
2358.code
2359make INSTALL_ARG='-no_symlink exim' install
2360.endd
2361
2362
2363
2364.section "Installing info documentation" "SECTinsinfdoc"
2365.cindex "installing Exim" "&'info'& documentation"
2366Not all systems use the GNU &'info'& system for documentation, and for this
2367reason, the Texinfo source of Exim's documentation is not included in the main
2368distribution. Instead it is available separately from the ftp site (see section
2369&<<SECTavail>>&).
2370
2371If you have defined INFO_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_& and the Texinfo
2372source of the documentation is found in the source tree, running &`make
2373install`& automatically builds the info files and installs them.
2374
2375
2376
2377.section "Setting up the spool directory" "SECID33"
2378.cindex "spool directory" "creating"
2379When it starts up, Exim tries to create its spool directory if it does not
2380exist. The Exim uid and gid are used for the owner and group of the spool
2381directory. Sub-directories are automatically created in the spool directory as
2382necessary.
2383
2384
2385
2386
2387.section "Testing" "SECID34"
2388.cindex "testing" "installation"
2389Having installed Exim, you can check that the run time configuration file is
2390syntactically valid by running the following command, which assumes that the
2391Exim binary directory is within your PATH environment variable:
2392.code
2393exim -bV
2394.endd
2395If there are any errors in the configuration file, Exim outputs error messages.
2396Otherwise it outputs the version number and build date,
2397the DBM library that is being used, and information about which drivers and
2398other optional code modules are included in the binary.
2399Some simple routing tests can be done by using the address testing option. For
2400example,
2401.display
2402&`exim -bt`& <&'local username'&>
2403.endd
2404should verify that it recognizes a local mailbox, and
2405.display
2406&`exim -bt`& <&'remote address'&>
2407.endd
2408a remote one. Then try getting it to deliver mail, both locally and remotely.
2409This can be done by passing messages directly to Exim, without going through a
2410user agent. For example:
2411.code
2412exim -v postmaster@your.domain.example
2413From: user@your.domain.example
2414To: postmaster@your.domain.example
2415Subject: Testing Exim
2416
2417This is a test message.
2418^D
2419.endd
2420The &%-v%& option causes Exim to output some verification of what it is doing.
2421In this case you should see copies of three log lines, one for the message's
2422arrival, one for its delivery, and one containing &"Completed"&.
2423
2424.cindex "delivery" "problems with"
2425If you encounter problems, look at Exim's log files (&'mainlog'& and
2426&'paniclog'&) to see if there is any relevant information there. Another source
2427of information is running Exim with debugging turned on, by specifying the
2428&%-d%& option. If a message is stuck on Exim's spool, you can force a delivery
2429with debugging turned on by a command of the form
2430.display
2431&`exim -d -M`& <&'exim-message-id'&>
2432.endd
2433You must be root or an &"admin user"& in order to do this. The &%-d%& option
2434produces rather a lot of output, but you can cut this down to specific areas.
2435For example, if you use &%-d-all+route%& only the debugging information
2436relevant to routing is included. (See the &%-d%& option in chapter
2437&<<CHAPcommandline>>& for more details.)
2438
2439.cindex '&"sticky"& bit'
2440.cindex "lock files"
2441One specific problem that has shown up on some sites is the inability to do
2442local deliveries into a shared mailbox directory, because it does not have the
2443&"sticky bit"& set on it. By default, Exim tries to create a lock file before
2444writing to a mailbox file, and if it cannot create the lock file, the delivery
2445is deferred. You can get round this either by setting the &"sticky bit"& on the
2446directory, or by setting a specific group for local deliveries and allowing
2447that group to create files in the directory (see the comments above the
2448&(local_delivery)& transport in the default configuration file). Another
2449approach is to configure Exim not to use lock files, but just to rely on
2450&[fcntl()]& locking instead. However, you should do this only if all user
2451agents also use &[fcntl()]& locking. For further discussion of locking issues,
2452see chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
2453
2454One thing that cannot be tested on a system that is already running an MTA is
2455the receipt of incoming SMTP mail on the standard SMTP port. However, the
2456&%-oX%& option can be used to run an Exim daemon that listens on some other
2457port, or &'inetd'& can be used to do this. The &%-bh%& option and the
2458&'exim_checkaccess'& utility can be used to check out policy controls on
2459incoming SMTP mail.
2460
2461Testing a new version on a system that is already running Exim can most easily
2462be done by building a binary with a different CONFIGURE_FILE setting. From
2463within the run time configuration, all other file and directory names
2464that Exim uses can be altered, in order to keep it entirely clear of the
2465production version.
2466
2467
2468.section "Replacing another MTA with Exim" "SECID35"
2469.cindex "replacing another MTA"
2470Building and installing Exim for the first time does not of itself put it in
2471general use. The name by which the system's MTA is called by mail user agents
2472is either &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&, or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& (depending on the
2473operating system), and it is necessary to make this name point to the &'exim'&
2474binary in order to get the user agents to pass messages to Exim. This is
2475normally done by renaming any existing file and making &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&
2476or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&
2477.cindex "symbolic link" "to &'exim'& binary"
2478a symbolic link to the &'exim'& binary. It is a good idea to remove any setuid
2479privilege and executable status from the old MTA. It is then necessary to stop
2480and restart the mailer daemon, if one is running.
2481
2482.cindex "FreeBSD, MTA indirection"
2483.cindex "&_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&"
2484Some operating systems have introduced alternative ways of switching MTAs. For
2485example, if you are running FreeBSD, you need to edit the file
2486&_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_& instead of setting up a symbolic link as just
2487described. A typical example of the contents of this file for running Exim is
2488as follows:
2489.code
2490sendmail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2491send-mail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2492mailq /usr/exim/bin/exim -bp
2493newaliases /usr/bin/true
2494.endd
2495Once you have set up the symbolic link, or edited &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&,
2496your Exim installation is &"live"&. Check it by sending a message from your
2497favourite user agent.
2498
2499You should consider what to tell your users about the change of MTA. Exim may
2500have different capabilities to what was previously running, and there are
2501various operational differences such as the text of messages produced by
2502command line options and in bounce messages. If you allow your users to make
2503use of Exim's filtering capabilities, you should make the document entitled
2504&'Exim's interface to mail filtering'& available to them.
2505
2506
2507
2508.section "Upgrading Exim" "SECID36"
2509.cindex "upgrading Exim"
2510If you are already running Exim on your host, building and installing a new
2511version automatically makes it available to MUAs, or any other programs that
2512call the MTA directly. However, if you are running an Exim daemon, you do need
2513to send it a HUP signal, to make it re-execute itself, and thereby pick up the
2514new binary. You do not need to stop processing mail in order to install a new
2515version of Exim. The install script does not modify an existing runtime
2516configuration file.
2517
2518
2519
2520
2521.section "Stopping the Exim daemon on Solaris" "SECID37"
2522.cindex "Solaris" "stopping Exim on"
2523The standard command for stopping the mailer daemon on Solaris is
2524.code
2525/etc/init.d/sendmail stop
2526.endd
2527If &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& has been turned into a symbolic link, this script
2528fails to stop Exim because it uses the command &'ps -e'& and greps the output
2529for the text &"sendmail"&; this is not present because the actual program name
2530(that is, &"exim"&) is given by the &'ps'& command with these options. A
2531solution is to replace the line that finds the process id with something like
2532.code
2533pid=`cat /var/spool/exim/exim-daemon.pid`
2534.endd
2535to obtain the daemon's pid directly from the file that Exim saves it in.
2536
2537Note, however, that stopping the daemon does not &"stop Exim"&. Messages can
2538still be received from local processes, and if automatic delivery is configured
2539(the normal case), deliveries will still occur.
2540
2541
2542
2543
2544. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2545. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2546
2547.chapter "The Exim command line" "CHAPcommandline"
2548.scindex IIDclo1 "command line" "options"
2549.scindex IIDclo2 "options" "command line"
2550Exim's command line takes the standard Unix form of a sequence of options,
2551each starting with a hyphen character, followed by a number of arguments. The
2552options are compatible with the main options of Sendmail, and there are also
2553some additional options, some of which are compatible with Smail 3. Certain
2554combinations of options do not make sense, and provoke an error if used.
2555The form of the arguments depends on which options are set.
2556
2557
2558.section "Setting options by program name" "SECID38"
2559.cindex "&'mailq'&"
2560If Exim is called under the name &'mailq'&, it behaves as if the option &%-bp%&
2561were present before any other options.
2562The &%-bp%& option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
2563standard output.
2564This feature is for compatibility with some systems that contain a command of
2565that name in one of the standard libraries, symbolically linked to
2566&_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&.
2567
2568.cindex "&'rsmtp'&"
2569If Exim is called under the name &'rsmtp'& it behaves as if the option &%-bS%&
2570were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The
2571&%-bS%& option is used for reading in a number of messages in batched SMTP
2572format.
2573
2574.cindex "&'rmail'&"
2575If Exim is called under the name &'rmail'& it behaves as if the &%-i%& and
2576&%-oee%& options were present before any other options, for compatibility with
2577Smail. The name &'rmail'& is used as an interface by some UUCP systems.
2578
2579.cindex "&'runq'&"
2580.cindex "queue runner"
2581If Exim is called under the name &'runq'& it behaves as if the option &%-q%&
2582were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The &%-q%&
2583option causes a single queue runner process to be started.
2584
2585.cindex "&'newaliases'&"
2586.cindex "alias file" "building"
2587.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "calling Exim as &'newaliases'&"
2588If Exim is called under the name &'newaliases'& it behaves as if the option
2589&%-bi%& were present before any other options, for compatibility with Sendmail.
2590This option is used for rebuilding Sendmail's alias file. Exim does not have
2591the concept of a single alias file, but can be configured to run a given
2592command if called with the &%-bi%& option.
2593
2594
2595.section "Trusted and admin users" "SECTtrustedadmin"
2596Some Exim options are available only to &'trusted users'& and others are
2597available only to &'admin users'&. In the description below, the phrases &"Exim
2598user"& and &"Exim group"& mean the user and group defined by EXIM_USER and
2599EXIM_GROUP in &_Local/Makefile_& or set by the &%exim_user%& and
2600&%exim_group%& options. These do not necessarily have to use the name &"exim"&.
2601
2602.ilist
2603.cindex "trusted users" "definition of"
2604.cindex "user" "trusted definition of"
2605The trusted users are root, the Exim user, any user listed in the
2606&%trusted_users%& configuration option, and any user whose current group or any
2607supplementary group is one of those listed in the &%trusted_groups%&
2608configuration option. Note that the Exim group is not automatically trusted.
2609
2610.cindex '&"From"& line'
2611.cindex "envelope sender"
2612Trusted users are always permitted to use the &%-f%& option or a leading
2613&"From&~"& line to specify the envelope sender of a message that is passed to
2614Exim through the local interface (see the &%-bm%& and &%-f%& options below).
2615See the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of permitting non-trusted
2616users to set envelope senders.
2617
2618.cindex "&'From:'& header line"
2619.cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
2620.cindex "header lines" "From:"
2621.cindex "header lines" "Sender:"
2622For a trusted user, there is never any check on the contents of the &'From:'&
2623header line, and a &'Sender:'& line is never added. Furthermore, any existing
2624&'Sender:'& line in incoming local (non-TCP/IP) messages is not removed.
2625
2626Trusted users may also specify a host name, host address, interface address,
2627protocol name, ident value, and authentication data when submitting a message
2628locally. Thus, they are able to insert messages into Exim's queue locally that
2629have the characteristics of messages received from a remote host. Untrusted
2630users may in some circumstances use &%-f%&, but can never set the other values
2631that are available to trusted users.
2632.next
2633.cindex "user" "admin definition of"
2634.cindex "admin user" "definition of"
2635The admin users are root, the Exim user, and any user that is a member of the
2636Exim group or of any group listed in the &%admin_groups%& configuration option.
2637The current group does not have to be one of these groups.
2638
2639Admin users are permitted to list the queue, and to carry out certain
2640operations on messages, for example, to force delivery failures. It is also
2641necessary to be an admin user in order to see the full information provided by
2642the Exim monitor, and full debugging output.
2643
2644By default, the use of the &%-M%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options to cause
2645Exim to attempt delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users.
2646However, this restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%prod_requires_admin%&
2647option false (that is, specifying &%no_prod_requires_admin%&).
2648
2649Similarly, the use of the &%-bp%& option to list all the messages in the queue
2650is restricted to admin users unless &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set
2651false.
2652.endlist
2653
2654
2655&*Warning*&: If you configure your system so that admin users are able to
2656edit Exim's configuration file, you are giving those users an easy way of
2657getting root. There is further discussion of this issue at the start of chapter
2658&<<CHAPconf>>&.
2659
2660
2661
2662
2663.section "Command line options" "SECID39"
2664Exim's command line options are described in alphabetical order below. If none
2665of the options that specifies a specific action (such as starting the daemon or
2666a queue runner, or testing an address, or receiving a message in a specific
2667format, or listing the queue) are present, and there is at least one argument
2668on the command line, &%-bm%& (accept a local message on the standard input,
2669with the arguments specifying the recipients) is assumed. Otherwise, Exim
2670outputs a brief message about itself and exits.
2671
2672. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2673. Insert a stylized XML comment here, to identify the start of the command line
2674. options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
2675. creates a man page for the options.
2676. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2677
2678.literal xml
2679<!-- === Start of command line options === -->
2680.literal off
2681
2682
2683.vlist
2684.vitem &%--%&
2685.oindex "--"
2686.cindex "options" "command line; terminating"
2687This is a pseudo-option whose only purpose is to terminate the options and
2688therefore to cause subsequent command line items to be treated as arguments
2689rather than options, even if they begin with hyphens.
2690
2691.vitem &%--help%&
2692.oindex "&%--help%&"
2693This option causes Exim to output a few sentences stating what it is.
2694The same output is generated if the Exim binary is called with no options and
2695no arguments.
2696
2697.vitem &%--version%&
2698.oindex "&%--version%&"
2699This option is an alias for &%-bV%& and causes version information to be
2700displayed.
2701
2702.vitem &%-Ac%& &&&
2703 &%-Am%&
2704.oindex "&%-Ac%&"
2705.oindex "&%-Am%&"
2706These options are used by Sendmail for selecting configuration files and are
2707ignored by Exim.
2708
2709.vitem &%-B%&<&'type'&>
2710.oindex "&%-B%&"
2711.cindex "8-bit characters"
2712.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "8-bit characters"
2713This is a Sendmail option for selecting 7 or 8 bit processing. Exim is 8-bit
2714clean; it ignores this option.
2715
2716.vitem &%-bd%&
2717.oindex "&%-bd%&"
2718.cindex "daemon"
2719.cindex "SMTP" "listener"
2720.cindex "queue runner"
2721This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections. Usually
2722the &%-bd%& option is combined with the &%-q%&<&'time'&> option, to specify
2723that the daemon should also initiate periodic queue runs.
2724
2725The &%-bd%& option can be used only by an admin user. If either of the &%-d%&
2726(debugging) or &%-v%& (verifying) options are set, the daemon does not
2727disconnect from the controlling terminal. When running this way, it can be
2728stopped by pressing ctrl-C.
2729
2730By default, Exim listens for incoming connections to the standard SMTP port on
2731all the host's running interfaces. However, it is possible to listen on other
2732ports, on multiple ports, and only on specific interfaces. Chapter
2733&<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a description of the options that control this.
2734
2735When a listening daemon
2736.cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
2737.cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
2738is started without the use of &%-oX%& (that is, without overriding the normal
2739configuration), it writes its process id to a file called &_exim-daemon.pid_&
2740in Exim's spool directory. This location can be overridden by setting
2741PID_FILE_PATH in &_Local/Makefile_&. The file is written while Exim is still
2742running as root.
2743
2744When &%-oX%& is used on the command line to start a listening daemon, the
2745process id is not written to the normal pid file path. However, &%-oP%& can be
2746used to specify a path on the command line if a pid file is required.
2747
2748The SIGHUP signal
2749.cindex "SIGHUP"
2750.cindex "daemon" "restarting"
2751can be used to cause the daemon to re-execute itself. This should be done
2752whenever Exim's configuration file, or any file that is incorporated into it by
2753means of the &%.include%& facility, is changed, and also whenever a new version
2754of Exim is installed. It is not necessary to do this when other files that are
2755referenced from the configuration (for example, alias files) are changed,
2756because these are reread each time they are used.
2757
2758.vitem &%-bdf%&
2759.oindex "&%-bdf%&"
2760This option has the same effect as &%-bd%& except that it never disconnects
2761from the controlling terminal, even when no debugging is specified.
2762
2763.vitem &%-be%&
2764.oindex "&%-be%&"
2765.cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2766.cindex "expansion" "testing"
2767Run Exim in expansion testing mode. Exim discards its root privilege, to
2768prevent ordinary users from using this mode to read otherwise inaccessible
2769files. If no arguments are given, Exim runs interactively, prompting for lines
2770of data. Otherwise, it processes each argument in turn.
2771
2772If Exim was built with USE_READLINE=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&, it tries
2773to load the &%libreadline%& library dynamically whenever the &%-be%& option is
2774used without command line arguments. If successful, it uses the &[readline()]&
2775function, which provides extensive line-editing facilities, for reading the
2776test data. A line history is supported.
2777
2778Long expansion expressions can be split over several lines by using backslash
2779continuations. As in Exim's run time configuration, white space at the start of
2780continuation lines is ignored. Each argument or data line is passed through the
2781string expansion mechanism, and the result is output. Variable values from the
2782configuration file (for example, &$qualify_domain$&) are available, but no
2783message-specific values (such as &$message_exim_id$&) are set, because no message
2784is being processed (but see &%-bem%& and &%-Mset%&).
2785
2786&*Note*&: If you use this mechanism to test lookups, and you change the data
2787files or databases you are using, you must exit and restart Exim before trying
2788the same lookup again. Otherwise, because each Exim process caches the results
2789of lookups, you will just get the same result as before.
2790
2791.vitem &%-bem%&&~<&'filename'&>
2792.oindex "&%-bem%&"
2793.cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2794.cindex "expansion" "testing"
2795This option operates like &%-be%& except that it must be followed by the name
2796of a file. For example:
2797.code
2798exim -bem /tmp/testmessage
2799.endd
2800The file is read as a message (as if receiving a locally-submitted non-SMTP
2801message) before any of the test expansions are done. Thus, message-specific
2802variables such as &$message_size$& and &$header_from:$& are available. However,
2803no &'Received:'& header is added to the message. If the &%-t%& option is set,
2804recipients are read from the headers in the normal way, and are shown in the
2805&$recipients$& variable. Note that recipients cannot be given on the command
2806line, because further arguments are taken as strings to expand (just like
2807&%-be%&).
2808
2809.vitem &%-bF%&&~<&'filename'&>
2810.oindex "&%-bF%&"
2811.cindex "system filter" "testing"
2812.cindex "testing" "system filter"
2813This option is the same as &%-bf%& except that it assumes that the filter being
2814tested is a system filter. The additional commands that are available only in
2815system filters are recognized.
2816
2817.vitem &%-bf%&&~<&'filename'&>
2818.oindex "&%-bf%&"
2819.cindex "filter" "testing"
2820.cindex "testing" "filter file"
2821.cindex "forward file" "testing"
2822.cindex "testing" "forward file"
2823.cindex "Sieve filter" "testing"
2824This option runs Exim in user filter testing mode; the file is the filter file
2825to be tested, and a test message must be supplied on the standard input. If
2826there are no message-dependent tests in the filter, an empty file can be
2827supplied.
2828
2829If you want to test a system filter file, use &%-bF%& instead of &%-bf%&. You
2830can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command, in order to test a system
2831filter and a user filter in the same run. For example:
2832.code
2833exim -bF /system/filter -bf /user/filter </test/message
2834.endd
2835This is helpful when the system filter adds header lines or sets filter
2836variables that are used by the user filter.
2837
2838If the test filter file does not begin with one of the special lines
2839.code
2840# Exim filter
2841# Sieve filter
2842.endd
2843it is taken to be a normal &_.forward_& file, and is tested for validity under
2844that interpretation. See sections &<<SECTitenonfilred>>& to
2845&<<SECTspecitredli>>& for a description of the possible contents of non-filter
2846redirection lists.
2847
2848The result of an Exim command that uses &%-bf%&, provided no errors are
2849detected, is a list of the actions that Exim would try to take if presented
2850with the message for real. More details of filter testing are given in the
2851separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
2852
2853When testing a filter file,
2854.cindex "&""From""& line"
2855.cindex "envelope sender"
2856.oindex "&%-f%&" "for filter testing"
2857the envelope sender can be set by the &%-f%& option,
2858or by a &"From&~"& line at the start of the test message. Various parameters
2859that would normally be taken from the envelope recipient address of the message
2860can be set by means of additional command line options (see the next four
2861options).
2862
2863.vitem &%-bfd%&&~<&'domain'&>
2864.oindex "&%-bfd%&"
2865.vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
2866This sets the domain of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2867tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the value of
2868&$qualify_domain$&.
2869
2870.vitem &%-bfl%&&~<&'local&~part'&>
2871.oindex "&%-bfl%&"
2872This sets the local part of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2873tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the username of the
2874process that calls Exim. A local part should be specified with any prefix or
2875suffix stripped, because that is how it appears to the filter when a message is
2876actually being delivered.
2877
2878.vitem &%-bfp%&&~<&'prefix'&>
2879.oindex "&%-bfp%&"
2880This sets the prefix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2881file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2882prefix.
2883
2884.vitem &%-bfs%&&~<&'suffix'&>
2885.oindex "&%-bfs%&"
2886This sets the suffix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2887file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2888suffix.
2889
2890.vitem &%-bh%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2891.oindex "&%-bh%&"
2892.cindex "testing" "incoming SMTP"
2893.cindex "SMTP" "testing incoming"
2894.cindex "testing" "relay control"
2895.cindex "relaying" "testing configuration"
2896.cindex "policy control" "testing"
2897.cindex "debugging" "&%-bh%& option"
2898This option runs a fake SMTP session as if from the given IP address, using the
2899standard input and output. The IP address may include a port number at the end,
2900after a full stop. For example:
2901.code
2902exim -bh 10.9.8.7.1234
2903exim -bh fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678
2904.endd
2905When an IPv6 address is given, it is converted into canonical form. In the case
2906of the second example above, the value of &$sender_host_address$& after
2907conversion to the canonical form is
2908&`fe80:0000:0000:0a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678`&.
2909
2910Comments as to what is going on are written to the standard error file. These
2911include lines beginning with &"LOG"& for anything that would have been logged.
2912This facility is provided for testing configuration options for incoming
2913messages, to make sure they implement the required policy. For example, you can
2914test your relay controls using &%-bh%&.
2915
2916&*Warning 1*&:
2917.cindex "RFC 1413"
2918You can test features of the configuration that rely on ident (RFC 1413)
2919information by using the &%-oMt%& option. However, Exim cannot actually perform
2920an ident callout when testing using &%-bh%& because there is no incoming SMTP
2921connection.
2922
2923&*Warning 2*&: Address verification callouts (see section &<<SECTcallver>>&)
2924are also skipped when testing using &%-bh%&. If you want these callouts to
2925occur, use &%-bhc%& instead.
2926
2927Messages supplied during the testing session are discarded, and nothing is
2928written to any of the real log files. There may be pauses when DNS (and other)
2929lookups are taking place, and of course these may time out. The &%-oMi%& option
2930can be used to specify a specific IP interface and port if this is important,
2931and &%-oMaa%& and &%-oMai%& can be used to set parameters as if the SMTP
2932session were authenticated.
2933
2934The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%& whose
2935output just states whether a given recipient address from a given host is
2936acceptable or not. See section &<<SECTcheckaccess>>&.
2937
2938Features such as authentication and encryption, where the client input is not
2939plain text, cannot easily be tested with &%-bh%&. Instead, you should use a
2940specialized SMTP test program such as
2941&url(http://jetmore.org/john/code/#swaks,swaks).
2942
2943.vitem &%-bhc%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2944.oindex "&%-bhc%&"
2945This option operates in the same way as &%-bh%&, except that address
2946verification callouts are performed if required. This includes consulting and
2947updating the callout cache database.
2948
2949.vitem &%-bi%&
2950.oindex "&%-bi%&"
2951.cindex "alias file" "building"
2952.cindex "building alias file"
2953.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-bi%& option"
2954Sendmail interprets the &%-bi%& option as a request to rebuild its alias file.
2955Exim does not have the concept of a single alias file, and so it cannot mimic
2956this behaviour. However, calls to &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& with the &%-bi%& option
2957tend to appear in various scripts such as NIS make files, so the option must be
2958recognized.
2959
2960If &%-bi%& is encountered, the command specified by the &%bi_command%&
2961configuration option is run, under the uid and gid of the caller of Exim. If
2962the &%-oA%& option is used, its value is passed to the command as an argument.
2963The command set by &%bi_command%& may not contain arguments. The command can
2964use the &'exim_dbmbuild'& utility, or some other means, to rebuild alias files
2965if this is required. If the &%bi_command%& option is not set, calling Exim with
2966&%-bi%& is a no-op.
2967
2968. // Keep :help first, then the rest in alphabetical order
2969.vitem &%-bI:help%&
2970.oindex "&%-bI:help%&"
2971.cindex "querying exim information"
2972We shall provide various options starting &`-bI:`& for querying Exim for
2973information. The output of many of these will be intended for machine
2974consumption. This one is not. The &%-bI:help%& option asks Exim for a
2975synopsis of supported options beginning &`-bI:`&. Use of any of these
2976options shall cause Exim to exit after producing the requested output.
2977
2978.vitem &%-bI:dscp%&
2979.oindex "&%-bI:dscp%&"
2980.cindex "DSCP" "values"
2981This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all
2982recognised DSCP names.
2983
2984.vitem &%-bI:sieve%&
2985.oindex "&%-bI:sieve%&"
2986.cindex "Sieve filter" "capabilities"
2987This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all supported
2988Sieve protocol extensions on stdout, one per line. This is anticipated to be
2989useful for ManageSieve (RFC 5804) implementations, in providing that protocol's
2990&`SIEVE`& capability response line. As the precise list may depend upon
2991compile-time build options, which this option will adapt to, this is the only
2992way to guarantee a correct response.
2993
2994.vitem &%-bm%&
2995.oindex "&%-bm%&"
2996.cindex "local message reception"
2997This option runs an Exim receiving process that accepts an incoming,
2998locally-generated message on the standard input. The recipients are given as the
2999command arguments (except when &%-t%& is also present &-- see below). Each
3000argument can be a comma-separated list of RFC 2822 addresses. This is the
3001default option for selecting the overall action of an Exim call; it is assumed
3002if no other conflicting option is present.
3003
3004If any addresses in the message are unqualified (have no domain), they are
3005qualified by the values of the &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&
3006options, as appropriate. The &%-bnq%& option (see below) provides a way of
3007suppressing this for special cases.
3008
3009Policy checks on the contents of local messages can be enforced by means of
3010the non-SMTP ACL. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details.
3011
3012.cindex "return code" "for &%-bm%&"
3013The return code is zero if the message is successfully accepted. Otherwise, the
3014action is controlled by the &%-oe%&&'x'& option setting &-- see below.
3015
3016The format
3017.cindex "message" "format"
3018.cindex "format" "message"
3019.cindex "&""From""& line"
3020.cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
3021.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
3022of the message must be as defined in RFC 2822, except that, for
3023compatibility with Sendmail and Smail, a line in one of the forms
3024.code
3025From sender Fri Jan 5 12:55 GMT 1997
3026From sender Fri, 5 Jan 97 12:55:01
3027.endd
3028(with the weekday optional, and possibly with additional text after the date)
3029is permitted to appear at the start of the message. There appears to be no
3030authoritative specification of the format of this line. Exim recognizes it by
3031matching against the regular expression defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%&
3032option, which can be changed if necessary.
3033
3034.oindex "&%-f%&" "overriding &""From""& line"
3035The specified sender is treated as if it were given as the argument to the
3036&%-f%& option, but if a &%-f%& option is also present, its argument is used in
3037preference to the address taken from the message. The caller of Exim must be a
3038trusted user for the sender of a message to be set in this way.
3039
3040.vitem &%-bmalware%&&~<&'filename'&>
3041.oindex "&%-bmalware%&"
3042.cindex "testing", "malware"
3043.cindex "malware scan test"
3044This debugging option causes Exim to scan the given file or directory
3045(depending on the used scanner interface),
3046using the malware scanning framework. The option of &%av_scanner%& influences
3047this option, so if &%av_scanner%&'s value is dependent upon an expansion then
3048the expansion should have defaults which apply to this invocation. ACLs are
3049not invoked, so if &%av_scanner%& references an ACL variable then that variable
3050will never be populated and &%-bmalware%& will fail.
3051
3052Exim will have changed working directory before resolving the filename, so
3053using fully qualified pathnames is advisable. Exim will be running as the Exim
3054user when it tries to open the file, rather than as the invoking user.
3055This option requires admin privileges.
3056
3057The &%-bmalware%& option will not be extended to be more generally useful,
3058there are better tools for file-scanning. This option exists to help
3059administrators verify their Exim and AV scanner configuration.
3060
3061.vitem &%-bnq%&
3062.oindex "&%-bnq%&"
3063.cindex "address qualification, suppressing"
3064By default, Exim automatically qualifies unqualified addresses (those
3065without domains) that appear in messages that are submitted locally (that
3066is, not over TCP/IP). This qualification applies both to addresses in
3067envelopes, and addresses in header lines. Sender addresses are qualified using
3068&%qualify_domain%&, and recipient addresses using &%qualify_recipient%& (which
3069defaults to the value of &%qualify_domain%&).
3070
3071Sometimes, qualification is not wanted. For example, if &%-bS%& (batch SMTP) is
3072being used to re-submit messages that originally came from remote hosts after
3073content scanning, you probably do not want to qualify unqualified addresses in
3074header lines. (Such lines will be present only if you have not enabled a header
3075syntax check in the appropriate ACL.)
3076
3077The &%-bnq%& option suppresses all qualification of unqualified addresses in
3078messages that originate on the local host. When this is used, unqualified
3079addresses in the envelope provoke errors (causing message rejection) and
3080unqualified addresses in header lines are left alone.
3081
3082
3083.vitem &%-bP%&
3084.oindex "&%-bP%&"
3085.cindex "configuration options" "extracting"
3086.cindex "options" "configuration &-- extracting"
3087If this option is given with no arguments, it causes the values of all Exim's
3088main configuration options to be written to the standard output. The values
3089of one or more specific options can be requested by giving their names as
3090arguments, for example:
3091.code
3092exim -bP qualify_domain hold_domains
3093.endd
3094.cindex "hiding configuration option values"
3095.cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
3096.cindex "options" "hiding value of"
3097However, any option setting that is preceded by the word &"hide"& in the
3098configuration file is not shown in full, except to an admin user. For other
3099users, the output is as in this example:
3100.code
3101mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
3102.endd
3103If &%config%& is given as an argument, the config is
3104output, as it was parsed, any include file resolved, any comment removed.
3105
3106If &%config_file%& is given as an argument, the name of the run time
3107configuration file is output. (&%configure_file%& works too, for
3108backward compatibility.)
3109If a list of configuration files was supplied, the value that is output here
3110is the name of the file that was actually used.
3111
3112.cindex "options" "hiding name of"
3113If the &%-n%& flag is given, then for most modes of &%-bP%& operation the
3114name will not be output.
3115
3116.cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
3117.cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
3118If &%log_file_path%& or &%pid_file_path%& are given, the names of the
3119directories where log files and daemon pid files are written are output,
3120respectively. If these values are unset, log files are written in a
3121sub-directory of the spool directory called &%log%&, and the pid file is
3122written directly into the spool directory.
3123
3124If &%-bP%& is followed by a name preceded by &`+`&, for example,
3125.code
3126exim -bP +local_domains
3127.endd
3128it searches for a matching named list of any type (domain, host, address, or
3129local part) and outputs what it finds.
3130
3131.cindex "options" "router &-- extracting"
3132.cindex "options" "transport &-- extracting"
3133.cindex "options" "authenticator &-- extracting"
3134If one of the words &%router%&, &%transport%&, or &%authenticator%& is given,
3135followed by the name of an appropriate driver instance, the option settings for
3136that driver are output. For example:
3137.code
3138exim -bP transport local_delivery
3139.endd
3140The generic driver options are output first, followed by the driver's private
3141options. A list of the names of drivers of a particular type can be obtained by
3142using one of the words &%router_list%&, &%transport_list%&, or
3143&%authenticator_list%&, and a complete list of all drivers with their option
3144settings can be obtained by using &%routers%&, &%transports%&, or
3145&%authenticators%&.
3146
3147.cindex "environment"
3148If &%environment%& is given as an argument, the set of environment
3149variables is output, line by line. Using the &%-n%& flag suppresses the value of the
3150variables.
3151
3152.cindex "options" "macro &-- extracting"
3153If invoked by an admin user, then &%macro%&, &%macro_list%& and &%macros%&
3154are available, similarly to the drivers. Because macros are sometimes used
3155for storing passwords, this option is restricted.
3156The output format is one item per line.
3157
3158.vitem &%-bp%&
3159.oindex "&%-bp%&"
3160.cindex "queue" "listing messages on"
3161.cindex "listing" "messages on the queue"
3162This option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
3163standard output. If the &%-bp%& option is followed by a list of message ids,
3164just those messages are listed. By default, this option can be used only by an
3165admin user. However, the &%queue_list_requires_admin%& option can be set false
3166to allow any user to see the queue.
3167
3168Each message on the queue is displayed as in the following example:
3169.code
317025m 2.9K 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 <alice@wonderland.fict.example>
3171 red.king@looking-glass.fict.example
3172 <other addresses>
3173.endd
3174.cindex "message" "size in queue listing"
3175.cindex "size" "of message"
3176The first line contains the length of time the message has been on the queue
3177(in this case 25 minutes), the size of the message (2.9K), the unique local
3178identifier for the message, and the message sender, as contained in the
3179envelope. For bounce messages, the sender address is empty, and appears as
3180&"<>"&. If the message was submitted locally by an untrusted user who overrode
3181the default sender address, the user's login name is shown in parentheses
3182before the sender address.
3183
3184.cindex "frozen messages" "in queue listing"
3185If the message is frozen (attempts to deliver it are suspended) then the text
3186&"*** frozen ***"& is displayed at the end of this line.
3187
3188The recipients of the message (taken from the envelope, not the headers) are
3189displayed on subsequent lines. Those addresses to which the message has already
3190been delivered are marked with the letter D. If an original address gets
3191expanded into several addresses via an alias or forward file, the original is
3192displayed with a D only when deliveries for all of its child addresses are
3193complete.
3194
3195
3196.vitem &%-bpa%&
3197.oindex "&%-bpa%&"
3198This option operates like &%-bp%&, but in addition it shows delivered addresses
3199that were generated from the original top level address(es) in each message by
3200alias or forwarding operations. These addresses are flagged with &"+D"& instead
3201of just &"D"&.
3202
3203
3204.vitem &%-bpc%&
3205.oindex "&%-bpc%&"
3206.cindex "queue" "count of messages on"
3207This option counts the number of messages on the queue, and writes the total
3208to the standard output. It is restricted to admin users, unless
3209&%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
3210
3211
3212.vitem &%-bpr%&
3213.oindex "&%-bpr%&"
3214This option operates like &%-bp%&, but the output is not sorted into
3215chronological order of message arrival. This can speed it up when there are
3216lots of messages on the queue, and is particularly useful if the output is
3217going to be post-processed in a way that doesn't need the sorting.
3218
3219.vitem &%-bpra%&
3220.oindex "&%-bpra%&"
3221This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpa%&.
3222
3223.vitem &%-bpru%&
3224.oindex "&%-bpru%&"
3225This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpu%&.
3226
3227
3228.vitem &%-bpu%&
3229.oindex "&%-bpu%&"
3230This option operates like &%-bp%& but shows only undelivered top-level
3231addresses for each message displayed. Addresses generated by aliasing or
3232forwarding are not shown, unless the message was deferred after processing by a
3233router with the &%one_time%& option set.
3234
3235
3236.vitem &%-brt%&
3237.oindex "&%-brt%&"
3238.cindex "testing" "retry configuration"
3239.cindex "retry" "configuration testing"
3240This option is for testing retry rules, and it must be followed by up to three
3241arguments. It causes Exim to look for a retry rule that matches the values
3242and to write it to the standard output. For example:
3243.code
3244exim -brt bach.comp.mus.example
3245Retry rule: *.comp.mus.example F,2h,15m; F,4d,30m;
3246.endd
3247See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for a description of Exim's retry rules. The first
3248argument, which is required, can be a complete address in the form
3249&'local_part@domain'&, or it can be just a domain name. If the second argument
3250contains a dot, it is interpreted as an optional second domain name; if no
3251retry rule is found for the first argument, the second is tried. This ties in
3252with Exim's behaviour when looking for retry rules for remote hosts &-- if no
3253rule is found that matches the host, one that matches the mail domain is
3254sought. Finally, an argument that is the name of a specific delivery error, as
3255used in setting up retry rules, can be given. For example:
3256.code
3257exim -brt haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d
3258Retry rule: *@haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d F,1h,15m
3259.endd
3260
3261.vitem &%-brw%&
3262.oindex "&%-brw%&"
3263.cindex "testing" "rewriting"
3264.cindex "rewriting" "testing"
3265This option is for testing address rewriting rules, and it must be followed by
3266a single argument, consisting of either a local part without a domain, or a
3267complete address with a fully qualified domain. Exim outputs how this address
3268would be rewritten for each possible place it might appear. See chapter
3269&<<CHAPrewrite>>& for further details.
3270
3271.vitem &%-bS%&
3272.oindex "&%-bS%&"
3273.cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
3274.cindex "batched SMTP input"
3275This option is used for batched SMTP input, which is an alternative interface
3276for non-interactive local message submission. A number of messages can be
3277submitted in a single run. However, despite its name, this is not really SMTP
3278input. Exim reads each message's envelope from SMTP commands on the standard
3279input, but generates no responses. If the caller is trusted, or
3280&%untrusted_set_sender%& is set, the senders in the SMTP MAIL commands are
3281believed; otherwise the sender is always the caller of Exim.
3282
3283The message itself is read from the standard input, in SMTP format (leading
3284dots doubled), terminated by a line containing just a single dot. An error is
3285provoked if the terminating dot is missing. A further message may then follow.
3286
3287As for other local message submissions, the contents of incoming batch SMTP
3288messages can be checked using the non-SMTP ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&).
3289Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using &%qualify_domain%& and
3290&%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the &%-bnq%& option is used.
3291
3292Some other SMTP commands are recognized in the input. HELO and EHLO act
3293as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN, and HELP act as NOOP;
3294QUIT quits, ignoring the rest of the standard input.
3295
3296.cindex "return code" "for &%-bS%&"
3297If any error is encountered, reports are written to the standard output and
3298error streams, and Exim gives up immediately. The return code is 0 if no error
3299was detected; it is 1 if one or more messages were accepted before the error
3300was detected; otherwise it is 2.
3301
3302More details of input using batched SMTP are given in section
3303&<<SECTincomingbatchedSMTP>>&.
3304
3305.vitem &%-bs%&
3306.oindex "&%-bs%&"
3307.cindex "SMTP" "local input"
3308.cindex "local SMTP input"
3309This option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by reading SMTP commands
3310on the standard input, and producing SMTP replies on the standard output. SMTP
3311policy controls, as defined in ACLs (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) are applied.
3312Some user agents use this interface as a way of passing locally-generated
3313messages to the MTA.
3314
3315In
3316.cindex "sender" "source of"
3317this usage, if the caller of Exim is trusted, or &%untrusted_set_sender%& is
3318set, the senders of messages are taken from the SMTP MAIL commands.
3319Otherwise the content of these commands is ignored and the sender is set up as
3320the calling user. Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using
3321&%qualify_domain%& and &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the
3322&%-bnq%& option is used.
3323
3324.cindex "inetd"
3325The
3326&%-bs%& option is also used to run Exim from &'inetd'&, as an alternative to
3327using a listening daemon. Exim can distinguish the two cases by checking
3328whether the standard input is a TCP/IP socket. When Exim is called from
3329&'inetd'&, the source of the mail is assumed to be remote, and the comments
3330above concerning senders and qualification do not apply. In this situation,
3331Exim behaves in exactly the same way as it does when receiving a message via
3332the listening daemon.
3333
3334.vitem &%-bt%&
3335.oindex "&%-bt%&"
3336.cindex "testing" "addresses"
3337.cindex "address" "testing"
3338This option runs Exim in address testing mode, in which each argument is taken
3339as a recipient address to be tested for deliverability. The results are
3340written to the standard output. If a test fails, and the caller is not an admin
3341user, no details of the failure are output, because these might contain
3342sensitive information such as usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3343
3344If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3345right angle bracket for addresses to be tested.
3346
3347Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3348&[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'root'& and there are
3349security issues.
3350
3351Each address is handled as if it were the recipient address of a message
3352(compare the &%-bv%& option). It is passed to the routers and the result is
3353written to the standard output. However, any router that has
3354&%no_address_test%& set is bypassed. This can make &%-bt%& easier to use for
3355genuine routing tests if your first router passes everything to a scanner
3356program.
3357
3358.cindex "return code" "for &%-bt%&"
3359The return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3360failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3361code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3362
3363.cindex "duplicate addresses"
3364&*Note*&: When actually delivering a message, Exim removes duplicate recipient
3365addresses after routing is complete, so that only one delivery takes place.
3366This does not happen when testing with &%-bt%&; the full results of routing are
3367always shown.
3368
3369&*Warning*&: &%-bt%& can only do relatively simple testing. If any of the
3370routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender address of a
3371message,
3372.oindex "&%-f%&" "for address testing"
3373you can use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate sender when running
3374&%-bt%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the calling user at the
3375default qualifying domain. However, if you have set up (for example) routers
3376whose behaviour depends on the contents of an incoming message, you cannot test
3377those conditions using &%-bt%&. The &%-N%& option provides a possible way of
3378doing such tests.
3379
3380.vitem &%-bV%&
3381.oindex "&%-bV%&"
3382.cindex "version number of Exim"
3383This option causes Exim to write the current version number, compilation
3384number, and compilation date of the &'exim'& binary to the standard output.
3385It also lists the DBM library that is being used, the optional modules (such as
3386specific lookup types), the drivers that are included in the binary, and the
3387name of the run time configuration file that is in use.
3388
3389As part of its operation, &%-bV%& causes Exim to read and syntax check its
3390configuration file. However, this is a static check only. It cannot check
3391values that are to be expanded. For example, although a misspelt ACL verb is
3392detected, an error in the verb's arguments is not. You cannot rely on &%-bV%&
3393alone to discover (for example) all the typos in the configuration; some
3394realistic testing is needed. The &%-bh%& and &%-N%& options provide more
3395dynamic testing facilities.
3396
3397.vitem &%-bv%&
3398.oindex "&%-bv%&"
3399.cindex "verifying address" "using &%-bv%&"
3400.cindex "address" "verification"
3401This option runs Exim in address verification mode, in which each argument is
3402taken as a recipient address to be verified by the routers. (This does
3403not involve any verification callouts). During normal operation, verification
3404happens mostly as a consequence processing a &%verify%& condition in an ACL
3405(see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). If you want to test an entire ACL, possibly
3406including callouts, see the &%-bh%& and &%-bhc%& options.
3407
3408If verification fails, and the caller is not an admin user, no details of the
3409failure are output, because these might contain sensitive information such as
3410usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3411
3412If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3413right angle bracket for addresses to be verified.
3414
3415Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3416&[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'exim'& and there are
3417security issues.
3418
3419Verification differs from address testing (the &%-bt%& option) in that routers
3420that have &%no_verify%& set are skipped, and if the address is accepted by a
3421router that has &%fail_verify%& set, verification fails. The address is
3422verified as a recipient if &%-bv%& is used; to test verification for a sender
3423address, &%-bvs%& should be used.
3424
3425If the &%-v%& option is not set, the output consists of a single line for each
3426address, stating whether it was verified or not, and giving a reason in the
3427latter case. Without &%-v%&, generating more than one address by redirection
3428causes verification to end successfully, without considering the generated
3429addresses. However, if just one address is generated, processing continues,
3430and the generated address must verify successfully for the overall verification
3431to succeed.
3432
3433When &%-v%& is set, more details are given of how the address has been handled,
3434and in the case of address redirection, all the generated addresses are also
3435considered. Verification may succeed for some and fail for others.
3436
3437The
3438.cindex "return code" "for &%-bv%&"
3439return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3440failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3441code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3442
3443If any of the routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender
3444address of a message, you should use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate
3445sender when running &%-bv%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the
3446calling user at the default qualifying domain.
3447
3448.vitem &%-bvs%&
3449.oindex "&%-bvs%&"
3450This option acts like &%-bv%&, but verifies the address as a sender rather
3451than a recipient address. This affects any rewriting and qualification that
3452might happen.
3453
3454.vitem &%-bw%&
3455.oindex "&%-bw%&"
3456.cindex "daemon"
3457.cindex "inetd"
3458.cindex "inetd" "wait mode"
3459This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections,
3460similarly to the &%-bd%& option. All port specifications on the command-line
3461and in the configuration file are ignored. Queue-running may not be specified.
3462
3463In this mode, Exim expects to be passed a socket as fd 0 (stdin) which is
3464listening for connections. This permits the system to start up and have
3465inetd (or equivalent) listen on the SMTP ports, starting an Exim daemon for
3466each port only when the first connection is received.
3467
3468If the option is given as &%-bw%&<&'time'&> then the time is a timeout, after
3469which the daemon will exit, which should cause inetd to listen once more.
3470
3471.vitem &%-C%&&~<&'filelist'&>
3472.oindex "&%-C%&"
3473.cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
3474.cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
3475.cindex "alternate configuration file"
3476This option causes Exim to find the run time configuration file from the given
3477list instead of from the list specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE
3478compile-time setting. Usually, the list will consist of just a single file
3479name, but it can be a colon-separated list of names. In this case, the first
3480file that exists is used. Failure to open an existing file stops Exim from
3481proceeding any further along the list, and an error is generated.
3482
3483When this option is used by a caller other than root, and the list is different
3484from the compiled-in list, Exim gives up its root privilege immediately, and
3485runs with the real and effective uid and gid set to those of the caller.
3486However, if a TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, that
3487file contains a list of full pathnames, one per line, for configuration files
3488which are trusted. Root privilege is retained for any configuration file so
3489listed, as long as the caller is the Exim user (or the user specified in the
3490CONFIGURE_OWNER option, if any), and as long as the configuration file is
3491not writeable by inappropriate users or groups.
3492
3493Leaving TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST unset precludes the possibility of testing a
3494configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and delivery,
3495even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time, Exim is
3496running as the Exim user, so when it re-executes to regain privilege for the
3497delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root can
3498test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a message
3499on the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using &%-M%&).
3500
3501If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
3502prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option
3503must start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence &`/../`&.
3504However, if the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of
3505CONFIGURE_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as
3506usual. There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is
3507unset, any file name can be used with &%-C%&.
3508
3509ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be used to confine alternative configuration files
3510to a directory to which only root has access. This prevents someone who has
3511broken into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
3512configuration file.
3513
3514The &%-C%& facility is useful for ensuring that configuration files are
3515syntactically correct, but cannot be used for test deliveries, unless the
3516caller is privileged, or unless it is an exotic configuration that does not
3517require privilege. No check is made on the owner or group of the files
3518specified by this option.
3519
3520
3521.vitem &%-D%&<&'macro'&>=<&'value'&>
3522.oindex "&%-D%&"
3523.cindex "macro" "setting on command line"
3524This option can be used to override macro definitions in the configuration file
3525(see section &<<SECTmacrodefs>>&). However, like &%-C%&, if it is used by an
3526unprivileged caller, it causes Exim to give up its root privilege.
3527If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
3528completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
3529
3530If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_& then it should be a
3531colon-separated list of macros which are considered safe and, if &%-D%& only
3532supplies macros from this list, and the values are acceptable, then Exim will
3533not give up root privilege if the caller is root, the Exim run-time user, or
3534the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a transition mechanism and is expected
3535to be removed in the future. Acceptable values for the macros satisfy the
3536regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
3537
3538The entire option (including equals sign if present) must all be within one
3539command line item. &%-D%& can be used to set the value of a macro to the empty
3540string, in which case the equals sign is optional. These two commands are
3541synonymous:
3542.code
3543exim -DABC ...
3544exim -DABC= ...
3545.endd
3546To include spaces in a macro definition item, quotes must be used. If you use
3547quotes, spaces are permitted around the macro name and the equals sign. For
3548example:
3549.code
3550exim '-D ABC = something' ...
3551.endd
3552&%-D%& may be repeated up to 10 times on a command line.
3553Only macro names up to 22 letters long can be set.
3554
3555
3556.vitem &%-d%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3557.oindex "&%-d%&"
3558.cindex "debugging" "list of selectors"
3559.cindex "debugging" "&%-d%& option"
3560This option causes debugging information to be written to the standard
3561error stream. It is restricted to admin users because debugging output may show
3562database queries that contain password information. Also, the details of users'
3563filter files should be protected. If a non-admin user uses &%-d%&, Exim
3564writes an error message to the standard error stream and exits with a non-zero
3565return code.
3566
3567When &%-d%& is used, &%-v%& is assumed. If &%-d%& is given on its own, a lot of
3568standard debugging data is output. This can be reduced, or increased to include
3569some more rarely needed information, by directly following &%-d%& with a string
3570made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. These add or remove sets
3571of debugging data, respectively. For example, &%-d+filter%& adds filter
3572debugging, whereas &%-d-all+filter%& selects only filter debugging. Note that
3573no spaces are allowed in the debug setting. The available debugging categories
3574are:
3575.display
3576&`acl `& ACL interpretation
3577&`auth `& authenticators
3578&`deliver `& general delivery logic
3579&`dns `& DNS lookups (see also resolver)
3580&`dnsbl `& DNS black list (aka RBL) code
3581&`exec `& arguments for &[execv()]& calls
3582&`expand `& detailed debugging for string expansions
3583&`filter `& filter handling
3584&`hints_lookup `& hints data lookups
3585&`host_lookup `& all types of name-to-IP address handling
3586&`ident `& ident lookup
3587&`interface `& lists of local interfaces
3588&`lists `& matching things in lists
3589&`load `& system load checks
3590&`local_scan `& can be used by &[local_scan()]& (see chapter &&&
3591 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&)
3592&`lookup `& general lookup code and all lookups
3593&`memory `& memory handling
3594&`pid `& add pid to debug output lines
3595&`process_info `& setting info for the process log
3596&`queue_run `& queue runs
3597&`receive `& general message reception logic
3598&`resolver `& turn on the DNS resolver's debugging output
3599&`retry `& retry handling
3600&`rewrite `& address rewriting
3601&`route `& address routing
3602&`timestamp `& add timestamp to debug output lines
3603&`tls `& TLS logic
3604&`transport `& transports
3605&`uid `& changes of uid/gid and looking up uid/gid
3606&`verify `& address verification logic
3607&`all `& almost all of the above (see below), and also &%-v%&
3608.endd
3609The &`all`& option excludes &`memory`& when used as &`+all`&, but includes it
3610for &`-all`&. The reason for this is that &`+all`& is something that people
3611tend to use when generating debug output for Exim maintainers. If &`+memory`&
3612is included, an awful lot of output that is very rarely of interest is
3613generated, so it now has to be explicitly requested. However, &`-all`& does
3614turn everything off.
3615
3616.cindex "resolver, debugging output"
3617.cindex "DNS resolver, debugging output"
3618The &`resolver`& option produces output only if the DNS resolver was compiled
3619with DEBUG enabled. This is not the case in some operating systems. Also,
3620unfortunately, debugging output from the DNS resolver is written to stdout
3621rather than stderr.
3622
3623The default (&%-d%& with no argument) omits &`expand`&, &`filter`&,
3624&`interface`&, &`load`&, &`memory`&, &`pid`&, &`resolver`&, and &`timestamp`&.
3625However, the &`pid`& selector is forced when debugging is turned on for a
3626daemon, which then passes it on to any re-executed Exims. Exim also
3627automatically adds the pid to debug lines when several remote deliveries are
3628run in parallel.
3629
3630The &`timestamp`& selector causes the current time to be inserted at the start
3631of all debug output lines. This can be useful when trying to track down delays
3632in processing.
3633
3634If the &%debug_print%& option is set in any driver, it produces output whenever
3635any debugging is selected, or if &%-v%& is used.
3636
3637.vitem &%-dd%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3638.oindex "&%-dd%&"
3639This option behaves exactly like &%-d%& except when used on a command that
3640starts a daemon process. In that case, debugging is turned off for the
3641subprocesses that the daemon creates. Thus, it is useful for monitoring the
3642behaviour of the daemon without creating as much output as full debugging does.
3643
3644.vitem &%-dropcr%&
3645.oindex "&%-dropcr%&"
3646This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
3647handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
3648described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
3649
3650.vitem &%-E%&
3651.oindex "&%-E%&"
3652.cindex "bounce message" "generating"
3653This option specifies that an incoming message is a locally-generated delivery
3654failure report. It is used internally by Exim when handling delivery failures
3655and is not intended for external use. Its only effect is to stop Exim
3656generating certain messages to the postmaster, as otherwise message cascades
3657could occur in some situations. As part of the same option, a message id may
3658follow the characters &%-E%&. If it does, the log entry for the receipt of the
3659new message contains the id, following &"R="&, as a cross-reference.
3660
3661.vitem &%-e%&&'x'&
3662.oindex "&%-e%&&'x'&"
3663There are a number of Sendmail options starting with &%-oe%& which seem to be
3664called by various programs without the leading &%o%& in the option. For
3665example, the &%vacation%& program uses &%-eq%&. Exim treats all options of the
3666form &%-e%&&'x'& as synonymous with the corresponding &%-oe%&&'x'& options.
3667
3668.vitem &%-F%&&~<&'string'&>
3669.oindex "&%-F%&"
3670.cindex "sender" "name"
3671.cindex "name" "of sender"
3672This option sets the sender's full name for use when a locally-generated
3673message is being accepted. In the absence of this option, the user's &'gecos'&
3674entry from the password data is used. As users are generally permitted to alter
3675their &'gecos'& entries, no security considerations are involved. White space
3676between &%-F%& and the <&'string'&> is optional.
3677
3678.vitem &%-f%&&~<&'address'&>
3679.oindex "&%-f%&"
3680.cindex "sender" "address"
3681.cindex "address" "sender"
3682.cindex "trusted users"
3683.cindex "envelope sender"
3684.cindex "user" "trusted"
3685This option sets the address of the envelope sender of a locally-generated
3686message (also known as the return path). The option can normally be used only
3687by a trusted user, but &%untrusted_set_sender%& can be set to allow untrusted
3688users to use it.
3689
3690Processes running as root or the Exim user are always trusted. Other
3691trusted users are defined by the &%trusted_users%& or &%trusted_groups%&
3692options. In the absence of &%-f%&, or if the caller is not trusted, the sender
3693of a local message is set to the caller's login name at the default qualify
3694domain.
3695
3696There is one exception to the restriction on the use of &%-f%&: an empty sender
3697can be specified by any user, trusted or not, to create a message that can
3698never provoke a bounce. An empty sender can be specified either as an empty
3699string, or as a pair of angle brackets with nothing between them, as in these
3700examples of shell commands:
3701.code
3702exim -f '<>' user@domain
3703exim -f "" user@domain
3704.endd
3705In addition, the use of &%-f%& is not restricted when testing a filter file
3706with &%-bf%& or when testing or verifying addresses using the &%-bt%& or
3707&%-bv%& options.
3708
3709Allowing untrusted users to change the sender address does not of itself make
3710it possible to send anonymous mail. Exim still checks that the &'From:'& header
3711refers to the local user, and if it does not, it adds a &'Sender:'& header,
3712though this can be overridden by setting &%no_local_from_check%&.
3713
3714White
3715.cindex "&""From""& line"
3716space between &%-f%& and the <&'address'&> is optional (that is, they can be
3717given as two arguments or one combined argument). The sender of a
3718locally-generated message can also be set (when permitted) by an initial
3719&"From&~"& line in the message &-- see the description of &%-bm%& above &-- but
3720if &%-f%& is also present, it overrides &"From&~"&.
3721
3722.vitem &%-G%&
3723.oindex "&%-G%&"
3724.cindex "submission fixups, suppressing (command-line)"
3725This option is equivalent to an ACL applying:
3726.code
3727control = suppress_local_fixups
3728.endd
3729for every message received. Note that Sendmail will complain about such
3730bad formatting, where Exim silently just does not fix it up. This may change
3731in future.
3732
3733As this affects audit information, the caller must be a trusted user to use
3734this option.
3735
3736.vitem &%-h%&&~<&'number'&>
3737.oindex "&%-h%&"
3738.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-h%& option ignored"
3739This option is accepted for compatibility with Sendmail, but has no effect. (In
3740Sendmail it overrides the &"hop count"& obtained by counting &'Received:'&
3741headers.)
3742
3743.vitem &%-i%&
3744.oindex "&%-i%&"
3745.cindex "Solaris" "&'mail'& command"
3746.cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
3747This option, which has the same effect as &%-oi%&, specifies that a dot on a
3748line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. I can find
3749no documentation for this option in Solaris 2.4 Sendmail, but the &'mailx'&
3750command in Solaris 2.4 uses it. See also &%-ti%&.
3751
3752.vitem &%-L%&&~<&'tag'&>
3753.oindex "&%-L%&"
3754.cindex "syslog" "process name; set with flag"
3755This option is equivalent to setting &%syslog_processname%& in the config
3756file and setting &%log_file_path%& to &`syslog`&.
3757Its use is restricted to administrators. The configuration file has to be
3758read and parsed, to determine access rights, before this is set and takes
3759effect, so early configuration file errors will not honour this flag.
3760
3761The tag should not be longer than 32 characters.
3762
3763.vitem &%-M%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3764.oindex "&%-M%&"
3765.cindex "forcing delivery"
3766.cindex "delivery" "forcing attempt"
3767.cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
3768This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn. If
3769any of the messages are frozen, they are automatically thawed before the
3770delivery attempt. The settings of &%queue_domains%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
3771and &%hold_domains%& are ignored.
3772
3773Retry
3774.cindex "hints database" "overriding retry hints"
3775hints for any of the addresses are overridden &-- Exim tries to deliver even if
3776the normal retry time has not yet been reached. This option requires the caller
3777to be an admin user. However, there is an option called &%prod_requires_admin%&
3778which can be set false to relax this restriction (and also the same requirement
3779for the &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options).
3780
3781The deliveries happen synchronously, that is, the original Exim process does
3782not terminate until all the delivery attempts have finished. No output is
3783produced unless there is a serious error. If you want to see what is happening,
3784use the &%-v%& option as well, or inspect Exim's main log.
3785
3786.vitem &%-Mar%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3787.oindex "&%-Mar%&"
3788.cindex "message" "adding recipients"
3789.cindex "recipient" "adding"
3790This option requests Exim to add the addresses to the list of recipients of the
3791message (&"ar"& for &"add recipients"&). The first argument must be a message
3792id, and the remaining ones must be email addresses. However, if the message is
3793active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), it is not altered. This option
3794can be used only by an admin user.
3795
3796.vitem "&%-MC%&&~<&'transport'&>&~<&'hostname'&>&~<&'sequence&~number'&>&&&
3797 &~<&'message&~id'&>"
3798.oindex "&%-MC%&"
3799.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
3800.cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
3801.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
3802This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3803by Exim to invoke another instance of itself to deliver a waiting message using
3804an existing SMTP connection, which is passed as the standard input. Details are
3805given in chapter &<<CHAPSMTP>>&. This must be the final option, and the caller
3806must be root or the Exim user in order to use it.
3807
3808.vitem &%-MCA%&
3809.oindex "&%-MCA%&"
3810This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3811by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3812connection to the remote host has been authenticated.
3813
3814.vitem &%-MCD%&
3815.oindex "&%-MCD%&"
3816This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3817by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3818remote host supports the ESMTP &_DSN_& extension.
3819
3820.vitem &%-MCG%&&~<&'queue&~name'&>
3821.oindex "&%-MCG%&"
3822This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3823by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that an
3824alternate queue is used, named by the following argument.
3825
3826.vitem &%-MCK%&
3827.oindex "&%-MCK%&"
3828This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3829by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that an
3830remote host supports the ESMTP &_CHUNKING_& extension.
3831
3832.vitem &%-MCP%&
3833.oindex "&%-MCP%&"
3834This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3835by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the server to
3836which Exim is connected supports pipelining.
3837
3838.vitem &%-MCQ%&&~<&'process&~id'&>&~<&'pipe&~fd'&>
3839.oindex "&%-MCQ%&"
3840This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3841by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option when the original delivery was
3842started by a queue runner. It passes on the process id of the queue runner,
3843together with the file descriptor number of an open pipe. Closure of the pipe
3844signals the final completion of the sequence of processes that are passing
3845messages through the same SMTP connection.
3846
3847.vitem &%-MCS%&
3848.oindex "&%-MCS%&"
3849This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3850by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3851SMTP SIZE option should be used on messages delivered down the existing
3852connection.
3853
3854.vitem &%-MCT%&
3855.oindex "&%-MCT%&"
3856This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3857by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3858host to which Exim is connected supports TLS encryption.
3859
3860.new
3861.vitem &%-MCt%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>&~<&'port'&>&~<&'cipher'&>
3862.oindex "&%-MCt%&"
3863This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3864by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3865connection is being proxied by a parent process for handling TLS encryption.
3866The arguments give the local address and port being proxied, and the TLS cipher.
3867.wen
3868
3869.vitem &%-Mc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3870.oindex "&%-Mc%&"
3871.cindex "hints database" "not overridden by &%-Mc%&"
3872.cindex "delivery" "manually started &-- not forced"
3873This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn,
3874but unlike the &%-M%& option, it does check for retry hints, and respects any
3875that are found. This option is not very useful to external callers. It is
3876provided mainly for internal use by Exim when it needs to re-invoke itself in
3877order to regain root privilege for a delivery (see chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&).
3878However, &%-Mc%& can be useful when testing, in order to run a delivery that
3879respects retry times and other options such as &%hold_domains%& that are
3880overridden when &%-M%& is used. Such a delivery does not count as a queue run.
3881If you want to run a specific delivery as if in a queue run, you should use
3882&%-q%& with a message id argument. A distinction between queue run deliveries
3883and other deliveries is made in one or two places.
3884
3885.vitem &%-Mes%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>
3886.oindex "&%-Mes%&"
3887.cindex "message" "changing sender"
3888.cindex "sender" "changing"
3889This option requests Exim to change the sender address in the message to the
3890given address, which must be a fully qualified address or &"<>"& (&"es"& for
3891&"edit sender"&). There must be exactly two arguments. The first argument must
3892be a message id, and the second one an email address. However, if the message
3893is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered.
3894This option can be used only by an admin user.
3895
3896.vitem &%-Mf%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3897.oindex "&%-Mf%&"
3898.cindex "freezing messages"
3899.cindex "message" "manually freezing"
3900This option requests Exim to mark each listed message as &"frozen"&. This
3901prevents any delivery attempts taking place until the message is &"thawed"&,
3902either manually or as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& configuration option.
3903However, if any of the messages are active (in the middle of a delivery
3904attempt), their status is not altered. This option can be used only by an admin
3905user.
3906
3907.vitem &%-Mg%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3908.oindex "&%-Mg%&"
3909.cindex "giving up on messages"
3910.cindex "message" "abandoning delivery attempts"
3911.cindex "delivery" "abandoning further attempts"
3912This option requests Exim to give up trying to deliver the listed messages,
3913including any that are frozen. However, if any of the messages are active,
3914their status is not altered. For non-bounce messages, a delivery error message
3915is sent to the sender, containing the text &"cancelled by administrator"&.
3916Bounce messages are just discarded. This option can be used only by an admin
3917user.
3918
3919.vitem &%-Mmad%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3920.oindex "&%-Mmad%&"
3921.cindex "delivery" "cancelling all"
3922This option requests Exim to mark all the recipient addresses in the messages
3923as already delivered (&"mad"& for &"mark all delivered"&). However, if any
3924message is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not
3925altered. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3926
3927.vitem &%-Mmd%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3928.oindex "&%-Mmd%&"
3929.cindex "delivery" "cancelling by address"
3930.cindex "recipient" "removing"
3931.cindex "removing recipients"
3932This option requests Exim to mark the given addresses as already delivered
3933(&"md"& for &"mark delivered"&). The first argument must be a message id, and
3934the remaining ones must be email addresses. These are matched to recipient
3935addresses in the message in a case-sensitive manner. If the message is active
3936(in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered. This option
3937can be used only by an admin user.
3938
3939.vitem &%-Mrm%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3940.oindex "&%-Mrm%&"
3941.cindex "removing messages"
3942.cindex "abandoning mail"
3943.cindex "message" "manually discarding"
3944This option requests Exim to remove the given messages from the queue. No
3945bounce messages are sent; each message is simply forgotten. However, if any of
3946the messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used
3947only by an admin user or by the user who originally caused the message to be
3948placed on the queue.
3949
3950.vitem &%-Mset%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3951.oindex "&%-Mset%&
3952.cindex "testing" "string expansion"
3953.cindex "expansion" "testing"
3954This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-be%& (that is, when testing
3955string expansions). Exim loads the given message from its spool before doing
3956the test expansions, thus setting message-specific variables such as
3957&$message_size$& and the header variables. The &$recipients$& variable is made
3958available. This feature is provided to make it easier to test expansions that
3959make use of these variables. However, this option can be used only by an admin
3960user. See also &%-bem%&.
3961
3962.vitem &%-Mt%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3963.oindex "&%-Mt%&"
3964.cindex "thawing messages"
3965.cindex "unfreezing messages"
3966.cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
3967.cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
3968This option requests Exim to &"thaw"& any of the listed messages that are
3969&"frozen"&, so that delivery attempts can resume. However, if any of the
3970messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used only
3971by an admin user.
3972
3973.vitem &%-Mvb%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3974.oindex "&%-Mvb%&"
3975.cindex "listing" "message body"
3976.cindex "message" "listing body of"
3977This option causes the contents of the message body (-D) spool file to be
3978written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3979
3980.vitem &%-Mvc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3981.oindex "&%-Mvc%&"
3982.cindex "message" "listing in RFC 2822 format"
3983.cindex "listing" "message in RFC 2822 format"
3984This option causes a copy of the complete message (header lines plus body) to
3985be written to the standard output in RFC 2822 format. This option can be used
3986only by an admin user.
3987
3988.vitem &%-Mvh%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3989.oindex "&%-Mvh%&"
3990.cindex "listing" "message headers"
3991.cindex "header lines" "listing"
3992.cindex "message" "listing header lines"
3993This option causes the contents of the message headers (-H) spool file to be
3994written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3995
3996.vitem &%-Mvl%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3997.oindex "&%-Mvl%&"
3998.cindex "listing" "message log"
3999.cindex "message" "listing message log"
4000This option causes the contents of the message log spool file to be written to
4001the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4002
4003.vitem &%-m%&
4004.oindex "&%-m%&"
4005This is apparently a synonym for &%-om%& that is accepted by Sendmail, so Exim
4006treats it that way too.
4007
4008.vitem &%-N%&
4009.oindex "&%-N%&"
4010.cindex "debugging" "&%-N%& option"
4011.cindex "debugging" "suppressing delivery"
4012This is a debugging option that inhibits delivery of a message at the transport
4013level. It implies &%-v%&. Exim goes through many of the motions of delivery &--
4014it just doesn't actually transport the message, but instead behaves as if it
4015had successfully done so. However, it does not make any updates to the retry
4016database, and the log entries for deliveries are flagged with &"*>"& rather
4017than &"=>"&.
4018
4019Because &%-N%& discards any message to which it applies, only root or the Exim
4020user are allowed to use it with &%-bd%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%& or &%-M%&. In other
4021words, an ordinary user can use it only when supplying an incoming message to
4022which it will apply. Although transportation never fails when &%-N%& is set, an
4023address may be deferred because of a configuration problem on a transport, or a
4024routing problem. Once &%-N%& has been used for a delivery attempt, it sticks to
4025the message, and applies to any subsequent delivery attempts that may happen
4026for that message.
4027
4028.vitem &%-n%&
4029.oindex "&%-n%&"
4030This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &"no aliasing"&.
4031For normal modes of operation, it is ignored by Exim.
4032When combined with &%-bP%& it makes the output more terse (suppresses
4033option names, environment values and config pretty printing).
4034
4035.vitem &%-O%&&~<&'data'&>
4036.oindex "&%-O%&"
4037This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &`set option`&. It is ignored by
4038Exim.
4039
4040.vitem &%-oA%&&~<&'file&~name'&>
4041.oindex "&%-oA%&"
4042.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oA%& option"
4043This option is used by Sendmail in conjunction with &%-bi%& to specify an
4044alternative alias file name. Exim handles &%-bi%& differently; see the
4045description above.
4046
4047.vitem &%-oB%&&~<&'n'&>
4048.oindex "&%-oB%&"
4049.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4050.cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4051.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4052This is a debugging option which limits the maximum number of messages that can
4053be delivered down one SMTP connection, overriding the value set in any &(smtp)&
4054transport. If <&'n'&> is omitted, the limit is set to 1.
4055
4056.vitem &%-odb%&
4057.oindex "&%-odb%&"
4058.cindex "background delivery"
4059.cindex "delivery" "in the background"
4060This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4061including the listening daemon. It requests &"background"& delivery of such
4062messages, which means that the accepting process automatically starts a
4063delivery process for each message received, but does not wait for the delivery
4064processes to finish.
4065
4066When all the messages have been received, the reception process exits,
4067leaving the delivery processes to finish in their own time. The standard output
4068and error streams are closed at the start of each delivery process.
4069This is the default action if none of the &%-od%& options are present.
4070
4071If one of the queueing options in the configuration file
4072(&%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%&, for example) is in effect, &%-odb%&
4073overrides it if &%queue_only_override%& is set true, which is the default
4074setting. If &%queue_only_override%& is set false, &%-odb%& has no effect.
4075
4076.vitem &%-odf%&
4077.oindex "&%-odf%&"
4078.cindex "foreground delivery"
4079.cindex "delivery" "in the foreground"
4080This option requests &"foreground"& (synchronous) delivery when Exim has
4081accepted a locally-generated message. (For the daemon it is exactly the same as
4082&%-odb%&.) A delivery process is automatically started to deliver the message,
4083and Exim waits for it to complete before proceeding.
4084
4085The original Exim reception process does not finish until the delivery
4086process for the final message has ended. The standard error stream is left open
4087during deliveries.
4088
4089However, like &%-odb%&, this option has no effect if &%queue_only_override%& is
4090false and one of the queueing options in the configuration file is in effect.
4091
4092If there is a temporary delivery error during foreground delivery, the
4093message is left on the queue for later delivery, and the original reception
4094process exits. See chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>& for a way of setting up a
4095restricted configuration that never queues messages.
4096
4097
4098.vitem &%-odi%&
4099.oindex "&%-odi%&"
4100This option is synonymous with &%-odf%&. It is provided for compatibility with
4101Sendmail.
4102
4103.vitem &%-odq%&
4104.oindex "&%-odq%&"
4105.cindex "non-immediate delivery"
4106.cindex "delivery" "suppressing immediate"
4107.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
4108This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4109including the listening daemon. It specifies that the accepting process should
4110not automatically start a delivery process for each message received. Messages
4111are placed on the queue, and remain there until a subsequent queue runner
4112process encounters them. There are several configuration options (such as
4113&%queue_only%&) that can be used to queue incoming messages under certain
4114conditions. This option overrides all of them and also &%-odqs%&. It always
4115forces queueing.
4116
4117.vitem &%-odqs%&
4118.oindex "&%-odqs%&"
4119.cindex "SMTP" "delaying delivery"
4120This option is a hybrid between &%-odb%&/&%-odi%& and &%-odq%&.
4121However, like &%-odb%& and &%-odi%&, this option has no effect if
4122&%queue_only_override%& is false and one of the queueing options in the
4123configuration file is in effect.
4124
4125When &%-odqs%& does operate, a delivery process is started for each incoming
4126message, in the background by default, but in the foreground if &%-odi%& is
4127also present. The recipient addresses are routed, and local deliveries are done
4128in the normal way. However, if any SMTP deliveries are required, they are not
4129done at this time, so the message remains on the queue until a subsequent queue
4130runner process encounters it. Because routing was done, Exim knows which
4131messages are waiting for which hosts, and so a number of messages for the same
4132host can be sent in a single SMTP connection. The &%queue_smtp_domains%&
4133configuration option has the same effect for specific domains. See also the
4134&%-qq%& option.
4135
4136.vitem &%-oee%&
4137.oindex "&%-oee%&"
4138.cindex "error" "reporting"
4139If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received (for
4140example, a malformed address), the error is reported to the sender in a mail
4141message.
4142
4143.cindex "return code" "for &%-oee%&"
4144Provided
4145this error message is successfully sent, the Exim receiving process
4146exits with a return code of zero. If not, the return code is 2 if the problem
4147is that the original message has no recipients, or 1 for any other error.
4148This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option if Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4149
4150.vitem &%-oem%&
4151.oindex "&%-oem%&"
4152.cindex "error" "reporting"
4153.cindex "return code" "for &%-oem%&"
4154This is the same as &%-oee%&, except that Exim always exits with a non-zero
4155return code, whether or not the error message was successfully sent.
4156This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option, unless Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4157
4158.vitem &%-oep%&
4159.oindex "&%-oep%&"
4160.cindex "error" "reporting"
4161If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received, the
4162error is reported by writing a message to the standard error file (stderr).
4163.cindex "return code" "for &%-oep%&"
4164The return code is 1 for all errors.
4165
4166.vitem &%-oeq%&
4167.oindex "&%-oeq%&"
4168.cindex "error" "reporting"
4169This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4170effect as &%-oep%&.
4171
4172.vitem &%-oew%&
4173.oindex "&%-oew%&"
4174.cindex "error" "reporting"
4175This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4176effect as &%-oem%&.
4177
4178.vitem &%-oi%&
4179.oindex "&%-oi%&"
4180.cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
4181This option, which has the same effect as &%-i%&, specifies that a dot on a
4182line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. Otherwise, a
4183single dot does terminate, though Exim does no special processing for other
4184lines that start with a dot. This option is set by default if Exim is called as
4185&'rmail'&. See also &%-ti%&.
4186
4187.vitem &%-oitrue%&
4188.oindex "&%-oitrue%&"
4189This option is treated as synonymous with &%-oi%&.
4190
4191.vitem &%-oMa%&&~<&'host&~address'&>
4192.oindex "&%-oMa%&"
4193.cindex "sender" "host address, specifying for local message"
4194A number of options starting with &%-oM%& can be used to set values associated
4195with remote hosts on locally-submitted messages (that is, messages not received
4196over TCP/IP). These options can be used by any caller in conjunction with the
4197&%-bh%&, &%-be%&, &%-bf%&, &%-bF%&, &%-bt%&, or &%-bv%& testing options. In
4198other circumstances, they are ignored unless the caller is trusted.
4199
4200The &%-oMa%& option sets the sender host address. This may include a port
4201number at the end, after a full stop (period). For example:
4202.code
4203exim -bs -oMa 10.9.8.7.1234
4204.endd
4205An alternative syntax is to enclose the IP address in square brackets,
4206followed by a colon and the port number:
4207.code
4208exim -bs -oMa [10.9.8.7]:1234
4209.endd
4210The IP address is placed in the &$sender_host_address$& variable, and the
4211port, if present, in &$sender_host_port$&. If both &%-oMa%& and &%-bh%&
4212are present on the command line, the sender host IP address is taken from
4213whichever one is last.
4214
4215.vitem &%-oMaa%&&~<&'name'&>
4216.oindex "&%-oMaa%&"
4217.cindex "authentication" "name, specifying for local message"
4218See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMaa%&
4219option sets the value of &$sender_host_authenticated$& (the authenticator
4220name). See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of SMTP authentication.
4221This option can be used with &%-bh%& and &%-bs%& to set up an
4222authenticated SMTP session without actually using the SMTP AUTH command.
4223
4224.vitem &%-oMai%&&~<&'string'&>
4225.oindex "&%-oMai%&"
4226.cindex "authentication" "id, specifying for local message"
4227See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMai%&
4228option sets the value of &$authenticated_id$& (the id that was authenticated).
4229This overrides the default value (the caller's login id, except with &%-bh%&,
4230where there is no default) for messages from local sources. See chapter
4231&<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated ids.
4232
4233.vitem &%-oMas%&&~<&'address'&>
4234.oindex "&%-oMas%&"
4235.cindex "authentication" "sender, specifying for local message"
4236See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMas%&
4237option sets the authenticated sender value in &$authenticated_sender$&. It
4238overrides the sender address that is created from the caller's login id for
4239messages from local sources, except when &%-bh%& is used, when there is no
4240default. For both &%-bh%& and &%-bs%&, an authenticated sender that is
4241specified on a MAIL command overrides this value. See chapter
4242&<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated senders.
4243
4244.vitem &%-oMi%&&~<&'interface&~address'&>
4245.oindex "&%-oMi%&"
4246.cindex "interface" "address, specifying for local message"
4247See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMi%&
4248option sets the IP interface address value. A port number may be included,
4249using the same syntax as for &%-oMa%&. The interface address is placed in
4250&$received_ip_address$& and the port number, if present, in &$received_port$&.
4251
4252.vitem &%-oMm%&&~<&'message&~reference'&>
4253.oindex "&%-oMm%&"
4254.cindex "message reference" "message reference, specifying for local message"
4255See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMm%&
4256option sets the message reference, e.g. message-id, and is logged during
4257delivery. This is useful when some kind of audit trail is required to tie
4258messages together. The format of the message reference is checked and will
4259abort if the format is invalid. The option will only be accepted if exim is
4260running in trusted mode, not as any regular user.
4261
4262The best example of a message reference is when Exim sends a bounce message.
4263The message reference is the message-id of the original message for which Exim
4264is sending the bounce.
4265
4266.vitem &%-oMr%&&~<&'protocol&~name'&>
4267.oindex "&%-oMr%&"
4268.cindex "protocol, specifying for local message"
4269.vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
4270See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMr%&
4271option sets the received protocol value that is stored in
4272&$received_protocol$&. However, it does not apply (and is ignored) when &%-bh%&
4273or &%-bs%& is used. For &%-bh%&, the protocol is forced to one of the standard
4274SMTP protocol names (see the description of &$received_protocol$& in section
4275&<<SECTexpvar>>&). For &%-bs%&, the protocol is always &"local-"& followed by
4276one of those same names. For &%-bS%& (batched SMTP) however, the protocol can
4277be set by &%-oMr%&.
4278
4279.vitem &%-oMs%&&~<&'host&~name'&>
4280.oindex "&%-oMs%&"
4281.cindex "sender" "host name, specifying for local message"
4282See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMs%&
4283option sets the sender host name in &$sender_host_name$&. When this option is
4284present, Exim does not attempt to look up a host name from an IP address; it
4285uses the name it is given.
4286
4287.vitem &%-oMt%&&~<&'ident&~string'&>
4288.oindex "&%-oMt%&"
4289.cindex "sender" "ident string, specifying for local message"
4290See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMt%&
4291option sets the sender ident value in &$sender_ident$&. The default setting for
4292local callers is the login id of the calling process, except when &%-bh%& is
4293used, when there is no default.
4294
4295.vitem &%-om%&
4296.oindex "&%-om%&"
4297.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-om%& option ignored"
4298In Sendmail, this option means &"me too"&, indicating that the sender of a
4299message should receive a copy of the message if the sender appears in an alias
4300expansion. Exim always does this, so the option does nothing.
4301
4302.vitem &%-oo%&
4303.oindex "&%-oo%&"
4304.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oo%& option ignored"
4305This option is ignored. In Sendmail it specifies &"old style headers"&,
4306whatever that means.
4307
4308.vitem &%-oP%&&~<&'path'&>
4309.oindex "&%-oP%&"
4310.cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
4311.cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
4312This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-bd%& or &%-q%& with a time
4313value. The option specifies the file to which the process id of the daemon is
4314written. When &%-oX%& is used with &%-bd%&, or when &%-q%& with a time is used
4315without &%-bd%&, this is the only way of causing Exim to write a pid file,
4316because in those cases, the normal pid file is not used.
4317
4318.vitem &%-or%&&~<&'time'&>
4319.oindex "&%-or%&"
4320.cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
4321This option sets a timeout value for incoming non-SMTP messages. If it is not
4322set, Exim will wait forever for the standard input. The value can also be set
4323by the &%receive_timeout%& option. The format used for specifying times is
4324described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4325
4326.vitem &%-os%&&~<&'time'&>
4327.oindex "&%-os%&"
4328.cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
4329.cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
4330This option sets a timeout value for incoming SMTP messages. The timeout
4331applies to each SMTP command and block of data. The value can also be set by
4332the &%smtp_receive_timeout%& option; it defaults to 5 minutes. The format used
4333for specifying times is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4334
4335.vitem &%-ov%&
4336.oindex "&%-ov%&"
4337This option has exactly the same effect as &%-v%&.
4338
4339.vitem &%-oX%&&~<&'number&~or&~string'&>
4340.oindex "&%-oX%&"
4341.cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
4342.cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
4343.cindex "port" "receiving TCP/IP"
4344This option is relevant only when the &%-bd%& (start listening daemon) option
4345is also given. It controls which ports and interfaces the daemon uses. Details
4346of the syntax, and how it interacts with configuration file options, are given
4347in chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&. When &%-oX%& is used to start a daemon, no pid
4348file is written unless &%-oP%& is also present to specify a pid file name.
4349
4350.vitem &%-pd%&
4351.oindex "&%-pd%&"
4352.cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4353This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4354chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4355option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to be delayed until it is
4356needed.
4357
4358.vitem &%-ps%&
4359.oindex "&%-ps%&"
4360.cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4361This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4362chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4363option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to occur as soon as Exim is
4364started.
4365
4366.vitem &%-p%&<&'rval'&>:<&'sval'&>
4367.oindex "&%-p%&"
4368For compatibility with Sendmail, this option is equivalent to
4369.display
4370&`-oMr`& <&'rval'&> &`-oMs`& <&'sval'&>
4371.endd
4372It sets the incoming protocol and host name (for trusted callers). The
4373host name and its colon can be omitted when only the protocol is to be set.
4374Note the Exim already has two private options, &%-pd%& and &%-ps%&, that refer
4375to embedded Perl. It is therefore impossible to set a protocol value of &`d`&
4376or &`s`& using this option (but that does not seem a real limitation).
4377
4378.vitem &%-q%&
4379.oindex "&%-q%&"
4380.cindex "queue runner" "starting manually"
4381This option is normally restricted to admin users. However, there is a
4382configuration option called &%prod_requires_admin%& which can be set false to
4383relax this restriction (and also the same requirement for the &%-M%&, &%-R%&,
4384and &%-S%& options).
4385
4386.cindex "queue runner" "description of operation"
4387If other commandline options do not specify an action,
4388the &%-q%& option starts one queue runner process. This scans the queue of
4389waiting messages, and runs a delivery process for each one in turn. It waits
4390for each delivery process to finish before starting the next one. A delivery
4391process may not actually do any deliveries if the retry times for the addresses
4392have not been reached. Use &%-qf%& (see below) if you want to override this.
4393
4394If
4395.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4396.cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4397.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4398the delivery process spawns other processes to deliver other messages down
4399passed SMTP connections, the queue runner waits for these to finish before
4400proceeding.
4401
4402When all the queued messages have been considered, the original queue runner
4403process terminates. In other words, a single pass is made over the waiting
4404mail, one message at a time. Use &%-q%& with a time (see below) if you want
4405this to be repeated periodically.
4406
4407Exim processes the waiting messages in an unpredictable order. It isn't very
4408random, but it is likely to be different each time, which is all that matters.
4409If one particular message screws up a remote MTA, other messages to the same
4410MTA have a chance of getting through if they get tried first.
4411
4412It is possible to cause the messages to be processed in lexical message id
4413order, which is essentially the order in which they arrived, by setting the
4414&%queue_run_in_order%& option, but this is not recommended for normal use.
4415
4416.vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>
4417The &%-q%& option may be followed by one or more flag letters that change its
4418behaviour. They are all optional, but if more than one is present, they must
4419appear in the correct order. Each flag is described in a separate item below.
4420
4421.vitem &%-qq...%&
4422.oindex "&%-qq%&"
4423.cindex "queue" "double scanning"
4424.cindex "queue" "routing"
4425.cindex "routing" "whole queue before delivery"
4426An option starting with &%-qq%& requests a two-stage queue run. In the first
4427stage, the queue is scanned as if the &%queue_smtp_domains%& option matched
4428every domain. Addresses are routed, local deliveries happen, but no remote
4429transports are run.
4430
4431.cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
4432The hints database that remembers which messages are waiting for specific hosts
4433is updated, as if delivery to those hosts had been deferred. After this is
4434complete, a second, normal queue scan happens, with routing and delivery taking
4435place as normal. Messages that are routed to the same host should mostly be
4436delivered down a single SMTP
4437.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4438.cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4439.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4440connection because of the hints that were set up during the first queue scan.
4441This option may be useful for hosts that are connected to the Internet
4442intermittently.
4443
4444.vitem &%-q[q]i...%&
4445.oindex "&%-qi%&"
4446.cindex "queue" "initial delivery"
4447If the &'i'& flag is present, the queue runner runs delivery processes only for
4448those messages that haven't previously been tried. (&'i'& stands for &"initial
4449delivery"&.) This can be helpful if you are putting messages on the queue using
4450&%-odq%& and want a queue runner just to process the new messages.
4451
4452.vitem &%-q[q][i]f...%&
4453.oindex "&%-qf%&"
4454.cindex "queue" "forcing delivery"
4455.cindex "delivery" "forcing in queue run"
4456If one &'f'& flag is present, a delivery attempt is forced for each non-frozen
4457message, whereas without &'f'& only those non-frozen addresses that have passed
4458their retry times are tried.
4459
4460.vitem &%-q[q][i]ff...%&
4461.oindex "&%-qff%&"
4462.cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4463If &'ff'& is present, a delivery attempt is forced for every message, whether
4464frozen or not.
4465
4466.vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]]l%&
4467.oindex "&%-ql%&"
4468.cindex "queue" "local deliveries only"
4469The &'l'& (the letter &"ell"&) flag specifies that only local deliveries are to
4470be done. If a message requires any remote deliveries, it remains on the queue
4471for later delivery.
4472
4473.vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]][l][G<name>[/<time>]]]%&
4474.oindex "&%-qG%&"
4475.cindex queue named
4476.cindex "named queues"
4477.cindex "queue" "delivering specific messages"
4478If the &'G'& flag and a name is present, the queue runner operates on the
4479queue with the given name rather than the default queue.
4480The name should not contain a &'/'& character.
4481For a periodic queue run (see below)
4482append to the name a slash and a time value.
4483
4484If other commandline options specify an action, a &'-qG<name>'& option
4485will specify a queue to operate on.
4486For example:
4487.code
4488exim -bp -qGquarantine
4489mailq -qGquarantine
4490exim -qGoffpeak -Rf @special.domain.example
4491.endd
4492
4493.vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>&~<&'start&~id'&>&~<&'end&~id'&>
4494When scanning the queue, Exim can be made to skip over messages whose ids are
4495lexically less than a given value by following the &%-q%& option with a
4496starting message id. For example:
4497.code
4498exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4499.endd
4500Messages that arrived earlier than &`0t5C6f-0000c8-00`& are not inspected. If a
4501second message id is given, messages whose ids are lexically greater than it
4502are also skipped. If the same id is given twice, for example,
4503.code
4504exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4505.endd
4506just one delivery process is started, for that message. This differs from
4507&%-M%& in that retry data is respected, and it also differs from &%-Mc%& in
4508that it counts as a delivery from a queue run. Note that the selection
4509mechanism does not affect the order in which the messages are scanned. There
4510are also other ways of selecting specific sets of messages for delivery in a
4511queue run &-- see &%-R%& and &%-S%&.
4512
4513.vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&><&'time'&>
4514.cindex "queue runner" "starting periodically"
4515.cindex "periodic queue running"
4516When a time value is present, the &%-q%& option causes Exim to run as a daemon,
4517starting a queue runner process at intervals specified by the given time value
4518(whose format is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&). This form of the
4519&%-q%& option is commonly combined with the &%-bd%& option, in which case a
4520single daemon process handles both functions. A common way of starting up a
4521combined daemon at system boot time is to use a command such as
4522.code
4523/usr/exim/bin/exim -bd -q30m
4524.endd
4525Such a daemon listens for incoming SMTP calls, and also starts a queue runner
4526process every 30 minutes.
4527
4528When a daemon is started by &%-q%& with a time value, but without &%-bd%&, no
4529pid file is written unless one is explicitly requested by the &%-oP%& option.
4530
4531.vitem &%-qR%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4532.oindex "&%-qR%&"
4533This option is synonymous with &%-R%&. It is provided for Sendmail
4534compatibility.
4535
4536.vitem &%-qS%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4537.oindex "&%-qS%&"
4538This option is synonymous with &%-S%&.
4539
4540.vitem &%-R%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4541.oindex "&%-R%&"
4542.cindex "queue runner" "for specific recipients"
4543.cindex "delivery" "to given domain"
4544.cindex "domain" "delivery to"
4545The <&'rsflags'&> may be empty, in which case the white space before the string
4546is optional, unless the string is &'f'&, &'ff'&, &'r'&, &'rf'&, or &'rff'&,
4547which are the possible values for <&'rsflags'&>. White space is required if
4548<&'rsflags'&> is not empty.
4549
4550This option is similar to &%-q%& with no time value, that is, it causes Exim to
4551perform a single queue run, except that, when scanning the messages on the
4552queue, Exim processes only those that have at least one undelivered recipient
4553address containing the given string, which is checked in a case-independent
4554way. If the <&'rsflags'&> start with &'r'&, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a
4555regular expression; otherwise it is a literal string.
4556
4557If you want to do periodic queue runs for messages with specific recipients,
4558you can combine &%-R%& with &%-q%& and a time value. For example:
4559.code
4560exim -q25m -R @special.domain.example
4561.endd
4562This example does a queue run for messages with recipients in the given domain
4563every 25 minutes. Any additional flags that are specified with &%-q%& are
4564applied to each queue run.
4565
4566Once a message is selected for delivery by this mechanism, all its addresses
4567are processed. For the first selected message, Exim overrides any retry
4568information and forces a delivery attempt for each undelivered address. This
4569means that if delivery of any address in the first message is successful, any
4570existing retry information is deleted, and so delivery attempts for that
4571address in subsequently selected messages (which are processed without forcing)
4572will run. However, if delivery of any address does not succeed, the retry
4573information is updated, and in subsequently selected messages, the failing
4574address will be skipped.
4575
4576.cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4577If the <&'rsflags'&> contain &'f'& or &'ff'&, the delivery forcing applies to
4578all selected messages, not just the first; frozen messages are included when
4579&'ff'& is present.
4580
4581The &%-R%& option makes it straightforward to initiate delivery of all messages
4582to a given domain after a host has been down for some time. When the SMTP
4583command ETRN is accepted by its ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), its default
4584effect is to run Exim with the &%-R%& option, but it can be configured to run
4585an arbitrary command instead.
4586
4587.vitem &%-r%&
4588.oindex "&%-r%&"
4589This is a documented (for Sendmail) obsolete alternative name for &%-f%&.
4590
4591.vitem &%-S%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4592.oindex "&%-S%&"
4593.cindex "delivery" "from given sender"
4594.cindex "queue runner" "for specific senders"
4595This option acts like &%-R%& except that it checks the string against each
4596message's sender instead of against the recipients. If &%-R%& is also set, both
4597conditions must be met for a message to be selected. If either of the options
4598has &'f'& or &'ff'& in its flags, the associated action is taken.
4599
4600.vitem &%-Tqt%&&~<&'times'&>
4601.oindex "&%-Tqt%&"
4602This is an option that is exclusively for use by the Exim testing suite. It is not
4603recognized when Exim is run normally. It allows for the setting up of explicit
4604&"queue times"& so that various warning/retry features can be tested.
4605
4606.vitem &%-t%&
4607.oindex "&%-t%&"
4608.cindex "recipient" "extracting from header lines"
4609.cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
4610.cindex "&'Cc:'& header line"
4611.cindex "&'To:'& header line"
4612When Exim is receiving a locally-generated, non-SMTP message on its standard
4613input, the &%-t%& option causes the recipients of the message to be obtained
4614from the &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'& header lines in the message instead of
4615from the command arguments. The addresses are extracted before any rewriting
4616takes place and the &'Bcc:'& header line, if present, is then removed.
4617
4618.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
4619If the command has any arguments, they specify addresses to which the message
4620is &'not'& to be delivered. That is, the argument addresses are removed from
4621the recipients list obtained from the headers. This is compatible with Smail 3
4622and in accordance with the documented behaviour of several versions of
4623Sendmail, as described in man pages on a number of operating systems (e.g.
4624Solaris 8, IRIX 6.5, HP-UX 11). However, some versions of Sendmail &'add'&
4625argument addresses to those obtained from the headers, and the O'Reilly
4626Sendmail book documents it that way. Exim can be made to add argument addresses
4627instead of subtracting them by setting the option
4628&%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& false.
4629
4630.cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines" "with &%-t%&"
4631If there are any &%Resent-%& header lines in the message, Exim extracts
4632recipients from all &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&, and &'Resent-Bcc:'& header
4633lines instead of from &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'&. This is for compatibility
4634with Sendmail and other MTAs. (Prior to release 4.20, Exim gave an error if
4635&%-t%& was used in conjunction with &%Resent-%& header lines.)
4636
4637RFC 2822 talks about different sets of &%Resent-%& header lines (for when a
4638message is resent several times). The RFC also specifies that they should be
4639added at the front of the message, and separated by &'Received:'& lines. It is
4640not at all clear how &%-t%& should operate in the present of multiple sets,
4641nor indeed exactly what constitutes a &"set"&.
4642In practice, it seems that MUAs do not follow the RFC. The &%Resent-%& lines
4643are often added at the end of the header, and if a message is resent more than
4644once, it is common for the original set of &%Resent-%& headers to be renamed as
4645&%X-Resent-%& when a new set is added. This removes any possible ambiguity.
4646
4647.vitem &%-ti%&
4648.oindex "&%-ti%&"
4649This option is exactly equivalent to &%-t%& &%-i%&. It is provided for
4650compatibility with Sendmail.
4651
4652.vitem &%-tls-on-connect%&
4653.oindex "&%-tls-on-connect%&"
4654.cindex "TLS" "use without STARTTLS"
4655.cindex "TLS" "automatic start"
4656This option is available when Exim is compiled with TLS support. It forces all
4657incoming SMTP connections to behave as if the incoming port is listed in the
4658&%tls_on_connect_ports%& option. See section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>& and chapter
4659&<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
4660
4661
4662.vitem &%-U%&
4663.oindex "&%-U%&"
4664.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-U%& option ignored"
4665Sendmail uses this option for &"initial message submission"&, and its
4666documentation states that in future releases, it may complain about
4667syntactically invalid messages rather than fixing them when this flag is not
4668set. Exim ignores this option.
4669
4670.vitem &%-v%&
4671.oindex "&%-v%&"
4672This option causes Exim to write information to the standard error stream,
4673describing what it is doing. In particular, it shows the log lines for
4674receiving and delivering a message, and if an SMTP connection is made, the SMTP
4675dialogue is shown. Some of the log lines shown may not actually be written to
4676the log if the setting of &%log_selector%& discards them. Any relevant
4677selectors are shown with each log line. If none are shown, the logging is
4678unconditional.
4679
4680.vitem &%-x%&
4681.oindex "&%-x%&"
4682AIX uses &%-x%& for a private purpose (&"mail from a local mail program has
4683National Language Support extended characters in the body of the mail item"&).
4684It sets &%-x%& when calling the MTA from its &%mail%& command. Exim ignores
4685this option.
4686
4687.vitem &%-X%&&~<&'logfile'&>
4688.oindex "&%-X%&"
4689This option is interpreted by Sendmail to cause debug information to be sent
4690to the named file. It is ignored by Exim.
4691
4692.vitem &%-z%&&~<&'log-line'&>
4693.oindex "&%-z%&"
4694This option writes its argument to Exim's logfile.
4695Use is restricted to administrators; the intent is for operational notes.
4696Quotes should be used to maintain a multi-word item as a single argument,
4697under most shells.
4698.endlist
4699
4700.ecindex IIDclo1
4701.ecindex IIDclo2
4702
4703
4704. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4705. Insert a stylized DocBook comment here, to identify the end of the command
4706. line options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
4707. creates a man page for the options.
4708. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4709
4710.literal xml
4711<!-- === End of command line options === -->
4712.literal off
4713
4714
4715
4716
4717
4718. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4719. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4720
4721
4722.chapter "The Exim run time configuration file" "CHAPconf" &&&
4723 "The runtime configuration file"
4724
4725.cindex "run time configuration"
4726.cindex "configuration file" "general description"
4727.cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
4728.cindex "configuration file" "errors in"
4729.cindex "error" "in configuration file"
4730.cindex "return code" "for bad configuration"
4731Exim uses a single run time configuration file that is read whenever an Exim
4732binary is executed. Note that in normal operation, this happens frequently,
4733because Exim is designed to operate in a distributed manner, without central
4734control.
4735
4736If a syntax error is detected while reading the configuration file, Exim
4737writes a message on the standard error, and exits with a non-zero return code.
4738The message is also written to the panic log. &*Note*&: Only simple syntax
4739errors can be detected at this time. The values of any expanded options are
4740not checked until the expansion happens, even when the expansion does not
4741actually alter the string.
4742
4743The name of the configuration file is compiled into the binary for security
4744reasons, and is specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE compilation option. In
4745most configurations, this specifies a single file. However, it is permitted to
4746give a colon-separated list of file names, in which case Exim uses the first
4747existing file in the list.
4748
4749.cindex "EXIM_USER"
4750.cindex "EXIM_GROUP"
4751.cindex "CONFIGURE_OWNER"
4752.cindex "CONFIGURE_GROUP"
4753.cindex "configuration file" "ownership"
4754.cindex "ownership" "configuration file"
4755The run time configuration file must be owned by root or by the user that is
4756specified at compile time by the CONFIGURE_OWNER option (if set). The
4757configuration file must not be world-writeable, or group-writeable unless its
4758group is the root group or the one specified at compile time by the
4759CONFIGURE_GROUP option.
4760
4761&*Warning*&: In a conventional configuration, where the Exim binary is setuid
4762to root, anybody who is able to edit the run time configuration file has an
4763easy way to run commands as root. If you specify a user or group in the
4764CONFIGURE_OWNER or CONFIGURE_GROUP options, then that user and/or any users
4765who are members of that group will trivially be able to obtain root privileges.
4766
4767Up to Exim version 4.72, the run time configuration file was also permitted to
4768be writeable by the Exim user and/or group. That has been changed in Exim 4.73
4769since it offered a simple privilege escalation for any attacker who managed to
4770compromise the Exim user account.
4771
4772A default configuration file, which will work correctly in simple situations,
4773is provided in the file &_src/configure.default_&. If CONFIGURE_FILE
4774defines just one file name, the installation process copies the default
4775configuration to a new file of that name if it did not previously exist. If
4776CONFIGURE_FILE is a list, no default is automatically installed. Chapter
4777&<<CHAPdefconfil>>& is a &"walk-through"& discussion of the default
4778configuration.
4779
4780
4781
4782.section "Using a different configuration file" "SECID40"
4783.cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
4784A one-off alternate configuration can be specified by the &%-C%& command line
4785option, which may specify a single file or a list of files. However, when
4786&%-C%& is used, Exim gives up its root privilege, unless called by root (or
4787unless the argument for &%-C%& is identical to the built-in value from
4788CONFIGURE_FILE), or is listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file and the caller
4789is the Exim user or the user specified in the CONFIGURE_OWNER setting. &%-C%&
4790is useful mainly for checking the syntax of configuration files before
4791installing them. No owner or group checks are done on a configuration file
4792specified by &%-C%&, if root privilege has been dropped.
4793
4794Even the Exim user is not trusted to specify an arbitrary configuration file
4795with the &%-C%& option to be used with root privileges, unless that file is
4796listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file. This locks out the possibility of
4797testing a configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and
4798delivery, even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time,
4799Exim is running as the Exim user, so when it re-execs to regain privilege for
4800the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root
4801can test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a
4802message on the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using
4803&%-M%&).
4804
4805If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
4806prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option must
4807start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence &"&`/../`&"&.
4808There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is unset, any file
4809name can be used with &%-C%&.
4810
4811One-off changes to a configuration can be specified by the &%-D%& command line
4812option, which defines and overrides values for macros used inside the
4813configuration file. However, like &%-C%&, the use of this option by a
4814non-privileged user causes Exim to discard its root privilege.
4815If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
4816completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
4817
4818The WHITELIST_D_MACROS option in &_Local/Makefile_& permits the binary builder
4819to declare certain macro names trusted, such that root privilege will not
4820necessarily be discarded.
4821WHITELIST_D_MACROS defines a colon-separated list of macros which are
4822considered safe and, if &%-D%& only supplies macros from this list, and the
4823values are acceptable, then Exim will not give up root privilege if the caller
4824is root, the Exim run-time user, or the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a
4825transition mechanism and is expected to be removed in the future. Acceptable
4826values for the macros satisfy the regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
4827
4828Some sites may wish to use the same Exim binary on different machines that
4829share a file system, but to use different configuration files on each machine.
4830If CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_NODE is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim first
4831looks for a file whose name is the configuration file name followed by a dot
4832and the machine's node name, as obtained from the &[uname()]& function. If this
4833file does not exist, the standard name is tried. This processing occurs for
4834each file name in the list given by CONFIGURE_FILE or &%-C%&.
4835
4836In some esoteric situations different versions of Exim may be run under
4837different effective uids and the CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_EUID is defined to
4838help with this. See the comments in &_src/EDITME_& for details.
4839
4840
4841
4842.section "Configuration file format" "SECTconffilfor"
4843.cindex "configuration file" "format of"
4844.cindex "format" "configuration file"
4845Exim's configuration file is divided into a number of different parts. General
4846option settings must always appear at the start of the file. The other parts
4847are all optional, and may appear in any order. Each part other than the first
4848is introduced by the word &"begin"& followed by at least one literal
4849space, and the name of the part. The optional parts are:
4850
4851.ilist
4852&'ACL'&: Access control lists for controlling incoming SMTP mail (see chapter
4853&<<CHAPACL>>&).
4854.next
4855.cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
4856&'authenticators'&: Configuration settings for the authenticator drivers. These
4857are concerned with the SMTP AUTH command (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&).
4858.next
4859&'routers'&: Configuration settings for the router drivers. Routers process
4860addresses and determine how the message is to be delivered (see chapters
4861&<<CHAProutergeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPredirect>>&).
4862.next
4863&'transports'&: Configuration settings for the transport drivers. Transports
4864define mechanisms for copying messages to destinations (see chapters
4865&<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPsmtptrans>>&).
4866.next
4867&'retry'&: Retry rules, for use when a message cannot be delivered immediately.
4868If there is no retry section, or if it is empty (that is, no retry rules are
4869defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. In this situation, temporary errors
4870are treated the same as permanent errors. Retry rules are discussed in chapter
4871&<<CHAPretry>>&.
4872.next
4873&'rewrite'&: Global address rewriting rules, for use when a message arrives and
4874when new addresses are generated during delivery. Rewriting is discussed in
4875chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&.
4876.next
4877&'local_scan'&: Private options for the &[local_scan()]& function. If you
4878want to use this feature, you must set
4879.code
4880LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
4881.endd
4882in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. Details of the &[local_scan()]&
4883facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&.
4884.endlist
4885
4886.cindex "configuration file" "leading white space in"
4887.cindex "configuration file" "trailing white space in"
4888.cindex "white space" "in configuration file"
4889Leading and trailing white space in configuration lines is always ignored.
4890
4891Blank lines in the file, and lines starting with a # character (ignoring
4892leading white space) are treated as comments and are ignored. &*Note*&: A
4893# character other than at the beginning of a line is not treated specially,
4894and does not introduce a comment.
4895
4896Any non-comment line can be continued by ending it with a backslash. Note that
4897the general rule for white space means that trailing white space after the
4898backslash and leading white space at the start of continuation
4899lines is ignored. Comment lines beginning with # (but not empty lines) may
4900appear in the middle of a sequence of continuation lines.
4901
4902A convenient way to create a configuration file is to start from the
4903default, which is supplied in &_src/configure.default_&, and add, delete, or
4904change settings as required.
4905
4906The ACLs, retry rules, and rewriting rules have their own syntax which is
4907described in chapters &<<CHAPACL>>&, &<<CHAPretry>>&, and &<<CHAPrewrite>>&,
4908respectively. The other parts of the configuration file have some syntactic
4909items in common, and these are described below, from section &<<SECTcos>>&
4910onwards. Before that, the inclusion, macro, and conditional facilities are
4911described.
4912
4913
4914
4915.section "File inclusions in the configuration file" "SECID41"
4916.cindex "inclusions in configuration file"
4917.cindex "configuration file" "including other files"
4918.cindex "&`.include`& in configuration file"
4919.cindex "&`.include_if_exists`& in configuration file"
4920You can include other files inside Exim's run time configuration file by
4921using this syntax:
4922.display
4923&`.include`& <&'file name'&>
4924&`.include_if_exists`& <&'file name'&>
4925.endd
4926on a line by itself. Double quotes round the file name are optional. If you use
4927the first form, a configuration error occurs if the file does not exist; the
4928second form does nothing for non-existent files.
4929The first form allows a relative name. It is resolved relative to
4930the directory of the including file. For the second form an absolute file
4931name is required.
4932
4933Includes may be nested to any depth, but remember that Exim reads its
4934configuration file often, so it is a good idea to keep them to a minimum.
4935If you change the contents of an included file, you must HUP the daemon,
4936because an included file is read only when the configuration itself is read.
4937
4938The processing of inclusions happens early, at a physical line level, so, like
4939comment lines, an inclusion can be used in the middle of an option setting,
4940for example:
4941.code
4942hosts_lookup = a.b.c \
4943 .include /some/file
4944.endd
4945Include processing happens after macro processing (see below). Its effect is to
4946process the lines of the included file as if they occurred inline where the
4947inclusion appears.
4948
4949
4950
4951.section "Macros in the configuration file" "SECTmacrodefs"
4952.cindex "macro" "description of"
4953.cindex "configuration file" "macros"
4954If a line in the main part of the configuration (that is, before the first
4955&"begin"& line) begins with an upper case letter, it is taken as a macro
4956definition, and must be of the form
4957.display
4958<&'name'&> = <&'rest of line'&>
4959.endd
4960The name must consist of letters, digits, and underscores, and need not all be
4961in upper case, though that is recommended. The rest of the line, including any
4962continuations, is the replacement text, and has leading and trailing white
4963space removed. Quotes are not removed. The replacement text can never end with
4964a backslash character, but this doesn't seem to be a serious limitation.
4965
4966Macros may also be defined between router, transport, authenticator, or ACL
4967definitions. They may not, however, be defined within an individual driver or
4968ACL, or in the &%local_scan%&, retry, or rewrite sections of the configuration.
4969
4970.section "Macro substitution" "SECID42"
4971Once a macro is defined, all subsequent lines in the file (and any included
4972files) are scanned for the macro name; if there are several macros, the line is
4973scanned for each in turn, in the order in which the macros are defined. The
4974replacement text is not re-scanned for the current macro, though it is scanned
4975for subsequently defined macros. For this reason, a macro name may not contain
4976the name of a previously defined macro as a substring. You could, for example,
4977define
4978.display
4979&`ABCD_XYZ = `&<&'something'&>
4980&`ABCD = `&<&'something else'&>
4981.endd
4982but putting the definitions in the opposite order would provoke a configuration
4983error. Macro expansion is applied to individual physical lines from the file,
4984before checking for line continuation or file inclusion (see above). If a line
4985consists solely of a macro name, and the expansion of the macro is empty, the
4986line is ignored. A macro at the start of a line may turn the line into a
4987comment line or a &`.include`& line.
4988
4989
4990.section "Redefining macros" "SECID43"
4991Once defined, the value of a macro can be redefined later in the configuration
4992(or in an included file). Redefinition is specified by using &'=='& instead of
4993&'='&. For example:
4994.code
4995MAC = initial value
4996...
4997MAC == updated value
4998.endd
4999Redefinition does not alter the order in which the macros are applied to the
5000subsequent lines of the configuration file. It is still the same order in which
5001the macros were originally defined. All that changes is the macro's value.
5002Redefinition makes it possible to accumulate values. For example:
5003.code
5004MAC = initial value
5005...
5006MAC == MAC and something added
5007.endd
5008This can be helpful in situations where the configuration file is built
5009from a number of other files.
5010
5011.section "Overriding macro values" "SECID44"
5012The values set for macros in the configuration file can be overridden by the
5013&%-D%& command line option, but Exim gives up its root privilege when &%-D%& is
5014used, unless called by root or the Exim user. A definition on the command line
5015using the &%-D%& option causes all definitions and redefinitions within the
5016file to be ignored.
5017
5018
5019
5020.section "Example of macro usage" "SECID45"
5021As an example of macro usage, consider a configuration where aliases are looked
5022up in a MySQL database. It helps to keep the file less cluttered if long
5023strings such as SQL statements are defined separately as macros, for example:
5024.code
5025ALIAS_QUERY = select mailbox from user where \
5026 login='${quote_mysql:$local_part}';
5027.endd
5028This can then be used in a &(redirect)& router setting like this:
5029.code
5030data = ${lookup mysql{ALIAS_QUERY}}
5031.endd
5032In earlier versions of Exim macros were sometimes used for domain, host, or
5033address lists. In Exim 4 these are handled better by named lists &-- see
5034section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
5035
5036
5037.section "Builtin macros" "SECTbuiltinmacros"
5038Exim defines some macros depending on facilities available, which may
5039differ due to build-time definitions and from one release to another.
5040All of these macros start with an underscore.
5041They can be used to conditionally include parts of a configuration
5042(see below).
5043
5044The following classes of macros are defined:
5045.display
5046&` _HAVE_* `& build-time defines
5047&` _DRIVER_ROUTER_* `& router drivers
5048&` _DRIVER_TRANSPORT_* `& transport drivers
5049&` _DRIVER_AUTHENTICATOR_* `& authenticator drivers
5050&` _OPT_MAIN_* `& main config options
5051&` _OPT_ROUTERS_* `& generic router options
5052&` _OPT_TRANSPORTS_* `& generic transport options
5053&` _OPT_AUTHENTICATORS_* `& generic authenticator options
5054&` _OPT_ROUTER_*_* `& private router options
5055&` _OPT_TRANSPORT_*_* `& private transport options
5056&` _OPT_AUTHENTICATOR_*_* `& private authenticator options
5057.endd
5058
5059Use an &"exim -bP macros"& command to get the list of macros.
5060
5061
5062.section "Conditional skips in the configuration file" "SECID46"
5063.cindex "configuration file" "conditional skips"
5064.cindex "&`.ifdef`&"
5065You can use the directives &`.ifdef`&, &`.ifndef`&, &`.elifdef`&,
5066&`.elifndef`&, &`.else`&, and &`.endif`& to dynamically include or exclude
5067portions of the configuration file. The processing happens whenever the file is
5068read (that is, when an Exim binary starts to run).
5069
5070The implementation is very simple. Instances of the first four directives must
5071be followed by text that includes the names of one or macros. The condition
5072that is tested is whether or not any macro substitution has taken place in the
5073line. Thus:
5074.code
5075.ifdef AAA
5076message_size_limit = 50M
5077.else
5078message_size_limit = 100M
5079.endif
5080.endd
5081sets a message size limit of 50M if the macro &`AAA`& is defined
5082(or &`A`& or &`AA`&), and 100M
5083otherwise. If there is more than one macro named on the line, the condition
5084is true if any of them are defined. That is, it is an &"or"& condition. To
5085obtain an &"and"& condition, you need to use nested &`.ifdef`&s.
5086
5087Although you can use a macro expansion to generate one of these directives,
5088it is not very useful, because the condition &"there was a macro substitution
5089in this line"& will always be true.
5090
5091Text following &`.else`& and &`.endif`& is ignored, and can be used as comment
5092to clarify complicated nestings.
5093
5094
5095
5096.section "Common option syntax" "SECTcos"
5097.cindex "common option syntax"
5098.cindex "syntax of common options"
5099.cindex "configuration file" "common option syntax"
5100For the main set of options, driver options, and &[local_scan()]& options,
5101each setting is on a line by itself, and starts with a name consisting of
5102lower-case letters and underscores. Many options require a data value, and in
5103these cases the name must be followed by an equals sign (with optional white
5104space) and then the value. For example:
5105.code
5106qualify_domain = mydomain.example.com
5107.endd
5108.cindex "hiding configuration option values"
5109.cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
5110.cindex "options" "hiding value of"
5111Some option settings may contain sensitive data, for example, passwords for
5112accessing databases. To stop non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& command
5113line option to read these values, you can precede the option settings with the
5114word &"hide"&. For example:
5115.code
5116hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/admin/secret-password
5117.endd
5118For non-admin users, such options are displayed like this:
5119.code
5120mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
5121.endd
5122If &"hide"& is used on a driver option, it hides the value of that option on
5123all instances of the same driver.
5124
5125The following sections describe the syntax used for the different data types
5126that are found in option settings.
5127
5128
5129.section "Boolean options" "SECID47"
5130.cindex "format" "boolean"
5131.cindex "boolean configuration values"
5132.oindex "&%no_%&&'xxx'&"
5133.oindex "&%not_%&&'xxx'&"
5134Options whose type is given as boolean are on/off switches. There are two
5135different ways of specifying such options: with and without a data value. If
5136the option name is specified on its own without data, the switch is turned on;
5137if it is preceded by &"no_"& or &"not_"& the switch is turned off. However,
5138boolean options may be followed by an equals sign and one of the words
5139&"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"&, or &"no"&, as an alternative syntax. For example,
5140the following two settings have exactly the same effect:
5141.code
5142queue_only
5143queue_only = true
5144.endd
5145The following two lines also have the same (opposite) effect:
5146.code
5147no_queue_only
5148queue_only = false
5149.endd
5150You can use whichever syntax you prefer.
5151
5152
5153
5154
5155.section "Integer values" "SECID48"
5156.cindex "integer configuration values"
5157.cindex "format" "integer"
5158If an option's type is given as &"integer"&, the value can be given in decimal,
5159hexadecimal, or octal. If it starts with a digit greater than zero, a decimal
5160number is assumed. Otherwise, it is treated as an octal number unless it starts
5161with the characters &"0x"&, in which case the remainder is interpreted as a
5162hexadecimal number.
5163
5164If an integer value is followed by the letter K, it is multiplied by 1024; if
5165it is followed by the letter M, it is multiplied by 1024x1024;
5166if by the letter G, 1024x1024x1024.
5167When the values
5168of integer option settings are output, values which are an exact multiple of
51691024 or 1024x1024 are sometimes, but not always, printed using the letters K
5170and M. The printing style is independent of the actual input format that was
5171used.
5172
5173
5174.section "Octal integer values" "SECID49"
5175.cindex "integer format"
5176.cindex "format" "octal integer"
5177If an option's type is given as &"octal integer"&, its value is always
5178interpreted as an octal number, whether or not it starts with the digit zero.
5179Such options are always output in octal.
5180
5181
5182.section "Fixed point numbers" "SECID50"
5183.cindex "fixed point configuration values"
5184.cindex "format" "fixed point"
5185If an option's type is given as &"fixed-point"&, its value must be a decimal
5186integer, optionally followed by a decimal point and up to three further digits.
5187
5188
5189
5190.section "Time intervals" "SECTtimeformat"
5191.cindex "time interval" "specifying in configuration"
5192.cindex "format" "time interval"
5193A time interval is specified as a sequence of numbers, each followed by one of
5194the following letters, with no intervening white space:
5195
5196.table2 30pt
5197.irow &%s%& seconds
5198.irow &%m%& minutes
5199.irow &%h%& hours
5200.irow &%d%& days
5201.irow &%w%& weeks
5202.endtable
5203
5204For example, &"3h50m"& specifies 3 hours and 50 minutes. The values of time
5205intervals are output in the same format. Exim does not restrict the values; it
5206is perfectly acceptable, for example, to specify &"90m"& instead of &"1h30m"&.
5207
5208
5209
5210.section "String values" "SECTstrings"
5211.cindex "string" "format of configuration values"
5212.cindex "format" "string"
5213If an option's type is specified as &"string"&, the value can be specified with
5214or without double-quotes. If it does not start with a double-quote, the value
5215consists of the remainder of the line plus any continuation lines, starting at
5216the first character after any leading white space, with trailing white space
5217removed, and with no interpretation of the characters in the string. Because
5218Exim removes comment lines (those beginning with #) at an early stage, they can
5219appear in the middle of a multi-line string. The following two settings are
5220therefore equivalent:
5221.code
5222trusted_users = uucp:mail
5223trusted_users = uucp:\
5224 # This comment line is ignored
5225 mail
5226.endd
5227.cindex "string" "quoted"
5228.cindex "escape characters in quoted strings"
5229If a string does start with a double-quote, it must end with a closing
5230double-quote, and any backslash characters other than those used for line
5231continuation are interpreted as escape characters, as follows:
5232
5233.table2 100pt
5234.irow &`\\`& "single backslash"
5235.irow &`\n`& "newline"
5236.irow &`\r`& "carriage return"
5237.irow &`\t`& "tab"
5238.irow "&`\`&<&'octal digits'&>" "up to 3 octal digits specify one character"
5239.irow "&`\x`&<&'hex digits'&>" "up to 2 hexadecimal digits specify one &&&
5240 character"
5241.endtable
5242
5243If a backslash is followed by some other character, including a double-quote
5244character, that character replaces the pair.
5245
5246Quoting is necessary only if you want to make use of the backslash escapes to
5247insert special characters, or if you need to specify a value with leading or
5248trailing spaces. These cases are rare, so quoting is almost never needed in
5249current versions of Exim. In versions of Exim before 3.14, quoting was required
5250in order to continue lines, so you may come across older configuration files
5251and examples that apparently quote unnecessarily.
5252
5253
5254.section "Expanded strings" "SECID51"
5255.cindex "expansion" "definition of"
5256Some strings in the configuration file are subjected to &'string expansion'&,
5257by which means various parts of the string may be changed according to the
5258circumstances (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). The input syntax for such strings
5259is as just described; in particular, the handling of backslashes in quoted
5260strings is done as part of the input process, before expansion takes place.
5261However, backslash is also an escape character for the expander, so any
5262backslashes that are required for that reason must be doubled if they are
5263within a quoted configuration string.
5264
5265
5266.section "User and group names" "SECID52"
5267.cindex "user name" "format of"
5268.cindex "format" "user name"
5269.cindex "groups" "name format"
5270.cindex "format" "group name"
5271User and group names are specified as strings, using the syntax described
5272above, but the strings are interpreted specially. A user or group name must
5273either consist entirely of digits, or be a name that can be looked up using the
5274&[getpwnam()]& or &[getgrnam()]& function, as appropriate.
5275
5276
5277.section "List construction" "SECTlistconstruct"
5278.cindex "list" "syntax of in configuration"
5279.cindex "format" "list item in configuration"
5280.cindex "string" "list, definition of"
5281The data for some configuration options is a list of items, with colon as the
5282default separator. Many of these options are shown with type &"string list"& in
5283the descriptions later in this document. Others are listed as &"domain list"&,
5284&"host list"&, &"address list"&, or &"local part list"&. Syntactically, they
5285are all the same; however, those other than &"string list"& are subject to
5286particular kinds of interpretation, as described in chapter
5287&<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
5288
5289In all these cases, the entire list is treated as a single string as far as the
5290input syntax is concerned. The &%trusted_users%& setting in section
5291&<<SECTstrings>>& above is an example. If a colon is actually needed in an item
5292in a list, it must be entered as two colons. Leading and trailing white space
5293on each item in a list is ignored. This makes it possible to include items that
5294start with a colon, and in particular, certain forms of IPv6 address. For
5295example, the list
5296.code
5297local_interfaces = 127.0.0.1 : ::::1
5298.endd
5299contains two IP addresses, the IPv4 address 127.0.0.1 and the IPv6 address ::1.
5300
5301&*Note*&: Although leading and trailing white space is ignored in individual
5302list items, it is not ignored when parsing the list. The space after the first
5303colon in the example above is necessary. If it were not there, the list would
5304be interpreted as the two items 127.0.0.1:: and 1.
5305
5306.section "Changing list separators" "SECTlistsepchange"
5307.cindex "list separator" "changing"
5308.cindex "IPv6" "addresses in lists"
5309Doubling colons in IPv6 addresses is an unwelcome chore, so a mechanism was
5310introduced to allow the separator character to be changed. If a list begins
5311with a left angle bracket, followed by any punctuation character, that
5312character is used instead of colon as the list separator. For example, the list
5313above can be rewritten to use a semicolon separator like this:
5314.code
5315local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1
5316.endd
5317This facility applies to all lists, with the exception of the list in
5318&%log_file_path%&. It is recommended that the use of non-colon separators be
5319confined to circumstances where they really are needed.
5320
5321.cindex "list separator" "newline as"
5322.cindex "newline" "as list separator"
5323It is also possible to use newline and other control characters (those with
5324code values less than 32, plus DEL) as separators in lists. Such separators
5325must be provided literally at the time the list is processed. For options that
5326are string-expanded, you can write the separator using a normal escape
5327sequence. This will be processed by the expander before the string is
5328interpreted as a list. For example, if a newline-separated list of domains is
5329generated by a lookup, you can process it directly by a line such as this:
5330.code
5331domains = <\n ${lookup mysql{.....}}
5332.endd
5333This avoids having to change the list separator in such data. You are unlikely
5334to want to use a control character as a separator in an option that is not
5335expanded, because the value is literal text. However, it can be done by giving
5336the value in quotes. For example:
5337.code
5338local_interfaces = "<\n 127.0.0.1 \n ::1"
5339.endd
5340Unlike printing character separators, which can be included in list items by
5341doubling, it is not possible to include a control character as data when it is
5342set as the separator. Two such characters in succession are interpreted as
5343enclosing an empty list item.
5344
5345
5346
5347.section "Empty items in lists" "SECTempitelis"
5348.cindex "list" "empty item in"
5349An empty item at the end of a list is always ignored. In other words, trailing
5350separator characters are ignored. Thus, the list in
5351.code
5352senders = user@domain :
5353.endd
5354contains only a single item. If you want to include an empty string as one item
5355in a list, it must not be the last item. For example, this list contains three
5356items, the second of which is empty:
5357.code
5358senders = user1@domain : : user2@domain
5359.endd
5360&*Note*&: There must be white space between the two colons, as otherwise they
5361are interpreted as representing a single colon data character (and the list
5362would then contain just one item). If you want to specify a list that contains
5363just one, empty item, you can do it as in this example:
5364.code
5365senders = :
5366.endd
5367In this case, the first item is empty, and the second is discarded because it
5368is at the end of the list.
5369
5370
5371
5372
5373.section "Format of driver configurations" "SECTfordricon"
5374.cindex "drivers" "configuration format"
5375There are separate parts in the configuration for defining routers, transports,
5376and authenticators. In each part, you are defining a number of driver
5377instances, each with its own set of options. Each driver instance is defined by
5378a sequence of lines like this:
5379.display
5380<&'instance name'&>:
5381 <&'option'&>
5382 ...
5383 <&'option'&>
5384.endd
5385In the following example, the instance name is &(localuser)&, and it is
5386followed by three options settings:
5387.code
5388localuser:
5389 driver = accept
5390 check_local_user
5391 transport = local_delivery
5392.endd
5393For each driver instance, you specify which Exim code module it uses &-- by the
5394setting of the &%driver%& option &-- and (optionally) some configuration
5395settings. For example, in the case of transports, if you want a transport to
5396deliver with SMTP you would use the &(smtp)& driver; if you want to deliver to
5397a local file you would use the &(appendfile)& driver. Each of the drivers is
5398described in detail in its own separate chapter later in this manual.
5399
5400You can have several routers, transports, or authenticators that are based on
5401the same underlying driver (each must have a different instance name).
5402
5403The order in which routers are defined is important, because addresses are
5404passed to individual routers one by one, in order. The order in which
5405transports are defined does not matter at all. The order in which
5406authenticators are defined is used only when Exim, as a client, is searching
5407them to find one that matches an authentication mechanism offered by the
5408server.
5409
5410.cindex "generic options"
5411.cindex "options" "generic &-- definition of"
5412Within a driver instance definition, there are two kinds of option: &'generic'&
5413and &'private'&. The generic options are those that apply to all drivers of the
5414same type (that is, all routers, all transports or all authenticators). The
5415&%driver%& option is a generic option that must appear in every definition.
5416.cindex "private options"
5417The private options are special for each driver, and none need appear, because
5418they all have default values.
5419
5420The options may appear in any order, except that the &%driver%& option must
5421precede any private options, since these depend on the particular driver. For
5422this reason, it is recommended that &%driver%& always be the first option.
5423
5424Driver instance names, which are used for reference in log entries and
5425elsewhere, can be any sequence of letters, digits, and underscores (starting
5426with a letter) and must be unique among drivers of the same type. A router and
5427a transport (for example) can each have the same name, but no two router
5428instances can have the same name. The name of a driver instance should not be
5429confused with the name of the underlying driver module. For example, the
5430configuration lines:
5431.code
5432remote_smtp:
5433 driver = smtp
5434.endd
5435create an instance of the &(smtp)& transport driver whose name is
5436&(remote_smtp)&. The same driver code can be used more than once, with
5437different instance names and different option settings each time. A second
5438instance of the &(smtp)& transport, with different options, might be defined
5439thus:
5440.code
5441special_smtp:
5442 driver = smtp
5443 port = 1234
5444 command_timeout = 10s
5445.endd
5446The names &(remote_smtp)& and &(special_smtp)& would be used to reference
5447these transport instances from routers, and these names would appear in log
5448lines.
5449
5450Comment lines may be present in the middle of driver specifications. The full
5451list of option settings for any particular driver instance, including all the
5452defaulted values, can be extracted by making use of the &%-bP%& command line
5453option.
5454
5455
5456
5457
5458
5459
5460. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5461. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5462
5463.chapter "The default configuration file" "CHAPdefconfil"
5464.scindex IIDconfiwal "configuration file" "default &""walk through""&"
5465.cindex "default" "configuration file &""walk through""&"
5466The default configuration file supplied with Exim as &_src/configure.default_&
5467is sufficient for a host with simple mail requirements. As an introduction to
5468the way Exim is configured, this chapter &"walks through"& the default
5469configuration, giving brief explanations of the settings. Detailed descriptions
5470of the options are given in subsequent chapters. The default configuration file
5471itself contains extensive comments about ways you might want to modify the
5472initial settings. However, note that there are many options that are not
5473mentioned at all in the default configuration.
5474
5475
5476
5477.section "Main configuration settings" "SECTdefconfmain"
5478The main (global) configuration option settings must always come first in the
5479file. The first thing you'll see in the file, after some initial comments, is
5480the line
5481.code
5482# primary_hostname =
5483.endd
5484This is a commented-out setting of the &%primary_hostname%& option. Exim needs
5485to know the official, fully qualified name of your host, and this is where you
5486can specify it. However, in most cases you do not need to set this option. When
5487it is unset, Exim uses the &[uname()]& system function to obtain the host name.
5488
5489The first three non-comment configuration lines are as follows:
5490.code
5491domainlist local_domains = @
5492domainlist relay_to_domains =
5493hostlist relay_from_hosts = 127.0.0.1
5494.endd
5495These are not, in fact, option settings. They are definitions of two named
5496domain lists and one named host list. Exim allows you to give names to lists of
5497domains, hosts, and email addresses, in order to make it easier to manage the
5498configuration file (see section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&).
5499
5500The first line defines a domain list called &'local_domains'&; this is used
5501later in the configuration to identify domains that are to be delivered
5502on the local host.
5503
5504.cindex "@ in a domain list"
5505There is just one item in this list, the string &"@"&. This is a special form
5506of entry which means &"the name of the local host"&. Thus, if the local host is
5507called &'a.host.example'&, mail to &'any.user@a.host.example'& is expected to
5508be delivered locally. Because the local host's name is referenced indirectly,
5509the same configuration file can be used on different hosts.
5510
5511The second line defines a domain list called &'relay_to_domains'&, but the
5512list itself is empty. Later in the configuration we will come to the part that
5513controls mail relaying through the local host; it allows relaying to any
5514domains in this list. By default, therefore, no relaying on the basis of a mail
5515domain is permitted.
5516
5517The third line defines a host list called &'relay_from_hosts'&. This list is
5518used later in the configuration to permit relaying from any host or IP address
5519that matches the list. The default contains just the IP address of the IPv4
5520loopback interface, which means that processes on the local host are able to
5521submit mail for relaying by sending it over TCP/IP to that interface. No other
5522hosts are permitted to submit messages for relaying.
5523
5524Just to be sure there's no misunderstanding: at this point in the configuration
5525we aren't actually setting up any controls. We are just defining some domains
5526and hosts that will be used in the controls that are specified later.
5527
5528The next two configuration lines are genuine option settings:
5529.code
5530acl_smtp_rcpt = acl_check_rcpt
5531acl_smtp_data = acl_check_data
5532.endd
5533These options specify &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs) that are to be used
5534during an incoming SMTP session for every recipient of a message (every RCPT
5535command), and after the contents of the message have been received,
5536respectively. The names of the lists are &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5537&'acl_check_data'&, and we will come to their definitions below, in the ACL
5538section of the configuration. The RCPT ACL controls which recipients are
5539accepted for an incoming message &-- if a configuration does not provide an ACL
5540to check recipients, no SMTP mail can be accepted. The DATA ACL allows the
5541contents of a message to be checked.
5542
5543Two commented-out option settings are next:
5544.code
5545# av_scanner = clamd:/tmp/clamd
5546# spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 783
5547.endd
5548These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with the
5549content-scanning extension. The first specifies the interface to the virus
5550scanner, and the second specifies the interface to SpamAssassin. Further
5551details are given in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
5552
5553Three more commented-out option settings follow:
5554.code
5555# tls_advertise_hosts = *
5556# tls_certificate = /etc/ssl/exim.crt
5557# tls_privatekey = /etc/ssl/exim.pem
5558.endd
5559These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with
5560support for TLS (aka SSL) as described in section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&. The
5561first one specifies the list of clients that are allowed to use TLS when
5562connecting to this server; in this case the wildcard means all clients. The
5563other options specify where Exim should find its TLS certificate and private
5564key, which together prove the server's identity to any clients that connect.
5565More details are given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
5566
5567Another two commented-out option settings follow:
5568.code
5569# daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 465 : 587
5570# tls_on_connect_ports = 465
5571.endd
5572.cindex "port" "465 and 587"
5573.cindex "port" "for message submission"
5574.cindex "message" "submission, ports for"
5575.cindex "ssmtp protocol"
5576.cindex "smtps protocol"
5577.cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
5578.cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
5579These options provide better support for roaming users who wish to use this
5580server for message submission. They are not much use unless you have turned on
5581TLS (as described in the previous paragraph) and authentication (about which
5582more in section &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&). The usual SMTP port 25 is often blocked
5583on end-user networks, so RFC 4409 specifies that message submission should use
5584port 587 instead. However some software (notably Microsoft Outlook) cannot be
5585configured to use port 587 correctly, so these settings also enable the
5586non-standard &"smtps"& (aka &"ssmtp"&) port 465 (see section
5587&<<SECTsupobssmt>>&).
5588
5589Two more commented-out options settings follow:
5590.code
5591# qualify_domain =
5592# qualify_recipient =
5593.endd
5594The first of these specifies a domain that Exim uses when it constructs a
5595complete email address from a local login name. This is often needed when Exim
5596receives a message from a local process. If you do not set &%qualify_domain%&,
5597the value of &%primary_hostname%& is used. If you set both of these options,
5598you can have different qualification domains for sender and recipient
5599addresses. If you set only the first one, its value is used in both cases.
5600
5601.cindex "domain literal" "recognizing format"
5602The following line must be uncommented if you want Exim to recognize
5603addresses of the form &'user@[10.11.12.13]'& that is, with a &"domain literal"&
5604(an IP address within square brackets) instead of a named domain.
5605.code
5606# allow_domain_literals
5607.endd
5608The RFCs still require this form, but many people think that in the modern
5609Internet it makes little sense to permit mail to be sent to specific hosts by
5610quoting their IP addresses. This ancient format has been used by people who
5611try to abuse hosts by using them for unwanted relaying. However, some
5612people believe there are circumstances (for example, messages addressed to
5613&'postmaster'&) where domain literals are still useful.
5614
5615The next configuration line is a kind of trigger guard:
5616.code
5617never_users = root
5618.endd
5619It specifies that no delivery must ever be run as the root user. The normal
5620convention is to set up &'root'& as an alias for the system administrator. This
5621setting is a guard against slips in the configuration.
5622The list of users specified by &%never_users%& is not, however, the complete
5623list; the build-time configuration in &_Local/Makefile_& has an option called
5624FIXED_NEVER_USERS specifying a list that cannot be overridden. The
5625contents of &%never_users%& are added to this list. By default
5626FIXED_NEVER_USERS also specifies root.
5627
5628When a remote host connects to Exim in order to send mail, the only information
5629Exim has about the host's identity is its IP address. The next configuration
5630line,
5631.code
5632host_lookup = *
5633.endd
5634specifies that Exim should do a reverse DNS lookup on all incoming connections,
5635in order to get a host name. This improves the quality of the logging
5636information, but if you feel it is too expensive, you can remove it entirely,
5637or restrict the lookup to hosts on &"nearby"& networks.
5638Note that it is not always possible to find a host name from an IP address,
5639because not all DNS reverse zones are maintained, and sometimes DNS servers are
5640unreachable.
5641
5642The next two lines are concerned with &'ident'& callbacks, as defined by RFC
56431413 (hence their names):
5644.code
5645rfc1413_hosts = *
5646rfc1413_query_timeout = 0s
5647.endd
5648These settings cause Exim to avoid ident callbacks for all incoming SMTP calls.
5649Few hosts offer RFC1413 service these days; calls have to be
5650terminated by a timeout and this needlessly delays the startup
5651of an incoming SMTP connection.
5652If you have hosts for which you trust RFC1413 and need this
5653information, you can change this.
5654
5655This line enables an efficiency SMTP option. It is negotiated by clients
5656and not expected to cause problems but can be disabled if needed.
5657.code
5658prdr_enable = true
5659.endd
5660
5661When Exim receives messages over SMTP connections, it expects all addresses to
5662be fully qualified with a domain, as required by the SMTP definition. However,
5663if you are running a server to which simple clients submit messages, you may
5664find that they send unqualified addresses. The two commented-out options:
5665.code
5666# sender_unqualified_hosts =
5667# recipient_unqualified_hosts =
5668.endd
5669show how you can specify hosts that are permitted to send unqualified sender
5670and recipient addresses, respectively.
5671
5672The &%log_selector%& option is used to increase the detail of logging
5673over the default:
5674.code
5675log_selector = +smtp_protocol_error +smtp_syntax_error \
5676 +tls_certificate_verified
5677.endd
5678
5679The &%percent_hack_domains%& option is also commented out:
5680.code
5681# percent_hack_domains =
5682.endd
5683It provides a list of domains for which the &"percent hack"& is to operate.
5684This is an almost obsolete form of explicit email routing. If you do not know
5685anything about it, you can safely ignore this topic.
5686
5687The next two settings in the main part of the default configuration are
5688concerned with messages that have been &"frozen"& on Exim's queue. When a
5689message is frozen, Exim no longer continues to try to deliver it. Freezing
5690occurs when a bounce message encounters a permanent failure because the sender
5691address of the original message that caused the bounce is invalid, so the
5692bounce cannot be delivered. This is probably the most common case, but there
5693are also other conditions that cause freezing, and frozen messages are not
5694always bounce messages.
5695.code
5696ignore_bounce_errors_after = 2d
5697timeout_frozen_after = 7d
5698.endd
5699The first of these options specifies that failing bounce messages are to be
5700discarded after 2 days on the queue. The second specifies that any frozen
5701message (whether a bounce message or not) is to be timed out (and discarded)
5702after a week. In this configuration, the first setting ensures that no failing
5703bounce message ever lasts a week.
5704
5705Exim queues it's messages in a spool directory. If you expect to have
5706large queues, you may consider using this option. It splits the spool
5707directory into subdirectories to avoid file system degradation from
5708many files in a single directory, resulting in better performance.
5709Manual manipulation of queued messages becomes more complex (though fortunately
5710not often needed).
5711.code
5712# split_spool_directory = true
5713.endd
5714
5715In an ideal world everybody follows the standards. For non-ASCII
5716messages RFC 2047 is a standard, allowing a maximum line length of 76
5717characters. Exim adheres that standard and won't process messages which
5718violate this standard. (Even ${rfc2047:...} expansions will fail.)
5719In particular, the Exim maintainers have had multiple reports of
5720problems from Russian administrators of issues until they disable this
5721check, because of some popular, yet buggy, mail composition software.
5722.code
5723# check_rfc2047_length = false
5724.endd
5725
5726If you need to be strictly RFC compliant you may wish to disable the
57278BITMIME advertisement. Use this, if you exchange mails with systems
5728that are not 8-bit clean.
5729.code
5730# accept_8bitmime = false
5731.endd
5732
5733Libraries you use may depend on specific environment settings. This
5734imposes a security risk (e.g. PATH). There are two lists:
5735&%keep_environment%& for the variables to import as they are, and
5736&%add_environment%& for variables we want to set to a fixed value.
5737Note that TZ is handled separately, by the $%timezone%$ runtime
5738option and by the TIMEZONE_DEFAULT buildtime option.
5739.code
5740# keep_environment = ^LDAP
5741# add_environment = PATH=/usr/bin::/bin
5742.endd
5743
5744
5745.section "ACL configuration" "SECID54"
5746.cindex "default" "ACLs"
5747.cindex "&ACL;" "default configuration"
5748In the default configuration, the ACL section follows the main configuration.
5749It starts with the line
5750.code
5751begin acl
5752.endd
5753and it contains the definitions of two ACLs, called &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5754&'acl_check_data'&, that were referenced in the settings of &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
5755and &%acl_smtp_data%& above.
5756
5757.cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
5758The first ACL is used for every RCPT command in an incoming SMTP message. Each
5759RCPT command specifies one of the message's recipients. The ACL statements
5760are considered in order, until the recipient address is either accepted or
5761rejected. The RCPT command is then accepted or rejected, according to the
5762result of the ACL processing.
5763.code
5764acl_check_rcpt:
5765.endd
5766This line, consisting of a name terminated by a colon, marks the start of the
5767ACL, and names it.
5768.code
5769accept hosts = :
5770.endd
5771This ACL statement accepts the recipient if the sending host matches the list.
5772But what does that strange list mean? It doesn't actually contain any host
5773names or IP addresses. The presence of the colon puts an empty item in the
5774list; Exim matches this only if the incoming message did not come from a remote
5775host, because in that case, the remote hostname is empty. The colon is
5776important. Without it, the list itself is empty, and can never match anything.
5777
5778What this statement is doing is to accept unconditionally all recipients in
5779messages that are submitted by SMTP from local processes using the standard
5780input and output (that is, not using TCP/IP). A number of MUAs operate in this
5781manner.
5782.code
5783deny message = Restricted characters in address
5784 domains = +local_domains
5785 local_parts = ^[.] : ^.*[@%!/|]
5786
5787deny message = Restricted characters in address
5788 domains = !+local_domains
5789 local_parts = ^[./|] : ^.*[@%!] : ^.*/\\.\\./
5790.endd
5791These statements are concerned with local parts that contain any of the
5792characters &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&, &"|"&, or dots in unusual places.
5793Although these characters are entirely legal in local parts (in the case of
5794&"@"& and leading dots, only if correctly quoted), they do not commonly occur
5795in Internet mail addresses.
5796
5797The first three have in the past been associated with explicitly routed
5798addresses (percent is still sometimes used &-- see the &%percent_hack_domains%&
5799option). Addresses containing these characters are regularly tried by spammers
5800in an attempt to bypass relaying restrictions, and also by open relay testing
5801programs. Unless you really need them it is safest to reject these characters
5802at this early stage. This configuration is heavy-handed in rejecting these
5803characters for all messages it accepts from remote hosts. This is a deliberate
5804policy of being as safe as possible.
5805
5806The first rule above is stricter, and is applied to messages that are addressed
5807to one of the local domains handled by this host. This is implemented by the
5808first condition, which restricts it to domains that are listed in the
5809&'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5810reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5811&'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5812
5813The second condition on the first statement uses two regular expressions to
5814block local parts that begin with a dot or contain &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&,
5815or &"|"&. If you have local accounts that include these characters, you will
5816have to modify this rule.
5817
5818Empty components (two dots in a row) are not valid in RFC 2822, but Exim
5819allows them because they have been encountered in practice. (Consider the
5820common convention of local parts constructed as
5821&"&'first-initial.second-initial.family-name'&"& when applied to someone like
5822the author of Exim, who has no second initial.) However, a local part starting
5823with a dot or containing &"/../"& can cause trouble if it is used as part of a
5824file name (for example, for a mailing list). This is also true for local parts
5825that contain slashes. A pipe symbol can also be troublesome if the local part
5826is incorporated unthinkingly into a shell command line.
5827
5828The second rule above applies to all other domains, and is less strict. This
5829allows your own users to send outgoing messages to sites that use slashes
5830and vertical bars in their local parts. It blocks local parts that begin
5831with a dot, slash, or vertical bar, but allows these characters within the
5832local part. However, the sequence &"/../"& is barred. The use of &"@"&, &"%"&,
5833and &"!"& is blocked, as before. The motivation here is to prevent your users
5834(or your users' viruses) from mounting certain kinds of attack on remote sites.
5835.code
5836accept local_parts = postmaster
5837 domains = +local_domains
5838.endd
5839This statement, which has two conditions, accepts an incoming address if the
5840local part is &'postmaster'& and the domain is one of those listed in the
5841&'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5842reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5843&'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5844
5845The presence of this statement means that mail to postmaster is never blocked
5846by any of the subsequent tests. This can be helpful while sorting out problems
5847in cases where the subsequent tests are incorrectly denying access.
5848.code
5849require verify = sender
5850.endd
5851This statement requires the sender address to be verified before any subsequent
5852ACL statement can be used. If verification fails, the incoming recipient
5853address is refused. Verification consists of trying to route the address, to
5854see if a bounce message could be delivered to it. In the case of remote
5855addresses, basic verification checks only the domain, but &'callouts'& can be
5856used for more verification if required. Section &<<SECTaddressverification>>&
5857discusses the details of address verification.
5858.code
5859accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
5860 control = submission
5861.endd
5862This statement accepts the address if the message is coming from one of the
5863hosts that are defined as being allowed to relay through this host. Recipient
5864verification is omitted here, because in many cases the clients are dumb MUAs
5865that do not cope well with SMTP error responses. For the same reason, the
5866second line specifies &"submission mode"& for messages that are accepted. This
5867is described in detail in section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>&; it causes Exim to fix
5868messages that are deficient in some way, for example, because they lack a
5869&'Date:'& header line. If you are actually relaying out from MTAs, you should
5870probably add recipient verification here, and disable submission mode.
5871.code
5872accept authenticated = *
5873 control = submission
5874.endd
5875This statement accepts the address if the client host has authenticated itself.
5876Submission mode is again specified, on the grounds that such messages are most
5877likely to come from MUAs. The default configuration does not define any
5878authenticators, though it does include some nearly complete commented-out
5879examples described in &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&. This means that no client can in
5880fact authenticate until you complete the authenticator definitions.
5881.code
5882require message = relay not permitted
5883 domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
5884.endd
5885This statement rejects the address if its domain is neither a local domain nor
5886one of the domains for which this host is a relay.
5887.code
5888require verify = recipient
5889.endd
5890This statement requires the recipient address to be verified; if verification
5891fails, the address is rejected.
5892.code
5893# deny message = rejected because $sender_host_address \
5894# is in a black list at $dnslist_domain\n\
5895# $dnslist_text
5896# dnslists = black.list.example
5897#
5898# warn dnslists = black.list.example
5899# add_header = X-Warning: $sender_host_address is in \
5900# a black list at $dnslist_domain
5901# log_message = found in $dnslist_domain
5902.endd
5903These commented-out lines are examples of how you could configure Exim to check
5904sending hosts against a DNS black list. The first statement rejects messages
5905from blacklisted hosts, whereas the second just inserts a warning header
5906line.
5907.code
5908# require verify = csa
5909.endd
5910This commented-out line is an example of how you could turn on client SMTP
5911authorization (CSA) checking. Such checks do DNS lookups for special SRV
5912records.
5913.code
5914accept
5915.endd
5916The final statement in the first ACL unconditionally accepts any recipient
5917address that has successfully passed all the previous tests.
5918.code
5919acl_check_data:
5920.endd
5921This line marks the start of the second ACL, and names it. Most of the contents
5922of this ACL are commented out:
5923.code
5924# deny malware = *
5925# message = This message contains a virus \
5926# ($malware_name).
5927.endd
5928These lines are examples of how to arrange for messages to be scanned for
5929viruses when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension, and a
5930suitable virus scanner is installed. If the message is found to contain a
5931virus, it is rejected with the given custom error message.
5932.code
5933# warn spam = nobody
5934# message = X-Spam_score: $spam_score\n\
5935# X-Spam_score_int: $spam_score_int\n\
5936# X-Spam_bar: $spam_bar\n\
5937# X-Spam_report: $spam_report
5938.endd
5939These lines are an example of how to arrange for messages to be scanned by
5940SpamAssassin when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension,
5941and SpamAssassin has been installed. The SpamAssassin check is run with
5942&`nobody`& as its user parameter, and the results are added to the message as a
5943series of extra header line. In this case, the message is not rejected,
5944whatever the spam score.
5945.code
5946accept
5947.endd
5948This final line in the DATA ACL accepts the message unconditionally.
5949
5950
5951.section "Router configuration" "SECID55"
5952.cindex "default" "routers"
5953.cindex "routers" "default"
5954The router configuration comes next in the default configuration, introduced
5955by the line
5956.code
5957begin routers
5958.endd
5959Routers are the modules in Exim that make decisions about where to send
5960messages. An address is passed to each router in turn, until it is either
5961accepted, or failed. This means that the order in which you define the routers
5962matters. Each router is fully described in its own chapter later in this
5963manual. Here we give only brief overviews.
5964.code
5965# domain_literal:
5966# driver = ipliteral
5967# domains = !+local_domains
5968# transport = remote_smtp
5969.endd
5970.cindex "domain literal" "default router"
5971This router is commented out because the majority of sites do not want to
5972support domain literal addresses (those of the form &'user@[10.9.8.7]'&). If
5973you uncomment this router, you also need to uncomment the setting of
5974&%allow_domain_literals%& in the main part of the configuration.
5975.code
5976dnslookup:
5977 driver = dnslookup
5978 domains = ! +local_domains
5979 transport = remote_smtp
5980 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.0/8
5981 no_more
5982.endd
5983The first uncommented router handles addresses that do not involve any local
5984domains. This is specified by the line
5985.code
5986domains = ! +local_domains
5987.endd
5988The &%domains%& option lists the domains to which this router applies, but the
5989exclamation mark is a negation sign, so the router is used only for domains
5990that are not in the domain list called &'local_domains'& (which was defined at
5991the start of the configuration). The plus sign before &'local_domains'&
5992indicates that it is referring to a named list. Addresses in other domains are
5993passed on to the following routers.
5994
5995The name of the router driver is &(dnslookup)&,
5996and is specified by the &%driver%& option. Do not be confused by the fact that
5997the name of this router instance is the same as the name of the driver. The
5998instance name is arbitrary, but the name set in the &%driver%& option must be
5999one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
6000
6001The &(dnslookup)& router routes addresses by looking up their domains in the
6002DNS in order to obtain a list of hosts to which the address is routed. If the
6003router succeeds, the address is queued for the &(remote_smtp)& transport, as
6004specified by the &%transport%& option. If the router does not find the domain
6005in the DNS, no further routers are tried because of the &%no_more%& setting, so
6006the address fails and is bounced.
6007
6008The &%ignore_target_hosts%& option specifies a list of IP addresses that are to
6009be entirely ignored. This option is present because a number of cases have been
6010encountered where MX records in the DNS point to host names
6011whose IP addresses are 0.0.0.0 or are in the 127 subnet (typically 127.0.0.1).
6012Completely ignoring these IP addresses causes Exim to fail to route the
6013email address, so it bounces. Otherwise, Exim would log a routing problem, and
6014continue to try to deliver the message periodically until the address timed
6015out.
6016.code
6017system_aliases:
6018 driver = redirect
6019 allow_fail
6020 allow_defer
6021 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
6022# user = exim
6023 file_transport = address_file
6024 pipe_transport = address_pipe
6025.endd
6026Control reaches this and subsequent routers only for addresses in the local
6027domains. This router checks to see whether the local part is defined as an
6028alias in the &_/etc/aliases_& file, and if so, redirects it according to the
6029data that it looks up from that file. If no data is found for the local part,
6030the value of the &%data%& option is empty, causing the address to be passed to
6031the next router.
6032
6033&_/etc/aliases_& is a conventional name for the system aliases file that is
6034often used. That is why it is referenced by from the default configuration
6035file. However, you can change this by setting SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in
6036&_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim.
6037.code
6038userforward:
6039 driver = redirect
6040 check_local_user
6041# local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6042# local_part_suffix_optional
6043 file = $home/.forward
6044# allow_filter
6045 no_verify
6046 no_expn
6047 check_ancestor
6048 file_transport = address_file
6049 pipe_transport = address_pipe
6050 reply_transport = address_reply
6051.endd
6052This is the most complicated router in the default configuration. It is another
6053redirection router, but this time it is looking for forwarding data set up by
6054individual users. The &%check_local_user%& setting specifies a check that the
6055local part of the address is the login name of a local user. If it is not, the
6056router is skipped. The two commented options that follow &%check_local_user%&,
6057namely:
6058.code
6059# local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6060# local_part_suffix_optional
6061.endd
6062.vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
6063show how you can specify the recognition of local part suffixes. If the first
6064is uncommented, a suffix beginning with either a plus or a minus sign, followed
6065by any sequence of characters, is removed from the local part and placed in the
6066variable &$local_part_suffix$&. The second suffix option specifies that the
6067presence of a suffix in the local part is optional. When a suffix is present,
6068the check for a local login uses the local part with the suffix removed.
6069
6070When a local user account is found, the file called &_.forward_& in the user's
6071home directory is consulted. If it does not exist, or is empty, the router
6072declines. Otherwise, the contents of &_.forward_& are interpreted as
6073redirection data (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& for more details).
6074
6075.cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling in default router"
6076Traditional &_.forward_& files contain just a list of addresses, pipes, or
6077files. Exim supports this by default. However, if &%allow_filter%& is set (it
6078is commented out by default), the contents of the file are interpreted as a set
6079of Exim or Sieve filtering instructions, provided the file begins with &"#Exim
6080filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, respectively. User filtering is discussed in the
6081separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
6082
6083The &%no_verify%& and &%no_expn%& options mean that this router is skipped when
6084verifying addresses, or when running as a consequence of an SMTP EXPN command.
6085There are two reasons for doing this:
6086
6087.olist
6088Whether or not a local user has a &_.forward_& file is not really relevant when
6089checking an address for validity; it makes sense not to waste resources doing
6090unnecessary work.
6091.next
6092More importantly, when Exim is verifying addresses or handling an EXPN
6093command during an SMTP session, it is running as the Exim user, not as root.
6094The group is the Exim group, and no additional groups are set up.
6095It may therefore not be possible for Exim to read users' &_.forward_& files at
6096this time.
6097.endlist
6098
6099The setting of &%check_ancestor%& prevents the router from generating a new
6100address that is the same as any previous address that was redirected. (This
6101works round a problem concerning a bad interaction between aliasing and
6102forwarding &-- see section &<<SECTredlocmai>>&).
6103
6104The final three option settings specify the transports that are to be used when
6105forwarding generates a direct delivery to a file, or to a pipe, or sets up an
6106auto-reply, respectively. For example, if a &_.forward_& file contains
6107.code
6108a.nother@elsewhere.example, /home/spqr/archive
6109.endd
6110the delivery to &_/home/spqr/archive_& is done by running the &%address_file%&
6111transport.
6112.code
6113localuser:
6114 driver = accept
6115 check_local_user
6116# local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6117# local_part_suffix_optional
6118 transport = local_delivery
6119.endd
6120The final router sets up delivery into local mailboxes, provided that the local
6121part is the name of a local login, by accepting the address and assigning it to
6122the &(local_delivery)& transport. Otherwise, we have reached the end of the
6123routers, so the address is bounced. The commented suffix settings fulfil the
6124same purpose as they do for the &(userforward)& router.
6125
6126
6127.section "Transport configuration" "SECID56"
6128.cindex "default" "transports"
6129.cindex "transports" "default"
6130Transports define mechanisms for actually delivering messages. They operate
6131only when referenced from routers, so the order in which they are defined does
6132not matter. The transports section of the configuration starts with
6133.code
6134begin transports
6135.endd
6136One remote transport and four local transports are defined.
6137.code
6138remote_smtp:
6139 driver = smtp
6140 hosts_try_prdr = *
6141.endd
6142This transport is used for delivering messages over SMTP connections.
6143The list of remote hosts comes from the router.
6144The &%hosts_try_prdr%& option enables an efficiency SMTP option.
6145It is negotiated between client and server
6146and not expected to cause problems but can be disabled if needed.
6147All other options are defaulted.
6148.code
6149local_delivery:
6150 driver = appendfile
6151 file = /var/mail/$local_part
6152 delivery_date_add
6153 envelope_to_add
6154 return_path_add
6155# group = mail
6156# mode = 0660
6157.endd
6158This &(appendfile)& transport is used for local delivery to user mailboxes in
6159traditional BSD mailbox format. By default it runs under the uid and gid of the
6160local user, which requires the sticky bit to be set on the &_/var/mail_&
6161directory. Some systems use the alternative approach of running mail deliveries
6162under a particular group instead of using the sticky bit. The commented options
6163show how this can be done.
6164
6165Exim adds three headers to the message as it delivers it: &'Delivery-date:'&,
6166&'Envelope-to:'& and &'Return-path:'&. This action is requested by the three
6167similarly-named options above.
6168.code
6169address_pipe:
6170 driver = pipe
6171 return_output
6172.endd
6173This transport is used for handling deliveries to pipes that are generated by
6174redirection (aliasing or users' &_.forward_& files). The &%return_output%&
6175option specifies that any output on stdout or stderr generated by the pipe is to
6176be returned to the sender.
6177.code
6178address_file:
6179 driver = appendfile
6180 delivery_date_add
6181 envelope_to_add
6182 return_path_add
6183.endd
6184This transport is used for handling deliveries to files that are generated by
6185redirection. The name of the file is not specified in this instance of
6186&(appendfile)&, because it comes from the &(redirect)& router.
6187.code
6188address_reply:
6189 driver = autoreply
6190.endd
6191This transport is used for handling automatic replies generated by users'
6192filter files.
6193
6194
6195
6196.section "Default retry rule" "SECID57"
6197.cindex "retry" "default rule"
6198.cindex "default" "retry rule"
6199The retry section of the configuration file contains rules which affect the way
6200Exim retries deliveries that cannot be completed at the first attempt. It is
6201introduced by the line
6202.code
6203begin retry
6204.endd
6205In the default configuration, there is just one rule, which applies to all
6206errors:
6207.code
6208* * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
6209.endd
6210This causes any temporarily failing address to be retried every 15 minutes for
62112 hours, then at intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
62121.5 until 16 hours have passed, then every 6 hours up to 4 days. If an address
6213is not delivered after 4 days of temporary failure, it is bounced. The time is
6214measured from first failure, not from the time the message was received.
6215
6216If the retry section is removed from the configuration, or is empty (that is,
6217if no retry rules are defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. This turns
6218temporary errors into permanent errors.
6219
6220
6221.section "Rewriting configuration" "SECID58"
6222The rewriting section of the configuration, introduced by
6223.code
6224begin rewrite
6225.endd
6226contains rules for rewriting addresses in messages as they arrive. There are no
6227rewriting rules in the default configuration file.
6228
6229
6230
6231.section "Authenticators configuration" "SECTdefconfauth"
6232.cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
6233The authenticators section of the configuration, introduced by
6234.code
6235begin authenticators
6236.endd
6237defines mechanisms for the use of the SMTP AUTH command. The default
6238configuration file contains two commented-out example authenticators
6239which support plaintext username/password authentication using the
6240standard PLAIN mechanism and the traditional but non-standard LOGIN
6241mechanism, with Exim acting as the server. PLAIN and LOGIN are enough
6242to support most MUA software.
6243
6244The example PLAIN authenticator looks like this:
6245.code
6246#PLAIN:
6247# driver = plaintext
6248# server_set_id = $auth2
6249# server_prompts = :
6250# server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6251# server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6252.endd
6253And the example LOGIN authenticator looks like this:
6254.code
6255#LOGIN:
6256# driver = plaintext
6257# server_set_id = $auth1
6258# server_prompts = <| Username: | Password:
6259# server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6260# server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6261.endd
6262
6263The &%server_set_id%& option makes Exim remember the authenticated username
6264in &$authenticated_id$&, which can be used later in ACLs or routers. The
6265&%server_prompts%& option configures the &(plaintext)& authenticator so
6266that it implements the details of the specific authentication mechanism,
6267i.e. PLAIN or LOGIN. The &%server_advertise_condition%& setting controls
6268when Exim offers authentication to clients; in the examples, this is only
6269when TLS or SSL has been started, so to enable the authenticators you also
6270need to add support for TLS as described in section &<<SECTdefconfmain>>&.
6271
6272The &%server_condition%& setting defines how to verify that the username and
6273password are correct. In the examples it just produces an error message.
6274To make the authenticators work, you can use a string expansion
6275expression like one of the examples in chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>&.
6276
6277Beware that the sequence of the parameters to PLAIN and LOGIN differ; the
6278usercode and password are in different positions.
6279Chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& covers both.
6280
6281.ecindex IIDconfiwal
6282
6283
6284
6285. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6286. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6287
6288.chapter "Regular expressions" "CHAPregexp"
6289
6290.cindex "regular expressions" "library"
6291.cindex "PCRE"
6292Exim supports the use of regular expressions in many of its options. It
6293uses the PCRE regular expression library; this provides regular expression
6294matching that is compatible with Perl 5. The syntax and semantics of
6295regular expressions is discussed in
6296online Perl manpages, in
6297many Perl reference books, and also in
6298Jeffrey Friedl's &'Mastering Regular Expressions'&, which is published by
6299O'Reilly (see &url(http://www.oreilly.com/catalog/regex2/)).
6300
6301The documentation for the syntax and semantics of the regular expressions that
6302are supported by PCRE is included in the PCRE distribution, and no further
6303description is included here. The PCRE functions are called from Exim using
6304the default option settings (that is, with no PCRE options set), except that
6305the PCRE_CASELESS option is set when the matching is required to be
6306case-insensitive.
6307
6308In most cases, when a regular expression is required in an Exim configuration,
6309it has to start with a circumflex, in order to distinguish it from plain text
6310or an &"ends with"& wildcard. In this example of a configuration setting, the
6311second item in the colon-separated list is a regular expression.
6312.code
6313domains = a.b.c : ^\\d{3} : *.y.z : ...
6314.endd
6315The doubling of the backslash is required because of string expansion that
6316precedes interpretation &-- see section &<<SECTlittext>>& for more discussion
6317of this issue, and a way of avoiding the need for doubling backslashes. The
6318regular expression that is eventually used in this example contains just one
6319backslash. The circumflex is included in the regular expression, and has the
6320normal effect of &"anchoring"& it to the start of the string that is being
6321matched.
6322
6323There are, however, two cases where a circumflex is not required for the
6324recognition of a regular expression: these are the &%match%& condition in a
6325string expansion, and the &%matches%& condition in an Exim filter file. In
6326these cases, the relevant string is always treated as a regular expression; if
6327it does not start with a circumflex, the expression is not anchored, and can
6328match anywhere in the subject string.
6329
6330In all cases, if you want a regular expression to match at the end of a string,
6331you must code the $ metacharacter to indicate this. For example:
6332.code
6333domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example
6334.endd
6335matches the domain &'123.example'&, but it also matches &'123.example.com'&.
6336You need to use:
6337.code
6338domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example\$
6339.endd
6340if you want &'example'& to be the top-level domain. The backslash before the
6341$ is needed because string expansion also interprets dollar characters.
6342
6343
6344
6345. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6346. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6347
6348.chapter "File and database lookups" "CHAPfdlookup"
6349.scindex IIDfidalo1 "file" "lookups"
6350.scindex IIDfidalo2 "database" "lookups"
6351.cindex "lookup" "description of"
6352Exim can be configured to look up data in files or databases as it processes
6353messages. Two different kinds of syntax are used:
6354
6355.olist
6356A string that is to be expanded may contain explicit lookup requests. These
6357cause parts of the string to be replaced by data that is obtained from the
6358lookup. Lookups of this type are conditional expansion items. Different results
6359can be defined for the cases of lookup success and failure. See chapter
6360&<<CHAPexpand>>&, where string expansions are described in detail.
6361The key for the lookup is specified as part of the string expansion.
6362.next
6363Lists of domains, hosts, and email addresses can contain lookup requests as a
6364way of avoiding excessively long linear lists. In this case, the data that is
6365returned by the lookup is often (but not always) discarded; whether the lookup
6366succeeds or fails is what really counts. These kinds of list are described in
6367chapter &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
6368The key for the lookup is given by the context in which the list is expanded.
6369.endlist
6370
6371String expansions, lists, and lookups interact with each other in such a way
6372that there is no order in which to describe any one of them that does not
6373involve references to the others. Each of these three chapters makes more sense
6374if you have read the other two first. If you are reading this for the first
6375time, be aware that some of it will make a lot more sense after you have read
6376chapters &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>& and &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
6377
6378.section "Examples of different lookup syntax" "SECID60"
6379It is easy to confuse the two different kinds of lookup, especially as the
6380lists that may contain the second kind are always expanded before being
6381processed as lists. Therefore, they may also contain lookups of the first kind.
6382Be careful to distinguish between the following two examples:
6383.code
6384domains = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch{/some/file}}
6385domains = lsearch;/some/file
6386.endd
6387The first uses a string expansion, the result of which must be a domain list.
6388No strings have been specified for a successful or a failing lookup; the
6389defaults in this case are the looked-up data and an empty string, respectively.
6390The expansion takes place before the string is processed as a list, and the
6391file that is searched could contain lines like this:
6392.code
6393192.168.3.4: domain1:domain2:...
6394192.168.1.9: domain3:domain4:...
6395.endd
6396When the lookup succeeds, the result of the expansion is a list of domains (and
6397possibly other types of item that are allowed in domain lists).
6398
6399In the second example, the lookup is a single item in a domain list. It causes
6400Exim to use a lookup to see if the domain that is being processed can be found
6401in the file. The file could contains lines like this:
6402.code
6403domain1:
6404domain2:
6405.endd
6406Any data that follows the keys is not relevant when checking that the domain
6407matches the list item.
6408
6409It is possible, though no doubt confusing, to use both kinds of lookup at once.
6410Consider a file containing lines like this:
6411.code
6412192.168.5.6: lsearch;/another/file
6413.endd
6414If the value of &$sender_host_address$& is 192.168.5.6, expansion of the
6415first &%domains%& setting above generates the second setting, which therefore
6416causes a second lookup to occur.
6417
6418The rest of this chapter describes the different lookup types that are
6419available. Any of them can be used in any part of the configuration where a
6420lookup is permitted.
6421
6422
6423.section "Lookup types" "SECID61"
6424.cindex "lookup" "types of"
6425.cindex "single-key lookup" "definition of"
6426Two different types of data lookup are implemented:
6427
6428.ilist
6429The &'single-key'& type requires the specification of a file in which to look,
6430and a single key to search for. The key must be a non-empty string for the
6431lookup to succeed. The lookup type determines how the file is searched.
6432.next
6433.cindex "query-style lookup" "definition of"
6434The &'query-style'& type accepts a generalized database query. No particular
6435key value is assumed by Exim for query-style lookups. You can use whichever
6436Exim variables you need to construct the database query.
6437.endlist
6438
6439The code for each lookup type is in a separate source file that is included in
6440the binary of Exim only if the corresponding compile-time option is set. The
6441default settings in &_src/EDITME_& are:
6442.code
6443LOOKUP_DBM=yes
6444LOOKUP_LSEARCH=yes
6445.endd
6446which means that only linear searching and DBM lookups are included by default.
6447For some types of lookup (e.g. SQL databases), you need to install appropriate
6448libraries and header files before building Exim.
6449
6450
6451
6452
6453.section "Single-key lookup types" "SECTsinglekeylookups"
6454.cindex "lookup" "single-key types"
6455.cindex "single-key lookup" "list of types"
6456The following single-key lookup types are implemented:
6457
6458.ilist
6459.cindex "cdb" "description of"
6460.cindex "lookup" "cdb"
6461.cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6462&(cdb)&: The given file is searched as a Constant DataBase file, using the key
6463string without a terminating binary zero. The cdb format is designed for
6464indexed files that are read frequently and never updated, except by total
6465re-creation. As such, it is particularly suitable for large files containing
6466aliases or other indexed data referenced by an MTA. Information about cdb can
6467be found in several places:
6468.display
6469&url(http://www.pobox.com/~djb/cdb.html)
6470&url(ftp://ftp.corpit.ru/pub/tinycdb/)
6471&url(http://packages.debian.org/stable/utils/freecdb.html)
6472.endd
6473A cdb distribution is not needed in order to build Exim with cdb support,
6474because the code for reading cdb files is included directly in Exim itself.
6475However, no means of building or testing cdb files is provided with Exim, so
6476you need to obtain a cdb distribution in order to do this.
6477.next
6478.cindex "DBM" "lookup type"
6479.cindex "lookup" "dbm"
6480.cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6481&(dbm)&: Calls to DBM library functions are used to extract data from the given
6482DBM file by looking up the record with the given key. A terminating binary
6483zero is included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. See section
6484&<<SECTdb>>& for a discussion of DBM libraries.
6485
6486.cindex "Berkeley DB library" "file format"
6487For all versions of Berkeley DB, Exim uses the DB_HASH style of database
6488when building DBM files using the &%exim_dbmbuild%& utility. However, when
6489using Berkeley DB versions 3 or 4, it opens existing databases for reading with
6490the DB_UNKNOWN option. This enables it to handle any of the types of database
6491that the library supports, and can be useful for accessing DBM files created by
6492other applications. (For earlier DB versions, DB_HASH is always used.)
6493.next
6494.cindex "lookup" "dbmjz"
6495.cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- embedded NULs"
6496.cindex "sasldb2"
6497.cindex "dbmjz lookup type"
6498&(dbmjz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that the lookup key is
6499interpreted as an Exim list; the elements of the list are joined together with
6500ASCII NUL characters to form the lookup key. An example usage would be to
6501authenticate incoming SMTP calls using the passwords from Cyrus SASL's
6502&_/etc/sasldb2_& file with the &(gsasl)& authenticator or Exim's own
6503&(cram_md5)& authenticator.
6504.next
6505.cindex "lookup" "dbmnz"
6506.cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- terminating zero"
6507.cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6508.cindex "Courier"
6509.cindex "&_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_&"
6510.cindex "dbmnz lookup type"
6511&(dbmnz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that a terminating binary zero
6512is not included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. You may need this
6513if you want to look up data in files that are created by or shared with some
6514other application that does not use terminating zeros. For example, you need to
6515use &(dbmnz)& rather than &(dbm)& if you want to authenticate incoming SMTP
6516calls using the passwords from Courier's &_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_& file. Exim's
6517utility program for creating DBM files (&'exim_dbmbuild'&) includes the zeros
6518by default, but has an option to omit them (see section &<<SECTdbmbuild>>&).
6519.next
6520.cindex "lookup" "dsearch"
6521.cindex "dsearch lookup type"
6522&(dsearch)&: The given file must be a directory; this is searched for an entry
6523whose name is the key by calling the &[lstat()]& function. The key may not
6524contain any forward slash characters. If &[lstat()]& succeeds, the result of
6525the lookup is the name of the entry, which may be a file, directory,
6526symbolic link, or any other kind of directory entry. An example of how this
6527lookup can be used to support virtual domains is given in section
6528&<<SECTvirtualdomains>>&.
6529.next
6530.cindex "lookup" "iplsearch"
6531.cindex "iplsearch lookup type"
6532&(iplsearch)&: The given file is a text file containing keys and data. A key is
6533terminated by a colon or white space or the end of the line. The keys in the
6534file must be IP addresses, or IP addresses with CIDR masks. Keys that involve
6535IPv6 addresses must be enclosed in quotes to prevent the first internal colon
6536being interpreted as a key terminator. For example:
6537.code
65381.2.3.4: data for 1.2.3.4
6539192.168.0.0/16: data for 192.168.0.0/16
6540"abcd::cdab": data for abcd::cdab
6541"abcd:abcd::/32" data for abcd:abcd::/32
6542.endd
6543The key for an &(iplsearch)& lookup must be an IP address (without a mask). The
6544file is searched linearly, using the CIDR masks where present, until a matching
6545key is found. The first key that matches is used; there is no attempt to find a
6546&"best"& match. Apart from the way the keys are matched, the processing for
6547&(iplsearch)& is the same as for &(lsearch)&.
6548
6549&*Warning 1*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6550&(iplsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6551lookup types support only literal keys.
6552
6553&*Warning 2*&: In a host list, you must always use &(net-iplsearch)& so that
6554the implicit key is the host's IP address rather than its name (see section
6555&<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&).
6556.next
6557.cindex "linear search"
6558.cindex "lookup" "lsearch"
6559.cindex "lsearch lookup type"
6560.cindex "case sensitivity" "in lsearch lookup"
6561&(lsearch)&: The given file is a text file that is searched linearly for a
6562line beginning with the search key, terminated by a colon or white space or the
6563end of the line. The search is case-insensitive; that is, upper and lower case
6564letters are treated as the same. The first occurrence of the key that is found
6565in the file is used.
6566
6567White space between the key and the colon is permitted. The remainder of the
6568line, with leading and trailing white space removed, is the data. This can be
6569continued onto subsequent lines by starting them with any amount of white
6570space, but only a single space character is included in the data at such a
6571junction. If the data begins with a colon, the key must be terminated by a
6572colon, for example:
6573.code
6574baduser: :fail:
6575.endd
6576Empty lines and lines beginning with # are ignored, even if they occur in the
6577middle of an item. This is the traditional textual format of alias files. Note
6578that the keys in an &(lsearch)& file are literal strings. There is no
6579wildcarding of any kind.
6580
6581.cindex "lookup" "lsearch &-- colons in keys"
6582.cindex "white space" "in lsearch key"
6583In most &(lsearch)& files, keys are not required to contain colons or #
6584characters, or white space. However, if you need this feature, it is available.
6585If a key begins with a doublequote character, it is terminated only by a
6586matching quote (or end of line), and the normal escaping rules apply to its
6587contents (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&). An optional colon is permitted after
6588quoted keys (exactly as for unquoted keys). There is no special handling of
6589quotes for the data part of an &(lsearch)& line.
6590
6591.next
6592.cindex "NIS lookup type"
6593.cindex "lookup" "NIS"
6594.cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6595&(nis)&: The given file is the name of a NIS map, and a NIS lookup is done with
6596the given key, without a terminating binary zero. There is a variant called
6597&(nis0)& which does include the terminating binary zero in the key. This is
6598reportedly needed for Sun-style alias files. Exim does not recognize NIS
6599aliases; the full map names must be used.
6600
6601.next
6602.cindex "wildlsearch lookup type"
6603.cindex "lookup" "wildlsearch"
6604.cindex "nwildlsearch lookup type"
6605.cindex "lookup" "nwildlsearch"
6606&(wildlsearch)& or &(nwildlsearch)&: These search a file linearly, like
6607&(lsearch)&, but instead of being interpreted as a literal string, each key in
6608the file may be wildcarded. The difference between these two lookup types is
6609that for &(wildlsearch)&, each key in the file is string-expanded before being
6610used, whereas for &(nwildlsearch)&, no expansion takes place.
6611
6612.cindex "case sensitivity" "in (n)wildlsearch lookup"
6613Like &(lsearch)&, the testing is done case-insensitively. However, keys in the
6614file that are regular expressions can be made case-sensitive by the use of
6615&`(-i)`& within the pattern. The following forms of wildcard are recognized:
6616
6617. ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
6618. ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
6619
6620.olist
6621The string may begin with an asterisk to mean &"ends with"&. For example:
6622.code
6623 *.a.b.c data for anything.a.b.c
6624 *fish data for anythingfish
6625.endd
6626.next
6627The string may begin with a circumflex to indicate a regular expression. For
6628example, for &(wildlsearch)&:
6629.code
6630 ^\N\d+\.a\.b\N data for <digits>.a.b
6631.endd
6632Note the use of &`\N`& to disable expansion of the contents of the regular
6633expression. If you are using &(nwildlsearch)&, where the keys are not
6634string-expanded, the equivalent entry is:
6635.code
6636 ^\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6637.endd
6638The case-insensitive flag is set at the start of compiling the regular
6639expression, but it can be turned off by using &`(-i)`& at an appropriate point.
6640For example, to make the entire pattern case-sensitive:
6641.code
6642 ^(?-i)\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6643.endd
6644
6645If the regular expression contains white space or colon characters, you must
6646either quote it (see &(lsearch)& above), or represent these characters in other
6647ways. For example, &`\s`& can be used for white space and &`\x3A`& for a
6648colon. This may be easier than quoting, because if you quote, you have to
6649escape all the backslashes inside the quotes.
6650
6651&*Note*&: It is not possible to capture substrings in a regular expression
6652match for later use, because the results of all lookups are cached. If a lookup
6653is repeated, the result is taken from the cache, and no actual pattern matching
6654takes place. The values of all the numeric variables are unset after a
6655&((n)wildlsearch)& match.
6656
6657.next
6658Although I cannot see it being of much use, the general matching function that
6659is used to implement &((n)wildlsearch)& means that the string may begin with a
6660lookup name terminated by a semicolon, and followed by lookup data. For
6661example:
6662.code
6663 cdb;/some/file data for keys that match the file
6664.endd
6665The data that is obtained from the nested lookup is discarded.
6666.endlist olist
6667
6668Keys that do not match any of these patterns are interpreted literally. The
6669continuation rules for the data are the same as for &(lsearch)&, and keys may
6670be followed by optional colons.
6671
6672&*Warning*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6673&((n)wildlsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6674lookup types support only literal keys.
6675.endlist ilist
6676
6677
6678.section "Query-style lookup types" "SECTquerystylelookups"
6679.cindex "lookup" "query-style types"
6680.cindex "query-style lookup" "list of types"
6681The supported query-style lookup types are listed below. Further details about
6682many of them are given in later sections.
6683
6684.ilist
6685.cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6686.cindex "lookup" "DNS"
6687&(dnsdb)&: This does a DNS search for one or more records whose domain names
6688are given in the supplied query. The resulting data is the contents of the
6689records. See section &<<SECTdnsdb>>&.
6690.next
6691.cindex "InterBase lookup type"
6692.cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
6693&(ibase)&: This does a lookup in an InterBase database.
6694.next
6695.cindex "LDAP" "lookup type"
6696.cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
6697&(ldap)&: This does an LDAP lookup using a query in the form of a URL, and
6698returns attributes from a single entry. There is a variant called &(ldapm)&
6699that permits values from multiple entries to be returned. A third variant
6700called &(ldapdn)& returns the Distinguished Name of a single entry instead of
6701any attribute values. See section &<<SECTldap>>&.
6702.next
6703.cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
6704.cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
6705&(mysql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6706MySQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6707.next
6708.cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
6709.cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
6710&(nisplus)&: This does a NIS+ lookup using a query that can specify the name of
6711the field to be returned. See section &<<SECTnisplus>>&.
6712.next
6713.cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
6714.cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
6715&(oracle)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to an
6716Oracle database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6717.next
6718.cindex "lookup" "passwd"
6719.cindex "passwd lookup type"
6720.cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
6721&(passwd)& is a query-style lookup with queries that are just user names. The
6722lookup calls &[getpwnam()]& to interrogate the system password data, and on
6723success, the result string is the same as you would get from an &(lsearch)&
6724lookup on a traditional &_/etc/passwd file_&, though with &`*`& for the
6725password value. For example:
6726.code
6727*:42:42:King Rat:/home/kr:/bin/bash
6728.endd
6729.next
6730.cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
6731.cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
6732&(pgsql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6733PostgreSQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6734
6735.next
6736.cindex "Redis lookup type"
6737.cindex lookup Redis
6738&(redis)&: The format of the query is either a simple get or simple set,
6739passed to a Redis database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6740
6741.next
6742.cindex "sqlite lookup type"
6743.cindex "lookup" "sqlite"
6744&(sqlite)&: The format of the query is a file name followed by an SQL statement
6745that is passed to an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>&.
6746
6747.next
6748&(testdb)&: This is a lookup type that is used for testing Exim. It is
6749not likely to be useful in normal operation.
6750.next
6751.cindex "whoson lookup type"
6752.cindex "lookup" "whoson"
6753&(whoson)&: &'Whoson'& (&url(http://whoson.sourceforge.net)) is a protocol that
6754allows a server to check whether a particular (dynamically allocated) IP
6755address is currently allocated to a known (trusted) user and, optionally, to
6756obtain the identity of the said user. For SMTP servers, &'Whoson'& was popular
6757at one time for &"POP before SMTP"& authentication, but that approach has been
6758superseded by SMTP authentication. In Exim, &'Whoson'& can be used to implement
6759&"POP before SMTP"& checking using ACL statements such as
6760.code
6761require condition = \
6762 ${lookup whoson {$sender_host_address}{yes}{no}}
6763.endd
6764The query consists of a single IP address. The value returned is the name of
6765the authenticated user, which is stored in the variable &$value$&. However, in
6766this example, the data in &$value$& is not used; the result of the lookup is
6767one of the fixed strings &"yes"& or &"no"&.
6768.endlist
6769
6770
6771
6772.section "Temporary errors in lookups" "SECID63"
6773.cindex "lookup" "temporary error in"
6774Lookup functions can return temporary error codes if the lookup cannot be
6775completed. For example, an SQL or LDAP database might be unavailable. For this
6776reason, it is not advisable to use a lookup that might do this for critical
6777options such as a list of local domains.
6778
6779When a lookup cannot be completed in a router or transport, delivery
6780of the message (to the relevant address) is deferred, as for any other
6781temporary error. In other circumstances Exim may assume the lookup has failed,
6782or may give up altogether.
6783
6784
6785
6786.section "Default values in single-key lookups" "SECTdefaultvaluelookups"
6787.cindex "wildcard lookups"
6788.cindex "lookup" "default values"
6789.cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
6790.cindex "lookup" "* added to type"
6791.cindex "default" "in single-key lookups"
6792In this context, a &"default value"& is a value specified by the administrator
6793that is to be used if a lookup fails.
6794
6795&*Note:*& This section applies only to single-key lookups. For query-style
6796lookups, the facilities of the query language must be used. An attempt to
6797specify a default for a query-style lookup provokes an error.
6798
6799If &"*"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example, &%lsearch*%&)
6800and the initial lookup fails, the key &"*"& is looked up in the file to
6801provide a default value. See also the section on partial matching below.
6802
6803.cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
6804.cindex "lookup" "*@ added to type"
6805.cindex "alias file" "per-domain default"
6806Alternatively, if &"*@"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example
6807&%dbm*@%&) then, if the initial lookup fails and the key contains an @
6808character, a second lookup is done with everything before the last @ replaced
6809by *. This makes it possible to provide per-domain defaults in alias files
6810that include the domains in the keys. If the second lookup fails (or doesn't
6811take place because there is no @ in the key), &"*"& is looked up.
6812For example, a &(redirect)& router might contain:
6813.code
6814data = ${lookup{$local_part@$domain}lsearch*@{/etc/mix-aliases}}
6815.endd
6816Suppose the address that is being processed is &'jane@eyre.example'&. Exim
6817looks up these keys, in this order:
6818.code
6819jane@eyre.example
6820*@eyre.example
6821*
6822.endd
6823The data is taken from whichever key it finds first. &*Note*&: In an
6824&(lsearch)& file, this does not mean the first of these keys in the file. A
6825complete scan is done for each key, and only if it is not found at all does
6826Exim move on to try the next key.
6827
6828
6829
6830.section "Partial matching in single-key lookups" "SECTpartiallookup"
6831.cindex "partial matching"
6832.cindex "wildcard lookups"
6833.cindex "lookup" "partial matching"
6834.cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
6835.cindex "asterisk" "in search type"
6836The normal operation of a single-key lookup is to search the file for an exact
6837match with the given key. However, in a number of situations where domains are
6838being looked up, it is useful to be able to do partial matching. In this case,
6839information in the file that has a key starting with &"*."& is matched by any
6840domain that ends with the components that follow the full stop. For example, if
6841a key in a DBM file is
6842.code
6843*.dates.fict.example
6844.endd
6845then when partial matching is enabled this is matched by (amongst others)
6846&'2001.dates.fict.example'& and &'1984.dates.fict.example'&. It is also matched
6847by &'dates.fict.example'&, if that does not appear as a separate key in the
6848file.
6849
6850&*Note*&: Partial matching is not available for query-style lookups. It is
6851also not available for any lookup items in address lists (see section
6852&<<SECTaddresslist>>&).
6853
6854Partial matching is implemented by doing a series of separate lookups using
6855keys constructed by modifying the original subject key. This means that it can
6856be used with any of the single-key lookup types, provided that
6857partial matching keys
6858beginning with a special prefix (default &"*."&) are included in the data file.
6859Keys in the file that do not begin with the prefix are matched only by
6860unmodified subject keys when partial matching is in use.
6861
6862Partial matching is requested by adding the string &"partial-"& to the front of
6863the name of a single-key lookup type, for example, &%partial-dbm%&. When this
6864is done, the subject key is first looked up unmodified; if that fails, &"*."&
6865is added at the start of the subject key, and it is looked up again. If that
6866fails, further lookups are tried with dot-separated components removed from the
6867start of the subject key, one-by-one, and &"*."& added on the front of what
6868remains.
6869
6870A minimum number of two non-* components are required. This can be adjusted
6871by including a number before the hyphen in the search type. For example,
6872&%partial3-lsearch%& specifies a minimum of three non-* components in the
6873modified keys. Omitting the number is equivalent to &"partial2-"&. If the
6874subject key is &'2250.dates.fict.example'& then the following keys are looked
6875up when the minimum number of non-* components is two:
6876.code
68772250.dates.fict.example
6878*.2250.dates.fict.example
6879*.dates.fict.example
6880*.fict.example
6881.endd
6882As soon as one key in the sequence is successfully looked up, the lookup
6883finishes.
6884
6885.cindex "lookup" "partial matching &-- changing prefix"
6886.cindex "prefix" "for partial matching"
6887The use of &"*."& as the partial matching prefix is a default that can be
6888changed. The motivation for this feature is to allow Exim to operate with file
6889formats that are used by other MTAs. A different prefix can be supplied in
6890parentheses instead of the hyphen after &"partial"&. For example:
6891.code
6892domains = partial(.)lsearch;/some/file
6893.endd
6894In this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
6895&`a.b.c`&, &`.a.b.c`&, and &`.b.c`& (the default minimum of 2 non-wild
6896components is unchanged). The prefix may consist of any punctuation characters
6897other than a closing parenthesis. It may be empty, for example:
6898.code
6899domains = partial1()cdb;/some/file
6900.endd
6901For this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
6902&`a.b.c`&, &`b.c`&, and &`c`&.
6903
6904If &"partial0"& is specified, what happens at the end (when the lookup with
6905just one non-wild component has failed, and the original key is shortened right
6906down to the null string) depends on the prefix:
6907
6908.ilist
6909If the prefix has zero length, the whole lookup fails.
6910.next
6911If the prefix has length 1, a lookup for just the prefix is done. For
6912example, the final lookup for &"partial0(.)"& is for &`.`& alone.
6913.next
6914Otherwise, if the prefix ends in a dot, the dot is removed, and the
6915remainder is looked up. With the default prefix, therefore, the final lookup is
6916for &"*"& on its own.
6917.next
6918Otherwise, the whole prefix is looked up.
6919.endlist
6920
6921
6922If the search type ends in &"*"& or &"*@"& (see section
6923&<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& above), the search for an ultimate default that
6924this implies happens after all partial lookups have failed. If &"partial0"& is
6925specified, adding &"*"& to the search type has no effect with the default
6926prefix, because the &"*"& key is already included in the sequence of partial
6927lookups. However, there might be a use for lookup types such as
6928&"partial0(.)lsearch*"&.
6929
6930The use of &"*"& in lookup partial matching differs from its use as a wildcard
6931in domain lists and the like. Partial matching works only in terms of
6932dot-separated components; a key such as &`*fict.example`&
6933in a database file is useless, because the asterisk in a partial matching
6934subject key is always followed by a dot.
6935
6936
6937
6938
6939.section "Lookup caching" "SECID64"
6940.cindex "lookup" "caching"
6941.cindex "caching" "lookup data"
6942Exim caches all lookup results in order to avoid needless repetition of
6943lookups. However, because (apart from the daemon) Exim operates as a collection
6944of independent, short-lived processes, this caching applies only within a
6945single Exim process. There is no inter-process lookup caching facility.
6946
6947For single-key lookups, Exim keeps the relevant files open in case there is
6948another lookup that needs them. In some types of configuration this can lead to
6949many files being kept open for messages with many recipients. To avoid hitting
6950the operating system limit on the number of simultaneously open files, Exim
6951closes the least recently used file when it needs to open more files than its
6952own internal limit, which can be changed via the &%lookup_open_max%& option.
6953
6954The single-key lookup files are closed and the lookup caches are flushed at
6955strategic points during delivery &-- for example, after all routing is
6956complete.
6957
6958
6959
6960
6961.section "Quoting lookup data" "SECID65"
6962.cindex "lookup" "quoting"
6963.cindex "quoting" "in lookups"
6964When data from an incoming message is included in a query-style lookup, there
6965is the possibility of special characters in the data messing up the syntax of
6966the query. For example, a NIS+ query that contains
6967.code
6968[name=$local_part]
6969.endd
6970will be broken if the local part happens to contain a closing square bracket.
6971For NIS+, data can be enclosed in double quotes like this:
6972.code
6973[name="$local_part"]
6974.endd
6975but this still leaves the problem of a double quote in the data. The rule for
6976NIS+ is that double quotes must be doubled. Other lookup types have different
6977rules, and to cope with the differing requirements, an expansion operator
6978of the following form is provided:
6979.code
6980${quote_<lookup-type>:<string>}
6981.endd
6982For example, the safest way to write the NIS+ query is
6983.code
6984[name="${quote_nisplus:$local_part}"]
6985.endd
6986See chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>& for full coverage of string expansions. The quote
6987operator can be used for all lookup types, but has no effect for single-key
6988lookups, since no quoting is ever needed in their key strings.
6989
6990
6991
6992
6993.section "More about dnsdb" "SECTdnsdb"
6994.cindex "dnsdb lookup"
6995.cindex "lookup" "dnsdb"
6996.cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6997The &(dnsdb)& lookup type uses the DNS as its database. A simple query consists
6998of a record type and a domain name, separated by an equals sign. For example,
6999an expansion string could contain:
7000.code
7001${lookup dnsdb{mx=a.b.example}{$value}fail}
7002.endd
7003If the lookup succeeds, the result is placed in &$value$&, which in this case
7004is used on its own as the result. If the lookup does not succeed, the
7005&`fail`& keyword causes a &'forced expansion failure'& &-- see section
7006&<<SECTforexpfai>>& for an explanation of what this means.
7007
7008The supported DNS record types are A, CNAME, MX, NS, PTR, SOA, SPF, SRV, TLSA
7009and TXT, and, when Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, AAAA.
7010If no type is given, TXT is assumed.
7011
7012For any record type, if multiple records are found, the data is returned as a
7013concatenation, with newline as the default separator. The order, of course,
7014depends on the DNS resolver. You can specify a different separator character
7015between multiple records by putting a right angle-bracket followed immediately
7016by the new separator at the start of the query. For example:
7017.code
7018${lookup dnsdb{>: a=host1.example}}
7019.endd
7020It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
7021white space is ignored.
7022For lookup types that return multiple fields per record,
7023an alternate field separator can be specified using a comma after the main
7024separator character, followed immediately by the field separator.
7025
7026.cindex "PTR record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7027When the type is PTR,
7028the data can be an IP address, written as normal; inversion and the addition of
7029&%in-addr.arpa%& or &%ip6.arpa%& happens automatically. For example:
7030.code
7031${lookup dnsdb{ptr=192.168.4.5}{$value}fail}
7032.endd
7033If the data for a PTR record is not a syntactically valid IP address, it is not
7034altered and nothing is added.
7035
7036.cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7037.cindex "SRV record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7038For an MX lookup, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
7039each record, separated by a space. For an SRV lookup, the priority, weight,
7040port, and host name are returned for each record, separated by spaces.
7041The field separator can be modified as above.
7042
7043.cindex "TXT record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7044.cindex "SPF record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7045For TXT records with multiple items of data, only the first item is returned,
7046unless a field separator is specified.
7047To concatenate items without a separator, use a semicolon instead.
7048For SPF records the
7049default behaviour is to concatenate multiple items without using a separator.
7050.code
7051${lookup dnsdb{>\n,: txt=a.b.example}}
7052${lookup dnsdb{>\n; txt=a.b.example}}
7053${lookup dnsdb{spf=example.org}}
7054.endd
7055It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
7056white space is ignored.
7057
7058.cindex "SOA record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7059For an SOA lookup, while no result is obtained the lookup is redone with
7060successively more leading components dropped from the given domain.
7061Only the primary-nameserver field is returned unless a field separator is
7062specified.
7063.code
7064${lookup dnsdb{>:,; soa=a.b.example.com}}
7065.endd
7066
7067.section "Dnsdb lookup modifiers" "SECTdnsdb_mod"
7068.cindex "dnsdb modifiers"
7069.cindex "modifiers" "dnsdb"
7070.cindex "options" "dnsdb"
7071Modifiers for &(dnsdb)& lookups are given by optional keywords,
7072each followed by a comma,
7073that may appear before the record type.
7074
7075The &(dnsdb)& lookup fails only if all the DNS lookups fail. If there is a
7076temporary DNS error for any of them, the behaviour is controlled by
7077a defer-option modifier.
7078The possible keywords are
7079&"defer_strict"&, &"defer_never"&, and &"defer_lax"&.
7080With &"strict"& behaviour, any temporary DNS error causes the
7081whole lookup to defer. With &"never"& behaviour, a temporary DNS error is
7082ignored, and the behaviour is as if the DNS lookup failed to find anything.
7083With &"lax"& behaviour, all the queries are attempted, but a temporary DNS
7084error causes the whole lookup to defer only if none of the other lookups
7085succeed. The default is &"lax"&, so the following lookups are equivalent:
7086.code
7087${lookup dnsdb{defer_lax,a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7088${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7089.endd
7090Thus, in the default case, as long as at least one of the DNS lookups
7091yields some data, the lookup succeeds.
7092
7093.cindex "DNSSEC" "dns lookup"
7094Use of &(DNSSEC)& is controlled by a dnssec modifier.
7095The possible keywords are
7096&"dnssec_strict"&, &"dnssec_lax"&, and &"dnssec_never"&.
7097With &"strict"& or &"lax"& DNSSEC information is requested
7098with the lookup.
7099With &"strict"& a response from the DNS resolver that
7100is not labelled as authenticated data
7101is treated as equivalent to a temporary DNS error.
7102The default is &"never"&.
7103
7104See also the &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$& variable.
7105
7106.cindex timeout "dns lookup"
7107.cindex "DNS" timeout
7108Timeout for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retrans modifier.
7109The form is &"retrans_VAL"& where VAL is an Exim time specification
7110(e.g. &"5s"&).
7111The default value is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retrans%&.
7112
7113Retries for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retry modifier.
7114The form if &"retry_VAL"& where VAL is an integer.
7115The default count is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retry%&.
7116
7117.cindex caching "of dns lookup"
7118.cindex TTL "of dns lookup"
7119.cindex DNS TTL
7120Dnsdb lookup results are cached within a single process (and its children).
7121The cache entry lifetime is limited to the smallest time-to-live (TTL)
7122value of the set of returned DNS records.
7123
7124
7125.section "Pseudo dnsdb record types" "SECID66"
7126.cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7127By default, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
7128each MX record, separated by a space. If you want only host names, you can use
7129the pseudo-type MXH:
7130.code
7131${lookup dnsdb{mxh=a.b.example}}
7132.endd
7133In this case, the preference values are omitted, and just the host names are
7134returned.
7135
7136.cindex "name server for enclosing domain"
7137Another pseudo-type is ZNS (for &"zone NS"&). It performs a lookup for NS
7138records on the given domain, but if none are found, it removes the first
7139component of the domain name, and tries again. This process continues until NS
7140records are found or there are no more components left (or there is a DNS
7141error). In other words, it may return the name servers for a top-level domain,
7142but it never returns the root name servers. If there are no NS records for the
7143top-level domain, the lookup fails. Consider these examples:
7144.code
7145${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.quercite.com}}
7146${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.edu}}
7147.endd
7148Assuming that in each case there are no NS records for the full domain name,
7149the first returns the name servers for &%quercite.com%&, and the second returns
7150the name servers for &%edu%&.
7151
7152You should be careful about how you use this lookup because, unless the
7153top-level domain does not exist, the lookup always returns some host names. The
7154sort of use to which this might be put is for seeing if the name servers for a
7155given domain are on a blacklist. You can probably assume that the name servers
7156for the high-level domains such as &%com%& or &%co.uk%& are not going to be on
7157such a list.
7158
7159.cindex "CSA" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7160A third pseudo-type is CSA (Client SMTP Authorization). This looks up SRV
7161records according to the CSA rules, which are described in section
7162&<<SECTverifyCSA>>&. Although &(dnsdb)& supports SRV lookups directly, this is
7163not sufficient because of the extra parent domain search behaviour of CSA. The
7164result of a successful lookup such as:
7165.code
7166${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
7167.endd
7168has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
7169The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
7170authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
7171
7172.cindex "A+" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7173The pseudo-type A+ performs an AAAA
7174and then an A lookup. All results are returned; defer processing
7175(see below) is handled separately for each lookup. Example:
7176.code
7177${lookup dnsdb {>; a+=$sender_helo_name}}
7178.endd
7179
7180
7181.section "Multiple dnsdb lookups" "SECID67"
7182In the previous sections, &(dnsdb)& lookups for a single domain are described.
7183However, you can specify a list of domains or IP addresses in a single
7184&(dnsdb)& lookup. The list is specified in the normal Exim way, with colon as
7185the default separator, but with the ability to change this. For example:
7186.code
7187${lookup dnsdb{one.domain.com:two.domain.com}}
7188${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7189${lookup dnsdb{ptr = <; 1.2.3.4 ; 4.5.6.8}}
7190.endd
7191In order to retain backwards compatibility, there is one special case: if
7192the lookup type is PTR and no change of separator is specified, Exim looks
7193to see if the rest of the string is precisely one IPv6 address. In this
7194case, it does not treat it as a list.
7195
7196The data from each lookup is concatenated, with newline separators by default,
7197in the same way that multiple DNS records for a single item are handled. A
7198different separator can be specified, as described above.
7199
7200
7201
7202
7203.section "More about LDAP" "SECTldap"
7204.cindex "LDAP" "lookup, more about"
7205.cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
7206.cindex "Solaris" "LDAP"
7207The original LDAP implementation came from the University of Michigan; this has
7208become &"Open LDAP"&, and there are now two different releases. Another
7209implementation comes from Netscape, and Solaris 7 and subsequent releases
7210contain inbuilt LDAP support. Unfortunately, though these are all compatible at
7211the lookup function level, their error handling is different. For this reason
7212it is necessary to set a compile-time variable when building Exim with LDAP, to
7213indicate which LDAP library is in use. One of the following should appear in
7214your &_Local/Makefile_&:
7215.code
7216LDAP_LIB_TYPE=UMICHIGAN
7217LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP1
7218LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP2
7219LDAP_LIB_TYPE=NETSCAPE
7220LDAP_LIB_TYPE=SOLARIS
7221.endd
7222If LDAP_LIB_TYPE is not set, Exim assumes &`OPENLDAP1`&, which has the
7223same interface as the University of Michigan version.
7224
7225There are three LDAP lookup types in Exim. These behave slightly differently in
7226the way they handle the results of a query:
7227
7228.ilist
7229&(ldap)& requires the result to contain just one entry; if there are more, it
7230gives an error.
7231.next
7232&(ldapdn)& also requires the result to contain just one entry, but it is the
7233Distinguished Name that is returned rather than any attribute values.
7234.next
7235&(ldapm)& permits the result to contain more than one entry; the attributes
7236from all of them are returned.
7237.endlist
7238
7239
7240For &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, if a query finds only entries with no attributes,
7241Exim behaves as if the entry did not exist, and the lookup fails. The format of
7242the data returned by a successful lookup is described in the next section.
7243First we explain how LDAP queries are coded.
7244
7245
7246.section "Format of LDAP queries" "SECTforldaque"
7247.cindex "LDAP" "query format"
7248An LDAP query takes the form of a URL as defined in RFC 2255. For example, in
7249the configuration of a &(redirect)& router one might have this setting:
7250.code
7251data = ${lookup ldap \
7252 {ldap:///cn=$local_part,o=University%20of%20Cambridge,\
7253 c=UK?mailbox?base?}}
7254.endd
7255.cindex "LDAP" "with TLS"
7256The URL may begin with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& if your LDAP library supports
7257secure (encrypted) LDAP connections. The second of these ensures that an
7258encrypted TLS connection is used.
7259
7260With sufficiently modern LDAP libraries, Exim supports forcing TLS over regular
7261LDAP connections, rather than the SSL-on-connect &`ldaps`&.
7262See the &%ldap_start_tls%& option.
7263
7264Starting with Exim 4.83, the initialization of LDAP with TLS is more tightly
7265controlled. Every part of the TLS configuration can be configured by settings in
7266&_exim.conf_&. Depending on the version of the client libraries installed on
7267your system, some of the initialization may have required setting options in
7268&_/etc/ldap.conf_& or &_~/.ldaprc_& to get TLS working with self-signed
7269certificates. This revealed a nuance where the current UID that exim was
7270running as could affect which config files it read. With Exim 4.83, these
7271methods become optional, only taking effect if not specifically set in
7272&_exim.conf_&.
7273
7274
7275.section "LDAP quoting" "SECID68"
7276.cindex "LDAP" "quoting"
7277Two levels of quoting are required in LDAP queries, the first for LDAP itself
7278and the second because the LDAP query is represented as a URL. Furthermore,
7279within an LDAP query, two different kinds of quoting are required. For this
7280reason, there are two different LDAP-specific quoting operators.
7281
7282The &%quote_ldap%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7283filter specifications. Conceptually, it first does the following conversions on
7284the string:
7285.code
7286* => \2A
7287( => \28
7288) => \29
7289\ => \5C
7290.endd
7291in accordance with RFC 2254. The resulting string is then quoted according
7292to the rules for URLs, that is, all non-alphanumeric characters except
7293.code
7294! $ ' - . _ ( ) * +
7295.endd
7296are converted to their hex values, preceded by a percent sign. For example:
7297.code
7298${quote_ldap: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7299.endd
7300yields
7301.code
7302%20a%5C28bc%5C29%5C2A%2C%20a%3Cyz%3E%3B%20
7303.endd
7304Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a leading and a trailing space):
7305.code
7306a\28bc\29\2A, a<yz>;
7307.endd
7308The &%quote_ldap_dn%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7309base DN specifications in queries. Conceptually, it first converts the string
7310by inserting a backslash in front of any of the following characters:
7311.code
7312, + " \ < > ;
7313.endd
7314It also inserts a backslash before any leading spaces or # characters, and
7315before any trailing spaces. (These rules are in RFC 2253.) The resulting string
7316is then quoted according to the rules for URLs. For example:
7317.code
7318${quote_ldap_dn: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7319.endd
7320yields
7321.code
7322%5C%20a(bc)*%5C%2C%20a%5C%3Cyz%5C%3E%5C%3B%5C%20
7323.endd
7324Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a trailing space):
7325.code
7326\ a(bc)*\, a\<yz\>\;\
7327.endd
7328There are some further comments about quoting in the section on LDAP
7329authentication below.
7330
7331
7332.section "LDAP connections" "SECID69"
7333.cindex "LDAP" "connections"
7334The connection to an LDAP server may either be over TCP/IP, or, when OpenLDAP
7335is in use, via a Unix domain socket. The example given above does not specify
7336an LDAP server. A server that is reached by TCP/IP can be specified in a query
7337by starting it with
7338.code
7339ldap://<hostname>:<port>/...
7340.endd
7341If the port (and preceding colon) are omitted, the standard LDAP port (389) is
7342used. When no server is specified in a query, a list of default servers is
7343taken from the &%ldap_default_servers%& configuration option. This supplies a
7344colon-separated list of servers which are tried in turn until one successfully
7345handles a query, or there is a serious error. Successful handling either
7346returns the requested data, or indicates that it does not exist. Serious errors
7347are syntactical, or multiple values when only a single value is expected.
7348Errors which cause the next server to be tried are connection failures, bind
7349failures, and timeouts.
7350
7351For each server name in the list, a port number can be given. The standard way
7352of specifying a host and port is to use a colon separator (RFC 1738). Because
7353&%ldap_default_servers%& is a colon-separated list, such colons have to be
7354doubled. For example
7355.code
7356ldap_default_servers = ldap1.example.com::145:ldap2.example.com
7357.endd
7358If &%ldap_default_servers%& is unset, a URL with no server name is passed
7359to the LDAP library with no server name, and the library's default (normally
7360the local host) is used.
7361
7362If you are using the OpenLDAP library, you can connect to an LDAP server using
7363a Unix domain socket instead of a TCP/IP connection. This is specified by using
7364&`ldapi`& instead of &`ldap`& in LDAP queries. What follows here applies only
7365to OpenLDAP. If Exim is compiled with a different LDAP library, this feature is
7366not available.
7367
7368For this type of connection, instead of a host name for the server, a pathname
7369for the socket is required, and the port number is not relevant. The pathname
7370can be specified either as an item in &%ldap_default_servers%&, or inline in
7371the query. In the former case, you can have settings such as
7372.code
7373ldap_default_servers = /tmp/ldap.sock : backup.ldap.your.domain
7374.endd
7375When the pathname is given in the query, you have to escape the slashes as
7376&`%2F`& to fit in with the LDAP URL syntax. For example:
7377.code
7378${lookup ldap {ldapi://%2Ftmp%2Fldap.sock/o=...
7379.endd
7380When Exim processes an LDAP lookup and finds that the &"hostname"& is really
7381a pathname, it uses the Unix domain socket code, even if the query actually
7382specifies &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`&. In particular, no encryption is used for a
7383socket connection. This behaviour means that you can use a setting of
7384&%ldap_default_servers%& such as in the example above with traditional &`ldap`&
7385or &`ldaps`& queries, and it will work. First, Exim tries a connection via
7386the Unix domain socket; if that fails, it tries a TCP/IP connection to the
7387backup host.
7388
7389If an explicit &`ldapi`& type is given in a query when a host name is
7390specified, an error is diagnosed. However, if there are more items in
7391&%ldap_default_servers%&, they are tried. In other words:
7392
7393.ilist
7394Using a pathname with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& forces the use of the Unix domain
7395interface.
7396.next
7397Using &`ldapi`& with a host name causes an error.
7398.endlist
7399
7400
7401Using &`ldapi`& with no host or path in the query, and no setting of
7402&%ldap_default_servers%&, does whatever the library does by default.
7403
7404
7405
7406.section "LDAP authentication and control information" "SECID70"
7407.cindex "LDAP" "authentication"
7408The LDAP URL syntax provides no way of passing authentication and other control
7409information to the server. To make this possible, the URL in an LDAP query may
7410be preceded by any number of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> settings, separated by
7411spaces. If a value contains spaces it must be enclosed in double quotes, and
7412when double quotes are used, backslash is interpreted in the usual way inside
7413them. The following names are recognized:
7414.display
7415&`DEREFERENCE`& set the dereferencing parameter
7416&`NETTIME `& set a timeout for a network operation
7417&`USER `& set the DN, for authenticating the LDAP bind
7418&`PASS `& set the password, likewise
7419&`REFERRALS `& set the referrals parameter
7420&`SERVERS `& set alternate server list for this query only
7421&`SIZE `& set the limit for the number of entries returned
7422&`TIME `& set the maximum waiting time for a query
7423.endd
7424The value of the DEREFERENCE parameter must be one of the words &"never"&,
7425&"searching"&, &"finding"&, or &"always"&. The value of the REFERRALS parameter
7426must be &"follow"& (the default) or &"nofollow"&. The latter stops the LDAP
7427library from trying to follow referrals issued by the LDAP server.
7428
7429.cindex LDAP timeout
7430.cindex timeout "LDAP lookup"
7431The name CONNECT is an obsolete name for NETTIME, retained for
7432backwards compatibility. This timeout (specified as a number of seconds) is
7433enforced from the client end for operations that can be carried out over a
7434network. Specifically, it applies to network connections and calls to the
7435&'ldap_result()'& function. If the value is greater than zero, it is used if
7436LDAP_OPT_NETWORK_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (OpenLDAP), or
7437if LDAP_X_OPT_CONNECT_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (Netscape
7438SDK 4.1). A value of zero forces an explicit setting of &"no timeout"& for
7439Netscape SDK; for OpenLDAP no action is taken.
7440
7441The TIME parameter (also a number of seconds) is passed to the server to
7442set a server-side limit on the time taken to complete a search.
7443
7444The SERVERS parameter allows you to specify an alternate list of ldap servers
7445to use for an individual lookup. The global &%ldap_default_servers%& option provides a
7446default list of ldap servers, and a single lookup can specify a single ldap
7447server to use. But when you need to do a lookup with a list of servers that is
7448different than the default list (maybe different order, maybe a completely
7449different set of servers), the SERVERS parameter allows you to specify this
7450alternate list (colon-separated).
7451
7452Here is an example of an LDAP query in an Exim lookup that uses some of these
7453values. This is a single line, folded to fit on the page:
7454.code
7455${lookup ldap
7456 {user="cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK" pass=secret
7457 ldap:///o=University%20of%20Cambridge,c=UK?sn?sub?(cn=foo)}
7458 {$value}fail}
7459.endd
7460The encoding of spaces as &`%20`& is a URL thing which should not be done for
7461any of the auxiliary data. Exim configuration settings that include lookups
7462which contain password information should be preceded by &"hide"& to prevent
7463non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& option to see their values.
7464
7465The auxiliary data items may be given in any order. The default is no
7466connection timeout (the system timeout is used), no user or password, no limit
7467on the number of entries returned, and no time limit on queries.
7468
7469When a DN is quoted in the USER= setting for LDAP authentication, Exim
7470removes any URL quoting that it may contain before passing it LDAP. Apparently
7471some libraries do this for themselves, but some do not. Removing the URL
7472quoting has two advantages:
7473
7474.ilist
7475It makes it possible to use the same &%quote_ldap_dn%& expansion for USER=
7476DNs as with DNs inside actual queries.
7477.next
7478It permits spaces inside USER= DNs.
7479.endlist
7480
7481For example, a setting such as
7482.code
7483USER=cn=${quote_ldap_dn:$1}
7484.endd
7485should work even if &$1$& contains spaces.
7486
7487Expanded data for the PASS= value should be quoted using the &%quote%&
7488expansion operator, rather than the LDAP quote operators. The only reason this
7489field needs quoting is to ensure that it conforms to the Exim syntax, which
7490does not allow unquoted spaces. For example:
7491.code
7492PASS=${quote:$3}
7493.endd
7494The LDAP authentication mechanism can be used to check passwords as part of
7495SMTP authentication. See the &%ldapauth%& expansion string condition in chapter
7496&<<CHAPexpand>>&.
7497
7498
7499
7500.section "Format of data returned by LDAP" "SECID71"
7501.cindex "LDAP" "returned data formats"
7502The &(ldapdn)& lookup type returns the Distinguished Name from a single entry
7503as a sequence of values, for example
7504.code
7505cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK
7506.endd
7507The &(ldap)& lookup type generates an error if more than one entry matches the
7508search filter, whereas &(ldapm)& permits this case, and inserts a newline in
7509the result between the data from different entries. It is possible for multiple
7510values to be returned for both &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, but in the former case
7511you know that whatever values are returned all came from a single entry in the
7512directory.
7513
7514In the common case where you specify a single attribute in your LDAP query, the
7515result is not quoted, and does not contain the attribute name. If the attribute
7516has multiple values, they are separated by commas. Any comma that is
7517part of an attribute's value is doubled.
7518
7519If you specify multiple attributes, the result contains space-separated, quoted
7520strings, each preceded by the attribute name and an equals sign. Within the
7521quotes, the quote character, backslash, and newline are escaped with
7522backslashes, and commas are used to separate multiple values for the attribute.
7523Any commas in attribute values are doubled
7524(permitting treatment of the values as a comma-separated list).
7525Apart from the escaping, the string within quotes takes the same form as the
7526output when a single attribute is requested. Specifying no attributes is the
7527same as specifying all of an entry's attributes.
7528
7529Here are some examples of the output format. The first line of each pair is an
7530LDAP query, and the second is the data that is returned. The attribute called
7531&%attr1%& has two values, one of them with an embedded comma, whereas
7532&%attr2%& has only one value. Both attributes are derived from &%attr%&
7533(they have SUP &%attr%& in their schema definitions).
7534
7535.code
7536ldap:///o=base?attr1?sub?(uid=fred)
7537value1.1,value1,,2
7538
7539ldap:///o=base?attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7540value two
7541
7542ldap:///o=base?attr?sub?(uid=fred)
7543value1.1,value1,,2,value two
7544
7545ldap:///o=base?attr1,attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7546attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
7547
7548ldap:///o=base??sub?(uid=fred)
7549objectClass="top" attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
7550.endd
7551You can
7552make use of Exim's &%-be%& option to run expansion tests and thereby check the
7553results of LDAP lookups.
7554The &%extract%& operator in string expansions can be used to pick out
7555individual fields from data that consists of &'key'&=&'value'& pairs.
7556The &%listextract%& operator should be used to pick out individual values
7557of attributes, even when only a single value is expected.
7558The doubling of embedded commas allows you to use the returned data as a
7559comma separated list (using the "<," syntax for changing the input list separator).
7560
7561
7562
7563
7564.section "More about NIS+" "SECTnisplus"
7565.cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
7566.cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
7567NIS+ queries consist of a NIS+ &'indexed name'& followed by an optional colon
7568and field name. If this is given, the result of a successful query is the
7569contents of the named field; otherwise the result consists of a concatenation
7570of &'field-name=field-value'& pairs, separated by spaces. Empty values and
7571values containing spaces are quoted. For example, the query
7572.code
7573[name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir
7574.endd
7575might return the string
7576.code
7577name=mg1456 passwd="" uid=999 gid=999 gcos="Martin Guerre"
7578home=/home/mg1456 shell=/bin/bash shadow=""
7579.endd
7580(split over two lines here to fit on the page), whereas
7581.code
7582[name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir:gcos
7583.endd
7584would just return
7585.code
7586Martin Guerre
7587.endd
7588with no quotes. A NIS+ lookup fails if NIS+ returns more than one table entry
7589for the given indexed key. The effect of the &%quote_nisplus%& expansion
7590operator is to double any quote characters within the text.
7591
7592
7593
7594.section "SQL lookups" "SECTsql"
7595.cindex "SQL lookup types"
7596.cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7597.cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7598.cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7599.cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7600.cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7601.cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7602.cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7603.cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7604.cindex "Redis lookup type"
7605.cindex lookup Redis
7606Exim can support lookups in InterBase, MySQL, Oracle, PostgreSQL, Redis,
7607and SQLite
7608databases. Queries for these databases contain SQL statements, so an example
7609might be
7610.code
7611${lookup mysql{select mailbox from users where id='userx'}\
7612 {$value}fail}
7613.endd
7614If the result of the query contains more than one field, the data for each
7615field in the row is returned, preceded by its name, so the result of
7616.code
7617${lookup pgsql{select home,name from users where id='userx'}\
7618 {$value}}
7619.endd
7620might be
7621.code
7622home=/home/userx name="Mister X"
7623.endd
7624Empty values and values containing spaces are double quoted, with embedded
7625quotes escaped by a backslash. If the result of the query contains just one
7626field, the value is passed back verbatim, without a field name, for example:
7627.code
7628Mister X
7629.endd
7630If the result of the query yields more than one row, it is all concatenated,
7631with a newline between the data for each row.
7632
7633
7634.section "More about MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, InterBase, and Redis" "SECID72"
7635.cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7636.cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7637.cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7638.cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7639.cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7640.cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7641.cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7642.cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7643.cindex "Redis lookup type"
7644.cindex lookup Redis
7645If any MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, InterBase or Redis lookups are used, the
7646&%mysql_servers%&, &%pgsql_servers%&, &%oracle_servers%&, &%ibase_servers%&,
7647or &%redis_servers%&
7648option (as appropriate) must be set to a colon-separated list of server
7649information.
7650(For MySQL and PostgreSQL, the global option need not be set if all
7651queries contain their own server information &-- see section
7652&<<SECTspeserque>>&.)
7653For all but Redis
7654each item in the list is a slash-separated list of four
7655items: host name, database name, user name, and password. In the case of
7656Oracle, the host name field is used for the &"service name"&, and the database
7657name field is not used and should be empty. For example:
7658.code
7659hide oracle_servers = oracle.plc.example//userx/abcdwxyz
7660.endd
7661Because password data is sensitive, you should always precede the setting with
7662&"hide"&, to prevent non-admin users from obtaining the setting via the &%-bP%&
7663option. Here is an example where two MySQL servers are listed:
7664.code
7665hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/root/secret:\
7666 otherhost/users/root/othersecret
7667.endd
7668For MySQL and PostgreSQL, a host may be specified as <&'name'&>:<&'port'&> but
7669because this is a colon-separated list, the colon has to be doubled. For each
7670query, these parameter groups are tried in order until a connection is made and
7671a query is successfully processed. The result of a query may be that no data is
7672found, but that is still a successful query. In other words, the list of
7673servers provides a backup facility, not a list of different places to look.
7674
7675For Redis the global option need not be specified if all queries contain their
7676own server information &-- see section &<<SECTspeserque>>&.
7677If specified, the option must be set to a colon-separated list of server
7678information.
7679Each item in the list is a slash-separated list of three items:
7680host, database number, and password.
7681.olist
7682The host is required and may be either an IPv4 address and optional
7683port number (separated by a colon, which needs doubling due to the
7684higher-level list), or a Unix socket pathname enclosed in parentheses
7685.next
7686The database number is optional; if present that number is selected in the backend
7687.next
7688The password is optional; if present it is used to authenticate to the backend
7689.endlist
7690
7691The &%quote_mysql%&, &%quote_pgsql%&, and &%quote_oracle%& expansion operators
7692convert newline, tab, carriage return, and backspace to \n, \t, \r, and \b
7693respectively, and the characters single-quote, double-quote, and backslash
7694itself are escaped with backslashes.
7695
7696The &%quote_redis%& expansion operator
7697escapes whitespace and backslash characters with a backslash.
7698
7699.section "Specifying the server in the query" "SECTspeserque"
7700For MySQL, PostgreSQL and Redis lookups (but not currently for Oracle and InterBase),
7701it is possible to specify a list of servers with an individual query. This is
7702done by starting the query with
7703.display
7704&`servers=`&&'server1:server2:server3:...'&&`;`&
7705.endd
7706Each item in the list may take one of two forms:
7707.olist
7708If it contains no slashes it is assumed to be just a host name. The appropriate
7709global option (&%mysql_servers%& or &%pgsql_servers%&) is searched for a host
7710of the same name, and the remaining parameters (database, user, password) are
7711taken from there.
7712.next
7713If it contains any slashes, it is taken as a complete parameter set.
7714.endlist
7715The list of servers is used in exactly the same way as the global list.
7716Once a connection to a server has happened and a query has been
7717successfully executed, processing of the lookup ceases.
7718
7719This feature is intended for use in master/slave situations where updates
7720are occurring and you want to update the master rather than a slave. If the
7721master is in the list as a backup for reading, you might have a global setting
7722like this:
7723.code
7724mysql_servers = slave1/db/name/pw:\
7725 slave2/db/name/pw:\
7726 master/db/name/pw
7727.endd
7728In an updating lookup, you could then write:
7729.code
7730${lookup mysql{servers=master; UPDATE ...} }
7731.endd
7732That query would then be sent only to the master server. If, on the other hand,
7733the master is not to be used for reading, and so is not present in the global
7734option, you can still update it by a query of this form:
7735.code
7736${lookup pgsql{servers=master/db/name/pw; UPDATE ...} }
7737.endd
7738
7739
7740.section "Special MySQL features" "SECID73"
7741For MySQL, an empty host name or the use of &"localhost"& in &%mysql_servers%&
7742causes a connection to the server on the local host by means of a Unix domain
7743socket. An alternate socket can be specified in parentheses.
7744An option group name for MySQL option files can be specified in square brackets;
7745the default value is &"exim"&.
7746The full syntax of each item in &%mysql_servers%& is:
7747.display
7748<&'hostname'&>::<&'port'&>(<&'socket name'&>)[<&'option group'&>]/&&&
7749 <&'database'&>/<&'user'&>/<&'password'&>
7750.endd
7751Any of the four sub-parts of the first field can be omitted. For normal use on
7752the local host it can be left blank or set to just &"localhost"&.
7753
7754No database need be supplied &-- but if it is absent here, it must be given in
7755the queries.
7756
7757If a MySQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert, update,
7758or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows affected.
7759
7760&*Warning*&: This can be misleading. If an update does not actually change
7761anything (for example, setting a field to the value it already has), the result
7762is zero because no rows are affected.
7763
7764
7765.section "Special PostgreSQL features" "SECID74"
7766PostgreSQL lookups can also use Unix domain socket connections to the database.
7767This is usually faster and costs less CPU time than a TCP/IP connection.
7768However it can be used only if the mail server runs on the same machine as the
7769database server. A configuration line for PostgreSQL via Unix domain sockets
7770looks like this:
7771.code
7772hide pgsql_servers = (/tmp/.s.PGSQL.5432)/db/user/password : ...
7773.endd
7774In other words, instead of supplying a host name, a path to the socket is
7775given. The path name is enclosed in parentheses so that its slashes aren't
7776visually confused with the delimiters for the other server parameters.
7777
7778If a PostgreSQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert,
7779update, or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows
7780affected.
7781
7782.section "More about SQLite" "SECTsqlite"
7783.cindex "lookup" "SQLite"
7784.cindex "sqlite lookup type"
7785SQLite is different to the other SQL lookups because a file name is required in
7786addition to the SQL query. An SQLite database is a single file, and there is no
7787daemon as in the other SQL databases. The interface to Exim requires the name
7788of the file, as an absolute path, to be given at the start of the query. It is
7789separated from the query by white space. This means that the path name cannot
7790contain white space. Here is a lookup expansion example:
7791.code
7792${lookup sqlite {/some/thing/sqlitedb \
7793 select name from aliases where id='userx';}}
7794.endd
7795In a list, the syntax is similar. For example:
7796.code
7797domainlist relay_to_domains = sqlite;/some/thing/sqlitedb \
7798 select * from relays where ip='$sender_host_address';
7799.endd
7800The only character affected by the &%quote_sqlite%& operator is a single
7801quote, which it doubles.
7802
7803.cindex timeout SQLite
7804.cindex sqlite "lookup timeout"
7805The SQLite library handles multiple simultaneous accesses to the database
7806internally. Multiple readers are permitted, but only one process can
7807update at once. Attempts to access the database while it is being updated
7808are rejected after a timeout period, during which the SQLite library
7809waits for the lock to be released. In Exim, the default timeout is set
7810to 5 seconds, but it can be changed by means of the &%sqlite_lock_timeout%&
7811option.
7812
7813.section "More about Redis" "SECTredis"
7814.cindex "lookup" "Redis"
7815.cindex "redis lookup type"
7816Redis is a non-SQL database. Commands are simple get and set.
7817Examples:
7818.code
7819${lookup redis{set keyname ${quote_redis:objvalue plus}}}
7820${lookup redis{get keyname}}
7821.endd
7822
7823.ecindex IIDfidalo1
7824.ecindex IIDfidalo2
7825
7826
7827. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7828. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7829
7830.chapter "Domain, host, address, and local part lists" &&&
7831 "CHAPdomhosaddlists" &&&
7832 "Domain, host, and address lists"
7833.scindex IIDdohoadli "lists of domains; hosts; etc."
7834A number of Exim configuration options contain lists of domains, hosts,
7835email addresses, or local parts. For example, the &%hold_domains%& option
7836contains a list of domains whose delivery is currently suspended. These lists
7837are also used as data in ACL statements (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), and as
7838arguments to expansion conditions such as &%match_domain%&.
7839
7840Each item in one of these lists is a pattern to be matched against a domain,
7841host, email address, or local part, respectively. In the sections below, the
7842different types of pattern for each case are described, but first we cover some
7843general facilities that apply to all four kinds of list.
7844
7845Note that other parts of Exim use a &'string list'& which does not
7846support all the complexity available in
7847domain, host, address and local part lists.
7848
7849
7850
7851.section "Expansion of lists" "SECTlistexpand"
7852.cindex "expansion" "of lists"
7853Each list is expanded as a single string before it is used.
7854
7855&'Exception: the router headers_remove option, where list-item
7856splitting is done before string-expansion.'&
7857
7858The result of
7859expansion must be a list, possibly containing empty items, which is split up
7860into separate items for matching. By default, colon is the separator character,
7861but this can be varied if necessary. See sections &<<SECTlistconstruct>>& and
7862&<<SECTempitelis>>& for details of the list syntax; the second of these
7863discusses the way to specify empty list items.
7864
7865
7866If the string expansion is forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the item it is
7867testing (domain, host, address, or local part) is not in the list. Other
7868expansion failures cause temporary errors.
7869
7870If an item in a list is a regular expression, backslashes, dollars and possibly
7871other special characters in the expression must be protected against
7872misinterpretation by the string expander. The easiest way to do this is to use
7873the &`\N`& expansion feature to indicate that the contents of the regular
7874expression should not be expanded. For example, in an ACL you might have:
7875.code
7876deny senders = \N^\d{8}\w@.*\.baddomain\.example$\N : \
7877 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/badsenders/bydomain}}
7878.endd
7879The first item is a regular expression that is protected from expansion by
7880&`\N`&, whereas the second uses the expansion to obtain a list of unwanted
7881senders based on the receiving domain.
7882
7883
7884
7885
7886.section "Negated items in lists" "SECID76"
7887.cindex "list" "negation"
7888.cindex "negation" "in lists"
7889Items in a list may be positive or negative. Negative items are indicated by a
7890leading exclamation mark, which may be followed by optional white space. A list
7891defines a set of items (domains, etc). When Exim processes one of these lists,
7892it is trying to find out whether a domain, host, address, or local part
7893(respectively) is in the set that is defined by the list. It works like this:
7894
7895The list is scanned from left to right. If a positive item is matched, the
7896subject that is being checked is in the set; if a negative item is matched, the
7897subject is not in the set. If the end of the list is reached without the
7898subject having matched any of the patterns, it is in the set if the last item
7899was a negative one, but not if it was a positive one. For example, the list in
7900.code
7901domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c : *.b.c
7902.endd
7903matches any domain ending in &'.b.c'& except for &'a.b.c'&. Domains that match
7904neither &'a.b.c'& nor &'*.b.c'& do not match, because the last item in the
7905list is positive. However, if the setting were
7906.code
7907domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c
7908.endd
7909then all domains other than &'a.b.c'& would match because the last item in the
7910list is negative. In other words, a list that ends with a negative item behaves
7911as if it had an extra item &`:*`& on the end.
7912
7913Another way of thinking about positive and negative items in lists is to read
7914the connector as &"or"& after a positive item and as &"and"& after a negative
7915item.
7916
7917
7918
7919.section "File names in lists" "SECTfilnamlis"
7920.cindex "list" "file name in"
7921If an item in a domain, host, address, or local part list is an absolute file
7922name (beginning with a slash character), each line of the file is read and
7923processed as if it were an independent item in the list, except that further
7924file names are not allowed,
7925and no expansion of the data from the file takes place.
7926Empty lines in the file are ignored, and the file may also contain comment
7927lines:
7928
7929.ilist
7930For domain and host lists, if a # character appears anywhere in a line of the
7931file, it and all following characters are ignored.
7932.next
7933Because local parts may legitimately contain # characters, a comment in an
7934address list or local part list file is recognized only if # is preceded by
7935white space or the start of the line. For example:
7936.code
7937not#comment@x.y.z # but this is a comment
7938.endd
7939.endlist
7940
7941Putting a file name in a list has the same effect as inserting each line of the
7942file as an item in the list (blank lines and comments excepted). However, there
7943is one important difference: the file is read each time the list is processed,
7944so if its contents vary over time, Exim's behaviour changes.
7945
7946If a file name is preceded by an exclamation mark, the sense of any match
7947within the file is inverted. For example, if
7948.code
7949hold_domains = !/etc/nohold-domains
7950.endd
7951and the file contains the lines
7952.code
7953!a.b.c
7954*.b.c
7955.endd
7956then &'a.b.c'& is in the set of domains defined by &%hold_domains%&, whereas
7957any domain matching &`*.b.c`& is not.
7958
7959
7960
7961.section "An lsearch file is not an out-of-line list" "SECID77"
7962As will be described in the sections that follow, lookups can be used in lists
7963to provide indexed methods of checking list membership. There has been some
7964confusion about the way &(lsearch)& lookups work in lists. Because
7965an &(lsearch)& file contains plain text and is scanned sequentially, it is
7966sometimes thought that it is allowed to contain wild cards and other kinds of
7967non-constant pattern. This is not the case. The keys in an &(lsearch)& file are
7968always fixed strings, just as for any other single-key lookup type.
7969
7970If you want to use a file to contain wild-card patterns that form part of a
7971list, just give the file name on its own, without a search type, as described
7972in the previous section. You could also use the &(wildlsearch)& or
7973&(nwildlsearch)&, but there is no advantage in doing this.
7974
7975
7976
7977
7978.section "Named lists" "SECTnamedlists"
7979.cindex "named lists"
7980.cindex "list" "named"
7981A list of domains, hosts, email addresses, or local parts can be given a name
7982which is then used to refer to the list elsewhere in the configuration. This is
7983particularly convenient if the same list is required in several different
7984places. It also allows lists to be given meaningful names, which can improve
7985the readability of the configuration. For example, it is conventional to define
7986a domain list called &'local_domains'& for all the domains that are handled
7987locally on a host, using a configuration line such as
7988.code
7989domainlist local_domains = localhost:my.dom.example
7990.endd
7991Named lists are referenced by giving their name preceded by a plus sign, so,
7992for example, a router that is intended to handle local domains would be
7993configured with the line
7994.code
7995domains = +local_domains
7996.endd
7997The first router in a configuration is often one that handles all domains
7998except the local ones, using a configuration with a negated item like this:
7999.code
8000dnslookup:
8001 driver = dnslookup
8002 domains = ! +local_domains
8003 transport = remote_smtp
8004 no_more
8005.endd
8006The four kinds of named list are created by configuration lines starting with
8007the words &%domainlist%&, &%hostlist%&, &%addresslist%&, or &%localpartlist%&,
8008respectively. Then there follows the name that you are defining, followed by an
8009equals sign and the list itself. For example:
8010.code
8011hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.23.0/24 : my.friend.example
8012addresslist bad_senders = cdb;/etc/badsenders
8013.endd
8014A named list may refer to other named lists:
8015.code
8016domainlist dom1 = first.example : second.example
8017domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : third.example
8018domainlist dom3 = fourth.example : +dom2 : fifth.example
8019.endd
8020&*Warning*&: If the last item in a referenced list is a negative one, the
8021effect may not be what you intended, because the negation does not propagate
8022out to the higher level. For example, consider:
8023.code
8024domainlist dom1 = !a.b
8025domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : *.b
8026.endd
8027The second list specifies &"either in the &%dom1%& list or &'*.b'&"&. The first
8028list specifies just &"not &'a.b'&"&, so the domain &'x.y'& matches it. That
8029means it matches the second list as well. The effect is not the same as
8030.code
8031domainlist dom2 = !a.b : *.b
8032.endd
8033where &'x.y'& does not match. It's best to avoid negation altogether in
8034referenced lists if you can.
8035
8036Named lists may have a performance advantage. When Exim is routing an
8037address or checking an incoming message, it caches the result of tests on named
8038lists. So, if you have a setting such as
8039.code
8040domains = +local_domains
8041.endd
8042on several of your routers
8043or in several ACL statements,
8044the actual test is done only for the first one. However, the caching works only
8045if there are no expansions within the list itself or any sublists that it
8046references. In other words, caching happens only for lists that are known to be
8047the same each time they are referenced.
8048
8049By default, there may be up to 16 named lists of each type. This limit can be
8050extended by changing a compile-time variable. The use of domain and host lists
8051is recommended for concepts such as local domains, relay domains, and relay
8052hosts. The default configuration is set up like this.
8053
8054
8055
8056.section "Named lists compared with macros" "SECID78"
8057.cindex "list" "named compared with macro"
8058.cindex "macro" "compared with named list"
8059At first sight, named lists might seem to be no different from macros in the
8060configuration file. However, macros are just textual substitutions. If you
8061write
8062.code
8063ALIST = host1 : host2
8064auth_advertise_hosts = !ALIST
8065.endd
8066it probably won't do what you want, because that is exactly the same as
8067.code
8068auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : host2
8069.endd
8070Notice that the second host name is not negated. However, if you use a host
8071list, and write
8072.code
8073hostlist alist = host1 : host2
8074auth_advertise_hosts = ! +alist
8075.endd
8076the negation applies to the whole list, and so that is equivalent to
8077.code
8078auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : !host2
8079.endd
8080
8081
8082.section "Named list caching" "SECID79"
8083.cindex "list" "caching of named"
8084.cindex "caching" "named lists"
8085While processing a message, Exim caches the result of checking a named list if
8086it is sure that the list is the same each time. In practice, this means that
8087the cache operates only if the list contains no $ characters, which guarantees
8088that it will not change when it is expanded. Sometimes, however, you may have
8089an expanded list that you know will be the same each time within a given
8090message. For example:
8091.code
8092domainlist special_domains = \
8093 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}cdb{/some/file}}
8094.endd
8095This provides a list of domains that depends only on the sending host's IP
8096address. If this domain list is referenced a number of times (for example,
8097in several ACL lines, or in several routers) the result of the check is not
8098cached by default, because Exim does not know that it is going to be the
8099same list each time.
8100
8101By appending &`_cache`& to &`domainlist`& you can tell Exim to go ahead and
8102cache the result anyway. For example:
8103.code
8104domainlist_cache special_domains = ${lookup{...
8105.endd
8106If you do this, you should be absolutely sure that caching is going to do
8107the right thing in all cases. When in doubt, leave it out.
8108
8109
8110
8111.section "Domain lists" "SECTdomainlist"
8112.cindex "domain list" "patterns for"
8113.cindex "list" "domain list"
8114Domain lists contain patterns that are to be matched against a mail domain.
8115The following types of item may appear in domain lists:
8116
8117.ilist
8118.cindex "primary host name"
8119.cindex "host name" "matched in domain list"
8120.oindex "&%primary_hostname%&"
8121.cindex "domain list" "matching primary host name"
8122.cindex "@ in a domain list"
8123If a pattern consists of a single @ character, it matches the local host name,
8124as set by the &%primary_hostname%& option (or defaulted). This makes it
8125possible to use the same configuration file on several different hosts that
8126differ only in their names.
8127.next
8128.cindex "@[] in a domain list"
8129.cindex "domain list" "matching local IP interfaces"
8130.cindex "domain literal"
8131If a pattern consists of the string &`@[]`& it matches an IP address enclosed
8132in square brackets (as in an email address that contains a domain literal), but
8133only if that IP address is recognized as local for email routing purposes. The
8134&%local_interfaces%& and &%extra_local_interfaces%& options can be used to
8135control which of a host's several IP addresses are treated as local.
8136In today's Internet, the use of domain literals is controversial.
8137.next
8138.cindex "@mx_any"
8139.cindex "@mx_primary"
8140.cindex "@mx_secondary"
8141.cindex "domain list" "matching MX pointers to local host"
8142If a pattern consists of the string &`@mx_any`& it matches any domain that
8143has an MX record pointing to the local host or to any host that is listed in
8144.oindex "&%hosts_treat_as_local%&"
8145&%hosts_treat_as_local%&. The items &`@mx_primary`& and &`@mx_secondary`&
8146are similar, except that the first matches only when a primary MX target is the
8147local host, and the second only when no primary MX target is the local host,
8148but a secondary MX target is. &"Primary"& means an MX record with the lowest
8149preference value &-- there may of course be more than one of them.
8150
8151The MX lookup that takes place when matching a pattern of this type is
8152performed with the resolver options for widening names turned off. Thus, for
8153example, a single-component domain will &'not'& be expanded by adding the
8154resolver's default domain. See the &%qualify_single%& and &%search_parents%&
8155options of the &(dnslookup)& router for a discussion of domain widening.
8156
8157Sometimes you may want to ignore certain IP addresses when using one of these
8158patterns. You can specify this by following the pattern with &`/ignore=`&<&'ip
8159list'&>, where <&'ip list'&> is a list of IP addresses. These addresses are
8160ignored when processing the pattern (compare the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option
8161on a router). For example:
8162.code
8163domains = @mx_any/ignore=127.0.0.1
8164.endd
8165This example matches any domain that has an MX record pointing to one of
8166the local host's IP addresses other than 127.0.0.1.
8167
8168The list of IP addresses is in fact processed by the same code that processes
8169host lists, so it may contain CIDR-coded network specifications and it may also
8170contain negative items.
8171
8172Because the list of IP addresses is a sublist within a domain list, you have to
8173be careful about delimiters if there is more than one address. Like any other
8174list, the default delimiter can be changed. Thus, you might have:
8175.code
8176domains = @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;0.0.0.0 : \
8177 an.other.domain : ...
8178.endd
8179so that the sublist uses semicolons for delimiters. When IPv6 addresses are
8180involved, it is easiest to change the delimiter for the main list as well:
8181.code
8182domains = <? @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;::1 ? \
8183 an.other.domain ? ...
8184.endd
8185.next
8186.cindex "asterisk" "in domain list"
8187.cindex "domain list" "asterisk in"
8188.cindex "domain list" "matching &""ends with""&"
8189If a pattern starts with an asterisk, the remaining characters of the pattern
8190are compared with the terminating characters of the domain. The use of &"*"& in
8191domain lists differs from its use in partial matching lookups. In a domain
8192list, the character following the asterisk need not be a dot, whereas partial
8193matching works only in terms of dot-separated components. For example, a domain
8194list item such as &`*key.ex`& matches &'donkey.ex'& as well as
8195&'cipher.key.ex'&.
8196
8197.next
8198.cindex "regular expressions" "in domain list"
8199.cindex "domain list" "matching regular expression"
8200If a pattern starts with a circumflex character, it is treated as a regular
8201expression, and matched against the domain using a regular expression matching
8202function. The circumflex is treated as part of the regular expression.
8203Email domains are case-independent, so this regular expression match is by
8204default case-independent, but you can make it case-dependent by starting it
8205with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the syntax of regular expressions
8206are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&.
8207
8208&*Warning*&: Because domain lists are expanded before being processed, you
8209must escape any backslash and dollar characters in the regular expression, or
8210use the special &`\N`& sequence (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&) to specify that
8211it is not to be expanded (unless you really do want to build a regular
8212expression by expansion, of course).
8213.next
8214.cindex "lookup" "in domain list"
8215.cindex "domain list" "matching by lookup"
8216If a pattern starts with the name of a single-key lookup type followed by a
8217semicolon (for example, &"dbm;"& or &"lsearch;"&), the remainder of the pattern
8218must be a file name in a suitable format for the lookup type. For example, for
8219&"cdb;"& it must be an absolute path:
8220.code
8221domains = cdb;/etc/mail/local_domains.cdb
8222.endd
8223The appropriate type of lookup is done on the file using the domain name as the
8224key. In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used; Exim is interested
8225only in whether or not the key is present in the file. However, when a lookup
8226is used for the &%domains%& option on a router
8227or a &%domains%& condition in an ACL statement, the data is preserved in the
8228&$domain_data$& variable and can be referred to in other router options or
8229other statements in the same ACL.
8230
8231.next
8232Any of the single-key lookup type names may be preceded by
8233&`partial`&<&'n'&>&`-`&, where the <&'n'&> is optional, for example,
8234.code
8235domains = partial-dbm;/partial/domains
8236.endd
8237This causes partial matching logic to be invoked; a description of how this
8238works is given in section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&.
8239
8240.next
8241.cindex "asterisk" "in lookup type"
8242Any of the single-key lookup types may be followed by an asterisk. This causes
8243a default lookup for a key consisting of a single asterisk to be done if the
8244original lookup fails. This is not a useful feature when using a domain list to
8245select particular domains (because any domain would match), but it might have
8246value if the result of the lookup is being used via the &$domain_data$&
8247expansion variable.
8248.next
8249If the pattern starts with the name of a query-style lookup type followed by a
8250semicolon (for example, &"nisplus;"& or &"ldap;"&), the remainder of the
8251pattern must be an appropriate query for the lookup type, as described in
8252chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example:
8253.code
8254hold_domains = mysql;select domain from holdlist \
8255 where domain = '${quote_mysql:$domain}';
8256.endd
8257In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used (so for an SQL query, for
8258example, it doesn't matter what field you select). Exim is interested only in
8259whether or not the query succeeds. However, when a lookup is used for the
8260&%domains%& option on a router, the data is preserved in the &$domain_data$&
8261variable and can be referred to in other options.
8262.next
8263.cindex "domain list" "matching literal domain name"
8264If none of the above cases apply, a caseless textual comparison is made
8265between the pattern and the domain.
8266.endlist
8267
8268Here is an example that uses several different kinds of pattern:
8269.code
8270domainlist funny_domains = \
8271 @ : \
8272 lib.unseen.edu : \
8273 *.foundation.fict.example : \
8274 \N^[1-2]\d{3}\.fict\.example$\N : \
8275 partial-dbm;/opt/data/penguin/book : \
8276 nis;domains.byname : \
8277 nisplus;[name=$domain,status=local],domains.org_dir
8278.endd
8279There are obvious processing trade-offs among the various matching modes. Using
8280an asterisk is faster than a regular expression, and listing a few names
8281explicitly probably is too. The use of a file or database lookup is expensive,
8282but may be the only option if hundreds of names are required. Because the
8283patterns are tested in order, it makes sense to put the most commonly matched
8284patterns earlier.
8285
8286
8287
8288.section "Host lists" "SECThostlist"
8289.cindex "host list" "patterns in"
8290.cindex "list" "host list"
8291Host lists are used to control what remote hosts are allowed to do. For
8292example, some hosts may be allowed to use the local host as a relay, and some
8293may be permitted to use the SMTP ETRN command. Hosts can be identified in
8294two different ways, by name or by IP address. In a host list, some types of
8295pattern are matched to a host name, and some are matched to an IP address.
8296You need to be particularly careful with this when single-key lookups are
8297involved, to ensure that the right value is being used as the key.
8298
8299
8300.section "Special host list patterns" "SECID80"
8301.cindex "empty item in hosts list"
8302.cindex "host list" "empty string in"
8303If a host list item is the empty string, it matches only when no remote host is
8304involved. This is the case when a message is being received from a local
8305process using SMTP on the standard input, that is, when a TCP/IP connection is
8306not used.
8307
8308.cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8309The special pattern &"*"& in a host list matches any host or no host. Neither
8310the IP address nor the name is actually inspected.
8311
8312
8313
8314.section "Host list patterns that match by IP address" "SECThoslispatip"
8315.cindex "host list" "matching IP addresses"
8316If an IPv4 host calls an IPv6 host and the call is accepted on an IPv6 socket,
8317the incoming address actually appears in the IPv6 host as
8318&`::ffff:`&<&'v4address'&>. When such an address is tested against a host
8319list, it is converted into a traditional IPv4 address first. (Not all operating
8320systems accept IPv4 calls on IPv6 sockets, as there have been some security
8321concerns.)
8322
8323The following types of pattern in a host list check the remote host by
8324inspecting its IP address:
8325
8326.ilist
8327If the pattern is a plain domain name (not a regular expression, not starting
8328with *, not a lookup of any kind), Exim calls the operating system function
8329to find the associated IP address(es). Exim uses the newer
8330&[getipnodebyname()]& function when available, otherwise &[gethostbyname()]&.
8331This typically causes a forward DNS lookup of the name. The result is compared
8332with the IP address of the subject host.
8333
8334If there is a temporary problem (such as a DNS timeout) with the host name
8335lookup, a temporary error occurs. For example, if the list is being used in an
8336ACL condition, the ACL gives a &"defer"& response, usually leading to a
8337temporary SMTP error code. If no IP address can be found for the host name,
8338what happens is described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8339
8340.next
8341.cindex "@ in a host list"
8342If the pattern is &"@"&, the primary host name is substituted and used as a
8343domain name, as just described.
8344
8345.next
8346If the pattern is an IP address, it is matched against the IP address of the
8347subject host. IPv4 addresses are given in the normal &"dotted-quad"& notation.
8348IPv6 addresses can be given in colon-separated format, but the colons have to
8349be doubled so as not to be taken as item separators when the default list
8350separator is used. IPv6 addresses are recognized even when Exim is compiled
8351without IPv6 support. This means that if they appear in a host list on an
8352IPv4-only host, Exim will not treat them as host names. They are just addresses
8353that can never match a client host.
8354
8355.next
8356.cindex "@[] in a host list"
8357If the pattern is &"@[]"&, it matches the IP address of any IP interface on
8358the local host. For example, if the local host is an IPv4 host with one
8359interface address 10.45.23.56, these two ACL statements have the same effect:
8360.code
8361accept hosts = 127.0.0.1 : 10.45.23.56
8362accept hosts = @[]
8363.endd
8364.next
8365.cindex "CIDR notation"
8366If the pattern is an IP address followed by a slash and a mask length (for
8367example 10.11.42.0/24), it is matched against the IP address of the subject
8368host under the given mask. This allows, an entire network of hosts to be
8369included (or excluded) by a single item. The mask uses CIDR notation; it
8370specifies the number of address bits that must match, starting from the most
8371significant end of the address.
8372
8373&*Note*&: The mask is &'not'& a count of addresses, nor is it the high number
8374of a range of addresses. It is the number of bits in the network portion of the
8375address. The above example specifies a 24-bit netmask, so it matches all 256
8376addresses in the 10.11.42.0 network. An item such as
8377.code
8378192.168.23.236/31
8379.endd
8380matches just two addresses, 192.168.23.236 and 192.168.23.237. A mask value of
838132 for an IPv4 address is the same as no mask at all; just a single address
8382matches.
8383
8384Here is another example which shows an IPv4 and an IPv6 network:
8385.code
8386recipient_unqualified_hosts = 192.168.0.0/16: \
8387 3ffe::ffff::836f::::/48
8388.endd
8389The doubling of list separator characters applies only when these items
8390appear inline in a host list. It is not required when indirecting via a file.
8391For example:
8392.code
8393recipient_unqualified_hosts = /opt/exim/unqualnets
8394.endd
8395could make use of a file containing
8396.code
8397172.16.0.0/12
83983ffe:ffff:836f::/48
8399.endd
8400to have exactly the same effect as the previous example. When listing IPv6
8401addresses inline, it is usually more convenient to use the facility for
8402changing separator characters. This list contains the same two networks:
8403.code
8404recipient_unqualified_hosts = <; 172.16.0.0/12; \
8405 3ffe:ffff:836f::/48
8406.endd
8407The separator is changed to semicolon by the leading &"<;"& at the start of the
8408list.
8409.endlist
8410
8411
8412
8413.section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host address" &&&
8414 "SECThoslispatsikey"
8415.cindex "host list" "lookup of IP address"
8416When a host is to be identified by a single-key lookup of its complete IP
8417address, the pattern takes this form:
8418.display
8419&`net-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8420.endd
8421For example:
8422.code
8423hosts_lookup = net-cdb;/hosts-by-ip.db
8424.endd
8425The text form of the IP address of the subject host is used as the lookup key.
8426IPv6 addresses are converted to an unabbreviated form, using lower case
8427letters, with dots as separators because colon is the key terminator in
8428&(lsearch)& files. [Colons can in fact be used in keys in &(lsearch)& files by
8429quoting the keys, but this is a facility that was added later.] The data
8430returned by the lookup is not used.
8431
8432.cindex "IP address" "masking"
8433.cindex "host list" "masked IP address"
8434Single-key lookups can also be performed using masked IP addresses, using
8435patterns of this form:
8436.display
8437&`net<`&&'number'&&`>-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8438.endd
8439For example:
8440.code
8441net24-dbm;/networks.db
8442.endd
8443The IP address of the subject host is masked using <&'number'&> as the mask
8444length. A textual string is constructed from the masked value, followed by the
8445mask, and this is used as the lookup key. For example, if the host's IP address
8446is 192.168.34.6, the key that is looked up for the above example is
8447&"192.168.34.0/24"&.
8448
8449When an IPv6 address is converted to a string, dots are normally used instead
8450of colons, so that keys in &(lsearch)& files need not contain colons (which
8451terminate &(lsearch)& keys). This was implemented some time before the ability
8452to quote keys was made available in &(lsearch)& files. However, the more
8453recently implemented &(iplsearch)& files do require colons in IPv6 keys
8454(notated using the quoting facility) so as to distinguish them from IPv4 keys.
8455For this reason, when the lookup type is &(iplsearch)&, IPv6 addresses are
8456converted using colons and not dots. In all cases, full, unabbreviated IPv6
8457addresses are always used.
8458
8459Ideally, it would be nice to tidy up this anomalous situation by changing to
8460colons in all cases, given that quoting is now available for &(lsearch)&.
8461However, this would be an incompatible change that might break some existing
8462configurations.
8463
8464&*Warning*&: Specifying &%net32-%& (for an IPv4 address) or &%net128-%& (for an
8465IPv6 address) is not the same as specifying just &%net-%& without a number. In
8466the former case the key strings include the mask value, whereas in the latter
8467case the IP address is used on its own.
8468
8469
8470
8471.section "Host list patterns that match by host name" "SECThoslispatnam"
8472.cindex "host" "lookup failures"
8473.cindex "unknown host name"
8474.cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8475There are several types of pattern that require Exim to know the name of the
8476remote host. These are either wildcard patterns or lookups by name. (If a
8477complete hostname is given without any wildcarding, it is used to find an IP
8478address to match against, as described in section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&
8479above.)
8480
8481If the remote host name is not already known when Exim encounters one of these
8482patterns, it has to be found from the IP address.
8483Although many sites on the Internet are conscientious about maintaining reverse
8484DNS data for their hosts, there are also many that do not do this.
8485Consequently, a name cannot always be found, and this may lead to unwanted
8486effects. Take care when configuring host lists with wildcarded name patterns.
8487Consider what will happen if a name cannot be found.
8488
8489Because of the problems of determining host names from IP addresses, matching
8490against host names is not as common as matching against IP addresses.
8491
8492By default, in order to find a host name, Exim first does a reverse DNS lookup;
8493if no name is found in the DNS, the system function (&[gethostbyaddr()]& or
8494&[getipnodebyaddr()]& if available) is tried. The order in which these lookups
8495are done can be changed by setting the &%host_lookup_order%& option. For
8496security, once Exim has found one or more names, it looks up the IP addresses
8497for these names and compares them with the IP address that it started with.
8498Only those names whose IP addresses match are accepted. Any other names are
8499discarded. If no names are left, Exim behaves as if the host name cannot be
8500found. In the most common case there is only one name and one IP address.
8501
8502There are some options that control what happens if a host name cannot be
8503found. These are described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8504
8505.cindex "host" "alias for"
8506.cindex "alias for host"
8507As a result of aliasing, hosts may have more than one name. When processing any
8508of the following types of pattern, all the host's names are checked:
8509
8510.ilist
8511.cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8512If a pattern starts with &"*"& the remainder of the item must match the end of
8513the host name. For example, &`*.b.c`& matches all hosts whose names end in
8514&'.b.c'&. This special simple form is provided because this is a very common
8515requirement. Other kinds of wildcarding require the use of a regular
8516expression.
8517.next
8518.cindex "regular expressions" "in host list"
8519.cindex "host list" "regular expression in"
8520If the item starts with &"^"& it is taken to be a regular expression which is
8521matched against the host name. Host names are case-independent, so this regular
8522expression match is by default case-independent, but you can make it
8523case-dependent by starting it with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the
8524syntax of regular expressions are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&. For
8525example,
8526.code
8527^(a|b)\.c\.d$
8528.endd
8529is a regular expression that matches either of the two hosts &'a.c.d'& or
8530&'b.c.d'&. When a regular expression is used in a host list, you must take care
8531that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted as part of the
8532string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`& to mark that
8533part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8534.code
8535sender_unqualified_hosts = \N^(a|b)\.c\.d$\N : ....
8536.endd
8537&*Warning*&: If you want to match a complete host name, you must include the
8538&`$`& terminating metacharacter in the regular expression, as in the above
8539example. Without it, a match at the start of the host name is all that is
8540required.
8541.endlist
8542
8543
8544
8545
8546.section "Behaviour when an IP address or name cannot be found" "SECTbehipnot"
8547.cindex "host" "lookup failures, permanent"
8548While processing a host list, Exim may need to look up an IP address from a
8549name (see section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&), or it may need to look up a host name
8550from an IP address (see section &<<SECThoslispatnam>>&). In either case, the
8551behaviour when it fails to find the information it is seeking is the same.
8552
8553&*Note*&: This section applies to permanent lookup failures. It does &'not'&
8554apply to temporary DNS errors, whose handling is described in the next section.
8555
8556.cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
8557.cindex "&`+ignore_unknown`&"
8558Exim parses a host list from left to right. If it encounters a permanent
8559lookup failure in any item in the host list before it has found a match,
8560Exim treats it as a failure and the default behavior is as if the host
8561does not match the list. This may not always be what you want to happen.
8562To change Exim's behaviour, the special items &`+include_unknown`& or
8563&`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the list (at top level &-- they are
8564not recognized in an indirected file).
8565
8566.ilist
8567If any item that follows &`+include_unknown`& requires information that
8568cannot found, Exim behaves as if the host does match the list. For example,
8569.code
8570host_reject_connection = +include_unknown:*.enemy.ex
8571.endd
8572rejects connections from any host whose name matches &`*.enemy.ex`&, and also
8573any hosts whose name it cannot find.
8574
8575.next
8576If any item that follows &`+ignore_unknown`& requires information that cannot
8577be found, Exim ignores that item and proceeds to the rest of the list. For
8578example:
8579.code
8580accept hosts = +ignore_unknown : friend.example : \
8581 192.168.4.5
8582.endd
8583accepts from any host whose name is &'friend.example'& and from 192.168.4.5,
8584whether or not its host name can be found. Without &`+ignore_unknown`&, if no
8585name can be found for 192.168.4.5, it is rejected.
8586.endlist
8587
8588Both &`+include_unknown`& and &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the same
8589list. The effect of each one lasts until the next, or until the end of the
8590list.
8591
8592.section "Mixing wildcarded host names and addresses in host lists" &&&
8593 "SECTmixwilhos"
8594.cindex "host list" "mixing names and addresses in"
8595
8596This section explains the host/ip processing logic with the same concepts
8597as the previous section, but specifically addresses what happens when a
8598wildcarded hostname is one of the items in the hostlist.
8599
8600.ilist
8601If you have name lookups or wildcarded host names and
8602IP addresses in the same host list, you should normally put the IP
8603addresses first. For example, in an ACL you could have:
8604.code
8605accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : *.friend.example
8606.endd
8607The reason you normally would order it this way lies in the
8608left-to-right way that Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses
8609without doing any DNS lookups, but when it reaches an item that requires
8610a host name, it fails if it cannot find a host name to compare with the
8611pattern. If the above list is given in the opposite order, the
8612&%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be found, even
8613if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
8614
8615.next
8616If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
8617address, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
8618.code
8619accept hosts = *.friend.example
8620accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
8621.endd
8622If the first &%accept%& fails, Exim goes on to try the second one. See chapter
8623&<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs. Alternatively, you can use
8624&`+ignore_unknown`&, which was discussed in depth in the first example in
8625this section.
8626.endlist
8627
8628
8629.section "Temporary DNS errors when looking up host information" &&&
8630 "SECTtemdnserr"
8631.cindex "host" "lookup failures, temporary"
8632.cindex "&`+include_defer`&"
8633.cindex "&`+ignore_defer`&"
8634A temporary DNS lookup failure normally causes a defer action (except when
8635&%dns_again_means_nonexist%& converts it into a permanent error). However,
8636host lists can include &`+ignore_defer`& and &`+include_defer`&, analogous to
8637&`+ignore_unknown`& and &`+include_unknown`&, as described in the previous
8638section. These options should be used with care, probably only in non-critical
8639host lists such as whitelists.
8640
8641
8642
8643.section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host name" &&&
8644 "SECThoslispatnamsk"
8645.cindex "unknown host name"
8646.cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8647If a pattern is of the form
8648.display
8649<&'single-key-search-type'&>;<&'search-data'&>
8650.endd
8651for example
8652.code
8653dbm;/host/accept/list
8654.endd
8655a single-key lookup is performed, using the host name as its key. If the
8656lookup succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual data that is looked up
8657is not used.
8658
8659&*Reminder*&: With this kind of pattern, you must have host &'names'& as
8660keys in the file, not IP addresses. If you want to do lookups based on IP
8661addresses, you must precede the search type with &"net-"& (see section
8662&<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&). There is, however, no reason why you could not use
8663two items in the same list, one doing an address lookup and one doing a name
8664lookup, both using the same file.
8665
8666
8667
8668.section "Host list patterns for query-style lookups" "SECID81"
8669If a pattern is of the form
8670.display
8671<&'query-style-search-type'&>;<&'query'&>
8672.endd
8673the query is obeyed, and if it succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual
8674data that is looked up is not used. The variables &$sender_host_address$& and
8675&$sender_host_name$& can be used in the query. For example:
8676.code
8677hosts_lookup = pgsql;\
8678 select ip from hostlist where ip='$sender_host_address'
8679.endd
8680The value of &$sender_host_address$& for an IPv6 address contains colons. You
8681can use the &%sg%& expansion item to change this if you need to. If you want to
8682use masked IP addresses in database queries, you can use the &%mask%& expansion
8683operator.
8684
8685If the query contains a reference to &$sender_host_name$&, Exim automatically
8686looks up the host name if it has not already done so. (See section
8687&<<SECThoslispatnam>>& for comments on finding host names.)
8688
8689Historical note: prior to release 4.30, Exim would always attempt to find a
8690host name before running the query, unless the search type was preceded by
8691&`net-`&. This is no longer the case. For backwards compatibility, &`net-`& is
8692still recognized for query-style lookups, but its presence or absence has no
8693effect. (Of course, for single-key lookups, &`net-`& &'is'& important.
8694See section &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&.)
8695
8696
8697
8698
8699
8700.section "Address lists" "SECTaddresslist"
8701.cindex "list" "address list"
8702.cindex "address list" "empty item"
8703.cindex "address list" "patterns"
8704Address lists contain patterns that are matched against mail addresses. There
8705is one special case to be considered: the sender address of a bounce message is
8706always empty. You can test for this by providing an empty item in an address
8707list. For example, you can set up a router to process bounce messages by
8708using this option setting:
8709.code
8710senders = :
8711.endd
8712The presence of the colon creates an empty item. If you do not provide any
8713data, the list is empty and matches nothing. The empty sender can also be
8714detected by a regular expression that matches an empty string,
8715and by a query-style lookup that succeeds when &$sender_address$& is empty.
8716
8717Non-empty items in an address list can be straightforward email addresses. For
8718example:
8719.code
8720senders = jbc@askone.example : hs@anacreon.example
8721.endd
8722A certain amount of wildcarding is permitted. If a pattern contains an @
8723character, but is not a regular expression and does not begin with a
8724semicolon-terminated lookup type (described below), the local part of the
8725subject address is compared with the local part of the pattern, which may start
8726with an asterisk. If the local parts match, the domain is checked in exactly
8727the same way as for a pattern in a domain list. For example, the domain can be
8728wildcarded, refer to a named list, or be a lookup:
8729.code
8730deny senders = *@*.spamming.site:\
8731 *@+hostile_domains:\
8732 bozo@partial-lsearch;/list/of/dodgy/sites:\
8733 *@dbm;/bad/domains.db
8734.endd
8735.cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8736.cindex "address list" "local part starting with !"
8737If a local part that begins with an exclamation mark is required, it has to be
8738specified using a regular expression, because otherwise the exclamation mark is
8739treated as a sign of negation, as is standard in lists.
8740
8741If a non-empty pattern that is not a regular expression or a lookup does not
8742contain an @ character, it is matched against the domain part of the subject
8743address. The only two formats that are recognized this way are a literal
8744domain, or a domain pattern that starts with *. In both these cases, the effect
8745is the same as if &`*@`& preceded the pattern. For example:
8746.code
8747deny senders = enemy.domain : *.enemy.domain
8748.endd
8749
8750The following kinds of more complicated address list pattern can match any
8751address, including the empty address that is characteristic of bounce message
8752senders:
8753
8754.ilist
8755.cindex "regular expressions" "in address list"
8756.cindex "address list" "regular expression in"
8757If (after expansion) a pattern starts with &"^"&, a regular expression match is
8758done against the complete address, with the pattern as the regular expression.
8759You must take care that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted
8760as part of the string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`&
8761to mark that part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8762.code
8763deny senders = \N^.*this.*@example\.com$\N : \
8764 \N^\d{8}.+@spamhaus.example$\N : ...
8765.endd
8766The &`\N`& sequences are removed by the expansion, so these items do indeed
8767start with &"^"& by the time they are being interpreted as address patterns.
8768
8769.next
8770.cindex "address list" "lookup for complete address"
8771Complete addresses can be looked up by using a pattern that starts with a
8772lookup type terminated by a semicolon, followed by the data for the lookup. For
8773example:
8774.code
8775deny senders = cdb;/etc/blocked.senders : \
8776 mysql;select address from blocked where \
8777 address='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'
8778.endd
8779Both query-style and single-key lookup types can be used. For a single-key
8780lookup type, Exim uses the complete address as the key. However, empty keys are
8781not supported for single-key lookups, so a match against the empty address
8782always fails. This restriction does not apply to query-style lookups.
8783
8784Partial matching for single-key lookups (section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&)
8785cannot be used, and is ignored if specified, with an entry being written to the
8786panic log.
8787.cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
8788However, you can configure lookup defaults, as described in section
8789&<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&, but this is useful only for the &"*@"& type of
8790default. For example, with this lookup:
8791.code
8792accept senders = lsearch*@;/some/file
8793.endd
8794the file could contains lines like this:
8795.code
8796user1@domain1.example
8797*@domain2.example
8798.endd
8799and for the sender address &'nimrod@jaeger.example'&, the sequence of keys
8800that are tried is:
8801.code
8802nimrod@jaeger.example
8803*@jaeger.example
8804*
8805.endd
8806&*Warning 1*&: Do not include a line keyed by &"*"& in the file, because that
8807would mean that every address matches, thus rendering the test useless.
8808
8809&*Warning 2*&: Do not confuse these two kinds of item:
8810.code
8811deny recipients = dbm*@;/some/file
8812deny recipients = *@dbm;/some/file
8813.endd
8814The first does a whole address lookup, with defaulting, as just described,
8815because it starts with a lookup type. The second matches the local part and
8816domain independently, as described in a bullet point below.
8817.endlist
8818
8819
8820The following kinds of address list pattern can match only non-empty addresses.
8821If the subject address is empty, a match against any of these pattern types
8822always fails.
8823
8824
8825.ilist
8826.cindex "@@ with single-key lookup"
8827.cindex "address list" "@@ lookup type"
8828.cindex "address list" "split local part and domain"
8829If a pattern starts with &"@@"& followed by a single-key lookup item
8830(for example, &`@@lsearch;/some/file`&), the address that is being checked is
8831split into a local part and a domain. The domain is looked up in the file. If
8832it is not found, there is no match. If it is found, the data that is looked up
8833from the file is treated as a colon-separated list of local part patterns, each
8834of which is matched against the subject local part in turn.
8835
8836.cindex "asterisk" "in address list"
8837The lookup may be a partial one, and/or one involving a search for a default
8838keyed by &"*"& (see section &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&). The local part
8839patterns that are looked up can be regular expressions or begin with &"*"&, or
8840even be further lookups. They may also be independently negated. For example,
8841with
8842.code
8843deny senders = @@dbm;/etc/reject-by-domain
8844.endd
8845the data from which the DBM file is built could contain lines like
8846.code
8847baddomain.com: !postmaster : *
8848.endd
8849to reject all senders except &%postmaster%& from that domain.
8850
8851.cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8852If a local part that actually begins with an exclamation mark is required, it
8853has to be specified using a regular expression. In &(lsearch)& files, an entry
8854may be split over several lines by indenting the second and subsequent lines,
8855but the separating colon must still be included at line breaks. White space
8856surrounding the colons is ignored. For example:
8857.code
8858aol.com: spammer1 : spammer2 : ^[0-9]+$ :
8859 spammer3 : spammer4
8860.endd
8861As in all colon-separated lists in Exim, a colon can be included in an item by
8862doubling.
8863
8864If the last item in the list starts with a right angle-bracket, the remainder
8865of the item is taken as a new key to look up in order to obtain a continuation
8866list of local parts. The new key can be any sequence of characters. Thus one
8867might have entries like
8868.code
8869aol.com: spammer1 : spammer 2 : >*
8870xyz.com: spammer3 : >*
8871*: ^\d{8}$
8872.endd
8873in a file that was searched with &%@@dbm*%&, to specify a match for 8-digit
8874local parts for all domains, in addition to the specific local parts listed for
8875each domain. Of course, using this feature costs another lookup each time a
8876chain is followed, but the effort needed to maintain the data is reduced.
8877
8878.cindex "loop" "in lookups"
8879It is possible to construct loops using this facility, and in order to catch
8880them, the chains may be no more than fifty items long.
8881
8882.next
8883The @@<&'lookup'&> style of item can also be used with a query-style
8884lookup, but in this case, the chaining facility is not available. The lookup
8885can only return a single list of local parts.
8886.endlist
8887
8888&*Warning*&: There is an important difference between the address list items
8889in these two examples:
8890.code
8891senders = +my_list
8892senders = *@+my_list
8893.endd
8894In the first one, &`my_list`& is a named address list, whereas in the second
8895example it is a named domain list.
8896
8897
8898
8899
8900.section "Case of letters in address lists" "SECTcasletadd"
8901.cindex "case of local parts"
8902.cindex "address list" "case forcing"
8903.cindex "case forcing in address lists"
8904Domains in email addresses are always handled caselessly, but for local parts
8905case may be significant on some systems (see &%caseful_local_part%& for how
8906Exim deals with this when routing addresses). However, RFC 2505 (&'Anti-Spam
8907Recommendations for SMTP MTAs'&) suggests that matching of addresses to
8908blocking lists should be done in a case-independent manner. Since most address
8909lists in Exim are used for this kind of control, Exim attempts to do this by
8910default.
8911
8912The domain portion of an address is always lowercased before matching it to an
8913address list. The local part is lowercased by default, and any string
8914comparisons that take place are done caselessly. This means that the data in
8915the address list itself, in files included as plain file names, and in any file
8916that is looked up using the &"@@"& mechanism, can be in any case. However, the
8917keys in files that are looked up by a search type other than &(lsearch)& (which
8918works caselessly) must be in lower case, because these lookups are not
8919case-independent.
8920
8921.cindex "&`+caseful`&"
8922To allow for the possibility of caseful address list matching, if an item in
8923an address list is the string &"+caseful"&, the original case of the local
8924part is restored for any comparisons that follow, and string comparisons are no
8925longer case-independent. This does not affect the domain, which remains in
8926lower case. However, although independent matches on the domain alone are still
8927performed caselessly, regular expressions that match against an entire address
8928become case-sensitive after &"+caseful"& has been seen.
8929
8930
8931
8932.section "Local part lists" "SECTlocparlis"
8933.cindex "list" "local part list"
8934.cindex "local part" "list"
8935Case-sensitivity in local part lists is handled in the same way as for address
8936lists, as just described. The &"+caseful"& item can be used if required. In a
8937setting of the &%local_parts%& option in a router with &%caseful_local_part%&
8938set false, the subject is lowercased and the matching is initially
8939case-insensitive. In this case, &"+caseful"& will restore case-sensitive
8940matching in the local part list, but not elsewhere in the router. If
8941&%caseful_local_part%& is set true in a router, matching in the &%local_parts%&
8942option is case-sensitive from the start.
8943
8944If a local part list is indirected to a file (see section &<<SECTfilnamlis>>&),
8945comments are handled in the same way as address lists &-- they are recognized
8946only if the # is preceded by white space or the start of the line.
8947Otherwise, local part lists are matched in the same way as domain lists, except
8948that the special items that refer to the local host (&`@`&, &`@[]`&,
8949&`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`&) are not recognized.
8950Refer to section &<<SECTdomainlist>>& for details of the other available item
8951types.
8952.ecindex IIDdohoadli
8953
8954
8955
8956
8957. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8958. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8959
8960.chapter "String expansions" "CHAPexpand"
8961.scindex IIDstrexp "expansion" "of strings"
8962Many strings in Exim's run time configuration are expanded before use. Some of
8963them are expanded every time they are used; others are expanded only once.
8964
8965When a string is being expanded it is copied verbatim from left to right except
8966when a dollar or backslash character is encountered. A dollar specifies the
8967start of a portion of the string that is interpreted and replaced as described
8968below in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& onwards. Backslash is used as an
8969escape character, as described in the following section.
8970
8971Whether a string is expanded depends upon the context. Usually this is solely
8972dependent upon the option for which a value is sought; in this documentation,
8973options for which string expansion is performed are marked with &dagger; after
8974the data type. ACL rules always expand strings. A couple of expansion
8975conditions do not expand some of the brace-delimited branches, for security
8976reasons.
8977
8978
8979
8980.section "Literal text in expanded strings" "SECTlittext"
8981.cindex "expansion" "including literal text"
8982An uninterpreted dollar can be included in an expanded string by putting a
8983backslash in front of it. A backslash can be used to prevent any special
8984character being treated specially in an expansion, including backslash itself.
8985If the string appears in quotes in the configuration file, two backslashes are
8986required because the quotes themselves cause interpretation of backslashes when
8987the string is read in (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&).
8988
8989.cindex "expansion" "non-expandable substrings"
8990A portion of the string can specified as non-expandable by placing it between
8991two occurrences of &`\N`&. This is particularly useful for protecting regular
8992expressions, which often contain backslashes and dollar signs. For example:
8993.code
8994deny senders = \N^\d{8}[a-z]@some\.site\.example$\N
8995.endd
8996On encountering the first &`\N`&, the expander copies subsequent characters
8997without interpretation until it reaches the next &`\N`& or the end of the
8998string.
8999
9000
9001
9002.section "Character escape sequences in expanded strings" "SECID82"
9003.cindex "expansion" "escape sequences"
9004A backslash followed by one of the letters &"n"&, &"r"&, or &"t"& in an
9005expanded string is recognized as an escape sequence for the character newline,
9006carriage return, or tab, respectively. A backslash followed by up to three
9007octal digits is recognized as an octal encoding for a single character, and a
9008backslash followed by &"x"& and up to two hexadecimal digits is a hexadecimal
9009encoding.
9010
9011These escape sequences are also recognized in quoted strings when they are read
9012in. Their interpretation in expansions as well is useful for unquoted strings,
9013and for other cases such as looked-up strings that are then expanded.
9014
9015
9016.section "Testing string expansions" "SECID83"
9017.cindex "expansion" "testing"
9018.cindex "testing" "string expansion"
9019.oindex "&%-be%&"
9020Many expansions can be tested by calling Exim with the &%-be%& option. This
9021takes the command arguments, or lines from the standard input if there are no
9022arguments, runs them through the string expansion code, and writes the results
9023to the standard output. Variables based on configuration values are set up, but
9024since no message is being processed, variables such as &$local_part$& have no
9025value. Nevertheless the &%-be%& option can be useful for checking out file and
9026database lookups, and the use of expansion operators such as &%sg%&, &%substr%&
9027and &%nhash%&.
9028
9029Exim gives up its root privilege when it is called with the &%-be%& option, and
9030instead runs under the uid and gid it was called with, to prevent users from
9031using &%-be%& for reading files to which they do not have access.
9032
9033.oindex "&%-bem%&"
9034If you want to test expansions that include variables whose values are taken
9035from a message, there are two other options that can be used. The &%-bem%&
9036option is like &%-be%& except that it is followed by a file name. The file is
9037read as a message before doing the test expansions. For example:
9038.code
9039exim -bem /tmp/test.message '$h_subject:'
9040.endd
9041The &%-Mset%& option is used in conjunction with &%-be%& and is followed by an
9042Exim message identifier. For example:
9043.code
9044exim -be -Mset 1GrA8W-0004WS-LQ '$recipients'
9045.endd
9046This loads the message from Exim's spool before doing the test expansions, and
9047is therefore restricted to admin users.
9048
9049
9050.section "Forced expansion failure" "SECTforexpfai"
9051.cindex "expansion" "forced failure"
9052A number of expansions that are described in the following section have
9053alternative &"true"& and &"false"& substrings, enclosed in brace characters
9054(which are sometimes called &"curly brackets"&). Which of the two strings is
9055used depends on some condition that is evaluated as part of the expansion. If,
9056instead of a &"false"& substring, the word &"fail"& is used (not in braces),
9057the entire string expansion fails in a way that can be detected by the code
9058that requested the expansion. This is called &"forced expansion failure"&, and
9059its consequences depend on the circumstances. In some cases it is no different
9060from any other expansion failure, but in others a different action may be
9061taken. Such variations are mentioned in the documentation of the option that is
9062being expanded.
9063
9064
9065
9066
9067.section "Expansion items" "SECTexpansionitems"
9068The following items are recognized in expanded strings. White space may be used
9069between sub-items that are keywords or substrings enclosed in braces inside an
9070outer set of braces, to improve readability. &*Warning*&: Within braces,
9071white space is significant.
9072
9073.vlist
9074.vitem &*$*&<&'variable&~name'&>&~or&~&*${*&<&'variable&~name'&>&*}*&
9075.cindex "expansion" "variables"
9076Substitute the contents of the named variable, for example:
9077.code
9078$local_part
9079${domain}
9080.endd
9081The second form can be used to separate the name from subsequent alphanumeric
9082characters. This form (using braces) is available only for variables; it does
9083&'not'& apply to message headers. The names of the variables are given in
9084section &<<SECTexpvar>>& below. If the name of a non-existent variable is
9085given, the expansion fails.
9086
9087.vitem &*${*&<&'op'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9088.cindex "expansion" "operators"
9089The string is first itself expanded, and then the operation specified by
9090<&'op'&> is applied to it. For example:
9091.code
9092${lc:$local_part}
9093.endd
9094The string starts with the first character after the colon, which may be
9095leading white space. A list of operators is given in section &<<SECTexpop>>&
9096below. The operator notation is used for simple expansion items that have just
9097one argument, because it reduces the number of braces and therefore makes the
9098string easier to understand.
9099
9100.vitem &*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
9101This item inserts &"basic"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
9102expansion item below.
9103
9104
9105.vitem "&*${acl{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
9106.cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
9107.cindex "&%acl%&" "call from expansion"
9108The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
9109arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
9110Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
9111arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
9112and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
9113are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
9114a value using a "message =" modifier and returns accept or deny, the value becomes
9115the result of the expansion.
9116If no message is set and the ACL returns accept or deny
9117the expansion result is an empty string.
9118If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail. Otherwise the expansion fails.
9119
9120
9121.vitem "&*${certextract{*&<&'field'&>&*}{*&<&'certificate'&>&*}&&&
9122 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9123.cindex "expansion" "extracting certificate fields"
9124.cindex "&%certextract%&" "certificate fields"
9125.cindex "certificate" "extracting fields"
9126The <&'certificate'&> must be a variable of type certificate.
9127The field name is expanded and used to retrieve the relevant field from
9128the certificate. Supported fields are:
9129.display
9130&`version `&
9131&`serial_number `&
9132&`subject `& RFC4514 DN
9133&`issuer `& RFC4514 DN
9134&`notbefore `& time
9135&`notafter `& time
9136&`sig_algorithm `&
9137&`signature `&
9138&`subj_altname `& tagged list
9139&`ocsp_uri `& list
9140&`crl_uri `& list
9141.endd
9142If the field is found,
9143<&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
9144otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
9145variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
9146is restored to any previous value it might have had.
9147
9148If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
9149key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9150extracted is used.
9151
9152Some field names take optional modifiers, appended and separated by commas.
9153
9154The field selectors marked as "RFC4514" above
9155output a Distinguished Name string which is
9156not quite
9157parseable by Exim as a comma-separated tagged list
9158(the exceptions being elements containing commas).
9159RDN elements of a single type may be selected by
9160a modifier of the type label; if so the expansion
9161result is a list (newline-separated by default).
9162The separator may be changed by another modifier of
9163a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
9164Recognised RDN type labels include "CN", "O", "OU" and "DC".
9165
9166The field selectors marked as "time" above
9167take an optional modifier of "int"
9168for which the result is the number of seconds since epoch.
9169Otherwise the result is a human-readable string
9170in the timezone selected by the main "timezone" option.
9171
9172The field selectors marked as "list" above return a list,
9173newline-separated by default,
9174(embedded separator characters in elements are doubled).
9175The separator may be changed by a modifier of
9176a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
9177
9178The field selectors marked as "tagged" above
9179prefix each list element with a type string and an equals sign.
9180Elements of only one type may be selected by a modifier
9181which is one of "dns", "uri" or "mail";
9182if so the element tags are omitted.
9183
9184If not otherwise noted field values are presented in human-readable form.
9185
9186.vitem "&*${dlfunc{*&<&'file'&>&*}{*&<&'function'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}&&&
9187 {*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
9188.cindex &%dlfunc%&
9189This expansion dynamically loads and then calls a locally-written C function.
9190This functionality is available only if Exim is compiled with
9191.code
9192EXPAND_DLFUNC=yes
9193.endd
9194set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Once loaded, Exim remembers the dynamically loaded
9195object so that it doesn't reload the same object file in the same Exim process
9196(but of course Exim does start new processes frequently).
9197
9198There may be from zero to eight arguments to the function. When compiling
9199a local function that is to be called in this way, &_local_scan.h_& should be
9200included. The Exim variables and functions that are defined by that API
9201are also available for dynamically loaded functions. The function itself
9202must have the following type:
9203.code
9204int dlfunction(uschar **yield, int argc, uschar *argv[])
9205.endd
9206Where &`uschar`& is a typedef for &`unsigned char`& in &_local_scan.h_&. The
9207function should return one of the following values:
9208
9209&`OK`&: Success. The string that is placed in the variable &'yield'& is put
9210into the expanded string that is being built.
9211
9212&`FAIL`&: A non-forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message taken
9213from &'yield'&, if it is set.
9214
9215&`FAIL_FORCED`&: A forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message
9216taken from &'yield'& if it is set.
9217
9218&`ERROR`&: Same as &`FAIL`&, except that a panic log entry is written.
9219
9220When compiling a function that is to be used in this way with gcc,
9221you need to add &%-shared%& to the gcc command. Also, in the Exim build-time
9222configuration, you must add &%-export-dynamic%& to EXTRALIBS.
9223
9224
9225.vitem "&*${env{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9226.cindex "expansion" "extracting value from environment"
9227.cindex "environment" "values from"
9228The key is first expanded separately, and leading and trailing white space
9229removed.
9230This is then searched for as a name in the environment.
9231If a variable is found then its value is placed in &$value$&
9232and <&'string1'&> is expanded, otherwise <&'string2'&> is expanded.
9233
9234Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9235appear, for example:
9236.code
9237${env{USER}{$value} fail }
9238.endd
9239This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9240{<&'string1'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9241
9242If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted an empty string is substituted on
9243search failure.
9244If {<&'string1'&>} is omitted the search result is substituted on
9245search success.
9246
9247The environment is adjusted by the &%keep_environment%& and
9248&%add_environment%& main section options.
9249
9250
9251.vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
9252 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9253.cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by key"
9254.cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by key"
9255The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
9256white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
9257must not be empty and must not consist entirely of digits.
9258The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the form:
9259.display
9260<&'key1'&> = <&'value1'&> <&'key2'&> = <&'value2'&> ...
9261.endd
9262.vindex "&$value$&"
9263where the equals signs and spaces (but not both) are optional. If any of the
9264values contain white space, they must be enclosed in double quotes, and any
9265values that are enclosed in double quotes are subject to escape processing as
9266described in section &<<SECTstrings>>&. The expanded <&'string1'&> is searched
9267for the value that corresponds to the key. The search is case-insensitive. If
9268the key is found, <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
9269otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
9270variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
9271is restored to any previous value it might have had.
9272
9273If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
9274key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9275extracted is used. Thus, for example, these two expansions are identical, and
9276yield &"2001"&:
9277.code
9278${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}}
9279${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}{$value}}
9280.endd
9281Instead of {<&'string3'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9282appear, for example:
9283.code
9284${extract{Z}{A=... B=...}{$value} fail }
9285.endd
9286This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9287{<&'string2'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9288
9289
9290.vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'number'&>&*}{*&<&'separators'&>&*}&&&
9291 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9292.cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by number"
9293.cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by number"
9294The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9295apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
9296This is what distinguishes this form of &%extract%& from the previous kind. It
9297behaves in the same way, except that, instead of extracting a named field, it
9298extracts from <&'string1'&> the field whose number is given as the first
9299argument. You can use &$value$& in <&'string2'&> or &`fail`& instead of
9300<&'string3'&> as before.
9301
9302The fields in the string are separated by any one of the characters in the
9303separator string. These may include space or tab characters.
9304The first field is numbered one. If the number is negative, the fields are
9305counted from the end of the string, with the rightmost one numbered -1. If the
9306number given is zero, the entire string is returned. If the modulus of the
9307number is greater than the number of fields in the string, the result is the
9308expansion of <&'string3'&>, or the empty string if <&'string3'&> is not
9309provided. For example:
9310.code
9311${extract{2}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9312.endd
9313yields &"42"&, and
9314.code
9315${extract{-4}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9316.endd
9317yields &"99"&. Two successive separators mean that the field between them is
9318empty (for example, the fifth field above).
9319
9320
9321.vitem &*${filter{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'condition'&>&*}}*&
9322.cindex "list" "selecting by condition"
9323.cindex "expansion" "selecting from list by condition"
9324.vindex "&$item$&"
9325After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9326default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
9327in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then the condition is
9328evaluated. If the condition is true, &$item$& is added to the output as an
9329item in a new list; if the condition is false, the item is discarded. The
9330separator used for the output list is the same as the one used for the
9331input, but a separator setting is not included in the output. For example:
9332.code
9333${filter{a:b:c}{!eq{$item}{b}}
9334.endd
9335yields &`a:c`&. At the end of the expansion, the value of &$item$& is restored
9336to what it was before. See also the &*map*& and &*reduce*& expansion items.
9337
9338
9339.vitem &*${hash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9340.cindex "hash function" "textual"
9341.cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
9342This is a textual hashing function, and was the first to be implemented in
9343early versions of Exim. In current releases, there are other hashing functions
9344(numeric, MD5, and SHA-1), which are described below.
9345
9346The first two strings, after expansion, must be numbers. Call them <&'m'&> and
9347<&'n'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is, if
9348<&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you can
9349use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9350.code
9351${hash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9352.endd
9353The second number is optional (in both notations). If <&'n'&> is greater than
9354or equal to the length of the string, the expansion item returns the string.
9355Otherwise it computes a new string of length <&'n'&> by applying a hashing
9356function to the string. The new string consists of characters taken from the
9357first <&'m'&> characters of the string
9358.code
9359abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQWRSTUVWXYZ0123456789
9360.endd
9361If <&'m'&> is not present the value 26 is used, so that only lower case
9362letters appear. For example:
9363.display
9364&`$hash{3}{monty}} `& yields &`jmg`&
9365&`$hash{5}{monty}} `& yields &`monty`&
9366&`$hash{4}{62}{monty python}}`& yields &`fbWx`&
9367.endd
9368
9369.vitem "&*$header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9370 &*$h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9371 "&*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9372 &*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9373 "&*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9374 &*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
9375.cindex "expansion" "header insertion"
9376.vindex "&$header_$&"
9377.vindex "&$bheader_$&"
9378.vindex "&$rheader_$&"
9379.cindex "header lines" "in expansion strings"
9380.cindex "header lines" "character sets"
9381.cindex "header lines" "decoding"
9382Substitute the contents of the named message header line, for example
9383.code
9384$header_reply-to:
9385.endd
9386The newline that terminates a header line is not included in the expansion, but
9387internal newlines (caused by splitting the header line over several physical
9388lines) may be present.
9389
9390The difference between &%rheader%&, &%bheader%&, and &%header%& is in the way
9391the data in the header line is interpreted.
9392
9393.ilist
9394.cindex "white space" "in header lines"
9395&%rheader%& gives the original &"raw"& content of the header line, with no
9396processing at all, and without the removal of leading and trailing white space.
9397
9398.next
9399.cindex "base64 encoding" "in header lines"
9400&%bheader%& removes leading and trailing white space, and then decodes base64
9401or quoted-printable MIME &"words"& within the header text, but does no
9402character set translation. If decoding of what looks superficially like a MIME
9403&"word"& fails, the raw string is returned. If decoding
9404.cindex "binary zero" "in header line"
9405produces a binary zero character, it is replaced by a question mark &-- this is
9406what Exim does for binary zeros that are actually received in header lines.
9407
9408.next
9409&%header%& tries to translate the string as decoded by &%bheader%& to a
9410standard character set. This is an attempt to produce the same string as would
9411be displayed on a user's MUA. If translation fails, the &%bheader%& string is
9412returned. Translation is attempted only on operating systems that support the
9413&[iconv()]& function. This is indicated by the compile-time macro HAVE_ICONV in
9414a system Makefile or in &_Local/Makefile_&.
9415.endlist ilist
9416
9417In a filter file, the target character set for &%header%& can be specified by a
9418command of the following form:
9419.code
9420headers charset "UTF-8"
9421.endd
9422This command affects all references to &$h_$& (or &$header_$&) expansions in
9423subsequently obeyed filter commands. In the absence of this command, the target
9424character set in a filter is taken from the setting of the &%headers_charset%&
9425option in the runtime configuration. The value of this option defaults to the
9426value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The ultimate default is
9427ISO-8859-1.
9428
9429Header names follow the syntax of RFC 2822, which states that they may contain
9430any printing characters except space and colon. Consequently, curly brackets
9431&'do not'& terminate header names, and should not be used to enclose them as
9432if they were variables. Attempting to do so causes a syntax error.
9433
9434Only header lines that are common to all copies of a message are visible to
9435this mechanism. These are the original header lines that are received with the
9436message, and any that are added by an ACL statement or by a system
9437filter. Header lines that are added to a particular copy of a message by a
9438router or transport are not accessible.
9439
9440For incoming SMTP messages, no header lines are visible in
9441ACLs that are obeyed before the data phase completes,
9442because the header structure is not set up until the message is received.
9443They are visible in DKIM, PRDR and DATA ACLs.
9444Header lines that are added in a RCPT ACL (for example)
9445are saved until the message's incoming header lines are available, at which
9446point they are added.
9447When any of the above ACLs ar
9448running, however, header lines added by earlier ACLs are visible.
9449
9450Upper case and lower case letters are synonymous in header names. If the
9451following character is white space, the terminating colon may be omitted, but
9452this is not recommended, because you may then forget it when it is needed. When
9453white space terminates the header name, this white space is included in the
9454expanded string. If the message does not contain the given header, the
9455expansion item is replaced by an empty string. (See the &%def%& condition in
9456section &<<SECTexpcond>>& for a means of testing for the existence of a
9457header.)
9458
9459If there is more than one header with the same name, they are all concatenated
9460to form the substitution string, up to a maximum length of 64K. Unless
9461&%rheader%& is being used, leading and trailing white space is removed from
9462each header before concatenation, and a completely empty header is ignored. A
9463newline character is then inserted between non-empty headers, but there is no
9464newline at the very end. For the &%header%& and &%bheader%& expansion, for
9465those headers that contain lists of addresses, a comma is also inserted at the
9466junctions between headers. This does not happen for the &%rheader%& expansion.
9467
9468
9469.vitem &*${hmac{*&<&'hashname'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&
9470.cindex "expansion" "hmac hashing"
9471.cindex &%hmac%&
9472This function uses cryptographic hashing (either MD5 or SHA-1) to convert a
9473shared secret and some text into a message authentication code, as specified in
9474RFC 2104. This differs from &`${md5:secret_text...}`& or
9475&`${sha1:secret_text...}`& in that the hmac step adds a signature to the
9476cryptographic hash, allowing for authentication that is not possible with MD5
9477or SHA-1 alone. The hash name must expand to either &`md5`& or &`sha1`& at
9478present. For example:
9479.code
9480${hmac{md5}{somesecret}{$primary_hostname $tod_log}}
9481.endd
9482For the hostname &'mail.example.com'& and time 2002-10-17 11:30:59, this
9483produces:
9484.code
9485dd97e3ba5d1a61b5006108f8c8252953
9486.endd
9487As an example of how this might be used, you might put in the main part of
9488an Exim configuration:
9489.code
9490SPAMSCAN_SECRET=cohgheeLei2thahw
9491.endd
9492In a router or a transport you could then have:
9493.code
9494headers_add = \
9495 X-Spam-Scanned: ${primary_hostname} ${message_exim_id} \
9496 ${hmac{md5}{SPAMSCAN_SECRET}\
9497 {${primary_hostname},${message_exim_id},$h_message-id:}}
9498.endd
9499Then given a message, you can check where it was scanned by looking at the
9500&'X-Spam-Scanned:'& header line. If you know the secret, you can check that
9501this header line is authentic by recomputing the authentication code from the
9502host name, message ID and the &'Message-id:'& header line. This can be done
9503using Exim's &%-be%& option, or by other means, for example by using the
9504&'hmac_md5_hex()'& function in Perl.
9505
9506
9507.vitem &*${if&~*&<&'condition'&>&*&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9508.cindex "expansion" "conditional"
9509.cindex "&%if%&, expansion item"
9510If <&'condition'&> is true, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the whole
9511item; otherwise <&'string2'&> is used. The available conditions are described
9512in section &<<SECTexpcond>>& below. For example:
9513.code
9514${if eq {$local_part}{postmaster} {yes}{no} }
9515.endd
9516The second string need not be present; if it is not and the condition is not
9517true, the item is replaced with nothing. Alternatively, the word &"fail"& may
9518be present instead of the second string (without any curly brackets). In this
9519case, the expansion is forced to fail if the condition is not true (see section
9520&<<SECTforexpfai>>&).
9521
9522If both strings are omitted, the result is the string &`true`& if the condition
9523is true, and the empty string if the condition is false. This makes it less
9524cumbersome to write custom ACL and router conditions. For example, instead of
9525.code
9526condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}{true}{false}}
9527.endd
9528you can use
9529.code
9530condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}}
9531.endd
9532
9533
9534
9535.vitem &*${imapfolder{*&<&'foldername'&>&*}}*&
9536.cindex expansion "imap folder"
9537.cindex "&%imapfolder%& expansion item"
9538This item converts a (possibly multilevel, or with non-ASCII characters)
9539folder specification to a Maildir name for filesystem use.
9540For information on internationalisation support see &<<SECTi18nMDA>>&.
9541
9542
9543
9544.vitem &*${length{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9545.cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
9546.cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
9547The &%length%& item is used to extract the initial portion of a string. Both
9548strings are expanded, and the first one must yield a number, <&'n'&>, say. If
9549you are using a fixed value for the number, that is, if <&'string1'&> does not
9550change when expanded, you can use the simpler operator notation that avoids
9551some of the braces:
9552.code
9553${length_<n>:<string>}
9554.endd
9555The result of this item is either the first <&'n'&> characters or the whole
9556of <&'string2'&>, whichever is the shorter. Do not confuse &%length%& with
9557&%strlen%&, which gives the length of a string.
9558
9559
9560.vitem "&*${listextract{*&<&'number'&>&*}&&&
9561 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9562.cindex "expansion" "extracting list elements by number"
9563.cindex "&%listextract%&" "extract list elements by number"
9564.cindex "list" "extracting elements by number"
9565The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9566apart from an optional leading minus,
9567and leading and trailing white space (which is ignored).
9568
9569After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9570default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way.
9571
9572The first field of the list is numbered one.
9573If the number is negative, the fields are
9574counted from the end of the list, with the rightmost one numbered -1.
9575The numbered element of the list is extracted and placed in &$value$&,
9576then <&'string2'&> is expanded as the result.
9577
9578If the modulus of the
9579number is zero or greater than the number of fields in the string,
9580the result is the expansion of <&'string3'&>.
9581
9582For example:
9583.code
9584${listextract{2}{x:42:99}}
9585.endd
9586yields &"42"&, and
9587.code
9588${listextract{-3}{<, x,42,99,& Mailer,,/bin/bash}{result: $value}}
9589.endd
9590yields &"result: 42"&.
9591
9592If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, an empty string is used for string3.
9593If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9594extracted is used.
9595You can use &`fail`& instead of {<&'string3'&>} as in a string extract.
9596
9597
9598.vitem "&*${lookup{*&<&'key'&>&*}&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~&&&
9599 {*&<&'file'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9600This is the first of one of two different types of lookup item, which are both
9601described in the next item.
9602
9603.vitem "&*${lookup&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~{*&<&'query'&>&*}&~&&&
9604 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9605.cindex "expansion" "lookup in"
9606.cindex "file" "lookups"
9607.cindex "lookup" "in expanded string"
9608The two forms of lookup item specify data lookups in files and databases, as
9609discussed in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. The first form is used for single-key
9610lookups, and the second is used for query-style lookups. The <&'key'&>,
9611<&'file'&>, and <&'query'&> strings are expanded before use.
9612
9613If there is any white space in a lookup item which is part of a filter command,
9614a retry or rewrite rule, a routing rule for the &(manualroute)& router, or any
9615other place where white space is significant, the lookup item must be enclosed
9616in double quotes. The use of data lookups in users' filter files may be locked
9617out by the system administrator.
9618
9619.vindex "&$value$&"
9620If the lookup succeeds, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the entire item.
9621During its expansion, the variable &$value$& contains the data returned by the
9622lookup. Afterwards it reverts to the value it had previously (at the outer
9623level it is empty). If the lookup fails, <&'string2'&> is expanded and replaces
9624the entire item. If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted, the replacement is the empty
9625string on failure. If <&'string2'&> is provided, it can itself be a nested
9626lookup, thus providing a mechanism for looking up a default value when the
9627original lookup fails.
9628
9629If a nested lookup is used as part of <&'string1'&>, &$value$& contains the
9630data for the outer lookup while the parameters of the second lookup are
9631expanded, and also while <&'string2'&> of the second lookup is expanded, should
9632the second lookup fail. Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& can
9633appear, and in this case, if the lookup fails, the entire expansion is forced
9634to fail (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&). If both {<&'string1'&>} and
9635{<&'string2'&>} are omitted, the result is the looked up value in the case of a
9636successful lookup, and nothing in the case of failure.
9637
9638For single-key lookups, the string &"partial"& is permitted to precede the
9639search type in order to do partial matching, and * or *@ may follow a search
9640type to request default lookups if the key does not match (see sections
9641&<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& and &<<SECTpartiallookup>>& for details).
9642
9643.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in lookup expansion"
9644If a partial search is used, the variables &$1$& and &$2$& contain the wild
9645and non-wild parts of the key during the expansion of the replacement text.
9646They return to their previous values at the end of the lookup item.
9647
9648This example looks up the postmaster alias in the conventional alias file:
9649.code
9650${lookup {postmaster} lsearch {/etc/aliases} {$value}}
9651.endd
9652This example uses NIS+ to look up the full name of the user corresponding to
9653the local part of an address, forcing the expansion to fail if it is not found:
9654.code
9655${lookup nisplus {[name=$local_part],passwd.org_dir:gcos} \
9656 {$value}fail}
9657.endd
9658
9659
9660.vitem &*${map{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9661.cindex "expansion" "list creation"
9662.vindex "&$item$&"
9663After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9664default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
9665in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then <&'string2'&> is
9666expanded and added to the output as an item in a new list. The separator used
9667for the output list is the same as the one used for the input, but a separator
9668setting is not included in the output. For example:
9669.code
9670${map{a:b:c}{[$item]}} ${map{<- x-y-z}{($item)}}
9671.endd
9672expands to &`[a]:[b]:[c] (x)-(y)-(z)`&. At the end of the expansion, the
9673value of &$item$& is restored to what it was before. See also the &*filter*&
9674and &*reduce*& expansion items.
9675
9676.vitem &*${nhash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9677.cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
9678.cindex "hash function" "numeric"
9679The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
9680<&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
9681if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
9682can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9683.code
9684${nhash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9685.endd
9686The second number is optional (in both notations). If there is only one number,
9687the result is a number in the range 0&--<&'n'&>-1. Otherwise, the string is
9688processed by a div/mod hash function that returns two numbers, separated by a
9689slash, in the ranges 0 to <&'n'&>-1 and 0 to <&'m'&>-1, respectively. For
9690example,
9691.code
9692${nhash{8}{64}{supercalifragilisticexpialidocious}}
9693.endd
9694returns the string &"6/33"&.
9695
9696
9697
9698.vitem &*${perl{*&<&'subroutine'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&
9699.cindex "Perl" "use in expanded string"
9700.cindex "expansion" "calling Perl from"
9701This item is available only if Exim has been built to include an embedded Perl
9702interpreter. The subroutine name and the arguments are first separately
9703expanded, and then the Perl subroutine is called with those arguments. No
9704additional arguments need be given; the maximum number permitted, including the
9705name of the subroutine, is nine.
9706
9707The return value of the subroutine is inserted into the expanded string, unless
9708the return value is &%undef%&. In that case, the expansion fails in the same
9709way as an explicit &"fail"& on a lookup item. The return value is a scalar.
9710Whatever you return is evaluated in a scalar context. For example, if you
9711return the name of a Perl vector, the return value is the size of the vector,
9712not its contents.
9713
9714If the subroutine exits by calling Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails
9715with the error message that was passed to &%die%&. More details of the embedded
9716Perl facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
9717
9718The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_perl%& which locks
9719out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9720
9721
9722.vitem &*${prvs{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'keynumber'&>&*}}*&
9723.cindex "&%prvs%& expansion item"
9724The first argument is a complete email address and the second is secret
9725keystring. The third argument, specifying a key number, is optional. If absent,
9726it defaults to 0. The result of the expansion is a prvs-signed email address,
9727to be typically used with the &%return_path%& option on an &(smtp)& transport
9728as part of a bounce address tag validation (BATV) scheme. For more discussion
9729and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
9730
9731.vitem "&*${prvscheck{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}&&&
9732 {*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&"
9733.cindex "&%prvscheck%& expansion item"
9734This expansion item is the complement of the &%prvs%& item. It is used for
9735checking prvs-signed addresses. If the expansion of the first argument does not
9736yield a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the whole item expands to the
9737empty string. When the first argument does expand to a syntactically valid
9738prvs-signed address, the second argument is expanded, with the prvs-decoded
9739version of the address and the key number extracted from the address in the
9740variables &$prvscheck_address$& and &$prvscheck_keynum$&, respectively.
9741
9742These two variables can be used in the expansion of the second argument to
9743retrieve the secret. The validity of the prvs-signed address is then checked
9744against the secret. The result is stored in the variable &$prvscheck_result$&,
9745which is empty for failure or &"1"& for success.
9746
9747The third argument is optional; if it is missing, it defaults to an empty
9748string. This argument is now expanded. If the result is an empty string, the
9749result of the expansion is the decoded version of the address. This is the case
9750whether or not the signature was valid. Otherwise, the result of the expansion
9751is the expansion of the third argument.
9752
9753All three variables can be used in the expansion of the third argument.
9754However, once the expansion is complete, only &$prvscheck_result$& remains set.
9755For more discussion and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
9756
9757.vitem &*${readfile{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}}*&
9758.cindex "expansion" "inserting an entire file"
9759.cindex "file" "inserting into expansion"
9760.cindex "&%readfile%& expansion item"
9761The file name and end-of-line string are first expanded separately. The file is
9762then read, and its contents replace the entire item. All newline characters in
9763the file are replaced by the end-of-line string if it is present. Otherwise,
9764newlines are left in the string.
9765String expansion is not applied to the contents of the file. If you want this,
9766you must wrap the item in an &%expand%& operator. If the file cannot be read,
9767the string expansion fails.
9768
9769The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readfile%& which
9770locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9771
9772
9773
9774.vitem "&*${readsocket{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'request'&>&*}&&&
9775 {*&<&'options'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}{*&<&'fail&~string'&>&*}}*&"
9776.cindex "expansion" "inserting from a socket"
9777.cindex "socket, use of in expansion"
9778.cindex "&%readsocket%& expansion item"
9779This item inserts data from a Unix domain or TCP socket into the expanded
9780string. The minimal way of using it uses just two arguments, as in these
9781examples:
9782.code
9783${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}}
9784${readsocket{inet:some.host:1234}{request string}}
9785.endd
9786For a Unix domain socket, the first substring must be the path to the socket.
9787For an Internet socket, the first substring must contain &`inet:`& followed by
9788a host name or IP address, followed by a colon and a port, which can be a
9789number or the name of a TCP port in &_/etc/services_&. An IP address may
9790optionally be enclosed in square brackets. This is best for IPv6 addresses. For
9791example:
9792.code
9793${readsocket{inet:[::1]:1234}{request string}}
9794.endd
9795Only a single host name may be given, but if looking it up yields more than
9796one IP address, they are each tried in turn until a connection is made. For
9797both kinds of socket, Exim makes a connection, writes the request string
9798unless it is an empty string; and no terminating NUL is ever sent)
9799and reads from the socket until an end-of-file
9800is read. A timeout of 5 seconds is applied. Additional, optional arguments
9801extend what can be done. Firstly, you can vary the timeout. For example:
9802.code
9803${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}}
9804.endd
9805The third argument is a list of options, of which the first element is the timeout
9806and must be present if the argument is given.
9807Further elements are options of form &'name=value'&.
9808One option type is currently recognised, defining whether (the default)
9809or not a shutdown is done on the connection after sending the request.
9810Example, to not do so (preferred, eg. by some webservers):
9811.code
9812${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s:shutdown=no}}
9813.endd
9814A fourth argument allows you to change any newlines that are in the data
9815that is read, in the same way as for &%readfile%& (see above). This example
9816turns them into spaces:
9817.code
9818${readsocket{inet:127.0.0.1:3294}{request string}{3s}{ }}
9819.endd
9820As with all expansions, the substrings are expanded before the processing
9821happens. Errors in these sub-expansions cause the expansion to fail. In
9822addition, the following errors can occur:
9823
9824.ilist
9825Failure to create a socket file descriptor;
9826.next
9827Failure to connect the socket;
9828.next
9829Failure to write the request string;
9830.next
9831Timeout on reading from the socket.
9832.endlist
9833
9834By default, any of these errors causes the expansion to fail. However, if
9835you supply a fifth substring, it is expanded and used when any of the above
9836errors occurs. For example:
9837.code
9838${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}{\n}\
9839 {socket failure}}
9840.endd
9841You can test for the existence of a Unix domain socket by wrapping this
9842expansion in &`${if exists`&, but there is a race condition between that test
9843and the actual opening of the socket, so it is safer to use the fifth argument
9844if you want to be absolutely sure of avoiding an expansion error for a
9845non-existent Unix domain socket, or a failure to connect to an Internet socket.
9846
9847The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readsocket%& which
9848locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9849
9850
9851.vitem &*${reduce{*&<&'string1'&>}{<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9852.cindex "expansion" "reducing a list to a scalar"
9853.cindex "list" "reducing to a scalar"
9854.vindex "&$value$&"
9855.vindex "&$item$&"
9856This operation reduces a list to a single, scalar string. After expansion,
9857<&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by default, but the
9858separator can be changed in the usual way. Then <&'string2'&> is expanded and
9859assigned to the &$value$& variable. After this, each item in the <&'string1'&>
9860list is assigned to &$item$& in turn, and <&'string3'&> is expanded for each of
9861them. The result of that expansion is assigned to &$value$& before the next
9862iteration. When the end of the list is reached, the final value of &$value$& is
9863added to the expansion output. The &*reduce*& expansion item can be used in a
9864number of ways. For example, to add up a list of numbers:
9865.code
9866${reduce {<, 1,2,3}{0}{${eval:$value+$item}}}
9867.endd
9868The result of that expansion would be &`6`&. The maximum of a list of numbers
9869can be found:
9870.code
9871${reduce {3:0:9:4:6}{0}{${if >{$item}{$value}{$item}{$value}}}}
9872.endd
9873At the end of a &*reduce*& expansion, the values of &$item$& and &$value$& are
9874restored to what they were before. See also the &*filter*& and &*map*&
9875expansion items.
9876
9877.vitem &*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
9878This item inserts &"raw"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
9879expansion item above.
9880
9881.vitem "&*${run{*&<&'command'&>&*&~*&<&'args'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&&&
9882 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9883.cindex "expansion" "running a command"
9884.cindex "&%run%& expansion item"
9885The command and its arguments are first expanded as one string. The string is
9886split apart into individual arguments by spaces, and then the command is run
9887in a separate process, but under the same uid and gid. As in other command
9888executions from Exim, a shell is not used by default. If the command requires
9889a shell, you must explicitly code it.
9890
9891Since the arguments are split by spaces, when there is a variable expansion
9892which has an empty result, it will cause the situation that the argument will
9893simply be omitted when the program is actually executed by Exim. If the
9894script/program requires a specific number of arguments and the expanded
9895variable could possibly result in this empty expansion, the variable must be
9896quoted. This is more difficult if the expanded variable itself could result
9897in a string containing quotes, because it would interfere with the quotes
9898around the command arguments. A possible guard against this is to wrap the
9899variable in the &%sg%& operator to change any quote marks to some other
9900character.
9901
9902The standard input for the command exists, but is empty. The standard output
9903and standard error are set to the same file descriptor.
9904.cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
9905.vindex "&$value$&"
9906If the command succeeds (gives a zero return code) <&'string1'&> is expanded
9907and replaces the entire item; during this expansion, the standard output/error
9908from the command is in the variable &$value$&. If the command fails,
9909<&'string2'&>, if present, is expanded and used. Once again, during the
9910expansion, the standard output/error from the command is in the variable
9911&$value$&.
9912
9913If <&'string2'&> is absent, the result is empty. Alternatively, <&'string2'&>
9914can be the word &"fail"& (not in braces) to force expansion failure if the
9915command does not succeed. If both strings are omitted, the result is contents
9916of the standard output/error on success, and nothing on failure.
9917
9918.vindex "&$run_in_acl$&"
9919The standard output/error of the command is put in the variable &$value$&.
9920In this ACL example, the output of a command is logged for the admin to
9921troubleshoot:
9922.code
9923warn condition = ${run{/usr/bin/id}{yes}{no}}
9924 log_message = Output of id: $value
9925.endd
9926If the command requires shell idioms, such as the > redirect operator, the
9927shell must be invoked directly, such as with:
9928.code
9929${run{/bin/bash -c "/usr/bin/id >/tmp/id"}{yes}{yes}}
9930.endd
9931
9932.vindex "&$runrc$&"
9933The return code from the command is put in the variable &$runrc$&, and this
9934remains set afterwards, so in a filter file you can do things like this:
9935.code
9936if "${run{x y z}{}}$runrc" is 1 then ...
9937 elif $runrc is 2 then ...
9938 ...
9939endif
9940.endd
9941If execution of the command fails (for example, the command does not exist),
9942the return code is 127 &-- the same code that shells use for non-existent
9943commands.
9944
9945&*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot assume the order in which
9946option values are expanded, except for those preconditions whose order of
9947testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot reliably expect to set &$runrc$&
9948by the expansion of one option, and use it in another.
9949
9950The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_run%& which locks
9951out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9952
9953
9954.vitem &*${sg{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'regex'&>&*}{*&<&'replacement'&>&*}}*&
9955.cindex "expansion" "string substitution"
9956.cindex "&%sg%& expansion item"
9957This item works like Perl's substitution operator (s) with the global (/g)
9958option; hence its name. However, unlike the Perl equivalent, Exim does not
9959modify the subject string; instead it returns the modified string for insertion
9960into the overall expansion. The item takes three arguments: the subject string,
9961a regular expression, and a substitution string. For example:
9962.code
9963${sg{abcdefabcdef}{abc}{xyz}}
9964.endd
9965yields &"xyzdefxyzdef"&. Because all three arguments are expanded before use,
9966if any $ or \ characters are required in the regular expression or in the
9967substitution string, they have to be escaped. For example:
9968.code
9969${sg{abcdef}{^(...)(...)\$}{\$2\$1}}
9970.endd
9971yields &"defabc"&, and
9972.code
9973${sg{1=A 4=D 3=C}{\N(\d+)=\N}{K\$1=}}
9974.endd
9975yields &"K1=A K4=D K3=C"&. Note the use of &`\N`& to protect the contents of
9976the regular expression from string expansion.
9977
9978
9979
9980.vitem &*${sort{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'comparator'&>&*}{*&<&'extractor'&>&*}}*&
9981.cindex sorting "a list"
9982.cindex list sorting
9983.cindex expansion "list sorting"
9984After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9985default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way.
9986The <&'comparator'&> argument is interpreted as the operator
9987of a two-argument expansion condition.
9988The numeric operators plus ge, gt, le, lt (and ~i variants) are supported.
9989The comparison should return true when applied to two values
9990if the first value should sort before the second value.
9991The <&'extractor'&> expansion is applied repeatedly to elements of the list,
9992the element being placed in &$item$&,
9993to give values for comparison.
9994
9995The item result is a sorted list,
9996with the original list separator,
9997of the list elements (in full) of the original.
9998
9999Examples:
10000.code
10001${sort{3:2:1:4}{<}{$item}}
10002.endd
10003sorts a list of numbers, and
10004.code
10005${sort {${lookup dnsdb{>:,,mx=example.com}}} {<} {${listextract{1}{<,$item}}}}
10006.endd
10007will sort an MX lookup into priority order.
10008
10009
10010.vitem &*${substr{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
10011.cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
10012.cindex "substring extraction"
10013.cindex "expansion" "substring extraction"
10014The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
10015<&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
10016if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
10017can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
10018.code
10019${substr_<n>_<m>:<string>}
10020.endd
10021The second number is optional (in both notations).
10022If it is absent in the simpler format, the preceding underscore must also be
10023omitted.
10024
10025The &%substr%& item can be used to extract more general substrings than
10026&%length%&. The first number, <&'n'&>, is a starting offset, and <&'m'&> is the
10027length required. For example
10028.code
10029${substr{3}{2}{$local_part}}
10030.endd
10031If the starting offset is greater than the string length the result is the
10032null string; if the length plus starting offset is greater than the string
10033length, the result is the right-hand part of the string, starting from the
10034given offset. The first character in the string has offset zero.
10035
10036The &%substr%& expansion item can take negative offset values to count
10037from the right-hand end of its operand. The last character is offset -1, the
10038second-last is offset -2, and so on. Thus, for example,
10039.code
10040${substr{-5}{2}{1234567}}
10041.endd
10042yields &"34"&. If the absolute value of a negative offset is greater than the
10043length of the string, the substring starts at the beginning of the string, and
10044the length is reduced by the amount of overshoot. Thus, for example,
10045.code
10046${substr{-5}{2}{12}}
10047.endd
10048yields an empty string, but
10049.code
10050${substr{-3}{2}{12}}
10051.endd
10052yields &"1"&.
10053
10054When the second number is omitted from &%substr%&, the remainder of the string
10055is taken if the offset is positive. If it is negative, all characters in the
10056string preceding the offset point are taken. For example, an offset of -1 and
10057no length, as in these semantically identical examples:
10058.code
10059${substr_-1:abcde}
10060${substr{-1}{abcde}}
10061.endd
10062yields all but the last character of the string, that is, &"abcd"&.
10063
10064
10065
10066.vitem "&*${tr{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'characters'&>&*}&&&
10067 {*&<&'replacements'&>&*}}*&"
10068.cindex "expansion" "character translation"
10069.cindex "&%tr%& expansion item"
10070This item does single-character translation on its subject string. The second
10071argument is a list of characters to be translated in the subject string. Each
10072matching character is replaced by the corresponding character from the
10073replacement list. For example
10074.code
10075${tr{abcdea}{ac}{13}}
10076.endd
10077yields &`1b3de1`&. If there are duplicates in the second character string, the
10078last occurrence is used. If the third string is shorter than the second, its
10079last character is replicated. However, if it is empty, no translation takes
10080place.
10081.endlist
10082
10083
10084
10085.section "Expansion operators" "SECTexpop"
10086.cindex "expansion" "operators"
10087For expansion items that perform transformations on a single argument string,
10088the &"operator"& notation is used because it is simpler and uses fewer braces.
10089The substring is first expanded before the operation is applied to it. The
10090following operations can be performed:
10091
10092.vlist
10093.vitem &*${address:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10094.cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
10095.cindex "&%address%& expansion item"
10096The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address, as it might appear in a
10097header line, and the effective address is extracted from it. If the string does
10098not parse successfully, the result is empty.
10099
10100
10101.vitem &*${addresses:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10102.cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
10103.cindex "&%addresses%& expansion item"
10104The string (after expansion) is interpreted as a list of addresses in RFC
101052822 format, such as can be found in a &'To:'& or &'Cc:'& header line. The
10106operative address (&'local-part@domain'&) is extracted from each item, and the
10107result of the expansion is a colon-separated list, with appropriate
10108doubling of colons should any happen to be present in the email addresses.
10109Syntactically invalid RFC2822 address items are omitted from the output.
10110
10111It is possible to specify a character other than colon for the output
10112separator by starting the string with > followed by the new separator
10113character. For example:
10114.code
10115${addresses:>& Chief <ceo@up.stairs>, sec@base.ment (dogsbody)}
10116.endd
10117expands to &`ceo@up.stairs&&sec@base.ment`&. Compare the &*address*& (singular)
10118expansion item, which extracts the working address from a single RFC2822
10119address. See the &*filter*&, &*map*&, and &*reduce*& items for ways of
10120processing lists.
10121
10122To clarify "list of addresses in RFC 2822 format" mentioned above, Exim follows
10123a strict interpretation of header line formatting. Exim parses the bare,
10124unquoted portion of an email address and if it finds a comma, treats it as an
10125email address separator. For the example header line:
10126.code
10127From: =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>
10128.endd
10129The first example below demonstrates that Q-encoded email addresses are parsed
10130properly if it is given the raw header (in this example, &`$rheader_from:`&).
10131It does not see the comma because it's still encoded as "=2C". The second
10132example below is passed the contents of &`$header_from:`&, meaning it gets
10133de-mimed. Exim sees the decoded "," so it treats it as &*two*& email addresses.
10134The third example shows that the presence of a comma is skipped when it is
10135quoted.
10136.code
10137# exim -be '${addresses:From: \
10138=?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>}'
10139user@example.com
10140# exim -be '${addresses:From: Last, First <user@example.com>}'
10141Last:user@example.com
10142# exim -be '${addresses:From: "Last, First" <user@example.com>}'
10143user@example.com
10144.endd
10145
10146.vitem &*${base32:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
10147.cindex "&%base32%& expansion item"
10148.cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 32"
10149The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
10150base 32 and output as a (empty, for zero) string of characters.
10151Only lowercase letters are used.
10152
10153.vitem &*${base32d:*&<&'base-32&~digits'&>&*}*&
10154.cindex "&%base32d%& expansion item"
10155.cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 32"
10156The string must consist entirely of base-32 digits.
10157The number is converted to decimal and output as a string.
10158
10159.vitem &*${base62:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
10160.cindex "&%base62%& expansion item"
10161.cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
10162The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
10163base 62 and output as a string of six characters, including leading zeros. In
10164the few operating environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for
10165its message identifiers (because those systems do not have case-sensitive file
10166names), base 36 is used by this operator, despite its name. &*Note*&: Just to
10167be absolutely clear: this is &'not'& base64 encoding.
10168
10169.vitem &*${base62d:*&<&'base-62&~digits'&>&*}*&
10170.cindex "&%base62d%& expansion item"
10171.cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
10172The string must consist entirely of base-62 digits, or, in operating
10173environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for its message
10174identifiers, base-36 digits. The number is converted to decimal and output as a
10175string.
10176
10177.vitem &*${base64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10178.cindex "expansion" "base64 encoding"
10179.cindex "base64 encoding" "in string expansion"
10180.cindex "&%base64%& expansion item"
10181.cindex certificate "base64 of DER"
10182This operator converts a string into one that is base64 encoded.
10183
10184If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10185returns the base64 encoding of the DER form of the certificate.
10186
10187
10188.vitem &*${base64d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10189.cindex "expansion" "base64 decoding"
10190.cindex "base64 decoding" "in string expansion"
10191.cindex "&%base64d%& expansion item"
10192This operator converts a base64-encoded string into the un-coded form.
10193
10194
10195.vitem &*${domain:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10196.cindex "domain" "extraction"
10197.cindex "expansion" "domain extraction"
10198The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the domain is extracted
10199from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is empty.
10200
10201
10202.vitem &*${escape:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10203.cindex "expansion" "escaping non-printing characters"
10204.cindex "&%escape%& expansion item"
10205If the string contains any non-printing characters, they are converted to
10206escape sequences starting with a backslash. Whether characters with the most
10207significant bit set (so-called &"8-bit characters"&) count as printing or not
10208is controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& option.
10209
10210.vitem &*${escape8bit:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10211.cindex "expansion" "escaping 8-bit characters"
10212.cindex "&%escape8bit%& expansion item"
10213If the string contains and characters with the most significant bit set,
10214they are converted to escape sequences starting with a backslash.
10215Backslashes and DEL characters are also converted.
10216
10217
10218.vitem &*${eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${eval10:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10219.cindex "expansion" "expression evaluation"
10220.cindex "expansion" "arithmetic expression"
10221.cindex "&%eval%& expansion item"
10222These items supports simple arithmetic and bitwise logical operations in
10223expansion strings. The string (after expansion) must be a conventional
10224arithmetic expression, but it is limited to basic arithmetic operators, bitwise
10225logical operators, and parentheses. All operations are carried out using
10226integer arithmetic. The operator priorities are as follows (the same as in the
10227C programming language):
10228.table2 70pt 300pt
10229.irow &'highest:'& "not (~), negate (-)"
10230.irow "" "multiply (*), divide (/), remainder (%)"
10231.irow "" "plus (+), minus (-)"
10232.irow "" "shift-left (<<), shift-right (>>)"
10233.irow "" "and (&&)"
10234.irow "" "xor (^)"
10235.irow &'lowest:'& "or (|)"
10236.endtable
10237Binary operators with the same priority are evaluated from left to right. White
10238space is permitted before or after operators.
10239
10240For &%eval%&, numbers may be decimal, octal (starting with &"0"&) or
10241hexadecimal (starting with &"0x"&). For &%eval10%&, all numbers are taken as
10242decimal, even if they start with a leading zero; hexadecimal numbers are not
10243permitted. This can be useful when processing numbers extracted from dates or
10244times, which often do have leading zeros.
10245
10246A number may be followed by &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& to multiply it by 1024, 1024*1024
10247or 1024*1024*1024,
10248respectively. Negative numbers are supported. The result of the computation is
10249a decimal representation of the answer (without &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"&). For example:
10250
10251.display
10252&`${eval:1+1} `& yields 2
10253&`${eval:1+2*3} `& yields 7
10254&`${eval:(1+2)*3} `& yields 9
10255&`${eval:2+42%5} `& yields 4
10256&`${eval:0xc&amp;5} `& yields 4
10257&`${eval:0xc|5} `& yields 13
10258&`${eval:0xc^5} `& yields 9
10259&`${eval:0xc>>1} `& yields 6
10260&`${eval:0xc<<1} `& yields 24
10261&`${eval:~255&amp;0x1234} `& yields 4608
10262&`${eval:-(~255&amp;0x1234)} `& yields -4608
10263.endd
10264
10265As a more realistic example, in an ACL you might have
10266.code
10267deny message = Too many bad recipients
10268 condition = \
10269 ${if and { \
10270 {>{$rcpt_count}{10}} \
10271 { \
10272 < \
10273 {$recipients_count} \
10274 {${eval:$rcpt_count/2}} \
10275 } \
10276 }{yes}{no}}
10277.endd
10278The condition is true if there have been more than 10 RCPT commands and
10279fewer than half of them have resulted in a valid recipient.
10280
10281
10282.vitem &*${expand:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10283.cindex "expansion" "re-expansion of substring"
10284The &%expand%& operator causes a string to be expanded for a second time. For
10285example,
10286.code
10287${expand:${lookup{$domain}dbm{/some/file}{$value}}}
10288.endd
10289first looks up a string in a file while expanding the operand for &%expand%&,
10290and then re-expands what it has found.
10291
10292
10293.vitem &*${from_utf8:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10294.cindex "Unicode"
10295.cindex "UTF-8" "conversion from"
10296.cindex "expansion" "UTF-8 conversion"
10297.cindex "&%from_utf8%& expansion item"
10298The world is slowly moving towards Unicode, although there are no standards for
10299email yet. However, other applications (including some databases) are starting
10300to store data in Unicode, using UTF-8 encoding. This operator converts from a
10301UTF-8 string to an ISO-8859-1 string. UTF-8 code values greater than 255 are
10302converted to underscores. The input must be a valid UTF-8 string. If it is not,
10303the result is an undefined sequence of bytes.
10304
10305Unicode code points with values less than 256 are compatible with ASCII and
10306ISO-8859-1 (also known as Latin-1).
10307For example, character 169 is the copyright symbol in both cases, though the
10308way it is encoded is different. In UTF-8, more than one byte is needed for
10309characters with code values greater than 127, whereas ISO-8859-1 is a
10310single-byte encoding (but thereby limited to 256 characters). This makes
10311translation from UTF-8 to ISO-8859-1 straightforward.
10312
10313
10314.vitem &*${hash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10315.cindex "hash function" "textual"
10316.cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
10317The &%hash%& operator is a simpler interface to the hashing function that can
10318be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings that
10319change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10320.code
10321${hash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
10322.endd
10323See the description of the general &%hash%& item above for details. The
10324abbreviation &%h%& can be used when &%hash%& is used as an operator.
10325
10326
10327
10328.vitem &*${hex2b64:*&<&'hexstring'&>&*}*&
10329.cindex "base64 encoding" "conversion from hex"
10330.cindex "expansion" "hex to base64"
10331.cindex "&%hex2b64%& expansion item"
10332This operator converts a hex string into one that is base64 encoded. This can
10333be useful for processing the output of the MD5 and SHA-1 hashing functions.
10334
10335
10336
10337.vitem &*${hexquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10338.cindex "quoting" "hex-encoded unprintable characters"
10339.cindex "&%hexquote%& expansion item"
10340This operator converts non-printable characters in a string into a hex
10341escape form. Byte values between 33 (!) and 126 (~) inclusive are left
10342as is, and other byte values are converted to &`\xNN`&, for example a
10343byte value 127 is converted to &`\x7f`&.
10344
10345
10346.vitem &*${ipv6denorm:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10347.cindex "&%ipv6denorm%& expansion item"
10348.cindex "IP address" normalisation
10349This expands an IPv6 address to a full eight-element colon-separated set
10350of hex digits including leading zeroes.
10351A trailing ipv4-style dotted-decimal set is converted to hex.
10352Pure IPv4 addresses are converted to IPv4-mapped IPv6.
10353
10354.vitem &*${ipv6norm:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10355.cindex "&%ipv6norm%& expansion item"
10356.cindex "IP address" normalisation
10357.cindex "IP address" "canonical form"
10358This converts an IPv6 address to canonical form.
10359Leading zeroes of groups are omitted, and the longest
10360set of zero-valued groups is replaced with a double colon.
10361A trailing ipv4-style dotted-decimal set is converted to hex.
10362Pure IPv4 addresses are converted to IPv4-mapped IPv6.
10363
10364
10365.vitem &*${lc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10366.cindex "case forcing in strings"
10367.cindex "string" "case forcing"
10368.cindex "lower casing"
10369.cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
10370.cindex "&%lc%& expansion item"
10371This forces the letters in the string into lower-case, for example:
10372.code
10373${lc:$local_part}
10374.endd
10375
10376.vitem &*${length_*&<&'number'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10377.cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
10378.cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
10379The &%length%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%length%& function that
10380can be used when the parameter is a fixed number (as opposed to a string that
10381changes when expanded). The effect is the same as
10382.code
10383${length{<number>}{<string>}}
10384.endd
10385See the description of the general &%length%& item above for details. Note that
10386&%length%& is not the same as &%strlen%&. The abbreviation &%l%& can be used
10387when &%length%& is used as an operator.
10388
10389
10390.vitem &*${listcount:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10391.cindex "expansion" "list item count"
10392.cindex "list" "item count"
10393.cindex "list" "count of items"
10394.cindex "&%listcount%& expansion item"
10395The string is interpreted as a list and the number of items is returned.
10396
10397
10398.vitem &*${listnamed:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${listnamed_*&<&'type'&>&*:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&
10399.cindex "expansion" "named list"
10400.cindex "&%listnamed%& expansion item"
10401The name is interpreted as a named list and the content of the list is returned,
10402expanding any referenced lists, re-quoting as needed for colon-separation.
10403If the optional type is given it must be one of "a", "d", "h" or "l"
10404and selects address-, domain-, host- or localpart- lists to search among respectively.
10405Otherwise all types are searched in an undefined order and the first
10406matching list is returned.
10407
10408
10409.vitem &*${local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10410.cindex "expansion" "local part extraction"
10411.cindex "&%local_part%& expansion item"
10412The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the local part is
10413extracted from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is
10414empty.
10415
10416
10417.vitem &*${mask:*&<&'IP&~address'&>&*/*&<&'bit&~count'&>&*}*&
10418.cindex "masked IP address"
10419.cindex "IP address" "masking"
10420.cindex "CIDR notation"
10421.cindex "expansion" "IP address masking"
10422.cindex "&%mask%& expansion item"
10423If the form of the string to be operated on is not an IP address followed by a
10424slash and an integer (that is, a network address in CIDR notation), the
10425expansion fails. Otherwise, this operator converts the IP address to binary,
10426masks off the least significant bits according to the bit count, and converts
10427the result back to text, with mask appended. For example,
10428.code
10429${mask:10.111.131.206/28}
10430.endd
10431returns the string &"10.111.131.192/28"&. Since this operation is expected to
10432be mostly used for looking up masked addresses in files, the result for an IPv6
10433address uses dots to separate components instead of colons, because colon
10434terminates a key string in lsearch files. So, for example,
10435.code
10436${mask:3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031/99}
10437.endd
10438returns the string
10439.code
104403ffe.ffff.836f.0a00.000a.0800.2000.0000/99
10441.endd
10442Letters in IPv6 addresses are always output in lower case.
10443
10444
10445.vitem &*${md5:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10446.cindex "MD5 hash"
10447.cindex "expansion" "MD5 hash"
10448.cindex certificate fingerprint
10449.cindex "&%md5%& expansion item"
10450The &%md5%& operator computes the MD5 hash value of the string, and returns it
10451as a 32-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in lower case.
10452
10453If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10454returns the MD5 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
10455
10456
10457.vitem &*${nhash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10458.cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
10459.cindex "hash function" "numeric"
10460The &%nhash%& operator is a simpler interface to the numeric hashing function
10461that can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to
10462strings that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10463.code
10464${nhash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
10465.endd
10466See the description of the general &%nhash%& item above for details.
10467
10468
10469.vitem &*${quote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10470.cindex "quoting" "in string expansions"
10471.cindex "expansion" "quoting"
10472.cindex "&%quote%& expansion item"
10473The &%quote%& operator puts its argument into double quotes if it
10474is an empty string or
10475contains anything other than letters, digits, underscores, dots, and hyphens.
10476Any occurrences of double quotes and backslashes are escaped with a backslash.
10477Newlines and carriage returns are converted to &`\n`& and &`\r`&,
10478respectively For example,
10479.code
10480${quote:ab"*"cd}
10481.endd
10482becomes
10483.code
10484"ab\"*\"cd"
10485.endd
10486The place where this is useful is when the argument is a substitution from a
10487variable or a message header.
10488
10489.vitem &*${quote_local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10490.cindex "&%quote_local_part%& expansion item"
10491This operator is like &%quote%&, except that it quotes the string only if
10492required to do so by the rules of RFC 2822 for quoting local parts. For
10493example, a plus sign would not cause quoting (but it would for &%quote%&).
10494If you are creating a new email address from the contents of &$local_part$&
10495(or any other unknown data), you should always use this operator.
10496
10497
10498.vitem &*${quote_*&<&'lookup-type'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10499.cindex "quoting" "lookup-specific"
10500This operator applies lookup-specific quoting rules to the string. Each
10501query-style lookup type has its own quoting rules which are described with
10502the lookups in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example,
10503.code
10504${quote_ldap:two * two}
10505.endd
10506returns
10507.code
10508two%20%5C2A%20two
10509.endd
10510For single-key lookup types, no quoting is ever necessary and this operator
10511yields an unchanged string.
10512
10513
10514.vitem &*${randint:*&<&'n'&>&*}*&
10515.cindex "random number"
10516This operator returns a somewhat random number which is less than the
10517supplied number and is at least 0. The quality of this randomness depends
10518on how Exim was built; the values are not suitable for keying material.
10519If Exim is linked against OpenSSL then RAND_pseudo_bytes() is used.
10520If Exim is linked against GnuTLS then gnutls_rnd(GNUTLS_RND_NONCE) is used,
10521for versions of GnuTLS with that function.
10522Otherwise, the implementation may be arc4random(), random() seeded by
10523srandomdev() or srandom(), or a custom implementation even weaker than
10524random().
10525
10526
10527.vitem &*${reverse_ip:*&<&'ipaddr'&>&*}*&
10528.cindex "expansion" "IP address"
10529This operator reverses an IP address; for IPv4 addresses, the result is in
10530dotted-quad decimal form, while for IPv6 addresses the result is in
10531dotted-nibble hexadecimal form. In both cases, this is the "natural" form
10532for DNS. For example,
10533.code
10534${reverse_ip:192.0.2.4}
10535${reverse_ip:2001:0db8:c42:9:1:abcd:192.0.2.127}
10536.endd
10537returns
10538.code
105394.2.0.192
10540f.7.2.0.0.0.0.c.d.c.b.a.1.0.0.0.9.0.0.0.2.4.c.0.8.b.d.0.1.0.0.2
10541.endd
10542
10543
10544.vitem &*${rfc2047:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10545.cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
10546.cindex "RFC 2047" "expansion operator"
10547.cindex "&%rfc2047%& expansion item"
10548This operator encodes text according to the rules of RFC 2047. This is an
10549encoding that is used in header lines to encode non-ASCII characters. It is
10550assumed that the input string is in the encoding specified by the
10551&%headers_charset%& option, which gets its default at build time. If the string
10552contains only characters in the range 33&--126, and no instances of the
10553characters
10554.code
10555? = ( ) < > @ , ; : \ " . [ ] _
10556.endd
10557it is not modified. Otherwise, the result is the RFC 2047 encoding of the
10558string, using as many &"encoded words"& as necessary to encode all the
10559characters.
10560
10561
10562.vitem &*${rfc2047d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10563.cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
10564.cindex "RFC 2047" "decoding"
10565.cindex "&%rfc2047d%& expansion item"
10566This operator decodes strings that are encoded as per RFC 2047. Binary zero
10567bytes are replaced by question marks. Characters are converted into the
10568character set defined by &%headers_charset%&. Overlong RFC 2047 &"words"& are
10569not recognized unless &%check_rfc2047_length%& is set false.
10570
10571&*Note*&: If you use &%$header%&_&'xxx'&&*:*& (or &%$h%&_&'xxx'&&*:*&) to
10572access a header line, RFC 2047 decoding is done automatically. You do not need
10573to use this operator as well.
10574
10575
10576
10577.vitem &*${rxquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10578.cindex "quoting" "in regular expressions"
10579.cindex "regular expressions" "quoting"
10580.cindex "&%rxquote%& expansion item"
10581The &%rxquote%& operator inserts a backslash before any non-alphanumeric
10582characters in its argument. This is useful when substituting the values of
10583variables or headers inside regular expressions.
10584
10585
10586.vitem &*${sha1:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10587.cindex "SHA-1 hash"
10588.cindex "expansion" "SHA-1 hashing"
10589.cindex certificate fingerprint
10590.cindex "&%sha1%& expansion item"
10591The &%sha1%& operator computes the SHA-1 hash value of the string, and returns
10592it as a 40-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10593
10594If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10595returns the SHA-1 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
10596
10597
10598.vitem &*${sha256:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10599.cindex "SHA-256 hash"
10600.cindex certificate fingerprint
10601.cindex "expansion" "SHA-256 hashing"
10602.cindex "&%sha256%& expansion item"
10603The &%sha256%& operator computes the SHA-256 hash value of the string
10604and returns
10605it as a 64-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10606
10607If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10608returns the SHA-256 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
10609
10610
10611.vitem &*${sha3:*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
10612 &*${sha3_<n>:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10613.cindex "SHA3 hash"
10614.cindex "expansion" "SHA3 hashing"
10615.cindex "&%sha3%& expansion item"
10616The &%sha3%& operator computes the SHA3-256 hash value of the string
10617and returns
10618it as a 64-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10619
10620If a number is appended, separated by an underbar, it specifies
10621the output length. Values of 224, 256, 384 and 512 are accepted;
10622with 256 being the default.
10623
10624The &%sha3%& expansion item is only supported if Exim has been
10625compiled with GnuTLS 3.5.0 or later.
10626
10627
10628.vitem &*${stat:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10629.cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
10630.cindex "file" "extracting characteristics"
10631.cindex "&%stat%& expansion item"
10632The string, after expansion, must be a file path. A call to the &[stat()]&
10633function is made for this path. If &[stat()]& fails, an error occurs and the
10634expansion fails. If it succeeds, the data from the stat replaces the item, as a
10635series of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> pairs, where the values are all numerical,
10636except for the value of &"smode"&. The names are: &"mode"& (giving the mode as
10637a 4-digit octal number), &"smode"& (giving the mode in symbolic format as a
1063810-character string, as for the &'ls'& command), &"inode"&, &"device"&,
10639&"links"&, &"uid"&, &"gid"&, &"size"&, &"atime"&, &"mtime"&, and &"ctime"&. You
10640can extract individual fields using the &%extract%& expansion item.
10641
10642The use of the &%stat%& expansion in users' filter files can be locked out by
10643the system administrator. &*Warning*&: The file size may be incorrect on 32-bit
10644systems for files larger than 2GB.
10645
10646.vitem &*${str2b64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10647.cindex "&%str2b64%& expansion item"
10648Now deprecated, a synonym for the &%base64%& expansion operator.
10649
10650
10651
10652.vitem &*${strlen:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10653.cindex "expansion" "string length"
10654.cindex "string" "length in expansion"
10655.cindex "&%strlen%& expansion item"
10656The item is replace by the length of the expanded string, expressed as a
10657decimal number. &*Note*&: Do not confuse &%strlen%& with &%length%&.
10658
10659
10660.vitem &*${substr_*&<&'start'&>&*_*&<&'length'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10661.cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
10662.cindex "substring extraction"
10663.cindex "expansion" "substring expansion"
10664The &%substr%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%substr%& function that
10665can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings
10666that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10667.code
10668${substr{<start>}{<length>}{<string>}}
10669.endd
10670See the description of the general &%substr%& item above for details. The
10671abbreviation &%s%& can be used when &%substr%& is used as an operator.
10672
10673.vitem &*${time_eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10674.cindex "&%time_eval%& expansion item"
10675.cindex "time interval" "decoding"
10676This item converts an Exim time interval such as &`2d4h5m`& into a number of
10677seconds.
10678
10679.vitem &*${time_interval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10680.cindex "&%time_interval%& expansion item"
10681.cindex "time interval" "formatting"
10682The argument (after sub-expansion) must be a sequence of decimal digits that
10683represents an interval of time as a number of seconds. It is converted into a
10684number of larger units and output in Exim's normal time format, for example,
10685&`1w3d4h2m6s`&.
10686
10687.vitem &*${uc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10688.cindex "case forcing in strings"
10689.cindex "string" "case forcing"
10690.cindex "upper casing"
10691.cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
10692.cindex "&%uc%& expansion item"
10693This forces the letters in the string into upper-case.
10694
10695.vitem &*${utf8clean:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10696.cindex "correction of invalid utf-8 sequences in strings"
10697.cindex "utf-8" "utf-8 sequences"
10698.cindex "incorrect utf-8"
10699.cindex "expansion" "utf-8 forcing"
10700.cindex "&%utf8clean%& expansion item"
10701This replaces any invalid utf-8 sequence in the string by the character &`?`&.
10702
10703.vitem "&*${utf8_domain_to_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
10704 "&*${utf8_domain_from_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
10705 "&*${utf8_localpart_to_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
10706 "&*${utf8_localpart_from_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&"
10707.cindex expansion UTF-8
10708.cindex UTF-8 expansion
10709.cindex EAI
10710.cindex internationalisation
10711.cindex "&%utf8_domain_to_alabel%& expansion item"
10712.cindex "&%utf8_domain_from_alabel%& expansion item"
10713.cindex "&%utf8_localpart_to_alabel%& expansion item"
10714.cindex "&%utf8_localpart_from_alabel%& expansion item"
10715These convert EAI mail name components between UTF-8 and a-label forms.
10716For information on internationalisation support see &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
10717.endlist
10718
10719
10720
10721
10722
10723
10724.section "Expansion conditions" "SECTexpcond"
10725.scindex IIDexpcond "expansion" "conditions"
10726The following conditions are available for testing by the &%${if%& construct
10727while expanding strings:
10728
10729.vlist
10730.vitem &*!*&<&'condition'&>
10731.cindex "expansion" "negating a condition"
10732.cindex "negation" "in expansion condition"
10733Preceding any condition with an exclamation mark negates the result of the
10734condition.
10735
10736.vitem <&'symbolic&~operator'&>&~&*{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10737.cindex "numeric comparison"
10738.cindex "expansion" "numeric comparison"
10739There are a number of symbolic operators for doing numeric comparisons. They
10740are:
10741.display
10742&`= `& equal
10743&`== `& equal
10744&`> `& greater
10745&`>= `& greater or equal
10746&`< `& less
10747&`<= `& less or equal
10748.endd
10749For example:
10750.code
10751${if >{$message_size}{10M} ...
10752.endd
10753Note that the general negation operator provides for inequality testing. The
10754two strings must take the form of optionally signed decimal integers,
10755optionally followed by one of the letters &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& (in either upper or
10756lower case), signifying multiplication by 1024, 1024*1024 or 1024*1024*1024, respectively.
10757As a special case, the numerical value of an empty string is taken as
10758zero.
10759
10760In all cases, a relative comparator OP is testing if <&'string1'&> OP
10761<&'string2'&>; the above example is checking if &$message_size$& is larger than
1076210M, not if 10M is larger than &$message_size$&.
10763
10764
10765.vitem &*acl&~{{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg1'&>&*}&&&
10766 {*&<&'arg2'&>&*}...}*&
10767.cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
10768.cindex "&%acl%&" "expansion condition"
10769The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
10770arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
10771Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
10772arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
10773and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
10774are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
10775a value using a "message =" modifier the variable $value becomes
10776the result of the expansion, otherwise it is empty.
10777If the ACL returns accept the condition is true; if deny, false.
10778If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail.
10779
10780.vitem &*bool&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10781.cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
10782.cindex "&%bool%& expansion condition"
10783This condition turns a string holding a true or false representation into
10784a boolean state. It parses &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"& and &"no"&
10785(case-insensitively); also integer numbers map to true if non-zero,
10786false if zero.
10787An empty string is treated as false.
10788Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored;
10789thus a string consisting only of whitespace is false.
10790All other string values will result in expansion failure.
10791
10792When combined with ACL variables, this expansion condition will let you
10793make decisions in one place and act on those decisions in another place.
10794For example:
10795.code
10796${if bool{$acl_m_privileged_sender} ...
10797.endd
10798
10799
10800.vitem &*bool_lax&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10801.cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
10802.cindex "&%bool_lax%& expansion condition"
10803Like &%bool%&, this condition turns a string into a boolean state. But
10804where &%bool%& accepts a strict set of strings, &%bool_lax%& uses the same
10805loose definition that the Router &%condition%& option uses. The empty string
10806and the values &"false"&, &"no"& and &"0"& map to false, all others map to
10807true. Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored.
10808
10809Note that where &"bool{00}"& is false, &"bool_lax{00}"& is true.
10810
10811.vitem &*crypteq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10812.cindex "expansion" "encrypted comparison"
10813.cindex "encrypted strings, comparing"
10814.cindex "&%crypteq%& expansion condition"
10815This condition is included in the Exim binary if it is built to support any
10816authentication mechanisms (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). Otherwise, it is
10817necessary to define SUPPORT_CRYPTEQ in &_Local/Makefile_& to get &%crypteq%&
10818included in the binary.
10819
10820The &%crypteq%& condition has two arguments. The first is encrypted and
10821compared against the second, which is already encrypted. The second string may
10822be in the LDAP form for storing encrypted strings, which starts with the
10823encryption type in curly brackets, followed by the data. If the second string
10824does not begin with &"{"& it is assumed to be encrypted with &[crypt()]& or
10825&[crypt16()]& (see below), since such strings cannot begin with &"{"&.
10826Typically this will be a field from a password file. An example of an encrypted
10827string in LDAP form is:
10828.code
10829{md5}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==
10830.endd
10831If such a string appears directly in an expansion, the curly brackets have to
10832be quoted, because they are part of the expansion syntax. For example:
10833.code
10834${if crypteq {test}{\{md5\}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==}{yes}{no}}
10835.endd
10836The following encryption types (whose names are matched case-independently) are
10837supported:
10838
10839.ilist
10840.cindex "MD5 hash"
10841.cindex "base64 encoding" "in encrypted password"
10842&%{md5}%& computes the MD5 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
10843printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
10844length of the comparison string is 24, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded
10845(as in the above example). If the length is 32, Exim assumes that it is a
10846hexadecimal encoding of the MD5 digest. If the length not 24 or 32, the
10847comparison fails.
10848
10849.next
10850.cindex "SHA-1 hash"
10851&%{sha1}%& computes the SHA-1 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
10852printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
10853length of the comparison string is 28, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded.
10854If the length is 40, Exim assumes that it is a hexadecimal encoding of the
10855SHA-1 digest. If the length is not 28 or 40, the comparison fails.
10856
10857.next
10858.cindex "&[crypt()]&"
10859&%{crypt}%& calls the &[crypt()]& function, which traditionally used to use
10860only the first eight characters of the password. However, in modern operating
10861systems this is no longer true, and in many cases the entire password is used,
10862whatever its length.
10863
10864.next
10865.cindex "&[crypt16()]&"
10866&%{crypt16}%& calls the &[crypt16()]& function, which was originally created to
10867use up to 16 characters of the password in some operating systems. Again, in
10868modern operating systems, more characters may be used.
10869.endlist
10870Exim has its own version of &[crypt16()]&, which is just a double call to
10871&[crypt()]&. For operating systems that have their own version, setting
10872HAVE_CRYPT16 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim causes it to use the
10873operating system version instead of its own. This option is set by default in
10874the OS-dependent &_Makefile_& for those operating systems that are known to
10875support &[crypt16()]&.
10876
10877Some years after Exim's &[crypt16()]& was implemented, a user discovered that
10878it was not using the same algorithm as some operating systems' versions. It
10879turns out that as well as &[crypt16()]& there is a function called
10880&[bigcrypt()]& in some operating systems. This may or may not use the same
10881algorithm, and both of them may be different to Exim's built-in &[crypt16()]&.
10882
10883However, since there is now a move away from the traditional &[crypt()]&
10884functions towards using SHA1 and other algorithms, tidying up this area of
10885Exim is seen as very low priority.
10886
10887If you do not put a encryption type (in curly brackets) in a &%crypteq%&
10888comparison, the default is usually either &`{crypt}`& or &`{crypt16}`&, as
10889determined by the setting of DEFAULT_CRYPT in &_Local/Makefile_&. The default
10890default is &`{crypt}`&. Whatever the default, you can always use either
10891function by specifying it explicitly in curly brackets.
10892
10893.vitem &*def:*&<&'variable&~name'&>
10894.cindex "expansion" "checking for empty variable"
10895.cindex "&%def%& expansion condition"
10896The &%def%& condition must be followed by the name of one of the expansion
10897variables defined in section &<<SECTexpvar>>&. The condition is true if the
10898variable does not contain the empty string. For example:
10899.code
10900${if def:sender_ident {from $sender_ident}}
10901.endd
10902Note that the variable name is given without a leading &%$%& character. If the
10903variable does not exist, the expansion fails.
10904
10905.vitem "&*def:header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~&~or&~&&&
10906 &~&*def:h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
10907.cindex "expansion" "checking header line existence"
10908This condition is true if a message is being processed and the named header
10909exists in the message. For example,
10910.code
10911${if def:header_reply-to:{$h_reply-to:}{$h_from:}}
10912.endd
10913&*Note*&: No &%$%& appears before &%header_%& or &%h_%& in the condition, and
10914the header name must be terminated by a colon if white space does not follow.
10915
10916.vitem &*eq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10917 &*eqi&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10918.cindex "string" "comparison"
10919.cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10920.cindex "&%eq%& expansion condition"
10921.cindex "&%eqi%& expansion condition"
10922The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the two
10923resulting strings are identical. For &%eq%& the comparison includes the case of
10924letters, whereas for &%eqi%& the comparison is case-independent.
10925
10926.vitem &*exists&~{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}*&
10927.cindex "expansion" "file existence test"
10928.cindex "file" "existence test"
10929.cindex "&%exists%&, expansion condition"
10930The substring is first expanded and then interpreted as an absolute path. The
10931condition is true if the named file (or directory) exists. The existence test
10932is done by calling the &[stat()]& function. The use of the &%exists%& test in
10933users' filter files may be locked out by the system administrator.
10934
10935.vitem &*first_delivery*&
10936.cindex "delivery" "first"
10937.cindex "first delivery"
10938.cindex "expansion" "first delivery test"
10939.cindex "&%first_delivery%& expansion condition"
10940This condition, which has no data, is true during a message's first delivery
10941attempt. It is false during any subsequent delivery attempts.
10942
10943
10944.vitem "&*forall{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
10945 "&*forany{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
10946.cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
10947.cindex "expansion" "&*forall*& condition"
10948.cindex "expansion" "&*forany*& condition"
10949.vindex "&$item$&"
10950These conditions iterate over a list. The first argument is expanded to form
10951the list. By default, the list separator is a colon, but it can be changed by
10952the normal method. The second argument is interpreted as a condition that is to
10953be applied to each item in the list in turn. During the interpretation of the
10954condition, the current list item is placed in a variable called &$item$&.
10955.ilist
10956For &*forany*&, interpretation stops if the condition is true for any item, and
10957the result of the whole condition is true. If the condition is false for all
10958items in the list, the overall condition is false.
10959.next
10960For &*forall*&, interpretation stops if the condition is false for any item,
10961and the result of the whole condition is false. If the condition is true for
10962all items in the list, the overall condition is true.
10963.endlist
10964Note that negation of &*forany*& means that the condition must be false for all
10965items for the overall condition to succeed, and negation of &*forall*& means
10966that the condition must be false for at least one item. In this example, the
10967list separator is changed to a comma:
10968.code
10969${if forany{<, $recipients}{match{$item}{^user3@}}{yes}{no}}
10970.endd
10971The value of &$item$& is saved and restored while &*forany*& or &*forall*& is
10972being processed, to enable these expansion items to be nested.
10973
10974To scan a named list, expand it with the &*listnamed*& operator.
10975
10976
10977.vitem &*ge&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10978 &*gei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10979.cindex "string" "comparison"
10980.cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10981.cindex "&%ge%& expansion condition"
10982.cindex "&%gei%& expansion condition"
10983The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10984string is lexically greater than or equal to the second string. For &%ge%& the
10985comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gei%& the comparison is
10986case-independent.
10987
10988.vitem &*gt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10989 &*gti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10990.cindex "string" "comparison"
10991.cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10992.cindex "&%gt%& expansion condition"
10993.cindex "&%gti%& expansion condition"
10994The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10995string is lexically greater than the second string. For &%gt%& the comparison
10996includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gti%& the comparison is
10997case-independent.
10998
10999.vitem &*inlist&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11000 &*inlisti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11001.cindex "string" "comparison"
11002.cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
11003Both strings are expanded; the second string is treated as a list of simple
11004strings; if the first string is a member of the second, then the condition
11005is true.
11006
11007These are simpler to use versions of the more powerful &*forany*& condition.
11008Examples, and the &*forany*& equivalents:
11009.code
11010${if inlist{needle}{foo:needle:bar}}
11011 ${if forany{foo:needle:bar}{eq{$item}{needle}}}
11012${if inlisti{Needle}{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}}
11013 ${if forany{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}{eqi{$item}{Needle}}}
11014.endd
11015
11016.vitem &*isip&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11017 &*isip4&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11018 &*isip6&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11019.cindex "IP address" "testing string format"
11020.cindex "string" "testing for IP address"
11021.cindex "&%isip%& expansion condition"
11022.cindex "&%isip4%& expansion condition"
11023.cindex "&%isip6%& expansion condition"
11024The substring is first expanded, and then tested to see if it has the form of
11025an IP address. Both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses are valid for &%isip%&, whereas
11026&%isip4%& and &%isip6%& test specifically for IPv4 or IPv6 addresses.
11027
11028For an IPv4 address, the test is for four dot-separated components, each of
11029which consists of from one to three digits. For an IPv6 address, up to eight
11030colon-separated components are permitted, each containing from one to four
11031hexadecimal digits. There may be fewer than eight components if an empty
11032component (adjacent colons) is present. Only one empty component is permitted.
11033
11034.new
11035&*Note*&: The checks used to be just on the form of the address; actual numerical
11036values were not considered. Thus, for example, 999.999.999.999 passed the IPv4
11037check.
11038This is no longer the case.
11039.wen
11040
11041The main use of these tests is to distinguish between IP addresses and
11042host names, or between IPv4 and IPv6 addresses. For example, you could use
11043.code
11044${if isip4{$sender_host_address}...
11045.endd
11046to test which IP version an incoming SMTP connection is using.
11047
11048.vitem &*ldapauth&~{*&<&'ldap&~query'&>&*}*&
11049.cindex "LDAP" "use for authentication"
11050.cindex "expansion" "LDAP authentication test"
11051.cindex "&%ldapauth%& expansion condition"
11052This condition supports user authentication using LDAP. See section
11053&<<SECTldap>>& for details of how to use LDAP in lookups and the syntax of
11054queries. For this use, the query must contain a user name and password. The
11055query itself is not used, and can be empty. The condition is true if the
11056password is not empty, and the user name and password are accepted by the LDAP
11057server. An empty password is rejected without calling LDAP because LDAP binds
11058with an empty password are considered anonymous regardless of the username, and
11059will succeed in most configurations. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details
11060of SMTP authentication, and chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& for an example of how
11061this can be used.
11062
11063
11064.vitem &*le&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11065 &*lei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11066.cindex "string" "comparison"
11067.cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11068.cindex "&%le%& expansion condition"
11069.cindex "&%lei%& expansion condition"
11070The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11071string is lexically less than or equal to the second string. For &%le%& the
11072comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lei%& the comparison is
11073case-independent.
11074
11075.vitem &*lt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11076 &*lti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11077.cindex "string" "comparison"
11078.cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11079.cindex "&%lt%& expansion condition"
11080.cindex "&%lti%& expansion condition"
11081The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11082string is lexically less than the second string. For &%lt%& the comparison
11083includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lti%& the comparison is
11084case-independent.
11085
11086
11087.vitem &*match&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11088.cindex "expansion" "regular expression comparison"
11089.cindex "regular expressions" "match in expanded string"
11090.cindex "&%match%& expansion condition"
11091The two substrings are first expanded. The second is then treated as a regular
11092expression and applied to the first. Because of the pre-expansion, if the
11093regular expression contains dollar, or backslash characters, they must be
11094escaped. Care must also be taken if the regular expression contains braces
11095(curly brackets). A closing brace must be escaped so that it is not taken as a
11096premature termination of <&'string2'&>. The easiest approach is to use the
11097&`\N`& feature to disable expansion of the regular expression.
11098For example,
11099.code
11100${if match {$local_part}{\N^\d{3}\N} ...
11101.endd
11102If the whole expansion string is in double quotes, further escaping of
11103backslashes is also required.
11104
11105The condition is true if the regular expression match succeeds.
11106The regular expression is not required to begin with a circumflex
11107metacharacter, but if there is no circumflex, the expression is not anchored,
11108and it may match anywhere in the subject, not just at the start. If you want
11109the pattern to match at the end of the subject, you must include the &`$`&
11110metacharacter at an appropriate point.
11111
11112.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%if%& expansion"
11113At the start of an &%if%& expansion the values of the numeric variable
11114substitutions &$1$& etc. are remembered. Obeying a &%match%& condition that
11115succeeds causes them to be reset to the substrings of that condition and they
11116will have these values during the expansion of the success string. At the end
11117of the &%if%& expansion, the previous values are restored. After testing a
11118combination of conditions using &%or%&, the subsequent values of the numeric
11119variables are those of the condition that succeeded.
11120
11121.vitem &*match_address&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11122.cindex "&%match_address%& expansion condition"
11123See &*match_local_part*&.
11124
11125.vitem &*match_domain&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11126.cindex "&%match_domain%& expansion condition"
11127See &*match_local_part*&.
11128
11129.vitem &*match_ip&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11130.cindex "&%match_ip%& expansion condition"
11131This condition matches an IP address to a list of IP address patterns. It must
11132be followed by two argument strings. The first (after expansion) must be an IP
11133address or an empty string. The second (not expanded) is a restricted host
11134list that can match only an IP address, not a host name. For example:
11135.code
11136${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{1.2.3.4:5.6.7.8}{...}{...}}
11137.endd
11138The specific types of host list item that are permitted in the list are:
11139
11140.ilist
11141An IP address, optionally with a CIDR mask.
11142.next
11143A single asterisk, which matches any IP address.
11144.next
11145An empty item, which matches only if the IP address is empty. This could be
11146useful for testing for a locally submitted message or one from specific hosts
11147in a single test such as
11148. ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
11149. ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. This comment applies to
11150. ==== the use of xmlto plus fop. There's no problem when formatting with
11151. ==== sdop, with or without the extra indent.
11152.code
11153 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{:4.3.2.1:...}{...}{...}}
11154.endd
11155where the first item in the list is the empty string.
11156.next
11157The item @[] matches any of the local host's interface addresses.
11158.next
11159Single-key lookups are assumed to be like &"net-"& style lookups in host lists,
11160even if &`net-`& is not specified. There is never any attempt to turn the IP
11161address into a host name. The most common type of linear search for
11162&*match_ip*& is likely to be &*iplsearch*&, in which the file can contain CIDR
11163masks. For example:
11164.code
11165 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{iplsearch;/some/file}...
11166.endd
11167It is of course possible to use other kinds of lookup, and in such a case, you
11168do need to specify the &`net-`& prefix if you want to specify a specific
11169address mask, for example:
11170.code
11171 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{net24-dbm;/some/file}...
11172.endd
11173However, unless you are combining a &%match_ip%& condition with others, it is
11174just as easy to use the fact that a lookup is itself a condition, and write:
11175.code
11176 ${lookup{${mask:$sender_host_address/24}}dbm{/a/file}...
11177.endd
11178.endlist ilist
11179
11180Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
11181Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
11182
11183Consult section &<<SECThoslispatip>>& for further details of these patterns.
11184
11185.vitem &*match_local_part&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11186.cindex "domain list" "in expansion condition"
11187.cindex "address list" "in expansion condition"
11188.cindex "local part" "list, in expansion condition"
11189.cindex "&%match_local_part%& expansion condition"
11190This condition, together with &%match_address%& and &%match_domain%&, make it
11191possible to test domain, address, and local part lists within expansions. Each
11192condition requires two arguments: an item and a list to match. A trivial
11193example is:
11194.code
11195${if match_domain{a.b.c}{x.y.z:a.b.c:p.q.r}{yes}{no}}
11196.endd
11197In each case, the second argument may contain any of the allowable items for a
11198list of the appropriate type. Also, because the second argument
11199is a standard form of list, it is possible to refer to a named list.
11200Thus, you can use conditions like this:
11201.code
11202${if match_domain{$domain}{+local_domains}{...
11203.endd
11204.cindex "&`+caseful`&"
11205For address lists, the matching starts off caselessly, but the &`+caseful`&
11206item can be used, as in all address lists, to cause subsequent items to
11207have their local parts matched casefully. Domains are always matched
11208caselessly.
11209
11210Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
11211Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
11212
11213&*Note*&: Host lists are &'not'& supported in this way. This is because
11214hosts have two identities: a name and an IP address, and it is not clear
11215how to specify cleanly how such a test would work. However, IP addresses can be
11216matched using &%match_ip%&.
11217
11218.vitem &*pam&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*:...}*&
11219.cindex "PAM authentication"
11220.cindex "AUTH" "with PAM"
11221.cindex "Solaris" "PAM support"
11222.cindex "expansion" "PAM authentication test"
11223.cindex "&%pam%& expansion condition"
11224&'Pluggable Authentication Modules'&
11225(&url(http://www.kernel.org/pub/linux/libs/pam/)) are a facility that is
11226available in the latest releases of Solaris and in some GNU/Linux
11227distributions. The Exim support, which is intended for use in conjunction with
11228the SMTP AUTH command, is available only if Exim is compiled with
11229.code
11230SUPPORT_PAM=yes
11231.endd
11232in &_Local/Makefile_&. You probably need to add &%-lpam%& to EXTRALIBS, and
11233in some releases of GNU/Linux &%-ldl%& is also needed.
11234
11235The argument string is first expanded, and the result must be a
11236colon-separated list of strings. Leading and trailing white space is ignored.
11237The PAM module is initialized with the service name &"exim"& and the user name
11238taken from the first item in the colon-separated data string (<&'string1'&>).
11239The remaining items in the data string are passed over in response to requests
11240from the authentication function. In the simple case there will only be one
11241request, for a password, so the data consists of just two strings.
11242
11243There can be problems if any of the strings are permitted to contain colon
11244characters. In the usual way, these have to be doubled to avoid being taken as
11245separators. If the data is being inserted from a variable, the &%sg%& expansion
11246item can be used to double any existing colons. For example, the configuration
11247of a LOGIN authenticator might contain this setting:
11248.code
11249server_condition = ${if pam{$auth1:${sg{$auth2}{:}{::}}}}
11250.endd
11251For a PLAIN authenticator you could use:
11252.code
11253server_condition = ${if pam{$auth2:${sg{$auth3}{:}{::}}}}
11254.endd
11255In some operating systems, PAM authentication can be done only from a process
11256running as root. Since Exim is running as the Exim user when receiving
11257messages, this means that PAM cannot be used directly in those systems.
11258A patched version of the &'pam_unix'& module that comes with the
11259Linux PAM package is available from &url(http://www.e-admin.de/pam_exim/).
11260The patched module allows one special uid/gid combination, in addition to root,
11261to authenticate. If you build the patched module to allow the Exim user and
11262group, PAM can then be used from an Exim authenticator.
11263
11264
11265.vitem &*pwcheck&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11266.cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
11267.cindex "Cyrus"
11268.cindex "expansion" "&'pwcheck'& authentication test"
11269.cindex "&%pwcheck%& expansion condition"
11270This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& daemon.
11271This is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked by a process
11272that is not running as root. &*Note*&: The use of &'pwcheck'& is now
11273deprecated. Its replacement is &'saslauthd'& (see below).
11274
11275The pwcheck support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
11276the location of the pwcheck daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
11277building Exim. For example:
11278.code
11279CYRUS_PWCHECK_SOCKET=/var/pwcheck/pwcheck
11280.endd
11281You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
11282the pwcheck daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
11283from the Cyrus SASL library. Ensure that &'exim'& is the only user that has
11284access to the &_/var/pwcheck_& directory.
11285
11286The &%pwcheck%& condition takes one argument, which must be the user name and
11287password, separated by a colon. For example, in a LOGIN authenticator
11288configuration, you might have this:
11289.code
11290server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth1:$auth2}}
11291.endd
11292Again, for a PLAIN authenticator configuration, this would be:
11293.code
11294server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth2:$auth3}}
11295.endd
11296.vitem &*queue_running*&
11297.cindex "queue runner" "detecting when delivering from"
11298.cindex "expansion" "queue runner test"
11299.cindex "&%queue_running%& expansion condition"
11300This condition, which has no data, is true during delivery attempts that are
11301initiated by queue runner processes, and false otherwise.
11302
11303
11304.vitem &*radius&~{*&<&'authentication&~string'&>&*}*&
11305.cindex "Radius"
11306.cindex "expansion" "Radius authentication"
11307.cindex "&%radius%& expansion condition"
11308Radius authentication (RFC 2865) is supported in a similar way to PAM. You must
11309set RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& to specify the location of
11310the Radius client configuration file in order to build Exim with Radius
11311support.
11312
11313With just that one setting, Exim expects to be linked with the &%radiusclient%&
11314library, using the original API. If you are using release 0.4.0 or later of
11315this library, you need to set
11316.code
11317RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADIUSCLIENTNEW
11318.endd
11319in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim. You can also link Exim with the
11320&%libradius%& library that comes with FreeBSD. To do this, set
11321.code
11322RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADLIB
11323.endd
11324in &_Local/Makefile_&, in addition to setting RADIUS_CONFIGURE_FILE.
11325You may also have to supply a suitable setting in EXTRALIBS so that the
11326Radius library can be found when Exim is linked.
11327
11328The string specified by RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE is expanded and passed to the
11329Radius client library, which calls the Radius server. The condition is true if
11330the authentication is successful. For example:
11331.code
11332server_condition = ${if radius{<arguments>}}
11333.endd
11334
11335
11336.vitem "&*saslauthd&~{{*&<&'user'&>&*}{*&<&'password'&>&*}&&&
11337 {*&<&'service'&>&*}{*&<&'realm'&>&*}}*&"
11338.cindex "&'saslauthd'& daemon"
11339.cindex "Cyrus"
11340.cindex "expansion" "&'saslauthd'& authentication test"
11341.cindex "&%saslauthd%& expansion condition"
11342This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'saslauthd'&
11343daemon. This replaces the older &'pwcheck'& daemon, which is now deprecated.
11344Using this daemon is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked
11345by a process that is not running as root.
11346
11347The saslauthd support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
11348the location of the saslauthd daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
11349building Exim. For example:
11350.code
11351CYRUS_SASLAUTHD_SOCKET=/var/state/saslauthd/mux
11352.endd
11353You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
11354the saslauthd daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
11355from the Cyrus SASL library.
11356
11357Up to four arguments can be supplied to the &%saslauthd%& condition, but only
11358two are mandatory. For example:
11359.code
11360server_condition = ${if saslauthd{{$auth1}{$auth2}}}
11361.endd
11362The service and the realm are optional (which is why the arguments are enclosed
11363in their own set of braces). For details of the meaning of the service and
11364realm, and how to run the daemon, consult the Cyrus documentation.
11365.endlist vlist
11366
11367
11368
11369.section "Combining expansion conditions" "SECID84"
11370.cindex "expansion" "combining conditions"
11371Several conditions can be tested at once by combining them using the &%and%&
11372and &%or%& combination conditions. Note that &%and%& and &%or%& are complete
11373conditions on their own, and precede their lists of sub-conditions. Each
11374sub-condition must be enclosed in braces within the overall braces that contain
11375the list. No repetition of &%if%& is used.
11376
11377
11378.vlist
11379.vitem &*or&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
11380.cindex "&""or""& expansion condition"
11381.cindex "expansion" "&""or""& of conditions"
11382The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
11383any one of the sub-conditions is true.
11384For example,
11385.code
11386${if or {{eq{$local_part}{spqr}}{eq{$domain}{testing.com}}}...
11387.endd
11388When a true sub-condition is found, the following ones are parsed but not
11389evaluated. If there are several &"match"& sub-conditions the values of the
11390numeric variables afterwards are taken from the first one that succeeds.
11391
11392.vitem &*and&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
11393.cindex "&""and""& expansion condition"
11394.cindex "expansion" "&""and""& of conditions"
11395The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
11396all of the sub-conditions are true. If there are several &"match"&
11397sub-conditions, the values of the numeric variables afterwards are taken from
11398the last one. When a false sub-condition is found, the following ones are
11399parsed but not evaluated.
11400.endlist
11401.ecindex IIDexpcond
11402
11403
11404
11405
11406.section "Expansion variables" "SECTexpvar"
11407.cindex "expansion" "variables, list of"
11408This section contains an alphabetical list of all the expansion variables. Some
11409of them are available only when Exim is compiled with specific options such as
11410support for TLS or the content scanning extension.
11411
11412.vlist
11413.vitem "&$0$&, &$1$&, etc"
11414.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)"
11415When a &%match%& expansion condition succeeds, these variables contain the
11416captured substrings identified by the regular expression during subsequent
11417processing of the success string of the containing &%if%& expansion item.
11418In the expansion condition case
11419they do not retain their values afterwards; in fact, their previous
11420values are restored at the end of processing an &%if%& item. The numerical
11421variables may also be set externally by some other matching process which
11422precedes the expansion of the string. For example, the commands available in
11423Exim filter files include an &%if%& command with its own regular expression
11424matching condition.
11425
11426.vitem "&$acl_arg1$&, &$acl_arg2$&, etc"
11427Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
11428any arguments are copied to these variables,
11429any unused variables being made empty.
11430
11431.vitem "&$acl_c...$&"
11432Values can be placed in these variables by the &%set%& modifier in an ACL. They
11433can be given any name that starts with &$acl_c$& and is at least six characters
11434long, but the sixth character must be either a digit or an underscore. For
11435example: &$acl_c5$&, &$acl_c_mycount$&. The values of the &$acl_c...$&
11436variables persist throughout the lifetime of an SMTP connection. They can be
11437used to pass information between ACLs and between different invocations of the
11438same ACL. When a message is received, the values of these variables are saved
11439with the message, and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports
11440during subsequent delivery.
11441
11442.vitem "&$acl_m...$&"
11443These variables are like the &$acl_c...$& variables, except that their values
11444are reset after a message has been received. Thus, if several messages are
11445received in one SMTP connection, &$acl_m...$& values are not passed on from one
11446message to the next, as &$acl_c...$& values are. The &$acl_m...$& variables are
11447also reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting a TLS session. When a
11448message is received, the values of these variables are saved with the message,
11449and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports during subsequent
11450delivery.
11451
11452.vitem &$acl_narg$&
11453Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
11454this variable has the number of arguments.
11455
11456.vitem &$acl_verify_message$&
11457.vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
11458After an address verification has failed, this variable contains the failure
11459message. It retains its value for use in subsequent modifiers. The message can
11460be preserved by coding like this:
11461.code
11462warn !verify = sender
11463 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
11464.endd
11465You can use &$acl_verify_message$& during the expansion of the &%message%& or
11466&%log_message%& modifiers, to include information about the verification
11467failure.
11468
11469.vitem &$address_data$&
11470.vindex "&$address_data$&"
11471This variable is set by means of the &%address_data%& option in routers. The
11472value then remains with the address while it is processed by subsequent routers
11473and eventually a transport. If the transport is handling multiple addresses,
11474the value from the first address is used. See chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&
11475for more details. &*Note*&: The contents of &$address_data$& are visible in
11476user filter files.
11477
11478If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify
11479a recipient address, the final value is still in the variable for subsequent
11480conditions and modifiers of the ACL statement. If routing the address caused it
11481to be redirected to just one address, the child address is also routed as part
11482of the verification, and in this case the final value of &$address_data$& is
11483from the child's routing.
11484
11485If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
11486sender address, the final value is also preserved, but this time in
11487&$sender_address_data$&, to distinguish it from data from a recipient
11488address.
11489
11490In both cases (recipient and sender verification), the value does not persist
11491after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve
11492these values for longer, you can save them in ACL variables.
11493
11494.vitem &$address_file$&
11495.vindex "&$address_file$&"
11496When, as a result of aliasing, forwarding, or filtering, a message is directed
11497to a specific file, this variable holds the name of the file when the transport
11498is running. At other times, the variable is empty. For example, using the
11499default configuration, if user &%r2d2%& has a &_.forward_& file containing
11500.code
11501/home/r2d2/savemail
11502.endd
11503then when the &(address_file)& transport is running, &$address_file$&
11504contains the text string &`/home/r2d2/savemail`&.
11505.cindex "Sieve filter" "value of &$address_file$&"
11506For Sieve filters, the value may be &"inbox"& or a relative folder name. It is
11507then up to the transport configuration to generate an appropriate absolute path
11508to the relevant file.
11509
11510.vitem &$address_pipe$&
11511.vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
11512When, as a result of aliasing or forwarding, a message is directed to a pipe,
11513this variable holds the pipe command when the transport is running.
11514
11515.vitem "&$auth1$& &-- &$auth3$&"
11516.vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
11517These variables are used in SMTP authenticators (see chapters
11518&<<CHAPplaintext>>&&--&<<CHAPtlsauth>>&). Elsewhere, they are empty.
11519
11520.vitem &$authenticated_id$&
11521.cindex "authentication" "id"
11522.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
11523When a server successfully authenticates a client it may be configured to
11524preserve some of the authentication information in the variable
11525&$authenticated_id$& (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). For example, a
11526user/password authenticator configuration might preserve the user name for use
11527in the routers. Note that this is not the same information that is saved in
11528&$sender_host_authenticated$&.
11529When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection)
11530the value of &$authenticated_id$& is normally the login name of the calling
11531process. However, a trusted user can override this by means of the &%-oMai%&
11532command line option.
11533
11534.vitem &$authenticated_fail_id$&
11535.cindex "authentication" "fail" "id"
11536.vindex "&$authenticated_fail_id$&"
11537When an authentication attempt fails, the variable &$authenticated_fail_id$&
11538will contain the failed authentication id. If more than one authentication
11539id is attempted, it will contain only the last one. The variable is
11540available for processing in the ACL's, generally the quit or notquit ACL.
11541A message to a local recipient could still be accepted without requiring
11542authentication, which means this variable could also be visible in all of
11543the ACL's as well.
11544
11545
11546.vitem &$authenticated_sender$&
11547.cindex "sender" "authenticated"
11548.cindex "authentication" "sender"
11549.cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
11550.vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
11551When acting as a server, Exim takes note of the AUTH= parameter on an incoming
11552SMTP MAIL command if it believes the sender is sufficiently trusted, as
11553described in section &<<SECTauthparamail>>&. Unless the data is the string
11554&"<>"&, it is set as the authenticated sender of the message, and the value is
11555available during delivery in the &$authenticated_sender$& variable. If the
11556sender is not trusted, Exim accepts the syntax of AUTH=, but ignores the data.
11557
11558.vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
11559When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection), the
11560value of &$authenticated_sender$& is an address constructed from the login
11561name of the calling process and &$qualify_domain$&, except that a trusted user
11562can override this by means of the &%-oMas%& command line option.
11563
11564
11565.vitem &$authentication_failed$&
11566.cindex "authentication" "failure"
11567.vindex "&$authentication_failed$&"
11568This variable is set to &"1"& in an Exim server if a client issues an AUTH
11569command that does not succeed. Otherwise it is set to &"0"&. This makes it
11570possible to distinguish between &"did not try to authenticate"&
11571(&$sender_host_authenticated$& is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to
11572&"0"&) and &"tried to authenticate but failed"& (&$sender_host_authenticated$&
11573is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to &"1"&). Failure includes any
11574negative response to an AUTH command, including (for example) an attempt to use
11575an undefined mechanism.
11576
11577.vitem &$av_failed$&
11578.cindex "content scanning" "AV scanner failure"
11579This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
11580extension. It is set to &"0"& by default, but will be set to &"1"& if any
11581problem occurs with the virus scanner (specified by &%av_scanner%&) during
11582the ACL malware condition.
11583
11584.vitem &$body_linecount$&
11585.cindex "message body" "line count"
11586.cindex "body of message" "line count"
11587.vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
11588When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11589number of lines in the message's body. See also &$message_linecount$&.
11590
11591.vitem &$body_zerocount$&
11592.cindex "message body" "binary zero count"
11593.cindex "body of message" "binary zero count"
11594.cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
11595.vindex "&$body_zerocount$&"
11596When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11597number of binary zero bytes (ASCII NULs) in the message's body.
11598
11599.vitem &$bounce_recipient$&
11600.vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
11601This is set to the recipient address of a bounce message while Exim is creating
11602it. It is useful if a customized bounce message text file is in use (see
11603chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
11604
11605.vitem &$bounce_return_size_limit$&
11606.vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
11607This contains the value set in the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& option, rounded
11608up to a multiple of 1000. It is useful when a customized error message text
11609file is in use (see chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
11610
11611.vitem &$caller_gid$&
11612.cindex "gid (group id)" "caller"
11613.vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
11614The real group id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
11615not the same as the group id of the originator of a message (see
11616&$originator_gid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
11617incarnation normally contains the Exim gid.
11618
11619.vitem &$caller_uid$&
11620.cindex "uid (user id)" "caller"
11621.vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
11622The real user id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
11623not the same as the user id of the originator of a message (see
11624&$originator_uid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
11625incarnation normally contains the Exim uid.
11626
11627.vitem &$callout_address$&
11628.vindex "&$callout_address$&"
11629After a callout for verification, spamd or malware daemon service, the
11630address that was connected to.
11631
11632.vitem &$compile_number$&
11633.vindex "&$compile_number$&"
11634The building process for Exim keeps a count of the number
11635of times it has been compiled. This serves to distinguish different
11636compilations of the same version of the program.
11637
11638.vitem &$config_dir$&
11639.vindex "&$config_dir$&"
11640The directory name of the main configuration file. That is, the content of
11641&$config_file$& with the last component stripped. The value does not
11642contain the trailing slash. If &$config_file$& does not contain a slash,
11643&$config_dir$& is ".".
11644
11645.vitem &$config_file$&
11646.vindex "&$config_file$&"
11647The name of the main configuration file Exim is using.
11648
11649.vitem &$dkim_cur_signer$& &&&
11650 &$dkim_verify_status$& &&&
11651 &$dkim_verify_reason$& &&&
11652 &$dkim_domain$& &&&
11653 &$dkim_identity$& &&&
11654 &$dkim_selector$& &&&
11655 &$dkim_algo$& &&&
11656 &$dkim_canon_body$& &&&
11657 &$dkim_canon_headers$& &&&
11658 &$dkim_copiedheaders$& &&&
11659 &$dkim_bodylength$& &&&
11660 &$dkim_created$& &&&
11661 &$dkim_expires$& &&&
11662 &$dkim_headernames$& &&&
11663 &$dkim_key_testing$& &&&
11664 &$dkim_key_nosubdomains$& &&&
11665 &$dkim_key_srvtype$& &&&
11666 &$dkim_key_granularity$& &&&
11667 &$dkim_key_notes$& &&&
11668 &$dkim_key_length$&
11669These variables are only available within the DKIM ACL.
11670For details see chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
11671
11672.vitem &$dkim_signers$&
11673.vindex &$dkim_signers$&
11674When a message has been received this variable contains
11675a colon-separated list of signer domains and identities for the message.
11676For details see chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
11677
11678.vitem &$dnslist_domain$& &&&
11679 &$dnslist_matched$& &&&
11680 &$dnslist_text$& &&&
11681 &$dnslist_value$&
11682.vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
11683.vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
11684.vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
11685.vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
11686.cindex "black list (DNS)"
11687When a DNS (black) list lookup succeeds, these variables are set to contain
11688the following data from the lookup: the list's domain name, the key that was
11689looked up, the contents of any associated TXT record, and the value from the
11690main A record. See section &<<SECID204>>& for more details.
11691
11692.vitem &$domain$&
11693.vindex "&$domain$&"
11694When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this variable
11695contains the domain. Uppercase letters in the domain are converted into lower
11696case for &$domain$&.
11697
11698Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
11699&$domain$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting. &$domain$&
11700is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering, because a
11701message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just once.
11702
11703When more than one address is being delivered at once (for example, several
11704RCPT commands in one SMTP delivery), &$domain$& is set only if they all
11705have the same domain. Transports can be restricted to handling only one domain
11706at a time if the value of &$domain$& is required at transport time &-- this is
11707the default for local transports. For further details of the environment in
11708which local transports are run, see chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
11709
11710.oindex "&%delay_warning_condition%&"
11711At the end of a delivery, if all deferred addresses have the same domain, it is
11712set in &$domain$& during the expansion of &%delay_warning_condition%&.
11713
11714The &$domain$& variable is also used in some other circumstances:
11715
11716.ilist
11717When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$domain$& contains the domain of
11718the recipient address. The domain of the &'sender'& address is in
11719&$sender_address_domain$& at both MAIL time and at RCPT time. &$domain$& is not
11720normally set during the running of the MAIL ACL. However, if the sender address
11721is verified with a callout during the MAIL ACL, the sender domain is placed in
11722&$domain$& during the expansions of &%hosts%&, &%interface%&, and &%port%& in
11723the &(smtp)& transport.
11724
11725.next
11726When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
11727&$domain$& contains the domain portion of the address that is being rewritten;
11728it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example, to
11729rewrite domains by file lookup.
11730
11731.next
11732With one important exception, whenever a domain list is being scanned,
11733&$domain$& contains the subject domain. &*Exception*&: When a domain list in
11734a &%sender_domains%& condition in an ACL is being processed, the subject domain
11735is in &$sender_address_domain$& and not in &$domain$&. It works this way so
11736that, in a RCPT ACL, the sender domain list can be dependent on the
11737recipient domain (which is what is in &$domain$& at this time).
11738
11739.next
11740.cindex "ETRN" "value of &$domain$&"
11741.oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
11742When the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option is being expanded, &$domain$& contains
11743the complete argument of the ETRN command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&).
11744.endlist
11745
11746
11747.vitem &$domain_data$&
11748.vindex "&$domain_data$&"
11749When the &%domains%& option on a router matches a domain by
11750means of a lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running
11751of the router as &$domain_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the
11752address to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the
11753transport is handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is
11754used.
11755
11756&$domain_data$& is also set when the &%domains%& condition in an ACL matches a
11757domain by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is available during
11758the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this variable expands
11759to nothing.
11760
11761.vitem &$exim_gid$&
11762.vindex "&$exim_gid$&"
11763This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim group id.
11764
11765.vitem &$exim_path$&
11766.vindex "&$exim_path$&"
11767This variable contains the path to the Exim binary.
11768
11769.vitem &$exim_uid$&
11770.vindex "&$exim_uid$&"
11771This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim user id.
11772
11773.vitem &$exim_version$&
11774.vindex "&$exim_version$&"
11775This variable contains the version string of the Exim build.
11776The first character is a major version number, currently 4.
11777Then after a dot, the next group of digits is a minor version number.
11778There may be other characters following the minor version.
11779
11780.vitem &$header_$&<&'name'&>
11781This is not strictly an expansion variable. It is expansion syntax for
11782inserting the message header line with the given name. Note that the name must
11783be terminated by colon or white space, because it may contain a wide variety of
11784characters. Note also that braces must &'not'& be used.
11785
11786.vitem &$headers_added$&
11787.vindex "&$headers_added$&"
11788Within an ACL this variable contains the headers added so far by
11789the ACL modifier add_header (section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
11790The headers are a newline-separated list.
11791
11792.vitem &$home$&
11793.vindex "&$home$&"
11794When the &%check_local_user%& option is set for a router, the user's home
11795directory is placed in &$home$& when the check succeeds. In particular, this
11796means it is set during the running of users' filter files. A router may also
11797explicitly set a home directory for use by a transport; this can be overridden
11798by a setting on the transport itself.
11799
11800When running a filter test via the &%-bf%& option, &$home$& is set to the value
11801of the environment variable HOME, which is subject to the
11802&%keep_environment%& and &%add_environment%& main config options.
11803
11804.vitem &$host$&
11805.vindex "&$host$&"
11806If a router assigns an address to a transport (any transport), and passes a
11807list of hosts with the address, the value of &$host$& when the transport starts
11808to run is the name of the first host on the list. Note that this applies both
11809to local and remote transports.
11810
11811.cindex "transport" "filter"
11812.cindex "filter" "transport filter"
11813For the &(smtp)& transport, if there is more than one host, the value of
11814&$host$& changes as the transport works its way through the list. In
11815particular, when the &(smtp)& transport is expanding its options for encryption
11816using TLS, or for specifying a transport filter (see chapter
11817&<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the host to which it
11818is connected.
11819
11820When used in the client part of an authenticator configuration (see chapter
11821&<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the server to which the
11822client is connected.
11823
11824
11825.vitem &$host_address$&
11826.vindex "&$host_address$&"
11827This variable is set to the remote host's IP address whenever &$host$& is set
11828for a remote connection. It is also set to the IP address that is being checked
11829when the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option is being processed.
11830
11831.vitem &$host_data$&
11832.vindex "&$host_data$&"
11833If a &%hosts%& condition in an ACL is satisfied by means of a lookup, the
11834result of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
11835allows you, for example, to do things like this:
11836.code
11837deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
11838message = $host_data
11839.endd
11840.vitem &$host_lookup_deferred$&
11841.cindex "host name" "lookup, failure of"
11842.vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
11843This variable normally contains &"0"&, as does &$host_lookup_failed$&. When a
11844message comes from a remote host and there is an attempt to look up the host's
11845name from its IP address, and the attempt is not successful, one of these
11846variables is set to &"1"&.
11847
11848.ilist
11849If the lookup receives a definite negative response (for example, a DNS lookup
11850succeeded, but no records were found), &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
11851
11852.next
11853If there is any kind of problem during the lookup, such that Exim cannot
11854tell whether or not the host name is defined (for example, a timeout for a DNS
11855lookup), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&.
11856.endlist ilist
11857
11858Looking up a host's name from its IP address consists of more than just a
11859single reverse lookup. Exim checks that a forward lookup of at least one of the
11860names it receives from a reverse lookup yields the original IP address. If this
11861is not the case, Exim does not accept the looked up name(s), and
11862&$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&. Thus, being able to find a name from an
11863IP address (for example, the existence of a PTR record in the DNS) is not
11864sufficient on its own for the success of a host name lookup. If the reverse
11865lookup succeeds, but there is a lookup problem such as a timeout when checking
11866the result, the name is not accepted, and &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to
11867&"1"&. See also &$sender_host_name$&.
11868
11869.vitem &$host_lookup_failed$&
11870.vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
11871See &$host_lookup_deferred$&.
11872
11873.vitem &$host_port$&
11874.vindex "&$host_port$&"
11875This variable is set to the remote host's TCP port whenever &$host$& is set
11876for an outbound connection.
11877
11878.vitem &$initial_cwd$&
11879.vindex "&$initial_cwd$&
11880This variable contains the full path name of the initial working
11881directory of the current Exim process. This may differ from the current
11882working directory, as Exim changes this to "/" during early startup, and
11883to &$spool_directory$& later.
11884
11885.vitem &$inode$&
11886.vindex "&$inode$&"
11887The only time this variable is set is while expanding the &%directory_file%&
11888option in the &(appendfile)& transport. The variable contains the inode number
11889of the temporary file which is about to be renamed. It can be used to construct
11890a unique name for the file.
11891
11892.vitem &$interface_address$&
11893.vindex "&$interface_address$&"
11894This is an obsolete name for &$received_ip_address$&.
11895
11896.vitem &$interface_port$&
11897.vindex "&$interface_port$&"
11898This is an obsolete name for &$received_port$&.
11899
11900.vitem &$item$&
11901.vindex "&$item$&"
11902This variable is used during the expansion of &*forall*& and &*forany*&
11903conditions (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&), and &*filter*&, &*map*&, and
11904&*reduce*& items (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&). In other circumstances, it is
11905empty.
11906
11907.vitem &$ldap_dn$&
11908.vindex "&$ldap_dn$&"
11909This variable, which is available only when Exim is compiled with LDAP support,
11910contains the DN from the last entry in the most recently successful LDAP
11911lookup.
11912
11913.vitem &$load_average$&
11914.vindex "&$load_average$&"
11915This variable contains the system load average, multiplied by 1000 so that it
11916is an integer. For example, if the load average is 0.21, the value of the
11917variable is 210. The value is recomputed every time the variable is referenced.
11918
11919.vitem &$local_part$&
11920.vindex "&$local_part$&"
11921When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this
11922variable contains the local part. When a number of addresses are being
11923delivered together (for example, multiple RCPT commands in an SMTP
11924session), &$local_part$& is not set.
11925
11926Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
11927&$local_part$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting.
11928&$local_part$& is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering,
11929because a message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just
11930once.
11931
11932.vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
11933.vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
11934If a local part prefix or suffix has been recognized, it is not included in the
11935value of &$local_part$& during routing and subsequent delivery. The values of
11936any prefix or suffix are in &$local_part_prefix$& and
11937&$local_part_suffix$&, respectively.
11938
11939When a message is being delivered to a file, pipe, or autoreply transport as a
11940result of aliasing or forwarding, &$local_part$& is set to the local part of
11941the parent address, not to the file name or command (see &$address_file$& and
11942&$address_pipe$&).
11943
11944When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$local_part$& contains the
11945local part of the recipient address.
11946
11947When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
11948&$local_part$& contains the local part of the address that is being rewritten;
11949it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example.
11950
11951In all cases, all quoting is removed from the local part. For example, for both
11952the addresses
11953.code
11954"abc:xyz"@test.example
11955abc\:xyz@test.example
11956.endd
11957the value of &$local_part$& is
11958.code
11959abc:xyz
11960.endd
11961If you use &$local_part$& to create another address, you should always wrap it
11962inside a quoting operator. For example, in a &(redirect)& router you could
11963have:
11964.code
11965data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@new.domain.example
11966.endd
11967&*Note*&: The value of &$local_part$& is normally lower cased. If you want
11968to process local parts in a case-dependent manner in a router, you can set the
11969&%caseful_local_part%& option (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&).
11970
11971.vitem &$local_part_data$&
11972.vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
11973When the &%local_parts%& option on a router matches a local part by means of a
11974lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running of the
11975router as &$local_part_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the address
11976to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the transport is
11977handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is used.
11978
11979&$local_part_data$& is also set when the &%local_parts%& condition in an ACL
11980matches a local part by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is
11981available during the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this
11982variable expands to nothing.
11983
11984.vitem &$local_part_prefix$&
11985.vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
11986When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
11987specific prefix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
11988variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
11989
11990.vitem &$local_part_suffix$&
11991.vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
11992When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
11993specific suffix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
11994variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
11995
11996.vitem &$local_scan_data$&
11997.vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
11998This variable contains the text returned by the &[local_scan()]& function when
11999a message is received. See chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>& for more details.
12000
12001.vitem &$local_user_gid$&
12002.vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
12003See &$local_user_uid$&.
12004
12005.vitem &$local_user_uid$&
12006.vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
12007This variable and &$local_user_gid$& are set to the uid and gid after the
12008&%check_local_user%& router precondition succeeds. This means that their values
12009are available for the remaining preconditions (&%senders%&, &%require_files%&,
12010and &%condition%&), for the &%address_data%& expansion, and for any
12011router-specific expansions. At all other times, the values in these variables
12012are &`(uid_t)(-1)`& and &`(gid_t)(-1)`&, respectively.
12013
12014.vitem &$localhost_number$&
12015.vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
12016This contains the expanded value of the
12017&%localhost_number%& option. The expansion happens after the main options have
12018been read.
12019
12020.vitem &$log_inodes$&
12021.vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
12022The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's
12023log files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is
12024referenced. If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes,
12025the value of is -1. See also the &%check_log_inodes%& option.
12026
12027.vitem &$log_space$&
12028.vindex "&$log_space$&"
12029The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk
12030partition where Exim's log files are being written. The value is recalculated
12031whenever the variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the
12032ability to find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems),
12033the space value is -1. See also the &%check_log_space%& option.
12034
12035
12036.vitem &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&
12037.vindex "&$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&"
12038This variable is set after a DNS lookup done by
12039a dnsdb lookup expansion, dnslookup router or smtp transport.
12040.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
12041It will be empty if &(DNSSEC)& was not requested,
12042&"no"& if the result was not labelled as authenticated data
12043and &"yes"& if it was.
12044Results that are labelled as authoritative answer that match
12045the &%dns_trust_aa%& configuration variable count also
12046as authenticated data.
12047
12048.vitem &$mailstore_basename$&
12049.vindex "&$mailstore_basename$&"
12050This variable is set only when doing deliveries in &"mailstore"& format in the
12051&(appendfile)& transport. During the expansion of the &%mailstore_prefix%&,
12052&%mailstore_suffix%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& options, it
12053contains the basename of the files that are being written, that is, the name
12054without the &".tmp"&, &".env"&, or &".msg"& suffix. At all other times, this
12055variable is empty.
12056
12057.vitem &$malware_name$&
12058.vindex "&$malware_name$&"
12059This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
12060content-scanning extension. It is set to the name of the virus that was found
12061when the ACL &%malware%& condition is true (see section &<<SECTscanvirus>>&).
12062
12063.vitem &$max_received_linelength$&
12064.vindex "&$max_received_linelength$&"
12065.cindex "maximum" "line length"
12066.cindex "line length" "maximum"
12067This variable contains the number of bytes in the longest line that was
12068received as part of the message, not counting the line termination
12069character(s).
12070.new
12071It is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
12072.wen
12073
12074.vitem &$message_age$&
12075.cindex "message" "age of"
12076.vindex "&$message_age$&"
12077This variable is set at the start of a delivery attempt to contain the number
12078of seconds since the message was received. It does not change during a single
12079delivery attempt.
12080
12081.vitem &$message_body$&
12082.cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
12083.cindex "message body" "in expansion"
12084.cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
12085.vindex "&$message_body$&"
12086.oindex "&%message_body_visible%&"
12087This variable contains the initial portion of a message's body while it is
12088being delivered, and is intended mainly for use in filter files. The maximum
12089number of characters of the body that are put into the variable is set by the
12090&%message_body_visible%& configuration option; the default is 500.
12091
12092.oindex "&%message_body_newlines%&"
12093By default, newlines are converted into spaces in &$message_body$&, to make it
12094easier to search for phrases that might be split over a line break. However,
12095this can be disabled by setting &%message_body_newlines%& to be true. Binary
12096zeros are always converted into spaces.
12097
12098.vitem &$message_body_end$&
12099.cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
12100.cindex "message body" "in expansion"
12101.vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
12102This variable contains the final portion of a message's
12103body while it is being delivered. The format and maximum size are as for
12104&$message_body$&.
12105
12106.vitem &$message_body_size$&
12107.cindex "body of message" "size"
12108.cindex "message body" "size"
12109.vindex "&$message_body_size$&"
12110When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the size of the body
12111in bytes. The count starts from the character after the blank line that
12112separates the body from the header. Newlines are included in the count. See
12113also &$message_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
12114
12115.new
12116If the spool file is wireformat
12117(see the &%spool_files_wireformat%& main option)
12118the CRLF line-terminators are included in the count.
12119.wen
12120
12121.vitem &$message_exim_id$&
12122.vindex "&$message_exim_id$&"
12123When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
12124unique message id that is generated and used by Exim to identify the message.
12125An id is not created for a message until after its header has been successfully
12126received. &*Note*&: This is &'not'& the contents of the &'Message-ID:'& header
12127line; it is the local id that Exim assigns to the message, for example:
12128&`1BXTIK-0001yO-VA`&.
12129
12130.vitem &$message_headers$&
12131.vindex &$message_headers$&
12132This variable contains a concatenation of all the header lines when a message
12133is being processed, except for lines added by routers or transports. The header
12134lines are separated by newline characters. Their contents are decoded in the
12135same way as a header line that is inserted by &%bheader%&.
12136
12137.vitem &$message_headers_raw$&
12138.vindex &$message_headers_raw$&
12139This variable is like &$message_headers$& except that no processing of the
12140contents of header lines is done.
12141
12142.vitem &$message_id$&
12143This is an old name for &$message_exim_id$&. It is now deprecated.
12144
12145.vitem &$message_linecount$&
12146.vindex "&$message_linecount$&"
12147This variable contains the total number of lines in the header and body of the
12148message. Compare &$body_linecount$&, which is the count for the body only.
12149During the DATA and content-scanning ACLs, &$message_linecount$& contains the
12150number of lines received. Before delivery happens (that is, before filters,
12151routers, and transports run) the count is increased to include the
12152&'Received:'& header line that Exim standardly adds, and also any other header
12153lines that are added by ACLs. The blank line that separates the message header
12154from the body is not counted.
12155
12156As with the special case of &$message_size$&, during the expansion of the
12157appendfile transport's maildir_tag option in maildir format, the value of
12158&$message_linecount$& is the precise size of the number of newlines in the
12159file that has been written (minus one for the blank line between the
12160header and the body).
12161
12162Here is an example of the use of this variable in a DATA ACL:
12163.code
12164deny message = Too many lines in message header
12165 condition = \
12166 ${if <{250}{${eval:$message_linecount - $body_linecount}}}
12167.endd
12168In the MAIL and RCPT ACLs, the value is zero because at that stage the
12169message has not yet been received.
12170
12171.new
12172This variable is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
12173.wen
12174
12175.vitem &$message_size$&
12176.cindex "size" "of message"
12177.cindex "message" "size"
12178.vindex "&$message_size$&"
12179When a message is being processed, this variable contains its size in bytes. In
12180most cases, the size includes those headers that were received with the
12181message, but not those (such as &'Envelope-to:'&) that are added to individual
12182deliveries as they are written. However, there is one special case: during the
12183expansion of the &%maildir_tag%& option in the &(appendfile)& transport while
12184doing a delivery in maildir format, the value of &$message_size$& is the
12185precise size of the file that has been written. See also
12186&$message_body_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
12187
12188.cindex "RCPT" "value of &$message_size$&"
12189While running a per message ACL (mail/rcpt/predata), &$message_size$&
12190contains the size supplied on the MAIL command, or -1 if no size was given. The
12191value may not, of course, be truthful.
12192
12193.vitem &$mime_$&&'xxx'&
12194A number of variables whose names start with &$mime$& are
12195available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For
12196details, see section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>&.
12197
12198.vitem "&$n0$& &-- &$n9$&"
12199These variables are counters that can be incremented by means
12200of the &%add%& command in filter files.
12201
12202.vitem &$original_domain$&
12203.vindex "&$domain$&"
12204.vindex "&$original_domain$&"
12205When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
12206same value as &$domain$&. However, if a &"child"& address (for example,
12207generated by an alias, forward, or filter file) is being processed, this
12208variable contains the domain of the original address (lower cased). This
12209differs from &$parent_domain$& only when there is more than one level of
12210aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being delivered in a
12211single transport run, &$original_domain$& is not set.
12212
12213If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
12214filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
12215part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
12216
12217.vitem &$original_local_part$&
12218.vindex "&$local_part$&"
12219.vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
12220When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
12221same value as &$local_part$&, unless a prefix or suffix was removed from the
12222local part, because &$original_local_part$& always contains the full local
12223part. When a &"child"& address (for example, generated by an alias, forward, or
12224filter file) is being processed, this variable contains the full local part of
12225the original address.
12226
12227If the router that did the redirection processed the local part
12228case-insensitively, the value in &$original_local_part$& is in lower case.
12229This variable differs from &$parent_local_part$& only when there is more than
12230one level of aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being
12231delivered in a single transport run, &$original_local_part$& is not set.
12232
12233If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
12234filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
12235part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
12236
12237.vitem &$originator_gid$&
12238.cindex "gid (group id)" "of originating user"
12239.cindex "sender" "gid"
12240.vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
12241.vindex "&$originator_gid$&"
12242This variable contains the value of &$caller_gid$& that was set when the
12243message was received. For messages received via the command line, this is the
12244gid of the sending user. For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is
12245normally the gid of the Exim user.
12246
12247.vitem &$originator_uid$&
12248.cindex "uid (user id)" "of originating user"
12249.cindex "sender" "uid"
12250.vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
12251.vindex "&$originator_uid$&"
12252The value of &$caller_uid$& that was set when the message was received. For
12253messages received via the command line, this is the uid of the sending user.
12254For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is normally the uid of the Exim
12255user.
12256
12257.vitem &$parent_domain$&
12258.vindex "&$parent_domain$&"
12259This variable is similar to &$original_domain$& (see
12260above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
12261
12262.vitem &$parent_local_part$&
12263.vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
12264This variable is similar to &$original_local_part$&
12265(see above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
12266
12267.vitem &$pid$&
12268.cindex "pid (process id)" "of current process"
12269.vindex "&$pid$&"
12270This variable contains the current process id.
12271
12272.vitem &$pipe_addresses$&
12273.cindex "filter" "transport filter"
12274.cindex "transport" "filter"
12275.vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
12276This is not an expansion variable, but is mentioned here because the string
12277&`$pipe_addresses`& is handled specially in the command specification for the
12278&(pipe)& transport (chapter &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&) and in transport filters
12279(described under &%transport_filter%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
12280It cannot be used in general expansion strings, and provokes an &"unknown
12281variable"& error if encountered.
12282
12283.vitem &$primary_hostname$&
12284.vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
12285This variable contains the value set by &%primary_hostname%& in the
12286configuration file, or read by the &[uname()]& function. If &[uname()]& returns
12287a single-component name, Exim calls &[gethostbyname()]& (or
12288&[getipnodebyname()]& where available) in an attempt to acquire a fully
12289qualified host name. See also &$smtp_active_hostname$&.
12290
12291
12292.vitem &$proxy_external_address$& &&&
12293 &$proxy_external_port$& &&&
12294 &$proxy_local_address$& &&&
12295 &$proxy_local_port$& &&&
12296 &$proxy_session$&
12297These variables are only available when built with Proxy Protocol
12298or SOCKS5 support.
12299For details see chapter &<<SECTproxyInbound>>&.
12300
12301.vitem &$prdr_requested$&
12302.cindex "PRDR" "variable for"
12303This variable is set to &"yes"& if PRDR was requested by the client for the
12304current message, otherwise &"no"&.
12305
12306.vitem &$prvscheck_address$&
12307This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12308which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12309&<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12310
12311.vitem &$prvscheck_keynum$&
12312This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12313which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12314&<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12315
12316.vitem &$prvscheck_result$&
12317This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12318which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12319&<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12320
12321.vitem &$qualify_domain$&
12322.vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
12323The value set for the &%qualify_domain%& option in the configuration file.
12324
12325.vitem &$qualify_recipient$&
12326.vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
12327The value set for the &%qualify_recipient%& option in the configuration file,
12328or if not set, the value of &$qualify_domain$&.
12329
12330.vitem &$queue_name$&
12331.vindex &$queue_name$&
12332.cindex "named queues"
12333.cindex queues named
12334The name of the spool queue in use; empty for the default queue.
12335
12336.vitem &$rcpt_count$&
12337.vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
12338When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12339RCPT commands received for the current message. If this variable is used in a
12340RCPT ACL, its value includes the current command.
12341
12342.vitem &$rcpt_defer_count$&
12343.vindex "&$rcpt_defer_count$&"
12344.cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "count of"
12345When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12346RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
12347temporary (4&'xx'&) response.
12348
12349.vitem &$rcpt_fail_count$&
12350.vindex "&$rcpt_fail_count$&"
12351When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12352RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
12353permanent (5&'xx'&) response.
12354
12355.vitem &$received_count$&
12356.vindex "&$received_count$&"
12357This variable contains the number of &'Received:'& header lines in the message,
12358including the one added by Exim (so its value is always greater than zero). It
12359is available in the DATA ACL, the non-SMTP ACL, and while routing and
12360delivering.
12361
12362.vitem &$received_for$&
12363.vindex "&$received_for$&"
12364If there is only a single recipient address in an incoming message, this
12365variable contains that address when the &'Received:'& header line is being
12366built. The value is copied after recipient rewriting has happened, but before
12367the &[local_scan()]& function is run.
12368
12369.vitem &$received_ip_address$&
12370.vindex "&$received_ip_address$&"
12371As soon as an Exim server starts processing an incoming TCP/IP connection, this
12372variable is set to the address of the local IP interface, and &$received_port$&
12373is set to the local port number. (The remote IP address and port are in
12374&$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.) When testing with &%-bh%&,
12375the port value is -1 unless it has been set using the &%-oMi%& command line
12376option.
12377
12378As well as being useful in ACLs (including the &"connect"& ACL), these variable
12379could be used, for example, to make the file name for a TLS certificate depend
12380on which interface and/or port is being used for the incoming connection. The
12381values of &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$& are saved with any
12382messages that are received, thus making these variables available at delivery
12383time.
12384For outbound connections see &$sending_ip_address$&.
12385
12386.vitem &$received_port$&
12387.vindex "&$received_port$&"
12388See &$received_ip_address$&.
12389
12390.vitem &$received_protocol$&
12391.vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
12392When a message is being processed, this variable contains the name of the
12393protocol by which it was received. Most of the names used by Exim are defined
12394by RFCs 821, 2821, and 3848. They start with &"smtp"& (the client used HELO) or
12395&"esmtp"& (the client used EHLO). This can be followed by &"s"& for secure
12396(encrypted) and/or &"a"& for authenticated. Thus, for example, if the protocol
12397is set to &"esmtpsa"&, the message was received over an encrypted SMTP
12398connection and the client was successfully authenticated.
12399
12400Exim uses the protocol name &"smtps"& for the case when encryption is
12401automatically set up on connection without the use of STARTTLS (see
12402&%tls_on_connect_ports%&), and the client uses HELO to initiate the
12403encrypted SMTP session. The name &"smtps"& is also used for the rare situation
12404where the client initially uses EHLO, sets up an encrypted connection using
12405STARTTLS, and then uses HELO afterwards.
12406
12407The &%-oMr%& option provides a way of specifying a custom protocol name for
12408messages that are injected locally by trusted callers. This is commonly used to
12409identify messages that are being re-injected after some kind of scanning.
12410
12411.vitem &$received_time$&
12412.vindex "&$received_time$&"
12413This variable contains the date and time when the current message was received,
12414as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
12415
12416.vitem &$recipient_data$&
12417.vindex "&$recipient_data$&"
12418This variable is set after an indexing lookup success in an ACL &%recipients%&
12419condition. It contains the data from the lookup, and the value remains set
12420until the next &%recipients%& test. Thus, you can do things like this:
12421.display
12422&`require recipients = cdb*@;/some/file`&
12423&`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$recipient_data`&
12424.endd
12425&*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
12426method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
12427The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
12428expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
12429
12430.vitem &$recipient_verify_failure$&
12431.vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
12432In an ACL, when a recipient verification fails, this variable contains
12433information about the failure. It is set to one of the following words:
12434
12435.ilist
12436&"qualify"&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
12437was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
12438
12439.next
12440&"route"&: Routing failed.
12441
12442.next
12443&"mail"&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection occurred at
12444or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial connection, HELO, or
12445MAIL).
12446
12447.next
12448&"recipient"&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
12449.next
12450
12451&"postmaster"&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
12452.endlist
12453
12454The main use of this variable is expected to be to distinguish between
12455rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT.
12456
12457.vitem &$recipients$&
12458.vindex "&$recipients$&"
12459This variable contains a list of envelope recipients for a message. A comma and
12460a space separate the addresses in the replacement text. However, the variable
12461is not generally available, to prevent exposure of Bcc recipients in
12462unprivileged users' filter files. You can use &$recipients$& only in these
12463cases:
12464
12465.olist
12466In a system filter file.
12467.next
12468In the ACLs associated with the DATA command and with non-SMTP messages, that
12469is, the ACLs defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&,
12470&%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_not_smtp_start%&, &%acl_not_smtp%&, and
12471&%acl_not_smtp_mime%&.
12472.next
12473From within a &[local_scan()]& function.
12474.endlist
12475
12476
12477.vitem &$recipients_count$&
12478.vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
12479When a message is being processed, this variable contains the number of
12480envelope recipients that came with the message. Duplicates are not excluded
12481from the count. While a message is being received over SMTP, the number
12482increases for each accepted recipient. It can be referenced in an ACL.
12483
12484
12485.vitem &$regex_match_string$&
12486.vindex "&$regex_match_string$&"
12487This variable is set to contain the matching regular expression after a
12488&%regex%& ACL condition has matched (see section &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
12489
12490.vitem "&$regex1$&, &$regex2$&, etc"
12491.cindex "regex submatch variables (&$1regex$& &$2regex$& etc)"
12492When a &%regex%& or &%mime_regex%& ACL condition succeeds,
12493these variables contain the
12494captured substrings identified by the regular expression.
12495
12496
12497.vitem &$reply_address$&
12498.vindex "&$reply_address$&"
12499When a message is being processed, this variable contains the contents of the
12500&'Reply-To:'& header line if one exists and it is not empty, or otherwise the
12501contents of the &'From:'& header line. Apart from the removal of leading
12502white space, the value is not processed in any way. In particular, no RFC 2047
12503decoding or character code translation takes place.
12504
12505.vitem &$return_path$&
12506.vindex "&$return_path$&"
12507When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the return path &--
12508the sender field that will be sent as part of the envelope. It is not enclosed
12509in <> characters. At the start of routing an address, &$return_path$& has the
12510same value as &$sender_address$&, but if, for example, an incoming message to a
12511mailing list has been expanded by a router which specifies a different address
12512for bounce messages, &$return_path$& subsequently contains the new bounce
12513address, whereas &$sender_address$& always contains the original sender address
12514that was received with the message. In other words, &$sender_address$& contains
12515the incoming envelope sender, and &$return_path$& contains the outgoing
12516envelope sender.
12517
12518.vitem &$return_size_limit$&
12519.vindex "&$return_size_limit$&"
12520This is an obsolete name for &$bounce_return_size_limit$&.
12521
12522.vitem &$router_name$&
12523.cindex "router" "name"
12524.cindex "name" "of router"
12525.vindex "&$router_name$&"
12526During the running of a router this variable contains its name.
12527
12528.vitem &$runrc$&
12529.cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
12530.vindex "&$runrc$&"
12531This variable contains the return code from a command that is run by the
12532&%${run...}%& expansion item. &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot
12533assume the order in which option values are expanded, except for those
12534preconditions whose order of testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot
12535reliably expect to set &$runrc$& by the expansion of one option, and use it in
12536another.
12537
12538.vitem &$self_hostname$&
12539.oindex "&%self%&" "value of host name"
12540.vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
12541When an address is routed to a supposedly remote host that turns out to be the
12542local host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& generic router option.
12543One of its values causes the address to be passed to another router. When this
12544happens, &$self_hostname$& is set to the name of the local host that the
12545original router encountered. In other circumstances its contents are null.
12546
12547.vitem &$sender_address$&
12548.vindex "&$sender_address$&"
12549When a message is being processed, this variable contains the sender's address
12550that was received in the message's envelope. The case of letters in the address
12551is retained, in both the local part and the domain. For bounce messages, the
12552value of this variable is the empty string. See also &$return_path$&.
12553
12554.vitem &$sender_address_data$&
12555.vindex "&$address_data$&"
12556.vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
12557If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
12558sender address, the final value is preserved in &$sender_address_data$&, to
12559distinguish it from data from a recipient address. The value does not persist
12560after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve it for
12561longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
12562
12563.vitem &$sender_address_domain$&
12564.vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
12565The domain portion of &$sender_address$&.
12566
12567.vitem &$sender_address_local_part$&
12568.vindex "&$sender_address_local_part$&"
12569The local part portion of &$sender_address$&.
12570
12571.vitem &$sender_data$&
12572.vindex "&$sender_data$&"
12573This variable is set after a lookup success in an ACL &%senders%& condition or
12574in a router &%senders%& option. It contains the data from the lookup, and the
12575value remains set until the next &%senders%& test. Thus, you can do things like
12576this:
12577.display
12578&`require senders = cdb*@;/some/file`&
12579&`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$sender_data`&
12580.endd
12581&*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
12582method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
12583The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
12584expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
12585
12586.vitem &$sender_fullhost$&
12587.vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
12588When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the host
12589name and IP address in a single string. It ends with the IP address in square
12590brackets, followed by a colon and a port number if the logging of ports is
12591enabled. The format of the rest of the string depends on whether the host
12592issued a HELO or EHLO SMTP command, and whether the host name was verified by
12593looking up its IP address. (Looking up the IP address can be forced by the
12594&%host_lookup%& option, independent of verification.) A plain host name at the
12595start of the string is a verified host name; if this is not present,
12596verification either failed or was not requested. A host name in parentheses is
12597the argument of a HELO or EHLO command. This is omitted if it is identical to
12598the verified host name or to the host's IP address in square brackets.
12599
12600.vitem &$sender_helo_dnssec$&
12601.vindex "&$sender_helo_dnssec$&"
12602This boolean variable is true if a successful HELO verification was
12603.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
12604done using DNS information the resolver library stated was authenticated data.
12605
12606.vitem &$sender_helo_name$&
12607.vindex "&$sender_helo_name$&"
12608When a message is received from a remote host that has issued a HELO or EHLO
12609command, the argument of that command is placed in this variable. It is also
12610set if HELO or EHLO is used when a message is received using SMTP locally via
12611the &%-bs%& or &%-bS%& options.
12612
12613.vitem &$sender_host_address$&
12614.vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
12615When a message is received from a remote host using SMTP,
12616this variable contains that
12617host's IP address. For locally non-SMTP submitted messages, it is empty.
12618
12619.vitem &$sender_host_authenticated$&
12620.vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
12621This variable contains the name (not the public name) of the authenticator
12622driver that successfully authenticated the client from which the message was
12623received. It is empty if there was no successful authentication. See also
12624&$authenticated_id$&.
12625
12626.vitem &$sender_host_dnssec$&
12627.vindex "&$sender_host_dnssec$&"
12628If an attempt to populate &$sender_host_name$& has been made
12629(by reference, &%hosts_lookup%& or
12630otherwise) then this boolean will have been set true if, and only if, the
12631resolver library states that both
12632the reverse and forward DNS were authenticated data. At all
12633other times, this variable is false.
12634
12635.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
12636It is likely that you will need to coerce DNSSEC support on in the resolver
12637library, by setting:
12638.code
12639dns_dnssec_ok = 1
12640.endd
12641
12642Exim does not perform DNSSEC validation itself, instead leaving that to a
12643validating resolver (e.g. unbound, or bind with suitable configuration).
12644
12645If you have changed &%host_lookup_order%& so that &`bydns`& is not the first
12646mechanism in the list, then this variable will be false.
12647
12648This requires that your system resolver library support EDNS0 (and that
12649DNSSEC flags exist in the system headers). If the resolver silently drops
12650all EDNS0 options, then this will have no effect. OpenBSD's asr resolver
12651is known to currently ignore EDNS0, documented in CAVEATS of asr_run(3).
12652
12653
12654.vitem &$sender_host_name$&
12655.vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
12656When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
12657host's name as obtained by looking up its IP address. For messages received by
12658other means, this variable is empty.
12659
12660.vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
12661If the host name has not previously been looked up, a reference to
12662&$sender_host_name$& triggers a lookup (for messages from remote hosts).
12663A looked up name is accepted only if it leads back to the original IP address
12664via a forward lookup. If either the reverse or the forward lookup fails to find
12665any data, or if the forward lookup does not yield the original IP address,
12666&$sender_host_name$& remains empty, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
12667
12668.vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
12669However, if either of the lookups cannot be completed (for example, there is a
12670DNS timeout), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&, and
12671&$host_lookup_failed$& remains set to &"0"&.
12672
12673Once &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&, Exim does not try to look up the
12674host name again if there is a subsequent reference to &$sender_host_name$&
12675in the same Exim process, but it does try again if &$host_lookup_deferred$&
12676is set to &"1"&.
12677
12678Exim does not automatically look up every calling host's name. If you want
12679maximum efficiency, you should arrange your configuration so that it avoids
12680these lookups altogether. The lookup happens only if one or more of the
12681following are true:
12682
12683.ilist
12684A string containing &$sender_host_name$& is expanded.
12685.next
12686The calling host matches the list in &%host_lookup%&. In the default
12687configuration, this option is set to *, so it must be changed if lookups are
12688to be avoided. (In the code, the default for &%host_lookup%& is unset.)
12689.next
12690Exim needs the host name in order to test an item in a host list. The items
12691that require this are described in sections &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& and
12692&<<SECThoslispatnamsk>>&.
12693.next
12694The calling host matches &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&.
12695In this case, the host name is required to compare with the name quoted in any
12696EHLO or HELO commands that the client issues.
12697.next
12698The remote host issues a EHLO or HELO command that quotes one of the
12699domains in &%helo_lookup_domains%&. The default value of this option is
12700. ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
12701. ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
12702.code
12703 helo_lookup_domains = @ : @[]
12704.endd
12705which causes a lookup if a remote host (incorrectly) gives the server's name or
12706IP address in an EHLO or HELO command.
12707.endlist
12708
12709
12710.vitem &$sender_host_port$&
12711.vindex "&$sender_host_port$&"
12712When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the port
12713number that was used on the remote host.
12714
12715.vitem &$sender_ident$&
12716.vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
12717When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
12718identification received in response to an RFC 1413 request. When a message has
12719been received locally, this variable contains the login name of the user that
12720called Exim.
12721
12722.vitem &$sender_rate_$&&'xxx'&
12723A number of variables whose names begin &$sender_rate_$& are set as part of the
12724&%ratelimit%& ACL condition. Details are given in section
12725&<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
12726
12727.vitem &$sender_rcvhost$&
12728.cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
12729.cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
12730.vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
12731This is provided specifically for use in &'Received:'& headers. It starts with
12732either the verified host name (as obtained from a reverse DNS lookup) or, if
12733there is no verified host name, the IP address in square brackets. After that
12734there may be text in parentheses. When the first item is a verified host name,
12735the first thing in the parentheses is the IP address in square brackets,
12736followed by a colon and a port number if port logging is enabled. When the
12737first item is an IP address, the port is recorded as &"port=&'xxxx'&"& inside
12738the parentheses.
12739
12740There may also be items of the form &"helo=&'xxxx'&"& if HELO or EHLO
12741was used and its argument was not identical to the real host name or IP
12742address, and &"ident=&'xxxx'&"& if an RFC 1413 ident string is available. If
12743all three items are present in the parentheses, a newline and tab are inserted
12744into the string, to improve the formatting of the &'Received:'& header.
12745
12746.vitem &$sender_verify_failure$&
12747.vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
12748In an ACL, when a sender verification fails, this variable contains information
12749about the failure. The details are the same as for
12750&$recipient_verify_failure$&.
12751
12752.vitem &$sending_ip_address$&
12753.vindex "&$sending_ip_address$&"
12754This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
12755been set up. It contains the IP address of the local interface that is being
12756used. This is useful if a host that has more than one IP address wants to take
12757on different personalities depending on which one is being used. For incoming
12758connections, see &$received_ip_address$&.
12759
12760.vitem &$sending_port$&
12761.vindex "&$sending_port$&"
12762This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
12763been set up. It contains the local port that is being used. For incoming
12764connections, see &$received_port$&.
12765
12766.vitem &$smtp_active_hostname$&
12767.vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
12768During an incoming SMTP session, this variable contains the value of the active
12769host name, as specified by the &%smtp_active_hostname%& option. The value of
12770&$smtp_active_hostname$& is saved with any message that is received, so its
12771value can be consulted during routing and delivery.
12772
12773.vitem &$smtp_command$&
12774.vindex "&$smtp_command$&"
12775During the processing of an incoming SMTP command, this variable contains the
12776entire command. This makes it possible to distinguish between HELO and EHLO in
12777the HELO ACL, and also to distinguish between commands such as these:
12778.code
12779MAIL FROM:<>
12780MAIL FROM: <>
12781.endd
12782For a MAIL command, extra parameters such as SIZE can be inspected. For a RCPT
12783command, the address in &$smtp_command$& is the original address before any
12784rewriting, whereas the values in &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are taken from
12785the address after SMTP-time rewriting.
12786
12787.vitem &$smtp_command_argument$&
12788.cindex "SMTP" "command, argument for"
12789.vindex "&$smtp_command_argument$&"
12790While an ACL is running to check an SMTP command, this variable contains the
12791argument, that is, the text that follows the command name, with leading white
12792space removed. Following the introduction of &$smtp_command$&, this variable is
12793somewhat redundant, but is retained for backwards compatibility.
12794
12795.vitem &$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&
12796.vindex "&$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&"
12797This variable is set greater than zero only in processes spawned by the Exim
12798daemon for handling incoming SMTP connections. The name is deliberately long,
12799in order to emphasize what the contents are. When the daemon accepts a new
12800connection, it increments this variable. A copy of the variable is passed to
12801the child process that handles the connection, but its value is fixed, and
12802never changes. It is only an approximation of how many incoming connections
12803there actually are, because many other connections may come and go while a
12804single connection is being processed. When a child process terminates, the
12805daemon decrements its copy of the variable.
12806
12807.vitem "&$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$&"
12808These variables are copies of the values of the &$n0$& &-- &$n9$& accumulators
12809that were current at the end of the system filter file. This allows a system
12810filter file to set values that can be tested in users' filter files. For
12811example, a system filter could set a value indicating how likely it is that a
12812message is junk mail.
12813
12814.vitem &$spam_$&&'xxx'&
12815A number of variables whose names start with &$spam$& are available when Exim
12816is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For details, see section
12817&<<SECTscanspamass>>&.
12818
12819
12820.vitem &$spool_directory$&
12821.vindex "&$spool_directory$&"
12822The name of Exim's spool directory.
12823
12824.vitem &$spool_inodes$&
12825.vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
12826The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's spool files are
12827being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is referenced.
12828If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes, the value of
12829is -1. See also the &%check_spool_inodes%& option.
12830
12831.vitem &$spool_space$&
12832.vindex "&$spool_space$&"
12833The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk partition where
12834Exim's spool files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the
12835variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the ability to
12836find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems), the space
12837value is -1. For example, to check in an ACL that there is at least 50
12838megabytes free on the spool, you could write:
12839.code
12840condition = ${if > {$spool_space}{50000}}
12841.endd
12842See also the &%check_spool_space%& option.
12843
12844
12845.vitem &$thisaddress$&
12846.vindex "&$thisaddress$&"
12847This variable is set only during the processing of the &%foranyaddress%&
12848command in a filter file. Its use is explained in the description of that
12849command, which can be found in the separate document entitled &'Exim's
12850interfaces to mail filtering'&.
12851
12852.vitem &$tls_in_bits$&
12853.vindex "&$tls_in_bits$&"
12854Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
12855on the inbound connection; the meaning of
12856this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
12857If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
12858The value of this is automatically fed into the Cyrus SASL authenticator
12859when acting as a server, to specify the "external SSF" (a SASL term).
12860
12861The deprecated &$tls_bits$& variable refers to the inbound side
12862except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12863the outbound.
12864
12865.vitem &$tls_out_bits$&
12866.vindex "&$tls_out_bits$&"
12867Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
12868on an outbound SMTP connection; the meaning of
12869this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
12870If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
12871
12872.vitem &$tls_in_ourcert$&
12873.vindex "&$tls_in_ourcert$&"
12874.cindex certificate variables
12875This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
12876inbound connection when the message was received.
12877It is only useful as the argument of a
12878&%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12879or a &%def%& condition.
12880
12881.vitem &$tls_in_peercert$&
12882.vindex "&$tls_in_peercert$&"
12883This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
12884inbound connection when the message was received.
12885It is only useful as the argument of a
12886&%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12887or a &%def%& condition.
12888If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
12889which is not the leaf.
12890
12891.vitem &$tls_out_ourcert$&
12892.vindex "&$tls_out_ourcert$&"
12893This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
12894outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
12895&%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12896or a &%def%& condition.
12897
12898.vitem &$tls_out_peercert$&
12899.vindex "&$tls_out_peercert$&"
12900This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
12901outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
12902&%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12903or a &%def%& condition.
12904If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
12905which is not the leaf.
12906
12907.vitem &$tls_in_certificate_verified$&
12908.vindex "&$tls_in_certificate_verified$&"
12909This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when the
12910message was received, and &"0"& otherwise.
12911
12912The deprecated &$tls_certificate_verified$& variable refers to the inbound side
12913except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12914the outbound.
12915
12916.vitem &$tls_out_certificate_verified$&
12917.vindex "&$tls_out_certificate_verified$&"
12918This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when an
12919outbound SMTP connection was made,
12920and &"0"& otherwise.
12921
12922.vitem &$tls_in_cipher$&
12923.vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
12924.vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
12925When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
12926connection, this variable is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated, for
12927example DES-CBC3-SHA. In other circumstances, in particular, for message
12928received over unencrypted connections, the variable is empty. Testing
12929&$tls_in_cipher$& for emptiness is one way of distinguishing between encrypted and
12930non-encrypted connections during ACL processing.
12931
12932The deprecated &$tls_cipher$& variable is the same as &$tls_in_cipher$& during message reception,
12933but in the context of an outward SMTP delivery taking place via the &(smtp)& transport
12934becomes the same as &$tls_out_cipher$&.
12935
12936.vitem &$tls_out_cipher$&
12937.vindex "&$tls_out_cipher$&"
12938This variable is
12939cleared before any outgoing SMTP connection is made,
12940and then set to the outgoing cipher suite if one is negotiated. See chapter
12941&<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS support and chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for
12942details of the &(smtp)& transport.
12943
12944.vitem &$tls_in_ocsp$&
12945.vindex "&$tls_in_ocsp$&"
12946When a message is received from a remote client connection
12947the result of any OCSP request from the client is encoded in this variable:
12948.code
129490 OCSP proof was not requested (default value)
129501 No response to request
129512 Response not verified
129523 Verification failed
129534 Verification succeeded
12954.endd
12955
12956.vitem &$tls_out_ocsp$&
12957.vindex "&$tls_out_ocsp$&"
12958When a message is sent to a remote host connection
12959the result of any OCSP request made is encoded in this variable.
12960See &$tls_in_ocsp$& for values.
12961
12962.vitem &$tls_in_peerdn$&
12963.vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
12964.vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
12965.cindex certificate "extracting fields"
12966When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
12967connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the client,
12968the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
12969&$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
12970If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
12971which is not the leaf.
12972
12973The deprecated &$tls_peerdn$& variable refers to the inbound side
12974except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12975the outbound.
12976
12977.vitem &$tls_out_peerdn$&
12978.vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
12979When a message is being delivered to a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
12980connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the server,
12981the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
12982&$tls_out_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
12983If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
12984which is not the leaf.
12985
12986.vitem &$tls_in_sni$&
12987.vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
12988.vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
12989.cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
12990When a TLS session is being established, if the client sends the Server
12991Name Indication extension, the value will be placed in this variable.
12992If the variable appears in &%tls_certificate%& then this option and
12993some others, described in &<<SECTtlssni>>&,
12994will be re-expanded early in the TLS session, to permit
12995a different certificate to be presented (and optionally a different key to be
12996used) to the client, based upon the value of the SNI extension.
12997
12998The deprecated &$tls_sni$& variable refers to the inbound side
12999except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13000the outbound.
13001
13002.vitem &$tls_out_sni$&
13003.vindex "&$tls_out_sni$&"
13004.cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
13005During outbound
13006SMTP deliveries, this variable reflects the value of the &%tls_sni%& option on
13007the transport.
13008
13009.vitem &$tod_bsdinbox$&
13010.vindex "&$tod_bsdinbox$&"
13011The time of day and the date, in the format required for BSD-style mailbox
13012files, for example: Thu Oct 17 17:14:09 1995.
13013
13014.vitem &$tod_epoch$&
13015.vindex "&$tod_epoch$&"
13016The time and date as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
13017
13018.vitem &$tod_epoch_l$&
13019.vindex "&$tod_epoch_l$&"
13020The time and date as a number of microseconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
13021
13022.vitem &$tod_full$&
13023.vindex "&$tod_full$&"
13024A full version of the time and date, for example: Wed, 16 Oct 1995 09:51:40
13025+0100. The timezone is always given as a numerical offset from UTC, with
13026positive values used for timezones that are ahead (east) of UTC, and negative
13027values for those that are behind (west).
13028
13029.vitem &$tod_log$&
13030.vindex "&$tod_log$&"
13031The time and date in the format used for writing Exim's log files, for example:
130321995-10-12 15:32:29, but without a timezone.
13033
13034.vitem &$tod_logfile$&
13035.vindex "&$tod_logfile$&"
13036This variable contains the date in the format yyyymmdd. This is the format that
13037is used for datestamping log files when &%log_file_path%& contains the &`%D`&
13038flag.
13039
13040.vitem &$tod_zone$&
13041.vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
13042This variable contains the numerical value of the local timezone, for example:
13043-0500.
13044
13045.vitem &$tod_zulu$&
13046.vindex "&$tod_zulu$&"
13047This variable contains the UTC date and time in &"Zulu"& format, as specified
13048by ISO 8601, for example: 20030221154023Z.
13049
13050.vitem &$transport_name$&
13051.cindex "transport" "name"
13052.cindex "name" "of transport"
13053.vindex "&$transport_name$&"
13054During the running of a transport, this variable contains its name.
13055
13056.vitem &$value$&
13057.vindex "&$value$&"
13058This variable contains the result of an expansion lookup, extraction operation,
13059or external command, as described above. It is also used during a
13060&*reduce*& expansion.
13061
13062.vitem &$verify_mode$&
13063.vindex "&$verify_mode$&"
13064While a router or transport is being run in verify mode or for cutthrough delivery,
13065contains "S" for sender-verification or "R" for recipient-verification.
13066Otherwise, empty.
13067
13068.vitem &$version_number$&
13069.vindex "&$version_number$&"
13070The version number of Exim.
13071
13072.vitem &$warn_message_delay$&
13073.vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
13074This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
13075delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
13076
13077.vitem &$warn_message_recipients$&
13078.vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
13079This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
13080delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
13081.endlist
13082.ecindex IIDstrexp
13083
13084
13085
13086. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13087. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13088
13089.chapter "Embedded Perl" "CHAPperl"
13090.scindex IIDperl "Perl" "calling from Exim"
13091Exim can be built to include an embedded Perl interpreter. When this is done,
13092Perl subroutines can be called as part of the string expansion process. To make
13093use of the Perl support, you need version 5.004 or later of Perl installed on
13094your system. To include the embedded interpreter in the Exim binary, include
13095the line
13096.code
13097EXIM_PERL = perl.o
13098.endd
13099in your &_Local/Makefile_& and then build Exim in the normal way.
13100
13101
13102.section "Setting up so Perl can be used" "SECID85"
13103.oindex "&%perl_startup%&"
13104Access to Perl subroutines is via a global configuration option called
13105&%perl_startup%& and an expansion string operator &%${perl ...}%&. If there is
13106no &%perl_startup%& option in the Exim configuration file then no Perl
13107interpreter is started and there is almost no overhead for Exim (since none of
13108the Perl library will be paged in unless used). If there is a &%perl_startup%&
13109option then the associated value is taken to be Perl code which is executed in
13110a newly created Perl interpreter.
13111
13112The value of &%perl_startup%& is not expanded in the Exim sense, so you do not
13113need backslashes before any characters to escape special meanings. The option
13114should usually be something like
13115.code
13116perl_startup = do '/etc/exim.pl'
13117.endd
13118where &_/etc/exim.pl_& is Perl code which defines any subroutines you want to
13119use from Exim. Exim can be configured either to start up a Perl interpreter as
13120soon as it is entered, or to wait until the first time it is needed. Starting
13121the interpreter at the beginning ensures that it is done while Exim still has
13122its setuid privilege, but can impose an unnecessary overhead if Perl is not in
13123fact used in a particular run. Also, note that this does not mean that Exim is
13124necessarily running as root when Perl is called at a later time. By default,
13125the interpreter is started only when it is needed, but this can be changed in
13126two ways:
13127
13128.ilist
13129.oindex "&%perl_at_start%&"
13130Setting &%perl_at_start%& (a boolean option) in the configuration requests
13131a startup when Exim is entered.
13132.next
13133The command line option &%-ps%& also requests a startup when Exim is entered,
13134overriding the setting of &%perl_at_start%&.
13135.endlist
13136
13137There is also a command line option &%-pd%& (for delay) which suppresses the
13138initial startup, even if &%perl_at_start%& is set.
13139
13140.ilist
13141.oindex "&%perl_taintmode%&"
13142.cindex "Perl" "taintmode"
13143To provide more security executing Perl code via the embedded Perl
13144interpreter, the &%perl_taintmode%& option can be set. This enables the
13145taint mode of the Perl interpreter. You are encouraged to set this
13146option to a true value. To avoid breaking existing installations, it
13147defaults to false.
13148
13149
13150.section "Calling Perl subroutines" "SECID86"
13151When the configuration file includes a &%perl_startup%& option you can make use
13152of the string expansion item to call the Perl subroutines that are defined
13153by the &%perl_startup%& code. The operator is used in any of the following
13154forms:
13155.code
13156${perl{foo}}
13157${perl{foo}{argument}}
13158${perl{foo}{argument1}{argument2} ... }
13159.endd
13160which calls the subroutine &%foo%& with the given arguments. A maximum of eight
13161arguments may be passed. Passing more than this results in an expansion failure
13162with an error message of the form
13163.code
13164Too many arguments passed to Perl subroutine "foo" (max is 8)
13165.endd
13166The return value of the Perl subroutine is evaluated in a scalar context before
13167it is passed back to Exim to be inserted into the expanded string. If the
13168return value is &'undef'&, the expansion is forced to fail in the same way as
13169an explicit &"fail"& on an &%if%& or &%lookup%& item. If the subroutine aborts
13170by obeying Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails with the error message
13171that was passed to &%die%&.
13172
13173
13174.section "Calling Exim functions from Perl" "SECID87"
13175Within any Perl code called from Exim, the function &'Exim::expand_string()'&
13176is available to call back into Exim's string expansion function. For example,
13177the Perl code
13178.code
13179my $lp = Exim::expand_string('$local_part');
13180.endd
13181makes the current Exim &$local_part$& available in the Perl variable &$lp$&.
13182Note those are single quotes and not double quotes to protect against
13183&$local_part$& being interpolated as a Perl variable.
13184
13185If the string expansion is forced to fail by a &"fail"& item, the result of
13186&'Exim::expand_string()'& is &%undef%&. If there is a syntax error in the
13187expansion string, the Perl call from the original expansion string fails with
13188an appropriate error message, in the same way as if &%die%& were used.
13189
13190.cindex "debugging" "from embedded Perl"
13191.cindex "log" "writing from embedded Perl"
13192Two other Exim functions are available for use from within Perl code.
13193&'Exim::debug_write()'& writes a string to the standard error stream if Exim's
13194debugging is enabled. If you want a newline at the end, you must supply it.
13195&'Exim::log_write()'& writes a string to Exim's main log, adding a leading
13196timestamp. In this case, you should not supply a terminating newline.
13197
13198
13199.section "Use of standard output and error by Perl" "SECID88"
13200.cindex "Perl" "standard output and error"
13201You should not write to the standard error or output streams from within your
13202Perl code, as it is not defined how these are set up. In versions of Exim
13203before 4.50, it is possible for the standard output or error to refer to the
13204SMTP connection during message reception via the daemon. Writing to this stream
13205is certain to cause chaos. From Exim 4.50 onwards, the standard output and
13206error streams are connected to &_/dev/null_& in the daemon. The chaos is
13207avoided, but the output is lost.
13208
13209.cindex "Perl" "use of &%warn%&"
13210The Perl &%warn%& statement writes to the standard error stream by default.
13211Calls to &%warn%& may be embedded in Perl modules that you use, but over which
13212you have no control. When Exim starts up the Perl interpreter, it arranges for
13213output from the &%warn%& statement to be written to the Exim main log. You can
13214change this by including appropriate Perl magic somewhere in your Perl code.
13215For example, to discard &%warn%& output completely, you need this:
13216.code
13217$SIG{__WARN__} = sub { };
13218.endd
13219Whenever a &%warn%& is obeyed, the anonymous subroutine is called. In this
13220example, the code for the subroutine is empty, so it does nothing, but you can
13221include any Perl code that you like. The text of the &%warn%& message is passed
13222as the first subroutine argument.
13223.ecindex IIDperl
13224
13225
13226. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13227. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13228
13229.chapter "Starting the daemon and the use of network interfaces" &&&
13230 "CHAPinterfaces" &&&
13231 "Starting the daemon"
13232.cindex "daemon" "starting"
13233.cindex "interface" "listening"
13234.cindex "network interface"
13235.cindex "interface" "network"
13236.cindex "IP address" "for listening"
13237.cindex "daemon" "listening IP addresses"
13238.cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
13239.cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
13240A host that is connected to a TCP/IP network may have one or more physical
13241hardware network interfaces. Each of these interfaces may be configured as one
13242or more &"logical"& interfaces, which are the entities that a program actually
13243works with. Each of these logical interfaces is associated with an IP address.
13244In addition, TCP/IP software supports &"loopback"& interfaces (127.0.0.1 in
13245IPv4 and ::1 in IPv6), which do not use any physical hardware. Exim requires
13246knowledge about the host's interfaces for use in three different circumstances:
13247
13248.olist
13249When a listening daemon is started, Exim needs to know which interfaces
13250and ports to listen on.
13251.next
13252When Exim is routing an address, it needs to know which IP addresses
13253are associated with local interfaces. This is required for the correct
13254processing of MX lists by removing the local host and others with the
13255same or higher priority values. Also, Exim needs to detect cases
13256when an address is routed to an IP address that in fact belongs to the
13257local host. Unless the &%self%& router option or the &%allow_localhost%&
13258option of the smtp transport is set (as appropriate), this is treated
13259as an error situation.
13260.next
13261When Exim connects to a remote host, it may need to know which interface to use
13262for the outgoing connection.
13263.endlist
13264
13265
13266Exim's default behaviour is likely to be appropriate in the vast majority
13267of cases. If your host has only one interface, and you want all its IP
13268addresses to be treated in the same way, and you are using only the
13269standard SMTP port, you should not need to take any special action. The
13270rest of this chapter does not apply to you.
13271
13272In a more complicated situation you may want to listen only on certain
13273interfaces, or on different ports, and for this reason there are a number of
13274options that can be used to influence Exim's behaviour. The rest of this
13275chapter describes how they operate.
13276
13277When a message is received over TCP/IP, the interface and port that were
13278actually used are set in &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$&.
13279
13280
13281
13282.section "Starting a listening daemon" "SECID89"
13283When a listening daemon is started (by means of the &%-bd%& command line
13284option), the interfaces and ports on which it listens are controlled by the
13285following options:
13286
13287.ilist
13288&%daemon_smtp_ports%& contains a list of default ports
13289or service names.
13290(For backward compatibility, this option can also be specified in the singular.)
13291.next
13292&%local_interfaces%& contains list of interface IP addresses on which to
13293listen. Each item may optionally also specify a port.
13294.endlist
13295
13296The default list separator in both cases is a colon, but this can be changed as
13297described in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. When IPv6 addresses are involved,
13298it is usually best to change the separator to avoid having to double all the
13299colons. For example:
13300.code
13301local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; \
13302 192.168.23.65 ; \
13303 ::1 ; \
13304 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
13305.endd
13306There are two different formats for specifying a port along with an IP address
13307in &%local_interfaces%&:
13308
13309.olist
13310The port is added onto the address with a dot separator. For example, to listen
13311on port 1234 on two different IP addresses:
13312.code
13313local_interfaces = <; 192.168.23.65.1234 ; \
13314 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061.1234
13315.endd
13316.next
13317The IP address is enclosed in square brackets, and the port is added
13318with a colon separator, for example:
13319.code
13320local_interfaces = <; [192.168.23.65]:1234 ; \
13321 [3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061]:1234
13322.endd
13323.endlist
13324
13325When a port is not specified, the value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is used. The
13326default setting contains just one port:
13327.code
13328daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
13329.endd
13330If more than one port is listed, each interface that does not have its own port
13331specified listens on all of them. Ports that are listed in
13332&%daemon_smtp_ports%& can be identified either by name (defined in
13333&_/etc/services_&) or by number. However, when ports are given with individual
13334IP addresses in &%local_interfaces%&, only numbers (not names) can be used.
13335
13336
13337
13338.section "Special IP listening addresses" "SECID90"
13339The addresses 0.0.0.0 and ::0 are treated specially. They are interpreted
13340as &"all IPv4 interfaces"& and &"all IPv6 interfaces"&, respectively. In each
13341case, Exim tells the TCP/IP stack to &"listen on all IPv&'x'& interfaces"&
13342instead of setting up separate listening sockets for each interface. The
13343default value of &%local_interfaces%& is
13344.code
13345local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
13346.endd
13347when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is:
13348.code
13349local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13350.endd
13351Thus, by default, Exim listens on all available interfaces, on the SMTP port.
13352
13353
13354
13355.section "Overriding local_interfaces and daemon_smtp_ports" "SECID91"
13356The &%-oX%& command line option can be used to override the values of
13357&%daemon_smtp_ports%& and/or &%local_interfaces%& for a particular daemon
13358instance. Another way of doing this would be to use macros and the &%-D%&
13359option. However, &%-oX%& can be used by any admin user, whereas modification of
13360the runtime configuration by &%-D%& is allowed only when the caller is root or
13361exim.
13362
13363The value of &%-oX%& is a list of items. The default colon separator can be
13364changed in the usual way if required. If there are any items that do not
13365contain dots or colons (that is, are not IP addresses), the value of
13366&%daemon_smtp_ports%& is replaced by the list of those items. If there are any
13367items that do contain dots or colons, the value of &%local_interfaces%& is
13368replaced by those items. Thus, for example,
13369.code
13370-oX 1225
13371.endd
13372overrides &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, but leaves &%local_interfaces%& unchanged,
13373whereas
13374.code
13375-oX 192.168.34.5.1125
13376.endd
13377overrides &%local_interfaces%&, leaving &%daemon_smtp_ports%& unchanged.
13378(However, since &%local_interfaces%& now contains no items without ports, the
13379value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is no longer relevant in this example.)
13380
13381
13382
13383.section "Support for the obsolete SSMTP (or SMTPS) protocol" "SECTsupobssmt"
13384.cindex "ssmtp protocol"
13385.cindex "smtps protocol"
13386.cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
13387.cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
13388Exim supports the obsolete SSMTP protocol (also known as SMTPS) that was used
13389before the STARTTLS command was standardized for SMTP. Some legacy clients
13390still use this protocol. If the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option is set to a
13391list of port numbers or service names,
13392connections to those ports must use SSMTP. The most
13393common use of this option is expected to be
13394.code
13395tls_on_connect_ports = 465
13396.endd
13397because 465 is the usual port number used by the legacy clients. There is also
13398a command line option &%-tls-on-connect%&, which forces all ports to behave in
13399this way when a daemon is started.
13400
13401&*Warning*&: Setting &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not of itself cause the
13402daemon to listen on those ports. You must still specify them in
13403&%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%local_interfaces%&, or the &%-oX%& option. (This is
13404because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& applies to &%inetd%& connections as well as to
13405connections via the daemon.)
13406
13407
13408
13409
13410.section "IPv6 address scopes" "SECID92"
13411.cindex "IPv6" "address scopes"
13412IPv6 addresses have &"scopes"&, and a host with multiple hardware interfaces
13413can, in principle, have the same link-local IPv6 address on different
13414interfaces. Thus, additional information is needed, over and above the IP
13415address, to distinguish individual interfaces. A convention of using a
13416percent sign followed by something (often the interface name) has been
13417adopted in some cases, leading to addresses like this:
13418.code
13419fe80::202:b3ff:fe03:45c1%eth0
13420.endd
13421To accommodate this usage, a percent sign followed by an arbitrary string is
13422allowed at the end of an IPv6 address. By default, Exim calls &[getaddrinfo()]&
13423to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use. This function recognizes the
13424percent convention in operating systems that support it, and it processes the
13425address appropriately. Unfortunately, some older libraries have problems with
13426&[getaddrinfo()]&. If
13427.code
13428IPV6_USE_INET_PTON=yes
13429.endd
13430is set in &_Local/Makefile_& (or an OS-dependent Makefile) when Exim is built,
13431Exim uses &'inet_pton()'& to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use,
13432instead of &[getaddrinfo()]&. (Before version 4.14, it always used this
13433function.) Of course, this means that the additional functionality of
13434&[getaddrinfo()]& &-- recognizing scoped addresses &-- is lost.
13435
13436.section "Disabling IPv6" "SECID93"
13437.cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
13438Sometimes it happens that an Exim binary that was compiled with IPv6 support is
13439run on a host whose kernel does not support IPv6. The binary will fall back to
13440using IPv4, but it may waste resources looking up AAAA records, and trying to
13441connect to IPv6 addresses, causing delays to mail delivery. If you set the
13442.oindex "&%disable_ipv6%&"
13443&%disable_ipv6%& option true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
13444activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
13445that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &(manualroute)& router,
13446etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
13447to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
13448
13449On the other hand, when IPv6 is in use, there may be times when you want to
13450disable it for certain hosts or domains. You can use the &%dns_ipv4_lookup%&
13451option to globally suppress the lookup of AAAA records for specified domains,
13452and you can use the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic router option to ignore
13453IPv6 addresses in an individual router.
13454
13455
13456
13457.section "Examples of starting a listening daemon" "SECID94"
13458The default case in an IPv6 environment is
13459.code
13460daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
13461local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13462.endd
13463This specifies listening on the smtp port on all IPv6 and IPv4 interfaces.
13464Either one or two sockets may be used, depending on the characteristics of
13465the TCP/IP stack. (This is complicated and messy; for more information,
13466read the comments in the &_daemon.c_& source file.)
13467
13468To specify listening on ports 25 and 26 on all interfaces:
13469.code
13470daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 26
13471.endd
13472(leaving &%local_interfaces%& at the default setting) or, more explicitly:
13473.code
13474local_interfaces = <; ::0.25 ; ::0.26 \
13475 0.0.0.0.25 ; 0.0.0.0.26
13476.endd
13477To listen on the default port on all IPv4 interfaces, and on port 26 on the
13478IPv4 loopback address only:
13479.code
13480local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.1.26
13481.endd
13482To specify listening on the default port on specific interfaces only:
13483.code
13484local_interfaces = 10.0.0.67 : 192.168.34.67
13485.endd
13486&*Warning*&: Such a setting excludes listening on the loopback interfaces.
13487
13488
13489
13490.section "Recognizing the local host" "SECTreclocipadd"
13491The &%local_interfaces%& option is also used when Exim needs to determine
13492whether or not an IP address refers to the local host. That is, the IP
13493addresses of all the interfaces on which a daemon is listening are always
13494treated as local.
13495
13496For this usage, port numbers in &%local_interfaces%& are ignored. If either of
13497the items 0.0.0.0 or ::0 are encountered, Exim gets a complete list of
13498available interfaces from the operating system, and extracts the relevant
13499(that is, IPv4 or IPv6) addresses to use for checking.
13500
13501Some systems set up large numbers of virtual interfaces in order to provide
13502many virtual web servers. In this situation, you may want to listen for
13503email on only a few of the available interfaces, but nevertheless treat all
13504interfaces as local when routing. You can do this by setting
13505&%extra_local_interfaces%& to a list of IP addresses, possibly including the
13506&"all"& wildcard values. These addresses are recognized as local, but are not
13507used for listening. Consider this example:
13508.code
13509local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1 ; \
13510 192.168.53.235 ; \
13511 3ffe:2101:12:1:a00:20ff:fe86:a061
13512
13513extra_local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13514.endd
13515The daemon listens on the loopback interfaces and just one IPv4 and one IPv6
13516address, but all available interface addresses are treated as local when
13517Exim is routing.
13518
13519In some environments the local host name may be in an MX list, but with an IP
13520address that is not assigned to any local interface. In other cases it may be
13521desirable to treat other host names as if they referred to the local host. Both
13522these cases can be handled by setting the &%hosts_treat_as_local%& option.
13523This contains host names rather than IP addresses. When a host is referenced
13524during routing, either via an MX record or directly, it is treated as the local
13525host if its name matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, or if any of its IP
13526addresses match &%local_interfaces%& or &%extra_local_interfaces%&.
13527
13528
13529
13530.section "Delivering to a remote host" "SECID95"
13531Delivery to a remote host is handled by the smtp transport. By default, it
13532allows the system's TCP/IP functions to choose which interface to use (if
13533there is more than one) when connecting to a remote host. However, the
13534&%interface%& option can be set to specify which interface is used. See the
13535description of the smtp transport in chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for more
13536details.
13537
13538
13539
13540
13541. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13542. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13543
13544.chapter "Main configuration" "CHAPmainconfig"
13545.scindex IIDconfima "configuration file" "main section"
13546.scindex IIDmaiconf "main configuration"
13547The first part of the run time configuration file contains three types of item:
13548
13549.ilist
13550Macro definitions: These lines start with an upper case letter. See section
13551&<<SECTmacrodefs>>& for details of macro processing.
13552.next
13553Named list definitions: These lines start with one of the words &"domainlist"&,
13554&"hostlist"&, &"addresslist"&, or &"localpartlist"&. Their use is described in
13555section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
13556.next
13557Main configuration settings: Each setting occupies one line of the file
13558(with possible continuations). If any setting is preceded by the word
13559&"hide"&, the &%-bP%& command line option displays its value to admin users
13560only. See section &<<SECTcos>>& for a description of the syntax of these option
13561settings.
13562.endlist
13563
13564This chapter specifies all the main configuration options, along with their
13565types and default values. For ease of finding a particular option, they appear
13566in alphabetical order in section &<<SECTalomo>>& below. However, because there
13567are now so many options, they are first listed briefly in functional groups, as
13568an aid to finding the name of the option you are looking for. Some options are
13569listed in more than one group.
13570
13571.section "Miscellaneous" "SECID96"
13572.table2
13573.row &%bi_command%& "to run for &%-bi%& command line option"
13574.row &%debug_store%& "do extra internal checks"
13575.row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
13576.row &%keep_malformed%& "for broken files &-- should not happen"
13577.row &%localhost_number%& "for unique message ids in clusters"
13578.row &%message_body_newlines%& "retain newlines in &$message_body$&"
13579.row &%message_body_visible%& "how much to show in &$message_body$&"
13580.row &%mua_wrapper%& "run in &""MUA wrapper""& mode"
13581.row &%print_topbitchars%& "top-bit characters are printing"
13582.row &%spool_wireformat%& "use wire-format spool data files when possible"
13583.row &%timezone%& "force time zone"
13584.endtable
13585
13586
13587.section "Exim parameters" "SECID97"
13588.table2
13589.row &%exim_group%& "override compiled-in value"
13590.row &%exim_path%& "override compiled-in value"
13591.row &%exim_user%& "override compiled-in value"
13592.row &%primary_hostname%& "default from &[uname()]&"
13593.row &%split_spool_directory%& "use multiple directories"
13594.row &%spool_directory%& "override compiled-in value"
13595.endtable
13596
13597
13598
13599.section "Privilege controls" "SECID98"
13600.table2
13601.row &%admin_groups%& "groups that are Exim admin users"
13602.row &%commandline_checks_require_admin%& "require admin for various checks"
13603.row &%deliver_drop_privilege%& "drop root for delivery processes"
13604.row &%local_from_check%& "insert &'Sender:'& if necessary"
13605.row &%local_from_prefix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
13606.row &%local_from_suffix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
13607.row &%local_sender_retain%& "keep &'Sender:'& from untrusted user"
13608.row &%never_users%& "do not run deliveries as these"
13609.row &%prod_requires_admin%& "forced delivery requires admin user"
13610.row &%queue_list_requires_admin%& "queue listing requires admin user"
13611.row &%trusted_groups%& "groups that are trusted"
13612.row &%trusted_users%& "users that are trusted"
13613.endtable
13614
13615
13616
13617.section "Logging" "SECID99"
13618.table2
13619.row &%event_action%& "custom logging"
13620.row &%hosts_connection_nolog%& "exemption from connect logging"
13621.row &%log_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
13622.row &%log_selector%& "set/unset optional logging"
13623.row &%log_timezone%& "add timezone to log lines"
13624.row &%message_logs%& "create per-message logs"
13625.row &%preserve_message_logs%& "after message completion"
13626.row &%process_log_path%& "for SIGUSR1 and &'exiwhat'&"
13627.row &%slow_lookup_log%& "control logging of slow DNS lookups"
13628.row &%syslog_duplication%& "controls duplicate log lines on syslog"
13629.row &%syslog_facility%& "set syslog &""facility""& field"
13630.row &%syslog_pid%& "pid in syslog lines"
13631.row &%syslog_processname%& "set syslog &""ident""& field"
13632.row &%syslog_timestamp%& "timestamp syslog lines"
13633.row &%write_rejectlog%& "control use of message log"
13634.endtable
13635
13636
13637
13638.section "Frozen messages" "SECID100"
13639.table2
13640.row &%auto_thaw%& "sets time for retrying frozen messages"
13641.row &%freeze_tell%& "send message when freezing"
13642.row &%move_frozen_messages%& "to another directory"
13643.row &%timeout_frozen_after%& "keep frozen messages only so long"
13644.endtable
13645
13646
13647
13648.section "Data lookups" "SECID101"
13649.table2
13650.row &%ibase_servers%& "InterBase servers"
13651.row &%ldap_ca_cert_dir%& "dir of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
13652.row &%ldap_ca_cert_file%& "file of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
13653.row &%ldap_cert_file%& "client cert file for LDAP"
13654.row &%ldap_cert_key%& "client key file for LDAP"
13655.row &%ldap_cipher_suite%& "TLS negotiation preference control"
13656.row &%ldap_default_servers%& "used if no server in query"
13657.row &%ldap_require_cert%& "action to take without LDAP server cert"
13658.row &%ldap_start_tls%& "require TLS within LDAP"
13659.row &%ldap_version%& "set protocol version"
13660.row &%lookup_open_max%& "lookup files held open"
13661.row &%mysql_servers%& "default MySQL servers"
13662.row &%oracle_servers%& "Oracle servers"
13663.row &%pgsql_servers%& "default PostgreSQL servers"
13664.row &%sqlite_lock_timeout%& "as it says"
13665.endtable
13666
13667
13668
13669.section "Message ids" "SECID102"
13670.table2
13671.row &%message_id_header_domain%& "used to build &'Message-ID:'& header"
13672.row &%message_id_header_text%& "ditto"
13673.endtable
13674
13675
13676
13677.section "Embedded Perl Startup" "SECID103"
13678.table2
13679.row &%perl_at_start%& "always start the interpreter"
13680.row &%perl_startup%& "code to obey when starting Perl"
13681.row &%perl_taintmode%& "enable taint mode in Perl"
13682.endtable
13683
13684
13685
13686.section "Daemon" "SECID104"
13687.table2
13688.row &%daemon_smtp_ports%& "default ports"
13689.row &%daemon_startup_retries%& "number of times to retry"
13690.row &%daemon_startup_sleep%& "time to sleep between tries"
13691.row &%extra_local_interfaces%& "not necessarily listened on"
13692.row &%local_interfaces%& "on which to listen, with optional ports"
13693.row &%pid_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
13694.row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
13695.endtable
13696
13697
13698
13699.section "Resource control" "SECID105"
13700.table2
13701.row &%check_log_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
13702.row &%check_log_space%& "before accepting a message"
13703.row &%check_spool_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
13704.row &%check_spool_space%& "before accepting a message"
13705.row &%deliver_queue_load_max%& "no queue deliveries if load high"
13706.row &%queue_only_load%& "queue incoming if load high"
13707.row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
13708.row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
13709.row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
13710.row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
13711.row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
13712.row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
13713.row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
13714.row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
13715.row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
13716.row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
13717 connection"
13718.row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
13719.row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
13720.row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
13721.row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "SMTP from reserved hosts if load high"
13722.row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
13723.endtable
13724
13725
13726
13727.section "Policy controls" "SECID106"
13728.table2
13729.row &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
13730.row &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
13731.row &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL for start of non-SMTP message"
13732.row &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
13733.row &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for connection"
13734.row &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL for DATA"
13735.row &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for DATA, per-recipient"
13736.row &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for DKIM verification"
13737.row &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
13738.row &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
13739.row &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for EHLO or HELO"
13740.row &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
13741.row &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for AUTH on MAIL command"
13742.row &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for MIME parts"
13743.row &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
13744.row &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL for start of data"
13745.row &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
13746.row &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
13747.row &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
13748.row &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
13749.row &%av_scanner%& "specify virus scanner"
13750.row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
13751 words""&"
13752.row &%dns_csa_search_limit%& "control CSA parent search depth"
13753.row &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& "en/disable CSA IP reverse search"
13754.row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
13755.row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
13756.row &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& "allow syntactic junk from these hosts"
13757.row &%helo_allow_chars%& "allow illegal chars in HELO names"
13758.row &%helo_lookup_domains%& "lookup hostname for these HELO names"
13759.row &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& "HELO soft-checked for these hosts"
13760.row &%helo_verify_hosts%& "HELO hard-checked for these hosts"
13761.row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
13762.row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
13763.row &%hosts_proxy%& "use proxy protocol for these hosts"
13764.row &%host_reject_connection%& "reject connection from these hosts"
13765.row &%hosts_treat_as_local%& "useful in some cluster configurations"
13766.row &%local_scan_timeout%& "timeout for &[local_scan()]&"
13767.row &%message_size_limit%& "for all messages"
13768.row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
13769.row &%spamd_address%& "set interface to SpamAssassin"
13770.row &%strict_acl_vars%& "object to unset ACL variables"
13771.endtable
13772
13773
13774
13775.section "Callout cache" "SECID107"
13776.table2
13777.row &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative domain cache &&&
13778 item"
13779.row &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive domain cache &&&
13780 item"
13781.row &%callout_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative address cache item"
13782.row &%callout_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive address cache item"
13783.row &%callout_random_local_part%& "string to use for &""random""& testing"
13784.endtable
13785
13786
13787
13788.section "TLS" "SECID108"
13789.table2
13790.row &%gnutls_compat_mode%& "use GnuTLS compatibility mode"
13791.row &%gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11%& "allow GnuTLS to autoload PKCS11 modules"
13792.row &%openssl_options%& "adjust OpenSSL compatibility options"
13793.row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
13794.row &%tls_certificate%& "location of server certificate"
13795.row &%tls_crl%& "certificate revocation list"
13796.row &%tls_dh_max_bits%& "clamp D-H bit count suggestion"
13797.row &%tls_dhparam%& "DH parameters for server"
13798.row &%tls_eccurve%& "EC curve selection for server"
13799.row &%tls_ocsp_file%& "location of server certificate status proof"
13800.row &%tls_on_connect_ports%& "specify SSMTP (SMTPS) ports"
13801.row &%tls_privatekey%& "location of server private key"
13802.row &%tls_remember_esmtp%& "don't reset after starting TLS"
13803.row &%tls_require_ciphers%& "specify acceptable ciphers"
13804.row &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& "try to verify client certificate"
13805.row &%tls_verify_certificates%& "expected client certificates"
13806.row &%tls_verify_hosts%& "insist on client certificate verify"
13807.endtable
13808
13809
13810
13811.section "Local user handling" "SECID109"
13812.table2
13813.row &%finduser_retries%& "useful in NIS environments"
13814.row &%gecos_name%& "used when creating &'Sender:'&"
13815.row &%gecos_pattern%& "ditto"
13816.row &%max_username_length%& "for systems that truncate"
13817.row &%unknown_login%& "used when no login name found"
13818.row &%unknown_username%& "ditto"
13819.row &%uucp_from_pattern%& "for recognizing &""From ""& lines"
13820.row &%uucp_from_sender%& "ditto"
13821.endtable
13822
13823
13824
13825.section "All incoming messages (SMTP and non-SMTP)" "SECID110"
13826.table2
13827.row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
13828.row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
13829.row &%message_size_limit%& "applies to all messages"
13830.row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
13831.row &%received_header_text%& "expanded to make &'Received:'&"
13832.row &%received_headers_max%& "for mail loop detection"
13833.row &%recipients_max%& "limit per message"
13834.row &%recipients_max_reject%& "permanently reject excess recipients"
13835.endtable
13836
13837
13838
13839
13840.section "Non-SMTP incoming messages" "SECID111"
13841.table2
13842.row &%receive_timeout%& "for non-SMTP messages"
13843.endtable
13844
13845
13846
13847
13848
13849.section "Incoming SMTP messages" "SECID112"
13850See also the &'Policy controls'& section above.
13851
13852.table2
13853.row &%dkim_verify_signers%& "DKIM domain for which DKIM ACL is run"
13854.row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
13855.row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
13856.row &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified recipients"
13857.row &%rfc1413_hosts%& "make ident calls to these hosts"
13858.row &%rfc1413_query_timeout%& "zero disables ident calls"
13859.row &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified senders"
13860.row &%smtp_accept_keepalive%& "some TCP/IP magic"
13861.row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
13862.row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
13863.row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
13864.row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
13865.row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
13866.row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
13867.row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
13868 connection"
13869.row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
13870.row &%smtp_active_hostname%& "host name to use in messages"
13871.row &%smtp_banner%& "text for welcome banner"
13872.row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
13873.row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
13874.row &%smtp_enforce_sync%& "of SMTP command/responses"
13875.row &%smtp_etrn_command%& "what to run for ETRN"
13876.row &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& "only one at once"
13877.row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if this load"
13878.row &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& "before dropping connection"
13879.row &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& "apply ratelimiting to these hosts"
13880.row &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& "ratelimit for MAIL commands"
13881.row &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& "ratelimit for RCPT commands"
13882.row &%smtp_receive_timeout%& "per command or data line"
13883.row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
13884.row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
13885.endtable
13886
13887
13888
13889.section "SMTP extensions" "SECID113"
13890.table2
13891.row &%accept_8bitmime%& "advertise 8BITMIME"
13892.row &%auth_advertise_hosts%& "advertise AUTH to these hosts"
13893.row &%chunking_advertise_hosts%& "advertise CHUNKING to these hosts"
13894.row &%dsn_advertise_hosts%& "advertise DSN extensions to these hosts"
13895.row &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& "allow &""From ""& from these hosts"
13896.row &%ignore_fromline_local%& "allow &""From ""& from local SMTP"
13897.row &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%& "advertise pipelining to these hosts"
13898.row &%prdr_enable%& "advertise PRDR to all hosts"
13899.row &%smtputf8_advertise_hosts%& "advertise SMTPUTF8 to these hosts"
13900.row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
13901.endtable
13902
13903
13904
13905.section "Processing messages" "SECID114"
13906.table2
13907.row &%allow_domain_literals%& "recognize domain literal syntax"
13908.row &%allow_mx_to_ip%& "allow MX to point to IP address"
13909.row &%allow_utf8_domains%& "in addresses"
13910.row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
13911 words""&"
13912.row &%delivery_date_remove%& "from incoming messages"
13913.row &%envelope_to_remove%& "from incoming messages"
13914.row &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& "affects &%-t%& processing"
13915.row &%headers_charset%& "default for translations"
13916.row &%qualify_domain%& "default for senders"
13917.row &%qualify_recipient%& "default for recipients"
13918.row &%return_path_remove%& "from incoming messages"
13919.row &%strip_excess_angle_brackets%& "in addresses"
13920.row &%strip_trailing_dot%& "at end of addresses"
13921.row &%untrusted_set_sender%& "untrusted can set envelope sender"
13922.endtable
13923
13924
13925
13926.section "System filter" "SECID115"
13927.table2
13928.row &%system_filter%& "locate system filter"
13929.row &%system_filter_directory_transport%& "transport for delivery to a &&&
13930 directory"
13931.row &%system_filter_file_transport%& "transport for delivery to a file"
13932.row &%system_filter_group%& "group for filter running"
13933.row &%system_filter_pipe_transport%& "transport for delivery to a pipe"
13934.row &%system_filter_reply_transport%& "transport for autoreply delivery"
13935.row &%system_filter_user%& "user for filter running"
13936.endtable
13937
13938
13939
13940.section "Routing and delivery" "SECID116"
13941.table2
13942.row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
13943.row &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& "for broken domains"
13944.row &%dns_check_names_pattern%& "pre-DNS syntax check"
13945.row &%dns_dnssec_ok%& "parameter for resolver"
13946.row &%dns_ipv4_lookup%& "only v4 lookup for these domains"
13947.row &%dns_retrans%& "parameter for resolver"
13948.row &%dns_retry%& "parameter for resolver"
13949.row &%dns_trust_aa%& "DNS zones trusted as authentic"
13950.row &%dns_use_edns0%& "parameter for resolver"
13951.row &%hold_domains%& "hold delivery for these domains"
13952.row &%local_interfaces%& "for routing checks"
13953.row &%queue_domains%& "no immediate delivery for these"
13954.row &%queue_only%& "no immediate delivery at all"
13955.row &%queue_only_file%& "no immediate delivery if file exists"
13956.row &%queue_only_load%& "no immediate delivery if load is high"
13957.row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
13958.row &%queue_only_override%& "allow command line to override"
13959.row &%queue_run_in_order%& "order of arrival"
13960.row &%queue_run_max%& "of simultaneous queue runners"
13961.row &%queue_smtp_domains%& "no immediate SMTP delivery for these"
13962.row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
13963.row &%remote_sort_domains%& "order of remote deliveries"
13964.row &%retry_data_expire%& "timeout for retry data"
13965.row &%retry_interval_max%& "safety net for retry rules"
13966.endtable
13967
13968
13969
13970.section "Bounce and warning messages" "SECID117"
13971.table2
13972.row &%bounce_message_file%& "content of bounce"
13973.row &%bounce_message_text%& "content of bounce"
13974.row &%bounce_return_body%& "include body if returning message"
13975.row &%bounce_return_linesize_limit%& "limit on returned message line length"
13976.row &%bounce_return_message%& "include original message in bounce"
13977.row &%bounce_return_size_limit%& "limit on returned message"
13978.row &%bounce_sender_authentication%& "send authenticated sender with bounce"
13979.row &%dsn_from%& "set &'From:'& contents in bounces"
13980.row &%errors_copy%& "copy bounce messages"
13981.row &%errors_reply_to%& "&'Reply-to:'& in bounces"
13982.row &%delay_warning%& "time schedule"
13983.row &%delay_warning_condition%& "condition for warning messages"
13984.row &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& "discard undeliverable bounces"
13985.row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
13986.row &%warn_message_file%& "content of warning message"
13987.endtable
13988
13989
13990
13991.section "Alphabetical list of main options" "SECTalomo"
13992Those options that undergo string expansion before use are marked with
13993&dagger;.
13994
13995.option accept_8bitmime main boolean true
13996.cindex "8BITMIME"
13997.cindex "8-bit characters"
13998.cindex "log" "selectors"
13999.cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
14000This option causes Exim to send 8BITMIME in its response to an SMTP
14001EHLO command, and to accept the BODY= parameter on MAIL commands.
14002However, though Exim is 8-bit clean, it is not a protocol converter, and it
14003takes no steps to do anything special with messages received by this route.
14004
14005Historically Exim kept this option off by default, but the maintainers
14006feel that in today's Internet, this causes more problems than it solves.
14007It now defaults to true.
14008A more detailed analysis of the issues is provided by Dan Bernstein:
14009.display
14010&url(http://cr.yp.to/smtp/8bitmime.html)
14011.endd
14012
14013To log received 8BITMIME status use
14014.code
14015log_selector = +8bitmime
14016.endd
14017
14018.option acl_not_smtp main string&!! unset
14019.cindex "&ACL;" "for non-SMTP messages"
14020.cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
14021This option defines the ACL that is run when a non-SMTP message has been
14022read and is on the point of being accepted. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
14023further details.
14024
14025.option acl_not_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
14026This option defines the ACL that is run for individual MIME parts of non-SMTP
14027messages. It operates in exactly the same way as &%acl_smtp_mime%& operates for
14028SMTP messages.
14029
14030.option acl_not_smtp_start main string&!! unset
14031.cindex "&ACL;" "at start of non-SMTP message"
14032.cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
14033This option defines the ACL that is run before Exim starts reading a
14034non-SMTP message. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14035
14036.option acl_smtp_auth main string&!! unset
14037.cindex "&ACL;" "setting up for SMTP commands"
14038.cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
14039This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP AUTH command is
14040received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14041
14042.option acl_smtp_connect main string&!! unset
14043.cindex "&ACL;" "on SMTP connection"
14044This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP connection is received.
14045See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14046
14047.option acl_smtp_data main string&!! unset
14048.cindex "DATA" "ACL for"
14049This option defines the ACL that is run after an SMTP DATA command has been
14050processed and the message itself has been received, but before the final
14051acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14052
14053.option acl_smtp_data_prdr main string&!! accept
14054.cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
14055.cindex "DATA" "PRDR ACL for"
14056.cindex "&ACL;" "PRDR-related"
14057.cindex "&ACL;" "per-user data processing"
14058This option defines the ACL that,
14059if the PRDR feature has been negotiated,
14060is run for each recipient after an SMTP DATA command has been
14061processed and the message itself has been received, but before the
14062acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14063
14064.option acl_smtp_dkim main string&!! unset
14065.cindex DKIM "ACL for"
14066This option defines the ACL that is run for each DKIM signature
14067(by default, or as specified in the dkim_verify_signers option)
14068of a received message.
14069See chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>& for further details.
14070
14071.option acl_smtp_etrn main string&!! unset
14072.cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
14073This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP ETRN command is
14074received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14075
14076.option acl_smtp_expn main string&!! unset
14077.cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
14078This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EXPN command is
14079received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14080
14081.option acl_smtp_helo main string&!! unset
14082.cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
14083.cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
14084This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EHLO or HELO
14085command is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14086
14087
14088.option acl_smtp_mail main string&!! unset
14089.cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
14090This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP MAIL command is
14091received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14092
14093.option acl_smtp_mailauth main string&!! unset
14094.cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
14095This option defines the ACL that is run when there is an AUTH parameter on
14096a MAIL command. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs, and chapter
14097&<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
14098
14099.option acl_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
14100.cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
14101This option is available when Exim is built with the content-scanning
14102extension. It defines the ACL that is run for each MIME part in a message. See
14103section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>& for details.
14104
14105.option acl_smtp_notquit main string&!! unset
14106.cindex "not-QUIT, ACL for"
14107This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP session
14108ends without a QUIT command being received.
14109See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14110
14111.option acl_smtp_predata main string&!! unset
14112This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP DATA command is
14113received, before the message itself is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
14114further details.
14115
14116.option acl_smtp_quit main string&!! unset
14117.cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
14118This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP QUIT command is
14119received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14120
14121.option acl_smtp_rcpt main string&!! unset
14122.cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
14123This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP RCPT command is
14124received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14125
14126.option acl_smtp_starttls main string&!! unset
14127.cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
14128This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP STARTTLS command is
14129received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14130
14131.option acl_smtp_vrfy main string&!! unset
14132.cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
14133This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP VRFY command is
14134received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14135
14136.option add_environment main "string list" empty
14137.cindex "environment" "set values"
14138This option allows to set individual environment variables that the
14139currently linked libraries and programs in child processes use.
14140See &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the environment of &(pipe)& transports.
14141
14142.option admin_groups main "string list&!!" unset
14143.cindex "admin user"
14144This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If the
14145current group or any of the supplementary groups of an Exim caller is in this
14146colon-separated list, the caller has admin privileges. If all your system
14147programmers are in a specific group, for example, you can give them all Exim
14148admin privileges by putting that group in &%admin_groups%&. However, this does
14149not permit them to read Exim's spool files (whose group owner is the Exim gid).
14150To permit this, you have to add individuals to the Exim group.
14151
14152.option allow_domain_literals main boolean false
14153.cindex "domain literal"
14154If this option is set, the RFC 2822 domain literal format is permitted in
14155email addresses. The option is not set by default, because the domain literal
14156format is not normally required these days, and few people know about it. It
14157has, however, been exploited by mail abusers.
14158
14159Unfortunately, it seems that some DNS black list maintainers are using this
14160format to report black listing to postmasters. If you want to accept messages
14161addressed to your hosts by IP address, you need to set
14162&%allow_domain_literals%& true, and also to add &`@[]`& to the list of local
14163domains (defined in the named domain list &%local_domains%& in the default
14164configuration). This &"magic string"& matches the domain literal form of all
14165the local host's IP addresses.
14166
14167
14168.option allow_mx_to_ip main boolean false
14169.cindex "MX record" "pointing to IP address"
14170It appears that more and more DNS zone administrators are breaking the rules
14171and putting domain names that look like IP addresses on the right hand side of
14172MX records. Exim follows the rules and rejects this, giving an error message
14173that explains the misconfiguration. However, some other MTAs support this
14174practice, so to avoid &"Why can't Exim do this?"& complaints,
14175&%allow_mx_to_ip%& exists, in order to enable this heinous activity. It is not
14176recommended, except when you have no other choice.
14177
14178.option allow_utf8_domains main boolean false
14179.cindex "domain" "UTF-8 characters in"
14180.cindex "UTF-8" "in domain name"
14181Lots of discussion is going on about internationalized domain names. One
14182camp is strongly in favour of just using UTF-8 characters, and it seems
14183that at least two other MTAs permit this. This option allows Exim users to
14184experiment if they wish.
14185
14186If it is set true, Exim's domain parsing function allows valid
14187UTF-8 multicharacters to appear in domain name components, in addition to
14188letters, digits, and hyphens. However, just setting this option is not
14189enough; if you want to look up these domain names in the DNS, you must also
14190adjust the value of &%dns_check_names_pattern%& to match the extended form. A
14191suitable setting is:
14192.code
14193dns_check_names_pattern = (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[a-z0-9\xc0-\xff]\
14194 (?>[-a-z0-9\x80-\xff]*[a-z0-9\x80-\xbf])?)+$
14195.endd
14196Alternatively, you can just disable this feature by setting
14197.code
14198dns_check_names_pattern =
14199.endd
14200That is, set the option to an empty string so that no check is done.
14201
14202
14203.option auth_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
14204.cindex "authentication" "advertising"
14205.cindex "AUTH" "advertising"
14206If any server authentication mechanisms are configured, Exim advertises them in
14207response to an EHLO command only if the calling host matches this list.
14208Otherwise, Exim does not advertise AUTH.
14209Exim does not accept AUTH commands from clients to which it has not
14210advertised the availability of AUTH. The advertising of individual
14211authentication mechanisms can be controlled by the use of the
14212&%server_advertise_condition%& generic authenticator option on the individual
14213authenticators. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for further details.
14214
14215Certain mail clients (for example, Netscape) require the user to provide a name
14216and password for authentication if AUTH is advertised, even though it may
14217not be needed (the host may accept messages from hosts on its local LAN without
14218authentication, for example). The &%auth_advertise_hosts%& option can be used
14219to make these clients more friendly by excluding them from the set of hosts to
14220which Exim advertises AUTH.
14221
14222.cindex "AUTH" "advertising when encrypted"
14223If you want to advertise the availability of AUTH only when the connection
14224is encrypted using TLS, you can make use of the fact that the value of this
14225option is expanded, with a setting like this:
14226.code
14227auth_advertise_hosts = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{}{*}}
14228.endd
14229.vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
14230If &$tls_in_cipher$& is empty, the session is not encrypted, and the result of
14231the expansion is empty, thus matching no hosts. Otherwise, the result of the
14232expansion is *, which matches all hosts.
14233
14234
14235.option auto_thaw main time 0s
14236.cindex "thawing messages"
14237.cindex "unfreezing messages"
14238If this option is set to a time greater than zero, a queue runner will try a
14239new delivery attempt on any frozen message, other than a bounce message, if
14240this much time has passed since it was frozen. This may result in the message
14241being re-frozen if nothing has changed since the last attempt. It is a way of
14242saying &"keep on trying, even though there are big problems"&.
14243
14244&*Note*&: This is an old option, which predates &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
14245&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. It is retained for compatibility, but it is not
14246thought to be very useful any more, and its use should probably be avoided.
14247
14248
14249.option av_scanner main string "see below"
14250This option is available if Exim is built with the content-scanning extension.
14251It specifies which anti-virus scanner to use. The default value is:
14252.code
14253sophie:/var/run/sophie
14254.endd
14255If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
14256before use. See section &<<SECTscanvirus>>& for further details.
14257
14258
14259.option bi_command main string unset
14260.oindex "&%-bi%&"
14261This option supplies the name of a command that is run when Exim is called with
14262the &%-bi%& option (see chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&). The string value is
14263just the command name, it is not a complete command line. If an argument is
14264required, it must come from the &%-oA%& command line option.
14265
14266
14267.option bounce_message_file main string unset
14268.cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
14269.cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
14270This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
14271for constructing bounce messages. Details of the file's contents are given in
14272chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%warn_message_file%&.
14273
14274
14275.option bounce_message_text main string unset
14276When this option is set, its contents are included in the default bounce
14277message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
14278delivery software."& It is not used if &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
14279
14280.option bounce_return_body main boolean true
14281.cindex "bounce message" "including body"
14282This option controls whether the body of an incoming message is included in a
14283bounce message when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The default setting
14284causes the entire message, both header and body, to be returned (subject to the
14285value of &%bounce_return_size_limit%&). If this option is false, only the
14286message header is included. In the case of a non-SMTP message containing an
14287error that is detected during reception, only those header lines preceding the
14288point at which the error was detected are returned.
14289.cindex "bounce message" "including original"
14290
14291.option bounce_return_linesize_limit main integer 998
14292.cindex "size" "of bounce lines, limit"
14293.cindex "bounce message" "line length limit"
14294.cindex "limit" "bounce message line length"
14295This option sets a limit in bytes on the line length of messages
14296that are returned to senders due to delivery problems,
14297when &%bounce_return_message%& is true.
14298The default value corresponds to RFC limits.
14299If the message being returned has lines longer than this value it is
14300treated as if the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& (below) restriction was exceeded.
14301
14302The option also applies to bounces returned when an error is detected
14303during reception of a message.
14304In this case lines from the original are truncated.
14305
14306The option does not apply to messages generated by an &(autoreply)& transport.
14307
14308
14309.option bounce_return_message main boolean true
14310If this option is set false, none of the original message is included in
14311bounce messages generated by Exim. See also &%bounce_return_size_limit%& and
14312&%bounce_return_body%&.
14313
14314
14315.option bounce_return_size_limit main integer 100K
14316.cindex "size" "of bounce, limit"
14317.cindex "bounce message" "size limit"
14318.cindex "limit" "bounce message size"
14319This option sets a limit in bytes on the size of messages that are returned to
14320senders as part of bounce messages when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The
14321limit should be less than the value of the global &%message_size_limit%& and of
14322any &%message_size_limit%& settings on transports, to allow for the bounce text
14323that Exim generates. If this option is set to zero there is no limit.
14324
14325When the body of any message that is to be included in a bounce message is
14326greater than the limit, it is truncated, and a comment pointing this out is
14327added at the top. The actual cutoff may be greater than the value given, owing
14328to the use of buffering for transferring the message in chunks (typically 8K in
14329size). The idea is to save bandwidth on those undeliverable 15-megabyte
14330messages.
14331
14332.option bounce_sender_authentication main string unset
14333.cindex "bounce message" "sender authentication"
14334.cindex "authentication" "bounce message"
14335.cindex "AUTH" "on bounce message"
14336This option provides an authenticated sender address that is sent with any
14337bounce messages generated by Exim that are sent over an authenticated SMTP
14338connection. A typical setting might be:
14339.code
14340bounce_sender_authentication = mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
14341.endd
14342which would cause bounce messages to be sent using the SMTP command:
14343.code
14344MAIL FROM:<> AUTH=mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
14345.endd
14346The value of &%bounce_sender_authentication%& must always be a complete email
14347address.
14348
14349.option callout_domain_negative_expire main time 3h
14350.cindex "caching" "callout timeouts"
14351.cindex "callout" "caching timeouts"
14352This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for a
14353domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14354section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14355
14356
14357.option callout_domain_positive_expire main time 7d
14358This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for a
14359domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14360section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14361
14362
14363.option callout_negative_expire main time 2h
14364This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for an
14365address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14366section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14367
14368
14369.option callout_positive_expire main time 24h
14370This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for an
14371address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14372section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14373
14374
14375.option callout_random_local_part main string&!! "see below"
14376This option defines the &"random"& local part that can be used as part of
14377callout verification. The default value is
14378.code
14379$primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
14380.endd
14381See section &<<CALLaddparcall>>& for details of how this value is used.
14382
14383
14384.option check_log_inodes main integer 100
14385See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14386
14387
14388.option check_log_space main integer 10M
14389See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14390
14391.oindex "&%check_rfc2047_length%&"
14392.cindex "RFC 2047" "disabling length check"
14393.option check_rfc2047_length main boolean true
14394RFC 2047 defines a way of encoding non-ASCII characters in headers using a
14395system of &"encoded words"&. The RFC specifies a maximum length for an encoded
14396word; strings to be encoded that exceed this length are supposed to use
14397multiple encoded words. By default, Exim does not recognize encoded words that
14398exceed the maximum length. However, it seems that some software, in violation
14399of the RFC, generates overlong encoded words. If &%check_rfc2047_length%& is
14400set false, Exim recognizes encoded words of any length.
14401
14402
14403.option check_spool_inodes main integer 100
14404See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14405
14406
14407.option check_spool_space main integer 10M
14408.cindex "checking disk space"
14409.cindex "disk space, checking"
14410.cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
14411The four &%check_...%& options allow for checking of disk resources before a
14412message is accepted.
14413
14414.vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
14415.vindex "&$log_space$&"
14416.vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
14417.vindex "&$spool_space$&"
14418When any of these options are nonzero, they apply to all incoming messages. If you
14419want to apply different checks to different kinds of message, you can do so by
14420testing the variables &$log_inodes$&, &$log_space$&, &$spool_inodes$&, and
14421&$spool_space$& in an ACL with appropriate additional conditions.
14422
14423
14424&%check_spool_space%& and &%check_spool_inodes%& check the spool partition if
14425either value is greater than zero, for example:
14426.code
14427check_spool_space = 100M
14428check_spool_inodes = 100
14429.endd
14430The spool partition is the one that contains the directory defined by
14431SPOOL_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is used for holding messages in
14432transit.
14433
14434&%check_log_space%& and &%check_log_inodes%& check the partition in which log
14435files are written if either is greater than zero. These should be set only if
14436&%log_file_path%& and &%spool_directory%& refer to different partitions.
14437
14438If there is less space or fewer inodes than requested, Exim refuses to accept
14439incoming mail. In the case of SMTP input this is done by giving a 452 temporary
14440error response to the MAIL command. If ESMTP is in use and there was a
14441SIZE parameter on the MAIL command, its value is added to the
14442&%check_spool_space%& value, and the check is performed even if
14443&%check_spool_space%& is zero, unless &%no_smtp_check_spool_space%& is set.
14444
14445The values for &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_log_space%& are held as a
14446number of kilobytes (though specified in bytes).
14447If a non-multiple of 1024 is specified, it is rounded up.
14448
14449For non-SMTP input and for batched SMTP input, the test is done at start-up; on
14450failure a message is written to stderr and Exim exits with a non-zero code, as
14451it obviously cannot send an error message of any kind.
14452
14453There is a slight performance penalty for these checks.
14454Versions of Exim preceding 4.88 had these disabled by default;
14455high-rate installations confident they will never run out of resources
14456may wish to deliberately disable them.
14457
14458.option chunking_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
14459.cindex CHUNKING advertisement
14460.cindex "RFC 3030" "CHUNKING"
14461The CHUNKING extension (RFC3030) will be advertised in the EHLO message to
14462these hosts.
14463Hosts may use the BDAT command as an alternate to DATA.
14464
14465.new
14466.option commandline_checks_require_admin main boolean &`false`&
14467.cindex "restricting access to features"
14468This option restricts various basic checking features to require an
14469administrative user.
14470This affects most of the &%-b*%& options, such as &%-be%&.
14471.wen
14472
14473.option debug_store main boolean &`false`&
14474.cindex debugging "memory corruption"
14475.cindex memory debugging
14476This option, when true, enables extra checking in Exim's internal memory
14477management. For use when a memory corruption issue is being investigated,
14478it should normally be left as default.
14479
14480.option daemon_smtp_ports main string &`smtp`&
14481.cindex "port" "for daemon"
14482.cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
14483This option specifies one or more default SMTP ports on which the Exim daemon
14484listens. See chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& for details of how it is used. For
14485backward compatibility, &%daemon_smtp_port%& (singular) is a synonym.
14486
14487.option daemon_startup_retries main integer 9
14488.cindex "daemon startup, retrying"
14489This option, along with &%daemon_startup_sleep%&, controls the retrying done by
14490the daemon at startup when it cannot immediately bind a listening socket
14491(typically because the socket is already in use): &%daemon_startup_retries%&
14492defines the number of retries after the first failure, and
14493&%daemon_startup_sleep%& defines the length of time to wait between retries.
14494
14495.option daemon_startup_sleep main time 30s
14496See &%daemon_startup_retries%&.
14497
14498.option delay_warning main "time list" 24h
14499.cindex "warning of delay"
14500.cindex "delay warning, specifying"
14501.cindex "queue" "delay warning"
14502When a message is delayed, Exim sends a warning message to the sender at
14503intervals specified by this option. The data is a colon-separated list of times
14504after which to send warning messages. If the value of the option is an empty
14505string or a zero time, no warnings are sent. Up to 10 times may be given. If a
14506message has been on the queue for longer than the last time, the last interval
14507between the times is used to compute subsequent warning times. For example,
14508with
14509.code
14510delay_warning = 4h:8h:24h
14511.endd
14512the first message is sent after 4 hours, the second after 8 hours, and
14513the third one after 24 hours. After that, messages are sent every 16 hours,
14514because that is the interval between the last two times on the list. If you set
14515just one time, it specifies the repeat interval. For example, with:
14516.code
14517delay_warning = 6h
14518.endd
14519messages are repeated every six hours. To stop warnings after a given time, set
14520a very large time at the end of the list. For example:
14521.code
14522delay_warning = 2h:12h:99d
14523.endd
14524Note that the option is only evaluated at the time a delivery attempt fails,
14525which depends on retry and queue-runner configuration.
14526Typically retries will be configured more frequently than warning messages.
14527
14528.option delay_warning_condition main string&!! "see below"
14529.vindex "&$domain$&"
14530The string is expanded at the time a warning message might be sent. If all the
14531deferred addresses have the same domain, it is set in &$domain$& during the
14532expansion. Otherwise &$domain$& is empty. If the result of the expansion is a
14533forced failure, an empty string, or a string matching any of &"0"&, &"no"& or
14534&"false"& (the comparison being done caselessly) then the warning message is
14535not sent. The default is:
14536.code
14537delay_warning_condition = ${if or {\
14538 { !eq{$h_list-id:$h_list-post:$h_list-subscribe:}{} }\
14539 { match{$h_precedence:}{(?i)bulk|list|junk} }\
14540 { match{$h_auto-submitted:}{(?i)auto-generated|auto-replied} }\
14541 } {no}{yes}}
14542.endd
14543This suppresses the sending of warnings for messages that contain &'List-ID:'&,
14544&'List-Post:'&, or &'List-Subscribe:'& headers, or have &"bulk"&, &"list"& or
14545&"junk"& in a &'Precedence:'& header, or have &"auto-generated"& or
14546&"auto-replied"& in an &'Auto-Submitted:'& header.
14547
14548.option deliver_drop_privilege main boolean false
14549.cindex "unprivileged delivery"
14550.cindex "delivery" "unprivileged"
14551If this option is set true, Exim drops its root privilege at the start of a
14552delivery process, and runs as the Exim user throughout. This severely restricts
14553the kinds of local delivery that are possible, but is viable in certain types
14554of configuration. There is a discussion about the use of root privilege in
14555chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&.
14556
14557.option deliver_queue_load_max main fixed-point unset
14558.cindex "load average"
14559.cindex "queue runner" "abandoning"
14560When this option is set, a queue run is abandoned if the system load average
14561becomes greater than the value of the option. The option has no effect on
14562ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average.
14563See also &%queue_only_load%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
14564
14565
14566.option delivery_date_remove main boolean true
14567.cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
14568Exim's transports have an option for adding a &'Delivery-date:'& header to a
14569message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
14570handled. &'Delivery-date:'& records the actual time of delivery. Such headers
14571should not be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be
14572removed at the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might
14573occur when a delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
14574
14575.option disable_fsync main boolean false
14576.cindex "&[fsync()]&, disabling"
14577This option is available only if Exim was built with the compile-time option
14578ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC. When this is not set, a reference to &%disable_fsync%& in
14579a runtime configuration generates an &"unknown option"& error. You should not
14580build Exim with ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC or set &%disable_fsync%& unless you
14581really, really, really understand what you are doing. &'No pre-compiled
14582distributions of Exim should ever make this option available.'&
14583
14584When &%disable_fsync%& is set true, Exim no longer calls &[fsync()]& to force
14585updated files' data to be written to disc before continuing. Unexpected events
14586such as crashes and power outages may cause data to be lost or scrambled.
14587Here be Dragons. &*Beware.*&
14588
14589
14590.option disable_ipv6 main boolean false
14591.cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
14592If this option is set true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
14593activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
14594that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &%manualroute%& router,
14595etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
14596to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
14597
14598
14599.option dkim_verify_signers main "domain list&!!" $dkim_signers
14600.cindex DKIM "controlling calls to the ACL"
14601This option gives a list of DKIM domains for which the DKIM ACL is run.
14602It is expanded after the message is received; by default it runs
14603the ACL once for each signature in the message.
14604See chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
14605
14606
14607.option dns_again_means_nonexist main "domain list&!!" unset
14608.cindex "DNS" "&""try again""& response; overriding"
14609DNS lookups give a &"try again"& response for the DNS errors
14610&"non-authoritative host not found"& and &"SERVERFAIL"&. This can cause Exim to
14611keep trying to deliver a message, or to give repeated temporary errors to
14612incoming mail. Sometimes the effect is caused by a badly set up name server and
14613may persist for a long time. If a domain which exhibits this problem matches
14614anything in &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, it is treated as if it did not exist.
14615This option should be used with care. You can make it apply to reverse lookups
14616by a setting such as this:
14617.code
14618dns_again_means_nonexist = *.in-addr.arpa
14619.endd
14620This option applies to all DNS lookups that Exim does. It also applies when the
14621&[gethostbyname()]& or &[getipnodebyname()]& functions give temporary errors,
14622since these are most likely to be caused by DNS lookup problems. The
14623&(dnslookup)& router has some options of its own for controlling what happens
14624when lookups for MX or SRV records give temporary errors. These more specific
14625options are applied after this global option.
14626
14627.option dns_check_names_pattern main string "see below"
14628.cindex "DNS" "pre-check of name syntax"
14629When this option is set to a non-empty string, it causes Exim to check domain
14630names for characters that are not allowed in host names before handing them to
14631the DNS resolver, because some resolvers give temporary errors for names that
14632contain unusual characters. If a domain name contains any unwanted characters,
14633a &"not found"& result is forced, and the resolver is not called. The check is
14634done by matching the domain name against a regular expression, which is the
14635value of this option. The default pattern is
14636.code
14637dns_check_names_pattern = \
14638 (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[^\W_](?>[a-z0-9/-]*[^\W_])?)+$
14639.endd
14640which permits only letters, digits, slashes, and hyphens in components, but
14641they must start and end with a letter or digit. Slashes are not, in fact,
14642permitted in host names, but they are found in certain NS records (which can be
14643accessed in Exim by using a &%dnsdb%& lookup). If you set
14644&%allow_utf8_domains%&, you must modify this pattern, or set the option to an
14645empty string.
14646
14647.option dns_csa_search_limit main integer 5
14648This option controls the depth of parental searching for CSA SRV records in the
14649DNS, as described in more detail in section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
14650
14651.option dns_csa_use_reverse main boolean true
14652This option controls whether or not an IP address, given as a CSA domain, is
14653reversed and looked up in the reverse DNS, as described in more detail in
14654section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
14655
14656
14657.option dns_dnssec_ok main integer -1
14658.cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14659.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
14660If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
14661DNS resolver library to either use or not use DNSSEC, overriding the system
14662default. A value of 0 coerces DNSSEC off, a value of 1 coerces DNSSEC on.
14663
14664If the resolver library does not support DNSSEC then this option has no effect.
14665
14666
14667.option dns_ipv4_lookup main "domain list&!!" unset
14668.cindex "IPv6" "DNS lookup for AAAA records"
14669.cindex "DNS" "IPv6 lookup for AAAA records"
14670When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support and &%disable_ipv6%& is not set, it
14671looks for IPv6 address records (AAAA records) as well as IPv4 address records
14672(A records) when trying to find IP addresses for hosts, unless the host's
14673domain matches this list.
14674
14675This is a fudge to help with name servers that give big delays or otherwise do
14676not work for the AAAA record type. In due course, when the world's name
14677servers have all been upgraded, there should be no need for this option.
14678
14679
14680.option dns_retrans main time 0s
14681.cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14682.cindex timeout "dns lookup"
14683.cindex "DNS" timeout
14684The options &%dns_retrans%& and &%dns_retry%& can be used to set the
14685retransmission and retry parameters for DNS lookups. Values of zero (the
14686defaults) leave the system default settings unchanged. The first value is the
14687time between retries, and the second is the number of retries. It isn't
14688totally clear exactly how these settings affect the total time a DNS lookup may
14689take. I haven't found any documentation about timeouts on DNS lookups; these
14690parameter values are available in the external resolver interface structure,
14691but nowhere does it seem to describe how they are used or what you might want
14692to set in them.
14693See also the &%slow_lookup_log%& option.
14694
14695
14696.option dns_retry main integer 0
14697See &%dns_retrans%& above.
14698
14699
14700.option dns_trust_aa main "domain list&!!" unset
14701.cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14702.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
14703If this option is set then lookup results marked with the AA bit
14704(Authoritative Answer) are trusted the same way as if they were
14705DNSSEC-verified. The authority section's name of the answer must
14706match with this expanded domain list.
14707
14708Use this option only if you talk directly to a resolver that is
14709authoritative for some zones and does not set the AD (Authentic Data)
14710bit in the answer. Some DNS servers may have an configuration option to
14711mark the answers from their own zones as verified (they set the AD bit).
14712Others do not have this option. It is considered as poor practice using
14713a resolver that is an authoritative server for some zones.
14714
14715Use this option only if you really have to (e.g. if you want
14716to use DANE for remote delivery to a server that is listed in the DNS
14717zones that your resolver is authoritative for).
14718
14719If the DNS answer packet has the AA bit set and contains resource record
14720in the answer section, the name of the first NS record appearing in the
14721authority section is compared against the list. If the answer packet is
14722authoritative but the answer section is empty, the name of the first SOA
14723record in the authoritative section is used instead.
14724
14725.cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14726.option dns_use_edns0 main integer -1
14727.cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14728.cindex "DNS" "EDNS0"
14729.cindex "DNS" "OpenBSD
14730If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
14731DNS resolver library to either use or not use EDNS0 extensions, overriding
14732the system default. A value of 0 coerces EDNS0 off, a value of 1 coerces EDNS0
14733on.
14734
14735If the resolver library does not support EDNS0 then this option has no effect.
14736
14737OpenBSD's asr resolver routines are known to ignore the EDNS0 option; this
14738means that DNSSEC will not work with Exim on that platform either, unless Exim
14739is linked against an alternative DNS client library.
14740
14741
14742.option drop_cr main boolean false
14743This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
14744handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
14745described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
14746
14747.option dsn_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14748.cindex "bounce messages" "success"
14749.cindex "DSN" "success"
14750.cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
14751DSN extensions (RFC3461) will be advertised in the EHLO message to,
14752and accepted from, these hosts.
14753Hosts may use the NOTIFY and ENVID options on RCPT TO commands,
14754and RET and ORCPT options on MAIL FROM commands.
14755A NOTIFY=SUCCESS option requests success-DSN messages.
14756A NOTIFY= option with no argument requests that no delay or failure DSNs
14757are sent.
14758
14759.option dsn_from main "string&!!" "see below"
14760.cindex "&'From:'& header line" "in bounces"
14761.cindex "bounce messages" "&'From:'& line, specifying"
14762This option can be used to vary the contents of &'From:'& header lines in
14763bounces and other automatically generated messages (&"Delivery Status
14764Notifications"& &-- hence the name of the option). The default setting is:
14765.code
14766dsn_from = Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@$qualify_domain>
14767.endd
14768The value is expanded every time it is needed. If the expansion fails, a
14769panic is logged, and the default value is used.
14770
14771.option envelope_to_remove main boolean true
14772.cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
14773Exim's transports have an option for adding an &'Envelope-to:'& header to a
14774message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
14775handled. &'Envelope-to:'& records the original recipient address from the
14776message's envelope that caused the delivery to happen. Such headers should not
14777be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be removed at
14778the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might occur when a
14779delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
14780
14781
14782.option errors_copy main "string list&!!" unset
14783.cindex "bounce message" "copy to other address"
14784.cindex "copy of bounce message"
14785Setting this option causes Exim to send bcc copies of bounce messages that it
14786generates to other addresses. &*Note*&: This does not apply to bounce messages
14787coming from elsewhere. The value of the option is a colon-separated list of
14788items. Each item consists of a pattern, terminated by white space, followed by
14789a comma-separated list of email addresses. If a pattern contains spaces, it
14790must be enclosed in double quotes.
14791
14792Each pattern is processed in the same way as a single item in an address list
14793(see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). When a pattern matches the recipient of
14794the bounce message, the message is copied to the addresses on the list. The
14795items are scanned in order, and once a matching one is found, no further items
14796are examined. For example:
14797.code
14798errors_copy = spqr@mydomain postmaster@mydomain.example :\
14799 rqps@mydomain hostmaster@mydomain.example,\
14800 postmaster@mydomain.example
14801.endd
14802.vindex "&$domain$&"
14803.vindex "&$local_part$&"
14804The address list is expanded before use. The expansion variables &$local_part$&
14805and &$domain$& are set from the original recipient of the error message, and if
14806there was any wildcard matching in the pattern, the expansion
14807.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%errors_copy%&"
14808variables &$0$&, &$1$&, etc. are set in the normal way.
14809
14810
14811.option errors_reply_to main string unset
14812.cindex "bounce message" "&'Reply-to:'& in"
14813By default, Exim's bounce and delivery warning messages contain the header line
14814.display
14815&`From: Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@`&&'qualify-domain'&&`>`&
14816.endd
14817.oindex &%quota_warn_message%&
14818where &'qualify-domain'& is the value of the &%qualify_domain%& option.
14819A warning message that is generated by the &%quota_warn_message%& option in an
14820&(appendfile)& transport may contain its own &'From:'& header line that
14821overrides the default.
14822
14823Experience shows that people reply to bounce messages. If the
14824&%errors_reply_to%& option is set, a &'Reply-To:'& header is added to bounce
14825and warning messages. For example:
14826.code
14827errors_reply_to = postmaster@my.domain.example
14828.endd
14829The value of the option is not expanded. It must specify a valid RFC 2822
14830address. However, if a warning message that is generated by the
14831&%quota_warn_message%& option in an &(appendfile)& transport contain its
14832own &'Reply-To:'& header line, the value of the &%errors_reply_to%& option is
14833not used.
14834
14835
14836.option event_action main string&!! unset
14837.cindex events
14838This option declares a string to be expanded for Exim's events mechanism.
14839For details see chapter &<<CHAPevents>>&.
14840
14841
14842.option exim_group main string "compile-time configured"
14843.cindex "gid (group id)" "Exim's own"
14844.cindex "Exim group"
14845This option changes the gid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
14846privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. The value of this
14847option is used only when &%exim_user%& is also set. Unless it consists entirely
14848of digits, the string is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&, and failure causes a
14849configuration error. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of
14850security issues.
14851
14852
14853.option exim_path main string "see below"
14854.cindex "Exim binary, path name"
14855This option specifies the path name of the Exim binary, which is used when Exim
14856needs to re-exec itself. The default is set up to point to the file &'exim'& in
14857the directory configured at compile time by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting. It
14858is necessary to change &%exim_path%& if, exceptionally, Exim is run from some
14859other place.
14860&*Warning*&: Do not use a macro to define the value of this option, because
14861you will break those Exim utilities that scan the configuration file to find
14862where the binary is. (They then use the &%-bP%& option to extract option
14863settings such as the value of &%spool_directory%&.)
14864
14865
14866.option exim_user main string "compile-time configured"
14867.cindex "uid (user id)" "Exim's own"
14868.cindex "Exim user"
14869This option changes the uid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
14870privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. Ownership of the run
14871time configuration file and the use of the &%-C%& and &%-D%& command line
14872options is checked against the values in the binary, not what is set here.
14873
14874Unless it consists entirely of digits, the string is looked up using
14875&[getpwnam()]&, and failure causes a configuration error. If &%exim_group%& is
14876not also supplied, the gid is taken from the result of &[getpwnam()]& if it is
14877used. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of security issues.
14878
14879
14880.option extra_local_interfaces main "string list" unset
14881This option defines network interfaces that are to be considered local when
14882routing, but which are not used for listening by the daemon. See section
14883&<<SECTreclocipadd>>& for details.
14884
14885
14886. Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
14887. for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
14888
14889.option "extract_addresses_remove_arguments" main boolean true &&&
14890 extract_addresses_remove_arguments
14891.oindex "&%-t%&"
14892.cindex "command line" "addresses with &%-t%&"
14893.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
14894According to some Sendmail documentation (Sun, IRIX, HP-UX), if any addresses
14895are present on the command line when the &%-t%& option is used to build an
14896envelope from a message's &'To:'&, &'Cc:'& and &'Bcc:'& headers, the command
14897line addresses are removed from the recipients list. This is also how Smail
14898behaves. However, other Sendmail documentation (the O'Reilly book) states that
14899command line addresses are added to those obtained from the header lines. When
14900&%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& is true (the default), Exim subtracts
14901argument headers. If it is set false, Exim adds rather than removes argument
14902addresses.
14903
14904
14905.option finduser_retries main integer 0
14906.cindex "NIS, retrying user lookups"
14907On systems running NIS or other schemes in which user and group information is
14908distributed from a remote system, there can be times when &[getpwnam()]& and
14909related functions fail, even when given valid data, because things time out.
14910Unfortunately these failures cannot be distinguished from genuine &"not found"&
14911errors. If &%finduser_retries%& is set greater than zero, Exim will try that
14912many extra times to find a user or a group, waiting for one second between
14913retries.
14914
14915.cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&" "multiple reading of"
14916You should not set this option greater than zero if your user information is in
14917a traditional &_/etc/passwd_& file, because it will cause Exim needlessly to
14918search the file multiple times for non-existent users, and also cause delay.
14919
14920
14921
14922.option freeze_tell main "string list, comma separated" unset
14923.cindex "freezing messages" "sending a message when freezing"
14924On encountering certain errors, or when configured to do so in a system filter,
14925ACL, or special router, Exim freezes a message. This means that no further
14926delivery attempts take place until an administrator thaws the message, or the
14927&%auto_thaw%&, &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&, or &%timeout_frozen_after%&
14928feature cause it to be processed. If &%freeze_tell%& is set, Exim generates a
14929warning message whenever it freezes something, unless the message it is
14930freezing is a locally-generated bounce message. (Without this exception there
14931is the possibility of looping.) The warning message is sent to the addresses
14932supplied as the comma-separated value of this option. If several of the
14933message's addresses cause freezing, only a single message is sent. If the
14934freezing was automatic, the reason(s) for freezing can be found in the message
14935log. If you configure freezing in a filter or ACL, you must arrange for any
14936logging that you require.
14937
14938
14939.option gecos_name main string&!! unset
14940.cindex "HP-UX"
14941.cindex "&""gecos""& field, parsing"
14942Some operating systems, notably HP-UX, use the &"gecos"& field in the system
14943password file to hold other information in addition to users' real names. Exim
14944looks up this field for use when it is creating &'Sender:'& or &'From:'&
14945headers. If either &%gecos_pattern%& or &%gecos_name%& are unset, the contents
14946of the field are used unchanged, except that, if an ampersand is encountered,
14947it is replaced by the user's login name with the first character forced to
14948upper case, since this is a convention that is observed on many systems.
14949
14950When these options are set, &%gecos_pattern%& is treated as a regular
14951expression that is to be applied to the field (again with && replaced by the
14952login name), and if it matches, &%gecos_name%& is expanded and used as the
14953user's name.
14954
14955.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%gecos_name%&"
14956Numeric variables such as &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. can be used in the expansion to
14957pick up sub-fields that were matched by the pattern. In HP-UX, where the user's
14958name terminates at the first comma, the following can be used:
14959.code
14960gecos_pattern = ([^,]*)
14961gecos_name = $1
14962.endd
14963
14964.option gecos_pattern main string unset
14965See &%gecos_name%& above.
14966
14967
14968.option gnutls_compat_mode main boolean unset
14969This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
14970server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
14971implementations of TLS.
14972
14973
14974option gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11 main boolean unset
14975This option will let GnuTLS (2.12.0 or later) autoload PKCS11 modules with
14976the p11-kit configuration files in &_/etc/pkcs11/modules/_&.
14977
14978See
14979&url(http://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Smart-cards-and-HSMs)
14980for documentation.
14981
14982
14983
14984.option headers_charset main string "see below"
14985This option sets a default character set for translating from encoded MIME
14986&"words"& in header lines, when referenced by an &$h_xxx$& expansion item. The
14987default is the value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The
14988ultimate default is ISO-8859-1. For more details see the description of header
14989insertions in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
14990
14991
14992
14993.option header_maxsize main integer "see below"
14994.cindex "header section" "maximum size of"
14995.cindex "limit" "size of message header section"
14996This option controls the overall maximum size of a message's header
14997section. The default is the value of HEADER_MAXSIZE in
14998&_Local/Makefile_&; the default for that is 1M. Messages with larger header
14999sections are rejected.
15000
15001
15002.option header_line_maxsize main integer 0
15003.cindex "header lines" "maximum size of"
15004.cindex "limit" "size of one header line"
15005This option limits the length of any individual header line in a message, after
15006all the continuations have been joined together. Messages with individual
15007header lines that are longer than the limit are rejected. The default value of
15008zero means &"no limit"&.
15009
15010
15011
15012
15013.option helo_accept_junk_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15014.cindex "HELO" "accepting junk data"
15015.cindex "EHLO" "accepting junk data"
15016Exim checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands for incoming SMTP
15017mail, and gives an error response for invalid data. Unfortunately, there are
15018some SMTP clients that send syntactic junk. They can be accommodated by setting
15019this option. Note that this is a syntax check only. See &%helo_verify_hosts%&
15020if you want to do semantic checking.
15021See also &%helo_allow_chars%& for a way of extending the permitted character
15022set.
15023
15024
15025.option helo_allow_chars main string unset
15026.cindex "HELO" "underscores in"
15027.cindex "EHLO" "underscores in"
15028.cindex "underscore in EHLO/HELO"
15029This option can be set to a string of rogue characters that are permitted in
15030all EHLO and HELO names in addition to the standard letters, digits,
15031hyphens, and dots. If you really must allow underscores, you can set
15032.code
15033helo_allow_chars = _
15034.endd
15035Note that the value is one string, not a list.
15036
15037
15038.option helo_lookup_domains main "domain list&!!" &`@:@[]`&
15039.cindex "HELO" "forcing reverse lookup"
15040.cindex "EHLO" "forcing reverse lookup"
15041If the domain given by a client in a HELO or EHLO command matches this
15042list, a reverse lookup is done in order to establish the host's true name. The
15043default forces a lookup if the client host gives the server's name or any of
15044its IP addresses (in brackets), something that broken clients have been seen to
15045do.
15046
15047
15048.option helo_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15049.cindex "HELO verifying" "optional"
15050.cindex "EHLO" "verifying, optional"
15051By default, Exim just checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands (see
15052&%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& and &%helo_allow_chars%&). However, some sites like
15053to do more extensive checking of the data supplied by these commands. The ACL
15054condition &`verify = helo`& is provided to make this possible.
15055Formerly, it was necessary also to set this option (&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&)
15056to force the check to occur. From release 4.53 onwards, this is no longer
15057necessary. If the check has not been done before &`verify = helo`& is
15058encountered, it is done at that time. Consequently, this option is obsolete.
15059Its specification is retained here for backwards compatibility.
15060
15061When an EHLO or HELO command is received, if the calling host matches
15062&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, Exim checks that the host name given in the HELO or
15063EHLO command either:
15064
15065.ilist
15066is an IP literal matching the calling address of the host, or
15067.next
15068.cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
15069.cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
15070matches the host name that Exim obtains by doing a reverse lookup of the
15071calling host address, or
15072.next
15073when looked up in DNS yields the calling host address.
15074.endlist
15075
15076However, the EHLO or HELO command is not rejected if any of the checks
15077fail. Processing continues, but the result of the check is remembered, and can
15078be detected later in an ACL by the &`verify = helo`& condition.
15079
15080If DNS was used for successful verification, the variable
15081.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
15082&$helo_verify_dnssec$& records the DNSSEC status of the lookups.
15083
15084.option helo_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15085.cindex "HELO verifying" "mandatory"
15086.cindex "EHLO" "verifying, mandatory"
15087Like &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, this option is obsolete, and retained only for
15088backwards compatibility. For hosts that match this option, Exim checks the host
15089name given in the HELO or EHLO in the same way as for
15090&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&. If the check fails, the HELO or EHLO command is
15091rejected with a 550 error, and entries are written to the main and reject logs.
15092If a MAIL command is received before EHLO or HELO, it is rejected with a 503
15093error.
15094
15095.option hold_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15096.cindex "domain" "delaying delivery"
15097.cindex "delivery" "delaying certain domains"
15098This option allows mail for particular domains to be held on the queue
15099manually. The option is overridden if a message delivery is forced with the
15100&%-M%&, &%-qf%&, &%-Rf%& or &%-Sf%& options, and also while testing or
15101verifying addresses using &%-bt%& or &%-bv%&. Otherwise, if a domain matches an
15102item in &%hold_domains%&, no routing or delivery for that address is done, and
15103it is deferred every time the message is looked at.
15104
15105This option is intended as a temporary operational measure for delaying the
15106delivery of mail while some problem is being sorted out, or some new
15107configuration tested. If you just want to delay the processing of some
15108domains until a queue run occurs, you should use &%queue_domains%& or
15109&%queue_smtp_domains%&, not &%hold_domains%&.
15110
15111A setting of &%hold_domains%& does not override Exim's code for removing
15112messages from the queue if they have been there longer than the longest retry
15113time in any retry rule. If you want to hold messages for longer than the normal
15114retry times, insert a dummy retry rule with a long retry time.
15115
15116
15117.option host_lookup main "host list&!!" unset
15118.cindex "host name" "lookup, forcing"
15119Exim does not look up the name of a calling host from its IP address unless it
15120is required to compare against some host list, or the host matches
15121&%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&, or the host matches this
15122option (which normally contains IP addresses rather than host names). The
15123default configuration file contains
15124.code
15125host_lookup = *
15126.endd
15127which causes a lookup to happen for all hosts. If the expense of these lookups
15128is felt to be too great, the setting can be changed or removed.
15129
15130After a successful reverse lookup, Exim does a forward lookup on the name it
15131has obtained, to verify that it yields the IP address that it started with. If
15132this check fails, Exim behaves as if the name lookup failed.
15133
15134.vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
15135.vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
15136After any kind of failure, the host name (in &$sender_host_name$&) remains
15137unset, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to the string &"1"&. See also
15138&%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, &%helo_lookup_domains%&, and
15139&`verify = reverse_host_lookup`& in ACLs.
15140
15141
15142.option host_lookup_order main "string list" &`bydns:byaddr`&
15143This option specifies the order of different lookup methods when Exim is trying
15144to find a host name from an IP address. The default is to do a DNS lookup
15145first, and then to try a local lookup (using &[gethostbyaddr()]& or equivalent)
15146if that fails. You can change the order of these lookups, or omit one entirely,
15147if you want.
15148
15149&*Warning*&: The &"byaddr"& method does not always yield aliases when there are
15150multiple PTR records in the DNS and the IP address is not listed in
15151&_/etc/hosts_&. Different operating systems give different results in this
15152case. That is why the default tries a DNS lookup first.
15153
15154
15155
15156.option host_reject_connection main "host list&!!" unset
15157.cindex "host" "rejecting connections from"
15158If this option is set, incoming SMTP calls from the hosts listed are rejected
15159as soon as the connection is made.
15160This option is obsolete, and retained only for backward compatibility, because
15161nowadays the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& can also reject incoming
15162connections immediately.
15163
15164The ability to give an immediate rejection (either by this option or using an
15165ACL) is provided for use in unusual cases. Many hosts will just try again,
15166sometimes without much delay. Normally, it is better to use an ACL to reject
15167incoming messages at a later stage, such as after RCPT commands. See
15168chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&.
15169
15170
15171.option hosts_connection_nolog main "host list&!!" unset
15172.cindex "host" "not logging connections from"
15173This option defines a list of hosts for which connection logging does not
15174happen, even though the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is set. For example,
15175you might want not to log SMTP connections from local processes, or from
15176127.0.0.1, or from your local LAN. This option is consulted in the main loop of
15177the daemon; you should therefore strive to restrict its value to a short inline
15178list of IP addresses and networks. To disable logging SMTP connections from
15179local processes, you must create a host list with an empty item. For example:
15180.code
15181hosts_connection_nolog = :
15182.endd
15183If the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is not set, this option has no effect.
15184
15185
15186
15187.option hosts_proxy main "host list&!!" unset
15188.cindex proxy "proxy protocol"
15189This option enables use of Proxy Protocol proxies for incoming
15190connections. For details see section &<<SECTproxyInbound>>&.
15191
15192
15193.option hosts_treat_as_local main "domain list&!!" unset
15194.cindex "local host" "domains treated as"
15195.cindex "host" "treated as local"
15196If this option is set, any host names that match the domain list are treated as
15197if they were the local host when Exim is scanning host lists obtained from MX
15198records
15199or other sources. Note that the value of this option is a domain list, not a
15200host list, because it is always used to check host names, not IP addresses.
15201
15202This option also applies when Exim is matching the special items
15203&`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`& in a domain list (see
15204section &<<SECTdomainlist>>&), and when checking the &%hosts%& option in the
15205&(smtp)& transport for the local host (see the &%allow_localhost%& option in
15206that transport). See also &%local_interfaces%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&, and
15207chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&, which contains a discussion about local network
15208interfaces and recognizing the local host.
15209
15210
15211.option ibase_servers main "string list" unset
15212.cindex "InterBase" "server list"
15213This option provides a list of InterBase servers and associated connection data,
15214to be used in conjunction with &(ibase)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
15215The option is available only if Exim has been built with InterBase support.
15216
15217
15218
15219.option ignore_bounce_errors_after main time 10w
15220.cindex "bounce message" "discarding"
15221.cindex "discarding bounce message"
15222This option affects the processing of bounce messages that cannot be delivered,
15223that is, those that suffer a permanent delivery failure. (Bounce messages that
15224suffer temporary delivery failures are of course retried in the usual way.)
15225
15226After a permanent delivery failure, bounce messages are frozen,
15227because there is no sender to whom they can be returned. When a frozen bounce
15228message has been on the queue for more than the given time, it is unfrozen at
15229the next queue run, and a further delivery is attempted. If delivery fails
15230again, the bounce message is discarded. This makes it possible to keep failed
15231bounce messages around for a shorter time than the normal maximum retry time
15232for frozen messages. For example,
15233.code
15234ignore_bounce_errors_after = 12h
15235.endd
15236retries failed bounce message deliveries after 12 hours, discarding any further
15237failures. If the value of this option is set to a zero time period, bounce
15238failures are discarded immediately. Setting a very long time (as in the default
15239value) has the effect of disabling this option. For ways of automatically
15240dealing with other kinds of frozen message, see &%auto_thaw%& and
15241&%timeout_frozen_after%&.
15242
15243
15244.option ignore_fromline_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15245.cindex "&""From""& line"
15246.cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
15247Some broken SMTP clients insist on sending a UUCP-like &"From&~"& line before
15248the headers of a message. By default this is treated as the start of the
15249message's body, which means that any following headers are not recognized as
15250such. Exim can be made to ignore it by setting &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& to
15251match those hosts that insist on sending it. If the sender is actually a local
15252process rather than a remote host, and is using &%-bs%& to inject the messages,
15253&%ignore_fromline_local%& must be set to achieve this effect.
15254
15255
15256.option ignore_fromline_local main boolean false
15257See &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& above.
15258
15259.option keep_environment main "string list" unset
15260.cindex "environment" "values from"
15261This option contains a string list of environment variables to keep.
15262You have to trust these variables or you have to be sure that
15263these variables do not impose any security risk. Keep in mind that
15264during the startup phase Exim is running with an effective UID 0 in most
15265installations. As the default value is an empty list, the default
15266environment for using libraries, running embedded Perl code, or running
15267external binaries is empty, and does not not even contain PATH or HOME.
15268
15269Actually the list is interpreted as a list of patterns
15270(&<<SECTlistexpand>>&), except that it is not expanded first.
15271
15272WARNING: Macro substitution is still done first, so having a macro
15273FOO and having FOO_HOME in your &%keep_environment%& option may have
15274unexpected results. You may work around this using a regular expression
15275that does not match the macro name: ^[F]OO_HOME$.
15276
15277Current versions of Exim issue a warning during startup if you do not mention
15278&%keep_environment%& in your runtime configuration file and if your
15279current environment is not empty. Future versions may not issue that warning
15280anymore.
15281
15282See the &%add_environment%& main config option for a way to set
15283environment variables to a fixed value. The environment for &(pipe)&
15284transports is handled separately, see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for
15285details.
15286
15287
15288.option keep_malformed main time 4d
15289This option specifies the length of time to keep messages whose spool files
15290have been corrupted in some way. This should, of course, never happen. At the
15291next attempt to deliver such a message, it gets removed. The incident is
15292logged.
15293
15294
15295.option ldap_ca_cert_dir main string unset
15296.cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate directory"
15297.cindex certificate "directory for LDAP"
15298This option indicates which directory contains CA certificates for verifying
15299a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
15300While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
15301Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
15302and constrained to be a directory.
15303
15304
15305.option ldap_ca_cert_file main string unset
15306.cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate file"
15307.cindex certificate "file for LDAP"
15308This option indicates which file contains CA certificates for verifying
15309a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
15310While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
15311Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
15312and constrained to be a file.
15313
15314
15315.option ldap_cert_file main string unset
15316.cindex "LDAP" "TLS client certificate file"
15317.cindex certificate "file for LDAP"
15318This option indicates which file contains an TLS client certificate which
15319Exim should present to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
15320Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_key%&.
15321
15322
15323.option ldap_cert_key main string unset
15324.cindex "LDAP" "TLS client key file"
15325.cindex certificate "key for LDAP"
15326This option indicates which file contains the secret/private key to use
15327to prove identity to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
15328Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_file%&, which contains the
15329identity to be proven.
15330
15331
15332.option ldap_cipher_suite main string unset
15333.cindex "LDAP" "TLS cipher suite"
15334This controls the TLS cipher-suite negotiation during TLS negotiation with
15335the LDAP server. See &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& for more details of the format of
15336cipher-suite options with OpenSSL (as used by LDAP client libraries).
15337
15338
15339.option ldap_default_servers main "string list" unset
15340.cindex "LDAP" "default servers"
15341This option provides a list of LDAP servers which are tried in turn when an
15342LDAP query does not contain a server. See section &<<SECTforldaque>>& for
15343details of LDAP queries. This option is available only when Exim has been built
15344with LDAP support.
15345
15346
15347.option ldap_require_cert main string unset.
15348.cindex "LDAP" "policy for LDAP server TLS cert presentation"
15349This should be one of the values "hard", "demand", "allow", "try" or "never".
15350A value other than one of these is interpreted as "never".
15351See the entry "TLS_REQCERT" in your system man page for ldap.conf(5).
15352Although Exim does not set a default, the LDAP library probably defaults
15353to hard/demand.
15354
15355
15356.option ldap_start_tls main boolean false
15357.cindex "LDAP" "whether or not to negotiate TLS"
15358If set, Exim will attempt to negotiate TLS with the LDAP server when
15359connecting on a regular LDAP port. This is the LDAP equivalent of SMTP's
15360"STARTTLS". This is distinct from using "ldaps", which is the LDAP form
15361of SSL-on-connect.
15362In the event of failure to negotiate TLS, the action taken is controlled
15363by &%ldap_require_cert%&.
15364This option is ignored for &`ldapi`& connections.
15365
15366
15367.option ldap_version main integer unset
15368.cindex "LDAP" "protocol version, forcing"
15369This option can be used to force Exim to set a specific protocol version for
15370LDAP. If it option is unset, it is shown by the &%-bP%& command line option as
15371-1. When this is the case, the default is 3 if LDAP_VERSION3 is defined in
15372the LDAP headers; otherwise it is 2. This option is available only when Exim
15373has been built with LDAP support.
15374
15375
15376
15377.option local_from_check main boolean true
15378.cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "disabling addition of"
15379.cindex "&'From:'& header line" "disabling checking of"
15380When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
15381an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line, and
15382checks that the &'From:'& header line matches the login of the calling user and
15383the domain specified by &%qualify_domain%&.
15384
15385&*Note*&: An unqualified address (no domain) in the &'From:'& header in a
15386locally submitted message is automatically qualified by Exim, unless the
15387&%-bnq%& command line option is used.
15388
15389You can use &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& to permit affixes
15390on the local part. If the &'From:'& header line does not match, Exim adds a
15391&'Sender:'& header with an address constructed from the calling user's login
15392and the default qualify domain.
15393
15394If &%local_from_check%& is set false, the &'From:'& header check is disabled,
15395and no &'Sender:'& header is ever added. If, in addition, you want to retain
15396&'Sender:'& header lines supplied by untrusted users, you must also set
15397&%local_sender_retain%& to be true.
15398
15399.cindex "envelope sender"
15400These options affect only the header lines in the message. The envelope sender
15401is still forced to be the login id at the qualify domain unless
15402&%untrusted_set_sender%& permits the user to supply an envelope sender.
15403
15404For messages received over TCP/IP, an ACL can specify &"submission mode"& to
15405request similar header line checking. See section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&, which
15406has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
15407
15408
15409
15410
15411.option local_from_prefix main string unset
15412When Exim checks the &'From:'& header line of locally submitted messages for
15413matching the login id (see &%local_from_check%& above), it can be configured to
15414ignore certain prefixes and suffixes in the local part of the address. This is
15415done by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and/or &%local_from_suffix%& to
15416appropriate lists, in the same form as the &%local_part_prefix%& and
15417&%local_part_suffix%& router options (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). For
15418example, if
15419.code
15420local_from_prefix = *-
15421.endd
15422is set, a &'From:'& line containing
15423.code
15424From: anything-user@your.domain.example
15425.endd
15426will not cause a &'Sender:'& header to be added if &'user@your.domain.example'&
15427matches the actual sender address that is constructed from the login name and
15428qualify domain.
15429
15430
15431.option local_from_suffix main string unset
15432See &%local_from_prefix%& above.
15433
15434
15435.option local_interfaces main "string list" "see below"
15436This option controls which network interfaces are used by the daemon for
15437listening; they are also used to identify the local host when routing. Chapter
15438&<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a full description of this option and the related
15439options &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&,
15440&%hosts_treat_as_local%&, and &%tls_on_connect_ports%&. The default value for
15441&%local_interfaces%& is
15442.code
15443local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
15444.endd
15445when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is
15446.code
15447local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
15448.endd
15449
15450.option local_scan_timeout main time 5m
15451.cindex "timeout" "for &[local_scan()]& function"
15452.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "timeout"
15453This timeout applies to the &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
15454&<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). Zero means &"no timeout"&. If the timeout is exceeded,
15455the incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP
15456message. For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a
15457non-zero code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
15458
15459
15460
15461.option local_sender_retain main boolean false
15462.cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "retaining from local submission"
15463When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
15464an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line. If you
15465do not want this to happen, you must set &%local_sender_retain%&, and you must
15466also set &%local_from_check%& to be false (Exim will complain if you do not).
15467See also the ACL modifier &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&. Section
15468&<<SECTthesenhea>>& has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
15469
15470
15471
15472
15473.option localhost_number main string&!! unset
15474.cindex "host" "locally unique number for"
15475.cindex "message ids" "with multiple hosts"
15476.vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
15477Exim's message ids are normally unique only within the local host. If
15478uniqueness among a set of hosts is required, each host must set a different
15479value for the &%localhost_number%& option. The string is expanded immediately
15480after reading the configuration file (so that a number can be computed from the
15481host name, for example) and the result of the expansion must be a number in the
15482range 0&--16 (or 0&--10 on operating systems with case-insensitive file
15483systems). This is available in subsequent string expansions via the variable
15484&$localhost_number$&. When &%localhost_number is set%&, the final two
15485characters of the message id, instead of just being a fractional part of the
15486time, are computed from the time and the local host number as described in
15487section &<<SECTmessiden>>&.
15488
15489
15490
15491.option log_file_path main "string list&!!" "set at compile time"
15492.cindex "log" "file path for"
15493This option sets the path which is used to determine the names of Exim's log
15494files, or indicates that logging is to be to syslog, or both. It is expanded
15495when Exim is entered, so it can, for example, contain a reference to the host
15496name. If no specific path is set for the log files at compile or run time,
15497or if the option is unset at run time (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&)
15498they are written in a sub-directory called &_log_& in Exim's spool directory.
15499Chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& contains further details about Exim's logging, and
15500section &<<SECTwhelogwri>>& describes how the contents of &%log_file_path%& are
15501used. If this string is fixed at your installation (contains no expansion
15502variables) it is recommended that you do not set this option in the
15503configuration file, but instead supply the path using LOG_FILE_PATH in
15504&_Local/Makefile_& so that it is available to Exim for logging errors detected
15505early on &-- in particular, failure to read the configuration file.
15506
15507
15508.option log_selector main string unset
15509.cindex "log" "selectors"
15510This option can be used to reduce or increase the number of things that Exim
15511writes to its log files. Its argument is made up of names preceded by plus or
15512minus characters. For example:
15513.code
15514log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
15515.endd
15516A list of possible names and what they control is given in the chapter on
15517logging, in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&.
15518
15519
15520.option log_timezone main boolean false
15521.cindex "log" "timezone for entries"
15522.vindex "&$tod_log$&"
15523.vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
15524By default, the timestamps on log lines are in local time without the
15525timezone. This means that if your timezone changes twice a year, the timestamps
15526in log lines are ambiguous for an hour when the clocks go back. One way of
15527avoiding this problem is to set the timezone to UTC. An alternative is to set
15528&%log_timezone%& true. This turns on the addition of the timezone offset to
15529timestamps in log lines. Turning on this option can add quite a lot to the size
15530of log files because each line is extended by 6 characters. Note that the
15531&$tod_log$& variable contains the log timestamp without the zone, but there is
15532another variable called &$tod_zone$& that contains just the timezone offset.
15533
15534
15535.option lookup_open_max main integer 25
15536.cindex "too many open files"
15537.cindex "open files, too many"
15538.cindex "file" "too many open"
15539.cindex "lookup" "maximum open files"
15540.cindex "limit" "open files for lookups"
15541This option limits the number of simultaneously open files for single-key
15542lookups that use regular files (that is, &(lsearch)&, &(dbm)&, and &(cdb)&).
15543Exim normally keeps these files open during routing, because often the same
15544file is required several times. If the limit is reached, Exim closes the least
15545recently used file. Note that if you are using the &'ndbm'& library, it
15546actually opens two files for each logical DBM database, though it still counts
15547as one for the purposes of &%lookup_open_max%&. If you are getting &"too many
15548open files"& errors with NDBM, you need to reduce the value of
15549&%lookup_open_max%&.
15550
15551
15552.option max_username_length main integer 0
15553.cindex "length of login name"
15554.cindex "user name" "maximum length"
15555.cindex "limit" "user name length"
15556Some operating systems are broken in that they truncate long arguments to
15557&[getpwnam()]& to eight characters, instead of returning &"no such user"&. If
15558this option is set greater than zero, any attempt to call &[getpwnam()]& with
15559an argument that is longer behaves as if &[getpwnam()]& failed.
15560
15561
15562.option message_body_newlines main bool false
15563.cindex "message body" "newlines in variables"
15564.cindex "newline" "in message body variables"
15565.vindex "&$message_body$&"
15566.vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
15567By default, newlines in the message body are replaced by spaces when setting
15568the &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables. If this
15569option is set true, this no longer happens.
15570
15571
15572.option message_body_visible main integer 500
15573.cindex "body of message" "visible size"
15574.cindex "message body" "visible size"
15575.vindex "&$message_body$&"
15576.vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
15577This option specifies how much of a message's body is to be included in the
15578&$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables.
15579
15580
15581.option message_id_header_domain main string&!! unset
15582.cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
15583If this option is set, the string is expanded and used as the right hand side
15584(domain) of the &'Message-ID:'& header that Exim creates if a
15585locally-originated incoming message does not have one. &"Locally-originated"&
15586means &"not received over TCP/IP."&
15587Otherwise, the primary host name is used.
15588Only letters, digits, dot and hyphen are accepted; any other characters are
15589replaced by hyphens. If the expansion is forced to fail, or if the result is an
15590empty string, the option is ignored.
15591
15592
15593.option message_id_header_text main string&!! unset
15594If this variable is set, the string is expanded and used to augment the text of
15595the &'Message-id:'& header that Exim creates if a locally-originated incoming
15596message does not have one. The text of this header is required by RFC 2822 to
15597take the form of an address. By default, Exim uses its internal message id as
15598the local part, and the primary host name as the domain. If this option is set,
15599it is expanded, and provided the expansion is not forced to fail, and does not
15600yield an empty string, the result is inserted into the header immediately
15601before the @, separated from the internal message id by a dot. Any characters
15602that are illegal in an address are automatically converted into hyphens. This
15603means that variables such as &$tod_log$& can be used, because the spaces and
15604colons will become hyphens.
15605
15606
15607.option message_logs main boolean true
15608.cindex "message logs" "disabling"
15609.cindex "log" "message log; disabling"
15610If this option is turned off, per-message log files are not created in the
15611&_msglog_& spool sub-directory. This reduces the amount of disk I/O required by
15612Exim, by reducing the number of files involved in handling a message from a
15613minimum of four (header spool file, body spool file, delivery journal, and
15614per-message log) to three. The other major I/O activity is Exim's main log,
15615which is not affected by this option.
15616
15617
15618.option message_size_limit main string&!! 50M
15619.cindex "message" "size limit"
15620.cindex "limit" "message size"
15621.cindex "size" "of message, limit"
15622This option limits the maximum size of message that Exim will process. The
15623value is expanded for each incoming connection so, for example, it can be made
15624to depend on the IP address of the remote host for messages arriving via
15625TCP/IP. After expansion, the value must be a sequence of decimal digits,
15626optionally followed by K or M.
15627
15628&*Note*&: This limit cannot be made to depend on a message's sender or any
15629other properties of an individual message, because it has to be advertised in
15630the server's response to EHLO. String expansion failure causes a temporary
15631error. A value of zero means no limit, but its use is not recommended. See also
15632&%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
15633
15634Incoming SMTP messages are failed with a 552 error if the limit is
15635exceeded; locally-generated messages either get a stderr message or a delivery
15636failure message to the sender, depending on the &%-oe%& setting. Rejection of
15637an oversized message is logged in both the main and the reject logs. See also
15638the generic transport option &%message_size_limit%&, which limits the size of
15639message that an individual transport can process.
15640
15641If you use a virus-scanner and set this option to to a value larger than the
15642maximum size that your virus-scanner is configured to support, you may get
15643failures triggered by large mails. The right size to configure for the
15644virus-scanner depends upon what data is passed and the options in use but it's
15645probably safest to just set it to a little larger than this value. E.g., with a
15646default Exim message size of 50M and a default ClamAV StreamMaxLength of 10M,
15647some problems may result.
15648
15649A value of 0 will disable size limit checking; Exim will still advertise the
15650SIZE extension in an EHLO response, but without a limit, so as to permit
15651SMTP clients to still indicate the message size along with the MAIL verb.
15652
15653
15654.option move_frozen_messages main boolean false
15655.cindex "frozen messages" "moving"
15656This option, which is available only if Exim has been built with the setting
15657.code
15658SUPPORT_MOVE_FROZEN_MESSAGES=yes
15659.endd
15660in &_Local/Makefile_&, causes frozen messages and their message logs to be
15661moved from the &_input_& and &_msglog_& directories on the spool to &_Finput_&
15662and &_Fmsglog_&, respectively. There is currently no support in Exim or the
15663standard utilities for handling such moved messages, and they do not show up in
15664lists generated by &%-bp%& or by the Exim monitor.
15665
15666
15667.option mua_wrapper main boolean false
15668Setting this option true causes Exim to run in a very restrictive mode in which
15669it passes messages synchronously to a smart host. Chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&
15670contains a full description of this facility.
15671
15672
15673
15674.option mysql_servers main "string list" unset
15675.cindex "MySQL" "server list"
15676This option provides a list of MySQL servers and associated connection data, to
15677be used in conjunction with &(mysql)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&). The
15678option is available only if Exim has been built with MySQL support.
15679
15680
15681.option never_users main "string list&!!" unset
15682This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. Local
15683message deliveries are normally run in processes that are setuid to the
15684recipient, and remote deliveries are normally run under Exim's own uid and gid.
15685It is usually desirable to prevent any deliveries from running as root, as a
15686safety precaution.
15687
15688When Exim is built, an option called FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a
15689list of users that must not be used for local deliveries. This list is fixed in
15690the binary and cannot be overridden by the configuration file. By default, it
15691contains just the single user name &"root"&. The &%never_users%& runtime option
15692can be used to add more users to the fixed list.
15693
15694If a message is to be delivered as one of the users on the fixed list or the
15695&%never_users%& list, an error occurs, and delivery is deferred. A common
15696example is
15697.code
15698never_users = root:daemon:bin
15699.endd
15700Including root is redundant if it is also on the fixed list, but it does no
15701harm. This option overrides the &%pipe_as_creator%& option of the &(pipe)&
15702transport driver.
15703
15704
15705.option openssl_options main "string list" "+no_sslv2 +single_dh_use +no_ticket"
15706.cindex "OpenSSL "compatibility options"
15707This option allows an administrator to adjust the SSL options applied
15708by OpenSSL to connections. It is given as a space-separated list of items,
15709each one to be +added or -subtracted from the current value.
15710
15711This option is only available if Exim is built against OpenSSL. The values
15712available for this option vary according to the age of your OpenSSL install.
15713The &"all"& value controls a subset of flags which are available, typically
15714the bug workaround options. The &'SSL_CTX_set_options'& man page will
15715list the values known on your system and Exim should support all the
15716&"bug workaround"& options and many of the &"modifying"& options. The Exim
15717names lose the leading &"SSL_OP_"& and are lower-cased.
15718
15719Note that adjusting the options can have severe impact upon the security of
15720SSL as used by Exim. It is possible to disable safety checks and shoot
15721yourself in the foot in various unpleasant ways. This option should not be
15722adjusted lightly. An unrecognised item will be detected at startup, by
15723invoking Exim with the &%-bV%& flag.
15724
15725The option affects Exim operating both as a server and as a client.
15726
15727Historical note: prior to release 4.80, Exim defaulted this value to
15728"+dont_insert_empty_fragments", which may still be needed for compatibility
15729with some clients, but which lowers security by increasing exposure to
15730some now infamous attacks.
15731
15732Examples:
15733.code
15734# Make both old MS and old Eudora happy:
15735openssl_options = -all +microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer \
15736 +dont_insert_empty_fragments
15737
15738# Disable older protocol versions:
15739openssl_options = +no_sslv2 +no_sslv3
15740.endd
15741
15742Possible options may include:
15743.ilist
15744&`all`&
15745.next
15746&`allow_unsafe_legacy_renegotiation`&
15747.next
15748&`cipher_server_preference`&
15749.next
15750&`dont_insert_empty_fragments`&
15751.next
15752&`ephemeral_rsa`&
15753.next
15754&`legacy_server_connect`&
15755.next
15756&`microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer`&
15757.next
15758&`microsoft_sess_id_bug`&
15759.next
15760&`msie_sslv2_rsa_padding`&
15761.next
15762&`netscape_challenge_bug`&
15763.next
15764&`netscape_reuse_cipher_change_bug`&
15765.next
15766&`no_compression`&
15767.next
15768&`no_session_resumption_on_renegotiation`&
15769.next
15770&`no_sslv2`&
15771.next
15772&`no_sslv3`&
15773.next
15774&`no_ticket`&
15775.next
15776&`no_tlsv1`&
15777.next
15778&`no_tlsv1_1`&
15779.next
15780&`no_tlsv1_2`&
15781.next
15782&`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`&
15783.next
15784&`single_dh_use`&
15785.next
15786&`single_ecdh_use`&
15787.next
15788&`ssleay_080_client_dh_bug`&
15789.next
15790&`sslref2_reuse_cert_type_bug`&
15791.next
15792&`tls_block_padding_bug`&
15793.next
15794&`tls_d5_bug`&
15795.next
15796&`tls_rollback_bug`&
15797.endlist
15798
15799As an aside, the &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`& item is a misnomer and affects
15800all clients connecting using the MacOS SecureTransport TLS facility prior
15801to MacOS 10.8.4, including email clients. If you see old MacOS clients failing
15802to negotiate TLS then this option value might help, provided that your OpenSSL
15803release is new enough to contain this work-around. This may be a situation
15804where you have to upgrade OpenSSL to get buggy clients working.
15805
15806
15807.option oracle_servers main "string list" unset
15808.cindex "Oracle" "server list"
15809This option provides a list of Oracle servers and associated connection data,
15810to be used in conjunction with &(oracle)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
15811The option is available only if Exim has been built with Oracle support.
15812
15813
15814.option percent_hack_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15815.cindex "&""percent hack""&"
15816.cindex "source routing" "in email address"
15817.cindex "address" "source-routed"
15818The &"percent hack"& is the convention whereby a local part containing a
15819percent sign is re-interpreted as a new email address, with the percent
15820replaced by @. This is sometimes called &"source routing"&, though that term is
15821also applied to RFC 2822 addresses that begin with an @ character. If this
15822option is set, Exim implements the percent facility for those domains listed,
15823but no others. This happens before an incoming SMTP address is tested against
15824an ACL.
15825
15826&*Warning*&: The &"percent hack"& has often been abused by people who are
15827trying to get round relaying restrictions. For this reason, it is best avoided
15828if at all possible. Unfortunately, a number of less security-conscious MTAs
15829implement it unconditionally. If you are running Exim on a gateway host, and
15830routing mail through to internal MTAs without processing the local parts, it is
15831a good idea to reject recipient addresses with percent characters in their
15832local parts. Exim's default configuration does this.
15833
15834
15835.option perl_at_start main boolean false
15836.cindex "Perl"
15837This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
15838interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
15839
15840
15841.option perl_startup main string unset
15842.cindex "Perl"
15843This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
15844interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
15845
15846.option perl_startup main boolean false
15847.cindex "Perl"
15848This Option enables the taint mode of the embedded Perl interpreter.
15849
15850
15851.option pgsql_servers main "string list" unset
15852.cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type" "server list"
15853This option provides a list of PostgreSQL servers and associated connection
15854data, to be used in conjunction with &(pgsql)& lookups (see section
15855&<<SECID72>>&). The option is available only if Exim has been built with
15856PostgreSQL support.
15857
15858
15859.option pid_file_path main string&!! "set at compile time"
15860.cindex "daemon" "pid file path"
15861.cindex "pid file, path for"
15862This option sets the name of the file to which the Exim daemon writes its
15863process id. The string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, references
15864to the host name:
15865.code
15866pid_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim.pid
15867.endd
15868If no path is set, the pid is written to the file &_exim-daemon.pid_& in Exim's
15869spool directory.
15870The value set by the option can be overridden by the &%-oP%& command line
15871option. A pid file is not written if a &"non-standard"& daemon is run by means
15872of the &%-oX%& option, unless a path is explicitly supplied by &%-oP%&.
15873
15874
15875.option pipelining_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
15876.cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
15877This option can be used to suppress the advertisement of the SMTP
15878PIPELINING extension to specific hosts. See also the &*no_pipelining*&
15879control in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. When PIPELINING is not advertised and
15880&%smtp_enforce_sync%& is true, an Exim server enforces strict synchronization
15881for each SMTP command and response. When PIPELINING is advertised, Exim assumes
15882that clients will use it; &"out of order"& commands that are &"expected"& do
15883not count as protocol errors (see &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%&).
15884
15885
15886.option prdr_enable main boolean false
15887.cindex "PRDR" "enabling on server"
15888This option can be used to enable the Per-Recipient Data Response extension
15889to SMTP, defined by Eric Hall.
15890If the option is set, PRDR is advertised by Exim when operating as a server.
15891If the client requests PRDR, and more than one recipient, for a message
15892an additional ACL is called for each recipient after the message content
15893is received. See section &<<SECTPRDRACL>>&.
15894
15895.option preserve_message_logs main boolean false
15896.cindex "message logs" "preserving"
15897If this option is set, message log files are not deleted when messages are
15898completed. Instead, they are moved to a sub-directory of the spool directory
15899called &_msglog.OLD_&, where they remain available for statistical or debugging
15900purposes. This is a dangerous option to set on systems with any appreciable
15901volume of mail. Use with care!
15902
15903
15904.option primary_hostname main string "see below"
15905.cindex "name" "of local host"
15906.cindex "host" "name of local"
15907.cindex "local host" "name of"
15908.vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
15909This specifies the name of the current host. It is used in the default EHLO or
15910HELO command for outgoing SMTP messages (changeable via the &%helo_data%&
15911option in the &(smtp)& transport), and as the default for &%qualify_domain%&.
15912The value is also used by default in some SMTP response messages from an Exim
15913server. This can be changed dynamically by setting &%smtp_active_hostname%&.
15914
15915If &%primary_hostname%& is not set, Exim calls &[uname()]& to find the host
15916name. If this fails, Exim panics and dies. If the name returned by &[uname()]&
15917contains only one component, Exim passes it to &[gethostbyname()]& (or
15918&[getipnodebyname()]& when available) in order to obtain the fully qualified
15919version. The variable &$primary_hostname$& contains the host name, whether set
15920explicitly by this option, or defaulted.
15921
15922
15923.option print_topbitchars main boolean false
15924.cindex "printing characters"
15925.cindex "8-bit characters"
15926By default, Exim considers only those characters whose codes lie in the range
1592732&--126 to be printing characters. In a number of circumstances (for example,
15928when writing log entries) non-printing characters are converted into escape
15929sequences, primarily to avoid messing up the layout. If &%print_topbitchars%&
15930is set, code values of 128 and above are also considered to be printing
15931characters.
15932
15933This option also affects the header syntax checks performed by the
15934&(autoreply)& transport, and whether Exim uses RFC 2047 encoding of
15935the user's full name when constructing From: and Sender: addresses (as
15936described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&). Setting this option can cause
15937Exim to generate eight bit message headers that do not conform to the
15938standards.
15939
15940
15941.option process_log_path main string unset
15942.cindex "process log path"
15943.cindex "log" "process log"
15944.cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
15945This option sets the name of the file to which an Exim process writes its
15946&"process log"& when sent a USR1 signal. This is used by the &'exiwhat'&
15947utility script. If this option is unset, the file called &_exim-process.info_&
15948in Exim's spool directory is used. The ability to specify the name explicitly
15949can be useful in environments where two different Exims are running, using
15950different spool directories.
15951
15952
15953.option prod_requires_admin main boolean true
15954.cindex "restricting access to features"
15955.oindex "&%-M%&"
15956.oindex "&%-R%&"
15957.oindex "&%-q%&"
15958The &%-M%&, &%-R%&, and &%-q%& command-line options require the caller to be an
15959admin user unless &%prod_requires_admin%& is set false. See also
15960&%queue_list_requires_admin%& and &%commandline_checks_require_admin%&.
15961
15962
15963.option qualify_domain main string "see below"
15964.cindex "domain" "for qualifying addresses"
15965.cindex "address" "qualification"
15966This option specifies the domain name that is added to any envelope sender
15967addresses that do not have a domain qualification. It also applies to
15968recipient addresses if &%qualify_recipient%& is not set. Unqualified addresses
15969are accepted by default only for locally-generated messages. Qualification is
15970also applied to addresses in header lines such as &'From:'& and &'To:'& for
15971locally-generated messages, unless the &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
15972
15973Messages from external sources must always contain fully qualified addresses,
15974unless the sending host matches &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or
15975&%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& (as appropriate), in which case incoming
15976addresses are qualified with &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%& as
15977necessary. Internally, Exim always works with fully qualified envelope
15978addresses. If &%qualify_domain%& is not set, it defaults to the
15979&%primary_hostname%& value.
15980
15981
15982.option qualify_recipient main string "see below"
15983This option allows you to specify a different domain for qualifying recipient
15984addresses to the one that is used for senders. See &%qualify_domain%& above.
15985
15986
15987
15988.option queue_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15989.cindex "domain" "specifying non-immediate delivery"
15990.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15991.cindex "message" "queueing certain domains"
15992This option lists domains for which immediate delivery is not required.
15993A delivery process is started whenever a message is received, but only those
15994domains that do not match are processed. All other deliveries wait until the
15995next queue run. See also &%hold_domains%& and &%queue_smtp_domains%&.
15996
15997
15998.option queue_list_requires_admin main boolean true
15999.cindex "restricting access to features"
16000.oindex "&%-bp%&"
16001The &%-bp%& command-line option, which lists the messages that are on the
16002queue, requires the caller to be an admin user unless
16003&%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
16004See also &%prod_requires_admin%& and &%commandline_checks_require_admin%&.
16005
16006
16007.option queue_only main boolean false
16008.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16009.cindex "message" "queueing unconditionally"
16010If &%queue_only%& is set, a delivery process is not automatically started
16011whenever a message is received. Instead, the message waits on the queue for the
16012next queue run. Even if &%queue_only%& is false, incoming messages may not get
16013delivered immediately when certain conditions (such as heavy load) occur.
16014
16015The &%-odq%& command line has the same effect as &%queue_only%&. The &%-odb%&
16016and &%-odi%& command line options override &%queue_only%& unless
16017&%queue_only_override%& is set false. See also &%queue_only_file%&,
16018&%queue_only_load%&, and &%smtp_accept_queue%&.
16019
16020
16021.option queue_only_file main string unset
16022.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16023.cindex "message" "queueing by file existence"
16024This option can be set to a colon-separated list of absolute path names, each
16025one optionally preceded by &"smtp"&. When Exim is receiving a message,
16026it tests for the existence of each listed path using a call to &[stat()]&. For
16027each path that exists, the corresponding queueing option is set.
16028For paths with no prefix, &%queue_only%& is set; for paths prefixed by
16029&"smtp"&, &%queue_smtp_domains%& is set to match all domains. So, for example,
16030.code
16031queue_only_file = smtp/some/file
16032.endd
16033causes Exim to behave as if &%queue_smtp_domains%& were set to &"*"& whenever
16034&_/some/file_& exists.
16035
16036
16037.option queue_only_load main fixed-point unset
16038.cindex "load average"
16039.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16040.cindex "message" "queueing by load"
16041If the system load average is higher than this value, incoming messages from
16042all sources are queued, and no automatic deliveries are started. If this
16043happens during local or remote SMTP input, all subsequent messages received on
16044the same SMTP connection are queued by default, whatever happens to the load in
16045the meantime, but this can be changed by setting &%queue_only_load_latch%&
16046false.
16047
16048Deliveries will subsequently be performed by queue runner processes. This
16049option has no effect on ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot
16050determine the load average. See also &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and
16051&%smtp_load_reserve%&.
16052
16053
16054.option queue_only_load_latch main boolean true
16055.cindex "load average" "re-evaluating per message"
16056When this option is true (the default), once one message has been queued
16057because the load average is higher than the value set by &%queue_only_load%&,
16058all subsequent messages received on the same SMTP connection are also queued.
16059This is a deliberate choice; even though the load average may fall below the
16060threshold, it doesn't seem right to deliver later messages on the same
16061connection when not delivering earlier ones. However, there are special
16062circumstances such as very long-lived connections from scanning appliances
16063where this is not the best strategy. In such cases, &%queue_only_load_latch%&
16064should be set false. This causes the value of the load average to be
16065re-evaluated for each message.
16066
16067
16068.option queue_only_override main boolean true
16069.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16070When this option is true, the &%-od%&&'x'& command line options override the
16071setting of &%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%& in the configuration file. If
16072&%queue_only_override%& is set false, the &%-od%&&'x'& options cannot be used
16073to override; they are accepted, but ignored.
16074
16075
16076.option queue_run_in_order main boolean false
16077.cindex "queue runner" "processing messages in order"
16078If this option is set, queue runs happen in order of message arrival instead of
16079in an arbitrary order. For this to happen, a complete list of the entire queue
16080must be set up before the deliveries start. When the queue is all held in a
16081single directory (the default), a single list is created for both the ordered
16082and the non-ordered cases. However, if &%split_spool_directory%& is set, a
16083single list is not created when &%queue_run_in_order%& is false. In this case,
16084the sub-directories are processed one at a time (in a random order), and this
16085avoids setting up one huge list for the whole queue. Thus, setting
16086&%queue_run_in_order%& with &%split_spool_directory%& may degrade performance
16087when the queue is large, because of the extra work in setting up the single,
16088large list. In most situations, &%queue_run_in_order%& should not be set.
16089
16090
16091
16092.option queue_run_max main integer&!! 5
16093.cindex "queue runner" "maximum number of"
16094This controls the maximum number of queue runner processes that an Exim daemon
16095can run simultaneously. This does not mean that it starts them all at once,
16096but rather that if the maximum number are still running when the time comes to
16097start another one, it refrains from starting another one. This can happen with
16098very large queues and/or very sluggish deliveries. This option does not,
16099however, interlock with other processes, so additional queue runners can be
16100started by other means, or by killing and restarting the daemon.
16101
16102Setting this option to zero does not suppress queue runs; rather, it disables
16103the limit, allowing any number of simultaneous queue runner processes to be
16104run. If you do not want queue runs to occur, omit the &%-q%&&'xx'& setting on
16105the daemon's command line.
16106
16107.cindex queues named
16108.cindex "named queues"
16109To set limits for different named queues use
16110an expansion depending on the &$queue_name$& variable.
16111
16112.option queue_smtp_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16113.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16114.cindex "message" "queueing remote deliveries"
16115When this option is set, a delivery process is started whenever a message is
16116received, routing is performed, and local deliveries take place.
16117However, if any SMTP deliveries are required for domains that match
16118&%queue_smtp_domains%&, they are not immediately delivered, but instead the
16119message waits on the queue for the next queue run. Since routing of the message
16120has taken place, Exim knows to which remote hosts it must be delivered, and so
16121when the queue run happens, multiple messages for the same host are delivered
16122over a single SMTP connection. The &%-odqs%& command line option causes all
16123SMTP deliveries to be queued in this way, and is equivalent to setting
16124&%queue_smtp_domains%& to &"*"&. See also &%hold_domains%& and
16125&%queue_domains%&.
16126
16127
16128.option receive_timeout main time 0s
16129.cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
16130This option sets the timeout for accepting a non-SMTP message, that is, the
16131maximum time that Exim waits when reading a message on the standard input. If
16132the value is zero, it will wait for ever. This setting is overridden by the
16133&%-or%& command line option. The timeout for incoming SMTP messages is
16134controlled by &%smtp_receive_timeout%&.
16135
16136.option received_header_text main string&!! "see below"
16137.cindex "customizing" "&'Received:'& header"
16138.cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "customizing"
16139This string defines the contents of the &'Received:'& message header that is
16140added to each message, except for the timestamp, which is automatically added
16141on at the end (preceded by a semicolon). The string is expanded each time it is
16142used. If the expansion yields an empty string, no &'Received:'& header line is
16143added to the message. Otherwise, the string should start with the text
16144&"Received:"& and conform to the RFC 2822 specification for &'Received:'&
16145header lines. The default setting is:
16146
16147.code
16148received_header_text = Received: \
16149 ${if def:sender_rcvhost {from $sender_rcvhost\n\t}\
16150 {${if def:sender_ident \
16151 {from ${quote_local_part:$sender_ident} }}\
16152 ${if def:sender_helo_name {(helo=$sender_helo_name)\n\t}}}}\
16153 by $primary_hostname \
16154 ${if def:received_protocol {with $received_protocol}} \
16155 ${if def:tls_in_cipher {($tls_in_cipher)\n\t}}\
16156 (Exim $version_number)\n\t\
16157 ${if def:sender_address \
16158 {(envelope-from <$sender_address>)\n\t}}\
16159 id $message_exim_id\
16160 ${if def:received_for {\n\tfor $received_for}}
16161.endd
16162
16163The reference to the TLS cipher is omitted when Exim is built without TLS
16164support. The use of conditional expansions ensures that this works for both
16165locally generated messages and messages received from remote hosts, giving
16166header lines such as the following:
16167.code
16168Received: from scrooge.carol.example ([192.168.12.25] ident=root)
16169by marley.carol.example with esmtp (Exim 4.00)
16170(envelope-from <bob@carol.example>)
16171id 16IOWa-00019l-00
16172for chas@dickens.example; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:44 +0000
16173Received: by scrooge.carol.example with local (Exim 4.00)
16174id 16IOWW-000083-00; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:41 +0000
16175.endd
16176Until the body of the message has been received, the timestamp is the time when
16177the message started to be received. Once the body has arrived, and all policy
16178checks have taken place, the timestamp is updated to the time at which the
16179message was accepted.
16180
16181
16182.option received_headers_max main integer 30
16183.cindex "loop" "prevention"
16184.cindex "mail loop prevention"
16185.cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "counting"
16186When a message is to be delivered, the number of &'Received:'& headers is
16187counted, and if it is greater than this parameter, a mail loop is assumed to
16188have occurred, the delivery is abandoned, and an error message is generated.
16189This applies to both local and remote deliveries.
16190
16191
16192.option recipient_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16193.cindex "unqualified addresses"
16194.cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
16195This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
16196recipient addresses in message envelopes. The addresses are made fully
16197qualified by the addition of the &%qualify_recipient%& value. This option also
16198affects message header lines. Exim does not reject unqualified recipient
16199addresses in headers, but it qualifies them only if the message came from a
16200host that matches &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
16201or if the message was submitted locally (not using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%&
16202option was not set.
16203
16204
16205.option recipients_max main integer 0
16206.cindex "limit" "number of recipients"
16207.cindex "recipient" "maximum number"
16208If this option is set greater than zero, it specifies the maximum number of
16209original recipients for any message. Additional recipients that are generated
16210by aliasing or forwarding do not count. SMTP messages get a 452 response for
16211all recipients over the limit; earlier recipients are delivered as normal.
16212Non-SMTP messages with too many recipients are failed, and no deliveries are
16213done.
16214
16215.cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of incoming"
16216&*Note*&: The RFCs specify that an SMTP server should accept at least 100
16217RCPT commands in a single message.
16218
16219
16220.option recipients_max_reject main boolean false
16221If this option is set true, Exim rejects SMTP messages containing too many
16222recipients by giving 552 errors to the surplus RCPT commands, and a 554
16223error to the eventual DATA command. Otherwise (the default) it gives a 452
16224error to the surplus RCPT commands and accepts the message on behalf of the
16225initial set of recipients. The remote server should then re-send the message
16226for the remaining recipients at a later time.
16227
16228
16229.option remote_max_parallel main integer 2
16230.cindex "delivery" "parallelism for remote"
16231This option controls parallel delivery of one message to a number of remote
16232hosts. If the value is less than 2, parallel delivery is disabled, and Exim
16233does all the remote deliveries for a message one by one. Otherwise, if a single
16234message has to be delivered to more than one remote host, or if several copies
16235have to be sent to the same remote host, up to &%remote_max_parallel%&
16236deliveries are done simultaneously. If more than &%remote_max_parallel%&
16237deliveries are required, the maximum number of processes are started, and as
16238each one finishes, another is begun. The order of starting processes is the
16239same as if sequential delivery were being done, and can be controlled by the
16240&%remote_sort_domains%& option. If parallel delivery takes place while running
16241with debugging turned on, the debugging output from each delivery process is
16242tagged with its process id.
16243
16244This option controls only the maximum number of parallel deliveries for one
16245message in one Exim delivery process. Because Exim has no central queue
16246manager, there is no way of controlling the total number of simultaneous
16247deliveries if the configuration allows a delivery attempt as soon as a message
16248is received.
16249
16250.cindex "number of deliveries"
16251.cindex "delivery" "maximum number of"
16252If you want to control the total number of deliveries on the system, you
16253need to set the &%queue_only%& option. This ensures that all incoming messages
16254are added to the queue without starting a delivery process. Then set up an Exim
16255daemon to start queue runner processes at appropriate intervals (probably
16256fairly often, for example, every minute), and limit the total number of queue
16257runners by setting the &%queue_run_max%& parameter. Because each queue runner
16258delivers only one message at a time, the maximum number of deliveries that can
16259then take place at once is &%queue_run_max%& multiplied by
16260&%remote_max_parallel%&.
16261
16262If it is purely remote deliveries you want to control, use
16263&%queue_smtp_domains%& instead of &%queue_only%&. This has the added benefit of
16264doing the SMTP routing before queueing, so that several messages for the same
16265host will eventually get delivered down the same connection.
16266
16267
16268.option remote_sort_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16269.cindex "sorting remote deliveries"
16270.cindex "delivery" "sorting remote"
16271When there are a number of remote deliveries for a message, they are sorted by
16272domain into the order given by this list. For example,
16273.code
16274remote_sort_domains = *.cam.ac.uk:*.uk
16275.endd
16276would attempt to deliver to all addresses in the &'cam.ac.uk'& domain first,
16277then to those in the &%uk%& domain, then to any others.
16278
16279
16280.option retry_data_expire main time 7d
16281.cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
16282This option sets a &"use before"& time on retry information in Exim's hints
16283database. Any older retry data is ignored. This means that, for example, once a
16284host has not been tried for 7 days, Exim behaves as if it has no knowledge of
16285past failures.
16286
16287
16288.option retry_interval_max main time 24h
16289.cindex "retry" "limit on interval"
16290.cindex "limit" "on retry interval"
16291Chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& describes Exim's mechanisms for controlling the
16292intervals between delivery attempts for messages that cannot be delivered
16293straight away. This option sets an overall limit to the length of time between
16294retries. It cannot be set greater than 24 hours; any attempt to do so forces
16295the default value.
16296
16297
16298.option return_path_remove main boolean true
16299.cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line" "removing"
16300RFC 2821, section 4.4, states that an SMTP server must insert a
16301&'Return-path:'& header line into a message when it makes a &"final delivery"&.
16302The &'Return-path:'& header preserves the sender address as received in the
16303MAIL command. This description implies that this header should not be present
16304in an incoming message. If &%return_path_remove%& is true, any existing
16305&'Return-path:'& headers are removed from messages at the time they are
16306received. Exim's transports have options for adding &'Return-path:'& headers at
16307the time of delivery. They are normally used only for final local deliveries.
16308
16309
16310.option return_size_limit main integer 100K
16311This option is an obsolete synonym for &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
16312
16313
16314.option rfc1413_hosts main "host list&!!" @[]
16315.cindex "RFC 1413"
16316.cindex "host" "for RFC 1413 calls"
16317RFC 1413 identification calls are made to any client host which matches
16318an item in the list.
16319The default value specifies just this host, being any local interface
16320for the system.
16321
16322.option rfc1413_query_timeout main time 0s
16323.cindex "RFC 1413" "query timeout"
16324.cindex "timeout" "for RFC 1413 call"
16325This sets the timeout on RFC 1413 identification calls. If it is set to zero,
16326no RFC 1413 calls are ever made.
16327
16328
16329.option sender_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16330.cindex "unqualified addresses"
16331.cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
16332This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
16333sender addresses. The addresses are made fully qualified by the addition of
16334&%qualify_domain%&. This option also affects message header lines. Exim does
16335not reject unqualified addresses in headers that contain sender addresses, but
16336it qualifies them only if the message came from a host that matches
16337&%sender_unqualified_hosts%&, or if the message was submitted locally (not
16338using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%& option was not set.
16339
16340.option set_environment main "string list" empty
16341.cindex "environment"
16342This option allows to set individual environment variables that the
16343currently linked libraries and programs in child processes use. The
16344default list is empty,
16345
16346
16347.option slow_lookup_log main integer 0
16348.cindex "logging" "slow lookups"
16349.cindex "dns" "logging slow lookups"
16350This option controls logging of slow lookups.
16351If the value is nonzero it is taken as a number of milliseconds
16352and lookups taking longer than this are logged.
16353Currently this applies only to DNS lookups.
16354
16355
16356
16357.option smtp_accept_keepalive main boolean true
16358.cindex "keepalive" "on incoming connection"
16359This option controls the setting of the SO_KEEPALIVE option on incoming
16360TCP/IP socket connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle
16361connections periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The
16362other end of the connection should send an acknowledgment if the connection is
16363still okay or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing
16364this is that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of
16365connection that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without
16366tidying up the TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several
16367hours to detect unreachable hosts.
16368
16369
16370
16371.option smtp_accept_max main integer 20
16372.cindex "limit" "incoming SMTP connections"
16373.cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
16374.cindex "inetd"
16375This option specifies the maximum number of simultaneous incoming SMTP calls
16376that Exim will accept. It applies only to the listening daemon; there is no
16377control (in Exim) when incoming SMTP is being handled by &'inetd'&. If the
16378value is set to zero, no limit is applied. However, it is required to be
16379non-zero if either &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& or &%smtp_accept_queue%& is
16380set. See also &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
16381
16382A new SMTP connection is immediately rejected if the &%smtp_accept_max%& limit
16383has been reached. If not, Exim first checks &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%&. If
16384that limit has not been reached for the client host, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&
16385and &%smtp_load_reserve%& are then checked before accepting the connection.
16386
16387
16388.option smtp_accept_max_nonmail main integer 10
16389.cindex "limit" "non-mail SMTP commands"
16390.cindex "SMTP" "limiting non-mail commands"
16391Exim counts the number of &"non-mail"& commands in an SMTP session, and drops
16392the connection if there are too many. This option defines &"too many"&. The
16393check catches some denial-of-service attacks, repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
16394client looping sending EHLO, for example. The check is applied only if the
16395client host matches &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&.
16396
16397When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
16398allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
16399but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
16400or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
16401starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
16402counted. The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately
16403following STARTTLS is not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than
16404MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
16405
16406
16407.option smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts main "host list&!!" *
16408You can control which hosts are subject to the &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
16409check by setting this option. The default value makes it apply to all hosts. By
16410changing the value, you can exclude any badly-behaved hosts that you have to
16411live with.
16412
16413
16414. Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
16415. for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
16416. We insert " &~&~" which is both pretty nasty visually and results in
16417. non-searchable text. HowItWorks.txt mentions an option for inserting
16418. zero-width-space, which would be nicer visually and results in (at least)
16419. html that Firefox will split on when it's forced to reflow (rather than
16420. inserting a horizontal scrollbar). However, the text is still not
16421. searchable. NM changed this occurrence for bug 1197 to no longer allow
16422. the option name to split.
16423
16424.option "smtp_accept_max_per_connection" main integer 1000 &&&
16425 smtp_accept_max_per_connection
16426.cindex "SMTP" "limiting incoming message count"
16427.cindex "limit" "messages per SMTP connection"
16428The value of this option limits the number of MAIL commands that Exim is
16429prepared to accept over a single SMTP connection, whether or not each command
16430results in the transfer of a message. After the limit is reached, a 421
16431response is given to subsequent MAIL commands. This limit is a safety
16432precaution against a client that goes mad (incidents of this type have been
16433seen).
16434
16435
16436.option smtp_accept_max_per_host main string&!! unset
16437.cindex "limit" "SMTP connections from one host"
16438.cindex "host" "limiting SMTP connections from"
16439This option restricts the number of simultaneous IP connections from a single
16440host (strictly, from a single IP address) to the Exim daemon. The option is
16441expanded, to enable different limits to be applied to different hosts by
16442reference to &$sender_host_address$&. Once the limit is reached, additional
16443connection attempts from the same host are rejected with error code 421. This
16444is entirely independent of &%smtp_accept_reserve%&. The option's default value
16445of zero imposes no limit. If this option is set greater than zero, it is
16446required that &%smtp_accept_max%& be non-zero.
16447
16448&*Warning*&: When setting this option you should not use any expansion
16449constructions that take an appreciable amount of time. The expansion and test
16450happen in the main daemon loop, in order to reject additional connections
16451without forking additional processes (otherwise a denial-of-service attack
16452could cause a vast number or processes to be created). While the daemon is
16453doing this processing, it cannot accept any other incoming connections.
16454
16455
16456
16457.option smtp_accept_queue main integer 0
16458.cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
16459.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16460.cindex "message" "queueing by SMTP connection count"
16461If the number of simultaneous incoming SMTP connections being handled via the
16462listening daemon exceeds this value, messages received by SMTP are just placed
16463on the queue; no delivery processes are started automatically. The count is
16464fixed at the start of an SMTP connection. It cannot be updated in the
16465subprocess that receives messages, and so the queueing or not queueing applies
16466to all messages received in the same connection.
16467
16468A value of zero implies no limit, and clearly any non-zero value is useful only
16469if it is less than the &%smtp_accept_max%& value (unless that is zero). See
16470also &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_load%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&, and the
16471various &%-od%&&'x'& command line options.
16472
16473
16474. See the comment on smtp_accept_max_per_connection
16475
16476.option "smtp_accept_queue_per_connection" main integer 10 &&&
16477 smtp_accept_queue_per_connection
16478.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16479.cindex "message" "queueing by message count"
16480This option limits the number of delivery processes that Exim starts
16481automatically when receiving messages via SMTP, whether via the daemon or by
16482the use of &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&. If the value of the option is greater than zero,
16483and the number of messages received in a single SMTP session exceeds this
16484number, subsequent messages are placed on the queue, but no delivery processes
16485are started. This helps to limit the number of Exim processes when a server
16486restarts after downtime and there is a lot of mail waiting for it on other
16487systems. On large systems, the default should probably be increased, and on
16488dial-in client systems it should probably be set to zero (that is, disabled).
16489
16490
16491.option smtp_accept_reserve main integer 0
16492.cindex "SMTP" "incoming call count"
16493.cindex "host" "reserved"
16494When &%smtp_accept_max%& is set greater than zero, this option specifies a
16495number of SMTP connections that are reserved for connections from the hosts
16496that are specified in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&. The value set in
16497&%smtp_accept_max%& includes this reserve pool. The specified hosts are not
16498restricted to this number of connections; the option specifies a minimum number
16499of connection slots for them, not a maximum. It is a guarantee that this group
16500of hosts can always get at least &%smtp_accept_reserve%& connections. However,
16501the limit specified by &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& is still applied to each
16502individual host.
16503
16504For example, if &%smtp_accept_max%& is set to 50 and &%smtp_accept_reserve%& is
16505set to 5, once there are 45 active connections (from any hosts), new
16506connections are accepted only from hosts listed in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&,
16507provided the other criteria for acceptance are met.
16508
16509
16510.option smtp_active_hostname main string&!! unset
16511.cindex "host" "name in SMTP responses"
16512.cindex "SMTP" "host name in responses"
16513.vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
16514This option is provided for multi-homed servers that want to masquerade as
16515several different hosts. At the start of an incoming SMTP connection, its value
16516is expanded and used instead of the value of &$primary_hostname$& in SMTP
16517responses. For example, it is used as domain name in the response to an
16518incoming HELO or EHLO command.
16519
16520.vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
16521The active hostname is placed in the &$smtp_active_hostname$& variable, which
16522is saved with any messages that are received. It is therefore available for use
16523in routers and transports when the message is later delivered.
16524
16525If this option is unset, or if its expansion is forced to fail, or if the
16526expansion results in an empty string, the value of &$primary_hostname$& is
16527used. Other expansion failures cause a message to be written to the main and
16528panic logs, and the SMTP command receives a temporary error. Typically, the
16529value of &%smtp_active_hostname%& depends on the incoming interface address.
16530For example:
16531.code
16532smtp_active_hostname = ${if eq{$received_ip_address}{10.0.0.1}\
16533 {cox.mydomain}{box.mydomain}}
16534.endd
16535
16536Although &$smtp_active_hostname$& is primarily concerned with incoming
16537messages, it is also used as the default for HELO commands in callout
16538verification if there is no remote transport from which to obtain a
16539&%helo_data%& value.
16540
16541.option smtp_banner main string&!! "see below"
16542.cindex "SMTP" "welcome banner"
16543.cindex "banner for SMTP"
16544.cindex "welcome banner for SMTP"
16545.cindex "customizing" "SMTP banner"
16546This string, which is expanded every time it is used, is output as the initial
16547positive response to an SMTP connection. The default setting is:
16548.code
16549smtp_banner = $smtp_active_hostname ESMTP Exim \
16550 $version_number $tod_full
16551.endd
16552Failure to expand the string causes a panic error. If you want to create a
16553multiline response to the initial SMTP connection, use &"\n"& in the string at
16554appropriate points, but not at the end. Note that the 220 code is not included
16555in this string. Exim adds it automatically (several times in the case of a
16556multiline response).
16557
16558
16559.option smtp_check_spool_space main boolean true
16560.cindex "checking disk space"
16561.cindex "disk space, checking"
16562.cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
16563When this option is set, if an incoming SMTP session encounters the SIZE
16564option on a MAIL command, it checks that there is enough space in the
16565spool directory's partition to accept a message of that size, while still
16566leaving free the amount specified by &%check_spool_space%& (even if that value
16567is zero). If there isn't enough space, a temporary error code is returned.
16568
16569
16570.option smtp_connect_backlog main integer 20
16571.cindex "connection backlog"
16572.cindex "SMTP" "connection backlog"
16573.cindex "backlog of connections"
16574This option specifies a maximum number of waiting SMTP connections. Exim passes
16575this value to the TCP/IP system when it sets up its listener. Once this number
16576of connections are waiting for the daemon's attention, subsequent connection
16577attempts are refused at the TCP/IP level. At least, that is what the manuals
16578say; in some circumstances such connection attempts have been observed to time
16579out instead. For large systems it is probably a good idea to increase the
16580value (to 50, say). It also gives some protection against denial-of-service
16581attacks by SYN flooding.
16582
16583
16584.option smtp_enforce_sync main boolean true
16585.cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
16586.cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
16587The SMTP protocol specification requires the client to wait for a response from
16588the server at certain points in the dialogue. Without PIPELINING these
16589synchronization points are after every command; with PIPELINING they are
16590fewer, but they still exist.
16591
16592Some spamming sites send out a complete set of SMTP commands without waiting
16593for any response. Exim protects against this by rejecting a message if the
16594client has sent further input when it should not have. The error response &"554
16595SMTP synchronization error"& is sent, and the connection is dropped. Testing
16596for this error cannot be perfect because of transmission delays (unexpected
16597input may be on its way but not yet received when Exim checks). However, it
16598does detect many instances.
16599
16600The check can be globally disabled by setting &%smtp_enforce_sync%& false.
16601If you want to disable the check selectively (for example, only for certain
16602hosts), you can do so by an appropriate use of a &%control%& modifier in an ACL
16603(see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&). See also &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
16604
16605
16606
16607.option smtp_etrn_command main string&!! unset
16608.cindex "ETRN" "command to be run"
16609.vindex "&$domain$&"
16610If this option is set, the given command is run whenever an SMTP ETRN
16611command is received from a host that is permitted to issue such commands (see
16612chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). The string is split up into separate arguments which
16613are independently expanded. The expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the
16614argument of the ETRN command, and no syntax checking is done on it. For
16615example:
16616.code
16617smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
16618 $sender_host_address
16619.endd
16620A new process is created to run the command, but Exim does not wait for it to
16621complete. Consequently, its status cannot be checked. If the command cannot be
16622run, a line is written to the panic log, but the ETRN caller still receives
16623a 250 success response. Exim is normally running under its own uid when
16624receiving SMTP, so it is not possible for it to change the uid before running
16625the command.
16626
16627
16628.option smtp_etrn_serialize main boolean true
16629.cindex "ETRN" "serializing"
16630When this option is set, it prevents the simultaneous execution of more than
16631one identical command as a result of ETRN in an SMTP connection. See
16632section &<<SECTETRN>>& for details.
16633
16634
16635.option smtp_load_reserve main fixed-point unset
16636.cindex "load average"
16637If the system load average ever gets higher than this, incoming SMTP calls are
16638accepted only from those hosts that match an entry in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&.
16639If &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& is not set, no incoming SMTP calls are accepted when
16640the load is over the limit. The option has no effect on ancient operating
16641systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average. See also
16642&%deliver_queue_load_max%& and &%queue_only_load%&.
16643
16644
16645
16646.option smtp_max_synprot_errors main integer 3
16647.cindex "SMTP" "limiting syntax and protocol errors"
16648.cindex "limit" "SMTP syntax and protocol errors"
16649Exim rejects SMTP commands that contain syntax or protocol errors. In
16650particular, a syntactically invalid email address, as in this command:
16651.code
16652RCPT TO:<abc xyz@a.b.c>
16653.endd
16654causes immediate rejection of the command, before any other tests are done.
16655(The ACL cannot be run if there is no valid address to set up for it.) An
16656example of a protocol error is receiving RCPT before MAIL. If there are
16657too many syntax or protocol errors in one SMTP session, the connection is
16658dropped. The limit is set by this option.
16659
16660.cindex "PIPELINING" "expected errors"
16661When the PIPELINING extension to SMTP is in use, some protocol errors are
16662&"expected"&, for instance, a RCPT command after a rejected MAIL command.
16663Exim assumes that PIPELINING will be used if it advertises it (see
16664&%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&), and in this situation, &"expected"& errors do
16665not count towards the limit.
16666
16667
16668
16669.option smtp_max_unknown_commands main integer 3
16670.cindex "SMTP" "limiting unknown commands"
16671.cindex "limit" "unknown SMTP commands"
16672If there are too many unrecognized commands in an incoming SMTP session, an
16673Exim server drops the connection. This is a defence against some kinds of abuse
16674that subvert web
16675clients
16676into making connections to SMTP ports; in these circumstances, a number of
16677non-SMTP command lines are sent first.
16678
16679
16680
16681.option smtp_ratelimit_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16682.cindex "SMTP" "rate limiting"
16683.cindex "limit" "rate of message arrival"
16684.cindex "RCPT" "rate limiting"
16685Some sites find it helpful to be able to limit the rate at which certain hosts
16686can send them messages, and the rate at which an individual message can specify
16687recipients.
16688
16689Exim has two rate-limiting facilities. This section describes the older
16690facility, which can limit rates within a single connection. The newer
16691&%ratelimit%& ACL condition can limit rates across all connections. See section
16692&<<SECTratelimiting>>& for details of the newer facility.
16693
16694When a host matches &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%&, the values of
16695&%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& and &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& are used to control the
16696rate of acceptance of MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session,
16697respectively. Each option, if set, must contain a set of four comma-separated
16698values:
16699
16700.ilist
16701A threshold, before which there is no rate limiting.
16702.next
16703An initial time delay. Unlike other times in Exim, numbers with decimal
16704fractional parts are allowed here.
16705.next
16706A factor by which to increase the delay each time.
16707.next
16708A maximum value for the delay. This should normally be less than 5 minutes,
16709because after that time, the client is liable to timeout the SMTP command.
16710.endlist
16711
16712For example, these settings have been used successfully at the site which
16713first suggested this feature, for controlling mail from their customers:
16714.code
16715smtp_ratelimit_mail = 2,0.5s,1.05,4m
16716smtp_ratelimit_rcpt = 4,0.25s,1.015,4m
16717.endd
16718The first setting specifies delays that are applied to MAIL commands after
16719two have been received over a single connection. The initial delay is 0.5
16720seconds, increasing by a factor of 1.05 each time. The second setting applies
16721delays to RCPT commands when more than four occur in a single message.
16722
16723
16724.option smtp_ratelimit_mail main string unset
16725See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
16726
16727
16728.option smtp_ratelimit_rcpt main string unset
16729See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
16730
16731
16732.option smtp_receive_timeout main time&!! 5m
16733.cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
16734.cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
16735This sets a timeout value for SMTP reception. It applies to all forms of SMTP
16736input, including batch SMTP. If a line of input (either an SMTP command or a
16737data line) is not received within this time, the SMTP connection is dropped and
16738the message is abandoned.
16739A line is written to the log containing one of the following messages:
16740.code
16741SMTP command timeout on connection from...
16742SMTP data timeout on connection from...
16743.endd
16744The former means that Exim was expecting to read an SMTP command; the latter
16745means that it was in the DATA phase, reading the contents of a message.
16746
16747If the first character of the option is a &"$"& the option is
16748expanded before use and may depend on
16749&$sender_host_name$&, &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.
16750
16751
16752.oindex "&%-os%&"
16753The value set by this option can be overridden by the
16754&%-os%& command-line option. A setting of zero time disables the timeout, but
16755this should never be used for SMTP over TCP/IP. (It can be useful in some cases
16756of local input using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.) For non-SMTP input, the reception
16757timeout is controlled by &%receive_timeout%& and &%-or%&.
16758
16759
16760.option smtp_reserve_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16761This option defines hosts for which SMTP connections are reserved; see
16762&%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%& above.
16763
16764
16765.option smtp_return_error_details main boolean false
16766.cindex "SMTP" "details policy failures"
16767.cindex "policy control" "rejection, returning details"
16768In the default state, Exim uses bland messages such as
16769&"Administrative prohibition"& when it rejects SMTP commands for policy
16770reasons. Many sysadmins like this because it gives away little information
16771to spammers. However, some other sysadmins who are applying strict checking
16772policies want to give out much fuller information about failures. Setting
16773&%smtp_return_error_details%& true causes Exim to be more forthcoming. For
16774example, instead of &"Administrative prohibition"&, it might give:
16775.code
16776550-Rejected after DATA: '>' missing at end of address:
16777550 failing address in "From" header is: <user@dom.ain
16778.endd
16779
16780
16781.option smtputf8_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
16782.cindex "SMTPUTF8" "advertising"
16783When Exim is built with support for internationalised mail names,
16784the availability thereof is advertised in
16785response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
16786chapter &<<CHAPi18n>>& for details of Exim's support for internationalisation.
16787
16788
16789.option spamd_address main string "see below"
16790This option is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
16791extension. It specifies how Exim connects to SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon.
16792The default value is
16793.code
16794127.0.0.1 783
16795.endd
16796See section &<<SECTscanspamass>>& for more details.
16797
16798
16799
16800.option split_spool_directory main boolean false
16801.cindex "multiple spool directories"
16802.cindex "spool directory" "split"
16803.cindex "directories, multiple"
16804If this option is set, it causes Exim to split its input directory into 62
16805subdirectories, each with a single alphanumeric character as its name. The
16806sixth character of the message id is used to allocate messages to
16807subdirectories; this is the least significant base-62 digit of the time of
16808arrival of the message.
16809
16810Splitting up the spool in this way may provide better performance on systems
16811where there are long mail queues, by reducing the number of files in any one
16812directory. The msglog directory is also split up in a similar way to the input
16813directory; however, if &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, all old msglog files
16814are still placed in the single directory &_msglog.OLD_&.
16815
16816It is not necessary to take any special action for existing messages when
16817changing &%split_spool_directory%&. Exim notices messages that are in the
16818&"wrong"& place, and continues to process them. If the option is turned off
16819after a period of being on, the subdirectories will eventually empty and be
16820automatically deleted.
16821
16822When &%split_spool_directory%& is set, the behaviour of queue runner processes
16823changes. Instead of creating a list of all messages in the queue, and then
16824trying to deliver each one in turn, it constructs a list of those in one
16825sub-directory and tries to deliver them, before moving on to the next
16826sub-directory. The sub-directories are processed in a random order. This
16827spreads out the scanning of the input directories, and uses less memory. It is
16828particularly beneficial when there are lots of messages on the queue. However,
16829if &%queue_run_in_order%& is set, none of this new processing happens. The
16830entire queue has to be scanned and sorted before any deliveries can start.
16831
16832
16833.option spool_directory main string&!! "set at compile time"
16834.cindex "spool directory" "path to"
16835This defines the directory in which Exim keeps its spool, that is, the messages
16836it is waiting to deliver. The default value is taken from the compile-time
16837configuration setting, if there is one. If not, this option must be set. The
16838string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, a reference to
16839&$primary_hostname$&.
16840
16841If the spool directory name is fixed on your installation, it is recommended
16842that you set it at build time rather than from this option, particularly if the
16843log files are being written to the spool directory (see &%log_file_path%&).
16844Otherwise log files cannot be used for errors that are detected early on, such
16845as failures in the configuration file.
16846
16847By using this option to override the compiled-in path, it is possible to run
16848tests of Exim without using the standard spool.
16849
16850.new
16851.option spool_wireformat main boolean false
16852.cindex "spool directory" "file formats"
16853If this option is set, Exim may for some messages use an alternate format
16854for data-files in the spool which matches the wire format.
16855Doing this permits more efficient message reception and transmission.
16856Currently it is only done for messages received using the EMSTP CHUNKING
16857option.
16858
16859The following variables will not have useful values:
16860.code
16861$max_received_linelength
16862$body_linecount
16863$body_zerocount
16864.endd
16865
16866Users of the local_scan() API (see &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&),
16867and any external programs which are passed a reference to a message data file
16868(except via the &"regex"&, &"malware"& or &"spam"&) ACL conditions)
16869will need to be aware of the potential different format.
16870
16871Using any of the ACL conditions noted will negate the reception benefit
16872(as a Unix-mbox-format file is contructed for them).
16873The transimssion benefit is maintained.
16874.wen
16875
16876.option sqlite_lock_timeout main time 5s
16877.cindex "sqlite lookup type" "lock timeout"
16878This option controls the timeout that the &(sqlite)& lookup uses when trying to
16879access an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>& for more details.
16880
16881.option strict_acl_vars main boolean false
16882.cindex "&ACL;" "variables, handling unset"
16883This option controls what happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL
16884variable is referenced. If it is false (the default), an empty string
16885is substituted; if it is true, an error is generated. See section
16886&<<SECTaclvariables>>& for details of ACL variables.
16887
16888.option strip_excess_angle_brackets main boolean false
16889.cindex "angle brackets, excess"
16890If this option is set, redundant pairs of angle brackets round &"route-addr"&
16891items in addresses are stripped. For example, &'<<xxx@a.b.c.d>>'& is
16892treated as &'<xxx@a.b.c.d>'&. If this is in the envelope and the message is
16893passed on to another MTA, the excess angle brackets are not passed on. If this
16894option is not set, multiple pairs of angle brackets cause a syntax error.
16895
16896
16897.option strip_trailing_dot main boolean false
16898.cindex "trailing dot on domain"
16899.cindex "dot" "trailing on domain"
16900If this option is set, a trailing dot at the end of a domain in an address is
16901ignored. If this is in the envelope and the message is passed on to another
16902MTA, the dot is not passed on. If this option is not set, a dot at the end of a
16903domain causes a syntax error.
16904However, addresses in header lines are checked only when an ACL requests header
16905syntax checking.
16906
16907
16908.option syslog_duplication main boolean true
16909.cindex "syslog" "duplicate log lines; suppressing"
16910When Exim is logging to syslog, it writes the log lines for its three
16911separate logs at different syslog priorities so that they can in principle
16912be separated on the logging hosts. Some installations do not require this
16913separation, and in those cases, the duplication of certain log lines is a
16914nuisance. If &%syslog_duplication%& is set false, only one copy of any
16915particular log line is written to syslog. For lines that normally go to
16916both the main log and the reject log, the reject log version (possibly
16917containing message header lines) is written, at LOG_NOTICE priority.
16918Lines that normally go to both the main and the panic log are written at
16919the LOG_ALERT priority.
16920
16921
16922.option syslog_facility main string unset
16923.cindex "syslog" "facility; setting"
16924This option sets the syslog &"facility"& name, used when Exim is logging to
16925syslog. The value must be one of the strings &"mail"&, &"user"&, &"news"&,
16926&"uucp"&, &"daemon"&, or &"local&'x'&"& where &'x'& is a digit between 0 and 7.
16927If this option is unset, &"mail"& is used. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
16928details of Exim's logging.
16929
16930
16931.option syslog_pid main boolean true
16932.cindex "syslog" "pid"
16933If &%syslog_pid%& is set false, the PID on Exim's log lines are
16934omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. (Syslog normally prefixes
16935the log lines with the PID of the logging process automatically.) You need
16936to enable the &`+pid`& log selector item, if you want Exim to write it's PID
16937into the logs.) See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
16938
16939
16940
16941.option syslog_processname main string &`exim`&
16942.cindex "syslog" "process name; setting"
16943This option sets the syslog &"ident"& name, used when Exim is logging to
16944syslog. The value must be no longer than 32 characters. See chapter
16945&<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
16946
16947
16948
16949.option syslog_timestamp main boolean true
16950.cindex "syslog" "timestamps"
16951If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on Exim's log lines are
16952omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
16953details of Exim's logging.
16954
16955
16956.option system_filter main string&!! unset
16957.cindex "filter" "system filter"
16958.cindex "system filter" "specifying"
16959.cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
16960This option specifies an Exim filter file that is applied to all messages at
16961the start of each delivery attempt, before any routing is done. System filters
16962must be Exim filters; they cannot be Sieve filters. If the system filter
16963generates any deliveries to files or pipes, or any new mail messages, the
16964appropriate &%system_filter_..._transport%& option(s) must be set, to define
16965which transports are to be used. Details of this facility are given in chapter
16966&<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&.
16967A forced expansion failure results in no filter operation.
16968
16969
16970.option system_filter_directory_transport main string&!! unset
16971.vindex "&$address_file$&"
16972This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the
16973&%save%& command in a system message filter specifies a path ending in &"/"&,
16974implying delivery of each message into a separate file in some directory.
16975During the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
16976
16977
16978.option system_filter_file_transport main string&!! unset
16979.cindex "file" "transport for system filter"
16980This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the &%save%&
16981command in a system message filter specifies a path not ending in &"/"&. During
16982the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
16983
16984.option system_filter_group main string unset
16985.cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
16986This option is used only when &%system_filter_user%& is also set. It sets the
16987gid under which the system filter is run, overriding any gid that is associated
16988with the user. The value may be numerical or symbolic.
16989
16990.option system_filter_pipe_transport main string&!! unset
16991.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "for system filter"
16992.vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
16993This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%pipe%& command
16994is used in a system filter. During the delivery, the variable &$address_pipe$&
16995contains the pipe command.
16996
16997
16998.option system_filter_reply_transport main string&!! unset
16999.cindex "&(autoreply)& transport" "for system filter"
17000This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%mail%& command
17001is used in a system filter.
17002
17003
17004.option system_filter_user main string unset
17005.cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
17006If this option is set to root, the system filter is run in the main Exim
17007delivery process, as root. Otherwise, the system filter runs in a separate
17008process, as the given user, defaulting to the Exim run-time user.
17009Unless the string consists entirely of digits, it
17010is looked up in the password data. Failure to find the named user causes a
17011configuration error. The gid is either taken from the password data, or
17012specified by &%system_filter_group%&. When the uid is specified numerically,
17013&%system_filter_group%& is required to be set.
17014
17015If the system filter generates any pipe, file, or reply deliveries, the uid
17016under which the filter is run is used when transporting them, unless a
17017transport option overrides.
17018
17019
17020.option tcp_nodelay main boolean true
17021.cindex "daemon" "TCP_NODELAY on sockets"
17022.cindex "Nagle algorithm"
17023.cindex "TCP_NODELAY on listening sockets"
17024If this option is set false, it stops the Exim daemon setting the
17025TCP_NODELAY option on its listening sockets. Setting TCP_NODELAY
17026turns off the &"Nagle algorithm"&, which is a way of improving network
17027performance in interactive (character-by-character) situations. Turning it off
17028should improve Exim's performance a bit, so that is what happens by default.
17029However, it appears that some broken clients cannot cope, and time out. Hence
17030this option. It affects only those sockets that are set up for listening by the
17031daemon. Sockets created by the smtp transport for delivering mail always set
17032TCP_NODELAY.
17033
17034
17035.option timeout_frozen_after main time 0s
17036.cindex "frozen messages" "timing out"
17037.cindex "timeout" "frozen messages"
17038If &%timeout_frozen_after%& is set to a time greater than zero, a frozen
17039message of any kind that has been on the queue for longer than the given time
17040is automatically cancelled at the next queue run. If the frozen message is a
17041bounce message, it is just discarded; otherwise, a bounce is sent to the
17042sender, in a similar manner to cancellation by the &%-Mg%& command line option.
17043If you want to timeout frozen bounce messages earlier than other kinds of
17044frozen message, see &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&.
17045
17046&*Note:*& the default value of zero means no timeouts; with this setting,
17047frozen messages remain on the queue forever (except for any frozen bounce
17048messages that are released by &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
17049
17050
17051.option timezone main string unset
17052.cindex "timezone, setting"
17053.cindex "environment" "values from"
17054The value of &%timezone%& is used to set the environment variable TZ while
17055running Exim (if it is different on entry). This ensures that all timestamps
17056created by Exim are in the required timezone. If you want all your timestamps
17057to be in UTC (aka GMT) you should set
17058.code
17059timezone = UTC
17060.endd
17061The default value is taken from TIMEZONE_DEFAULT in &_Local/Makefile_&,
17062or, if that is not set, from the value of the TZ environment variable when Exim
17063is built. If &%timezone%& is set to the empty string, either at build or run
17064time, any existing TZ variable is removed from the environment when Exim
17065runs. This is appropriate behaviour for obtaining wall-clock time on some, but
17066unfortunately not all, operating systems.
17067
17068
17069.option tls_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
17070.cindex "TLS" "advertising"
17071.cindex "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
17072.cindex "SMTP" "encrypted connection"
17073When Exim is built with support for TLS encrypted connections, the availability
17074of the STARTTLS command to set up an encrypted session is advertised in
17075response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
17076chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of Exim's support for TLS.
17077Note that the default value requires that a certificate be supplied
17078using the &%tls_certificate%& option. If TLS support for incoming connections
17079is not required the &%tls_advertise_hosts%& option should be set empty.
17080
17081
17082.option tls_certificate main string&!! unset
17083.cindex "TLS" "server certificate; location of"
17084.cindex "certificate" "server, location of"
17085The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to a
17086file which contains the server's certificates. The server's private key is also
17087assumed to be in this file if &%tls_privatekey%& is unset. See chapter
17088&<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
17089
17090&*Note*&: The certificates defined by this option are used only when Exim is
17091receiving incoming messages as a server. If you want to supply certificates for
17092use when sending messages as a client, you must set the &%tls_certificate%&
17093option in the relevant &(smtp)& transport.
17094
17095If the option contains &$tls_out_sni$& and Exim is built against OpenSSL, then
17096if the OpenSSL build supports TLS extensions and the TLS client sends the
17097Server Name Indication extension, then this option and others documented in
17098&<<SECTtlssni>>& will be re-expanded.
17099
17100If this option is unset or empty a fresh self-signed certificate will be
17101generated for every connection.
17102
17103.option tls_crl main string&!! unset
17104.cindex "TLS" "server certificate revocation list"
17105.cindex "certificate" "revocation list for server"
17106This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
17107be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
17108
17109See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
17110
17111
17112.option tls_dh_max_bits main integer 2236
17113.cindex "TLS" "D-H bit count"
17114The number of bits used for Diffie-Hellman key-exchange may be suggested by
17115the chosen TLS library. That value might prove to be too high for
17116interoperability. This option provides a maximum clamp on the value
17117suggested, trading off security for interoperability.
17118
17119The value must be at least 1024.
17120
17121The value 2236 was chosen because, at time of adding the option, it was the
17122hard-coded maximum value supported by the NSS cryptographic library, as used
17123by Thunderbird, while GnuTLS was suggesting 2432 bits as normal.
17124
17125If you prefer more security and are willing to break some clients, raise this
17126number.
17127
17128Note that the value passed to GnuTLS for *generating* a new prime may be a
17129little less than this figure, because GnuTLS is inexact and may produce a
17130larger prime than requested.
17131
17132
17133.option tls_dhparam main string&!! unset
17134.cindex "TLS" "D-H parameters for server"
17135The value of this option is expanded and indicates the source of DH parameters
17136to be used by Exim.
17137
17138&*Note: The Exim Maintainers strongly recommend using a filename with site-generated
17139local DH parameters*&, which has been supported across all versions of Exim. The
17140other specific constants available are a fallback so that even when
17141"unconfigured", Exim can offer Perfect Forward Secrecy in older ciphersuites in TLS.
17142
17143If &%tls_dhparam%& is a filename starting with a &`/`&,
17144then it names a file from which DH
17145parameters should be loaded. If the file exists, it should hold a PEM-encoded
17146PKCS#3 representation of the DH prime. If the file does not exist, for
17147OpenSSL it is an error. For GnuTLS, Exim will attempt to create the file and
17148fill it with a generated DH prime. For OpenSSL, if the DH bit-count from
17149loading the file is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then it will be ignored,
17150and treated as though the &%tls_dhparam%& were set to "none".
17151
17152If this option expands to the string "none", then no DH parameters will be
17153loaded by Exim.
17154
17155If this option expands to the string "historic" and Exim is using GnuTLS, then
17156Exim will attempt to load a file from inside the spool directory. If the file
17157does not exist, Exim will attempt to create it.
17158See section &<<SECTgnutlsparam>>& for further details.
17159
17160If Exim is using OpenSSL and this option is empty or unset, then Exim will load
17161a default DH prime; the default is Exim-specific but lacks verifiable provenance.
17162
17163In older versions of Exim the default was the 2048 bit prime described in section
171642.2 of RFC 5114, "2048-bit MODP Group with 224-bit Prime Order Subgroup", which
17165in IKE is assigned number 23.
17166
17167Otherwise, the option must expand to the name used by Exim for any of a number
17168of DH primes specified in RFC 2409, RFC 3526, RFC 5114, RFC 7919, or from other
17169sources. As names, Exim uses a standard specified name, else "ike" followed by
17170the number used by IKE, or "default" which corresponds to
17171&`exim.dev.20160529.3`&.
17172
17173The available standard primes are:
17174&`ffdhe2048`&, &`ffdhe3072`&, &`ffdhe4096`&, &`ffdhe6144`&, &`ffdhe8192`&,
17175&`ike1`&, &`ike2`&, &`ike5`&,
17176&`ike14`&, &`ike15`&, &`ike16`&, &`ike17`&, &`ike18`&,
17177&`ike22`&, &`ike23`& and &`ike24`&.
17178
17179The available additional primes are:
17180&`exim.dev.20160529.1`&, &`exim.dev.20160529.2`& and &`exim.dev.20160529.3`&.
17181
17182Some of these will be too small to be accepted by clients.
17183Some may be too large to be accepted by clients.
17184The open cryptographic community has suspicions about the integrity of some
17185of the later IKE values, which led into RFC7919 providing new fixed constants
17186(the "ffdhe" identifiers).
17187
17188At this point, all of the "ike" values should be considered obsolete;
17189they're still in Exim to avoid breaking unusual configurations, but are
17190candidates for removal the next time we have backwards-incompatible changes.
17191
17192The TLS protocol does not negotiate an acceptable size for this; clients tend
17193to hard-drop connections if what is offered by the server is unacceptable,
17194whether too large or too small, and there's no provision for the client to
17195tell the server what these constraints are. Thus, as a server operator, you
17196need to make an educated guess as to what is most likely to work for your
17197userbase.
17198
17199Some known size constraints suggest that a bit-size in the range 2048 to 2236
17200is most likely to maximise interoperability. The upper bound comes from
17201applications using the Mozilla Network Security Services (NSS) library, which
17202used to set its &`DH_MAX_P_BITS`& upper-bound to 2236. This affects many
17203mail user agents (MUAs). The lower bound comes from Debian installs of Exim4
17204prior to the 4.80 release, as Debian used to patch Exim to raise the minimum
17205acceptable bound from 1024 to 2048.
17206
17207
17208.option tls_eccurve main string&!! &`auto`&
17209.cindex TLS "EC cryptography"
17210This option selects a EC curve for use by Exim when used with OpenSSL.
17211It has no effect when Exim is used with GnuTLS.
17212
17213After expansion it must contain a valid EC curve parameter, such as
17214&`prime256v1`&, &`secp384r1`&, or &`P-512`&. Consult your OpenSSL manual
17215for valid selections.
17216
17217For OpenSSL versions before (and not including) 1.0.2, the string
17218&`auto`& selects &`prime256v1`&. For more recent OpenSSL versions
17219&`auto`& tells the library to choose.
17220
17221If the option expands to an empty string, no EC curves will be enabled.
17222
17223
17224.option tls_ocsp_file main string&!! unset
17225.cindex TLS "certificate status"
17226.cindex TLS "OCSP proof file"
17227This option
17228must if set expand to the absolute path to a file which contains a current
17229status proof for the server's certificate, as obtained from the
17230Certificate Authority.
17231
17232Usable for GnuTLS 3.4.4 or 3.3.17 or OpenSSL 1.1.0 (or later).
17233
17234
17235.option tls_on_connect_ports main "string list" unset
17236.cindex SSMTP
17237.cindex SMTPS
17238This option specifies a list of incoming SSMTP (aka SMTPS) ports that should
17239operate the obsolete SSMTP (SMTPS) protocol, where a TLS session is immediately
17240set up without waiting for the client to issue a STARTTLS command. For
17241further details, see section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&.
17242
17243
17244
17245.option tls_privatekey main string&!! unset
17246.cindex "TLS" "server private key; location of"
17247The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to a
17248file which contains the server's private key. If this option is unset, or if
17249the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the private
17250key is assumed to be in the same file as the server's certificates. See chapter
17251&<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
17252
17253See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
17254
17255
17256.option tls_remember_esmtp main boolean false
17257.cindex "TLS" "esmtp state; remembering"
17258.cindex "TLS" "broken clients"
17259If this option is set true, Exim violates the RFCs by remembering that it is in
17260&"esmtp"& state after successfully negotiating a TLS session. This provides
17261support for broken clients that fail to send a new EHLO after starting a
17262TLS session.
17263
17264
17265.option tls_require_ciphers main string&!! unset
17266.cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
17267.cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
17268This option controls which ciphers can be used for incoming TLS connections.
17269The &(smtp)& transport has an option of the same name for controlling outgoing
17270connections. This option is expanded for each connection, so can be varied for
17271different clients if required. The value of this option must be a list of
17272permitted cipher suites. The OpenSSL and GnuTLS libraries handle cipher control
17273in somewhat different ways. If GnuTLS is being used, the client controls the
17274preference order of the available ciphers. Details are given in sections
17275&<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
17276
17277
17278.option tls_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17279.cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
17280.cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
17281See &%tls_verify_hosts%& below.
17282
17283
17284.option tls_verify_certificates main string&!! system
17285.cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
17286.cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
17287The value of this option is expanded, and must then be either the
17288word "system"
17289or the absolute path to
17290a file or directory containing permitted certificates for clients that
17291match &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&.
17292
17293The "system" value for the option will use a
17294system default location compiled into the SSL library.
17295This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20,
17296and will be taken as empty; an explicit location
17297must be specified.
17298
17299The use of a directory for the option value is not available for GnuTLS versions
17300preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
17301
17302With OpenSSL the certificates specified
17303explicitly
17304either by file or directory
17305are added to those given by the system default location.
17306
17307These certificates should be for the certificate authorities trusted, rather
17308than the public cert of individual clients. With both OpenSSL and GnuTLS, if
17309the value is a file then the certificates are sent by Exim as a server to
17310connecting clients, defining the list of accepted certificate authorities.
17311Thus the values defined should be considered public data. To avoid this,
17312use the explicit directory version.
17313
17314See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
17315
17316A forced expansion failure or setting to an empty string is equivalent to
17317being unset.
17318
17319
17320.option tls_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17321.cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
17322.cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
17323This option, along with &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, controls the checking of
17324certificates from clients. The expected certificates are defined by
17325&%tls_verify_certificates%&, which must be set. A configuration error occurs if
17326either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is set and
17327&%tls_verify_certificates%& is not set.
17328
17329Any client that matches &%tls_verify_hosts%& is constrained by
17330&%tls_verify_certificates%&. When the client initiates a TLS session, it must
17331present one of the listed certificates. If it does not, the connection is
17332aborted. &*Warning*&: Including a host in &%tls_verify_hosts%& does not require
17333the host to use TLS. It can still send SMTP commands through unencrypted
17334connections. Forcing a client to use TLS has to be done separately using an
17335ACL to reject inappropriate commands when the connection is not encrypted.
17336
17337A weaker form of checking is provided by &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. If a client
17338matches this option (but not &%tls_verify_hosts%&), Exim requests a
17339certificate and checks it against &%tls_verify_certificates%&, but does not
17340abort the connection if there is no certificate or if it does not match. This
17341state can be detected in an ACL, which makes it possible to implement policies
17342such as &"accept for relay only if a verified certificate has been received,
17343but accept for local delivery if encrypted, even without a verified
17344certificate"&.
17345
17346Client hosts that match neither of these lists are not asked to present
17347certificates.
17348
17349
17350.option trusted_groups main "string list&!!" unset
17351.cindex "trusted groups"
17352.cindex "groups" "trusted"
17353This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
17354option is set, any process that is running in one of the listed groups, or
17355which has one of them as a supplementary group, is trusted. The groups can be
17356specified numerically or by name. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for
17357details of what trusted callers are permitted to do. If neither
17358&%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the Exim user
17359are trusted.
17360
17361.option trusted_users main "string list&!!" unset
17362.cindex "trusted users"
17363.cindex "user" "trusted"
17364This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
17365option is set, any process that is running as one of the listed users is
17366trusted. The users can be specified numerically or by name. See section
17367&<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of what trusted callers are permitted to do.
17368If neither &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the
17369Exim user are trusted.
17370
17371.option unknown_login main string&!! unset
17372.cindex "uid (user id)" "unknown caller"
17373.vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
17374This is a specialized feature for use in unusual configurations. By default, if
17375the uid of the caller of Exim cannot be looked up using &[getpwuid()]&, Exim
17376gives up. The &%unknown_login%& option can be used to set a login name to be
17377used in this circumstance. It is expanded, so values like &%user$caller_uid%&
17378can be set. When &%unknown_login%& is used, the value of &%unknown_username%&
17379is used for the user's real name (gecos field), unless this has been set by the
17380&%-F%& option.
17381
17382.option unknown_username main string unset
17383See &%unknown_login%&.
17384
17385.option untrusted_set_sender main "address list&!!" unset
17386.cindex "trusted users"
17387.cindex "sender" "setting by untrusted user"
17388.cindex "untrusted user setting sender"
17389.cindex "user" "untrusted setting sender"
17390.cindex "envelope sender"
17391When an untrusted user submits a message to Exim using the standard input, Exim
17392normally creates an envelope sender address from the user's login and the
17393default qualification domain. Data from the &%-f%& option (for setting envelope
17394senders on non-SMTP messages) or the SMTP MAIL command (if &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&
17395is used) is ignored.
17396
17397However, untrusted users are permitted to set an empty envelope sender address,
17398to declare that a message should never generate any bounces. For example:
17399.code
17400exim -f '<>' user@domain.example
17401.endd
17402.vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
17403The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option allows you to permit untrusted users to set
17404other envelope sender addresses in a controlled way. When it is set, untrusted
17405users are allowed to set envelope sender addresses that match any of the
17406patterns in the list. Like all address lists, the string is expanded. The
17407identity of the user is in &$sender_ident$&, so you can, for example, restrict
17408users to setting senders that start with their login ids
17409followed by a hyphen
17410by a setting like this:
17411.code
17412untrusted_set_sender = ^$sender_ident-
17413.endd
17414If you want to allow untrusted users to set envelope sender addresses without
17415restriction, you can use
17416.code
17417untrusted_set_sender = *
17418.endd
17419The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option applies to all forms of local input, but
17420only to the setting of the envelope sender. It does not permit untrusted users
17421to use the other options which trusted user can use to override message
17422parameters. Furthermore, it does not stop Exim from removing an existing
17423&'Sender:'& header in the message, or from adding a &'Sender:'& header if
17424necessary. See &%local_sender_retain%& and &%local_from_check%& for ways of
17425overriding these actions. The handling of the &'Sender:'& header is also
17426described in section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&.
17427
17428The log line for a message's arrival shows the envelope sender following
17429&"<="&. For local messages, the user's login always follows, after &"U="&. In
17430&%-bp%& displays, and in the Exim monitor, if an untrusted user sets an
17431envelope sender address, the user's login is shown in parentheses after the
17432sender address.
17433
17434
17435.option uucp_from_pattern main string "see below"
17436.cindex "&""From""& line"
17437.cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
17438Some applications that pass messages to an MTA via a command line interface use
17439an initial line starting with &"From&~"& to pass the envelope sender. In
17440particular, this is used by UUCP software. Exim recognizes such a line by means
17441of a regular expression that is set in &%uucp_from_pattern%&. When the pattern
17442matches, the sender address is constructed by expanding the contents of
17443&%uucp_from_sender%&, provided that the caller of Exim is a trusted user. The
17444default pattern recognizes lines in the following two forms:
17445.code
17446From ph10 Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
17447From ph10 Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
17448.endd
17449The pattern can be seen by running
17450.code
17451exim -bP uucp_from_pattern
17452.endd
17453It checks only up to the hours and minutes, and allows for a 2-digit or 4-digit
17454year in the second case. The first word after &"From&~"& is matched in the
17455regular expression by a parenthesized subpattern. The default value for
17456&%uucp_from_sender%& is &"$1"&, which therefore just uses this first word
17457(&"ph10"& in the example above) as the message's sender. See also
17458&%ignore_fromline_hosts%&.
17459
17460
17461.option uucp_from_sender main string&!! &`$1`&
17462See &%uucp_from_pattern%& above.
17463
17464
17465.option warn_message_file main string unset
17466.cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
17467.cindex "customizing" "warning message"
17468This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
17469for constructing the warning message which is sent by Exim when a message has
17470been on the queue for a specified amount of time, as specified by
17471&%delay_warning%&. Details of the file's contents are given in chapter
17472&<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%bounce_message_file%&.
17473
17474
17475.option write_rejectlog main boolean true
17476.cindex "reject log" "disabling"
17477If this option is set false, Exim no longer writes anything to the reject log.
17478See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of what Exim writes to its logs.
17479.ecindex IIDconfima
17480.ecindex IIDmaiconf
17481
17482
17483
17484
17485. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17486. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17487
17488.chapter "Generic options for routers" "CHAProutergeneric"
17489.scindex IIDgenoprou1 "options" "generic; for routers"
17490.scindex IIDgenoprou2 "generic options" "router"
17491This chapter describes the generic options that apply to all routers.
17492Those that are preconditions are marked with &Dagger; in the &"use"& field.
17493
17494For a general description of how a router operates, see sections
17495&<<SECTrunindrou>>& and &<<SECTrouprecon>>&. The latter specifies the order in
17496which the preconditions are tested. The order of expansion of the options that
17497provide data for a transport is: &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&,
17498&%headers_remove%&, &%transport%&.
17499
17500
17501
17502.option address_data routers string&!! unset
17503.cindex "router" "data attached to address"
17504The string is expanded just before the router is run, that is, after all the
17505precondition tests have succeeded. If the expansion is forced to fail, the
17506router declines, the value of &%address_data%& remains unchanged, and the
17507&%more%& option controls what happens next. Other expansion failures cause
17508delivery of the address to be deferred.
17509
17510.vindex "&$address_data$&"
17511When the expansion succeeds, the value is retained with the address, and can be
17512accessed using the variable &$address_data$& in the current router, subsequent
17513routers, and the eventual transport.
17514
17515&*Warning*&: If the current or any subsequent router is a &(redirect)& router
17516that runs a user's filter file, the contents of &$address_data$& are accessible
17517in the filter. This is not normally a problem, because such data is usually
17518either not confidential or it &"belongs"& to the current user, but if you do
17519put confidential data into &$address_data$& you need to remember this point.
17520
17521Even if the router declines or passes, the value of &$address_data$& remains
17522with the address, though it can be changed by another &%address_data%& setting
17523on a subsequent router. If a router generates child addresses, the value of
17524&$address_data$& propagates to them. This also applies to the special kind of
17525&"child"& that is generated by a router with the &%unseen%& option.
17526
17527The idea of &%address_data%& is that you can use it to look up a lot of data
17528for the address once, and then pick out parts of the data later. For example,
17529you could use a single LDAP lookup to return a string of the form
17530.code
17531uid=1234 gid=5678 mailbox=/mail/xyz forward=/home/xyz/.forward
17532.endd
17533In the transport you could pick out the mailbox by a setting such as
17534.code
17535file = ${extract{mailbox}{$address_data}}
17536.endd
17537This makes the configuration file less messy, and also reduces the number of
17538lookups (though Exim does cache lookups).
17539
17540.vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
17541.vindex "&$address_data$&"
17542The &%address_data%& facility is also useful as a means of passing information
17543from one router to another, and from a router to a transport. In addition, if
17544&$address_data$& is set by a router when verifying a recipient address from an
17545ACL, it remains available for use in the rest of the ACL statement. After
17546verifying a sender, the value is transferred to &$sender_address_data$&.
17547
17548
17549
17550.option address_test routers&!? boolean true
17551.oindex "&%-bt%&"
17552.cindex "router" "skipping when address testing"
17553If this option is set false, the router is skipped when routing is being tested
17554by means of the &%-bt%& command line option. This can be a convenience when
17555your first router sends messages to an external scanner, because it saves you
17556having to set the &"already scanned"& indicator when testing real address
17557routing.
17558
17559
17560
17561.option cannot_route_message routers string&!! unset
17562.cindex "router" "customizing &""cannot route""& message"
17563.cindex "customizing" "&""cannot route""& message"
17564This option specifies a text message that is used when an address cannot be
17565routed because Exim has run out of routers. The default message is
17566&"Unrouteable address"&. This option is useful only on routers that have
17567&%more%& set false, or on the very last router in a configuration, because the
17568value that is used is taken from the last router that is considered. This
17569includes a router that is skipped because its preconditions are not met, as
17570well as a router that declines. For example, using the default configuration,
17571you could put:
17572.code
17573cannot_route_message = Remote domain not found in DNS
17574.endd
17575on the first router, which is a &(dnslookup)& router with &%more%& set false,
17576and
17577.code
17578cannot_route_message = Unknown local user
17579.endd
17580on the final router that checks for local users. If string expansion fails for
17581this option, the default message is used. Unless the expansion failure was
17582explicitly forced, a message about the failure is written to the main and panic
17583logs, in addition to the normal message about the routing failure.
17584
17585
17586.option caseful_local_part routers boolean false
17587.cindex "case of local parts"
17588.cindex "router" "case of local parts"
17589By default, routers handle the local parts of addresses in a case-insensitive
17590manner, though the actual case is preserved for transmission with the message.
17591If you want the case of letters to be significant in a router, you must set
17592this option true. For individual router options that contain address or local
17593part lists (for example, &%local_parts%&), case-sensitive matching can be
17594turned on by &"+caseful"& as a list item. See section &<<SECTcasletadd>>& for
17595more details.
17596
17597.vindex "&$local_part$&"
17598.vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
17599.vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
17600The value of the &$local_part$& variable is forced to lower case while a
17601router is running unless &%caseful_local_part%& is set. When a router assigns
17602an address to a transport, the value of &$local_part$& when the transport runs
17603is the same as it was in the router. Similarly, when a router generates child
17604addresses by aliasing or forwarding, the values of &$original_local_part$&
17605and &$parent_local_part$& are those that were used by the redirecting router.
17606
17607This option applies to the processing of an address by a router. When a
17608recipient address is being processed in an ACL, there is a separate &%control%&
17609modifier that can be used to specify case-sensitive processing within the ACL
17610(see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&).
17611
17612
17613
17614.option check_local_user routers&!? boolean false
17615.cindex "local user, checking in router"
17616.cindex "router" "checking for local user"
17617.cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
17618.vindex "&$home$&"
17619When this option is true, Exim checks that the local part of the recipient
17620address (with affixes removed if relevant) is the name of an account on the
17621local system. The check is done by calling the &[getpwnam()]& function rather
17622than trying to read &_/etc/passwd_& directly. This means that other methods of
17623holding password data (such as NIS) are supported. If the local part is a local
17624user, &$home$& is set from the password data, and can be tested in other
17625preconditions that are evaluated after this one (the order of evaluation is
17626given in section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). However, the value of &$home$& can be
17627overridden by &%router_home_directory%&. If the local part is not a local user,
17628the router is skipped.
17629
17630If you want to check that the local part is either the name of a local user
17631or matches something else, you cannot combine &%check_local_user%& with a
17632setting of &%local_parts%&, because that specifies the logical &'and'& of the
17633two conditions. However, you can use a &(passwd)& lookup in a &%local_parts%&
17634setting to achieve this. For example:
17635.code
17636local_parts = passwd;$local_part : lsearch;/etc/other/users
17637.endd
17638Note, however, that the side effects of &%check_local_user%& (such as setting
17639up a home directory) do not occur when a &(passwd)& lookup is used in a
17640&%local_parts%& (or any other) precondition.
17641
17642
17643
17644.option condition routers&!? string&!! unset
17645.cindex "router" "customized precondition"
17646This option specifies a general precondition test that has to succeed for the
17647router to be called. The &%condition%& option is the last precondition to be
17648evaluated (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). The string is expanded, and if the
17649result is a forced failure, or an empty string, or one of the strings &"0"& or
17650&"no"& or &"false"& (checked without regard to the case of the letters), the
17651router is skipped, and the address is offered to the next one.
17652
17653If the result is any other value, the router is run (as this is the last
17654precondition to be evaluated, all the other preconditions must be true).
17655
17656This option is unusual in that multiple &%condition%& options may be present.
17657All &%condition%& options must succeed.
17658
17659The &%condition%& option provides a means of applying custom conditions to the
17660running of routers. Note that in the case of a simple conditional expansion,
17661the default expansion values are exactly what is wanted. For example:
17662.code
17663condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
17664.endd
17665Because of the default behaviour of the string expansion, this is equivalent to
17666.code
17667condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}{true}{}}
17668.endd
17669
17670A multiple condition example, which succeeds:
17671.code
17672condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
17673condition = ${if !eq{${lc:$local_part}}{postmaster}}
17674condition = foobar
17675.endd
17676
17677If the expansion fails (other than forced failure) delivery is deferred. Some
17678of the other precondition options are common special cases that could in fact
17679be specified using &%condition%&.
17680
17681Historical note: We have &%condition%& on ACLs and on Routers. Routers
17682are far older, and use one set of semantics. ACLs are newer and when
17683they were created, the ACL &%condition%& process was given far stricter
17684parse semantics. The &%bool{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
17685ACLs. The &%bool_lax{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
17686Routers. More pointedly, the &%bool_lax{}%& was written to match the existing
17687Router rules processing behavior.
17688
17689This is best illustrated in an example:
17690.code
17691# If used in an ACL condition will fail with a syntax error, but
17692# in a router condition any extra characters are treated as a string
17693
17694$ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:GOOGLE.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
17695true {yes} {no}}
17696
17697$ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:WHOIS.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
17698 {yes} {no}}
17699.endd
17700In each example above, the &%if%& statement actually ends after
17701&"{google.com}}"&. Since no true or false braces were defined, the
17702default &%if%& behavior is to return a boolean true or a null answer
17703(which evaluates to false). The rest of the line is then treated as a
17704string. So the first example resulted in the boolean answer &"true"&
17705with the string &" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it. The second example
17706resulted in the null output (indicating false) with the string
17707&" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it.
17708
17709In fact you can put excess forward braces in too. In the router
17710&%condition%&, Exim's parser only looks for &"{"& symbols when they
17711mean something, like after a &"$"& or when required as part of a
17712conditional. But otherwise &"{"& and &"}"& are treated as ordinary
17713string characters.
17714
17715Thus, in a Router, the above expansion strings will both always evaluate
17716true, as the result of expansion is a non-empty string which doesn't
17717match an explicit false value. This can be tricky to debug. By
17718contrast, in an ACL either of those strings will always result in an
17719expansion error because the result doesn't look sufficiently boolean.
17720
17721
17722.option debug_print routers string&!! unset
17723.cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
17724If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
17725option) or in address-testing mode (see the &%-bt%& command line option),
17726the string is expanded and included in the debugging output.
17727If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
17728output, and Exim carries on processing.
17729This option is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
17730so on when debugging router configurations. For example, if a &%condition%&
17731option appears not to be working, &%debug_print%& can be used to output the
17732variables it references. The output happens after checks for &%domains%&,
17733&%local_parts%&, and &%check_local_user%& but before any other preconditions
17734are tested. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with one.
17735The variable &$router_name$& contains the name of the router.
17736
17737
17738
17739.option disable_logging routers boolean false
17740If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any routing errors
17741or for any deliveries caused by this router. You should not set this option
17742unless you really, really know what you are doing. See also the generic
17743transport option of the same name.
17744
17745.option dnssec_request_domains routers "domain list&!!" unset
17746.cindex "MX record" "security"
17747.cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
17748.cindex "security" "MX lookup"
17749.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
17750DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
17751the dnssec request bit set.
17752This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
17753
17754.option dnssec_require_domains routers "domain list&!!" unset
17755.cindex "MX record" "security"
17756.cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
17757.cindex "security" "MX lookup"
17758.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
17759DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_require_domains%& will be done with
17760the dnssec request bit set. Any returns not having the Authenticated Data bit
17761(AD bit) set will be ignored and logged as a host-lookup failure.
17762This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
17763
17764
17765.option domains routers&!? "domain list&!!" unset
17766.cindex "router" "restricting to specific domains"
17767.vindex "&$domain_data$&"
17768If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the current domain matches
17769the list. If the match is achieved by means of a file lookup, the data that the
17770lookup returned for the domain is placed in &$domain_data$& for use in string
17771expansions of the driver's private options. See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for
17772a list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.
17773
17774
17775
17776.option driver routers string unset
17777This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available routers is
17778to be used.
17779
17780
17781.option dsn_lasthop routers boolean false
17782.cindex "DSN" "success"
17783.cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
17784If this option is set true, and extended DSN (RFC3461) processing is in effect,
17785Exim will not pass on DSN requests to downstream DSN-aware hosts but will
17786instead send a success DSN as if the next hop does not support DSN.
17787Not effective on redirect routers.
17788
17789
17790
17791.option errors_to routers string&!! unset
17792.cindex "envelope sender"
17793.cindex "router" "changing address for errors"
17794If a router successfully handles an address, it may assign the address to a
17795transport for delivery or it may generate child addresses. In both cases, if
17796there is a delivery problem during later processing, the resulting bounce
17797message is sent to the address that results from expanding this string,
17798provided that the address verifies successfully. The &%errors_to%& option is
17799expanded before &%headers_add%&, &%headers_remove%&, and &%transport%&.
17800
17801The &%errors_to%& setting associated with an address can be overridden if it
17802subsequently passes through other routers that have their own &%errors_to%&
17803settings, or if the message is delivered by a transport with a &%return_path%&
17804setting.
17805
17806If &%errors_to%& is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the result of
17807the expansion fails to verify, the errors address associated with the incoming
17808address is used. At top level, this is the envelope sender. A non-forced
17809expansion failure causes delivery to be deferred.
17810
17811If an address for which &%errors_to%& has been set ends up being delivered over
17812SMTP, the envelope sender for that delivery is the &%errors_to%& value, so that
17813any bounces that are generated by other MTAs on the delivery route are also
17814sent there. You can set &%errors_to%& to the empty string by either of these
17815settings:
17816.code
17817errors_to =
17818errors_to = ""
17819.endd
17820An expansion item that yields an empty string has the same effect. If you do
17821this, a locally detected delivery error for addresses processed by this router
17822no longer gives rise to a bounce message; the error is discarded. If the
17823address is delivered to a remote host, the return path is set to &`<>`&, unless
17824overridden by the &%return_path%& option on the transport.
17825
17826.vindex "&$address_data$&"
17827If for some reason you want to discard local errors, but use a non-empty
17828MAIL command for remote delivery, you can preserve the original return
17829path in &$address_data$& in the router, and reinstate it in the transport by
17830setting &%return_path%&.
17831
17832The most common use of &%errors_to%& is to direct mailing list bounces to the
17833manager of the list, as described in section &<<SECTmailinglists>>&, or to
17834implement VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) (see section &<<SECTverp>>&).
17835
17836
17837
17838.option expn routers&!? boolean true
17839.cindex "address" "testing"
17840.cindex "testing" "addresses"
17841.cindex "EXPN" "router skipping"
17842.cindex "router" "skipping for EXPN"
17843If this option is turned off, the router is skipped when testing an address
17844as a result of processing an SMTP EXPN command. You might, for example,
17845want to turn it off on a router for users' &_.forward_& files, while leaving it
17846on for the system alias file.
17847See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17848are evaluated.
17849
17850The use of the SMTP EXPN command is controlled by an ACL (see chapter
17851&<<CHAPACL>>&). When Exim is running an EXPN command, it is similar to testing
17852an address with &%-bt%&. Compare VRFY, whose counterpart is &%-bv%&.
17853
17854
17855
17856.option fail_verify routers boolean false
17857.cindex "router" "forcing verification failure"
17858Setting this option has the effect of setting both &%fail_verify_sender%& and
17859&%fail_verify_recipient%& to the same value.
17860
17861
17862
17863.option fail_verify_recipient routers boolean false
17864If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
17865verifying a recipient, verification fails.
17866
17867
17868
17869.option fail_verify_sender routers boolean false
17870If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
17871verifying a sender, verification fails.
17872
17873
17874
17875.option fallback_hosts routers "string list" unset
17876.cindex "router" "fallback hosts"
17877.cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on router"
17878String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
17879colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses. The list separator can be
17880changed (see section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&), and a port can be specified with
17881each name or address. In fact, the format of each item is exactly the same as
17882defined for the list of hosts in a &(manualroute)& router (see section
17883&<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&).
17884
17885If a router queues an address for a remote transport, this host list is
17886associated with the address, and used instead of the transport's fallback host
17887list. If &%hosts_randomize%& is set on the transport, the order of the list is
17888randomized for each use. See the &%fallback_hosts%& option of the &(smtp)&
17889transport for further details.
17890
17891
17892.option group routers string&!! "see below"
17893.cindex "gid (group id)" "local delivery"
17894.cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
17895.cindex "transport" "local"
17896.cindex "router" "setting group"
17897When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
17898specify a group, the group given here is used when running the delivery
17899process.
17900The group may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
17901error is logged and delivery is deferred.
17902The default is unset, unless &%check_local_user%& is set, when the default
17903is taken from the password information. See also &%initgroups%& and &%user%&
17904and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
17905
17906
17907
17908.option headers_add routers list&!! unset
17909.cindex "header lines" "adding"
17910.cindex "router" "adding header lines"
17911This option specifies a list of text headers,
17912newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way),
17913that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
17914Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
17915option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
17916the text is used to add header lines at transport time is described in section
17917&<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. New header lines are not actually added until the
17918message is in the process of being transported. This means that references to
17919header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration do not
17920&"see"& the added header lines.
17921
17922The &%headers_add%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%&, but before
17923&%headers_remove%& and &%transport%&. If an item is empty, or if
17924an item expansion is forced to fail, the item has no effect. Other expansion
17925failures are treated as configuration errors.
17926
17927Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
17928for a router; all listed headers are added.
17929
17930&*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_add%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
17931router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
17932
17933.cindex "duplicate addresses"
17934.oindex "&%unseen%&"
17935&*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
17936additions are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent routers.
17937For a &%redirect%& router, if a generated address is the same as the incoming
17938address, this can lead to duplicate addresses with different header
17939modifications. Exim does not do duplicate deliveries (except, in certain
17940circumstances, to pipes -- see section &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined
17941which of the duplicates is discarded, so this ambiguous situation should be
17942avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the &%redirect%& router may be of help.
17943
17944
17945
17946.option headers_remove routers list&!! unset
17947.cindex "header lines" "removing"
17948.cindex "router" "removing header lines"
17949This option specifies a list of text headers,
17950colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way),
17951that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
17952Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
17953option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
17954the text is used to remove header lines at transport time is described in
17955section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header lines are not actually removed until
17956the message is in the process of being transported. This means that references
17957to header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration still
17958&"see"& the original header lines.
17959
17960The &%headers_remove%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%& and
17961&%headers_add%&, but before &%transport%&. If an item expansion is forced to fail,
17962the item has no effect. Other expansion failures are treated as configuration
17963errors.
17964
17965Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
17966for a router; all listed headers are removed.
17967
17968&*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_remove%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
17969router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
17970
17971&*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
17972removal requests are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent
17973routers, and this can lead to problems with duplicates -- see the similar
17974warning for &%headers_add%& above.
17975
17976&*Warning 3*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
17977items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
17978To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
17979
17980
17981
17982.option ignore_target_hosts routers "host list&!!" unset
17983.cindex "IP address" "discarding"
17984.cindex "router" "discarding IP addresses"
17985Although this option is a host list, it should normally contain IP address
17986entries rather than names. If any host that is looked up by the router has an
17987IP address that matches an item in this list, Exim behaves as if that IP
17988address did not exist. This option allows you to cope with rogue DNS entries
17989like
17990.code
17991remote.domain.example. A 127.0.0.1
17992.endd
17993by setting
17994.code
17995ignore_target_hosts = 127.0.0.1
17996.endd
17997on the relevant router. If all the hosts found by a &(dnslookup)& router are
17998discarded in this way, the router declines. In a conventional configuration, an
17999attempt to mail to such a domain would normally provoke the &"unrouteable
18000domain"& error, and an attempt to verify an address in the domain would fail.
18001Similarly, if &%ignore_target_hosts%& is set on an &(ipliteral)& router, the
18002router declines if presented with one of the listed addresses.
18003
18004You can use this option to disable the use of IPv4 or IPv6 for mail delivery by
18005means of the first or the second of the following settings, respectively:
18006.code
18007ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0/0
18008ignore_target_hosts = <; 0::0/0
18009.endd
18010The pattern in the first line matches all IPv4 addresses, whereas the pattern
18011in the second line matches all IPv6 addresses.
18012
18013This option may also be useful for ignoring link-local and site-local IPv6
18014addresses. Because, like all host lists, the value of &%ignore_target_hosts%&
18015is expanded before use as a list, it is possible to make it dependent on the
18016domain that is being routed.
18017
18018.vindex "&$host_address$&"
18019During its expansion, &$host_address$& is set to the IP address that is being
18020checked.
18021
18022.option initgroups routers boolean false
18023.cindex "additional groups"
18024.cindex "groups" "additional"
18025.cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
18026.cindex "transport" "local"
18027If the router queues an address for a transport, and this option is true, and
18028the uid supplied by the router is not overridden by the transport, the
18029&[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport to ensure that
18030any additional groups associated with the uid are set up. See also &%group%&
18031and &%user%& and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
18032
18033
18034
18035.option local_part_prefix routers&!? "string list" unset
18036.cindex "router" "prefix for local part"
18037.cindex "prefix" "for local part, used in router"
18038If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the local part starts with
18039one of the given strings, or &%local_part_prefix_optional%& is true. See
18040section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions are
18041evaluated.
18042
18043The list is scanned from left to right, and the first prefix that matches is
18044used. A limited form of wildcard is available; if the prefix begins with an
18045asterisk, it matches the longest possible sequence of arbitrary characters at
18046the start of the local part. An asterisk should therefore always be followed by
18047some character that does not occur in normal local parts.
18048.cindex "multiple mailboxes"
18049.cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
18050Wildcarding can be used to set up multiple user mailboxes, as described in
18051section &<<SECTmulbox>>&.
18052
18053.vindex "&$local_part$&"
18054.vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
18055During the testing of the &%local_parts%& option, and while the router is
18056running, the prefix is removed from the local part, and is available in the
18057expansion variable &$local_part_prefix$&. When a message is being delivered, if
18058the router accepts the address, this remains true during subsequent delivery by
18059a transport. In particular, the local part that is transmitted in the RCPT
18060command for LMTP, SMTP, and BSMTP deliveries has the prefix removed by default.
18061This behaviour can be overridden by setting &%rcpt_include_affixes%& true on
18062the relevant transport.
18063
18064When an address is being verified, &%local_part_prefix%& affects only the
18065behaviour of the router. If the callout feature of verification is in use, this
18066means that the full address, including the prefix, will be used during the
18067callout.
18068
18069The prefix facility is commonly used to handle local parts of the form
18070&%owner-something%&. Another common use is to support local parts of the form
18071&%real-username%& to bypass a user's &_.forward_& file &-- helpful when trying
18072to tell a user their forwarding is broken &-- by placing a router like this one
18073immediately before the router that handles &_.forward_& files:
18074.code
18075real_localuser:
18076 driver = accept
18077 local_part_prefix = real-
18078 check_local_user
18079 transport = local_delivery
18080.endd
18081For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
18082router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
18083.code
18084 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
18085 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
18086.endd
18087
18088If both &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& are set for a router,
18089both conditions must be met if not optional. Care must be taken if wildcards
18090are used in both a prefix and a suffix on the same router. Different
18091separator characters must be used to avoid ambiguity.
18092
18093
18094.option local_part_prefix_optional routers boolean false
18095See &%local_part_prefix%& above.
18096
18097
18098
18099.option local_part_suffix routers&!? "string list" unset
18100.cindex "router" "suffix for local part"
18101.cindex "suffix for local part" "used in router"
18102This option operates in the same way as &%local_part_prefix%&, except that the
18103local part must end (rather than start) with the given string, the
18104&%local_part_suffix_optional%& option determines whether the suffix is
18105mandatory, and the wildcard * character, if present, must be the last
18106character of the suffix. This option facility is commonly used to handle local
18107parts of the form &%something-request%& and multiple user mailboxes of the form
18108&%username-foo%&.
18109
18110
18111.option local_part_suffix_optional routers boolean false
18112See &%local_part_suffix%& above.
18113
18114
18115
18116.option local_parts routers&!? "local part list&!!" unset
18117.cindex "router" "restricting to specific local parts"
18118.cindex "local part" "checking in router"
18119The router is run only if the local part of the address matches the list.
18120See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18121are evaluated, and
18122section &<<SECTlocparlis>>& for a discussion of local part lists. Because the
18123string is expanded, it is possible to make it depend on the domain, for
18124example:
18125.code
18126local_parts = dbm;/usr/local/specials/$domain
18127.endd
18128.vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
18129If the match is achieved by a lookup, the data that the lookup returned
18130for the local part is placed in the variable &$local_part_data$& for use in
18131expansions of the router's private options. You might use this option, for
18132example, if you have a large number of local virtual domains, and you want to
18133send all postmaster mail to the same place without having to set up an alias in
18134each virtual domain:
18135.code
18136postmaster:
18137 driver = redirect
18138 local_parts = postmaster
18139 data = postmaster@real.domain.example
18140.endd
18141
18142
18143.option log_as_local routers boolean "see below"
18144.cindex "log" "delivery line"
18145.cindex "delivery" "log line format"
18146Exim has two logging styles for delivery, the idea being to make local
18147deliveries stand out more visibly from remote ones. In the &"local"& style, the
18148recipient address is given just as the local part, without a domain. The use of
18149this style is controlled by this option. It defaults to true for the &(accept)&
18150router, and false for all the others. This option applies only when a
18151router assigns an address to a transport. It has no effect on routers that
18152redirect addresses.
18153
18154
18155
18156.option more routers boolean&!! true
18157The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
18158that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
18159result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
18160fail, the default value for the option (true) is used. Other failures cause
18161delivery to be deferred.
18162
18163If this option is set false, and the router declines to handle the address, no
18164further routers are tried, routing fails, and the address is bounced.
18165.oindex "&%self%&"
18166However, if the router explicitly passes an address to the following router by
18167means of the setting
18168.code
18169self = pass
18170.endd
18171or otherwise, the setting of &%more%& is ignored. Also, the setting of &%more%&
18172does not affect the behaviour if one of the precondition tests fails. In that
18173case, the address is always passed to the next router.
18174
18175Note that &%address_data%& is not considered to be a precondition. If its
18176expansion is forced to fail, the router declines, and the value of &%more%&
18177controls what happens next.
18178
18179
18180.option pass_on_timeout routers boolean false
18181.cindex "timeout" "of router"
18182.cindex "router" "timeout"
18183If a router times out during a host lookup, it normally causes deferral of the
18184address. If &%pass_on_timeout%& is set, the address is passed on to the next
18185router, overriding &%no_more%&. This may be helpful for systems that are
18186intermittently connected to the Internet, or those that want to pass to a smart
18187host any messages that cannot immediately be delivered.
18188
18189There are occasional other temporary errors that can occur while doing DNS
18190lookups. They are treated in the same way as a timeout, and this option
18191applies to all of them.
18192
18193
18194
18195.option pass_router routers string unset
18196.cindex "router" "go to after &""pass""&"
18197Routers that recognize the generic &%self%& option (&(dnslookup)&,
18198&(ipliteral)&, and &(manualroute)&) are able to return &"pass"&, forcing
18199routing to continue, and overriding a false setting of &%more%&. When one of
18200these routers returns &"pass"&, the address is normally handed on to the next
18201router in sequence. This can be changed by setting &%pass_router%& to the name
18202of another router. However (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router must
18203be below the current router, to avoid loops. Note that this option applies only
18204to the special case of &"pass"&. It does not apply when a router returns
18205&"decline"& because it cannot handle an address.
18206
18207
18208
18209.option redirect_router routers string unset
18210.cindex "router" "start at after redirection"
18211Sometimes an administrator knows that it is pointless to reprocess addresses
18212generated from alias or forward files with the same router again. For
18213example, if an alias file translates real names into login ids there is no
18214point searching the alias file a second time, especially if it is a large file.
18215
18216The &%redirect_router%& option can be set to the name of any router instance.
18217It causes the routing of any generated addresses to start at the named router
18218instead of at the first router. This option has no effect if the router in
18219which it is set does not generate new addresses.
18220
18221
18222
18223.option require_files routers&!? "string list&!!" unset
18224.cindex "file" "requiring for router"
18225.cindex "router" "requiring file existence"
18226This option provides a general mechanism for predicating the running of a
18227router on the existence or non-existence of certain files or directories.
18228Before running a router, as one of its precondition tests, Exim works its way
18229through the &%require_files%& list, expanding each item separately.
18230
18231Because the list is split before expansion, any colons in expansion items must
18232be doubled, or the facility for using a different list separator must be used.
18233If any expansion is forced to fail, the item is ignored. Other expansion
18234failures cause routing of the address to be deferred.
18235
18236If any expanded string is empty, it is ignored. Otherwise, except as described
18237below, each string must be a fully qualified file path, optionally preceded by
18238&"!"&. The paths are passed to the &[stat()]& function to test for the
18239existence of the files or directories. The router is skipped if any paths not
18240preceded by &"!"& do not exist, or if any paths preceded by &"!"& do exist.
18241
18242.cindex "NFS"
18243If &[stat()]& cannot determine whether a file exists or not, delivery of
18244the message is deferred. This can happen when NFS-mounted filesystems are
18245unavailable.
18246
18247This option is checked after the &%domains%&, &%local_parts%&, and &%senders%&
18248options, so you cannot use it to check for the existence of a file in which to
18249look up a domain, local part, or sender. (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a
18250full list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.) However, as
18251these options are all expanded, you can use the &%exists%& expansion condition
18252to make such tests. The &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files
18253that the router may be going to use internally, or which are needed by a
18254transport (for example &_.procmailrc_&).
18255
18256During delivery, the &[stat()]& function is run as root, but there is a
18257facility for some checking of the accessibility of a file by another user.
18258This is not a proper permissions check, but just a &"rough"& check that
18259operates as follows:
18260
18261If an item in a &%require_files%& list does not contain any forward slash
18262characters, it is taken to be the user (and optional group, separated by a
18263comma) to be checked for subsequent files in the list. If no group is specified
18264but the user is specified symbolically, the gid associated with the uid is
18265used. For example:
18266.code
18267require_files = mail:/some/file
18268require_files = $local_part:$home/.procmailrc
18269.endd
18270If a user or group name in a &%require_files%& list does not exist, the
18271&%require_files%& condition fails.
18272
18273Exim performs the check by scanning along the components of the file path, and
18274checking the access for the given uid and gid. It checks for &"x"& access on
18275directories, and &"r"& access on the final file. Note that this means that file
18276access control lists, if the operating system has them, are ignored.
18277
18278&*Warning 1*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an
18279incoming SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. This
18280may affect the result of a &%require_files%& check. In particular, &[stat()]&
18281may yield the error EACCES (&"Permission denied"&). This means that the Exim
18282user is not permitted to read one of the directories on the file's path.
18283
18284&*Warning 2*&: Even when Exim is running as root while delivering a message,
18285&[stat()]& can yield EACCES for a file in an NFS directory that is mounted
18286without root access. In this case, if a check for access by a particular user
18287is requested, Exim creates a subprocess that runs as that user, and tries the
18288check again in that process.
18289
18290The default action for handling an unresolved EACCES is to consider it to
18291be caused by a configuration error, and routing is deferred because the
18292existence or non-existence of the file cannot be determined. However, in some
18293circumstances it may be desirable to treat this condition as if the file did
18294not exist. If the file name (or the exclamation mark that precedes the file
18295name for non-existence) is preceded by a plus sign, the EACCES error is treated
18296as if the file did not exist. For example:
18297.code
18298require_files = +/some/file
18299.endd
18300If the router is not an essential part of verification (for example, it
18301handles users' &_.forward_& files), another solution is to set the &%verify%&
18302option false so that the router is skipped when verifying.
18303
18304
18305
18306.option retry_use_local_part routers boolean "see below"
18307.cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
18308.cindex "local part" "in retry keys"
18309When a delivery suffers a temporary routing failure, a retry record is created
18310in Exim's hints database. For addresses whose routing depends only on the
18311domain, the key for the retry record should not involve the local part, but for
18312other addresses, both the domain and the local part should be included.
18313Usually, remote routing is of the former kind, and local routing is of the
18314latter kind.
18315
18316This option controls whether the local part is used to form the key for retry
18317hints for addresses that suffer temporary errors while being handled by this
18318router. The default value is true for any router that has &%check_local_user%&
18319set, and false otherwise. Note that this option does not apply to hints keys
18320for transport delays; they are controlled by a generic transport option of the
18321same name.
18322
18323The setting of &%retry_use_local_part%& applies only to the router on which it
18324appears. If the router generates child addresses, they are routed
18325independently; this setting does not become attached to them.
18326
18327
18328
18329.option router_home_directory routers string&!! unset
18330.cindex "router" "home directory for"
18331.cindex "home directory" "for router"
18332.vindex "&$home$&"
18333This option sets a home directory for use while the router is running. (Compare
18334&%transport_home_directory%&, which sets a home directory for later
18335transporting.) In particular, if used on a &(redirect)& router, this option
18336sets a value for &$home$& while a filter is running. The value is expanded;
18337forced expansion failure causes the option to be ignored &-- other failures
18338cause the router to defer.
18339
18340Expansion of &%router_home_directory%& happens immediately after the
18341&%check_local_user%& test (if configured), before any further expansions take
18342place.
18343(See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18344are evaluated.)
18345While the router is running, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the value of
18346&$home$& that came from &%check_local_user%&.
18347
18348When a router accepts an address and assigns it to a local transport (including
18349the cases when a &(redirect)& router generates a pipe, file, or autoreply
18350delivery), the home directory setting for the transport is taken from the first
18351of these values that is set:
18352
18353.ilist
18354The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
18355.next
18356The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
18357.next
18358The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
18359.next
18360The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
18361.endlist
18362
18363In other words, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the password data for the
18364router, but not for the transport.
18365
18366
18367
18368.option self routers string freeze
18369.cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
18370.cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
18371This option applies to those routers that use a recipient address to find a
18372list of remote hosts. Currently, these are the &(dnslookup)&, &(ipliteral)&,
18373and &(manualroute)& routers.
18374Certain configurations of the &(queryprogram)& router can also specify a list
18375of remote hosts.
18376Usually such routers are configured to send the message to a remote host via an
18377&(smtp)& transport. The &%self%& option specifies what happens when the first
18378host on the list turns out to be the local host.
18379The way in which Exim checks for the local host is described in section
18380&<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
18381
18382Normally this situation indicates either an error in Exim's configuration (for
18383example, the router should be configured not to process this domain), or an
18384error in the DNS (for example, the MX should not point to this host). For this
18385reason, the default action is to log the incident, defer the address, and
18386freeze the message. The following alternatives are provided for use in special
18387cases:
18388
18389.vlist
18390.vitem &%defer%&
18391Delivery of the message is tried again later, but the message is not frozen.
18392
18393.vitem "&%reroute%&: <&'domain'&>"
18394The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to
18395be reprocessed by the routers. No rewriting of headers takes place. This
18396behaviour is essentially a redirection.
18397
18398.vitem "&%reroute: rewrite:%& <&'domain'&>"
18399The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to be
18400reprocessed by the routers. Any headers that contain the original domain are
18401rewritten.
18402
18403.vitem &%pass%&
18404.oindex "&%more%&"
18405.vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
18406The router passes the address to the next router, or to the router named in the
18407&%pass_router%& option if it is set. This overrides &%no_more%&. During
18408subsequent routing and delivery, the variable &$self_hostname$& contains the
18409name of the local host that the router encountered. This can be used to
18410distinguish between different cases for hosts with multiple names. The
18411combination
18412.code
18413self = pass
18414no_more
18415.endd
18416ensures that only those addresses that routed to the local host are passed on.
18417Without &%no_more%&, addresses that were declined for other reasons would also
18418be passed to the next router.
18419
18420.vitem &%fail%&
18421Delivery fails and an error report is generated.
18422
18423.vitem &%send%&
18424.cindex "local host" "sending to"
18425The anomaly is ignored and the address is queued for the transport. This
18426setting should be used with extreme caution. For an &(smtp)& transport, it
18427makes sense only in cases where the program that is listening on the SMTP port
18428is not this version of Exim. That is, it must be some other MTA, or Exim with a
18429different configuration file that handles the domain in another way.
18430.endlist
18431
18432
18433
18434.option senders routers&!? "address list&!!" unset
18435.cindex "router" "checking senders"
18436If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the message's sender
18437address matches something on the list.
18438See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18439are evaluated.
18440
18441There are issues concerning verification when the running of routers is
18442dependent on the sender. When Exim is verifying the address in an &%errors_to%&
18443setting, it sets the sender to the null string. When using the &%-bt%& option
18444to check a configuration file, it is necessary also to use the &%-f%& option to
18445set an appropriate sender. For incoming mail, the sender is unset when
18446verifying the sender, but is available when verifying any recipients. If the
18447SMTP VRFY command is enabled, it must be used after MAIL if the sender address
18448matters.
18449
18450
18451.option translate_ip_address routers string&!! unset
18452.cindex "IP address" "translating"
18453.cindex "packet radio"
18454.cindex "router" "IP address translation"
18455There exist some rare networking situations (for example, packet radio) where
18456it is helpful to be able to translate IP addresses generated by normal routing
18457mechanisms into other IP addresses, thus performing a kind of manual IP
18458routing. This should be done only if the normal IP routing of the TCP/IP stack
18459is inadequate or broken. Because this is an extremely uncommon requirement, the
18460code to support this option is not included in the Exim binary unless
18461SUPPORT_TRANSLATE_IP_ADDRESS=yes is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
18462
18463.vindex "&$host_address$&"
18464The &%translate_ip_address%& string is expanded for every IP address generated
18465by the router, with the generated address set in &$host_address$&. If the
18466expansion is forced to fail, no action is taken.
18467For any other expansion error, delivery of the message is deferred.
18468If the result of the expansion is an IP address, that replaces the original
18469address; otherwise the result is assumed to be a host name &-- this is looked
18470up using &[gethostbyname()]& (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) to
18471produce one or more replacement IP addresses. For example, to subvert all IP
18472addresses in some specific networks, this could be added to a router:
18473.code
18474translate_ip_address = \
18475 ${lookup{${mask:$host_address/26}}lsearch{/some/file}\
18476 {$value}fail}}
18477.endd
18478The file would contain lines like
18479.code
1848010.2.3.128/26 some.host
1848110.8.4.34/26 10.44.8.15
18482.endd
18483You should not make use of this facility unless you really understand what you
18484are doing.
18485
18486
18487
18488.option transport routers string&!! unset
18489This option specifies the transport to be used when a router accepts an address
18490and sets it up for delivery. A transport is never needed if a router is used
18491only for verification. The value of the option is expanded at routing time,
18492after the expansion of &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&, and &%headers_remove%&,
18493and result must be the name of one of the configured transports. If it is not,
18494delivery is deferred.
18495
18496The &%transport%& option is not used by the &(redirect)& router, but it does
18497have some private options that set up transports for pipe and file deliveries
18498(see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>&).
18499
18500
18501
18502.option transport_current_directory routers string&!! unset
18503.cindex "current directory for local transport"
18504This option associates a current directory with any address that is routed
18505to a local transport. This can happen either because a transport is
18506explicitly configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a
18507file or a pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), this
18508option string is expanded and is set as the current directory, unless
18509overridden by a setting on the transport.
18510If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
18511logged, and delivery is deferred.
18512See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for details of the local delivery
18513environment.
18514
18515
18516
18517
18518.option transport_home_directory routers string&!! "see below"
18519.cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
18520This option associates a home directory with any address that is routed to a
18521local transport. This can happen either because a transport is explicitly
18522configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a file or a
18523pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), the option
18524string is expanded and is set as the home directory, unless overridden by a
18525setting of &%home_directory%& on the transport.
18526If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
18527logged, and delivery is deferred.
18528
18529If the transport does not specify a home directory, and
18530&%transport_home_directory%& is not set for the router, the home directory for
18531the transport is taken from the password data if &%check_local_user%& is set for
18532the router. Otherwise it is taken from &%router_home_directory%& if that option
18533is set; if not, no home directory is set for the transport.
18534
18535See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for further details of the local delivery
18536environment.
18537
18538
18539
18540
18541.option unseen routers boolean&!! false
18542.cindex "router" "carrying on after success"
18543The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
18544that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
18545result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
18546fail, the default value for the option (false) is used. Other failures cause
18547delivery to be deferred.
18548
18549When this option is set true, routing does not cease if the router accepts the
18550address. Instead, a copy of the incoming address is passed to the next router,
18551overriding a false setting of &%more%&. There is little point in setting
18552&%more%& false if &%unseen%& is always true, but it may be useful in cases when
18553the value of &%unseen%& contains expansion items (and therefore, presumably, is
18554sometimes true and sometimes false).
18555
18556.cindex "copy of message (&%unseen%& option)"
18557Setting the &%unseen%& option has a similar effect to the &%unseen%& command
18558qualifier in filter files. It can be used to cause copies of messages to be
18559delivered to some other destination, while also carrying out a normal delivery.
18560In effect, the current address is made into a &"parent"& that has two children
18561&-- one that is delivered as specified by this router, and a clone that goes on
18562to be routed further. For this reason, &%unseen%& may not be combined with the
18563&%one_time%& option in a &(redirect)& router.
18564
18565&*Warning*&: Header lines added to the address (or specified for removal) by
18566this router or by previous routers affect the &"unseen"& copy of the message
18567only. The clone that continues to be processed by further routers starts with
18568no added headers and none specified for removal. For a &%redirect%& router, if
18569a generated address is the same as the incoming address, this can lead to
18570duplicate addresses with different header modifications. Exim does not do
18571duplicate deliveries (except, in certain circumstances, to pipes -- see section
18572&<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined which of the duplicates is discarded,
18573so this ambiguous situation should be avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the
18574&%redirect%& router may be of help.
18575
18576Unlike the handling of header modifications, any data that was set by the
18577&%address_data%& option in the current or previous routers &'is'& passed on to
18578subsequent routers.
18579
18580
18581.option user routers string&!! "see below"
18582.cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
18583.cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
18584.cindex "transport" "local"
18585.cindex "router" "user for filter processing"
18586.cindex "filter" "user for processing"
18587When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
18588specify a user, the user given here is used when running the delivery process.
18589The user may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
18590error is logged and delivery is deferred.
18591This user is also used by the &(redirect)& router when running a filter file.
18592The default is unset, except when &%check_local_user%& is set. In this case,
18593the default is taken from the password information. If the user is specified as
18594a name, and &%group%& is not set, the group associated with the user is used.
18595See also &%initgroups%& and &%group%& and the discussion in chapter
18596&<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
18597
18598
18599
18600.option verify routers&!? boolean true
18601Setting this option has the effect of setting &%verify_sender%& and
18602&%verify_recipient%& to the same value.
18603
18604
18605.option verify_only routers&!? boolean false
18606.cindex "EXPN" "with &%verify_only%&"
18607.oindex "&%-bv%&"
18608.cindex "router" "used only when verifying"
18609If this option is set, the router is used only when verifying an address,
18610delivering in cutthrough mode or
18611testing with the &%-bv%& option, not when actually doing a delivery, testing
18612with the &%-bt%& option, or running the SMTP EXPN command. It can be further
18613restricted to verifying only senders or recipients by means of
18614&%verify_sender%& and &%verify_recipient%&.
18615
18616&*Warning*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an incoming
18617SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. If the router
18618accesses any files, you need to make sure that they are accessible to the Exim
18619user or group.
18620
18621
18622.option verify_recipient routers&!? boolean true
18623If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying recipient
18624addresses,
18625delivering in cutthrough mode
18626or testing recipient verification using &%-bv%&.
18627See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18628are evaluated.
18629See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
18630
18631
18632.option verify_sender routers&!? boolean true
18633If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying sender addresses
18634or testing sender verification using &%-bvs%&.
18635See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18636are evaluated.
18637See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
18638.ecindex IIDgenoprou1
18639.ecindex IIDgenoprou2
18640
18641
18642
18643
18644
18645
18646. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18647. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18648
18649.chapter "The accept router" "CHID4"
18650.cindex "&(accept)& router"
18651.cindex "routers" "&(accept)&"
18652The &(accept)& router has no private options of its own. Unless it is being
18653used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to
18654be defined by the generic &%transport%& option. If the preconditions that are
18655specified by generic options are met, the router accepts the address and queues
18656it for the given transport. The most common use of this router is for setting
18657up deliveries to local mailboxes. For example:
18658.code
18659localusers:
18660 driver = accept
18661 domains = mydomain.example
18662 check_local_user
18663 transport = local_delivery
18664.endd
18665The &%domains%& condition in this example checks the domain of the address, and
18666&%check_local_user%& checks that the local part is the login of a local user.
18667When both preconditions are met, the &(accept)& router runs, and queues the
18668address for the &(local_delivery)& transport.
18669
18670
18671
18672
18673
18674
18675. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18676. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18677
18678.chapter "The dnslookup router" "CHAPdnslookup"
18679.scindex IIDdnsrou1 "&(dnslookup)& router"
18680.scindex IIDdnsrou2 "routers" "&(dnslookup)&"
18681The &(dnslookup)& router looks up the hosts that handle mail for the
18682recipient's domain in the DNS. A transport must always be set for this router,
18683unless &%verify_only%& is set.
18684
18685If SRV support is configured (see &%check_srv%& below), Exim first searches for
18686SRV records. If none are found, or if SRV support is not configured,
18687MX records are looked up. If no MX records exist, address records are sought.
18688However, &%mx_domains%& can be set to disable the direct use of address
18689records.
18690
18691MX records of equal priority are sorted by Exim into a random order. Exim then
18692looks for address records for the host names obtained from MX or SRV records.
18693When a host has more than one IP address, they are sorted into a random order,
18694except that IPv6 addresses are always sorted before IPv4 addresses. If all the
18695IP addresses found are discarded by a setting of the &%ignore_target_hosts%&
18696generic option, the router declines.
18697
18698Unless they have the highest priority (lowest MX value), MX records that point
18699to the local host, or to any host name that matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&,
18700are discarded, together with any other MX records of equal or lower priority.
18701
18702.cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
18703.cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
18704.oindex "&%self%&" "in &(dnslookup)& router"
18705If the host pointed to by the highest priority MX record, or looked up as an
18706address record, is the local host, or matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, what
18707happens is controlled by the generic &%self%& option.
18708
18709
18710.section "Problems with DNS lookups" "SECTprowitdnsloo"
18711There have been problems with DNS servers when SRV records are looked up.
18712Some misbehaving servers return a DNS error or timeout when a non-existent
18713SRV record is sought. Similar problems have in the past been reported for
18714MX records. The global &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& option can help with this
18715problem, but it is heavy-handed because it is a global option.
18716
18717For this reason, there are two options, &%srv_fail_domains%& and
18718&%mx_fail_domains%&, that control what happens when a DNS lookup in a
18719&(dnslookup)& router results in a DNS failure or a &"try again"& response. If
18720an attempt to look up an SRV or MX record causes one of these results, and the
18721domain matches the relevant list, Exim behaves as if the DNS had responded &"no
18722such record"&. In the case of an SRV lookup, this means that the router
18723proceeds to look for MX records; in the case of an MX lookup, it proceeds to
18724look for A or AAAA records, unless the domain matches &%mx_domains%&, in which
18725case routing fails.
18726
18727
18728.section "Declining addresses by dnslookup" "SECTdnslookupdecline"
18729.cindex "&(dnslookup)& router" "declines"
18730There are a few cases where a &(dnslookup)& router will decline to accept
18731an address; if such a router is expected to handle "all remaining non-local
18732domains", then it is important to set &%no_more%&.
18733
18734The router will defer rather than decline if the domain
18735is found in the &%fail_defer_domains%& router option.
18736
18737Reasons for a &(dnslookup)& router to decline currently include:
18738.ilist
18739The domain does not exist in DNS
18740.next
18741The domain exists but the MX record's host part is just "."; this is a common
18742convention (borrowed from SRV) used to indicate that there is no such service
18743for this domain and to not fall back to trying A/AAAA records.
18744.next
18745Ditto, but for SRV records, when &%check_srv%& is set on this router.
18746.next
18747MX record points to a non-existent host.
18748.next
18749MX record points to an IP address and the main section option
18750&%allow_mx_to_ip%& is not set.
18751.next
18752MX records exist and point to valid hosts, but all hosts resolve only to
18753addresses blocked by the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic option on this router.
18754.next
18755The domain is not syntactically valid (see also &%allow_utf8_domains%& and
18756&%dns_check_names_pattern%& for handling one variant of this)
18757.next
18758&%check_secondary_mx%& is set on this router but the local host can
18759not be found in the MX records (see below)
18760.endlist
18761
18762
18763
18764
18765.section "Private options for dnslookup" "SECID118"
18766.cindex "options" "&(dnslookup)& router"
18767The private options for the &(dnslookup)& router are as follows:
18768
18769.option check_secondary_mx dnslookup boolean false
18770.cindex "MX record" "checking for secondary"
18771If this option is set, the router declines unless the local host is found in
18772(and removed from) the list of hosts obtained by MX lookup. This can be used to
18773process domains for which the local host is a secondary mail exchanger
18774differently to other domains. The way in which Exim decides whether a host is
18775the local host is described in section &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
18776
18777
18778.option check_srv dnslookup string&!! unset
18779.cindex "SRV record" "enabling use of"
18780The &(dnslookup)& router supports the use of SRV records (see RFC 2782) in
18781addition to MX and address records. The support is disabled by default. To
18782enable SRV support, set the &%check_srv%& option to the name of the service
18783required. For example,
18784.code
18785check_srv = smtp
18786.endd
18787looks for SRV records that refer to the normal smtp service. The option is
18788expanded, so the service name can vary from message to message or address
18789to address. This might be helpful if SRV records are being used for a
18790submission service. If the expansion is forced to fail, the &%check_srv%&
18791option is ignored, and the router proceeds to look for MX records in the
18792normal way.
18793
18794When the expansion succeeds, the router searches first for SRV records for
18795the given service (it assumes TCP protocol). A single SRV record with a
18796host name that consists of just a single dot indicates &"no such service for
18797this domain"&; if this is encountered, the router declines. If other kinds of
18798SRV record are found, they are used to construct a host list for delivery
18799according to the rules of RFC 2782. MX records are not sought in this case.
18800
18801When no SRV records are found, MX records (and address records) are sought in
18802the traditional way. In other words, SRV records take precedence over MX
18803records, just as MX records take precedence over address records. Note that
18804this behaviour is not sanctioned by RFC 2782, though a previous draft RFC
18805defined it. It is apparently believed that MX records are sufficient for email
18806and that SRV records should not be used for this purpose. However, SRV records
18807have an additional &"weight"& feature which some people might find useful when
18808trying to split an SMTP load between hosts of different power.
18809
18810See section &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& above for a discussion of Exim's behaviour
18811when there is a DNS lookup error.
18812
18813
18814
18815
18816.option fail_defer_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
18817.cindex "MX record" "not found"
18818DNS lookups for domains matching &%fail_defer_domains%&
18819which find no matching record will cause the router to defer
18820rather than the default behaviour of decline.
18821This maybe be useful for queueing messages for a newly created
18822domain while the DNS configuration is not ready.
18823However, it will result in any message with mistyped domains
18824also being queued.
18825
18826
18827.option mx_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
18828.cindex "MX record" "required to exist"
18829.cindex "SRV record" "required to exist"
18830A domain that matches &%mx_domains%& is required to have either an MX or an SRV
18831record in order to be recognized. (The name of this option could be improved.)
18832For example, if all the mail hosts in &'fict.example'& are known to have MX
18833records, except for those in &'discworld.fict.example'&, you could use this
18834setting:
18835.code
18836mx_domains = ! *.discworld.fict.example : *.fict.example
18837.endd
18838This specifies that messages addressed to a domain that matches the list but
18839has no MX record should be bounced immediately instead of being routed using
18840the address record.
18841
18842
18843.option mx_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
18844If the DNS lookup for MX records for one of the domains in this list causes a
18845DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no MX records were found. See section
18846&<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
18847
18848
18849
18850
18851.option qualify_single dnslookup boolean true
18852.cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
18853.cindex "DNS" "qualifying single-component names"
18854When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DEFNAMES is set for DNS
18855lookups. Typically, but not standardly, this causes the resolver to qualify
18856single-component names with the default domain. For example, on a machine
18857called &'dictionary.ref.example'&, the domain &'thesaurus'& would be changed to
18858&'thesaurus.ref.example'& inside the resolver. For details of what your
18859resolver actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and
18860&'resolv.conf'&.
18861
18862
18863
18864.option rewrite_headers dnslookup boolean true
18865.cindex "rewriting" "header lines"
18866.cindex "header lines" "rewriting"
18867If the domain name in the address that is being processed is not fully
18868qualified, it may be expanded to its full form by a DNS lookup. For example, if
18869an address is specified as &'dormouse@teaparty'&, the domain might be
18870expanded to &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. Domain expansion can also
18871occur as a result of setting the &%widen_domains%& option. If
18872&%rewrite_headers%& is true, all occurrences of the abbreviated domain name in
18873any &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-to:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&
18874header lines of the message are rewritten with the full domain name.
18875
18876This option should be turned off only when it is known that no message is
18877ever going to be sent outside an environment where the abbreviation makes
18878sense.
18879
18880When an MX record is looked up in the DNS and matches a wildcard record, name
18881servers normally return a record containing the name that has been looked up,
18882making it impossible to detect whether a wildcard was present or not. However,
18883some name servers have recently been seen to return the wildcard entry. If the
18884name returned by a DNS lookup begins with an asterisk, it is not used for
18885header rewriting.
18886
18887
18888.option same_domain_copy_routing dnslookup boolean false
18889.cindex "address" "copying routing"
18890Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(dnslookup)& router
18891to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the router
18892options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
18893default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
18894servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
18895any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
18896
18897If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
18898domain, and you are using a &(dnslookup)& router which is independent of the
18899local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
18900lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when &(dnslookup)&
18901routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted addresses in the
18902message that have the same domain are automatically given the same routing
18903without processing them independently,
18904provided the following conditions are met:
18905
18906.ilist
18907No router that processed the address specified &%headers_add%& or
18908&%headers_remove%&.
18909.next
18910The router did not change the address in any way, for example, by &"widening"&
18911the domain.
18912.endlist
18913
18914
18915
18916
18917.option search_parents dnslookup boolean false
18918.cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
18919When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DNSRCH is set for DNS
18920lookups. This is different from the &%qualify_single%& option in that it
18921applies to domains containing dots. Typically, but not standardly, it causes
18922the resolver to search for the name in the current domain and in parent
18923domains. For example, on a machine in the &'fict.example'& domain, if looking
18924up &'teaparty.wonderland'& failed, the resolver would try
18925&'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. For details of what your resolver
18926actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and &'resolv.conf'&.
18927
18928Setting this option true can cause problems in domains that have a wildcard MX
18929record, because any domain that does not have its own MX record matches the
18930local wildcard.
18931
18932
18933
18934.option srv_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
18935If the DNS lookup for SRV records for one of the domains in this list causes a
18936DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no SRV records were found. See section
18937&<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
18938
18939
18940
18941
18942.option widen_domains dnslookup "string list" unset
18943.cindex "domain" "partial; widening"
18944If a DNS lookup fails and this option is set, each of its strings in turn is
18945added onto the end of the domain, and the lookup is tried again. For example,
18946if
18947.code
18948widen_domains = fict.example:ref.example
18949.endd
18950is set and a lookup of &'klingon.dictionary'& fails,
18951&'klingon.dictionary.fict.example'& is looked up, and if this fails,
18952&'klingon.dictionary.ref.example'& is tried. Note that the &%qualify_single%&
18953and &%search_parents%& options can cause some widening to be undertaken inside
18954the DNS resolver. &%widen_domains%& is not applied to sender addresses
18955when verifying, unless &%rewrite_headers%& is false (not the default).
18956
18957
18958.section "Effect of qualify_single and search_parents" "SECID119"
18959When a domain from an envelope recipient is changed by the resolver as a result
18960of the &%qualify_single%& or &%search_parents%& options, Exim rewrites the
18961corresponding address in the message's header lines unless &%rewrite_headers%&
18962is set false. Exim then re-routes the address, using the full domain.
18963
18964These two options affect only the DNS lookup that takes place inside the router
18965for the domain of the address that is being routed. They do not affect lookups
18966such as that implied by
18967.code
18968domains = @mx_any
18969.endd
18970that may happen while processing a router precondition before the router is
18971entered. No widening ever takes place for these lookups.
18972.ecindex IIDdnsrou1
18973.ecindex IIDdnsrou2
18974
18975
18976
18977
18978
18979
18980
18981
18982
18983. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18984. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18985
18986.chapter "The ipliteral router" "CHID5"
18987.cindex "&(ipliteral)& router"
18988.cindex "domain literal" "routing"
18989.cindex "routers" "&(ipliteral)&"
18990This router has no private options. Unless it is being used purely for
18991verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to be defined by the
18992generic &%transport%& option. The router accepts the address if its domain part
18993takes the form of an RFC 2822 domain literal. For example, the &(ipliteral)&
18994router handles the address
18995.code
18996root@[192.168.1.1]
18997.endd
18998by setting up delivery to the host with that IP address. IPv4 domain literals
18999consist of an IPv4 address enclosed in square brackets. IPv6 domain literals
19000are similar, but the address is preceded by &`ipv6:`&. For example:
19001.code
19002postmaster@[ipv6:fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678]
19003.endd
19004Exim allows &`ipv4:`& before IPv4 addresses, for consistency, and on the
19005grounds that sooner or later somebody will try it.
19006
19007.oindex "&%self%&" "in &(ipliteral)& router"
19008If the IP address matches something in &%ignore_target_hosts%&, the router
19009declines. If an IP literal turns out to refer to the local host, the generic
19010&%self%& option determines what happens.
19011
19012The RFCs require support for domain literals; however, their use is
19013controversial in today's Internet. If you want to use this router, you must
19014also set the main configuration option &%allow_domain_literals%&. Otherwise,
19015Exim will not recognize the domain literal syntax in addresses.
19016
19017
19018
19019. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19020. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19021
19022.chapter "The iplookup router" "CHID6"
19023.cindex "&(iplookup)& router"
19024.cindex "routers" "&(iplookup)&"
19025The &(iplookup)& router was written to fulfil a specific requirement in
19026Cambridge University (which in fact no longer exists). For this reason, it is
19027not included in the binary of Exim by default. If you want to include it, you
19028must set
19029.code
19030ROUTER_IPLOOKUP=yes
19031.endd
19032in your &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file.
19033
19034The &(iplookup)& router routes an address by sending it over a TCP or UDP
19035connection to one or more specific hosts. The host can then return the same or
19036a different address &-- in effect rewriting the recipient address in the
19037message's envelope. The new address is then passed on to subsequent routers. If
19038this process fails, the address can be passed on to other routers, or delivery
19039can be deferred. Since &(iplookup)& is just a rewriting router, a transport
19040must not be specified for it.
19041
19042.cindex "options" "&(iplookup)& router"
19043.option hosts iplookup string unset
19044This option must be supplied. Its value is a colon-separated list of host
19045names. The hosts are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
19046(or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
19047and are tried in order until one responds to the query. If none respond, what
19048happens is controlled by &%optional%&.
19049
19050
19051.option optional iplookup boolean false
19052If &%optional%& is true, if no response is obtained from any host, the address
19053is passed to the next router, overriding &%no_more%&. If &%optional%& is false,
19054delivery to the address is deferred.
19055
19056
19057.option port iplookup integer 0
19058.cindex "port" "&(iplookup)& router"
19059This option must be supplied. It specifies the port number for the TCP or UDP
19060call.
19061
19062
19063.option protocol iplookup string udp
19064This option can be set to &"udp"& or &"tcp"& to specify which of the two
19065protocols is to be used.
19066
19067
19068.option query iplookup string&!! "see below"
19069This defines the content of the query that is sent to the remote hosts. The
19070default value is:
19071.code
19072$local_part@$domain $local_part@$domain
19073.endd
19074The repetition serves as a way of checking that a response is to the correct
19075query in the default case (see &%response_pattern%& below).
19076
19077
19078.option reroute iplookup string&!! unset
19079If this option is not set, the rerouted address is precisely the byte string
19080returned by the remote host, up to the first white space, if any. If set, the
19081string is expanded to form the rerouted address. It can include parts matched
19082in the response by &%response_pattern%& by means of numeric variables such as
19083&$1$&, &$2$&, etc. The variable &$0$& refers to the entire input string,
19084whether or not a pattern is in use. In all cases, the rerouted address must end
19085up in the form &'local_part@domain'&.
19086
19087
19088.option response_pattern iplookup string unset
19089This option can be set to a regular expression that is applied to the string
19090returned from the remote host. If the pattern does not match the response, the
19091router declines. If &%response_pattern%& is not set, no checking of the
19092response is done, unless the query was defaulted, in which case there is a
19093check that the text returned after the first white space is the original
19094address. This checks that the answer that has been received is in response to
19095the correct question. For example, if the response is just a new domain, the
19096following could be used:
19097.code
19098response_pattern = ^([^@]+)$
19099reroute = $local_part@$1
19100.endd
19101
19102.option timeout iplookup time 5s
19103This specifies the amount of time to wait for a response from the remote
19104machine. The same timeout is used for the &[connect()]& function for a TCP
19105call. It does not apply to UDP.
19106
19107
19108
19109
19110. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19111. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19112
19113.chapter "The manualroute router" "CHID7"
19114.scindex IIDmanrou1 "&(manualroute)& router"
19115.scindex IIDmanrou2 "routers" "&(manualroute)&"
19116.cindex "domain" "manually routing"
19117The &(manualroute)& router is so-called because it provides a way of manually
19118routing an address according to its domain. It is mainly used when you want to
19119route addresses to remote hosts according to your own rules, bypassing the
19120normal DNS routing that looks up MX records. However, &(manualroute)& can also
19121route to local transports, a facility that may be useful if you want to save
19122messages for dial-in hosts in local files.
19123
19124The &(manualroute)& router compares a list of domain patterns with the domain
19125it is trying to route. If there is no match, the router declines. Each pattern
19126has associated with it a list of hosts and some other optional data, which may
19127include a transport. The combination of a pattern and its data is called a
19128&"routing rule"&. For patterns that do not have an associated transport, the
19129generic &%transport%& option must specify a transport, unless the router is
19130being used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&).
19131
19132.vindex "&$host$&"
19133In the case of verification, matching the domain pattern is sufficient for the
19134router to accept the address. When actually routing an address for delivery,
19135an address that matches a domain pattern is queued for the associated
19136transport. If the transport is not a local one, a host list must be associated
19137with the pattern; IP addresses are looked up for the hosts, and these are
19138passed to the transport along with the mail address. For local transports, a
19139host list is optional. If it is present, it is passed in &$host$& as a single
19140text string.
19141
19142The list of routing rules can be provided as an inline string in
19143&%route_list%&, or the data can be obtained by looking up the domain in a file
19144or database by setting &%route_data%&. Only one of these settings may appear in
19145any one instance of &(manualroute)&. The format of routing rules is described
19146below, following the list of private options.
19147
19148
19149.section "Private options for manualroute" "SECTprioptman"
19150
19151.cindex "options" "&(manualroute)& router"
19152The private options for the &(manualroute)& router are as follows:
19153
19154.option host_all_ignored manualroute string defer
19155See &%host_find_failed%&.
19156
19157.option host_find_failed manualroute string freeze
19158This option controls what happens when &(manualroute)& tries to find an IP
19159address for a host, and the host does not exist. The option can be set to one
19160of the following values:
19161.code
19162decline
19163defer
19164fail
19165freeze
19166ignore
19167pass
19168.endd
19169The default (&"freeze"&) assumes that this state is a serious configuration
19170error. The difference between &"pass"& and &"decline"& is that the former
19171forces the address to be passed to the next router (or the router defined by
19172&%pass_router%&),
19173.oindex "&%more%&"
19174overriding &%no_more%&, whereas the latter passes the address to the next
19175router only if &%more%& is true.
19176
19177The value &"ignore"& causes Exim to completely ignore a host whose IP address
19178cannot be found. If all the hosts in the list are ignored, the behaviour is
19179controlled by the &%host_all_ignored%& option. This takes the same values
19180as &%host_find_failed%&, except that it cannot be set to &"ignore"&.
19181
19182The &%host_find_failed%& option applies only to a definite &"does not exist"&
19183state; if a host lookup gets a temporary error, delivery is deferred unless the
19184generic &%pass_on_timeout%& option is set.
19185
19186
19187.option hosts_randomize manualroute boolean false
19188.cindex "randomized host list"
19189.cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
19190If this option is set, the order of the items in a host list in a routing rule
19191is randomized each time the list is used, unless an option in the routing rule
19192overrides (see below). Randomizing the order of a host list can be used to do
19193crude load sharing. However, if more than one mail address is routed by the
19194same router to the same host list, the host lists are considered to be the same
19195(even though they may be randomized into different orders) for the purpose of
19196deciding whether to batch the deliveries into a single SMTP transaction.
19197
19198When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split
19199into groups whose order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to
19200set up MX-like behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an
19201item that is just &`+`& in the host list. For example:
19202.code
19203route_list = * host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
19204.endd
19205The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
19206randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
19207If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored. If a
19208randomized host list is passed to an &(smtp)& transport that also has
19209&%hosts_randomize set%&, the list is not re-randomized.
19210
19211
19212.option route_data manualroute string&!! unset
19213If this option is set, it must expand to yield the data part of a routing rule.
19214Typically, the expansion string includes a lookup based on the domain. For
19215example:
19216.code
19217route_data = ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/etc/routes}}
19218.endd
19219If the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the
19220router declines. Other kinds of expansion failure cause delivery to be
19221deferred.
19222
19223
19224.option route_list manualroute "string list" unset
19225This string is a list of routing rules, in the form defined below. Note that,
19226unlike most string lists, the items are separated by semicolons. This is so
19227that they may contain colon-separated host lists.
19228
19229
19230.option same_domain_copy_routing manualroute boolean false
19231.cindex "address" "copying routing"
19232Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(manualroute)&
19233router to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the
19234router options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
19235default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
19236servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
19237any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
19238
19239If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
19240domain, and you are using a &(manualroute)& router which is independent of the
19241local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
19242lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when
19243&(manualroute)& routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted
19244addresses in the message that have the same domain are automatically given the
19245same routing without processing them independently. However, this is only done
19246if &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& are unset.
19247
19248
19249
19250
19251.section "Routing rules in route_list" "SECID120"
19252The value of &%route_list%& is a string consisting of a sequence of routing
19253rules, separated by semicolons. If a semicolon is needed in a rule, it can be
19254entered as two semicolons. Alternatively, the list separator can be changed as
19255described (for colon-separated lists) in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
19256Empty rules are ignored. The format of each rule is
19257.display
19258<&'domain pattern'&> <&'list of hosts'&> <&'options'&>
19259.endd
19260The following example contains two rules, each with a simple domain pattern and
19261no options:
19262.code
19263route_list = \
19264 dict.ref.example mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example ; \
19265 thes.ref.example mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
19266.endd
19267The three parts of a rule are separated by white space. The pattern and the
19268list of hosts can be enclosed in quotes if necessary, and if they are, the
19269usual quoting rules apply. Each rule in a &%route_list%& must start with a
19270single domain pattern, which is the only mandatory item in the rule. The
19271pattern is in the same format as one item in a domain list (see section
19272&<<SECTdomainlist>>&),
19273except that it may not be the name of an interpolated file.
19274That is, it may be wildcarded, or a regular expression, or a file or database
19275lookup (with semicolons doubled, because of the use of semicolon as a separator
19276in a &%route_list%&).
19277
19278The rules in &%route_list%& are searched in order until one of the patterns
19279matches the domain that is being routed. The list of hosts and then options are
19280then used as described below. If there is no match, the router declines. When
19281&%route_list%& is set, &%route_data%& must not be set.
19282
19283
19284
19285.section "Routing rules in route_data" "SECID121"
19286The use of &%route_list%& is convenient when there are only a small number of
19287routing rules. For larger numbers, it is easier to use a file or database to
19288hold the routing information, and use the &%route_data%& option instead.
19289The value of &%route_data%& is a list of hosts, followed by (optional) options.
19290Most commonly, &%route_data%& is set as a string that contains an
19291expansion lookup. For example, suppose we place two routing rules in a file
19292like this:
19293.code
19294dict.ref.example: mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example
19295thes.ref.example: mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
19296.endd
19297This data can be accessed by setting
19298.code
19299route_data = ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/the/file/name}}
19300.endd
19301Failure of the lookup results in an empty string, causing the router to
19302decline. However, you do not have to use a lookup in &%route_data%&. The only
19303requirement is that the result of expanding the string is a list of hosts,
19304possibly followed by options, separated by white space. The list of hosts must
19305be enclosed in quotes if it contains white space.
19306
19307
19308
19309
19310.section "Format of the list of hosts" "SECID122"
19311A list of hosts, whether obtained via &%route_data%& or &%route_list%&, is
19312always separately expanded before use. If the expansion fails, the router
19313declines. The result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list of names
19314and/or IP addresses, optionally also including ports. The format of each item
19315in the list is described in the next section. The list separator can be changed
19316as described in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
19317
19318If the list of hosts was obtained from a &%route_list%& item, the following
19319variables are set during its expansion:
19320
19321.ilist
19322.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(manualroute)& router"
19323If the domain was matched against a regular expression, the numeric variables
19324&$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set. For example:
19325.code
19326route_list = ^domain(\d+) host-$1.text.example
19327.endd
19328.next
19329&$0$& is always set to the entire domain.
19330.next
19331&$1$& is also set when partial matching is done in a file lookup.
19332
19333.next
19334.vindex "&$value$&"
19335If the pattern that matched the domain was a lookup item, the data that was
19336looked up is available in the expansion variable &$value$&. For example:
19337.code
19338route_list = lsearch;;/some/file.routes $value
19339.endd
19340.endlist
19341
19342Note the doubling of the semicolon in the pattern that is necessary because
19343semicolon is the default route list separator.
19344
19345
19346
19347.section "Format of one host item" "SECTformatonehostitem"
19348Each item in the list of hosts is either a host name or an IP address,
19349optionally with an attached port number. When no port is given, an IP address
19350is not enclosed in brackets. When a port is specified, it overrides the port
19351specification on the transport. The port is separated from the name or address
19352by a colon. This leads to some complications:
19353
19354.ilist
19355Because colon is the default separator for the list of hosts, either
19356the colon that specifies a port must be doubled, or the list separator must
19357be changed. The following two examples have the same effect:
19358.code
19359route_list = * "host1.tld::1225 : host2.tld::1226"
19360route_list = * "<+ host1.tld:1225 + host2.tld:1226"
19361.endd
19362.next
19363When IPv6 addresses are involved, it gets worse, because they contain
19364colons of their own. To make this case easier, it is permitted to
19365enclose an IP address (either v4 or v6) in square brackets if a port
19366number follows. For example:
19367.code
19368route_list = * "</ [10.1.1.1]:1225 / [::1]:1226"
19369.endd
19370.endlist
19371
19372.section "How the list of hosts is used" "SECThostshowused"
19373When an address is routed to an &(smtp)& transport by &(manualroute)&, each of
19374the hosts is tried, in the order specified, when carrying out the SMTP
19375delivery. However, the order can be changed by setting the &%hosts_randomize%&
19376option, either on the router (see section &<<SECTprioptman>>& above), or on the
19377transport.
19378
19379Hosts may be listed by name or by IP address. An unadorned name in the list of
19380hosts is interpreted as a host name. A name that is followed by &`/MX`& is
19381interpreted as an indirection to a sublist of hosts obtained by looking up MX
19382records in the DNS. For example:
19383.code
19384route_list = * x.y.z:p.q.r/MX:e.f.g
19385.endd
19386If this feature is used with a port specifier, the port must come last. For
19387example:
19388.code
19389route_list = * dom1.tld/mx::1225
19390.endd
19391If the &%hosts_randomize%& option is set, the order of the items in the list is
19392randomized before any lookups are done. Exim then scans the list; for any name
19393that is not followed by &`/MX`& it looks up an IP address. If this turns out to
19394be an interface on the local host and the item is not the first in the list,
19395Exim discards it and any subsequent items. If it is the first item, what
19396happens is controlled by the
19397.oindex "&%self%&" "in &(manualroute)& router"
19398&%self%& option of the router.
19399
19400A name on the list that is followed by &`/MX`& is replaced with the list of
19401hosts obtained by looking up MX records for the name. This is always a DNS
19402lookup; the &%bydns%& and &%byname%& options (see section &<<SECThowoptused>>&
19403below) are not relevant here. The order of these hosts is determined by the
19404preference values in the MX records, according to the usual rules. Because
19405randomizing happens before the MX lookup, it does not affect the order that is
19406defined by MX preferences.
19407
19408If the local host is present in the sublist obtained from MX records, but is
19409not the most preferred host in that list, it and any equally or less
19410preferred hosts are removed before the sublist is inserted into the main list.
19411
19412If the local host is the most preferred host in the MX list, what happens
19413depends on where in the original list of hosts the &`/MX`& item appears. If it
19414is not the first item (that is, there are previous hosts in the main list),
19415Exim discards this name and any subsequent items in the main list.
19416
19417If the MX item is first in the list of hosts, and the local host is the
19418most preferred host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& option of the
19419router.
19420
19421DNS failures when lookup up the MX records are treated in the same way as DNS
19422failures when looking up IP addresses: &%pass_on_timeout%& and
19423&%host_find_failed%& are used when relevant.
19424
19425The generic &%ignore_target_hosts%& option applies to all hosts in the list,
19426whether obtained from an MX lookup or not.
19427
19428
19429
19430.section "How the options are used" "SECThowoptused"
19431The options are a sequence of words; in practice no more than three are ever
19432present. One of the words can be the name of a transport; this overrides the
19433&%transport%& option on the router for this particular routing rule only. The
19434other words (if present) control randomization of the list of hosts on a
19435per-rule basis, and how the IP addresses of the hosts are to be found when
19436routing to a remote transport. These options are as follows:
19437
19438.ilist
19439&%randomize%&: randomize the order of the hosts in this list, overriding the
19440setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
19441.next
19442&%no_randomize%&: do not randomize the order of the hosts in this list,
19443overriding the setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
19444.next
19445&%byname%&: use &[getipnodebyname()]& (&[gethostbyname()]& on older systems) to
19446find IP addresses. This function may ultimately cause a DNS lookup, but it may
19447also look in &_/etc/hosts_& or other sources of information.
19448.next
19449&%bydns%&: look up address records for the hosts directly in the DNS; fail if
19450no address records are found. If there is a temporary DNS error (such as a
19451timeout), delivery is deferred.
19452.endlist
19453
19454For example:
19455.code
19456route_list = domain1 host1:host2:host3 randomize bydns;\
19457 domain2 host4:host5
19458.endd
19459If neither &%byname%& nor &%bydns%& is given, Exim behaves as follows: First, a
19460DNS lookup is done. If this yields anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that
19461result is used. Otherwise, Exim goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]&
19462or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the result of the lookup is the result of that
19463call.
19464
19465&*Warning*&: It has been discovered that on some systems, if a DNS lookup
19466called via &[getipnodebyname()]& times out, HOST_NOT_FOUND is returned
19467instead of TRY_AGAIN. That is why the default action is to try a DNS
19468lookup first. Only if that gives a definite &"no such host"& is the local
19469function called.
19470
19471
19472
19473If no IP address for a host can be found, what happens is controlled by the
19474&%host_find_failed%& option.
19475
19476.vindex "&$host$&"
19477When an address is routed to a local transport, IP addresses are not looked up.
19478The host list is passed to the transport in the &$host$& variable.
19479
19480
19481
19482.section "Manualroute examples" "SECID123"
19483In some of the examples that follow, the presence of the &%remote_smtp%&
19484transport, as defined in the default configuration file, is assumed:
19485
19486.ilist
19487.cindex "smart host" "example router"
19488The &(manualroute)& router can be used to forward all external mail to a
19489&'smart host'&. If you have set up, in the main part of the configuration, a
19490named domain list that contains your local domains, for example:
19491.code
19492domainlist local_domains = my.domain.example
19493.endd
19494You can arrange for all other domains to be routed to a smart host by making
19495your first router something like this:
19496.code
19497smart_route:
19498 driver = manualroute
19499 domains = !+local_domains
19500 transport = remote_smtp
19501 route_list = * smarthost.ref.example
19502.endd
19503This causes all non-local addresses to be sent to the single host
19504&'smarthost.ref.example'&. If a colon-separated list of smart hosts is given,
19505they are tried in order
19506(but you can use &%hosts_randomize%& to vary the order each time).
19507Another way of configuring the same thing is this:
19508.code
19509smart_route:
19510 driver = manualroute
19511 transport = remote_smtp
19512 route_list = !+local_domains smarthost.ref.example
19513.endd
19514There is no difference in behaviour between these two routers as they stand.
19515However, they behave differently if &%no_more%& is added to them. In the first
19516example, the router is skipped if the domain does not match the &%domains%&
19517precondition; the following router is always tried. If the router runs, it
19518always matches the domain and so can never decline. Therefore, &%no_more%&
19519would have no effect. In the second case, the router is never skipped; it
19520always runs. However, if it doesn't match the domain, it declines. In this case
19521&%no_more%& would prevent subsequent routers from running.
19522
19523.next
19524.cindex "mail hub example"
19525A &'mail hub'& is a host which receives mail for a number of domains via MX
19526records in the DNS and delivers it via its own private routing mechanism. Often
19527the final destinations are behind a firewall, with the mail hub being the one
19528machine that can connect to machines both inside and outside the firewall. The
19529&(manualroute)& router is usually used on a mail hub to route incoming messages
19530to the correct hosts. For a small number of domains, the routing can be inline,
19531using the &%route_list%& option, but for a larger number a file or database
19532lookup is easier to manage.
19533
19534If the domain names are in fact the names of the machines to which the mail is
19535to be sent by the mail hub, the configuration can be quite simple. For
19536example:
19537.code
19538hub_route:
19539 driver = manualroute
19540 transport = remote_smtp
19541 route_list = *.rhodes.tvs.example $domain
19542.endd
19543This configuration routes domains that match &`*.rhodes.tvs.example`& to hosts
19544whose names are the same as the mail domains. A similar approach can be taken
19545if the host name can be obtained from the domain name by a string manipulation
19546that the expansion facilities can handle. Otherwise, a lookup based on the
19547domain can be used to find the host:
19548.code
19549through_firewall:
19550 driver = manualroute
19551 transport = remote_smtp
19552 route_data = ${lookup {$domain} cdb {/internal/host/routes}}
19553.endd
19554The result of the lookup must be the name or IP address of the host (or
19555hosts) to which the address is to be routed. If the lookup fails, the route
19556data is empty, causing the router to decline. The address then passes to the
19557next router.
19558
19559.next
19560.cindex "batched SMTP output example"
19561.cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing; example"
19562You can use &(manualroute)& to deliver messages to pipes or files in batched
19563SMTP format for onward transportation by some other means. This is one way of
19564storing mail for a dial-up host when it is not connected. The route list entry
19565can be as simple as a single domain name in a configuration like this:
19566.code
19567save_in_file:
19568 driver = manualroute
19569 transport = batchsmtp_appendfile
19570 route_list = saved.domain.example
19571.endd
19572though often a pattern is used to pick up more than one domain. If there are
19573several domains or groups of domains with different transport requirements,
19574different transports can be listed in the routing information:
19575.code
19576save_in_file:
19577 driver = manualroute
19578 route_list = \
19579 *.saved.domain1.example $domain batch_appendfile; \
19580 *.saved.domain2.example \
19581 ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/domain2/hosts}{$value}fail} \
19582 batch_pipe
19583.endd
19584.vindex "&$domain$&"
19585.vindex "&$host$&"
19586The first of these just passes the domain in the &$host$& variable, which
19587doesn't achieve much (since it is also in &$domain$&), but the second does a
19588file lookup to find a value to pass, causing the router to decline to handle
19589the address if the lookup fails.
19590
19591.next
19592.cindex "UUCP" "example of router for"
19593Routing mail directly to UUCP software is a specific case of the use of
19594&(manualroute)& in a gateway to another mail environment. This is an example of
19595one way it can be done:
19596.code
19597# Transport
19598uucp:
19599 driver = pipe
19600 user = nobody
19601 command = /usr/local/bin/uux -r - \
19602 ${substr_-5:$host}!rmail ${local_part}
19603 return_fail_output = true
19604
19605# Router
19606uucphost:
19607 transport = uucp
19608 driver = manualroute
19609 route_data = \
19610 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/usr/local/exim/uucphosts}}
19611.endd
19612The file &_/usr/local/exim/uucphosts_& contains entries like
19613.code
19614darksite.ethereal.example: darksite.UUCP
19615.endd
19616It can be set up more simply without adding and removing &".UUCP"& but this way
19617makes clear the distinction between the domain name
19618&'darksite.ethereal.example'& and the UUCP host name &'darksite'&.
19619.endlist
19620.ecindex IIDmanrou1
19621.ecindex IIDmanrou2
19622
19623
19624
19625
19626
19627
19628
19629
19630. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19631. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19632
19633.chapter "The queryprogram router" "CHAPdriverlast"
19634.scindex IIDquerou1 "&(queryprogram)& router"
19635.scindex IIDquerou2 "routers" "&(queryprogram)&"
19636.cindex "routing" "by external program"
19637The &(queryprogram)& router routes an address by running an external command
19638and acting on its output. This is an expensive way to route, and is intended
19639mainly for use in lightly-loaded systems, or for performing experiments.
19640However, if it is possible to use the precondition options (&%domains%&,
19641&%local_parts%&, etc) to skip this router for most addresses, it could sensibly
19642be used in special cases, even on a busy host. There are the following private
19643options:
19644.cindex "options" "&(queryprogram)& router"
19645
19646.option command queryprogram string&!! unset
19647This option must be set. It specifies the command that is to be run. The
19648command is split up into a command name and arguments, and then each is
19649expanded separately (exactly as for a &(pipe)& transport, described in chapter
19650&<<CHAPpipetransport>>&).
19651
19652
19653.option command_group queryprogram string unset
19654.cindex "gid (group id)" "in &(queryprogram)& router"
19655This option specifies a gid to be set when running the command while routing an
19656address for deliver. It must be set if &%command_user%& specifies a numerical
19657uid. If it begins with a digit, it is interpreted as the numerical value of the
19658gid. Otherwise it is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&.
19659
19660
19661.option command_user queryprogram string unset
19662.cindex "uid (user id)" "for &(queryprogram)&"
19663This option must be set. It specifies the uid which is set when running the
19664command while routing an address for delivery. If the value begins with a digit,
19665it is interpreted as the numerical value of the uid. Otherwise, it is looked up
19666using &[getpwnam()]& to obtain a value for the uid and, if &%command_group%& is
19667not set, a value for the gid also.
19668
19669&*Warning:*& Changing uid and gid is possible only when Exim is running as
19670root, which it does during a normal delivery in a conventional configuration.
19671However, when an address is being verified during message reception, Exim is
19672usually running as the Exim user, not as root. If the &(queryprogram)& router
19673is called from a non-root process, Exim cannot change uid or gid before running
19674the command. In this circumstance the command runs under the current uid and
19675gid.
19676
19677
19678.option current_directory queryprogram string /
19679This option specifies an absolute path which is made the current directory
19680before running the command.
19681
19682
19683.option timeout queryprogram time 1h
19684If the command does not complete within the timeout period, its process group
19685is killed and the message is frozen. A value of zero time specifies no
19686timeout.
19687
19688
19689The standard output of the command is connected to a pipe, which is read when
19690the command terminates. It should consist of a single line of output,
19691containing up to five fields, separated by white space. The maximum length of
19692the line is 1023 characters. Longer lines are silently truncated. The first
19693field is one of the following words (case-insensitive):
19694
19695.ilist
19696&'Accept'&: routing succeeded; the remaining fields specify what to do (see
19697below).
19698.next
19699&'Decline'&: the router declines; pass the address to the next router, unless
19700&%no_more%& is set.
19701.next
19702&'Fail'&: routing failed; do not pass the address to any more routers. Any
19703subsequent text on the line is an error message. If the router is run as part
19704of address verification during an incoming SMTP message, the message is
19705included in the SMTP response.
19706.next
19707&'Defer'&: routing could not be completed at this time; try again later. Any
19708subsequent text on the line is an error message which is logged. It is not
19709included in any SMTP response.
19710.next
19711&'Freeze'&: the same as &'defer'&, except that the message is frozen.
19712.next
19713&'Pass'&: pass the address to the next router (or the router specified by
19714&%pass_router%&), overriding &%no_more%&.
19715.next
19716&'Redirect'&: the message is redirected. The remainder of the line is a list of
19717new addresses, which are routed independently, starting with the first router,
19718or the router specified by &%redirect_router%&, if set.
19719.endlist
19720
19721When the first word is &'accept'&, the remainder of the line consists of a
19722number of keyed data values, as follows (split into two lines here, to fit on
19723the page):
19724.code
19725ACCEPT TRANSPORT=<transport> HOSTS=<list of hosts>
19726LOOKUP=byname|bydns DATA=<text>
19727.endd
19728The data items can be given in any order, and all are optional. If no transport
19729is included, the transport specified by the generic &%transport%& option is
19730used. The list of hosts and the lookup type are needed only if the transport is
19731an &(smtp)& transport that does not itself supply a list of hosts.
19732
19733The format of the list of hosts is the same as for the &(manualroute)& router.
19734As well as host names and IP addresses with optional port numbers, as described
19735in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&, it may contain names followed by
19736&`/MX`& to specify sublists of hosts that are obtained by looking up MX records
19737(see section &<<SECThostshowused>>&).
19738
19739If the lookup type is not specified, Exim behaves as follows when trying to
19740find an IP address for each host: First, a DNS lookup is done. If this yields
19741anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that result is used. Otherwise, Exim
19742goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]& or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the
19743result of the lookup is the result of that call.
19744
19745.vindex "&$address_data$&"
19746If the DATA field is set, its value is placed in the &$address_data$&
19747variable. For example, this return line
19748.code
19749accept hosts=x1.y.example:x2.y.example data="rule1"
19750.endd
19751routes the address to the default transport, passing a list of two hosts. When
19752the transport runs, the string &"rule1"& is in &$address_data$&.
19753.ecindex IIDquerou1
19754.ecindex IIDquerou2
19755
19756
19757
19758
19759. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19760. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19761
19762.chapter "The redirect router" "CHAPredirect"
19763.scindex IIDredrou1 "&(redirect)& router"
19764.scindex IIDredrou2 "routers" "&(redirect)&"
19765.cindex "alias file" "in a &(redirect)& router"
19766.cindex "address redirection" "&(redirect)& router"
19767The &(redirect)& router handles several kinds of address redirection. Its most
19768common uses are for resolving local part aliases from a central alias file
19769(usually called &_/etc/aliases_&) and for handling users' personal &_.forward_&
19770files, but it has many other potential uses. The incoming address can be
19771redirected in several different ways:
19772
19773.ilist
19774It can be replaced by one or more new addresses which are themselves routed
19775independently.
19776.next
19777It can be routed to be delivered to a given file or directory.
19778.next
19779It can be routed to be delivered to a specified pipe command.
19780.next
19781It can cause an automatic reply to be generated.
19782.next
19783It can be forced to fail, optionally with a custom error message.
19784.next
19785It can be temporarily deferred, optionally with a custom message.
19786.next
19787It can be discarded.
19788.endlist
19789
19790The generic &%transport%& option must not be set for &(redirect)& routers.
19791However, there are some private options which define transports for delivery to
19792files and pipes, and for generating autoreplies. See the &%file_transport%&,
19793&%pipe_transport%& and &%reply_transport%& descriptions below.
19794
19795If success DSNs have been requested
19796.cindex "DSN" "success"
19797.cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
19798redirection triggers one and the DSN options are not passed any further.
19799
19800
19801
19802.section "Redirection data" "SECID124"
19803The router operates by interpreting a text string which it obtains either by
19804expanding the contents of the &%data%& option, or by reading the entire
19805contents of a file whose name is given in the &%file%& option. These two
19806options are mutually exclusive. The first is commonly used for handling system
19807aliases, in a configuration like this:
19808.code
19809system_aliases:
19810 driver = redirect
19811 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
19812.endd
19813If the lookup fails, the expanded string in this example is empty. When the
19814expansion of &%data%& results in an empty string, the router declines. A forced
19815expansion failure also causes the router to decline; other expansion failures
19816cause delivery to be deferred.
19817
19818A configuration using &%file%& is commonly used for handling users'
19819&_.forward_& files, like this:
19820.code
19821userforward:
19822 driver = redirect
19823 check_local_user
19824 file = $home/.forward
19825 no_verify
19826.endd
19827If the file does not exist, or causes no action to be taken (for example, it is
19828empty or consists only of comments), the router declines. &*Warning*&: This
19829is not the case when the file contains syntactically valid items that happen to
19830yield empty addresses, for example, items containing only RFC 2822 address
19831comments.
19832
19833
19834
19835.section "Forward files and address verification" "SECID125"
19836.cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
19837It is usual to set &%no_verify%& on &(redirect)& routers which handle users'
19838&_.forward_& files, as in the example above. There are two reasons for this:
19839
19840.ilist
19841When Exim is receiving an incoming SMTP message from a remote host, it is
19842running under the Exim uid, not as root. Exim is unable to change uid to read
19843the file as the user, and it may not be able to read it as the Exim user. So in
19844practice the router may not be able to operate.
19845.next
19846However, even when the router can operate, the existence of a &_.forward_& file
19847is unimportant when verifying an address. What should be checked is whether the
19848local part is a valid user name or not. Cutting out the redirection processing
19849saves some resources.
19850.endlist
19851
19852
19853
19854
19855
19856
19857.section "Interpreting redirection data" "SECID126"
19858.cindex "Sieve filter" "specifying in redirection data"
19859.cindex "filter" "specifying in redirection data"
19860The contents of the data string, whether obtained from &%data%& or &%file%&,
19861can be interpreted in two different ways:
19862
19863.ilist
19864If the &%allow_filter%& option is set true, and the data begins with the text
19865&"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, it is interpreted as a list of
19866&'filtering'& instructions in the form of an Exim or Sieve filter file,
19867respectively. Details of the syntax and semantics of filter files are described
19868in a separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&; this
19869document is intended for use by end users.
19870.next
19871Otherwise, the data must be a comma-separated list of redirection items, as
19872described in the next section.
19873.endlist
19874
19875When a message is redirected to a file (a &"mail folder"&), the file name given
19876in a non-filter redirection list must always be an absolute path. A filter may
19877generate a relative path &-- how this is handled depends on the transport's
19878configuration. See section &<<SECTfildiropt>>& for a discussion of this issue
19879for the &(appendfile)& transport.
19880
19881
19882
19883.section "Items in a non-filter redirection list" "SECTitenonfilred"
19884.cindex "address redirection" "non-filter list items"
19885When the redirection data is not an Exim or Sieve filter, for example, if it
19886comes from a conventional alias or forward file, it consists of a list of
19887addresses, file names, pipe commands, or certain special items (see section
19888&<<SECTspecitredli>>& below). The special items can be individually enabled or
19889disabled by means of options whose names begin with &%allow_%& or &%forbid_%&,
19890depending on their default values. The items in the list are separated by
19891commas or newlines.
19892If a comma is required in an item, the entire item must be enclosed in double
19893quotes.
19894
19895Lines starting with a # character are comments, and are ignored, and # may
19896also appear following a comma, in which case everything between the # and the
19897next newline character is ignored.
19898
19899If an item is entirely enclosed in double quotes, these are removed. Otherwise
19900double quotes are retained because some forms of mail address require their use
19901(but never to enclose the entire address). In the following description,
19902&"item"& refers to what remains after any surrounding double quotes have been
19903removed.
19904
19905.vindex "&$local_part$&"
19906&*Warning*&: If you use an Exim expansion to construct a redirection address,
19907and the expansion contains a reference to &$local_part$&, you should make use
19908of the &%quote_local_part%& expansion operator, in case the local part contains
19909special characters. For example, to redirect all mail for the domain
19910&'obsolete.example'&, retaining the existing local part, you could use this
19911setting:
19912.code
19913data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@newdomain.example
19914.endd
19915
19916
19917.section "Redirecting to a local mailbox" "SECTredlocmai"
19918.cindex "routing" "loops in"
19919.cindex "loop" "while routing, avoidance of"
19920.cindex "address redirection" "to local mailbox"
19921A redirection item may safely be the same as the address currently under
19922consideration. This does not cause a routing loop, because a router is
19923automatically skipped if any ancestor of the address that is being processed
19924is the same as the current address and was processed by the current router.
19925Such an address is therefore passed to the following routers, so it is handled
19926as if there were no redirection. When making this loop-avoidance test, the
19927complete local part, including any prefix or suffix, is used.
19928
19929.cindex "address redirection" "local part without domain"
19930Specifying the same local part without a domain is a common usage in personal
19931filter files when the user wants to have messages delivered to the local
19932mailbox and also forwarded elsewhere. For example, the user whose login is
19933&'cleo'& might have a &_.forward_& file containing this:
19934.code
19935cleo, cleopatra@egypt.example
19936.endd
19937.cindex "backslash in alias file"
19938.cindex "alias file" "backslash in"
19939For compatibility with other MTAs, such unqualified local parts may be
19940preceded by &"\"&, but this is not a requirement for loop prevention. However,
19941it does make a difference if more than one domain is being handled
19942synonymously.
19943
19944If an item begins with &"\"& and the rest of the item parses as a valid RFC
199452822 address that does not include a domain, the item is qualified using the
19946domain of the incoming address. In the absence of a leading &"\"&, unqualified
19947addresses are qualified using the value in &%qualify_recipient%&, but you can
19948force the incoming domain to be used by setting &%qualify_preserve_domain%&.
19949
19950Care must be taken if there are alias names for local users.
19951Consider an MTA handling a single local domain where the system alias file
19952contains:
19953.code
19954Sam.Reman: spqr
19955.endd
19956Now suppose that Sam (whose login id is &'spqr'&) wants to save copies of
19957messages in the local mailbox, and also forward copies elsewhere. He creates
19958this forward file:
19959.code
19960Sam.Reman, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
19961.endd
19962With these settings, an incoming message addressed to &'Sam.Reman'& fails. The
19963&(redirect)& router for system aliases does not process &'Sam.Reman'& the
19964second time round, because it has previously routed it,
19965and the following routers presumably cannot handle the alias. The forward file
19966should really contain
19967.code
19968spqr, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
19969.endd
19970but because this is such a common error, the &%check_ancestor%& option (see
19971below) exists to provide a way to get round it. This is normally set on a
19972&(redirect)& router that is handling users' &_.forward_& files.
19973
19974
19975
19976.section "Special items in redirection lists" "SECTspecitredli"
19977In addition to addresses, the following types of item may appear in redirection
19978lists (that is, in non-filter redirection data):
19979
19980.ilist
19981.cindex "pipe" "in redirection list"
19982.cindex "address redirection" "to pipe"
19983An item is treated as a pipe command if it begins with &"|"& and does not parse
19984as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. A transport for running the
19985command must be specified by the &%pipe_transport%& option.
19986Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
19987which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
19988
19989Single or double quotes can be used for enclosing the individual arguments of
19990the pipe command; no interpretation of escapes is done for single quotes. If
19991the command contains a comma character, it is necessary to put the whole item
19992in double quotes, for example:
19993.code
19994"|/some/command ready,steady,go"
19995.endd
19996since items in redirection lists are terminated by commas. Do not, however,
19997quote just the command. An item such as
19998.code
19999|"/some/command ready,steady,go"
20000.endd
20001is interpreted as a pipe with a rather strange command name, and no arguments.
20002
20003Note that the above example assumes that the text comes from a lookup source
20004of some sort, so that the quotes are part of the data. If composing a
20005redirect router with a &%data%& option directly specifying this command, the
20006quotes will be used by the configuration parser to define the extent of one
20007string, but will not be passed down into the redirect router itself. There
20008are two main approaches to get around this: escape quotes to be part of the
20009data itself, or avoid using this mechanism and instead create a custom
20010transport with the &%command%& option set and reference that transport from
20011an &%accept%& router.
20012
20013.next
20014.cindex "file" "in redirection list"
20015.cindex "address redirection" "to file"
20016An item is interpreted as a path name if it begins with &"/"& and does not
20017parse as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. For example,
20018.code
20019/home/world/minbari
20020.endd
20021is treated as a file name, but
20022.code
20023/s=molari/o=babylon/@x400gate.way
20024.endd
20025is treated as an address. For a file name, a transport must be specified using
20026the &%file_transport%& option. However, if the generated path name ends with a
20027forward slash character, it is interpreted as a directory name rather than a
20028file name, and &%directory_transport%& is used instead.
20029
20030Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
20031which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
20032
20033.cindex "&_/dev/null_&"
20034However, if a redirection item is the path &_/dev/null_&, delivery to it is
20035bypassed at a high level, and the log entry shows &"**bypassed**"&
20036instead of a transport name. In this case the user and group are not used.
20037
20038.next
20039.cindex "included address list"
20040.cindex "address redirection" "included external list"
20041If an item is of the form
20042.code
20043:include:<path name>
20044.endd
20045a list of further items is taken from the given file and included at that
20046point. &*Note*&: Such a file can not be a filter file; it is just an
20047out-of-line addition to the list. The items in the included list are separated
20048by commas or newlines and are not subject to expansion. If this is the first
20049item in an alias list in an &(lsearch)& file, a colon must be used to terminate
20050the alias name. This example is incorrect:
20051.code
20052list1 :include:/opt/lists/list1
20053.endd
20054It must be given as
20055.code
20056list1: :include:/opt/lists/list1
20057.endd
20058.next
20059.cindex "address redirection" "to black hole"
20060.cindex "delivery" "discard"
20061.cindex "delivery" "blackhole"
20062.cindex "black hole"
20063.cindex "abandoning mail"
20064Sometimes you want to throw away mail to a particular local part. Making the
20065&%data%& option expand to an empty string does not work, because that causes
20066the router to decline. Instead, the alias item
20067.code
20068:blackhole:
20069.endd
20070can be used. It does what its name implies. No delivery is
20071done, and no error message is generated. This has the same effect as specifying
20072&_/dev/null_& as a destination, but it can be independently disabled.
20073
20074&*Warning*&: If &':blackhole:'& appears anywhere in a redirection list, no
20075delivery is done for the original local part, even if other redirection items
20076are present. If you are generating a multi-item list (for example, by reading a
20077database) and need the ability to provide a no-op item, you must use
20078&_/dev/null_&.
20079
20080.next
20081.cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
20082.cindex "delivery" "forcing deferral"
20083.cindex "failing delivery" "forcing"
20084.cindex "deferred delivery, forcing"
20085.cindex "customizing" "failure message"
20086An attempt to deliver a particular address can be deferred or forced to fail by
20087redirection items of the form
20088.code
20089:defer:
20090:fail:
20091.endd
20092respectively. When a redirection list contains such an item, it applies
20093to the entire redirection; any other items in the list are ignored. Any
20094text following &':fail:'& or &':defer:'& is placed in the error text
20095associated with the failure. For example, an alias file might contain:
20096.code
20097X.Employee: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
20098.endd
20099In the case of an address that is being verified from an ACL or as the subject
20100of a
20101.cindex "VRFY" "error text, display of"
20102VRFY command, the text is included in the SMTP error response by
20103default.
20104.cindex "EXPN" "error text, display of"
20105The text is not included in the response to an EXPN command. In non-SMTP cases
20106the text is included in the error message that Exim generates.
20107
20108.cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
20109By default, Exim sends a 451 SMTP code for a &':defer:'&, and 550 for
20110&':fail:'&. However, if the message starts with three digits followed by a
20111space, optionally followed by an extended code of the form &'n.n.n'&, also
20112followed by a space, and the very first digit is the same as the default error
20113code, the code from the message is used instead. If the very first digit is
20114incorrect, a panic error is logged, and the default code is used. You can
20115suppress the use of the supplied code in a redirect router by setting the
20116&%forbid_smtp_code%& option true. In this case, any SMTP code is quietly
20117ignored.
20118
20119.vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
20120In an ACL, an explicitly provided message overrides the default, but the
20121default message is available in the variable &$acl_verify_message$& and can
20122therefore be included in a custom message if this is desired.
20123
20124Normally the error text is the rest of the redirection list &-- a comma does
20125not terminate it &-- but a newline does act as a terminator. Newlines are not
20126normally present in alias expansions. In &(lsearch)& lookups they are removed
20127as part of the continuation process, but they may exist in other kinds of
20128lookup and in &':include:'& files.
20129
20130During routing for message delivery (as opposed to verification), a redirection
20131containing &':fail:'& causes an immediate failure of the incoming address,
20132whereas &':defer:'& causes the message to remain on the queue so that a
20133subsequent delivery attempt can happen at a later time. If an address is
20134deferred for too long, it will ultimately fail, because the normal retry
20135rules still apply.
20136
20137.next
20138.cindex "alias file" "exception to default"
20139Sometimes it is useful to use a single-key search type with a default (see
20140chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&) to look up aliases. However, there may be a need
20141for exceptions to the default. These can be handled by aliasing them to
20142&':unknown:'&. This differs from &':fail:'& in that it causes the &(redirect)&
20143router to decline, whereas &':fail:'& forces routing to fail. A lookup which
20144results in an empty redirection list has the same effect.
20145.endlist
20146
20147
20148.section "Duplicate addresses" "SECTdupaddr"
20149.cindex "duplicate addresses"
20150.cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
20151.cindex "pipe" "duplicated"
20152Exim removes duplicate addresses from the list to which it is delivering, so as
20153to deliver just one copy to each address. This does not apply to deliveries
20154routed to pipes by different immediate parent addresses, but an indirect
20155aliasing scheme of the type
20156.code
20157pipe: |/some/command $local_part
20158localpart1: pipe
20159localpart2: pipe
20160.endd
20161does not work with a message that is addressed to both local parts, because
20162when the second is aliased to the intermediate local part &"pipe"& it gets
20163discarded as being the same as a previously handled address. However, a scheme
20164such as
20165.code
20166localpart1: |/some/command $local_part
20167localpart2: |/some/command $local_part
20168.endd
20169does result in two different pipe deliveries, because the immediate parents of
20170the pipes are distinct.
20171
20172
20173
20174.section "Repeated redirection expansion" "SECID128"
20175.cindex "repeated redirection expansion"
20176.cindex "address redirection" "repeated for each delivery attempt"
20177When a message cannot be delivered to all of its recipients immediately,
20178leading to two or more delivery attempts, redirection expansion is carried out
20179afresh each time for those addresses whose children were not all previously
20180delivered. If redirection is being used as a mailing list, this can lead to new
20181members of the list receiving copies of old messages. The &%one_time%& option
20182can be used to avoid this.
20183
20184
20185.section "Errors in redirection lists" "SECID129"
20186.cindex "address redirection" "errors"
20187If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, a malformed address that causes a parsing
20188error is skipped, and an entry is written to the main log. This may be useful
20189for mailing lists that are automatically managed. Otherwise, if an error is
20190detected while generating the list of new addresses, the original address is
20191deferred. See also &%syntax_errors_to%&.
20192
20193
20194
20195.section "Private options for the redirect router" "SECID130"
20196
20197.cindex "options" "&(redirect)& router"
20198The private options for the &(redirect)& router are as follows:
20199
20200
20201.option allow_defer redirect boolean false
20202Setting this option allows the use of &':defer:'& in non-filter redirection
20203data, or the &%defer%& command in an Exim filter file.
20204
20205
20206.option allow_fail redirect boolean false
20207.cindex "failing delivery" "from filter"
20208If this option is true, the &':fail:'& item can be used in a redirection list,
20209and the &%fail%& command may be used in an Exim filter file.
20210
20211
20212.option allow_filter redirect boolean false
20213.cindex "filter" "enabling use of"
20214.cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling use of"
20215Setting this option allows Exim to interpret redirection data that starts with
20216&"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"& as a set of filtering instructions. There
20217are some features of Exim filter files that some administrators may wish to
20218lock out; see the &%forbid_filter_%&&'xxx'& options below.
20219
20220It is also possible to lock out Exim filters or Sieve filters while allowing
20221the other type; see &%forbid_exim_filter%& and &%forbid_sieve_filter%&.
20222
20223
20224The filter is run using the uid and gid set by the generic &%user%& and
20225&%group%& options. These take their defaults from the password data if
20226&%check_local_user%& is set, so in the normal case of users' personal filter
20227files, the filter is run as the relevant user. When &%allow_filter%& is set
20228true, Exim insists that either &%check_local_user%& or &%user%& is set.
20229
20230
20231
20232.option allow_freeze redirect boolean false
20233.cindex "freezing messages" "allowing in filter"
20234Setting this option allows the use of the &%freeze%& command in an Exim filter.
20235This command is more normally encountered in system filters, and is disabled by
20236default for redirection filters because it isn't something you usually want to
20237let ordinary users do.
20238
20239
20240
20241.option check_ancestor redirect boolean false
20242This option is concerned with handling generated addresses that are the same
20243as some address in the list of redirection ancestors of the current address.
20244Although it is turned off by default in the code, it is set in the default
20245configuration file for handling users' &_.forward_& files. It is recommended
20246for this use of the &(redirect)& router.
20247
20248When &%check_ancestor%& is set, if a generated address (including the domain)
20249is the same as any ancestor of the current address, it is replaced by a copy of
20250the current address. This helps in the case where local part A is aliased to B,
20251and B has a &_.forward_& file pointing back to A. For example, within a single
20252domain, the local part &"Joe.Bloggs"& is aliased to &"jb"& and
20253&_&~jb/.forward_& contains:
20254.code
20255\Joe.Bloggs, <other item(s)>
20256.endd
20257Without the &%check_ancestor%& setting, either local part (&"jb"& or
20258&"joe.bloggs"&) gets processed once by each router and so ends up as it was
20259originally. If &"jb"& is the real mailbox name, mail to &"jb"& gets delivered
20260(having been turned into &"joe.bloggs"& by the &_.forward_& file and back to
20261&"jb"& by the alias), but mail to &"joe.bloggs"& fails. Setting
20262&%check_ancestor%& on the &(redirect)& router that handles the &_.forward_&
20263file prevents it from turning &"jb"& back into &"joe.bloggs"& when that was the
20264original address. See also the &%repeat_use%& option below.
20265
20266
20267.option check_group redirect boolean "see below"
20268When the &%file%& option is used, the group owner of the file is checked only
20269when this option is set. The permitted groups are those listed in the
20270&%owngroups%& option, together with the user's default group if
20271&%check_local_user%& is set. If the file has the wrong group, routing is
20272deferred. The default setting for this option is true if &%check_local_user%&
20273is set and the &%modemask%& option permits the group write bit, or if the
20274&%owngroups%& option is set. Otherwise it is false, and no group check occurs.
20275
20276
20277
20278.option check_owner redirect boolean "see below"
20279When the &%file%& option is used, the owner of the file is checked only when
20280this option is set. If &%check_local_user%& is set, the local user is
20281permitted; otherwise the owner must be one of those listed in the &%owners%&
20282option. The default value for this option is true if &%check_local_user%& or
20283&%owners%& is set. Otherwise the default is false, and no owner check occurs.
20284
20285
20286.option data redirect string&!! unset
20287This option is mutually exclusive with &%file%&. One or other of them must be
20288set, but not both. The contents of &%data%& are expanded, and then used as the
20289list of forwarding items, or as a set of filtering instructions. If the
20290expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string or a string that
20291has no effect (consists entirely of comments), the router declines.
20292
20293When filtering instructions are used, the string must begin with &"#Exim
20294filter"&, and all comments in the string, including this initial one, must be
20295terminated with newline characters. For example:
20296.code
20297data = #Exim filter\n\
20298 if $h_to: contains Exim then save $home/mail/exim endif
20299.endd
20300If you are reading the data from a database where newlines cannot be included,
20301you can use the &${sg}$& expansion item to turn the escape string of your
20302choice into a newline.
20303
20304
20305.option directory_transport redirect string&!! unset
20306A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a directory when a path name
20307ending with a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
20308specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
20309configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport.
20310
20311
20312.option file redirect string&!! unset
20313This option specifies the name of a file that contains the redirection data. It
20314is mutually exclusive with the &%data%& option. The string is expanded before
20315use; if the expansion is forced to fail, the router declines. Other expansion
20316failures cause delivery to be deferred. The result of a successful expansion
20317must be an absolute path. The entire file is read and used as the redirection
20318data. If the data is an empty string or a string that has no effect (consists
20319entirely of comments), the router declines.
20320
20321.cindex "NFS" "checking for file existence"
20322If the attempt to open the file fails with a &"does not exist"& error, Exim
20323runs a check on the containing directory,
20324unless &%ignore_enotdir%& is true (see below).
20325If the directory does not appear to exist, delivery is deferred. This can
20326happen when users' &_.forward_& files are in NFS-mounted directories, and there
20327is a mount problem. If the containing directory does exist, but the file does
20328not, the router declines.
20329
20330
20331.option file_transport redirect string&!! unset
20332.vindex "&$address_file$&"
20333A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a file when a path name not
20334ending in a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
20335specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
20336configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport. When
20337it is running, the file name is in &$address_file$&.
20338
20339
20340.option filter_prepend_home redirect boolean true
20341When this option is true, if a &(save)& command in an Exim filter specifies a
20342relative path, and &$home$& is defined, it is automatically prepended to the
20343relative path. If this option is set false, this action does not happen. The
20344relative path is then passed to the transport unmodified.
20345
20346
20347.option forbid_blackhole redirect boolean false
20348.cindex "restricting access to features"
20349.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20350If this option is true, the &':blackhole:'& item may not appear in a
20351redirection list.
20352
20353
20354.option forbid_exim_filter redirect boolean false
20355.cindex "restricting access to features"
20356.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20357If this option is set true, only Sieve filters are permitted when
20358&%allow_filter%& is true.
20359
20360
20361
20362
20363.option forbid_file redirect boolean false
20364.cindex "restricting access to features"
20365.cindex "delivery" "to file; forbidding"
20366.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20367.cindex "Sieve filter" "forbidding delivery to a file"
20368.cindex "Sieve filter" "&""keep""& facility; disabling"
20369If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address that
20370specifies delivery to a local file or directory, either from a filter or from a
20371conventional forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is
20372set. It applies to Sieve filters as well as to Exim filters, but if true, it
20373locks out the Sieve's &"keep"& facility.
20374
20375
20376.option forbid_filter_dlfunc redirect boolean false
20377.cindex "restricting access to features"
20378.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20379If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
20380make use of the &%dlfunc%& expansion facility to run dynamically loaded
20381functions.
20382
20383.option forbid_filter_existstest redirect boolean false
20384.cindex "restricting access to features"
20385.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20386.cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
20387If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
20388make use of the &%exists%& condition or the &%stat%& expansion item.
20389
20390.option forbid_filter_logwrite redirect boolean false
20391.cindex "restricting access to features"
20392.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20393If this option is true, use of the logging facility in Exim filters is not
20394permitted. Logging is in any case available only if the filter is being run
20395under some unprivileged uid (which is normally the case for ordinary users'
20396&_.forward_& files).
20397
20398
20399.option forbid_filter_lookup redirect boolean false
20400.cindex "restricting access to features"
20401.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20402If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
20403to make use of &%lookup%& items.
20404
20405
20406.option forbid_filter_perl redirect boolean false
20407.cindex "restricting access to features"
20408.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20409This option has an effect only if Exim is built with embedded Perl support. If
20410it is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed to make use
20411of the embedded Perl support.
20412
20413
20414.option forbid_filter_readfile redirect boolean false
20415.cindex "restricting access to features"
20416.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20417If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
20418to make use of &%readfile%& items.
20419
20420
20421.option forbid_filter_readsocket redirect boolean false
20422.cindex "restricting access to features"
20423.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20424If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
20425to make use of &%readsocket%& items.
20426
20427
20428.option forbid_filter_reply redirect boolean false
20429.cindex "restricting access to features"
20430.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20431If this option is true, this router may not generate an automatic reply
20432message. Automatic replies can be generated only from Exim or Sieve filter
20433files, not from traditional forward files. This option is forced to be true if
20434&%one_time%& is set.
20435
20436
20437.option forbid_filter_run redirect boolean false
20438.cindex "restricting access to features"
20439.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20440If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
20441to make use of &%run%& items.
20442
20443
20444.option forbid_include redirect boolean false
20445.cindex "restricting access to features"
20446.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20447If this option is true, items of the form
20448.code
20449:include:<path name>
20450.endd
20451are not permitted in non-filter redirection lists.
20452
20453
20454.option forbid_pipe redirect boolean false
20455.cindex "restricting access to features"
20456.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20457.cindex "delivery" "to pipe; forbidding"
20458If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address which
20459specifies delivery to a pipe, either from an Exim filter or from a conventional
20460forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is set.
20461
20462
20463.option forbid_sieve_filter redirect boolean false
20464.cindex "restricting access to features"
20465.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20466If this option is set true, only Exim filters are permitted when
20467&%allow_filter%& is true.
20468
20469
20470.cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
20471.option forbid_smtp_code redirect boolean false
20472If this option is set true, any SMTP error codes that are present at the start
20473of messages specified for &`:defer:`& or &`:fail:`& are quietly ignored, and
20474the default codes (451 and 550, respectively) are always used.
20475
20476
20477
20478
20479.option hide_child_in_errmsg redirect boolean false
20480.cindex "bounce message" "redirection details; suppressing"
20481If this option is true, it prevents Exim from quoting a child address if it
20482generates a bounce or delay message for it. Instead it says &"an address
20483generated from <&'the top level address'&>"&. Of course, this applies only to
20484bounces generated locally. If a message is forwarded to another host, &'its'&
20485bounce may well quote the generated address.
20486
20487
20488.option ignore_eacces redirect boolean false
20489.cindex "EACCES"
20490If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
20491EACCES error (permission denied), the &(redirect)& router behaves as if the
20492file did not exist.
20493
20494
20495.option ignore_enotdir redirect boolean false
20496.cindex "ENOTDIR"
20497If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
20498ENOTDIR error (something on the path is not a directory), the &(redirect)&
20499router behaves as if the file did not exist.
20500
20501Setting &%ignore_enotdir%& has another effect as well: When a &(redirect)&
20502router that has the &%file%& option set discovers that the file does not exist
20503(the ENOENT error), it tries to &[stat()]& the parent directory, as a check
20504against unmounted NFS directories. If the parent can not be statted, delivery
20505is deferred. However, it seems wrong to do this check when &%ignore_enotdir%&
20506is set, because that option tells Exim to ignore &"something on the path is not
20507a directory"& (the ENOTDIR error). This is a confusing area, because it seems
20508that some operating systems give ENOENT where others give ENOTDIR.
20509
20510
20511
20512.option include_directory redirect string unset
20513If this option is set, the path names of any &':include:'& items in a
20514redirection list must start with this directory.
20515
20516
20517.option modemask redirect "octal integer" 022
20518This specifies mode bits which must not be set for a file specified by the
20519&%file%& option. If any of the forbidden bits are set, delivery is deferred.
20520
20521
20522.option one_time redirect boolean false
20523.cindex "one-time aliasing/forwarding expansion"
20524.cindex "alias file" "one-time expansion"
20525.cindex "forward file" "one-time expansion"
20526.cindex "mailing lists" "one-time expansion"
20527.cindex "address redirection" "one-time expansion"
20528Sometimes the fact that Exim re-evaluates aliases and reprocesses redirection
20529files each time it tries to deliver a message causes a problem when one or more
20530of the generated addresses fails be delivered at the first attempt. The problem
20531is not one of duplicate delivery &-- Exim is clever enough to handle that &--
20532but of what happens when the redirection list changes during the time that the
20533message is on Exim's queue. This is particularly true in the case of mailing
20534lists, where new subscribers might receive copies of messages that were posted
20535before they subscribed.
20536
20537If &%one_time%& is set and any addresses generated by the router fail to
20538deliver at the first attempt, the failing addresses are added to the message as
20539&"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
20540&"delivered"&. Thus, redirection does not happen again at the next delivery
20541attempt.
20542
20543&*Warning 1*&: Any header line addition or removal that is specified by this
20544router would be lost if delivery did not succeed at the first attempt. For this
20545reason, the &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& generic options are not
20546permitted when &%one_time%& is set.
20547
20548&*Warning 2*&: To ensure that the router generates only addresses (as opposed
20549to pipe or file deliveries or auto-replies) &%forbid_file%&, &%forbid_pipe%&,
20550and &%forbid_filter_reply%& are forced to be true when &%one_time%& is set.
20551
20552&*Warning 3*&: The &%unseen%& generic router option may not be set with
20553&%one_time%&.
20554
20555The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
20556addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
20557addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if
20558&%all_parents%& log selector is set. It is expected that &%one_time%& will
20559typically be used for mailing lists, where there is normally just one level of
20560expansion.
20561
20562
20563.option owners redirect "string list" unset
20564.cindex "ownership" "alias file"
20565.cindex "ownership" "forward file"
20566.cindex "alias file" "ownership"
20567.cindex "forward file" "ownership"
20568This specifies a list of permitted owners for the file specified by &%file%&.
20569This list is in addition to the local user when &%check_local_user%& is set.
20570See &%check_owner%& above.
20571
20572
20573.option owngroups redirect "string list" unset
20574This specifies a list of permitted groups for the file specified by &%file%&.
20575The list is in addition to the local user's primary group when
20576&%check_local_user%& is set. See &%check_group%& above.
20577
20578
20579.option pipe_transport redirect string&!! unset
20580.vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
20581A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a pipe when a string
20582starting with a vertical bar character is specified as a new &"address"&. The
20583transport used is specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the
20584name of a configured transport. This should normally be a &(pipe)& transport.
20585When the transport is run, the pipe command is in &$address_pipe$&.
20586
20587
20588.option qualify_domain redirect string&!! unset
20589.vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
20590If this option is set, and an unqualified address (one without a domain) is
20591generated, and that address would normally be qualified by the global setting
20592in &%qualify_recipient%&, it is instead qualified with the domain specified by
20593expanding this string. If the expansion fails, the router declines. If you want
20594to revert to the default, you can have the expansion generate
20595&$qualify_recipient$&.
20596
20597This option applies to all unqualified addresses generated by Exim filters,
20598but for traditional &_.forward_& files, it applies only to addresses that are
20599not preceded by a backslash. Sieve filters cannot generate unqualified
20600addresses.
20601
20602.option qualify_preserve_domain redirect boolean false
20603.cindex "domain" "in redirection; preserving"
20604.cindex "preserving domain in redirection"
20605.cindex "address redirection" "domain; preserving"
20606If this option is set, the router's local &%qualify_domain%& option must not be
20607set (a configuration error occurs if it is). If an unqualified address (one
20608without a domain) is generated, it is qualified with the domain of the parent
20609address (the immediately preceding ancestor) instead of the global
20610&%qualify_recipient%& value. In the case of a traditional &_.forward_& file,
20611this applies whether or not the address is preceded by a backslash.
20612
20613
20614.option repeat_use redirect boolean true
20615If this option is set false, the router is skipped for a child address that has
20616any ancestor that was routed by this router. This test happens before any of
20617the other preconditions are tested. Exim's default anti-looping rules skip
20618only when the ancestor is the same as the current address. See also
20619&%check_ancestor%& above and the generic &%redirect_router%& option.
20620
20621
20622.option reply_transport redirect string&!! unset
20623A &(redirect)& router sets up an automatic reply when a &%mail%& or
20624&%vacation%& command is used in a filter file. The transport used is specified
20625by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a configured
20626transport. This should normally be an &(autoreply)& transport. Other transports
20627are unlikely to do anything sensible or useful.
20628
20629
20630.option rewrite redirect boolean true
20631.cindex "address redirection" "disabling rewriting"
20632If this option is set false, addresses generated by the router are not
20633subject to address rewriting. Otherwise, they are treated like new addresses
20634and are rewritten according to the global rewriting rules.
20635
20636
20637.option sieve_subaddress redirect string&!! unset
20638The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the
20639:subaddress part of an address.
20640
20641.option sieve_useraddress redirect string&!! unset
20642The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the :user part
20643of an address. However, if it is unset, the entire original local part
20644(including any prefix or suffix) is used for :user.
20645
20646
20647.option sieve_vacation_directory redirect string&!! unset
20648.cindex "Sieve filter" "vacation directory"
20649To enable the &"vacation"& extension for Sieve filters, you must set
20650&%sieve_vacation_directory%& to the directory where vacation databases are held
20651(do not put anything else in that directory), and ensure that the
20652&%reply_transport%& option refers to an &(autoreply)& transport. Each user
20653needs their own directory; Exim will create it if necessary.
20654
20655
20656
20657.option skip_syntax_errors redirect boolean false
20658.cindex "forward file" "broken"
20659.cindex "address redirection" "broken files"
20660.cindex "alias file" "broken"
20661.cindex "broken alias or forward files"
20662.cindex "ignoring faulty addresses"
20663.cindex "skipping faulty addresses"
20664.cindex "error" "skipping bad syntax"
20665If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, syntactically malformed addresses in
20666non-filter redirection data are skipped, and each failing address is logged. If
20667&%syntax_errors_to%& is set, a message is sent to the address it defines,
20668giving details of the failures. If &%syntax_errors_text%& is set, its contents
20669are expanded and placed at the head of the error message generated by
20670&%syntax_errors_to%&. Usually it is appropriate to set &%syntax_errors_to%& to
20671be the same address as the generic &%errors_to%& option. The
20672&%skip_syntax_errors%& option is often used when handling mailing lists.
20673
20674If all the addresses in a redirection list are skipped because of syntax
20675errors, the router declines to handle the original address, and it is passed to
20676the following routers.
20677
20678If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set when an Exim filter is interpreted, any syntax
20679error in the filter causes filtering to be abandoned without any action being
20680taken. The incident is logged, and the router declines to handle the address,
20681so it is passed to the following routers.
20682
20683.cindex "Sieve filter" "syntax errors in"
20684Syntax errors in a Sieve filter file cause the &"keep"& action to occur. This
20685action is specified by RFC 3028. The values of &%skip_syntax_errors%&,
20686&%syntax_errors_to%&, and &%syntax_errors_text%& are not used.
20687
20688&%skip_syntax_errors%& can be used to specify that errors in users' forward
20689lists or filter files should not prevent delivery. The &%syntax_errors_to%&
20690option, used with an address that does not get redirected, can be used to
20691notify users of these errors, by means of a router like this:
20692.code
20693userforward:
20694 driver = redirect
20695 allow_filter
20696 check_local_user
20697 file = $home/.forward
20698 file_transport = address_file
20699 pipe_transport = address_pipe
20700 reply_transport = address_reply
20701 no_verify
20702 skip_syntax_errors
20703 syntax_errors_to = real-$local_part@$domain
20704 syntax_errors_text = \
20705 This is an automatically generated message. An error has\n\
20706 been found in your .forward file. Details of the error are\n\
20707 reported below. While this error persists, you will receive\n\
20708 a copy of this message for every message that is addressed\n\
20709 to you. If your .forward file is a filter file, or if it is\n\
20710 a non-filter file containing no valid forwarding addresses,\n\
20711 a copy of each incoming message will be put in your normal\n\
20712 mailbox. If a non-filter file contains at least one valid\n\
20713 forwarding address, forwarding to the valid addresses will\n\
20714 happen, and those will be the only deliveries that occur.
20715.endd
20716You also need a router to ensure that local addresses that are prefixed by
20717&`real-`& are recognized, but not forwarded or filtered. For example, you could
20718put this immediately before the &(userforward)& router:
20719.code
20720real_localuser:
20721 driver = accept
20722 check_local_user
20723 local_part_prefix = real-
20724 transport = local_delivery
20725.endd
20726For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
20727router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
20728.code
20729 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
20730 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
20731.endd
20732
20733
20734.option syntax_errors_text redirect string&!! unset
20735See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
20736
20737
20738.option syntax_errors_to redirect string unset
20739See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
20740.ecindex IIDredrou1
20741.ecindex IIDredrou2
20742
20743
20744
20745
20746
20747
20748. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20749. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20750
20751.chapter "Environment for running local transports" "CHAPenvironment" &&&
20752 "Environment for local transports"
20753.scindex IIDenvlotra1 "local transports" "environment for"
20754.scindex IIDenvlotra2 "environment" "local transports"
20755.scindex IIDenvlotra3 "transport" "local; environment for"
20756Local transports handle deliveries to files and pipes. (The &(autoreply)&
20757transport can be thought of as similar to a pipe.) Exim always runs transports
20758in subprocesses, under specified uids and gids. Typical deliveries to local
20759mailboxes run under the uid and gid of the local user.
20760
20761Exim also sets a specific current directory while running the transport; for
20762some transports a home directory setting is also relevant. The &(pipe)&
20763transport is the only one that sets up environment variables; see section
20764&<<SECTpipeenv>>& for details.
20765
20766The values used for the uid, gid, and the directories may come from several
20767different places. In many cases, the router that handles the address associates
20768settings with that address as a result of its &%check_local_user%&, &%group%&,
20769or &%user%& options. However, values may also be given in the transport's own
20770configuration, and these override anything that comes from the router.
20771
20772
20773
20774.section "Concurrent deliveries" "SECID131"
20775.cindex "concurrent deliveries"
20776.cindex "simultaneous deliveries"
20777If two different messages for the same local recipient arrive more or less
20778simultaneously, the two delivery processes are likely to run concurrently. When
20779the &(appendfile)& transport is used to write to a file, Exim applies locking
20780rules to stop concurrent processes from writing to the same file at the same
20781time.
20782
20783However, when you use a &(pipe)& transport, it is up to you to arrange any
20784locking that is needed. Here is a silly example:
20785.code
20786my_transport:
20787 driver = pipe
20788 command = /bin/sh -c 'cat >>/some/file'
20789.endd
20790This is supposed to write the message at the end of the file. However, if two
20791messages arrive at the same time, the file will be scrambled. You can use the
20792&%exim_lock%& utility program (see section &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>&) to lock a
20793file using the same algorithm that Exim itself uses.
20794
20795
20796
20797
20798.section "Uids and gids" "SECTenvuidgid"
20799.cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
20800.cindex "transport" "local; uid and gid"
20801All transports have the options &%group%& and &%user%&. If &%group%& is set, it
20802overrides any group that the router set in the address, even if &%user%& is not
20803set for the transport. This makes it possible, for example, to run local mail
20804delivery under the uid of the recipient (set by the router), but in a special
20805group (set by the transport). For example:
20806.code
20807# Routers ...
20808# User/group are set by check_local_user in this router
20809local_users:
20810 driver = accept
20811 check_local_user
20812 transport = group_delivery
20813
20814# Transports ...
20815# This transport overrides the group
20816group_delivery:
20817 driver = appendfile
20818 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
20819 group = mail
20820.endd
20821If &%user%& is set for a transport, its value overrides what is set in the
20822address by the router. If &%user%& is non-numeric and &%group%& is not set, the
20823gid associated with the user is used. If &%user%& is numeric, &%group%& must be
20824set.
20825
20826.oindex "&%initgroups%&"
20827When the uid is taken from the transport's configuration, the &[initgroups()]&
20828function is called for the groups associated with that uid if the
20829&%initgroups%& option is set for the transport. When the uid is not specified
20830by the transport, but is associated with the address by a router, the option
20831for calling &[initgroups()]& is taken from the router configuration.
20832
20833.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "uid for"
20834The &(pipe)& transport contains the special option &%pipe_as_creator%&. If this
20835is set and &%user%& is not set, the uid of the process that called Exim to
20836receive the message is used, and if &%group%& is not set, the corresponding
20837original gid is also used.
20838
20839This is the detailed preference order for obtaining a gid; the first of the
20840following that is set is used:
20841
20842.ilist
20843A &%group%& setting of the transport;
20844.next
20845A &%group%& setting of the router;
20846.next
20847A gid associated with a user setting of the router, either as a result of
20848&%check_local_user%& or an explicit non-numeric &%user%& setting;
20849.next
20850The group associated with a non-numeric &%user%& setting of the transport;
20851.next
20852In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's gid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set and
20853the uid is the creator's uid;
20854.next
20855The Exim gid if the Exim uid is being used as a default.
20856.endlist
20857
20858If, for example, the user is specified numerically on the router and there are
20859no group settings, no gid is available. In this situation, an error occurs.
20860This is different for the uid, for which there always is an ultimate default.
20861The first of the following that is set is used:
20862
20863.ilist
20864A &%user%& setting of the transport;
20865.next
20866In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's uid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set;
20867.next
20868A &%user%& setting of the router;
20869.next
20870A &%check_local_user%& setting of the router;
20871.next
20872The Exim uid.
20873.endlist
20874
20875Of course, an error will still occur if the uid that is chosen is on the
20876&%never_users%& list.
20877
20878
20879
20880
20881
20882.section "Current and home directories" "SECID132"
20883.cindex "current directory for local transport"
20884.cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
20885.cindex "transport" "local; home directory for"
20886.cindex "transport" "local; current directory for"
20887Routers may set current and home directories for local transports by means of
20888the &%transport_current_directory%& and &%transport_home_directory%& options.
20889However, if the transport's &%current_directory%& or &%home_directory%& options
20890are set, they override the router's values. In detail, the home directory
20891for a local transport is taken from the first of these values that is set:
20892
20893.ilist
20894The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
20895.next
20896The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
20897.next
20898The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
20899.next
20900The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
20901.endlist
20902
20903The current directory is taken from the first of these values that is set:
20904
20905.ilist
20906The &%current_directory%& option on the transport;
20907.next
20908The &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router.
20909.endlist
20910
20911
20912If neither the router nor the transport sets a current directory, Exim uses the
20913value of the home directory, if it is set. Otherwise it sets the current
20914directory to &_/_& before running a local transport.
20915
20916
20917
20918.section "Expansion variables derived from the address" "SECID133"
20919.vindex "&$domain$&"
20920.vindex "&$local_part$&"
20921.vindex "&$original_domain$&"
20922Normally a local delivery is handling a single address, and in that case the
20923variables such as &$domain$& and &$local_part$& are set during local
20924deliveries. However, in some circumstances more than one address may be handled
20925at once (for example, while writing batch SMTP for onward transmission by some
20926other means). In this case, the variables associated with the local part are
20927never set, &$domain$& is set only if all the addresses have the same domain,
20928and &$original_domain$& is never set.
20929.ecindex IIDenvlotra1
20930.ecindex IIDenvlotra2
20931.ecindex IIDenvlotra3
20932
20933
20934
20935
20936
20937
20938
20939. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20940. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20941
20942.chapter "Generic options for transports" "CHAPtransportgeneric"
20943.scindex IIDgenoptra1 "generic options" "transport"
20944.scindex IIDgenoptra2 "options" "generic; for transports"
20945.scindex IIDgenoptra3 "transport" "generic options for"
20946The following generic options apply to all transports:
20947
20948
20949.option body_only transports boolean false
20950.cindex "transport" "body only"
20951.cindex "message" "transporting body only"
20952.cindex "body of message" "transporting"
20953If this option is set, the message's headers are not transported. It is
20954mutually exclusive with &%headers_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)&
20955or &(pipe)& transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and
20956&%message_suffix%& should be checked, because this option does not
20957automatically suppress them.
20958
20959
20960.option current_directory transports string&!! unset
20961.cindex "transport" "current directory for"
20962This specifies the current directory that is to be set while running the
20963transport, overriding any value that may have been set by the router.
20964If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
20965logged, and delivery is deferred.
20966
20967
20968.option disable_logging transports boolean false
20969If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any
20970deliveries by the transport or for any
20971transport errors. You should not set this option unless you really, really know
20972what you are doing.
20973
20974
20975.option debug_print transports string&!! unset
20976.cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
20977If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
20978option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging output when the
20979transport is run.
20980If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
20981output, and Exim carries on processing.
20982This facility is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
20983so on when debugging driver configurations. For example, if a &%headers_add%&
20984option is not working properly, &%debug_print%& could be used to output the
20985variables it references. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with
20986one.
20987The variables &$transport_name$& and &$router_name$& contain the name of the
20988transport and the router that called it.
20989
20990.option delivery_date_add transports boolean false
20991.cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
20992If this option is true, a &'Delivery-date:'& header is added to the message.
20993This gives the actual time the delivery was made. As this is not a standard
20994header, Exim has a configuration option (&%delivery_date_remove%&) which
20995requests its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can
20996safely be resent to other recipients.
20997
20998
20999.option driver transports string unset
21000This specifies which of the available transport drivers is to be used.
21001There is no default, and this option must be set for every transport.
21002
21003
21004.option envelope_to_add transports boolean false
21005.cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
21006If this option is true, an &'Envelope-to:'& header is added to the message.
21007This gives the original address(es) in the incoming envelope that caused this
21008delivery to happen. More than one address may be present if the transport is
21009configured to handle several addresses at once, or if more than one original
21010address was redirected to the same final address. As this is not a standard
21011header, Exim has a configuration option (&%envelope_to_remove%&) which requests
21012its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be
21013resent to other recipients.
21014
21015
21016.option event_action transports string&!! unset
21017.cindex events
21018This option declares a string to be expanded for Exim's events mechanism.
21019For details see chapter &<<CHAPevents>>&.
21020
21021
21022.option group transports string&!! "Exim group"
21023.cindex "transport" "group; specifying"
21024This option specifies a gid for running the transport process, overriding any
21025value that the router supplies, and also overriding any value associated with
21026&%user%& (see below).
21027
21028
21029.option headers_add transports list&!! unset
21030.cindex "header lines" "adding in transport"
21031.cindex "transport" "header lines; adding"
21032This option specifies a list of text headers,
21033newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way),
21034which are (separately) expanded and added to the header
21035portion of a message as it is transported, as described in section
21036&<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Additional header lines can also be specified by
21037routers. If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
21038is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
21039errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
21040
21041Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
21042for a transport; all listed headers are added.
21043
21044
21045.option headers_only transports boolean false
21046.cindex "transport" "header lines only"
21047.cindex "message" "transporting headers only"
21048.cindex "header lines" "transporting"
21049If this option is set, the message's body is not transported. It is mutually
21050exclusive with &%body_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)& or &(pipe)&
21051transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& should be
21052checked, since this option does not automatically suppress them.
21053
21054
21055.option headers_remove transports list&!! unset
21056.cindex "header lines" "removing"
21057.cindex "transport" "header lines; removing"
21058This option specifies a list of header names,
21059colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way);
21060these headers are omitted from the message as it is transported, as described
21061in section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header removal can also be specified by
21062routers.
21063Each list item is separately expanded.
21064If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
21065is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
21066errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
21067
21068Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
21069for a transport; all listed headers are removed.
21070
21071&*Warning*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
21072items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
21073To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
21074
21075
21076
21077.option headers_rewrite transports string unset
21078.cindex "transport" "header lines; rewriting"
21079.cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
21080This option allows addresses in header lines to be rewritten at transport time,
21081that is, as the message is being copied to its destination. The contents of the
21082option are a colon-separated list of rewriting rules. Each rule is in exactly
21083the same form as one of the general rewriting rules that are applied when a
21084message is received. These are described in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. For
21085example,
21086.code
21087headers_rewrite = a@b c@d f : \
21088 x@y w@z
21089.endd
21090changes &'a@b'& into &'c@d'& in &'From:'& header lines, and &'x@y'& into
21091&'w@z'& in all address-bearing header lines. The rules are applied to the
21092header lines just before they are written out at transport time, so they affect
21093only those copies of the message that pass through the transport. However, only
21094the message's original header lines, and any that were added by a system
21095filter, are rewritten. If a router or transport adds header lines, they are not
21096affected by this option. These rewriting rules are &'not'& applied to the
21097envelope. You can change the return path using &%return_path%&, but you cannot
21098change envelope recipients at this time.
21099
21100
21101.option home_directory transports string&!! unset
21102.cindex "transport" "home directory for"
21103.vindex "&$home$&"
21104This option specifies a home directory setting for a local transport,
21105overriding any value that may be set by the router. The home directory is
21106placed in &$home$& while expanding the transport's private options. It is also
21107used as the current directory if no current directory is set by the
21108&%current_directory%& option on the transport or the
21109&%transport_current_directory%& option on the router. If the expansion fails
21110for any reason, including forced failure, an error is logged, and delivery is
21111deferred.
21112
21113
21114.option initgroups transports boolean false
21115.cindex "additional groups"
21116.cindex "groups" "additional"
21117.cindex "transport" "group; additional"
21118If this option is true and the uid for the delivery process is provided by the
21119transport, the &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport
21120to ensure that any additional groups associated with the uid are set up.
21121
21122
21123.option max_parallel transports integer&!! unset
21124.cindex limit "transport parallelism"
21125.cindex transport "parallel processes"
21126.cindex transport "concurrency limit"
21127.cindex "delivery" "parallelism for transport"
21128If this option is set and expands to an integer greater than zero
21129it limits the number of concurrent runs of the transport.
21130The control does not apply to shadow transports.
21131
21132.cindex "hints database" "transport concurrency control"
21133Exim implements this control by means of a hints database in which a record is
21134incremented whenever a transport process is being created. The record
21135is decremented and possibly removed when the process terminates.
21136Obviously there is scope for
21137records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
21138guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
21139
21140If you use this option, you should also arrange to delete the
21141relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
21142start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
21143may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
21144are used for ETRN and smtp transport serialization.
21145
21146
21147.option message_size_limit transports string&!! 0
21148.cindex "limit" "message size per transport"
21149.cindex "size" "of message, limit"
21150.cindex "transport" "message size; limiting"
21151This option controls the size of messages passed through the transport. It is
21152expanded before use; the result of the expansion must be a sequence of decimal
21153digits, optionally followed by K or M. If the expansion fails for any reason,
21154including forced failure, or if the result is not of the required form,
21155delivery is deferred. If the value is greater than zero and the size of a
21156message exceeds this limit, the address is failed. If there is any chance that
21157the resulting bounce message could be routed to the same transport, you should
21158ensure that &%return_size_limit%& is less than the transport's
21159&%message_size_limit%&, as otherwise the bounce message will fail to get
21160delivered.
21161
21162
21163
21164.option rcpt_include_affixes transports boolean false
21165.cindex "prefix" "for local part, including in envelope"
21166.cindex "suffix for local part" "including in envelope"
21167.cindex "local part" "prefix"
21168.cindex "local part" "suffix"
21169When this option is false (the default), and an address that has had any
21170affixes (prefixes or suffixes) removed from the local part is delivered by any
21171form of SMTP or LMTP, the affixes are not included. For example, if a router
21172that contains
21173.code
21174local_part_prefix = *-
21175.endd
21176routes the address &'abc-xyz@some.domain'& to an SMTP transport, the envelope
21177is delivered with
21178.code
21179RCPT TO:<xyz@some.domain>
21180.endd
21181This is also the case when an ACL-time callout is being used to verify a
21182recipient address. However, if &%rcpt_include_affixes%& is set true, the
21183whole local part is included in the RCPT command. This option applies to BSMTP
21184deliveries by the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports as well as to the
21185&(lmtp)& and &(smtp)& transports.
21186
21187
21188.option retry_use_local_part transports boolean "see below"
21189.cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
21190When a delivery suffers a temporary failure, a retry record is created
21191in Exim's hints database. For remote deliveries, the key for the retry record
21192is based on the name and/or IP address of the failing remote host. For local
21193deliveries, the key is normally the entire address, including both the local
21194part and the domain. This is suitable for most common cases of local delivery
21195temporary failure &-- for example, exceeding a mailbox quota should delay only
21196deliveries to that mailbox, not to the whole domain.
21197
21198However, in some special cases you may want to treat a temporary local delivery
21199as a failure associated with the domain, and not with a particular local part.
21200(For example, if you are storing all mail for some domain in files.) You can do
21201this by setting &%retry_use_local_part%& false.
21202
21203For all the local transports, its default value is true. For remote transports,
21204the default value is false for tidiness, but changing the value has no effect
21205on a remote transport in the current implementation.
21206
21207
21208.option return_path transports string&!! unset
21209.cindex "envelope sender"
21210.cindex "transport" "return path; changing"
21211.cindex "return path" "changing in transport"
21212If this option is set, the string is expanded at transport time and replaces
21213the existing return path (envelope sender) value in the copy of the message
21214that is being delivered. An empty return path is permitted. This feature is
21215designed for remote deliveries, where the value of this option is used in the
21216SMTP MAIL command. If you set &%return_path%& for a local transport, the
21217only effect is to change the address that is placed in the &'Return-path:'&
21218header line, if one is added to the message (see the next option).
21219
21220&*Note:*& A changed return path is not logged unless you add
21221&%return_path_on_delivery%& to the log selector.
21222
21223.vindex "&$return_path$&"
21224The expansion can refer to the existing value via &$return_path$&. This is
21225either the message's envelope sender, or an address set by the
21226&%errors_to%& option on a router. If the expansion is forced to fail, no
21227replacement occurs; if it fails for another reason, delivery is deferred. This
21228option can be used to support VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) &-- see
21229section &<<SECTverp>>&.
21230
21231&*Note*&: If a delivery error is detected locally, including the case when a
21232remote server rejects a message at SMTP time, the bounce message is not sent to
21233the value of this option. It is sent to the previously set errors address.
21234This defaults to the incoming sender address, but can be changed by setting
21235&%errors_to%& in a router.
21236
21237
21238
21239.option return_path_add transports boolean false
21240.cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
21241If this option is true, a &'Return-path:'& header is added to the message.
21242Although the return path is normally available in the prefix line of BSD
21243mailboxes, this is commonly not displayed by MUAs, and so the user does not
21244have easy access to it.
21245
21246RFC 2821 states that the &'Return-path:'& header is added to a message &"when
21247the delivery SMTP server makes the final delivery"&. This implies that this
21248header should not be present in incoming messages. Exim has a configuration
21249option, &%return_path_remove%&, which requests removal of this header from
21250incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be resent to other
21251recipients.
21252
21253
21254.option shadow_condition transports string&!! unset
21255See &%shadow_transport%& below.
21256
21257
21258.option shadow_transport transports string unset
21259.cindex "shadow transport"
21260.cindex "transport" "shadow"
21261A local transport may set the &%shadow_transport%& option to the name of
21262another local transport. Shadow remote transports are not supported.
21263
21264Whenever a delivery to the main transport succeeds, and either
21265&%shadow_condition%& is unset, or its expansion does not result in the empty
21266string or one of the strings &"0"& or &"no"& or &"false"&, the message is also
21267passed to the shadow transport, with the same delivery address or addresses. If
21268expansion fails, no action is taken except that non-forced expansion failures
21269cause a log line to be written.
21270
21271The result of the shadow transport is discarded and does not affect the
21272subsequent processing of the message. Only a single level of shadowing is
21273provided; the &%shadow_transport%& option is ignored on any transport when it
21274is running as a shadow. Options concerned with output from pipes are also
21275ignored. The log line for the successful delivery has an item added on the end,
21276of the form
21277.code
21278ST=<shadow transport name>
21279.endd
21280If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
21281parentheses afterwards. Shadow transports can be used for a number of different
21282purposes, including keeping more detailed log information than Exim normally
21283provides, and implementing automatic acknowledgment policies based on message
21284headers that some sites insist on.
21285
21286
21287.option transport_filter transports string&!! unset
21288.cindex "transport" "filter"
21289.cindex "filter" "transport filter"
21290This option sets up a filtering (in the Unix shell sense) process for messages
21291at transport time. It should not be confused with mail filtering as set up by
21292individual users or via a system filter.
21293If unset, or expanding to an empty string, no filtering is done.
21294
21295When the message is about to be written out, the command specified by
21296&%transport_filter%& is started up in a separate, parallel process, and
21297the entire message, including the header lines, is passed to it on its standard
21298input (this in fact is done from a third process, to avoid deadlock). The
21299command must be specified as an absolute path.
21300
21301The lines of the message that are written to the transport filter are
21302terminated by newline (&"\n"&). The message is passed to the filter before any
21303SMTP-specific processing, such as turning &"\n"& into &"\r\n"& and escaping
21304lines beginning with a dot, and also before any processing implied by the
21305settings of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& in the &(appendfile)& or
21306&(pipe)& transports.
21307
21308The standard error for the filter process is set to the same destination as its
21309standard output; this is read and written to the message's ultimate
21310destination. The process that writes the message to the filter, the
21311filter itself, and the original process that reads the result and delivers it
21312are all run in parallel, like a shell pipeline.
21313
21314The filter can perform any transformations it likes, but of course should take
21315care not to break RFC 2822 syntax. Exim does not check the result, except to
21316test for a final newline when SMTP is in use. All messages transmitted over
21317SMTP must end with a newline, so Exim supplies one if it is missing.
21318
21319.cindex "content scanning" "per user"
21320A transport filter can be used to provide content-scanning on a per-user basis
21321at delivery time if the only required effect of the scan is to modify the
21322message. For example, a content scan could insert a new header line containing
21323a spam score. This could be interpreted by a filter in the user's MUA. It is
21324not possible to discard a message at this stage.
21325
21326.cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
21327A problem might arise if the filter increases the size of a message that is
21328being sent down an SMTP connection. If the receiving SMTP server has indicated
21329support for the SIZE parameter, Exim will have sent the size of the message
21330at the start of the SMTP session. If what is actually sent is substantially
21331more, the server might reject the message. This can be worked round by setting
21332the &%size_addition%& option on the &(smtp)& transport, either to allow for
21333additions to the message, or to disable the use of SIZE altogether.
21334
21335.vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
21336The value of the &%transport_filter%& option is the command string for starting
21337the filter, which is run directly from Exim, not under a shell. The string is
21338parsed by Exim in the same way as a command string for the &(pipe)& transport:
21339Exim breaks it up into arguments and then expands each argument separately (see
21340section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&). Any kind of expansion failure causes delivery
21341to be deferred. The special argument &$pipe_addresses$& is replaced by a number
21342of arguments, one for each address that applies to this delivery. (This isn't
21343an ideal name for this feature here, but as it was already implemented for the
21344&(pipe)& transport, it seemed sensible not to change it.)
21345
21346.vindex "&$host$&"
21347.vindex "&$host_address$&"
21348The expansion variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available when the
21349transport is a remote one. They contain the name and IP address of the host to
21350which the message is being sent. For example:
21351.code
21352transport_filter = /some/directory/transport-filter.pl \
21353 $host $host_address $sender_address $pipe_addresses
21354.endd
21355
21356Two problems arise if you want to use more complicated expansion items to
21357generate transport filter commands, both of which due to the fact that the
21358command is split up &'before'& expansion.
21359.ilist
21360If an expansion item contains white space, you must quote it, so that it is all
21361part of the same command item. If the entire option setting is one such
21362expansion item, you have to take care what kind of quoting you use. For
21363example:
21364.code
21365transport_filter = '/bin/cmd${if eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}}'
21366.endd
21367This runs the command &(/bin/cmd1)& if the host name is &'a.b.c'&, and
21368&(/bin/cmd2)& otherwise. If double quotes had been used, they would have been
21369stripped by Exim when it read the option's value. When the value is used, if
21370the single quotes were missing, the line would be split into two items,
21371&`/bin/cmd${if`& and &`eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}`&, and an error would occur when
21372Exim tried to expand the first one.
21373.next
21374Except for the special case of &$pipe_addresses$& that is mentioned above, an
21375expansion cannot generate multiple arguments, or a command name followed by
21376arguments. Consider this example:
21377.code
21378transport_filter = ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
21379 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
21380.endd
21381The result of the lookup is interpreted as the name of the command, even
21382if it contains white space. The simplest way round this is to use a shell:
21383.code
21384transport_filter = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
21385 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
21386.endd
21387.endlist
21388
21389The filter process is run under the same uid and gid as the normal delivery.
21390For remote deliveries this is the Exim uid/gid by default. The command should
21391normally yield a zero return code. Transport filters are not supposed to fail.
21392A non-zero code is taken to mean that the transport filter encountered some
21393serious problem. Delivery of the message is deferred; the message remains on
21394the queue and is tried again later. It is not possible to cause a message to be
21395bounced from a transport filter.
21396
21397If a transport filter is set on an autoreply transport, the original message is
21398passed through the filter as it is being copied into the newly generated
21399message, which happens if the &%return_message%& option is set.
21400
21401
21402.option transport_filter_timeout transports time 5m
21403.cindex "transport" "filter, timeout"
21404When Exim is reading the output of a transport filter, it applies a timeout
21405that can be set by this option. Exceeding the timeout is normally treated as a
21406temporary delivery failure. However, if a transport filter is used with a
21407&(pipe)& transport, a timeout in the transport filter is treated in the same
21408way as a timeout in the pipe command itself. By default, a timeout is a hard
21409error, but if the &(pipe)& transport's &%timeout_defer%& option is set true, it
21410becomes a temporary error.
21411
21412
21413.option user transports string&!! "Exim user"
21414.cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
21415.cindex "transport" "user, specifying"
21416This option specifies the user under whose uid the delivery process is to be
21417run, overriding any uid that may have been set by the router. If the user is
21418given as a name, the uid is looked up from the password data, and the
21419associated group is taken as the value of the gid to be used if the &%group%&
21420option is not set.
21421
21422For deliveries that use local transports, a user and group are normally
21423specified explicitly or implicitly (for example, as a result of
21424&%check_local_user%&) by the router or transport.
21425
21426.cindex "hints database" "access by remote transport"
21427For remote transports, you should leave this option unset unless you really are
21428sure you know what you are doing. When a remote transport is running, it needs
21429to be able to access Exim's hints databases, because each host may have its own
21430retry data.
21431.ecindex IIDgenoptra1
21432.ecindex IIDgenoptra2
21433.ecindex IIDgenoptra3
21434
21435
21436
21437
21438
21439
21440. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21441. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21442
21443.chapter "Address batching in local transports" "CHAPbatching" &&&
21444 "Address batching"
21445.cindex "transport" "local; address batching in"
21446The only remote transport (&(smtp)&) is normally configured to handle more than
21447one address at a time, so that when several addresses are routed to the same
21448remote host, just one copy of the message is sent. Local transports, however,
21449normally handle one address at a time. That is, a separate instance of the
21450transport is run for each address that is routed to the transport. A separate
21451copy of the message is delivered each time.
21452
21453.cindex "batched local delivery"
21454.oindex "&%batch_max%&"
21455.oindex "&%batch_id%&"
21456In special cases, it may be desirable to handle several addresses at once in a
21457local transport, for example:
21458
21459.ilist
21460In an &(appendfile)& transport, when storing messages in files for later
21461delivery by some other means, a single copy of the message with multiple
21462recipients saves space.
21463.next
21464In an &(lmtp)& transport, when delivering over &"local SMTP"& to some process,
21465a single copy saves time, and is the normal way LMTP is expected to work.
21466.next
21467In a &(pipe)& transport, when passing the message
21468to a scanner program or
21469to some other delivery mechanism such as UUCP, multiple recipients may be
21470acceptable.
21471.endlist
21472
21473These three local transports all have the same options for controlling multiple
21474(&"batched"&) deliveries, namely &%batch_max%& and &%batch_id%&. To save
21475repeating the information for each transport, these options are described here.
21476
21477The &%batch_max%& option specifies the maximum number of addresses that can be
21478delivered together in a single run of the transport. Its default value is one
21479(no batching). When more than one address is routed to a transport that has a
21480&%batch_max%& value greater than one, the addresses are delivered in a batch
21481(that is, in a single run of the transport with multiple recipients), subject
21482to certain conditions:
21483
21484.ilist
21485.vindex "&$local_part$&"
21486If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$local_part$&, no
21487batching is possible.
21488.next
21489.vindex "&$domain$&"
21490If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$domain$&, only
21491addresses with the same domain are batched.
21492.next
21493.cindex "customizing" "batching condition"
21494If &%batch_id%& is set, it is expanded for each address, and only those
21495addresses with the same expanded value are batched. This allows you to specify
21496customized batching conditions. Failure of the expansion for any reason,
21497including forced failure, disables batching, but it does not stop the delivery
21498from taking place.
21499.next
21500Batched addresses must also have the same errors address (where to send
21501delivery errors), the same header additions and removals, the same user and
21502group for the transport, and if a host list is present, the first host must
21503be the same.
21504.endlist
21505
21506In the case of the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports, batching applies
21507both when the file or pipe command is specified in the transport, and when it
21508is specified by a &(redirect)& router, but all the batched addresses must of
21509course be routed to the same file or pipe command. These two transports have an
21510option called &%use_bsmtp%&, which causes them to deliver the message in
21511&"batched SMTP"& format, with the envelope represented as SMTP commands. The
21512&%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& options are forced to the values
21513.code
21514check_string = "."
21515escape_string = ".."
21516.endd
21517when batched SMTP is in use. A full description of the batch SMTP mechanism is
21518given in section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&. The &(lmtp)& transport does not have a
21519&%use_bsmtp%& option, because it always delivers using the SMTP protocol.
21520
21521.cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
21522If the generic &%envelope_to_add%& option is set for a batching transport, the
21523&'Envelope-to:'& header that is added to the message contains all the addresses
21524that are being processed together. If you are using a batching &(appendfile)&
21525transport without &%use_bsmtp%&, the only way to preserve the recipient
21526addresses is to set the &%envelope_to_add%& option.
21527
21528.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "with multiple addresses"
21529.vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
21530If you are using a &(pipe)& transport without BSMTP, and setting the
21531transport's &%command%& option, you can include &$pipe_addresses$& as part of
21532the command. This is not a true variable; it is a bit of magic that causes each
21533of the recipient addresses to be inserted into the command as a separate
21534argument. This provides a way of accessing all the addresses that are being
21535delivered in the batch. &*Note:*& This is not possible for pipe commands that
21536are specified by a &(redirect)& router.
21537
21538
21539
21540
21541. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21542. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21543
21544.chapter "The appendfile transport" "CHAPappendfile"
21545.scindex IIDapptra1 "&(appendfile)& transport"
21546.scindex IIDapptra2 "transports" "&(appendfile)&"
21547.cindex "directory creation"
21548.cindex "creating directories"
21549The &(appendfile)& transport delivers a message by appending it to an existing
21550file, or by creating an entirely new file in a specified directory. Single
21551files to which messages are appended can be in the traditional Unix mailbox
21552format, or optionally in the MBX format supported by the Pine MUA and
21553University of Washington IMAP daemon, &'inter alia'&. When each message is
21554being delivered as a separate file, &"maildir"& format can optionally be used
21555to give added protection against failures that happen part-way through the
21556delivery. A third form of separate-file delivery known as &"mailstore"& is also
21557supported. For all file formats, Exim attempts to create as many levels of
21558directory as necessary, provided that &%create_directory%& is set.
21559
21560The code for the optional formats is not included in the Exim binary by
21561default. It is necessary to set SUPPORT_MBX, SUPPORT_MAILDIR and/or
21562SUPPORT_MAILSTORE in &_Local/Makefile_& to have the appropriate code
21563included.
21564
21565.cindex "quota" "system"
21566Exim recognizes system quota errors, and generates an appropriate message. Exim
21567also supports its own quota control within the transport, for use when the
21568system facility is unavailable or cannot be used for some reason.
21569
21570If there is an error while appending to a file (for example, quota exceeded or
21571partition filled), Exim attempts to reset the file's length and last
21572modification time back to what they were before. If there is an error while
21573creating an entirely new file, the new file is removed.
21574
21575Before appending to a file, a number of security checks are made, and the
21576file is locked. A detailed description is given below, after the list of
21577private options.
21578
21579The &(appendfile)& transport is most commonly used for local deliveries to
21580users' mailboxes. However, it can also be used as a pseudo-remote transport for
21581putting messages into files for remote delivery by some means other than Exim.
21582&"Batch SMTP"& format is often used in this case (see the &%use_bsmtp%&
21583option).
21584
21585
21586
21587.section "The file and directory options" "SECTfildiropt"
21588The &%file%& option specifies a single file, to which the message is appended;
21589the &%directory%& option specifies a directory, in which a new file containing
21590the message is created. Only one of these two options can be set, and for
21591normal deliveries to mailboxes, one of them &'must'& be set.
21592
21593.vindex "&$address_file$&"
21594.vindex "&$local_part$&"
21595However, &(appendfile)& is also used for delivering messages to files or
21596directories whose names (or parts of names) are obtained from alias,
21597forwarding, or filtering operations (for example, a &%save%& command in a
21598user's Exim filter). When such a transport is running, &$local_part$& contains
21599the local part that was aliased or forwarded, and &$address_file$& contains the
21600name (or partial name) of the file or directory generated by the redirection
21601operation. There are two cases:
21602
21603.ilist
21604If neither &%file%& nor &%directory%& is set, the redirection operation
21605must specify an absolute path (one that begins with &`/`&). This is the most
21606common case when users with local accounts use filtering to sort mail into
21607different folders. See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the
21608default configuration. If the path ends with a slash, it is assumed to be the
21609name of a directory. A delivery to a directory can also be forced by setting
21610&%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%&.
21611.next
21612If &%file%& or &%directory%& is set for a delivery from a redirection, it is
21613used to determine the file or directory name for the delivery. Normally, the
21614contents of &$address_file$& are used in some way in the string expansion.
21615.endlist
21616
21617
21618.cindex "Sieve filter" "configuring &(appendfile)&"
21619.cindex "Sieve filter" "relative mailbox path handling"
21620As an example of the second case, consider an environment where users do not
21621have home directories. They may be permitted to use Exim filter commands of the
21622form:
21623.code
21624save folder23
21625.endd
21626or Sieve filter commands of the form:
21627.code
21628require "fileinto";
21629fileinto "folder23";
21630.endd
21631In this situation, the expansion of &%file%& or &%directory%& in the transport
21632must transform the relative path into an appropriate absolute file name. In the
21633case of Sieve filters, the name &'inbox'& must be handled. It is the name that
21634is used as a result of a &"keep"& action in the filter. This example shows one
21635way of handling this requirement:
21636.code
21637file = ${if eq{$address_file}{inbox} \
21638 {/var/mail/$local_part} \
21639 {${if eq{${substr_0_1:$address_file}}{/} \
21640 {$address_file} \
21641 {$home/mail/$address_file} \
21642 }} \
21643 }
21644.endd
21645With this setting of &%file%&, &'inbox'& refers to the standard mailbox
21646location, absolute paths are used without change, and other folders are in the
21647&_mail_& directory within the home directory.
21648
21649&*Note 1*&: While processing an Exim filter, a relative path such as
21650&_folder23_& is turned into an absolute path if a home directory is known to
21651the router. In particular, this is the case if &%check_local_user%& is set. If
21652you want to prevent this happening at routing time, you can set
21653&%router_home_directory%& empty. This forces the router to pass the relative
21654path to the transport.
21655
21656&*Note 2*&: An absolute path in &$address_file$& is not treated specially;
21657the &%file%& or &%directory%& option is still used if it is set.
21658
21659
21660
21661
21662.section "Private options for appendfile" "SECID134"
21663.cindex "options" "&(appendfile)& transport"
21664
21665
21666
21667.option allow_fifo appendfile boolean false
21668.cindex "fifo (named pipe)"
21669.cindex "named pipe (fifo)"
21670.cindex "pipe" "named (fifo)"
21671Setting this option permits delivery to named pipes (FIFOs) as well as to
21672regular files. If no process is reading the named pipe at delivery time, the
21673delivery is deferred.
21674
21675
21676.option allow_symlink appendfile boolean false
21677.cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
21678.cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
21679By default, &(appendfile)& will not deliver if the path name for the file is
21680that of a symbolic link. Setting this option relaxes that constraint, but there
21681are security issues involved in the use of symbolic links. Be sure you know
21682what you are doing if you set this. Details of exactly what this option affects
21683are included in the discussion which follows this list of options.
21684
21685
21686.option batch_id appendfile string&!! unset
21687See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21688However, batching is automatically disabled for &(appendfile)& deliveries that
21689happen as a result of forwarding or aliasing or other redirection directly to a
21690file.
21691
21692
21693.option batch_max appendfile integer 1
21694See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21695
21696
21697.option check_group appendfile boolean false
21698When this option is set, the group owner of the file defined by the &%file%&
21699option is checked to see that it is the same as the group under which the
21700delivery process is running. The default setting is false because the default
21701file mode is 0600, which means that the group is irrelevant.
21702
21703
21704.option check_owner appendfile boolean true
21705When this option is set, the owner of the file defined by the &%file%& option
21706is checked to ensure that it is the same as the user under which the delivery
21707process is running.
21708
21709
21710.option check_string appendfile string "see below"
21711.cindex "&""From""& line"
21712As &(appendfile)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for
21713matching &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are
21714replaced by the contents of &%escape_string%&. The value of &%check_string%& is
21715a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of any letters it
21716contains is significant.
21717
21718If &%use_bsmtp%& is set the values of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%&
21719are forced to &"."& and &".."& respectively, and any settings in the
21720configuration are ignored. Otherwise, they default to &"From&~"& and
21721&">From&~"& when the &%file%& option is set, and unset when any of the
21722&%directory%&, &%maildir%&, or &%mailstore%& options are set.
21723
21724The default settings, along with &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, are
21725suitable for traditional &"BSD"& mailboxes, where a line beginning with
21726&"From&~"& indicates the start of a new message. All four options need changing
21727if another format is used. For example, to deliver to mailboxes in MMDF format:
21728.cindex "MMDF format mailbox"
21729.cindex "mailbox" "MMDF format"
21730.code
21731check_string = "\1\1\1\1\n"
21732escape_string = "\1\1\1\1 \n"
21733message_prefix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
21734message_suffix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
21735.endd
21736.option create_directory appendfile boolean true
21737.cindex "directory creation"
21738When this option is true, Exim attempts to create any missing superior
21739directories for the file that it is about to write. A created directory's mode
21740is given by the &%directory_mode%& option.
21741
21742The group ownership of a newly created directory is highly dependent on the
21743operating system (and possibly the file system) that is being used. For
21744example, in Solaris, if the parent directory has the setgid bit set, its group
21745is propagated to the child; if not, the currently set group is used. However,
21746in FreeBSD, the parent's group is always used.
21747
21748
21749
21750.option create_file appendfile string anywhere
21751This option constrains the location of files and directories that are created
21752by this transport. It applies to files defined by the &%file%& option and
21753directories defined by the &%directory%& option. In the case of maildir
21754delivery, it applies to the top level directory, not the maildir directories
21755beneath.
21756
21757The option must be set to one of the words &"anywhere"&, &"inhome"&, or
21758&"belowhome"&. In the second and third cases, a home directory must have been
21759set for the transport. This option is not useful when an explicit file name is
21760given for normal mailbox deliveries. It is intended for the case when file
21761names are generated from users' &_.forward_& files. These are usually handled
21762by an &(appendfile)& transport called &%address_file%&. See also
21763&%file_must_exist%&.
21764
21765
21766.option directory appendfile string&!! unset
21767This option is mutually exclusive with the &%file%& option, but one of &%file%&
21768or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result of a
21769redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&).
21770
21771When &%directory%& is set, the string is expanded, and the message is delivered
21772into a new file or files in or below the given directory, instead of being
21773appended to a single mailbox file. A number of different formats are provided
21774(see &%maildir_format%& and &%mailstore_format%&), and see section
21775&<<SECTopdir>>& for further details of this form of delivery.
21776
21777
21778.option directory_file appendfile string&!! "see below"
21779.cindex "base62"
21780.vindex "&$inode$&"
21781When &%directory%& is set, but neither &%maildir_format%& nor
21782&%mailstore_format%& is set, &(appendfile)& delivers each message into a file
21783whose name is obtained by expanding this string. The default value is:
21784.code
21785q${base62:$tod_epoch}-$inode
21786.endd
21787This generates a unique name from the current time, in base 62 form, and the
21788inode of the file. The variable &$inode$& is available only when expanding this
21789option.
21790
21791
21792.option directory_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0700
21793If &(appendfile)& creates any directories as a result of the
21794&%create_directory%& option, their mode is specified by this option.
21795
21796
21797.option escape_string appendfile string "see description"
21798See &%check_string%& above.
21799
21800
21801.option file appendfile string&!! unset
21802This option is mutually exclusive with the &%directory%& option, but one of
21803&%file%& or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result
21804of a redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&). The &%file%& option
21805specifies a single file, to which the message is appended. One or more of
21806&%use_fcntl_lock%&, &%use_flock_lock%&, or &%use_lockfile%& must be set with
21807&%file%&.
21808
21809.cindex "NFS" "lock file"
21810.cindex "locking files"
21811.cindex "lock files"
21812If you are using more than one host to deliver over NFS into the same
21813mailboxes, you should always use lock files.
21814
21815The string value is expanded for each delivery, and must yield an absolute
21816path. The most common settings of this option are variations on one of these
21817examples:
21818.code
21819file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
21820file = /home/$local_part/inbox
21821file = $home/inbox
21822.endd
21823.cindex "&""sticky""& bit"
21824In the first example, all deliveries are done into the same directory. If Exim
21825is configured to use lock files (see &%use_lockfile%& below) it must be able to
21826create a file in the directory, so the &"sticky"& bit must be turned on for
21827deliveries to be possible, or alternatively the &%group%& option can be used to
21828run the delivery under a group id which has write access to the directory.
21829
21830
21831
21832.option file_format appendfile string unset
21833.cindex "file" "mailbox; checking existing format"
21834This option requests the transport to check the format of an existing file
21835before adding to it. The check consists of matching a specific string at the
21836start of the file. The value of the option consists of an even number of
21837colon-separated strings. The first of each pair is the test string, and the
21838second is the name of a transport. If the transport associated with a matched
21839string is not the current transport, control is passed over to the other
21840transport. For example, suppose the standard &(local_delivery)& transport has
21841this added to it:
21842.code
21843file_format = "From : local_delivery :\
21844 \1\1\1\1\n : local_mmdf_delivery"
21845.endd
21846Mailboxes that begin with &"From"& are still handled by this transport, but if
21847a mailbox begins with four binary ones followed by a newline, control is passed
21848to a transport called &%local_mmdf_delivery%&, which presumably is configured
21849to do the delivery in MMDF format. If a mailbox does not exist or is empty, it
21850is assumed to match the current transport. If the start of a mailbox doesn't
21851match any string, or if the transport named for a given string is not defined,
21852delivery is deferred.
21853
21854
21855.option file_must_exist appendfile boolean false
21856If this option is true, the file specified by the &%file%& option must exist.
21857A temporary error occurs if it does not, causing delivery to be deferred.
21858If this option is false, the file is created if it does not exist.
21859
21860
21861.option lock_fcntl_timeout appendfile time 0s
21862.cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
21863.cindex "mailbox" "locking, blocking and non-blocking"
21864.cindex "locking files"
21865By default, the &(appendfile)& transport uses non-blocking calls to &[fcntl()]&
21866when locking an open mailbox file. If the call fails, the delivery process
21867sleeps for &%lock_interval%& and tries again, up to &%lock_retries%& times.
21868Non-blocking calls are used so that the file is not kept open during the wait
21869for the lock; the reason for this is to make it as safe as possible for
21870deliveries over NFS in the case when processes might be accessing an NFS
21871mailbox without using a lock file. This should not be done, but
21872misunderstandings and hence misconfigurations are not unknown.
21873
21874On a busy system, however, the performance of a non-blocking lock approach is
21875not as good as using a blocking lock with a timeout. In this case, the waiting
21876is done inside the system call, and Exim's delivery process acquires the lock
21877and can proceed as soon as the previous lock holder releases it.
21878
21879If &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set to a non-zero time, blocking locks, with that
21880timeout, are used. There may still be some retrying: the maximum number of
21881retries is
21882.code
21883(lock_retries * lock_interval) / lock_fcntl_timeout
21884.endd
21885rounded up to the next whole number. In other words, the total time during
21886which &(appendfile)& is trying to get a lock is roughly the same, unless
21887&%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set very large.
21888
21889You should consider setting this option if you are getting a lot of delayed
21890local deliveries because of errors of the form
21891.code
21892failed to lock mailbox /some/file (fcntl)
21893.endd
21894
21895.option lock_flock_timeout appendfile time 0s
21896This timeout applies to file locking when using &[flock()]& (see
21897&%use_flock%&); the timeout operates in a similar manner to
21898&%lock_fcntl_timeout%&.
21899
21900
21901.option lock_interval appendfile time 3s
21902This specifies the time to wait between attempts to lock the file. See below
21903for details of locking.
21904
21905
21906.option lock_retries appendfile integer 10
21907This specifies the maximum number of attempts to lock the file. A value of zero
21908is treated as 1. See below for details of locking.
21909
21910
21911.option lockfile_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
21912This specifies the mode of the created lock file, when a lock file is being
21913used (see &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_mbx_lock%&).
21914
21915
21916.option lockfile_timeout appendfile time 30m
21917.cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
21918When a lock file is being used (see &%use_lockfile%&), if a lock file already
21919exists and is older than this value, it is assumed to have been left behind by
21920accident, and Exim attempts to remove it.
21921
21922
21923.option mailbox_filecount appendfile string&!! unset
21924.cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
21925.cindex "size" "of mailbox"
21926If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
21927number of files in the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally
21928followed by K or M. This provides a way of obtaining this information from an
21929external source that maintains the data.
21930
21931
21932.option mailbox_size appendfile string&!! unset
21933.cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
21934.cindex "size" "of mailbox"
21935If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
21936size the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally followed by K or M.
21937This provides a way of obtaining this information from an external source that
21938maintains the data. This is likely to be helpful for maildir deliveries where
21939it is computationally expensive to compute the size of a mailbox.
21940
21941
21942
21943.option maildir_format appendfile boolean false
21944.cindex "maildir format" "specifying"
21945If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into a new
21946file, in the &"maildir"& format that is used by other mail software. When the
21947transport is activated directly from a &(redirect)& router (for example, the
21948&(address_file)& transport in the default configuration), setting
21949&%maildir_format%& causes the path received from the router to be treated as a
21950directory, whether or not it ends with &`/`&. This option is available only if
21951SUPPORT_MAILDIR is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section
21952&<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
21953
21954
21955.option maildir_quota_directory_regex appendfile string "See below"
21956.cindex "maildir format" "quota; directories included in"
21957.cindex "quota" "maildir; directories included in"
21958This option is relevant only when &%maildir_use_size_file%& is set. It defines
21959a regular expression for specifying directories, relative to the quota
21960directory (see &%quota_directory%&), that should be included in the quota
21961calculation. The default value is:
21962.code
21963maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\..*)$
21964.endd
21965This includes the &_cur_& and &_new_& directories, and any maildir++ folders
21966(directories whose names begin with a dot). If you want to exclude the
21967&_Trash_&
21968folder from the count (as some sites do), you need to change this setting to
21969.code
21970maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\.(?!Trash).*)$
21971.endd
21972This uses a negative lookahead in the regular expression to exclude the
21973directory whose name is &_.Trash_&. When a directory is excluded from quota
21974calculations, quota processing is bypassed for any messages that are delivered
21975directly into that directory.
21976
21977
21978.option maildir_retries appendfile integer 10
21979This option specifies the number of times to retry when writing a file in
21980&"maildir"& format. See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
21981
21982
21983.option maildir_tag appendfile string&!! unset
21984This option applies only to deliveries in maildir format, and is described in
21985section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
21986
21987
21988.option maildir_use_size_file appendfile&!! boolean false
21989.cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
21990The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value.
21991If it is true, it enables support for &_maildirsize_& files. Exim
21992creates a &_maildirsize_& file in a maildir if one does not exist, taking the
21993quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If &%quota%& is unset, the
21994value is zero. See &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& above and section
21995&<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
21996
21997.option maildirfolder_create_regex appendfile string unset
21998.cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirfolder_& file"
21999.cindex "&_maildirfolder_&, creating"
22000The value of this option is a regular expression. If it is unset, it has no
22001effect. Otherwise, before a maildir delivery takes place, the pattern is
22002matched against the name of the maildir directory, that is, the directory
22003containing the &_new_& and &_tmp_& subdirectories that will be used for the
22004delivery. If there is a match, Exim checks for the existence of a file called
22005&_maildirfolder_& in the directory, and creates it if it does not exist.
22006See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& for more details.
22007
22008
22009.option mailstore_format appendfile boolean false
22010.cindex "mailstore format" "specifying"
22011If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into two
22012new files in &"mailstore"& format. The option is available only if
22013SUPPORT_MAILSTORE is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section &<<SECTopdir>>&
22014below for further details.
22015
22016
22017.option mailstore_prefix appendfile string&!! unset
22018This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
22019section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
22020
22021
22022.option mailstore_suffix appendfile string&!! unset
22023This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
22024section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
22025
22026
22027.option mbx_format appendfile boolean false
22028.cindex "locking files"
22029.cindex "file" "locking"
22030.cindex "file" "MBX format"
22031.cindex "MBX format, specifying"
22032This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
22033set in &_Local/Makefile_&. If &%mbx_format%& is set with the &%file%& option,
22034the message is appended to the mailbox file in MBX format instead of
22035traditional Unix format. This format is supported by Pine4 and its associated
22036IMAP and POP daemons, by means of the &'c-client'& library that they all use.
22037
22038&*Note*&: The &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are not
22039automatically changed by the use of &%mbx_format%&. They should normally be set
22040empty when using MBX format, so this option almost always appears in this
22041combination:
22042.code
22043mbx_format = true
22044message_prefix =
22045message_suffix =
22046.endd
22047If none of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration,
22048&%use_mbx_lock%& is assumed and the other locking options default to false. It
22049is possible to specify the other kinds of locking with &%mbx_format%&, but
22050&%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_mbx_lock%& are mutually exclusive. MBX locking
22051interworks with &'c-client'&, providing for shared access to the mailbox. It
22052should not be used if any program that does not use this form of locking is
22053going to access the mailbox, nor should it be used if the mailbox file is NFS
22054mounted, because it works only when the mailbox is accessed from a single host.
22055
22056If you set &%use_fcntl_lock%& with an MBX-format mailbox, you cannot use
22057the standard version of &'c-client'&, because as long as it has a mailbox open
22058(this means for the whole of a Pine or IMAP session), Exim will not be able to
22059append messages to it.
22060
22061
22062.option message_prefix appendfile string&!! "see below"
22063.cindex "&""From""& line"
22064The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
22065The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
22066in which case it is:
22067.code
22068message_prefix = "From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}\
22069 {MAILER-DAEMON}} $tod_bsdinbox\n"
22070.endd
22071&*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
22072&`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
22073
22074.option message_suffix appendfile string&!! "see below"
22075The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
22076The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
22077in which case it is a single newline character. The suffix can be suppressed by
22078setting
22079.code
22080message_suffix =
22081.endd
22082&*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
22083&`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
22084
22085.option mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
22086If the output file is created, it is given this mode. If it already exists and
22087has wider permissions, they are reduced to this mode. If it has narrower
22088permissions, an error occurs unless &%mode_fail_narrower%& is false. However,
22089if the delivery is the result of a &%save%& command in a filter file specifying
22090a particular mode, the mode of the output file is always forced to take that
22091value, and this option is ignored.
22092
22093
22094.option mode_fail_narrower appendfile boolean true
22095This option applies in the case when an existing mailbox file has a narrower
22096mode than that specified by the &%mode%& option. If &%mode_fail_narrower%& is
22097true, the delivery is deferred (&"mailbox has the wrong mode"&); otherwise Exim
22098continues with the delivery attempt, using the existing mode of the file.
22099
22100
22101.option notify_comsat appendfile boolean false
22102If this option is true, the &'comsat'& daemon is notified after every
22103successful delivery to a user mailbox. This is the daemon that notifies logged
22104on users about incoming mail.
22105
22106
22107.option quota appendfile string&!! unset
22108.cindex "quota" "imposed by Exim"
22109This option imposes a limit on the size of the file to which Exim is appending,
22110or to the total space used in the directory tree when the &%directory%& option
22111is set. In the latter case, computation of the space used is expensive, because
22112all the files in the directory (and any sub-directories) have to be
22113individually inspected and their sizes summed. (See &%quota_size_regex%& and
22114&%maildir_use_size_file%& for ways to avoid this in environments where users
22115have no shell access to their mailboxes).
22116
22117As there is no interlock against two simultaneous deliveries into a
22118multi-file mailbox, it is possible for the quota to be overrun in this case.
22119For single-file mailboxes, of course, an interlock is a necessity.
22120
22121A file's size is taken as its &'used'& value. Because of blocking effects, this
22122may be a lot less than the actual amount of disk space allocated to the file.
22123If the sizes of a number of files are being added up, the rounding effect can
22124become quite noticeable, especially on systems that have large block sizes.
22125Nevertheless, it seems best to stick to the &'used'& figure, because this is
22126the obvious value which users understand most easily.
22127
22128The value of the option is expanded, and must then be a numerical value
22129(decimal point allowed), optionally followed by one of the letters K, M, or G,
22130for kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes. If Exim is running on a system with
22131large file support (Linux and FreeBSD have this), mailboxes larger than 2G can
22132be handled.
22133
22134&*Note*&: A value of zero is interpreted as &"no quota"&.
22135
22136The expansion happens while Exim is running as root, before it changes uid for
22137the delivery. This means that files that are inaccessible to the end user can
22138be used to hold quota values that are looked up in the expansion. When delivery
22139fails because this quota is exceeded, the handling of the error is as for
22140system quota failures.
22141
22142By default, Exim's quota checking mimics system quotas, and restricts the
22143mailbox to the specified maximum size, though the value is not accurate to the
22144last byte, owing to separator lines and additional headers that may get added
22145during message delivery. When a mailbox is nearly full, large messages may get
22146refused even though small ones are accepted, because the size of the current
22147message is added to the quota when the check is made. This behaviour can be
22148changed by setting &%quota_is_inclusive%& false. When this is done, the check
22149for exceeding the quota does not include the current message. Thus, deliveries
22150continue until the quota has been exceeded; thereafter, no further messages are
22151delivered. See also &%quota_warn_threshold%&.
22152
22153
22154.option quota_directory appendfile string&!! unset
22155This option defines the directory to check for quota purposes when delivering
22156into individual files. The default is the delivery directory, or, if a file
22157called &_maildirfolder_& exists in a maildir directory, the parent of the
22158delivery directory.
22159
22160
22161.option quota_filecount appendfile string&!! 0
22162This option applies when the &%directory%& option is set. It limits the total
22163number of files in the directory (compare the inode limit in system quotas). It
22164can only be used if &%quota%& is also set. The value is expanded; an expansion
22165failure causes delivery to be deferred. A value of zero is interpreted as
22166&"no quota"&.
22167
22168
22169.option quota_is_inclusive appendfile boolean true
22170See &%quota%& above.
22171
22172
22173.option quota_size_regex appendfile string unset
22174This option applies when one of the delivery modes that writes a separate file
22175for each message is being used. When Exim wants to find the size of one of
22176these files in order to test the quota, it first checks &%quota_size_regex%&.
22177If this is set to a regular expression that matches the file name, and it
22178captures one string, that string is interpreted as a representation of the
22179file's size. The value of &%quota_size_regex%& is not expanded.
22180
22181This feature is useful only when users have no shell access to their mailboxes
22182&-- otherwise they could defeat the quota simply by renaming the files. This
22183facility can be used with maildir deliveries, by setting &%maildir_tag%& to add
22184the file length to the file name. For example:
22185.code
22186maildir_tag = ,S=$message_size
22187quota_size_regex = ,S=(\d+)
22188.endd
22189An alternative to &$message_size$& is &$message_linecount$&, which contains the
22190number of lines in the message.
22191
22192The regular expression should not assume that the length is at the end of the
22193file name (even though &%maildir_tag%& puts it there) because maildir MUAs
22194sometimes add other information onto the ends of message file names.
22195
22196Section &<<SECID136>>& contains further information.
22197
22198
22199.option quota_warn_message appendfile string&!! "see below"
22200See below for the use of this option. If it is not set when
22201&%quota_warn_threshold%& is set, it defaults to
22202.code
22203quota_warn_message = "\
22204 To: $local_part@$domain\n\
22205 Subject: Your mailbox\n\n\
22206 This message is automatically created \
22207 by mail delivery software.\n\n\
22208 The size of your mailbox has exceeded \
22209 a warning threshold that is\n\
22210 set by the system administrator.\n"
22211.endd
22212
22213
22214.option quota_warn_threshold appendfile string&!! 0
22215.cindex "quota" "warning threshold"
22216.cindex "mailbox" "size warning"
22217.cindex "size" "of mailbox"
22218This option is expanded in the same way as &%quota%& (see above). If the
22219resulting value is greater than zero, and delivery of the message causes the
22220size of the file or total space in the directory tree to cross the given
22221threshold, a warning message is sent. If &%quota%& is also set, the threshold
22222may be specified as a percentage of it by following the value with a percent
22223sign. For example:
22224.code
22225quota = 10M
22226quota_warn_threshold = 75%
22227.endd
22228If &%quota%& is not set, a setting of &%quota_warn_threshold%& that ends with a
22229percent sign is ignored.
22230
22231The warning message itself is specified by the &%quota_warn_message%& option,
22232and it must start with a &'To:'& header line containing the recipient(s) of the
22233warning message. These do not necessarily have to include the recipient(s) of
22234the original message. A &'Subject:'& line should also normally be supplied. You
22235can include any other header lines that you want. If you do not include a
22236&'From:'& line, the default is:
22237.code
22238From: Mail Delivery System <mailer-daemon@$qualify_domain_sender>
22239.endd
22240.oindex &%errors_reply_to%&
22241If you supply a &'Reply-To:'& line, it overrides the global &%errors_reply_to%&
22242option.
22243
22244The &%quota%& option does not have to be set in order to use this option; they
22245are independent of one another except when the threshold is specified as a
22246percentage.
22247
22248
22249.option use_bsmtp appendfile boolean false
22250.cindex "envelope sender"
22251If this option is set true, &(appendfile)& writes messages in &"batch SMTP"&
22252format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP commands. If
22253you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages, you can do
22254so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&
22255for details of batch SMTP.
22256
22257
22258.option use_crlf appendfile boolean false
22259.cindex "carriage return"
22260.cindex "linefeed"
22261This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
22262(carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
22263of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the file is then an exact image
22264of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
22265
22266&*Note:*& The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options
22267(which are used to supply the traditional &"From&~"& and blank line separators
22268in Berkeley-style mailboxes) are written verbatim, so must contain their own
22269carriage return characters if these are needed. In cases where these options
22270have non-empty defaults, the values end with a single linefeed, so they must be
22271changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
22272
22273
22274.option use_fcntl_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
22275This option controls the use of the &[fcntl()]& function to lock a file for
22276exclusive use when a message is being appended. It is set by default unless
22277&%use_flock_lock%& is set. Otherwise, it should be turned off only if you know
22278that all your MUAs use lock file locking. When both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
22279&%use_flock_lock%& are unset, &%use_lockfile%& must be set.
22280
22281
22282.option use_flock_lock appendfile boolean false
22283This option is provided to support the use of &[flock()]& for file locking, for
22284the few situations where it is needed. Most modern operating systems support
22285&[fcntl()]& and &[lockf()]& locking, and these two functions interwork with
22286each other. Exim uses &[fcntl()]& locking by default.
22287
22288This option is required only if you are using an operating system where
22289&[flock()]& is used by programs that access mailboxes (typically MUAs), and
22290where &[flock()]& does not correctly interwork with &[fcntl()]&. You can use
22291both &[fcntl()]& and &[flock()]& locking simultaneously if you want.
22292
22293.cindex "Solaris" "&[flock()]& support"
22294Not all operating systems provide &[flock()]&. Some versions of Solaris do not
22295have it (and some, I think, provide a not quite right version built on top of
22296&[lockf()]&). If the OS does not have &[flock()]&, Exim will be built without
22297the ability to use it, and any attempt to do so will cause a configuration
22298error.
22299
22300&*Warning*&: &[flock()]& locks do not work on NFS files (unless &[flock()]&
22301is just being mapped onto &[fcntl()]& by the OS).
22302
22303
22304.option use_lockfile appendfile boolean "see below"
22305If this option is turned off, Exim does not attempt to create a lock file when
22306appending to a mailbox file. In this situation, the only locking is by
22307&[fcntl()]&. You should only turn &%use_lockfile%& off if you are absolutely
22308sure that every MUA that is ever going to look at your users' mailboxes uses
22309&[fcntl()]& rather than a lock file, and even then only when you are not
22310delivering over NFS from more than one host.
22311
22312.cindex "NFS" "lock file"
22313In order to append to an NFS file safely from more than one host, it is
22314necessary to take out a lock &'before'& opening the file, and the lock file
22315achieves this. Otherwise, even with &[fcntl()]& locking, there is a risk of
22316file corruption.
22317
22318The &%use_lockfile%& option is set by default unless &%use_mbx_lock%& is set.
22319It is not possible to turn both &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_fcntl_lock%& off,
22320except when &%mbx_format%& is set.
22321
22322
22323.option use_mbx_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
22324This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
22325set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Setting the option specifies that special MBX
22326locking rules be used. It is set by default if &%mbx_format%& is set and none
22327of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration. The locking rules
22328are the same as are used by the &'c-client'& library that underlies Pine and
22329the IMAP4 and POP daemons that come with it (see the discussion below). The
22330rules allow for shared access to the mailbox. However, this kind of locking
22331does not work when the mailbox is NFS mounted.
22332
22333You can set &%use_mbx_lock%& with either (or both) of &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
22334&%use_flock_lock%& to control what kind of locking is used in implementing the
22335MBX locking rules. The default is to use &[fcntl()]& if &%use_mbx_lock%& is set
22336without &%use_fcntl_lock%& or &%use_flock_lock%&.
22337
22338
22339
22340
22341.section "Operational details for appending" "SECTopappend"
22342.cindex "appending to a file"
22343.cindex "file" "appending"
22344Before appending to a file, the following preparations are made:
22345
22346.ilist
22347If the name of the file is &_/dev/null_&, no action is taken, and a success
22348return is given.
22349
22350.next
22351.cindex "directory creation"
22352If any directories on the file's path are missing, Exim creates them if the
22353&%create_directory%& option is set. A created directory's mode is given by the
22354&%directory_mode%& option.
22355
22356.next
22357If &%file_format%& is set, the format of an existing file is checked. If this
22358indicates that a different transport should be used, control is passed to that
22359transport.
22360
22361.next
22362.cindex "file" "locking"
22363.cindex "locking files"
22364.cindex "NFS" "lock file"
22365If &%use_lockfile%& is set, a lock file is built in a way that will work
22366reliably over NFS, as follows:
22367
22368.olist
22369Create a &"hitching post"& file whose name is that of the lock file with the
22370current time, primary host name, and process id added, by opening for writing
22371as a new file. If this fails with an access error, delivery is deferred.
22372.next
22373Close the hitching post file, and hard link it to the lock file name.
22374.next
22375If the call to &[link()]& succeeds, creation of the lock file has succeeded.
22376Unlink the hitching post name.
22377.next
22378Otherwise, use &[stat()]& to get information about the hitching post file, and
22379then unlink hitching post name. If the number of links is exactly two, creation
22380of the lock file succeeded but something (for example, an NFS server crash and
22381restart) caused this fact not to be communicated to the &[link()]& call.
22382.next
22383If creation of the lock file failed, wait for &%lock_interval%& and try again,
22384up to &%lock_retries%& times. However, since any program that writes to a
22385mailbox should complete its task very quickly, it is reasonable to time out old
22386lock files that are normally the result of user agent and system crashes. If an
22387existing lock file is older than &%lockfile_timeout%& Exim attempts to unlink
22388it before trying again.
22389.endlist olist
22390
22391.next
22392A call is made to &[lstat()]& to discover whether the main file exists, and if
22393so, what its characteristics are. If &[lstat()]& fails for any reason other
22394than non-existence, delivery is deferred.
22395
22396.next
22397.cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
22398.cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
22399If the file does exist and is a symbolic link, delivery is deferred, unless the
22400&%allow_symlink%& option is set, in which case the ownership of the link is
22401checked, and then &[stat()]& is called to find out about the real file, which
22402is then subjected to the checks below. The check on the top-level link
22403ownership prevents one user creating a link for another's mailbox in a sticky
22404directory, though allowing symbolic links in this case is definitely not a good
22405idea. If there is a chain of symbolic links, the intermediate ones are not
22406checked.
22407
22408.next
22409If the file already exists but is not a regular file, or if the file's owner
22410and group (if the group is being checked &-- see &%check_group%& above) are
22411different from the user and group under which the delivery is running,
22412delivery is deferred.
22413
22414.next
22415If the file's permissions are more generous than specified, they are reduced.
22416If they are insufficient, delivery is deferred, unless &%mode_fail_narrower%&
22417is set false, in which case the delivery is tried using the existing
22418permissions.
22419
22420.next
22421The file's inode number is saved, and the file is then opened for appending.
22422If this fails because the file has vanished, &(appendfile)& behaves as if it
22423hadn't existed (see below). For any other failures, delivery is deferred.
22424
22425.next
22426If the file is opened successfully, check that the inode number hasn't
22427changed, that it is still a regular file, and that the owner and permissions
22428have not changed. If anything is wrong, defer delivery and freeze the message.
22429
22430.next
22431If the file did not exist originally, defer delivery if the &%file_must_exist%&
22432option is set. Otherwise, check that the file is being created in a permitted
22433directory if the &%create_file%& option is set (deferring on failure), and then
22434open for writing as a new file, with the O_EXCL and O_CREAT options,
22435except when dealing with a symbolic link (the &%allow_symlink%& option must be
22436set). In this case, which can happen if the link points to a non-existent file,
22437the file is opened for writing using O_CREAT but not O_EXCL, because
22438that prevents link following.
22439
22440.next
22441.cindex "loop" "while file testing"
22442If opening fails because the file exists, obey the tests given above for
22443existing files. However, to avoid looping in a situation where the file is
22444being continuously created and destroyed, the exists/not-exists loop is broken
22445after 10 repetitions, and the message is then frozen.
22446
22447.next
22448If opening fails with any other error, defer delivery.
22449
22450.next
22451.cindex "file" "locking"
22452.cindex "locking files"
22453Once the file is open, unless both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_flock_lock%&
22454are false, it is locked using &[fcntl()]& or &[flock()]& or both. If
22455&%use_mbx_lock%& is false, an exclusive lock is requested in each case.
22456However, if &%use_mbx_lock%& is true, Exim takes out a shared lock on the open
22457file, and an exclusive lock on the file whose name is
22458.code
22459/tmp/.<device-number>.<inode-number>
22460.endd
22461using the device and inode numbers of the open mailbox file, in accordance with
22462the MBX locking rules. This file is created with a mode that is specified by
22463the &%lockfile_mode%& option.
22464
22465If Exim fails to lock the file, there are two possible courses of action,
22466depending on the value of the locking timeout. This is obtained from
22467&%lock_fcntl_timeout%& or &%lock_flock_timeout%&, as appropriate.
22468
22469If the timeout value is zero, the file is closed, Exim waits for
22470&%lock_interval%&, and then goes back and re-opens the file as above and tries
22471to lock it again. This happens up to &%lock_retries%& times, after which the
22472delivery is deferred.
22473
22474If the timeout has a value greater than zero, blocking calls to &[fcntl()]& or
22475&[flock()]& are used (with the given timeout), so there has already been some
22476waiting involved by the time locking fails. Nevertheless, Exim does not give up
22477immediately. It retries up to
22478.code
22479(lock_retries * lock_interval) / <timeout>
22480.endd
22481times (rounded up).
22482.endlist
22483
22484At the end of delivery, Exim closes the file (which releases the &[fcntl()]&
22485and/or &[flock()]& locks) and then deletes the lock file if one was created.
22486
22487
22488.section "Operational details for delivery to a new file" "SECTopdir"
22489.cindex "delivery" "to single file"
22490.cindex "&""From""& line"
22491When the &%directory%& option is set instead of &%file%&, each message is
22492delivered into a newly-created file or set of files. When &(appendfile)& is
22493activated directly from a &(redirect)& router, neither &%file%& nor
22494&%directory%& is normally set, because the path for delivery is supplied by the
22495router. (See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the default
22496configuration.) In this case, delivery is to a new file if either the path name
22497ends in &`/`&, or the &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%& option is set.
22498
22499No locking is required while writing the message to a new file, so the various
22500locking options of the transport are ignored. The &"From"& line that by default
22501separates messages in a single file is not normally needed, nor is the escaping
22502of message lines that start with &"From"&, and there is no need to ensure a
22503newline at the end of each message. Consequently, the default values for
22504&%check_string%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& are all unset when
22505any of &%directory%&, &%maildir_format%&, or &%mailstore_format%& is set.
22506
22507If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting, it adds up the sizes of all
22508the files in the delivery directory by default. However, you can specify a
22509different directory by setting &%quota_directory%&. Also, for maildir
22510deliveries (see below) the &_maildirfolder_& convention is honoured.
22511
22512
22513.cindex "maildir format"
22514.cindex "mailstore format"
22515There are three different ways in which delivery to individual files can be
22516done, controlled by the settings of the &%maildir_format%& and
22517&%mailstore_format%& options. Note that code to support maildir or mailstore
22518formats is not included in the binary unless SUPPORT_MAILDIR or
22519SUPPORT_MAILSTORE, respectively, is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
22520
22521.cindex "directory creation"
22522In all three cases an attempt is made to create the directory and any necessary
22523sub-directories if they do not exist, provided that the &%create_directory%&
22524option is set (the default). The location of a created directory can be
22525constrained by setting &%create_file%&. A created directory's mode is given by
22526the &%directory_mode%& option. If creation fails, or if the
22527&%create_directory%& option is not set when creation is required, delivery is
22528deferred.
22529
22530
22531
22532.section "Maildir delivery" "SECTmaildirdelivery"
22533.cindex "maildir format" "description of"
22534If the &%maildir_format%& option is true, Exim delivers each message by writing
22535it to a file whose name is &_tmp/<stime>.H<mtime>P<pid>.<host>_& in the
22536directory that is defined by the &%directory%& option (the &"delivery
22537directory"&). If the delivery is successful, the file is renamed into the
22538&_new_& subdirectory.
22539
22540In the file name, <&'stime'&> is the current time of day in seconds, and
22541<&'mtime'&> is the microsecond fraction of the time. After a maildir delivery,
22542Exim checks that the time-of-day clock has moved on by at least one microsecond
22543before terminating the delivery process. This guarantees uniqueness for the
22544file name. However, as a precaution, Exim calls &[stat()]& for the file before
22545opening it. If any response other than ENOENT (does not exist) is given,
22546Exim waits 2 seconds and tries again, up to &%maildir_retries%& times.
22547
22548Before Exim carries out a maildir delivery, it ensures that subdirectories
22549called &_new_&, &_cur_&, and &_tmp_& exist in the delivery directory. If they
22550do not exist, Exim tries to create them and any superior directories in their
22551path, subject to the &%create_directory%& and &%create_file%& options. If the
22552&%maildirfolder_create_regex%& option is set, and the regular expression it
22553contains matches the delivery directory, Exim also ensures that a file called
22554&_maildirfolder_& exists in the delivery directory. If a missing directory or
22555&_maildirfolder_& file cannot be created, delivery is deferred.
22556
22557These features make it possible to use Exim to create all the necessary files
22558and directories in a maildir mailbox, including subdirectories for maildir++
22559folders. Consider this example:
22560.code
22561maildir_format = true
22562directory = /var/mail/$local_part\
22563 ${if eq{$local_part_suffix}{}{}\
22564 {/.${substr_1:$local_part_suffix}}}
22565maildirfolder_create_regex = /\.[^/]+$
22566.endd
22567If &$local_part_suffix$& is empty (there was no suffix for the local part),
22568delivery is into a toplevel maildir with a name like &_/var/mail/pimbo_& (for
22569the user called &'pimbo'&). The pattern in &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& does
22570not match this name, so Exim will not look for or create the file
22571&_/var/mail/pimbo/maildirfolder_&, though it will create
22572&_/var/mail/pimbo/{cur,new,tmp}_& if necessary.
22573
22574However, if &$local_part_suffix$& contains &`-eximusers`& (for example),
22575delivery is into the maildir++ folder &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers_&, which
22576does match &%maildirfolder_create_regex%&. In this case, Exim will create
22577&_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/maildirfolder_& as well as the three maildir
22578directories &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/{cur,new,tmp}_&.
22579
22580&*Warning:*& Take care when setting &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& that it does
22581not inadvertently match the toplevel maildir directory, because a
22582&_maildirfolder_& file at top level would completely break quota calculations.
22583
22584.cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
22585.cindex "maildir++"
22586If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting before a maildir delivery, and
22587&%quota_directory%& is not set, it looks for a file called &_maildirfolder_& in
22588the maildir directory (alongside &_new_&, &_cur_&, &_tmp_&). If this exists,
22589Exim assumes the directory is a maildir++ folder directory, which is one level
22590down from the user's top level mailbox directory. This causes it to start at
22591the parent directory instead of the current directory when calculating the
22592amount of space used.
22593
22594One problem with delivering into a multi-file mailbox is that it is
22595computationally expensive to compute the size of the mailbox for quota
22596checking. Various approaches have been taken to reduce the amount of work
22597needed. The next two sections describe two of them. A third alternative is to
22598use some external process for maintaining the size data, and use the expansion
22599of the &%mailbox_size%& option as a way of importing it into Exim.
22600
22601
22602
22603
22604.section "Using tags to record message sizes" "SECID135"
22605If &%maildir_tag%& is set, the string is expanded for each delivery.
22606When the maildir file is renamed into the &_new_& sub-directory, the
22607tag is added to its name. However, if adding the tag takes the length of the
22608name to the point where the test &[stat()]& call fails with ENAMETOOLONG,
22609the tag is dropped and the maildir file is created with no tag.
22610
22611
22612.vindex "&$message_size$&"
22613Tags can be used to encode the size of files in their names; see
22614&%quota_size_regex%& above for an example. The expansion of &%maildir_tag%&
22615happens after the message has been written. The value of the &$message_size$&
22616variable is set to the number of bytes actually written. If the expansion is
22617forced to fail, the tag is ignored, but a non-forced failure causes delivery to
22618be deferred. The expanded tag may contain any printing characters except &"/"&.
22619Non-printing characters in the string are ignored; if the resulting string is
22620empty, it is ignored. If it starts with an alphanumeric character, a leading
22621colon is inserted; this default has not proven to be the path that popular
22622maildir implementations have chosen (but changing it in Exim would break
22623backwards compatibility).
22624
22625For one common implementation, you might set:
22626.code
22627maildir_tag = ,S=${message_size}
22628.endd
22629but you should check the documentation of the other software to be sure.
22630
22631It is advisable to also set &%quota_size_regex%& when setting &%maildir_tag%&
22632as this allows Exim to extract the size from your tag, instead of having to
22633&[stat()]& each message file.
22634
22635
22636.section "Using a maildirsize file" "SECID136"
22637.cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
22638.cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
22639If &%maildir_use_size_file%& is true, Exim implements the maildir++ rules for
22640storing quota and message size information in a file called &_maildirsize_&
22641within the toplevel maildir directory. If this file does not exist, Exim
22642creates it, setting the quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If
22643the maildir directory itself does not exist, it is created before any attempt
22644to write a &_maildirsize_& file.
22645
22646The &_maildirsize_& file is used to hold information about the sizes of
22647messages in the maildir, thus speeding up quota calculations. The quota value
22648in the file is just a cache; if the quota is changed in the transport, the new
22649value overrides the cached value when the next message is delivered. The cache
22650is maintained for the benefit of other programs that access the maildir and
22651need to know the quota.
22652
22653If the &%quota%& option in the transport is unset or zero, the &_maildirsize_&
22654file is maintained (with a zero quota setting), but no quota is imposed.
22655
22656A regular expression is available for controlling which directories in the
22657maildir participate in quota calculations when a &_maildirsizefile_& is in use.
22658See the description of the &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& option above for
22659details.
22660
22661
22662.section "Mailstore delivery" "SECID137"
22663.cindex "mailstore format" "description of"
22664If the &%mailstore_format%& option is true, each message is written as two
22665files in the given directory. A unique base name is constructed from the
22666message id and the current delivery process, and the files that are written use
22667this base name plus the suffixes &_.env_& and &_.msg_&. The &_.env_& file
22668contains the message's envelope, and the &_.msg_& file contains the message
22669itself. The base name is placed in the variable &$mailstore_basename$&.
22670
22671During delivery, the envelope is first written to a file with the suffix
22672&_.tmp_&. The &_.msg_& file is then written, and when it is complete, the
22673&_.tmp_& file is renamed as the &_.env_& file. Programs that access messages in
22674mailstore format should wait for the presence of both a &_.msg_& and a &_.env_&
22675file before accessing either of them. An alternative approach is to wait for
22676the absence of a &_.tmp_& file.
22677
22678The envelope file starts with any text defined by the &%mailstore_prefix%&
22679option, expanded and terminated by a newline if there isn't one. Then follows
22680the sender address on one line, then all the recipient addresses, one per line.
22681There can be more than one recipient only if the &%batch_max%& option is set
22682greater than one. Finally, &%mailstore_suffix%& is expanded and the result
22683appended to the file, followed by a newline if it does not end with one.
22684
22685If expansion of &%mailstore_prefix%& or &%mailstore_suffix%& ends with a forced
22686failure, it is ignored. Other expansion errors are treated as serious
22687configuration errors, and delivery is deferred. The variable
22688&$mailstore_basename$& is available for use during these expansions.
22689
22690
22691.section "Non-special new file delivery" "SECID138"
22692If neither &%maildir_format%& nor &%mailstore_format%& is set, a single new
22693file is created directly in the named directory. For example, when delivering
22694messages into files in batched SMTP format for later delivery to some host (see
22695section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&), a setting such as
22696.code
22697directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
22698.endd
22699might be used. A message is written to a file with a temporary name, which is
22700then renamed when the delivery is complete. The final name is obtained by
22701expanding the contents of the &%directory_file%& option.
22702.ecindex IIDapptra1
22703.ecindex IIDapptra2
22704
22705
22706
22707
22708
22709
22710. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22711. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22712
22713.chapter "The autoreply transport" "CHID8"
22714.scindex IIDauttra1 "transports" "&(autoreply)&"
22715.scindex IIDauttra2 "&(autoreply)& transport"
22716The &(autoreply)& transport is not a true transport in that it does not cause
22717the message to be transmitted. Instead, it generates a new mail message as an
22718automatic reply to the incoming message. &'References:'& and
22719&'Auto-Submitted:'& header lines are included. These are constructed according
22720to the rules in RFCs 2822 and 3834, respectively.
22721
22722If the router that passes the message to this transport does not have the
22723&%unseen%& option set, the original message (for the current recipient) is not
22724delivered anywhere. However, when the &%unseen%& option is set on the router
22725that passes the message to this transport, routing of the address continues, so
22726another router can set up a normal message delivery.
22727
22728
22729The &(autoreply)& transport is usually run as the result of mail filtering, a
22730&"vacation"& message being the standard example. However, it can also be run
22731directly from a router like any other transport. To reduce the possibility of
22732message cascades, messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport always have
22733empty envelope sender addresses, like bounce messages.
22734
22735The parameters of the message to be sent can be specified in the configuration
22736by options described below. However, these are used only when the address
22737passed to the transport does not contain its own reply information. When the
22738transport is run as a consequence of a
22739&%mail%&
22740or &%vacation%& command in a filter file, the parameters of the message are
22741supplied by the filter, and passed with the address. The transport's options
22742that define the message are then ignored (so they are not usually set in this
22743case). The message is specified entirely by the filter or by the transport; it
22744is never built from a mixture of options. However, the &%file_optional%&,
22745&%mode%&, and &%return_message%& options apply in all cases.
22746
22747&(Autoreply)& is implemented as a local transport. When used as a result of a
22748command in a user's filter file, &(autoreply)& normally runs under the uid and
22749gid of the user, and with appropriate current and home directories (see chapter
22750&<<CHAPenvironment>>&).
22751
22752There is a subtle difference between routing a message to a &(pipe)& transport
22753that generates some text to be returned to the sender, and routing it to an
22754&(autoreply)& transport. This difference is noticeable only if more than one
22755address from the same message is so handled. In the case of a pipe, the
22756separate outputs from the different addresses are gathered up and returned to
22757the sender in a single message, whereas if &(autoreply)& is used, a separate
22758message is generated for each address that is passed to it.
22759
22760Non-printing characters are not permitted in the header lines generated for the
22761message that &(autoreply)& creates, with the exception of newlines that are
22762immediately followed by white space. If any non-printing characters are found,
22763the transport defers.
22764Whether characters with the top bit set count as printing characters or not is
22765controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& global option.
22766
22767If any of the generic options for manipulating headers (for example,
22768&%headers_add%&) are set on an &(autoreply)& transport, they apply to the copy
22769of the original message that is included in the generated message when
22770&%return_message%& is set. They do not apply to the generated message itself.
22771
22772.vindex "&$sender_address$&"
22773If the &(autoreply)& transport receives return code 2 from Exim when it submits
22774the message, indicating that there were no recipients, it does not treat this
22775as an error. This means that autoreplies sent to &$sender_address$& when this
22776is empty (because the incoming message is a bounce message) do not cause
22777problems. They are just discarded.
22778
22779
22780
22781.section "Private options for autoreply" "SECID139"
22782.cindex "options" "&(autoreply)& transport"
22783
22784.option bcc autoreply string&!! unset
22785This specifies the addresses that are to receive &"blind carbon copies"& of the
22786message when the message is specified by the transport.
22787
22788
22789.option cc autoreply string&!! unset
22790This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'Cc:'& header
22791when the message is specified by the transport.
22792
22793
22794.option file autoreply string&!! unset
22795The contents of the file are sent as the body of the message when the message
22796is specified by the transport. If both &%file%& and &%text%& are set, the text
22797string comes first.
22798
22799
22800.option file_expand autoreply boolean false
22801If this is set, the contents of the file named by the &%file%& option are
22802subjected to string expansion as they are added to the message.
22803
22804
22805.option file_optional autoreply boolean false
22806If this option is true, no error is generated if the file named by the &%file%&
22807option or passed with the address does not exist or cannot be read.
22808
22809
22810.option from autoreply string&!! unset
22811This specifies the contents of the &'From:'& header when the message is
22812specified by the transport.
22813
22814
22815.option headers autoreply string&!! unset
22816This specifies additional RFC 2822 headers that are to be added to the message
22817when the message is specified by the transport. Several can be given by using
22818&"\n"& to separate them. There is no check on the format.
22819
22820
22821.option log autoreply string&!! unset
22822This option names a file in which a record of every message sent is logged when
22823the message is specified by the transport.
22824
22825
22826.option mode autoreply "octal integer" 0600
22827If either the log file or the &"once"& file has to be created, this mode is
22828used.
22829
22830
22831.option never_mail autoreply "address list&!!" unset
22832If any run of the transport creates a message with a recipient that matches any
22833item in the list, that recipient is quietly discarded. If all recipients are
22834discarded, no message is created. This applies both when the recipients are
22835generated by a filter and when they are specified in the transport.
22836
22837
22838
22839.option once autoreply string&!! unset
22840This option names a file or DBM database in which a record of each &'To:'&
22841recipient is kept when the message is specified by the transport. &*Note*&:
22842This does not apply to &'Cc:'& or &'Bcc:'& recipients.
22843
22844If &%once%& is unset, or is set to an empty string, the message is always sent.
22845By default, if &%once%& is set to a non-empty file name, the message
22846is not sent if a potential recipient is already listed in the database.
22847However, if the &%once_repeat%& option specifies a time greater than zero, the
22848message is sent if that much time has elapsed since a message was last sent to
22849this recipient. A setting of zero time for &%once_repeat%& (the default)
22850prevents a message from being sent a second time &-- in this case, zero means
22851infinity.
22852
22853If &%once_file_size%& is zero, a DBM database is used to remember recipients,
22854and it is allowed to grow as large as necessary. If &%once_file_size%& is set
22855greater than zero, it changes the way Exim implements the &%once%& option.
22856Instead of using a DBM file to record every recipient it sends to, it uses a
22857regular file, whose size will never get larger than the given value.
22858
22859In the file, Exim keeps a linear list of recipient addresses and the times at
22860which they were sent messages. If the file is full when a new address needs to
22861be added, the oldest address is dropped. If &%once_repeat%& is not set, this
22862means that a given recipient may receive multiple messages, but at
22863unpredictable intervals that depend on the rate of turnover of addresses in the
22864file. If &%once_repeat%& is set, it specifies a maximum time between repeats.
22865
22866
22867.option once_file_size autoreply integer 0
22868See &%once%& above.
22869
22870
22871.option once_repeat autoreply time&!! 0s
22872See &%once%& above.
22873After expansion, the value of this option must be a valid time value.
22874
22875
22876.option reply_to autoreply string&!! unset
22877This specifies the contents of the &'Reply-To:'& header when the message is
22878specified by the transport.
22879
22880
22881.option return_message autoreply boolean false
22882If this is set, a copy of the original message is returned with the new
22883message, subject to the maximum size set in the &%return_size_limit%& global
22884configuration option.
22885
22886
22887.option subject autoreply string&!! unset
22888This specifies the contents of the &'Subject:'& header when the message is
22889specified by the transport. It is tempting to quote the original subject in
22890automatic responses. For example:
22891.code
22892subject = Re: $h_subject:
22893.endd
22894There is a danger in doing this, however. It may allow a third party to
22895subscribe your users to an opt-in mailing list, provided that the list accepts
22896bounce messages as subscription confirmations. Well-managed lists require a
22897non-bounce message to confirm a subscription, so the danger is relatively
22898small.
22899
22900
22901
22902.option text autoreply string&!! unset
22903This specifies a single string to be used as the body of the message when the
22904message is specified by the transport. If both &%text%& and &%file%& are set,
22905the text comes first.
22906
22907
22908.option to autoreply string&!! unset
22909This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'To:'& header
22910when the message is specified by the transport.
22911.ecindex IIDauttra1
22912.ecindex IIDauttra2
22913
22914
22915
22916
22917. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22918. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22919
22920.chapter "The lmtp transport" "CHAPLMTP"
22921.cindex "transports" "&(lmtp)&"
22922.cindex "&(lmtp)& transport"
22923.cindex "LMTP" "over a pipe"
22924.cindex "LMTP" "over a socket"
22925The &(lmtp)& transport runs the LMTP protocol (RFC 2033) over a pipe to a
22926specified command
22927or by interacting with a Unix domain socket.
22928This transport is something of a cross between the &(pipe)& and &(smtp)&
22929transports. Exim also has support for using LMTP over TCP/IP; this is
22930implemented as an option for the &(smtp)& transport. Because LMTP is expected
22931to be of minority interest, the default build-time configure in &_src/EDITME_&
22932has it commented out. You need to ensure that
22933.code
22934TRANSPORT_LMTP=yes
22935.endd
22936.cindex "options" "&(lmtp)& transport"
22937is present in your &_Local/Makefile_& in order to have the &(lmtp)& transport
22938included in the Exim binary. The private options of the &(lmtp)& transport are
22939as follows:
22940
22941.option batch_id lmtp string&!! unset
22942See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22943
22944
22945.option batch_max lmtp integer 1
22946This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
22947Most LMTP servers can handle several addresses at once, so it is normally a
22948good idea to increase this value. See the description of local delivery
22949batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22950
22951
22952.option command lmtp string&!! unset
22953This option must be set if &%socket%& is not set. The string is a command which
22954is run in a separate process. It is split up into a command name and list of
22955arguments, each of which is separately expanded (so expansion cannot change the
22956number of arguments). The command is run directly, not via a shell. The message
22957is passed to the new process using the standard input and output to operate the
22958LMTP protocol.
22959
22960.option ignore_quota lmtp boolean false
22961.cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
22962If this option is set true, the string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT
22963commands, provided that the LMTP server has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA
22964in its response to the LHLO command.
22965
22966.option socket lmtp string&!! unset
22967This option must be set if &%command%& is not set. The result of expansion must
22968be the name of a Unix domain socket. The transport connects to the socket and
22969delivers the message to it using the LMTP protocol.
22970
22971
22972.option timeout lmtp time 5m
22973The transport is aborted if the created process or Unix domain socket does not
22974respond to LMTP commands or message input within this timeout. Delivery
22975is deferred, and will be tried again later. Here is an example of a typical
22976LMTP transport:
22977.code
22978lmtp:
22979 driver = lmtp
22980 command = /some/local/lmtp/delivery/program
22981 batch_max = 20
22982 user = exim
22983.endd
22984This delivers up to 20 addresses at a time, in a mixture of domains if
22985necessary, running as the user &'exim'&.
22986
22987
22988
22989. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22990. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22991
22992.chapter "The pipe transport" "CHAPpipetransport"
22993.scindex IIDpiptra1 "transports" "&(pipe)&"
22994.scindex IIDpiptra2 "&(pipe)& transport"
22995The &(pipe)& transport is used to deliver messages via a pipe to a command
22996running in another process. One example is the use of &(pipe)& as a
22997pseudo-remote transport for passing messages to some other delivery mechanism
22998(such as UUCP). Another is the use by individual users to automatically process
22999their incoming messages. The &(pipe)& transport can be used in one of the
23000following ways:
23001
23002.ilist
23003.vindex "&$local_part$&"
23004A router routes one address to a transport in the normal way, and the
23005transport is configured as a &(pipe)& transport. In this case, &$local_part$&
23006contains the local part of the address (as usual), and the command that is run
23007is specified by the &%command%& option on the transport.
23008.next
23009.vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
23010If the &%batch_max%& option is set greater than 1 (the default is 1), the
23011transport can handle more than one address in a single run. In this case, when
23012more than one address is routed to the transport, &$local_part$& is not set
23013(because it is not unique). However, the pseudo-variable &$pipe_addresses$&
23014(described in section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& below) contains all the addresses
23015that are routed to the transport.
23016.next
23017.vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
23018A router redirects an address directly to a pipe command (for example, from an
23019alias or forward file). In this case, &$address_pipe$& contains the text of the
23020pipe command, and the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored unless
23021&%force_command%& is set. If only one address is being transported
23022(&%batch_max%& is not greater than one, or only one address was redirected to
23023this pipe command), &$local_part$& contains the local part that was redirected.
23024.endlist
23025
23026
23027The &(pipe)& transport is a non-interactive delivery method. Exim can also
23028deliver messages over pipes using the LMTP interactive protocol. This is
23029implemented by the &(lmtp)& transport.
23030
23031In the case when &(pipe)& is run as a consequence of an entry in a local user's
23032&_.forward_& file, the command runs under the uid and gid of that user. In
23033other cases, the uid and gid have to be specified explicitly, either on the
23034transport or on the router that handles the address. Current and &"home"&
23035directories are also controllable. See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for
23036details of the local delivery environment and chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&
23037for a discussion of local delivery batching.
23038
23039
23040.section "Concurrent delivery" "SECID140"
23041If two messages arrive at almost the same time, and both are routed to a pipe
23042delivery, the two pipe transports may be run concurrently. You must ensure that
23043any pipe commands you set up are robust against this happening. If the commands
23044write to a file, the &%exim_lock%& utility might be of use.
23045Alternatively the &%max_parallel%& option could be used with a value
23046of "1" to enforce serialization.
23047
23048
23049
23050
23051.section "Returned status and data" "SECID141"
23052.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "returned data"
23053If the command exits with a non-zero return code, the delivery is deemed to
23054have failed, unless either the &%ignore_status%& option is set (in which case
23055the return code is treated as zero), or the return code is one of those listed
23056in the &%temp_errors%& option, which are interpreted as meaning &"try again
23057later"&. In this case, delivery is deferred. Details of a permanent failure are
23058logged, but are not included in the bounce message, which merely contains
23059&"local delivery failed"&.
23060
23061If the command exits on a signal and the &%freeze_signal%& option is set then
23062the message will be frozen in the queue. If that option is not set, a bounce
23063will be sent as normal.
23064
23065If the return code is greater than 128 and the command being run is a shell
23066script, it normally means that the script was terminated by a signal whose
23067value is the return code minus 128. The &%freeze_signal%& option does not
23068apply in this case.
23069
23070If Exim is unable to run the command (that is, if &[execve()]& fails), the
23071return code is set to 127. This is the value that a shell returns if it is
23072asked to run a non-existent command. The wording for the log line suggests that
23073a non-existent command may be the problem.
23074
23075The &%return_output%& option can affect the result of a pipe delivery. If it is
23076set and the command produces any output on its standard output or standard
23077error streams, the command is considered to have failed, even if it gave a zero
23078return code or if &%ignore_status%& is set. The output from the command is
23079included as part of the bounce message. The &%return_fail_output%& option is
23080similar, except that output is returned only when the command exits with a
23081failure return code, that is, a value other than zero or a code that matches
23082&%temp_errors%&.
23083
23084
23085
23086.section "How the command is run" "SECThowcommandrun"
23087.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "path for command"
23088The command line is (by default) broken down into a command name and arguments
23089by the &(pipe)& transport itself. The &%allow_commands%& and
23090&%restrict_to_path%& options can be used to restrict the commands that may be
23091run.
23092
23093.cindex "quoting" "in pipe command"
23094Unquoted arguments are delimited by white space. If an argument appears in
23095double quotes, backslash is interpreted as an escape character in the usual
23096way. If an argument appears in single quotes, no escaping is done.
23097
23098String expansion is applied to the command line except when it comes from a
23099traditional &_.forward_& file (commands from a filter file are expanded). The
23100expansion is applied to each argument in turn rather than to the whole line.
23101For this reason, any string expansion item that contains white space must be
23102quoted so as to be contained within a single argument. A setting such as
23103.code
23104command = /some/path ${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}
23105.endd
23106will not work, because the expansion item gets split between several
23107arguments. You have to write
23108.code
23109command = /some/path "${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}"
23110.endd
23111to ensure that it is all in one argument. The expansion is done in this way,
23112argument by argument, so that the number of arguments cannot be changed as a
23113result of expansion, and quotes or backslashes in inserted variables do not
23114interact with external quoting. However, this leads to problems if you want to
23115generate multiple arguments (or the command name plus arguments) from a single
23116expansion. In this situation, the simplest solution is to use a shell. For
23117example:
23118.code
23119command = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/some/file}}
23120.endd
23121
23122.cindex "transport" "filter"
23123.cindex "filter" "transport filter"
23124.vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
23125Special handling takes place when an argument consists of precisely the text
23126&`$pipe_addresses`&. This is not a general expansion variable; the only
23127place this string is recognized is when it appears as an argument for a pipe or
23128transport filter command. It causes each address that is being handled to be
23129inserted in the argument list at that point &'as a separate argument'&. This
23130avoids any problems with spaces or shell metacharacters, and is of use when a
23131&(pipe)& transport is handling groups of addresses in a batch.
23132
23133If &%force_command%& is enabled on the transport, Special handling takes place
23134for an argument that consists of precisely the text &`$address_pipe`&. It
23135is handled similarly to &$pipe_addresses$& above. It is expanded and each
23136argument is inserted in the argument list at that point
23137&'as a separate argument'&. The &`$address_pipe`& item does not need to be
23138the only item in the argument; in fact, if it were then &%force_command%&
23139should behave as a no-op. Rather, it should be used to adjust the command
23140run while preserving the argument vector separation.
23141
23142After splitting up into arguments and expansion, the resulting command is run
23143in a subprocess directly from the transport, &'not'& under a shell. The
23144message that is being delivered is supplied on the standard input, and the
23145standard output and standard error are both connected to a single pipe that is
23146read by Exim. The &%max_output%& option controls how much output the command
23147may produce, and the &%return_output%& and &%return_fail_output%& options
23148control what is done with it.
23149
23150Not running the command under a shell (by default) lessens the security risks
23151in cases when a command from a user's filter file is built out of data that was
23152taken from an incoming message. If a shell is required, it can of course be
23153explicitly specified as the command to be run. However, there are circumstances
23154where existing commands (for example, in &_.forward_& files) expect to be run
23155under a shell and cannot easily be modified. To allow for these cases, there is
23156an option called &%use_shell%&, which changes the way the &(pipe)& transport
23157works. Instead of breaking up the command line as just described, it expands it
23158as a single string and passes the result to &_/bin/sh_&. The
23159&%restrict_to_path%& option and the &$pipe_addresses$& facility cannot be used
23160with &%use_shell%&, and the whole mechanism is inherently less secure.
23161
23162
23163
23164.section "Environment variables" "SECTpipeenv"
23165.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
23166.cindex "environment" "&(pipe)& transport"
23167The environment variables listed below are set up when the command is invoked.
23168This list is a compromise for maximum compatibility with other MTAs. Note that
23169the &%environment%& option can be used to add additional variables to this
23170environment. The environment for the &(pipe)& transport is not subject
23171to the &%add_environment%& and &%keep_environment%& main config options.
23172.display
23173&`DOMAIN `& the domain of the address
23174&`HOME `& the home directory, if set
23175&`HOST `& the host name when called from a router (see below)
23176&`LOCAL_PART `& see below
23177&`LOCAL_PART_PREFIX `& see below
23178&`LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX `& see below
23179&`LOGNAME `& see below
23180&`MESSAGE_ID `& Exim's local ID for the message
23181&`PATH `& as specified by the &%path%& option below
23182&`QUALIFY_DOMAIN `& the sender qualification domain
23183&`RECIPIENT `& the complete recipient address
23184&`SENDER `& the sender of the message (empty if a bounce)
23185&`SHELL `& &`/bin/sh`&
23186&`TZ `& the value of the &%timezone%& option, if set
23187&`USER `& see below
23188.endd
23189When a &(pipe)& transport is called directly from (for example) an &(accept)&
23190router, LOCAL_PART is set to the local part of the address. When it is
23191called as a result of a forward or alias expansion, LOCAL_PART is set to
23192the local part of the address that was expanded. In both cases, any affixes are
23193removed from the local part, and made available in LOCAL_PART_PREFIX and
23194LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX, respectively. LOGNAME and USER are set to the
23195same value as LOCAL_PART for compatibility with other MTAs.
23196
23197.cindex "HOST"
23198HOST is set only when a &(pipe)& transport is called from a router that
23199associates hosts with an address, typically when using &(pipe)& as a
23200pseudo-remote transport. HOST is set to the first host name specified by
23201the router.
23202
23203.cindex "HOME"
23204If the transport's generic &%home_directory%& option is set, its value is used
23205for the HOME environment variable. Otherwise, a home directory may be set
23206by the router's &%transport_home_directory%& option, which defaults to the
23207user's home directory if &%check_local_user%& is set.
23208
23209
23210.section "Private options for pipe" "SECID142"
23211.cindex "options" "&(pipe)& transport"
23212
23213
23214
23215.option allow_commands pipe "string list&!!" unset
23216.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "permitted commands"
23217The string is expanded, and is then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
23218permitted commands. If &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only commands
23219permitted are those in the &%allow_commands%& list. They need not be absolute
23220paths; the &%path%& option is still used for relative paths. If
23221&%restrict_to_path%& is set with &%allow_commands%&, the command must either be
23222in the &%allow_commands%& list, or a name without any slashes that is found on
23223the path. In other words, if neither &%allow_commands%& nor
23224&%restrict_to_path%& is set, there is no restriction on the command, but
23225otherwise only commands that are permitted by one or the other are allowed. For
23226example, if
23227.code
23228allow_commands = /usr/bin/vacation
23229.endd
23230and &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only permitted command is
23231&_/usr/bin/vacation_&. The &%allow_commands%& option may not be set if
23232&%use_shell%& is set.
23233
23234
23235.option batch_id pipe string&!! unset
23236See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23237
23238
23239.option batch_max pipe integer 1
23240This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
23241See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23242
23243
23244.option check_string pipe string unset
23245As &(pipe)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for matching
23246&%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are replaced
23247by the contents of &%escape_string%&, provided both are set. The value of
23248&%check_string%& is a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of
23249any letters it contains is significant. When &%use_bsmtp%& is set, the contents
23250of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& are forced to values that implement
23251the SMTP escaping protocol. Any settings made in the configuration file are
23252ignored.
23253
23254
23255.option command pipe string&!! unset
23256This option need not be set when &(pipe)& is being used to deliver to pipes
23257obtained directly from address redirections. In other cases, the option must be
23258set, to provide a command to be run. It need not yield an absolute path (see
23259the &%path%& option below). The command is split up into separate arguments by
23260Exim, and each argument is separately expanded, as described in section
23261&<<SECThowcommandrun>>& above.
23262
23263
23264.option environment pipe string&!! unset
23265.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
23266.cindex "environment" "&(pipe)& transport"
23267This option is used to add additional variables to the environment in which the
23268command runs (see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the default list). Its value is
23269a string which is expanded, and then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
23270environment settings of the form <&'name'&>=<&'value'&>.
23271
23272
23273.option escape_string pipe string unset
23274See &%check_string%& above.
23275
23276
23277.option freeze_exec_fail pipe boolean false
23278.cindex "exec failure"
23279.cindex "failure of exec"
23280.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "failure of exec"
23281Failure to exec the command in a pipe transport is by default treated like
23282any other failure while running the command. However, if &%freeze_exec_fail%&
23283is set, failure to exec is treated specially, and causes the message to be
23284frozen, whatever the setting of &%ignore_status%&.
23285
23286
23287.option freeze_signal pipe boolean false
23288.cindex "signal exit"
23289.cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "signal exit"
23290Normally if the process run by a command in a pipe transport exits on a signal,
23291a bounce message is sent. If &%freeze_signal%& is set, the message will be
23292frozen in Exim's queue instead.
23293
23294
23295.option force_command pipe boolean false
23296.cindex "force command"
23297.cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "force command"
23298Normally when a router redirects an address directly to a pipe command
23299the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored. If &%force_command%&
23300is set, the &%command%& option will used. This is especially
23301useful for forcing a wrapper or additional argument to be added to the
23302command. For example:
23303.code
23304command = /usr/bin/remote_exec myhost -- $address_pipe
23305force_command
23306.endd
23307
23308Note that &$address_pipe$& is handled specially in &%command%& when
23309&%force_command%& is set, expanding out to the original argument vector as
23310separate items, similarly to a Unix shell &`"$@"`& construct.
23311
23312
23313.option ignore_status pipe boolean false
23314If this option is true, the status returned by the subprocess that is set up to
23315run the command is ignored, and Exim behaves as if zero had been returned.
23316Otherwise, a non-zero status or termination by signal causes an error return
23317from the transport unless the status value is one of those listed in
23318&%temp_errors%&; these cause the delivery to be deferred and tried again later.
23319
23320&*Note*&: This option does not apply to timeouts, which do not return a status.
23321See the &%timeout_defer%& option for how timeouts are handled.
23322
23323
23324.option log_defer_output pipe boolean false
23325.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "logging output"
23326If this option is set, and the status returned by the command is
23327one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, delivery was deferred),
23328and any output was produced on stdout or stderr, the first line of it is
23329written to the main log.
23330
23331
23332.option log_fail_output pipe boolean false
23333If this option is set, and the command returns any output on stdout or
23334stderr, and also ends with a return code that is neither zero nor one of
23335the return codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, the delivery
23336failed), the first line of output is written to the main log. This
23337option and &%log_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may
23338be set.
23339
23340
23341.option log_output pipe boolean false
23342If this option is set and the command returns any output on stdout or
23343stderr, the first line of output is written to the main log, whatever
23344the return code. This option and &%log_fail_output%& are mutually
23345exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
23346
23347
23348.option max_output pipe integer 20K
23349This specifies the maximum amount of output that the command may produce on its
23350standard output and standard error file combined. If the limit is exceeded, the
23351process running the command is killed. This is intended as a safety measure to
23352catch runaway processes. The limit is applied independently of the settings of
23353the options that control what is done with such output (for example,
23354&%return_output%&). Because of buffering effects, the amount of output may
23355exceed the limit by a small amount before Exim notices.
23356
23357
23358.option message_prefix pipe string&!! "see below"
23359The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
23360The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is
23361.code
23362message_prefix = \
23363 From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}{MAILER-DAEMON}}\
23364 ${tod_bsdinbox}\n
23365.endd
23366.cindex "Cyrus"
23367.cindex "&%tmail%&"
23368.cindex "&""From""& line"
23369This is required by the commonly used &_/usr/bin/vacation_& program.
23370However, it must &'not'& be present if delivery is to the Cyrus IMAP server,
23371or to the &%tmail%& local delivery agent. The prefix can be suppressed by
23372setting
23373.code
23374message_prefix =
23375.endd
23376&*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
23377&`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
23378
23379
23380.option message_suffix pipe string&!! "see below"
23381The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
23382The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is a single newline.
23383The suffix can be suppressed by setting
23384.code
23385message_suffix =
23386.endd
23387&*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
23388&`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
23389
23390
23391.option path pipe string&!! "/bin:/usr/bin"
23392This option is expanded and
23393specifies the string that is set up in the PATH environment
23394variable of the subprocess.
23395If the &%command%& option does not yield an absolute path name, the command is
23396sought in the PATH directories, in the usual way. &*Warning*&: This does not
23397apply to a command specified as a transport filter.
23398
23399
23400.option permit_coredump pipe boolean false
23401Normally Exim inhibits core-dumps during delivery. If you have a need to get
23402a core-dump of a pipe command, enable this command. This enables core-dumps
23403during delivery and affects both the Exim binary and the pipe command run.
23404It is recommended that this option remain off unless and until you have a need
23405for it and that this only be enabled when needed, as the risk of excessive
23406resource consumption can be quite high. Note also that Exim is typically
23407installed as a setuid binary and most operating systems will inhibit coredumps
23408of these by default, so further OS-specific action may be required.
23409
23410
23411.option pipe_as_creator pipe boolean false
23412.cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
23413If the generic &%user%& option is not set and this option is true, the delivery
23414process is run under the uid that was in force when Exim was originally called
23415to accept the message. If the group id is not otherwise set (via the generic
23416&%group%& option), the gid that was in force when Exim was originally called to
23417accept the message is used.
23418
23419
23420.option restrict_to_path pipe boolean false
23421When this option is set, any command name not listed in &%allow_commands%& must
23422contain no slashes. The command is searched for only in the directories listed
23423in the &%path%& option. This option is intended for use in the case when a pipe
23424command has been generated from a user's &_.forward_& file. This is usually
23425handled by a &(pipe)& transport called &%address_pipe%&.
23426
23427
23428.option return_fail_output pipe boolean false
23429If this option is true, and the command produced any output and ended with a
23430return code other than zero or one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that
23431is, the delivery failed), the output is returned in the bounce message.
23432However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is itself a bounce
23433message), output from the command is discarded. This option and
23434&%return_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
23435
23436
23437
23438.option return_output pipe boolean false
23439If this option is true, and the command produced any output, the delivery is
23440deemed to have failed whatever the return code from the command, and the output
23441is returned in the bounce message. Otherwise, the output is just discarded.
23442However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is a bounce message),
23443output from the command is always discarded, whatever the setting of this
23444option. This option and &%return_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one
23445of them may be set.
23446
23447
23448
23449.option temp_errors pipe "string list" "see below"
23450.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "temporary failure"
23451This option contains either a colon-separated list of numbers, or a single
23452asterisk. If &%ignore_status%& is false
23453and &%return_output%& is not set,
23454and the command exits with a non-zero return code, the failure is treated as
23455temporary and the delivery is deferred if the return code matches one of the
23456numbers, or if the setting is a single asterisk. Otherwise, non-zero return
23457codes are treated as permanent errors. The default setting contains the codes
23458defined by EX_TEMPFAIL and EX_CANTCREAT in &_sysexits.h_&. If Exim is
23459compiled on a system that does not define these macros, it assumes values of 75
23460and 73, respectively.
23461
23462
23463.option timeout pipe time 1h
23464If the command fails to complete within this time, it is killed. This normally
23465causes the delivery to fail (but see &%timeout_defer%&). A zero time interval
23466specifies no timeout. In order to ensure that any subprocesses created by the
23467command are also killed, Exim makes the initial process a process group leader,
23468and kills the whole process group on a timeout. However, this can be defeated
23469if one of the processes starts a new process group.
23470
23471.option timeout_defer pipe boolean false
23472A timeout in a &(pipe)& transport, either in the command that the transport
23473runs, or in a transport filter that is associated with it, is by default
23474treated as a hard error, and the delivery fails. However, if &%timeout_defer%&
23475is set true, both kinds of timeout become temporary errors, causing the
23476delivery to be deferred.
23477
23478.option umask pipe "octal integer" 022
23479This specifies the umask setting for the subprocess that runs the command.
23480
23481
23482.option use_bsmtp pipe boolean false
23483.cindex "envelope sender"
23484If this option is set true, the &(pipe)& transport writes messages in &"batch
23485SMTP"& format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP
23486commands. If you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages,
23487you can do so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section
23488&<<SECTbatchSMTP>>& for details of batch SMTP.
23489
23490.option use_classresources pipe boolean false
23491.cindex "class resources (BSD)"
23492This option is available only when Exim is running on FreeBSD, NetBSD, or
23493BSD/OS. If it is set true, the &[setclassresources()]& function is used to set
23494resource limits when a &(pipe)& transport is run to perform a delivery. The
23495limits for the uid under which the pipe is to run are obtained from the login
23496class database.
23497
23498
23499.option use_crlf pipe boolean false
23500.cindex "carriage return"
23501.cindex "linefeed"
23502This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
23503(carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
23504of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the pipe is then an exact image
23505of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
23506
23507The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are
23508written verbatim, so must contain their own carriage return characters if these
23509are needed. When &%use_bsmtp%& is not set, the default values for both
23510&%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& end with a single linefeed, so their
23511values must be changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
23512
23513
23514.option use_shell pipe boolean false
23515.vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
23516If this option is set, it causes the command to be passed to &_/bin/sh_&
23517instead of being run directly from the transport, as described in section
23518&<<SECThowcommandrun>>&. This is less secure, but is needed in some situations
23519where the command is expected to be run under a shell and cannot easily be
23520modified. The &%allow_commands%& and &%restrict_to_path%& options, and the
23521&`$pipe_addresses`& facility are incompatible with &%use_shell%&. The
23522command is expanded as a single string, and handed to &_/bin/sh_& as data for
23523its &%-c%& option.
23524
23525
23526
23527.section "Using an external local delivery agent" "SECID143"
23528.cindex "local delivery" "using an external agent"
23529.cindex "&'procmail'&"
23530.cindex "external local delivery"
23531.cindex "delivery" "&'procmail'&"
23532.cindex "delivery" "by external agent"
23533The &(pipe)& transport can be used to pass all messages that require local
23534delivery to a separate local delivery agent such as &%procmail%&. When doing
23535this, care must be taken to ensure that the pipe is run under an appropriate
23536uid and gid. In some configurations one wants this to be a uid that is trusted
23537by the delivery agent to supply the correct sender of the message. It may be
23538necessary to recompile or reconfigure the delivery agent so that it trusts an
23539appropriate user. The following is an example transport and router
23540configuration for &%procmail%&:
23541.code
23542# transport
23543procmail_pipe:
23544 driver = pipe
23545 command = /usr/local/bin/procmail -d $local_part
23546 return_path_add
23547 delivery_date_add
23548 envelope_to_add
23549 check_string = "From "
23550 escape_string = ">From "
23551 umask = 077
23552 user = $local_part
23553 group = mail
23554
23555# router
23556procmail:
23557 driver = accept
23558 check_local_user
23559 transport = procmail_pipe
23560.endd
23561In this example, the pipe is run as the local user, but with the group set to
23562&'mail'&. An alternative is to run the pipe as a specific user such as &'mail'&
23563or &'exim'&, but in this case you must arrange for &%procmail%& to trust that
23564user to supply a correct sender address. If you do not specify either a
23565&%group%& or a &%user%& option, the pipe command is run as the local user. The
23566home directory is the user's home directory by default.
23567
23568&*Note*&: The command that the pipe transport runs does &'not'& begin with
23569.code
23570IFS=" "
23571.endd
23572as shown in some &%procmail%& documentation, because Exim does not by default
23573use a shell to run pipe commands.
23574
23575.cindex "Cyrus"
23576The next example shows a transport and a router for a system where local
23577deliveries are handled by the Cyrus IMAP server.
23578.code
23579# transport
23580local_delivery_cyrus:
23581 driver = pipe
23582 command = /usr/cyrus/bin/deliver \
23583 -m ${substr_1:$local_part_suffix} -- $local_part
23584 user = cyrus
23585 group = mail
23586 return_output
23587 log_output
23588 message_prefix =
23589 message_suffix =
23590
23591# router
23592local_user_cyrus:
23593 driver = accept
23594 check_local_user
23595 local_part_suffix = .*
23596 transport = local_delivery_cyrus
23597.endd
23598Note the unsetting of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, and the use of
23599&%return_output%& to cause any text written by Cyrus to be returned to the
23600sender.
23601.ecindex IIDpiptra1
23602.ecindex IIDpiptra2
23603
23604
23605. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23606. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23607
23608.chapter "The smtp transport" "CHAPsmtptrans"
23609.scindex IIDsmttra1 "transports" "&(smtp)&"
23610.scindex IIDsmttra2 "&(smtp)& transport"
23611The &(smtp)& transport delivers messages over TCP/IP connections using the SMTP
23612or LMTP protocol. The list of hosts to try can either be taken from the address
23613that is being processed (having been set up by the router), or specified
23614explicitly for the transport. Timeout and retry processing (see chapter
23615&<<CHAPretry>>&) is applied to each IP address independently.
23616
23617
23618.section "Multiple messages on a single connection" "SECID144"
23619The sending of multiple messages over a single TCP/IP connection can arise in
23620two ways:
23621
23622.ilist
23623If a message contains more than &%max_rcpt%& (see below) addresses that are
23624routed to the same host, more than one copy of the message has to be sent to
23625that host. In this situation, multiple copies may be sent in a single run of
23626the &(smtp)& transport over a single TCP/IP connection. (What Exim actually
23627does when it has too many addresses to send in one message also depends on the
23628value of the global &%remote_max_parallel%& option. Details are given in
23629section &<<SECToutSMTPTCP>>&.)
23630.next
23631.cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
23632When a message has been successfully delivered over a TCP/IP connection, Exim
23633looks in its hints database to see if there are any other messages awaiting a
23634connection to the same host. If there are, a new delivery process is started
23635for one of them, and the current TCP/IP connection is passed on to it. The new
23636process may in turn send multiple copies and possibly create yet another
23637process.
23638.endlist
23639
23640
23641For each copy sent over the same TCP/IP connection, a sequence counter is
23642incremented, and if it ever gets to the value of &%connection_max_messages%&,
23643no further messages are sent over that connection.
23644
23645
23646
23647.section "Use of the $host and $host_address variables" "SECID145"
23648.vindex "&$host$&"
23649.vindex "&$host_address$&"
23650At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$host$& and
23651&$host_address$& are the name and IP address of the first host on the host list
23652passed by the router. However, when the transport is about to connect to a
23653specific host, and while it is connected to that host, &$host$& and
23654&$host_address$& are set to the values for that host. These are the values
23655that are in force when the &%helo_data%&, &%hosts_try_auth%&, &%interface%&,
23656&%serialize_hosts%&, and the various TLS options are expanded.
23657
23658
23659.section "Use of $tls_cipher and $tls_peerdn" "usecippeer"
23660.vindex &$tls_bits$&
23661.vindex &$tls_cipher$&
23662.vindex &$tls_peerdn$&
23663.vindex &$tls_sni$&
23664At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$tls_bits$&,
23665&$tls_cipher$&, &$tls_peerdn$& and &$tls_sni$&
23666are the values that were set when the message was received.
23667These are the values that are used for options that are expanded before any
23668SMTP connections are made. Just before each connection is made, these four
23669variables are emptied. If TLS is subsequently started, they are set to the
23670appropriate values for the outgoing connection, and these are the values that
23671are in force when any authenticators are run and when the
23672&%authenticated_sender%& option is expanded.
23673
23674These variables are deprecated in favour of &$tls_in_cipher$& et. al.
23675and will be removed in a future release.
23676
23677
23678.section "Private options for smtp" "SECID146"
23679.cindex "options" "&(smtp)& transport"
23680The private options of the &(smtp)& transport are as follows:
23681
23682
23683.option address_retry_include_sender smtp boolean true
23684.cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retrying after"
23685When an address is delayed because of a 4&'xx'& response to a RCPT command, it
23686is the combination of sender and recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue
23687runs until the retry time is reached. You can delay the recipient without
23688reference to the sender (which is what earlier versions of Exim did), by
23689setting &%address_retry_include_sender%& false. However, this can lead to
23690problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT commands.
23691
23692.option allow_localhost smtp boolean false
23693.cindex "local host" "sending to"
23694.cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
23695When a host specified in &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& (see below) turns out
23696to be the local host, or is listed in &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, delivery is
23697deferred by default. However, if &%allow_localhost%& is set, Exim goes on to do
23698the delivery anyway. This should be used only in special cases when the
23699configuration ensures that no looping will result (for example, a differently
23700configured Exim is listening on the port to which the message is sent).
23701
23702
23703.option authenticated_sender smtp string&!! unset
23704.cindex "Cyrus"
23705When Exim has authenticated as a client, or if &%authenticated_sender_force%&
23706is true, this option sets a value for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands,
23707overriding any existing authenticated sender value. If the string expansion is
23708forced to fail, the option is ignored. Other expansion failures cause delivery
23709to be deferred. If the result of expansion is an empty string, that is also
23710ignored.
23711
23712The expansion happens after the outgoing connection has been made and TLS
23713started, if required. This means that the &$host$&, &$host_address$&,
23714&$tls_out_cipher$&, and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables are set according to the
23715particular connection.
23716
23717If the SMTP session is not authenticated, the expansion of
23718&%authenticated_sender%& still happens (and can cause the delivery to be
23719deferred if it fails), but no AUTH= item is added to MAIL commands
23720unless &%authenticated_sender_force%& is true.
23721
23722This option allows you to use the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode to
23723deliver mail to Cyrus IMAP and provide the proper local part as the
23724&"authenticated sender"&, via a setting such as:
23725.code
23726authenticated_sender = $local_part
23727.endd
23728This removes the need for IMAP subfolders to be assigned special ACLs to
23729allow direct delivery to those subfolders.
23730
23731Because of expected uses such as that just described for Cyrus (when no
23732domain is involved), there is no checking on the syntax of the provided
23733value.
23734
23735
23736.option authenticated_sender_force smtp boolean false
23737If this option is set true, the &%authenticated_sender%& option's value
23738is used for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands, even if Exim has not
23739authenticated as a client.
23740
23741
23742.option command_timeout smtp time 5m
23743This sets a timeout for receiving a response to an SMTP command that has been
23744sent out. It is also used when waiting for the initial banner line from the
23745remote host. Its value must not be zero.
23746
23747
23748.option connect_timeout smtp time 5m
23749This sets a timeout for the &[connect()]& function, which sets up a TCP/IP call
23750to a remote host. A setting of zero allows the system timeout (typically
23751several minutes) to act. To have any effect, the value of this option must be
23752less than the system timeout. However, it has been observed that on some
23753systems there is no system timeout, which is why the default value for this
23754option is 5 minutes, a value recommended by RFC 1123.
23755
23756
23757.option connection_max_messages smtp integer 500
23758.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
23759.cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
23760.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
23761This controls the maximum number of separate message deliveries that are sent
23762over a single TCP/IP connection. If the value is zero, there is no limit.
23763For testing purposes, this value can be overridden by the &%-oB%& command line
23764option.
23765
23766
23767.option data_timeout smtp time 5m
23768This sets a timeout for the transmission of each block in the data portion of
23769the message. As a result, the overall timeout for a message depends on the size
23770of the message. Its value must not be zero. See also &%final_timeout%&.
23771
23772
23773.option dkim_domain smtp string list&!! unset
23774.option dkim_selector smtp string&!! unset
23775.option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
23776.option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
23777.option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
23778.option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! unset
23779DKIM signing options. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
23780
23781
23782.option delay_after_cutoff smtp boolean true
23783This option controls what happens when all remote IP addresses for a given
23784domain have been inaccessible for so long that they have passed their retry
23785cutoff times.
23786
23787In the default state, if the next retry time has not been reached for any of
23788them, the address is bounced without trying any deliveries. In other words,
23789Exim delays retrying an IP address after the final cutoff time until a new
23790retry time is reached, and can therefore bounce an address without ever trying
23791a delivery, when machines have been down for a long time. Some people are
23792unhappy at this prospect, so...
23793
23794If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
23795addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those
23796IP addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
23797none, of if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other words, it does not
23798delay when a new message arrives, but immediately tries those expired IP
23799addresses that haven't been tried since the message arrived. If there is a
23800continuous stream of messages for the dead hosts, unsetting
23801&%delay_after_cutoff%& means that there will be many more attempts to deliver
23802to them.
23803
23804
23805.option dns_qualify_single smtp boolean true
23806If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used,
23807and the &%gethostbyname%& option is false,
23808the RES_DEFNAMES resolver option is set. See the &%qualify_single%& option
23809in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more details.
23810
23811
23812.option dns_search_parents smtp boolean false
23813If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used, and the
23814&%gethostbyname%& option is false, the RES_DNSRCH resolver option is set.
23815See the &%search_parents%& option in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more
23816details.
23817
23818
23819.option dnssec_request_domains smtp "domain list&!!" unset
23820.cindex "MX record" "security"
23821.cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
23822.cindex "security" "MX lookup"
23823.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
23824DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
23825the dnssec request bit set.
23826This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
23827
23828
23829
23830.option dnssec_require_domains smtp "domain list&!!" unset
23831.cindex "MX record" "security"
23832.cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
23833.cindex "security" "MX lookup"
23834.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
23835DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_require_domains%& will be done with
23836the dnssec request bit set. Any returns not having the Authenticated Data bit
23837(AD bit) set will be ignored and logged as a host-lookup failure.
23838This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
23839
23840
23841
23842.option dscp smtp string&!! unset
23843.cindex "DCSP" "outbound"
23844This option causes the DSCP value associated with a socket to be set to one
23845of a number of fixed strings or to numeric value.
23846The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
23847Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
23848&`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
23849
23850The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
23851(for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
23852that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
23853equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
23854Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
23855
23856
23857.option fallback_hosts smtp "string list" unset
23858.cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
23859String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
23860colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses, optionally also including
23861port numbers, though the separator can be changed, as described in section
23862&<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
23863item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
23864in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&.
23865
23866Fallback hosts can also be specified on routers, which associate them with the
23867addresses they process. As for the &%hosts%& option without &%hosts_override%&,
23868&%fallback_hosts%& specified on the transport is used only if the address does
23869not have its own associated fallback host list. Unlike &%hosts%&, a setting of
23870&%fallback_hosts%& on an address is not overridden by &%hosts_override%&.
23871However, &%hosts_randomize%& does apply to fallback host lists.
23872
23873If Exim is unable to deliver to any of the hosts for a particular address, and
23874the errors are not permanent rejections, the address is put on a separate
23875transport queue with its host list replaced by the fallback hosts, unless the
23876address was routed via MX records and the current host was in the original MX
23877list. In that situation, the fallback host list is not used.
23878
23879Once normal deliveries are complete, the fallback queue is delivered by
23880re-running the same transports with the new host lists. If several failing
23881addresses have the same fallback hosts (and &%max_rcpt%& permits it), a single
23882copy of the message is sent.
23883
23884The resolution of the host names on the fallback list is controlled by the
23885&%gethostbyname%& option, as for the &%hosts%& option. Fallback hosts apply
23886both to cases when the host list comes with the address and when it is taken
23887from &%hosts%&. This option provides a &"use a smart host only if delivery
23888fails"& facility.
23889
23890
23891.option final_timeout smtp time 10m
23892This is the timeout that applies while waiting for the response to the final
23893line containing just &"."& that terminates a message. Its value must not be
23894zero.
23895
23896.option gethostbyname smtp boolean false
23897If this option is true when the &%hosts%& and/or &%fallback_hosts%& options are
23898being used, names are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
23899(or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
23900instead of using the DNS. Of course, that function may in fact use the DNS, but
23901it may also consult other sources of information such as &_/etc/hosts_&.
23902
23903.option gnutls_compat_mode smtp boolean unset
23904This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
23905server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
23906implementations of TLS.
23907
23908.option helo_data smtp string&!! "see below"
23909.cindex "HELO" "argument, setting"
23910.cindex "EHLO" "argument, setting"
23911.cindex "LHLO argument setting"
23912The value of this option is expanded after a connection to a another host has
23913been set up. The result is used as the argument for the EHLO, HELO, or LHLO
23914command that starts the outgoing SMTP or LMTP session. The default value of the
23915option is:
23916.code
23917$primary_hostname
23918.endd
23919During the expansion, the variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to
23920the identity of the remote host, and the variables &$sending_ip_address$& and
23921&$sending_port$& are set to the local IP address and port number that are being
23922used. These variables can be used to generate different values for different
23923servers or different local IP addresses. For example, if you want the string
23924that is used for &%helo_data%& to be obtained by a DNS lookup of the outgoing
23925interface address, you could use this:
23926.code
23927helo_data = ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=$sending_ip_address}{$value}\
23928 {$primary_hostname}}
23929.endd
23930The use of &%helo_data%& applies both to sending messages and when doing
23931callouts.
23932
23933.option hosts smtp "string list&!!" unset
23934Hosts are associated with an address by a router such as &(dnslookup)&, which
23935finds the hosts by looking up the address domain in the DNS, or by
23936&(manualroute)&, which has lists of hosts in its configuration. However,
23937email addresses can be passed to the &(smtp)& transport by any router, and not
23938all of them can provide an associated list of hosts.
23939
23940The &%hosts%& option specifies a list of hosts to be used if the address being
23941processed does not have any hosts associated with it. The hosts specified by
23942&%hosts%& are also used, whether or not the address has its own hosts, if
23943&%hosts_override%& is set.
23944
23945The string is first expanded, before being interpreted as a colon-separated
23946list of host names or IP addresses, possibly including port numbers. The
23947separator may be changed to something other than colon, as described in section
23948&<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
23949item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
23950in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&. However, note that the &`/MX`& facility
23951of the &(manualroute)& router is not available here.
23952
23953If the expansion fails, delivery is deferred. Unless the failure was caused by
23954the inability to complete a lookup, the error is logged to the panic log as
23955well as the main log. Host names are looked up either by searching directly for
23956address records in the DNS or by calling &[gethostbyname()]& (or
23957&[getipnodebyname()]& when available), depending on the setting of the
23958&%gethostbyname%& option. When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, if a host
23959that is looked up in the DNS has both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses, both types of
23960address are used.
23961
23962During delivery, the hosts are tried in order, subject to their retry status,
23963unless &%hosts_randomize%& is set.
23964
23965
23966.option hosts_avoid_esmtp smtp "host list&!!" unset
23967.cindex "ESMTP, avoiding use of"
23968.cindex "HELO" "forcing use of"
23969.cindex "EHLO" "avoiding use of"
23970.cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
23971This option is for use with broken hosts that announce ESMTP facilities (for
23972example, PIPELINING) and then fail to implement them properly. When a host
23973matches &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%&, Exim sends HELO rather than EHLO at the
23974start of the SMTP session. This means that it cannot use any of the ESMTP
23975facilities such as AUTH, PIPELINING, SIZE, and STARTTLS.
23976
23977
23978.option hosts_avoid_pipelining smtp "host list&!!" unset
23979.cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
23980Exim will not use the SMTP PIPELINING extension when delivering to any host
23981that matches this list, even if the server host advertises PIPELINING support.
23982
23983
23984.option hosts_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
23985.cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
23986Exim will not try to start a TLS session when delivering to any host that
23987matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
23988
23989.option hosts_verify_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
23990.cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
23991Exim will not try to start a TLS session for a verify callout,
23992or when delivering in cutthrough mode,
23993to any host that matches this list.
23994
23995
23996.option hosts_max_try smtp integer 5
23997.cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
23998.cindex "limit" "number of hosts tried"
23999.cindex "limit" "number of MX tried"
24000.cindex "MX record" "maximum tried"
24001This option limits the number of IP addresses that are tried for any one
24002delivery in cases where there are temporary delivery errors. Section
24003&<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes in detail how the value of this option is used.
24004
24005
24006.option hosts_max_try_hardlimit smtp integer 50
24007This is an additional check on the maximum number of IP addresses that Exim
24008tries for any one delivery. Section &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes its use and
24009why it exists.
24010
24011
24012
24013.option hosts_nopass_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24014.cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
24015.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
24016.cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
24017For any host that matches this list, a connection on which a TLS session has
24018been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
24019message on the same connection. See section &<<SECTmulmessam>>& for an
24020explanation of when this might be needed.
24021
24022.new
24023.option hosts_noproxy_tls smtp "host list&!!" *
24024.cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
24025.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
24026.cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
24027For any host that matches this list, a TLS session which has
24028been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
24029message on the same session.
24030
24031The traditional implementation closes down TLS and re-starts it in the new
24032process, on the same open TCP connection, for each successive message
24033sent. If permitted by this option a pipe to to the new process is set up
24034instead, and the original process maintains the TLS connection and proxies
24035the SMTP connection from and to the new process and any subsequents.
24036The new process has no access to TLS information, so cannot include it in
24037logging.
24038.wen
24039
24040
24041
24042.option hosts_override smtp boolean false
24043If this option is set and the &%hosts%& option is also set, any hosts that are
24044attached to the address are ignored, and instead the hosts specified by the
24045&%hosts%& option are always used. This option does not apply to
24046&%fallback_hosts%&.
24047
24048
24049.option hosts_randomize smtp boolean false
24050.cindex "randomized host list"
24051.cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
24052.cindex "fallback" "randomized hosts"
24053If this option is set, and either the list of hosts is taken from the
24054&%hosts%& or the &%fallback_hosts%& option, or the hosts supplied by the router
24055were not obtained from MX records (this includes fallback hosts from the
24056router), and were not randomized by the router, the order of trying the hosts
24057is randomized each time the transport runs. Randomizing the order of a host
24058list can be used to do crude load sharing.
24059
24060When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split into groups whose
24061order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to set up MX-like
24062behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an item that is just
24063&`+`& in the host list. For example:
24064.code
24065hosts = host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
24066.endd
24067The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
24068randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
24069If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored.
24070
24071.option hosts_require_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
24072.cindex "authentication" "required by client"
24073This option provides a list of servers for which authentication must succeed
24074before Exim will try to transfer a message. If authentication fails for
24075servers which are not in this list, Exim tries to send unauthenticated. If
24076authentication fails for one of these servers, delivery is deferred. This
24077temporary error is detectable in the retry rules, so it can be turned into a
24078hard failure if required. See also &%hosts_try_auth%&, and chapter
24079&<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
24080
24081
24082.option hosts_request_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" *
24083.cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
24084Exim will request a Certificate Status on a
24085TLS session for any host that matches this list.
24086&%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
24087
24088.option hosts_require_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" unset
24089.cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
24090Exim will request, and check for a valid Certificate Status being given, on a
24091TLS session for any host that matches this list.
24092&%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
24093
24094.option hosts_require_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24095.cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
24096Exim will insist on using a TLS session when delivering to any host that
24097matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
24098&*Note*&: This option affects outgoing mail only. To insist on TLS for
24099incoming messages, use an appropriate ACL.
24100
24101.option hosts_try_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
24102.cindex "authentication" "optional in client"
24103This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
24104authentication support, Exim will attempt to authenticate as a client when it
24105connects. If authentication fails, Exim will try to transfer the message
24106unauthenticated. See also &%hosts_require_auth%&, and chapter
24107&<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
24108
24109.option hosts_try_chunking smtp "host list&!!" *
24110.cindex CHUNKING "enabling, in client"
24111.cindex BDAT "SMTP command"
24112.cindex "RFC 3030" "CHUNKING"
24113This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
24114CHUNKING support, Exim will attempt to use BDAT commands rather than DATA.
24115BDAT will not be used in conjunction with a transport filter.
24116
24117.option hosts_try_fastopen smtp "host list!!" unset
24118.cindex "fast open, TCP" "enabling, in client"
24119.cindex "TCP Fast Open" "enabling, in client"
24120.cindex "RFC 7413" "TCP Fast Open"
24121This option provides a list of servers to which, provided
24122the facility is supported by this system, Exim will attempt to
24123perform a TCP Fast Open.
24124No data is sent on the SYN segment but, if the remote server also
24125supports the facility, it can send its SMTP banner immediately after
24126the SYN,ACK segment. This can save up to one round-trip time.
24127
24128The facility is only active for previously-contacted servers,
24129as the initiator must present a cookie in the SYN segment.
24130
24131On (at least some) current Linux distributions the facility must be enabled
24132in the kernel by the sysadmin before the support is usable.
24133
24134.option hosts_try_prdr smtp "host list&!!" *
24135.cindex "PRDR" "enabling, optional in client"
24136This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
24137PRDR support, Exim will attempt to negotiate PRDR
24138for multi-recipient messages.
24139The option can usually be left as default.
24140
24141.option interface smtp "string list&!!" unset
24142.cindex "bind IP address"
24143.cindex "IP address" "binding"
24144.vindex "&$host$&"
24145.vindex "&$host_address$&"
24146This option specifies which interface to bind to when making an outgoing SMTP
24147call. The value is an IP address, not an interface name such as
24148&`eth0`&. Do not confuse this with the interface address that was used when a
24149message was received, which is in &$received_ip_address$&, formerly known as
24150&$interface_address$&. The name was changed to minimize confusion with the
24151outgoing interface address. There is no variable that contains an outgoing
24152interface address because, unless it is set by this option, its value is
24153unknown.
24154
24155During the expansion of the &%interface%& option the variables &$host$& and
24156&$host_address$& refer to the host to which a connection is about to be made
24157during the expansion of the string. Forced expansion failure, or an empty
24158string result causes the option to be ignored. Otherwise, after expansion, the
24159string must be a list of IP addresses, colon-separated by default, but the
24160separator can be changed in the usual way. For example:
24161.code
24162interface = <; 192.168.123.123 ; 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
24163.endd
24164The first interface of the correct type (IPv4 or IPv6) is used for the outgoing
24165connection. If none of them are the correct type, the option is ignored. If
24166&%interface%& is not set, or is ignored, the system's IP functions choose which
24167interface to use if the host has more than one.
24168
24169
24170.option keepalive smtp boolean true
24171.cindex "keepalive" "on outgoing connection"
24172This option controls the setting of SO_KEEPALIVE on outgoing TCP/IP socket
24173connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle connections
24174periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The other end
24175of the connection should send a acknowledgment if the connection is still okay
24176or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing this is
24177that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of connection
24178that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without tidying up the
24179TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several hours to detect
24180unreachable hosts.
24181
24182
24183.option lmtp_ignore_quota smtp boolean false
24184.cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
24185If this option is set true when the &%protocol%& option is set to &"lmtp"&, the
24186string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT commands, provided that the LMTP server
24187has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA in its response to the LHLO command.
24188
24189.option max_rcpt smtp integer 100
24190.cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of outgoing"
24191This option limits the number of RCPT commands that are sent in a single
24192SMTP message transaction. Each set of addresses is treated independently, and
24193so can cause parallel connections to the same host if &%remote_max_parallel%&
24194permits this.
24195
24196
24197.option multi_domain smtp boolean&!! true
24198.vindex "&$domain$&"
24199When this option is set, the &(smtp)& transport can handle a number of
24200addresses containing a mixture of different domains provided they all resolve
24201to the same list of hosts. Turning the option off restricts the transport to
24202handling only one domain at a time. This is useful if you want to use
24203&$domain$& in an expansion for the transport, because it is set only when there
24204is a single domain involved in a remote delivery.
24205
24206It is expanded per-address and can depend on any of
24207&$address_data$&, &$domain_data$&, &$local_part_data$&,
24208&$host$&, &$host_address$& and &$host_port$&.
24209
24210.option port smtp string&!! "see below"
24211.cindex "port" "sending TCP/IP"
24212.cindex "TCP/IP" "setting outgoing port"
24213This option specifies the TCP/IP port on the server to which Exim connects.
24214&*Note:*& Do not confuse this with the port that was used when a message was
24215received, which is in &$received_port$&, formerly known as &$interface_port$&.
24216The name was changed to minimize confusion with the outgoing port. There is no
24217variable that contains an outgoing port.
24218
24219If the value of this option begins with a digit it is taken as a port number;
24220otherwise it is looked up using &[getservbyname()]&. The default value is
24221normally &"smtp"&, but if &%protocol%& is set to &"lmtp"&, the default is
24222&"lmtp"&. If the expansion fails, or if a port number cannot be found, delivery
24223is deferred.
24224
24225
24226
24227.option protocol smtp string smtp
24228.cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
24229.cindex "ssmtp protocol" "outbound"
24230.cindex "TLS" "SSL-on-connect outbound"
24231.vindex "&$port$&"
24232If this option is set to &"lmtp"& instead of &"smtp"&, the default value for
24233the &%port%& option changes to &"lmtp"&, and the transport operates the LMTP
24234protocol (RFC 2033) instead of SMTP. This protocol is sometimes used for local
24235deliveries into closed message stores. Exim also has support for running LMTP
24236over a pipe to a local process &-- see chapter &<<CHAPLMTP>>&.
24237
24238If this option is set to &"smtps"&, the default value for the &%port%& option
24239changes to &"smtps"&, and the transport initiates TLS immediately after
24240connecting, as an outbound SSL-on-connect, instead of using STARTTLS to upgrade.
24241The Internet standards bodies strongly discourage use of this mode.
24242
24243
24244.option retry_include_ip_address smtp boolean&!! true
24245Exim normally includes both the host name and the IP address in the key it
24246constructs for indexing retry data after a temporary delivery failure. This
24247means that when one of several IP addresses for a host is failing, it gets
24248tried periodically (controlled by the retry rules), but use of the other IP
24249addresses is not affected.
24250
24251However, in some dialup environments hosts are assigned a different IP address
24252each time they connect. In this situation the use of the IP address as part of
24253the retry key leads to undesirable behaviour. Setting this option false causes
24254Exim to use only the host name.
24255Since it is expanded it can be made to depend on the host or domain.
24256
24257
24258.option serialize_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
24259.cindex "serializing connections"
24260.cindex "host" "serializing connections"
24261Because Exim operates in a distributed manner, if several messages for the same
24262host arrive at around the same time, more than one simultaneous connection to
24263the remote host can occur. This is not usually a problem except when there is a
24264slow link between the hosts. In that situation it may be helpful to restrict
24265Exim to one connection at a time. This can be done by setting
24266&%serialize_hosts%& to match the relevant hosts.
24267
24268.cindex "hints database" "serializing deliveries to a host"
24269Exim implements serialization by means of a hints database in which a record is
24270written whenever a process connects to one of the restricted hosts. The record
24271is deleted when the connection is completed. Obviously there is scope for
24272records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
24273guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
24274
24275If you set up this kind of serialization, you should also arrange to delete the
24276relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
24277start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
24278may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
24279are used for ETRN serialization.
24280
24281See also the &%max_parallel%& generic transport option.
24282
24283
24284.option size_addition smtp integer 1024
24285.cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
24286.cindex "message" "size issue for transport filter"
24287.cindex "size" "of message"
24288.cindex "transport" "filter"
24289.cindex "filter" "transport filter"
24290If a remote SMTP server indicates that it supports the SIZE option of the
24291MAIL command, Exim uses this to pass over the message size at the start of
24292an SMTP transaction. It adds the value of &%size_addition%& to the value it
24293sends, to allow for headers and other text that may be added during delivery by
24294configuration options or in a transport filter. It may be necessary to increase
24295this if a lot of text is added to messages.
24296
24297Alternatively, if the value of &%size_addition%& is set negative, it disables
24298the use of the SIZE option altogether.
24299
24300
24301.option socks_proxy smtp string&!! unset
24302.cindex proxy SOCKS
24303This option enables use of SOCKS proxies for connections made by the
24304transport. For details see section &<<SECTproxySOCKS>>&.
24305
24306
24307.option tls_certificate smtp string&!! unset
24308.cindex "TLS" "client certificate, location of"
24309.cindex "certificate" "client, location of"
24310.vindex "&$host$&"
24311.vindex "&$host_address$&"
24312The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
24313client's certificate, for possible use when sending a message over an encrypted
24314connection. The values of &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to the name and
24315address of the server during the expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for
24316details of TLS.
24317
24318&*Note*&: This option must be set if you want Exim to be able to use a TLS
24319certificate when sending messages as a client. The global option of the same
24320name specifies the certificate for Exim as a server; it is not automatically
24321assumed that the same certificate should be used when Exim is operating as a
24322client.
24323
24324
24325.option tls_crl smtp string&!! unset
24326.cindex "TLS" "client certificate revocation list"
24327.cindex "certificate" "revocation list for client"
24328This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
24329be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
24330
24331
24332.option tls_dh_min_bits smtp integer 1024
24333.cindex "TLS" "Diffie-Hellman minimum acceptable size"
24334When establishing a TLS session, if a ciphersuite which uses Diffie-Hellman
24335key agreement is negotiated, the server will provide a large prime number
24336for use. This option establishes the minimum acceptable size of that number.
24337If the parameter offered by the server is too small, then the TLS handshake
24338will fail.
24339
24340Only supported when using GnuTLS.
24341
24342
24343.option tls_privatekey smtp string&!! unset
24344.cindex "TLS" "client private key, location of"
24345.vindex "&$host$&"
24346.vindex "&$host_address$&"
24347The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
24348client's private key. This is used when sending a message over an encrypted
24349connection using a client certificate. The values of &$host$& and
24350&$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
24351expansion. If this option is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the
24352result is an empty string, the private key is assumed to be in the same file as
24353the certificate. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
24354
24355
24356.option tls_require_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
24357.cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
24358.cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
24359.vindex "&$host$&"
24360.vindex "&$host_address$&"
24361The value of this option must be a list of permitted cipher suites, for use
24362when setting up an outgoing encrypted connection. (There is a global option of
24363the same name for controlling incoming connections.) The values of &$host$& and
24364&$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
24365expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS; note that this option
24366is used in different ways by OpenSSL and GnuTLS (see sections
24367&<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&). For GnuTLS, the order of the
24368ciphers is a preference order.
24369
24370
24371
24372.option tls_sni smtp string&!! unset
24373.cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
24374.vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
24375If this option is set then it sets the $tls_out_sni variable and causes any
24376TLS session to pass this value as the Server Name Indication extension to
24377the remote side, which can be used by the remote side to select an appropriate
24378certificate and private key for the session.
24379
24380See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for more information.
24381
24382Note that for OpenSSL, this feature requires a build of OpenSSL that supports
24383TLS extensions.
24384
24385
24386
24387
24388.option tls_tempfail_tryclear smtp boolean true
24389.cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "to STARTTLS"
24390When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and there is a problem in
24391setting up a TLS session, this option determines whether or not Exim should try
24392to deliver the message unencrypted. If it is set false, delivery to the
24393current host is deferred; if there are other hosts, they are tried. If this
24394option is set true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'&
24395response to STARTTLS. Also, if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent
24396TLS negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
24397unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
24398in clear.
24399
24400
24401.option tls_try_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" *
24402.cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
24403.cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
24404This option gives a list of hosts for which, on encrypted connections,
24405certificate verification will be tried but need not succeed.
24406The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
24407Note that unless the host is in this list
24408TLS connections will be denied to hosts using self-signed certificates
24409when &%tls_verify_certificates%& is matched.
24410The &$tls_out_certificate_verified$& variable is set when
24411certificate verification succeeds.
24412
24413
24414.option tls_verify_cert_hostnames smtp "host list&!!" *
24415.cindex "TLS" "server certificate hostname verification"
24416.cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
24417This option give a list of hosts for which,
24418while verifying the server certificate,
24419checks will be included on the host name
24420(note that this will generally be the result of a DNS MX lookup)
24421versus Subject and Subject-Alternate-Name fields. Wildcard names are permitted
24422limited to being the initial component of a 3-or-more component FQDN.
24423
24424There is no equivalent checking on client certificates.
24425
24426
24427.option tls_verify_certificates smtp string&!! system
24428.cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
24429.cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
24430.vindex "&$host$&"
24431.vindex "&$host_address$&"
24432The value of this option must be either the
24433word "system"
24434or the absolute path to
24435a file or directory containing permitted certificates for servers,
24436for use when setting up an encrypted connection.
24437
24438The "system" value for the option will use a location compiled into the SSL library.
24439This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20; a value of "system"
24440is taken as empty and an explicit location
24441must be specified.
24442
24443The use of a directory for the option value is not available for GnuTLS versions
24444preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
24445
24446With OpenSSL the certificates specified
24447explicitly
24448either by file or directory
24449are added to those given by the system default location.
24450
24451The values of &$host$& and
24452&$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
24453expansion of this option. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
24454
24455For back-compatibility,
24456if neither tls_verify_hosts nor tls_try_verify_hosts are set
24457(a single-colon empty list counts as being set)
24458and certificate verification fails the TLS connection is closed.
24459
24460
24461.option tls_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
24462.cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
24463.cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
24464This option gives a list of hosts for which, on encrypted connections,
24465certificate verification must succeed.
24466The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
24467If both this option and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& are unset
24468operation is as if this option selected all hosts.
24469
24470
24471
24472
24473.section "How the limits for the number of hosts to try are used" &&&
24474 "SECTvalhosmax"
24475.cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
24476.cindex "limit" "hosts; maximum number tried"
24477There are two options that are concerned with the number of hosts that are
24478tried when an SMTP delivery takes place. They are &%hosts_max_try%& and
24479&%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%&.
24480
24481
24482The &%hosts_max_try%& option limits the number of hosts that are tried
24483for a single delivery. However, despite the term &"host"& in its name, the
24484option actually applies to each IP address independently. In other words, a
24485multihomed host is treated as several independent hosts, just as it is for
24486retrying.
24487
24488Many of the larger ISPs have multiple MX records which often point to
24489multihomed hosts. As a result, a list of a dozen or more IP addresses may be
24490created as a result of routing one of these domains.
24491
24492Trying every single IP address on such a long list does not seem sensible; if
24493several at the top of the list fail, it is reasonable to assume there is some
24494problem that is likely to affect all of them. Roughly speaking, the value of
24495&%hosts_max_try%& is the maximum number that are tried before deferring the
24496delivery. However, the logic cannot be quite that simple.
24497
24498Firstly, IP addresses that are skipped because their retry times have not
24499arrived do not count, and in addition, addresses that are past their retry
24500limits are also not counted, even when they are tried. This means that when
24501some IP addresses are past their retry limits, more than the value of
24502&%hosts_max_retry%& may be tried. The reason for this behaviour is to ensure
24503that all IP addresses are considered before timing out an email address (but
24504see below for an exception).
24505
24506Secondly, when the &%hosts_max_try%& limit is reached, Exim looks down the host
24507list to see if there is a subsequent host with a different (higher valued) MX.
24508If there is, that host is considered next, and the current IP address is used
24509but not counted. This behaviour helps in the case of a domain with a retry rule
24510that hardly ever delays any hosts, as is now explained:
24511
24512Consider the case of a long list of hosts with one MX value, and a few with a
24513higher MX value. If &%hosts_max_try%& is small (the default is 5) only a few
24514hosts at the top of the list are tried at first. With the default retry rule,
24515which specifies increasing retry times, the higher MX hosts are eventually
24516tried when those at the top of the list are skipped because they have not
24517reached their retry times.
24518
24519However, it is common practice to put a fixed short retry time on domains for
24520large ISPs, on the grounds that their servers are rarely down for very long.
24521Unfortunately, these are exactly the domains that tend to resolve to long lists
24522of hosts. The short retry time means that the lowest MX hosts are tried every
24523time. The attempts may be in a different order because of random sorting, but
24524without the special MX check, the higher MX hosts would never be tried until
24525all the lower MX hosts had timed out (which might be several days), because
24526there are always some lower MX hosts that have reached their retry times. With
24527the special check, Exim considers at least one IP address from each MX value at
24528every delivery attempt, even if the &%hosts_max_try%& limit has already been
24529reached.
24530
24531The above logic means that &%hosts_max_try%& is not a hard limit, and in
24532particular, Exim normally eventually tries all the IP addresses before timing
24533out an email address. When &%hosts_max_try%& was implemented, this seemed a
24534reasonable thing to do. Recently, however, some lunatic DNS configurations have
24535been set up with hundreds of IP addresses for some domains. It can
24536take a very long time indeed for an address to time out in these cases.
24537
24538The &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%& option was added to help with this problem.
24539Exim never tries more than this number of IP addresses; if it hits this limit
24540and they are all timed out, the email address is bounced, even though not all
24541possible IP addresses have been tried.
24542.ecindex IIDsmttra1
24543.ecindex IIDsmttra2
24544
24545
24546
24547
24548
24549. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24550. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24551
24552.chapter "Address rewriting" "CHAPrewrite"
24553.scindex IIDaddrew "rewriting" "addresses"
24554There are some circumstances in which Exim automatically rewrites domains in
24555addresses. The two most common are when an address is given without a domain
24556(referred to as an &"unqualified address"&) or when an address contains an
24557abbreviated domain that is expanded by DNS lookup.
24558
24559Unqualified envelope addresses are accepted only for locally submitted
24560messages, or for messages that are received from hosts matching
24561&%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
24562appropriate. Unqualified addresses in header lines are qualified if they are in
24563locally submitted messages, or messages from hosts that are permitted to send
24564unqualified envelope addresses. Otherwise, unqualified addresses in header
24565lines are neither qualified nor rewritten.
24566
24567One situation in which Exim does &'not'& automatically rewrite a domain is
24568when it is the name of a CNAME record in the DNS. The older RFCs suggest that
24569such a domain should be rewritten using the &"canonical"& name, and some MTAs
24570do this. The new RFCs do not contain this suggestion.
24571
24572
24573.section "Explicitly configured address rewriting" "SECID147"
24574This chapter describes the rewriting rules that can be used in the
24575main rewrite section of the configuration file, and also in the generic
24576&%headers_rewrite%& option that can be set on any transport.
24577
24578Some people believe that configured address rewriting is a Mortal Sin.
24579Others believe that life is not possible without it. Exim provides the
24580facility; you do not have to use it.
24581
24582The main rewriting rules that appear in the &"rewrite"& section of the
24583configuration file are applied to addresses in incoming messages, both envelope
24584addresses and addresses in header lines. Each rule specifies the types of
24585address to which it applies.
24586
24587Whether or not addresses in header lines are rewritten depends on the origin of
24588the headers and the type of rewriting. Global rewriting, that is, rewriting
24589rules from the rewrite section of the configuration file, is applied only to
24590those headers that were received with the message. Header lines that are added
24591by ACLs or by a system filter or by individual routers or transports (which
24592are specific to individual recipient addresses) are not rewritten by the global
24593rules.
24594
24595Rewriting at transport time, by means of the &%headers_rewrite%& option,
24596applies all headers except those added by routers and transports. That is, as
24597well as the headers that were received with the message, it also applies to
24598headers that were added by an ACL or a system filter.
24599
24600
24601In general, rewriting addresses from your own system or domain has some
24602legitimacy. Rewriting other addresses should be done only with great care and
24603in special circumstances. The author of Exim believes that rewriting should be
24604used sparingly, and mainly for &"regularizing"& addresses in your own domains.
24605Although it can sometimes be used as a routing tool, this is very strongly
24606discouraged.
24607
24608There are two commonly encountered circumstances where rewriting is used, as
24609illustrated by these examples:
24610
24611.ilist
24612The company whose domain is &'hitch.fict.example'& has a number of hosts that
24613exchange mail with each other behind a firewall, but there is only a single
24614gateway to the outer world. The gateway rewrites &'*.hitch.fict.example'& as
24615&'hitch.fict.example'& when sending mail off-site.
24616.next
24617A host rewrites the local parts of its own users so that, for example,
24618&'fp42@hitch.fict.example'& becomes &'Ford.Prefect@hitch.fict.example'&.
24619.endlist
24620
24621
24622
24623.section "When does rewriting happen?" "SECID148"
24624.cindex "rewriting" "timing of"
24625.cindex "&ACL;" "rewriting addresses in"
24626Configured address rewriting can take place at several different stages of a
24627message's processing.
24628
24629.vindex "&$sender_address$&"
24630At the start of an ACL for MAIL, the sender address may have been rewritten
24631by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule (see section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&), but no
24632ordinary rewrite rules have yet been applied. If, however, the sender address
24633is verified in the ACL, it is rewritten before verification, and remains
24634rewritten thereafter. The subsequent value of &$sender_address$& is the
24635rewritten address. This also applies if sender verification happens in a
24636RCPT ACL. Otherwise, when the sender address is not verified, it is
24637rewritten as soon as a message's header lines have been received.
24638
24639.vindex "&$domain$&"
24640.vindex "&$local_part$&"
24641Similarly, at the start of an ACL for RCPT, the current recipient's address
24642may have been rewritten by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule, but no ordinary
24643rewrite rules have yet been applied to it. However, the behaviour is different
24644from the sender address when a recipient is verified. The address is rewritten
24645for the verification, but the rewriting is not remembered at this stage. The
24646value of &$local_part$& and &$domain$& after verification are always the same
24647as they were before (that is, they contain the unrewritten &-- except for
24648SMTP-time rewriting &-- address).
24649
24650As soon as a message's header lines have been received, all the envelope
24651recipient addresses are permanently rewritten, and rewriting is also applied to
24652the addresses in the header lines (if configured). This happens before adding
24653any header lines that were specified in MAIL or RCPT ACLs, and
24654.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "address rewriting; timing of"
24655before the DATA ACL and &[local_scan()]& functions are run.
24656
24657When an address is being routed, either for delivery or for verification,
24658rewriting is applied immediately to child addresses that are generated by
24659redirection, unless &%no_rewrite%& is set on the router.
24660
24661.cindex "envelope sender" "rewriting at transport time"
24662.cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
24663.cindex "header lines" "rewriting at transport time"
24664At transport time, additional rewriting of addresses in header lines can be
24665specified by setting the generic &%headers_rewrite%& option on a transport.
24666This option contains rules that are identical in form to those in the rewrite
24667section of the configuration file. They are applied to the original message
24668header lines and any that were added by ACLs or a system filter. They are not
24669applied to header lines that are added by routers or the transport.
24670
24671The outgoing envelope sender can be rewritten by means of the &%return_path%&
24672transport option. However, it is not possible to rewrite envelope recipients at
24673transport time.
24674
24675
24676
24677
24678.section "Testing the rewriting rules that apply on input" "SECID149"
24679.cindex "rewriting" "testing"
24680.cindex "testing" "rewriting"
24681Exim's input rewriting configuration appears in a part of the run time
24682configuration file headed by &"begin rewrite"&. It can be tested by the
24683&%-brw%& command line option. This takes an address (which can be a full RFC
246842822 address) as its argument. The output is a list of how the address would be
24685transformed by the rewriting rules for each of the different places it might
24686appear in an incoming message, that is, for each different header and for the
24687envelope sender and recipient fields. For example,
24688.code
24689exim -brw ph10@exim.workshop.example
24690.endd
24691might produce the output
24692.code
24693sender: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
24694from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
24695to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
24696cc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
24697bcc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
24698reply-to: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
24699env-from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
24700env-to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
24701.endd
24702which shows that rewriting has been set up for that address when used in any of
24703the source fields, but not when it appears as a recipient address. At the
24704present time, there is no equivalent way of testing rewriting rules that are
24705set for a particular transport.
24706
24707
24708.section "Rewriting rules" "SECID150"
24709.cindex "rewriting" "rules"
24710The rewrite section of the configuration file consists of lines of rewriting
24711rules in the form
24712.display
24713<&'source pattern'&> <&'replacement'&> <&'flags'&>
24714.endd
24715Rewriting rules that are specified for the &%headers_rewrite%& generic
24716transport option are given as a colon-separated list. Each item in the list
24717takes the same form as a line in the main rewriting configuration (except that
24718any colons must be doubled, of course).
24719
24720The formats of source patterns and replacement strings are described below.
24721Each is terminated by white space, unless enclosed in double quotes, in which
24722case normal quoting conventions apply inside the quotes. The flags are single
24723characters which may appear in any order. Spaces and tabs between them are
24724ignored.
24725
24726For each address that could potentially be rewritten, the rules are scanned in
24727order, and replacements for the address from earlier rules can themselves be
24728replaced by later rules (but see the &"q"& and &"R"& flags).
24729
24730The order in which addresses are rewritten is undefined, may change between
24731releases, and must not be relied on, with one exception: when a message is
24732received, the envelope sender is always rewritten first, before any header
24733lines are rewritten. For example, the replacement string for a rewrite of an
24734address in &'To:'& must not assume that the message's address in &'From:'& has
24735(or has not) already been rewritten. However, a rewrite of &'From:'& may assume
24736that the envelope sender has already been rewritten.
24737
24738.vindex "&$domain$&"
24739.vindex "&$local_part$&"
24740The variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used in the replacement
24741string to refer to the address that is being rewritten. Note that lookup-driven
24742rewriting can be done by a rule of the form
24743.code
24744*@* ${lookup ...
24745.endd
24746where the lookup key uses &$1$& and &$2$& or &$local_part$& and &$domain$& to
24747refer to the address that is being rewritten.
24748
24749
24750.section "Rewriting patterns" "SECID151"
24751.cindex "rewriting" "patterns"
24752.cindex "address list" "in a rewriting pattern"
24753The source pattern in a rewriting rule is any item which may appear in an
24754address list (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a
24755single-item address list, which means that it is expanded before being tested
24756against the address. As always, if you use a regular expression as a pattern,
24757you must take care to escape dollar and backslash characters, or use the &`\N`&
24758facility to suppress string expansion within the regular expression.
24759
24760Domains in patterns should be given in lower case. Local parts in patterns are
24761case-sensitive. If you want to do case-insensitive matching of local parts, you
24762can use a regular expression that starts with &`^(?i)`&.
24763
24764.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in rewriting rules"
24765After matching, the numerical variables &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set,
24766depending on the type of match which occurred. These can be used in the
24767replacement string to insert portions of the incoming address. &$0$& always
24768refers to the complete incoming address. When a regular expression is used, the
24769numerical variables are set from its capturing subexpressions. For other types
24770of pattern they are set as follows:
24771
24772.ilist
24773If a local part or domain starts with an asterisk, the numerical variables
24774refer to the character strings matched by asterisks, with &$1$& associated with
24775the first asterisk, and &$2$& with the second, if present. For example, if the
24776pattern
24777.code
24778*queen@*.fict.example
24779.endd
24780is matched against the address &'hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example'& then
24781.code
24782$0 = hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example
24783$1 = hearts-
24784$2 = wonderland
24785.endd
24786Note that if the local part does not start with an asterisk, but the domain
24787does, it is &$1$& that contains the wild part of the domain.
24788
24789.next
24790If the domain part of the pattern is a partial lookup, the wild and fixed parts
24791of the domain are placed in the next available numerical variables. Suppose,
24792for example, that the address &'foo@bar.baz.example'& is processed by a
24793rewriting rule of the form
24794.display
24795&`*@partial-dbm;/some/dbm/file`& <&'replacement string'&>
24796.endd
24797and the key in the file that matches the domain is &`*.baz.example`&. Then
24798.code
24799$1 = foo
24800$2 = bar
24801$3 = baz.example
24802.endd
24803If the address &'foo@baz.example'& is looked up, this matches the same
24804wildcard file entry, and in this case &$2$& is set to the empty string, but
24805&$3$& is still set to &'baz.example'&. If a non-wild key is matched in a
24806partial lookup, &$2$& is again set to the empty string and &$3$& is set to the
24807whole domain. For non-partial domain lookups, no numerical variables are set.
24808.endlist
24809
24810
24811.section "Rewriting replacements" "SECID152"
24812.cindex "rewriting" "replacements"
24813If the replacement string for a rule is a single asterisk, addresses that
24814match the pattern and the flags are &'not'& rewritten, and no subsequent
24815rewriting rules are scanned. For example,
24816.code
24817hatta@lookingglass.fict.example * f
24818.endd
24819specifies that &'hatta@lookingglass.fict.example'& is never to be rewritten in
24820&'From:'& headers.
24821
24822.vindex "&$domain$&"
24823.vindex "&$local_part$&"
24824If the replacement string is not a single asterisk, it is expanded, and must
24825yield a fully qualified address. Within the expansion, the variables
24826&$local_part$& and &$domain$& refer to the address that is being rewritten.
24827Any letters they contain retain their original case &-- they are not lower
24828cased. The numerical variables are set up according to the type of pattern that
24829matched the address, as described above. If the expansion is forced to fail by
24830the presence of &"fail"& in a conditional or lookup item, rewriting by the
24831current rule is abandoned, but subsequent rules may take effect. Any other
24832expansion failure causes the entire rewriting operation to be abandoned, and an
24833entry written to the panic log.
24834
24835
24836
24837.section "Rewriting flags" "SECID153"
24838There are three different kinds of flag that may appear on rewriting rules:
24839
24840.ilist
24841Flags that specify which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite: E, F, T, b,
24842c, f, h, r, s, t.
24843.next
24844A flag that specifies rewriting at SMTP time: S.
24845.next
24846Flags that control the rewriting process: Q, q, R, w.
24847.endlist
24848
24849For rules that are part of the &%headers_rewrite%& generic transport option,
24850E, F, T, and S are not permitted.
24851
24852
24853
24854.section "Flags specifying which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite" &&&
24855 "SECID154"
24856.cindex "rewriting" "flags"
24857If none of the following flag letters, nor the &"S"& flag (see section
24858&<<SECTrewriteS>>&) are present, a main rewriting rule applies to all headers
24859and to both the sender and recipient fields of the envelope, whereas a
24860transport-time rewriting rule just applies to all headers. Otherwise, the
24861rewriting rule is skipped unless the relevant addresses are being processed.
24862.display
24863&`E`& rewrite all envelope fields
24864&`F`& rewrite the envelope From field
24865&`T`& rewrite the envelope To field
24866&`b`& rewrite the &'Bcc:'& header
24867&`c`& rewrite the &'Cc:'& header
24868&`f`& rewrite the &'From:'& header
24869&`h`& rewrite all headers
24870&`r`& rewrite the &'Reply-To:'& header
24871&`s`& rewrite the &'Sender:'& header
24872&`t`& rewrite the &'To:'& header
24873.endd
24874"All headers" means all of the headers listed above that can be selected
24875individually, plus their &'Resent-'& versions. It does not include
24876other headers such as &'Subject:'& etc.
24877
24878You should be particularly careful about rewriting &'Sender:'& headers, and
24879restrict this to special known cases in your own domains.
24880
24881
24882.section "The SMTP-time rewriting flag" "SECTrewriteS"
24883.cindex "SMTP" "rewriting malformed addresses"
24884.cindex "RCPT" "rewriting argument of"
24885.cindex "MAIL" "rewriting argument of"
24886The rewrite flag &"S"& specifies a rewrite of incoming envelope addresses at
24887SMTP time, as soon as an address is received in a MAIL or RCPT command, and
24888before any other processing; even before syntax checking. The pattern is
24889required to be a regular expression, and it is matched against the whole of the
24890data for the command, including any surrounding angle brackets.
24891
24892.vindex "&$domain$&"
24893.vindex "&$local_part$&"
24894This form of rewrite rule allows for the handling of addresses that are not
24895compliant with RFCs 2821 and 2822 (for example, &"bang paths"& in batched SMTP
24896input). Because the input is not required to be a syntactically valid address,
24897the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are not available during the
24898expansion of the replacement string. The result of rewriting replaces the
24899original address in the MAIL or RCPT command.
24900
24901
24902.section "Flags controlling the rewriting process" "SECID155"
24903There are four flags which control the way the rewriting process works. These
24904take effect only when a rule is invoked, that is, when the address is of the
24905correct type (matches the flags) and matches the pattern:
24906
24907.ilist
24908If the &"Q"& flag is set on a rule, the rewritten address is permitted to be an
24909unqualified local part. It is qualified with &%qualify_recipient%&. In the
24910absence of &"Q"& the rewritten address must always include a domain.
24911.next
24912If the &"q"& flag is set on a rule, no further rewriting rules are considered,
24913even if no rewriting actually takes place because of a &"fail"& in the
24914expansion. The &"q"& flag is not effective if the address is of the wrong type
24915(does not match the flags) or does not match the pattern.
24916.next
24917The &"R"& flag causes a successful rewriting rule to be re-applied to the new
24918address, up to ten times. It can be combined with the &"q"& flag, to stop
24919rewriting once it fails to match (after at least one successful rewrite).
24920.next
24921.cindex "rewriting" "whole addresses"
24922When an address in a header is rewritten, the rewriting normally applies only
24923to the working part of the address, with any comments and RFC 2822 &"phrase"&
24924left unchanged. For example, rewriting might change
24925.code
24926From: Ford Prefect <fp42@restaurant.hitch.fict.example>
24927.endd
24928into
24929.code
24930From: Ford Prefect <prefectf@hitch.fict.example>
24931.endd
24932.cindex "RFC 2047"
24933Sometimes there is a need to replace the whole address item, and this can be
24934done by adding the flag letter &"w"& to a rule. If this is set on a rule that
24935causes an address in a header line to be rewritten, the entire address is
24936replaced, not just the working part. The replacement must be a complete RFC
249372822 address, including the angle brackets if necessary. If text outside angle
24938brackets contains a character whose value is greater than 126 or less than 32
24939(except for tab), the text is encoded according to RFC 2047. The character set
24940is taken from &%headers_charset%&, which gets its default at build time.
24941
24942When the &"w"& flag is set on a rule that causes an envelope address to be
24943rewritten, all but the working part of the replacement address is discarded.
24944.endlist
24945
24946
24947.section "Rewriting examples" "SECID156"
24948Here is an example of the two common rewriting paradigms:
24949.code
24950*@*.hitch.fict.example $1@hitch.fict.example
24951*@hitch.fict.example ${lookup{$1}dbm{/etc/realnames}\
24952 {$value}fail}@hitch.fict.example bctfrF
24953.endd
24954Note the use of &"fail"& in the lookup expansion in the second rule, forcing
24955the string expansion to fail if the lookup does not succeed. In this context it
24956has the effect of leaving the original address unchanged, but Exim goes on to
24957consider subsequent rewriting rules, if any, because the &"q"& flag is not
24958present in that rule. An alternative to &"fail"& would be to supply &$1$&
24959explicitly, which would cause the rewritten address to be the same as before,
24960at the cost of a small bit of processing. Not supplying either of these is an
24961error, since the rewritten address would then contain no local part.
24962
24963The first example above replaces the domain with a superior, more general
24964domain. This may not be desirable for certain local parts. If the rule
24965.code
24966root@*.hitch.fict.example *
24967.endd
24968were inserted before the first rule, rewriting would be suppressed for the
24969local part &'root'& at any domain ending in &'hitch.fict.example'&.
24970
24971Rewriting can be made conditional on a number of tests, by making use of
24972&${if$& in the expansion item. For example, to apply a rewriting rule only to
24973messages that originate outside the local host:
24974.code
24975*@*.hitch.fict.example "${if !eq {$sender_host_address}{}\
24976 {$1@hitch.fict.example}fail}"
24977.endd
24978The replacement string is quoted in this example because it contains white
24979space.
24980
24981.cindex "rewriting" "bang paths"
24982.cindex "bang paths" "rewriting"
24983Exim does not handle addresses in the form of &"bang paths"&. If it sees such
24984an address it treats it as an unqualified local part which it qualifies with
24985the local qualification domain (if the source of the message is local or if the
24986remote host is permitted to send unqualified addresses). Rewriting can
24987sometimes be used to handle simple bang paths with a fixed number of
24988components. For example, the rule
24989.code
24990\N^([^!]+)!(.*)@your.domain.example$\N $2@$1
24991.endd
24992rewrites a two-component bang path &'host.name!user'& as the domain address
24993&'user@host.name'&. However, there is a security implication in using this as
24994a global rewriting rule for envelope addresses. It can provide a backdoor
24995method for using your system as a relay, because the incoming addresses appear
24996to be local. If the bang path addresses are received via SMTP, it is safer to
24997use the &"S"& flag to rewrite them as they are received, so that relay checking
24998can be done on the rewritten addresses.
24999.ecindex IIDaddrew
25000
25001
25002
25003
25004
25005. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25006. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25007
25008.chapter "Retry configuration" "CHAPretry"
25009.scindex IIDretconf1 "retry" "configuration, description of"
25010.scindex IIDregconf2 "configuration file" "retry section"
25011The &"retry"& section of the runtime configuration file contains a list of
25012retry rules that control how often Exim tries to deliver messages that cannot
25013be delivered at the first attempt. If there are no retry rules (the section is
25014empty or not present), there are no retries. In this situation, temporary
25015errors are treated as permanent. The default configuration contains a single,
25016general-purpose retry rule (see section &<<SECID57>>&). The &%-brt%& command
25017line option can be used to test which retry rule will be used for a given
25018address, domain and error.
25019
25020The most common cause of retries is temporary failure to deliver to a remote
25021host because the host is down, or inaccessible because of a network problem.
25022Exim's retry processing in this case is applied on a per-host (strictly, per IP
25023address) basis, not on a per-message basis. Thus, if one message has recently
25024been delayed, delivery of a new message to the same host is not immediately
25025tried, but waits for the host's retry time to arrive. If the &%retry_defer%&
25026log selector is set, the message
25027.cindex "retry" "time not reached"
25028&"retry time not reached"& is written to the main log whenever a delivery is
25029skipped for this reason. Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& contains more details of
25030the handling of errors during remote deliveries.
25031
25032Retry processing applies to routing as well as to delivering, except as covered
25033in the next paragraph. The retry rules do not distinguish between these
25034actions. It is not possible, for example, to specify different behaviour for
25035failures to route the domain &'snark.fict.example'& and failures to deliver to
25036the host &'snark.fict.example'&. I didn't think anyone would ever need this
25037added complication, so did not implement it. However, although they share the
25038same retry rule, the actual retry times for routing and transporting a given
25039domain are maintained independently.
25040
25041When a delivery is not part of a queue run (typically an immediate delivery on
25042receipt of a message), the routers are always run, and local deliveries are
25043always attempted, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for better
25044behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example, causing
25045quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file). If such a delivery
25046suffers a temporary failure, the retry data is updated as normal, and
25047subsequent delivery attempts from queue runs occur only when the retry time for
25048the local address is reached.
25049
25050.section "Changing retry rules" "SECID157"
25051If you change the retry rules in your configuration, you should consider
25052whether or not to delete the retry data that is stored in Exim's spool area in
25053files with names like &_db/retry_&. Deleting any of Exim's hints files is
25054always safe; that is why they are called &"hints"&.
25055
25056The hints retry data contains suggested retry times based on the previous
25057rules. In the case of a long-running problem with a remote host, it might
25058record the fact that the host has timed out. If your new rules increase the
25059timeout time for such a host, you should definitely remove the old retry data
25060and let Exim recreate it, based on the new rules. Otherwise Exim might bounce
25061messages that it should now be retaining.
25062
25063
25064
25065.section "Format of retry rules" "SECID158"
25066.cindex "retry" "rules"
25067Each retry rule occupies one line and consists of three or four parts,
25068separated by white space: a pattern, an error name, an optional list of sender
25069addresses, and a list of retry parameters. The pattern and sender lists must be
25070enclosed in double quotes if they contain white space. The rules are searched
25071in order until one is found where the pattern, error name, and sender list (if
25072present) match the failing host or address, the error that occurred, and the
25073message's sender, respectively.
25074
25075
25076The pattern is any single item that may appear in an address list (see section
25077&<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a one-item address list,
25078which means that it is expanded before being tested against the address that
25079has been delayed. A negated address list item is permitted. Address
25080list processing treats a plain domain name as if it were preceded by &"*@"&,
25081which makes it possible for many retry rules to start with just a domain. For
25082example,
25083.code
25084lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
25085.endd
25086provides a rule for any address in the &'lookingglass.fict.example'& domain,
25087whereas
25088.code
25089alice@lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
25090.endd
25091applies only to temporary failures involving the local part &%alice%&.
25092In practice, almost all rules start with a domain name pattern without a local
25093part.
25094
25095.cindex "regular expressions" "in retry rules"
25096&*Warning*&: If you use a regular expression in a retry rule pattern, it
25097must match a complete address, not just a domain, because that is how regular
25098expressions work in address lists.
25099.display
25100&`^\Nxyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Wrong%&
25101&`^\N[^@]+@xyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Right%&
25102.endd
25103
25104
25105.section "Choosing which retry rule to use for address errors" "SECID159"
25106When Exim is looking for a retry rule after a routing attempt has failed (for
25107example, after a DNS timeout), each line in the retry configuration is tested
25108against the complete address only if &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the
25109router. Otherwise, only the domain is used, except when matching against a
25110regular expression, when the local part of the address is replaced with &"*"&.
25111A domain on its own can match a domain pattern, or a pattern that starts with
25112&"*@"&. By default, &%retry_use_local_part%& is true for routers where
25113&%check_local_user%& is true, and false for other routers.
25114
25115Similarly, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a local delivery has
25116failed (for example, after a mailbox full error), each line in the retry
25117configuration is tested against the complete address only if
25118&%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the transport (it defaults true for all
25119local transports).
25120
25121.cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retry rules for"
25122However, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a remote delivery attempt
25123suffers an address error (a 4&'xx'& SMTP response for a recipient address), the
25124whole address is always used as the key when searching the retry rules. The
25125rule that is found is used to create a retry time for the combination of the
25126failing address and the message's sender. It is the combination of sender and
25127recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue runs until its retry time is
25128reached. You can delay the recipient without regard to the sender by setting
25129&%address_retry_include_sender%& false in the &(smtp)& transport but this can
25130lead to problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT
25131commands.
25132
25133
25134
25135.section "Choosing which retry rule to use for host and message errors" &&&
25136 "SECID160"
25137For a temporary error that is not related to an individual address (for
25138example, a connection timeout), each line in the retry configuration is checked
25139twice. First, the name of the remote host is used as a domain name (preceded by
25140&"*@"& when matching a regular expression). If this does not match the line,
25141the domain from the email address is tried in a similar fashion. For example,
25142suppose the MX records for &'a.b.c.example'& are
25143.code
25144a.b.c.example MX 5 x.y.z.example
25145 MX 6 p.q.r.example
25146 MX 7 m.n.o.example
25147.endd
25148and the retry rules are
25149.code
25150p.q.r.example * F,24h,30m;
25151a.b.c.example * F,4d,45m;
25152.endd
25153and a delivery to the host &'x.y.z.example'& suffers a connection failure. The
25154first rule matches neither the host nor the domain, so Exim looks at the second
25155rule. This does not match the host, but it does match the domain, so it is used
25156to calculate the retry time for the host &'x.y.z.example'&. Meanwhile, Exim
25157tries to deliver to &'p.q.r.example'&. If this also suffers a host error, the
25158first retry rule is used, because it matches the host.
25159
25160In other words, temporary failures to deliver to host &'p.q.r.example'& use the
25161first rule to determine retry times, but for all the other hosts for the domain
25162&'a.b.c.example'&, the second rule is used. The second rule is also used if
25163routing to &'a.b.c.example'& suffers a temporary failure.
25164
25165&*Note*&: The host name is used when matching the patterns, not its IP address.
25166However, if a message is routed directly to an IP address without the use of a
25167host name, for example, if a &(manualroute)& router contains a setting such as:
25168.code
25169route_list = *.a.example 192.168.34.23
25170.endd
25171then the &"host name"& that is used when searching for a retry rule is the
25172textual form of the IP address.
25173
25174.section "Retry rules for specific errors" "SECID161"
25175.cindex "retry" "specific errors; specifying"
25176The second field in a retry rule is the name of a particular error, or an
25177asterisk, which matches any error. The errors that can be tested for are:
25178
25179.vlist
25180.vitem &%auth_failed%&
25181Authentication failed when trying to send to a host in the
25182&%hosts_require_auth%& list in an &(smtp)& transport.
25183
25184.vitem &%data_4xx%&
25185A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing DATA command, either immediately
25186after the command, or after sending the message's data.
25187
25188.vitem &%mail_4xx%&
25189A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing MAIL command.
25190
25191.vitem &%rcpt_4xx%&
25192A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing RCPT command.
25193.endlist
25194
25195For the three 4&'xx'& errors, either the first or both of the x's can be given
25196as specific digits, for example: &`mail_45x`& or &`rcpt_436`&. For example, to
25197recognize 452 errors given to RCPT commands for addresses in a certain domain,
25198and have retries every ten minutes with a one-hour timeout, you could set up a
25199retry rule of this form:
25200.code
25201the.domain.name rcpt_452 F,1h,10m
25202.endd
25203These errors apply to both outgoing SMTP (the &(smtp)& transport) and outgoing
25204LMTP (either the &(lmtp)& transport, or the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode).
25205
25206.vlist
25207.vitem &%lost_connection%&
25208A server unexpectedly closed the SMTP connection. There may, of course,
25209legitimate reasons for this (host died, network died), but if it repeats a lot
25210for the same host, it indicates something odd.
25211
25212.vitem &%lookup%&
25213A DNS lookup for a host failed.
25214Note that a &%dnslookup%& router will need to have matched
25215its &%fail_defer_domains%& option for this retry type to be usable.
25216Also note that a &%manualroute%& router will probably need
25217its &%host_find_failed%& option set to &%defer%&.
25218
25219.vitem &%refused_MX%&
25220A connection to a host obtained from an MX record was refused.
25221
25222.vitem &%refused_A%&
25223A connection to a host not obtained from an MX record was refused.
25224
25225.vitem &%refused%&
25226A connection was refused.
25227
25228.vitem &%timeout_connect_MX%&
25229A connection attempt to a host obtained from an MX record timed out.
25230
25231.vitem &%timeout_connect_A%&
25232A connection attempt to a host not obtained from an MX record timed out.
25233
25234.vitem &%timeout_connect%&
25235A connection attempt timed out.
25236
25237.vitem &%timeout_MX%&
25238There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host
25239obtained from an MX record.
25240
25241.vitem &%timeout_A%&
25242There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host not
25243obtained from an MX record.
25244
25245.vitem &%timeout%&
25246There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session.
25247
25248.vitem &%tls_required%&
25249The server was required to use TLS (it matched &%hosts_require_tls%& in the
25250&(smtp)& transport), but either did not offer TLS, or it responded with 4&'xx'&
25251to STARTTLS, or there was a problem setting up the TLS connection.
25252
25253.vitem &%quota%&
25254A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
25255transport.
25256
25257.vitem &%quota_%&<&'time'&>
25258.cindex "quota" "error testing in retry rule"
25259.cindex "retry" "quota error testing"
25260A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
25261transport, and the mailbox has not been accessed for <&'time'&>. For example,
25262&'quota_4d'& applies to a quota error when the mailbox has not been accessed
25263for four days.
25264.endlist
25265
25266.cindex "mailbox" "time of last read"
25267The idea of &%quota_%&<&'time'&> is to make it possible to have shorter
25268timeouts when the mailbox is full and is not being read by its owner. Ideally,
25269it should be based on the last time that the user accessed the mailbox.
25270However, it is not always possible to determine this. Exim uses the following
25271heuristic rules:
25272
25273.ilist
25274If the mailbox is a single file, the time of last access (the &"atime"&) is
25275used. As no new messages are being delivered (because the mailbox is over
25276quota), Exim does not access the file, so this is the time of last user access.
25277.next
25278.cindex "maildir format" "time of last read"
25279For a maildir delivery, the time of last modification of the &_new_&
25280subdirectory is used. As the mailbox is over quota, no new files are created in
25281the &_new_& subdirectory, because no new messages are being delivered. Any
25282change to the &_new_& subdirectory is therefore assumed to be the result of an
25283MUA moving a new message to the &_cur_& directory when it is first read. The
25284time that is used is therefore the last time that the user read a new message.
25285.next
25286For other kinds of multi-file mailbox, the time of last access cannot be
25287obtained, so a retry rule that uses this type of error field is never matched.
25288.endlist
25289
25290The quota errors apply both to system-enforced quotas and to Exim's own quota
25291mechanism in the &(appendfile)& transport. The &'quota'& error also applies
25292when a local delivery is deferred because a partition is full (the ENOSPC
25293error).
25294
25295
25296
25297.section "Retry rules for specified senders" "SECID162"
25298.cindex "retry" "rules; sender-specific"
25299You can specify retry rules that apply only when the failing message has a
25300specific sender. In particular, this can be used to define retry rules that
25301apply only to bounce messages. The third item in a retry rule can be of this
25302form:
25303.display
25304&`senders=`&<&'address list'&>
25305.endd
25306The retry timings themselves are then the fourth item. For example:
25307.code
25308* rcpt_4xx senders=: F,1h,30m
25309.endd
25310matches recipient 4&'xx'& errors for bounce messages sent to any address at any
25311host. If the address list contains white space, it must be enclosed in quotes.
25312For example:
25313.code
25314a.domain rcpt_452 senders="xb.dom : yc.dom" G,8h,10m,1.5
25315.endd
25316&*Warning*&: This facility can be unhelpful if it is used for host errors
25317(which do not depend on the recipient). The reason is that the sender is used
25318only to match the retry rule. Once the rule has been found for a host error,
25319its contents are used to set a retry time for the host, and this will apply to
25320all messages, not just those with specific senders.
25321
25322When testing retry rules using &%-brt%&, you can supply a sender using the
25323&%-f%& command line option, like this:
25324.code
25325exim -f "" -brt user@dom.ain
25326.endd
25327If you do not set &%-f%& with &%-brt%&, a retry rule that contains a senders
25328list is never matched.
25329
25330
25331
25332
25333
25334.section "Retry parameters" "SECID163"
25335.cindex "retry" "parameters in rules"
25336The third (or fourth, if a senders list is present) field in a retry rule is a
25337sequence of retry parameter sets, separated by semicolons. Each set consists of
25338.display
25339<&'letter'&>,<&'cutoff time'&>,<&'arguments'&>
25340.endd
25341The letter identifies the algorithm for computing a new retry time; the cutoff
25342time is the time beyond which this algorithm no longer applies, and the
25343arguments vary the algorithm's action. The cutoff time is measured from the
25344time that the first failure for the domain (combined with the local part if
25345relevant) was detected, not from the time the message was received.
25346
25347.cindex "retry" "algorithms"
25348.cindex "retry" "fixed intervals"
25349.cindex "retry" "increasing intervals"
25350.cindex "retry" "random intervals"
25351The available algorithms are:
25352
25353.ilist
25354&'F'&: retry at fixed intervals. There is a single time parameter specifying
25355the interval.
25356.next
25357&'G'&: retry at geometrically increasing intervals. The first argument
25358specifies a starting value for the interval, and the second a multiplier, which
25359is used to increase the size of the interval at each retry.
25360.next
25361&'H'&: retry at randomized intervals. The arguments are as for &'G'&. For each
25362retry, the previous interval is multiplied by the factor in order to get a
25363maximum for the next interval. The minimum interval is the first argument of
25364the parameter, and an actual interval is chosen randomly between them. Such a
25365rule has been found to be helpful in cluster configurations when all the
25366members of the cluster restart at once, and may therefore synchronize their
25367queue processing times.
25368.endlist
25369
25370When computing the next retry time, the algorithm definitions are scanned in
25371order until one whose cutoff time has not yet passed is reached. This is then
25372used to compute a new retry time that is later than the current time. In the
25373case of fixed interval retries, this simply means adding the interval to the
25374current time. For geometrically increasing intervals, retry intervals are
25375computed from the rule's parameters until one that is greater than the previous
25376interval is found. The main configuration variable
25377.cindex "limit" "retry interval"
25378.cindex "retry" "interval, maximum"
25379.oindex "&%retry_interval_max%&"
25380&%retry_interval_max%& limits the maximum interval between retries. It
25381cannot be set greater than &`24h`&, which is its default value.
25382
25383A single remote domain may have a number of hosts associated with it, and each
25384host may have more than one IP address. Retry algorithms are selected on the
25385basis of the domain name, but are applied to each IP address independently. If,
25386for example, a host has two IP addresses and one is unusable, Exim will
25387generate retry times for it and will not try to use it until its next retry
25388time comes. Thus the good IP address is likely to be tried first most of the
25389time.
25390
25391.cindex "hints database" "use for retrying"
25392Retry times are hints rather than promises. Exim does not make any attempt to
25393run deliveries exactly at the computed times. Instead, a queue runner process
25394starts delivery processes for delayed messages periodically, and these attempt
25395new deliveries only for those addresses that have passed their next retry time.
25396If a new message arrives for a deferred address, an immediate delivery attempt
25397occurs only if the address has passed its retry time. In the absence of new
25398messages, the minimum time between retries is the interval between queue runner
25399processes. There is not much point in setting retry times of five minutes if
25400your queue runners happen only once an hour, unless there are a significant
25401number of incoming messages (which might be the case on a system that is
25402sending everything to a smart host, for example).
25403
25404The data in the retry hints database can be inspected by using the
25405&'exim_dumpdb'& or &'exim_fixdb'& utility programs (see chapter
25406&<<CHAPutils>>&). The latter utility can also be used to change the data. The
25407&'exinext'& utility script can be used to find out what the next retry times
25408are for the hosts associated with a particular mail domain, and also for local
25409deliveries that have been deferred.
25410
25411
25412.section "Retry rule examples" "SECID164"
25413Here are some example retry rules:
25414.code
25415alice@wonderland.fict.example quota_5d F,7d,3h
25416wonderland.fict.example quota_5d
25417wonderland.fict.example * F,1h,15m; G,2d,1h,2;
25418lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
25419* refused_A F,2h,20m;
25420* * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,5d,8h
25421.endd
25422The first rule sets up special handling for mail to
25423&'alice@wonderland.fict.example'& when there is an over-quota error and the
25424mailbox has not been read for at least 5 days. Retries continue every three
25425hours for 7 days. The second rule handles over-quota errors for all other local
25426parts at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; the absence of a local part has the same
25427effect as supplying &"*@"&. As no retry algorithms are supplied, messages that
25428fail are bounced immediately if the mailbox has not been read for at least 5
25429days.
25430
25431The third rule handles all other errors at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; retries
25432happen every 15 minutes for an hour, then with geometrically increasing
25433intervals until two days have passed since a delivery first failed. After the
25434first hour there is a delay of one hour, then two hours, then four hours, and
25435so on (this is a rather extreme example).
25436
25437The fourth rule controls retries for the domain &'lookingglass.fict.example'&.
25438They happen every 30 minutes for 24 hours only. The remaining two rules handle
25439all other domains, with special action for connection refusal from hosts that
25440were not obtained from an MX record.
25441
25442The final rule in a retry configuration should always have asterisks in the
25443first two fields so as to provide a general catch-all for any addresses that do
25444not have their own special handling. This example tries every 15 minutes for 2
25445hours, then with intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
254461.5 up to 16 hours, then every 8 hours up to 5 days.
25447
25448
25449
25450.section "Timeout of retry data" "SECID165"
25451.cindex "timeout" "of retry data"
25452.oindex "&%retry_data_expire%&"
25453.cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
25454.cindex "retry" "timeout of data"
25455Exim timestamps the data that it writes to its retry hints database. When it
25456consults the data during a delivery it ignores any that is older than the value
25457set in &%retry_data_expire%& (default 7 days). If, for example, a host hasn't
25458been tried for 7 days, Exim will try to deliver to it immediately a message
25459arrives, and if that fails, it will calculate a retry time as if it were
25460failing for the first time.
25461
25462This improves the behaviour for messages routed to rarely-used hosts such as MX
25463backups. If such a host was down at one time, and happens to be down again when
25464Exim tries a month later, using the old retry data would imply that it had been
25465down all the time, which is not a justified assumption.
25466
25467If a host really is permanently dead, this behaviour causes a burst of retries
25468every now and again, but only if messages routed to it are rare. If there is a
25469message at least once every 7 days the retry data never expires.
25470
25471
25472
25473
25474.section "Long-term failures" "SECID166"
25475.cindex "delivery failure, long-term"
25476.cindex "retry" "after long-term failure"
25477Special processing happens when an email address has been failing for so long
25478that the cutoff time for the last algorithm is reached. For example, using the
25479default retry rule:
25480.code
25481* * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
25482.endd
25483the cutoff time is four days. Reaching the retry cutoff is independent of how
25484long any specific message has been failing; it is the length of continuous
25485failure for the recipient address that counts.
25486
25487When the cutoff time is reached for a local delivery, or for all the IP
25488addresses associated with a remote delivery, a subsequent delivery failure
25489causes Exim to give up on the address, and a bounce message is generated.
25490In order to cater for new messages that use the failing address, a next retry
25491time is still computed from the final algorithm, and is used as follows:
25492
25493For local deliveries, one delivery attempt is always made for any subsequent
25494messages. If this delivery fails, the address fails immediately. The
25495post-cutoff retry time is not used.
25496
25497If the delivery is remote, there are two possibilities, controlled by the
25498.oindex "&%delay_after_cutoff%&"
25499&%delay_after_cutoff%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. The option is true by
25500default. Until the post-cutoff retry time for one of the IP addresses is
25501reached, the failing email address is bounced immediately, without a delivery
25502attempt taking place. After that time, one new delivery attempt is made to
25503those IP addresses that are past their retry times, and if that still fails,
25504the address is bounced and new retry times are computed.
25505
25506In other words, when all the hosts for a given email address have been failing
25507for a long time, Exim bounces rather then defers until one of the hosts' retry
25508times is reached. Then it tries once, and bounces if that attempt fails. This
25509behaviour ensures that few resources are wasted in repeatedly trying to deliver
25510to a broken destination, but if the host does recover, Exim will eventually
25511notice.
25512
25513If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
25514addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those IP
25515addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
25516no suitable IP addresses, or if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other
25517words, it does not delay when a new message arrives, but tries the expired
25518addresses immediately, unless they have been tried since the message arrived.
25519If there is a continuous stream of messages for the failing domains, setting
25520&%delay_after_cutoff%& false means that there will be many more attempts to
25521deliver to permanently failing IP addresses than when &%delay_after_cutoff%& is
25522true.
25523
25524.section "Deliveries that work intermittently" "SECID167"
25525.cindex "retry" "intermittently working deliveries"
25526Some additional logic is needed to cope with cases where a host is
25527intermittently available, or when a message has some attribute that prevents
25528its delivery when others to the same address get through. In this situation,
25529because some messages are successfully delivered, the &"retry clock"& for the
25530host or address keeps getting reset by the successful deliveries, and so
25531failing messages remain on the queue for ever because the cutoff time is never
25532reached.
25533
25534Two exceptional actions are applied to prevent this happening. The first
25535applies to errors that are related to a message rather than a remote host.
25536Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& has a discussion of the different kinds of error;
25537examples of message-related errors are 4&'xx'& responses to MAIL or DATA
25538commands, and quota failures. For this type of error, if a message's arrival
25539time is earlier than the &"first failed"& time for the error, the earlier time
25540is used when scanning the retry rules to decide when to try next and when to
25541time out the address.
25542
25543The exceptional second action applies in all cases. If a message has been on
25544the queue for longer than the cutoff time of any applicable retry rule for a
25545given address, a delivery is attempted for that address, even if it is not yet
25546time, and if this delivery fails, the address is timed out. A new retry time is
25547not computed in this case, so that other messages for the same address are
25548considered immediately.
25549.ecindex IIDretconf1
25550.ecindex IIDregconf2
25551
25552
25553
25554
25555
25556
25557. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25558. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25559
25560.chapter "SMTP authentication" "CHAPSMTPAUTH"
25561.scindex IIDauthconf1 "SMTP" "authentication configuration"
25562.scindex IIDauthconf2 "authentication"
25563The &"authenticators"& section of Exim's run time configuration is concerned
25564with SMTP authentication. This facility is an extension to the SMTP protocol,
25565described in RFC 2554, which allows a client SMTP host to authenticate itself
25566to a server. This is a common way for a server to recognize clients that are
25567permitted to use it as a relay. SMTP authentication is not of relevance to the
25568transfer of mail between servers that have no managerial connection with each
25569other.
25570
25571.cindex "AUTH" "description of"
25572Very briefly, the way SMTP authentication works is as follows:
25573
25574.ilist
25575The server advertises a number of authentication &'mechanisms'& in response to
25576the client's EHLO command.
25577.next
25578The client issues an AUTH command, naming a specific mechanism. The command
25579may, optionally, contain some authentication data.
25580.next
25581The server may issue one or more &'challenges'&, to which the client must send
25582appropriate responses. In simple authentication mechanisms, the challenges are
25583just prompts for user names and passwords. The server does not have to issue
25584any challenges &-- in some mechanisms the relevant data may all be transmitted
25585with the AUTH command.
25586.next
25587The server either accepts or denies authentication.
25588.next
25589If authentication succeeds, the client may optionally make use of the AUTH
25590option on the MAIL command to pass an authenticated sender in subsequent
25591mail transactions. Authentication lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
25592connection.
25593.next
25594If authentication fails, the client may give up, or it may try a different
25595authentication mechanism, or it may try transferring mail over the
25596unauthenticated connection.
25597.endlist
25598
25599If you are setting up a client, and want to know which authentication
25600mechanisms the server supports, you can use Telnet to connect to port 25 (the
25601SMTP port) on the server, and issue an EHLO command. The response to this
25602includes the list of supported mechanisms. For example:
25603.display
25604&`$ `&&*&`telnet server.example 25`&*&
25605&`Trying 192.168.34.25...`&
25606&`Connected to server.example.`&
25607&`Escape character is &#x0027;^]&#x0027;.`&
25608&`220 server.example ESMTP Exim 4.20 ...`&
25609&*&`ehlo client.example`&*&
25610&`250-server.example Hello client.example [10.8.4.5]`&
25611&`250-SIZE 52428800`&
25612&`250-PIPELINING`&
25613&`250-AUTH PLAIN`&
25614&`250 HELP`&
25615.endd
25616The second-last line of this example output shows that the server supports
25617authentication using the PLAIN mechanism. In Exim, the different authentication
25618mechanisms are configured by specifying &'authenticator'& drivers. Like the
25619routers and transports, which authenticators are included in the binary is
25620controlled by build-time definitions. The following are currently available,
25621included by setting
25622.code
25623AUTH_CRAM_MD5=yes
25624AUTH_CYRUS_SASL=yes
25625AUTH_DOVECOT=yes
25626AUTH_GSASL=yes
25627AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
25628AUTH_PLAINTEXT=yes
25629AUTH_SPA=yes
25630AUTH_TLS=yes
25631.endd
25632in &_Local/Makefile_&, respectively. The first of these supports the CRAM-MD5
25633authentication mechanism (RFC 2195), and the second provides an interface to
25634the Cyrus SASL authentication library.
25635The third is an interface to Dovecot's authentication system, delegating the
25636work via a socket interface.
25637The fourth provides an interface to the GNU SASL authentication library, which
25638provides mechanisms but typically not data sources.
25639The fifth provides direct access to Heimdal GSSAPI, geared for Kerberos, but
25640supporting setting a server keytab.
25641The sixth can be configured to support
25642the PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) or the LOGIN mechanism, which is
25643not formally documented, but used by several MUAs. The seventh authenticator
25644supports Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& mechanism.
25645The eighth is an Exim authenticator but not an SMTP one;
25646instead it can use information from a TLS negotiation.
25647
25648The authenticators are configured using the same syntax as other drivers (see
25649section &<<SECTfordricon>>&). If no authenticators are required, no
25650authentication section need be present in the configuration file. Each
25651authenticator can in principle have both server and client functions. When Exim
25652is receiving SMTP mail, it is acting as a server; when it is sending out
25653messages over SMTP, it is acting as a client. Authenticator configuration
25654options are provided for use in both these circumstances.
25655
25656To make it clear which options apply to which situation, the prefixes
25657&%server_%& and &%client_%& are used on option names that are specific to
25658either the server or the client function, respectively. Server and client
25659functions are disabled if none of their options are set. If an authenticator is
25660to be used for both server and client functions, a single definition, using
25661both sets of options, is required. For example:
25662.code
25663cram:
25664 driver = cram_md5
25665 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25666 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret1}fail}
25667 client_name = ph10
25668 client_secret = secret2
25669.endd
25670The &%server_%& option is used when Exim is acting as a server, and the
25671&%client_%& options when it is acting as a client.
25672
25673Descriptions of the individual authenticators are given in subsequent chapters.
25674The remainder of this chapter covers the generic options for the
25675authenticators, followed by general discussion of the way authentication works
25676in Exim.
25677
25678&*Beware:*& the meaning of &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, ... varies on a per-driver and
25679per-mechanism basis. Please read carefully to determine which variables hold
25680account labels such as usercodes and which hold passwords or other
25681authenticating data.
25682
25683Note that some mechanisms support two different identifiers for accounts: the
25684&'authentication id'& and the &'authorization id'&. The contractions &'authn'&
25685and &'authz'& are commonly encountered. The American spelling is standard here.
25686Conceptually, authentication data such as passwords are tied to the identifier
25687used to authenticate; servers may have rules to permit one user to act as a
25688second user, so that after login the session is treated as though that second
25689user had logged in. That second user is the &'authorization id'&. A robust
25690configuration might confirm that the &'authz'& field is empty or matches the
25691&'authn'& field. Often this is just ignored. The &'authn'& can be considered
25692as verified data, the &'authz'& as an unverified request which the server might
25693choose to honour.
25694
25695A &'realm'& is a text string, typically a domain name, presented by a server
25696to a client to help it select an account and credentials to use. In some
25697mechanisms, the client and server provably agree on the realm, but clients
25698typically can not treat the realm as secure data to be blindly trusted.
25699
25700
25701
25702.section "Generic options for authenticators" "SECID168"
25703.cindex "authentication" "generic options"
25704.cindex "options" "generic; for authenticators"
25705
25706.option client_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25707When Exim is authenticating as a client, it skips any authenticator whose
25708&%client_condition%& expansion yields &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&. This can be
25709used, for example, to skip plain text authenticators when the connection is not
25710encrypted by a setting such as:
25711.code
25712client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_out_cipher}{}}
25713.endd
25714
25715
25716.option client_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
25717When client authentication succeeds, this condition is expanded; the
25718result is used in the log lines for outbound messages.
25719Typically it will be the user name used for authentication.
25720
25721
25722.option driver authenticators string unset
25723This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available
25724authenticators is to be used.
25725
25726
25727.option public_name authenticators string unset
25728This option specifies the name of the authentication mechanism that the driver
25729implements, and by which it is known to the outside world. These names should
25730contain only upper case letters, digits, underscores, and hyphens (RFC 2222),
25731but Exim in fact matches them caselessly. If &%public_name%& is not set, it
25732defaults to the driver's instance name.
25733
25734
25735.option server_advertise_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25736When a server is about to advertise an authentication mechanism, the condition
25737is expanded. If it yields the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the
25738mechanism is not advertised.
25739If the expansion fails, the mechanism is not advertised. If the failure was not
25740forced, and was not caused by a lookup defer, the incident is logged.
25741See section &<<SECTauthexiser>>& below for further discussion.
25742
25743
25744.option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25745This option must be set for a &%plaintext%& server authenticator, where it
25746is used directly to control authentication. See section &<<SECTplainserver>>&
25747for details.
25748
25749For the &(gsasl)& authenticator, this option is required for various
25750mechanisms; see chapter &<<CHAPgsasl>>& for details.
25751
25752For the other authenticators, &%server_condition%& can be used as an additional
25753authentication or authorization mechanism that is applied after the other
25754authenticator conditions succeed. If it is set, it is expanded when the
25755authenticator would otherwise return a success code. If the expansion is forced
25756to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary
25757error code to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty
25758string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
25759expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds. For any
25760other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded string as
25761the error text.
25762
25763
25764.option server_debug_print authenticators string&!! unset
25765If this option is set and authentication debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%&
25766command line option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging
25767output when the authenticator is run as a server. This can help with checking
25768out the values of variables.
25769If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
25770output, and Exim carries on processing.
25771
25772
25773.option server_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
25774.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
25775When an Exim server successfully authenticates a client, this string is
25776expanded using data from the authentication, and preserved for any incoming
25777messages in the variable &$authenticated_id$&. It is also included in the log
25778lines for incoming messages. For example, a user/password authenticator
25779configuration might preserve the user name that was used to authenticate, and
25780refer to it subsequently during delivery of the message.
25781If expansion fails, the option is ignored.
25782
25783
25784.option server_mail_auth_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25785This option allows a server to discard authenticated sender addresses supplied
25786as part of MAIL commands in SMTP connections that are authenticated by the
25787driver on which &%server_mail_auth_condition%& is set. The option is not used
25788as part of the authentication process; instead its (unexpanded) value is
25789remembered for later use.
25790How it is used is described in the following section.
25791
25792
25793
25794
25795
25796.section "The AUTH parameter on MAIL commands" "SECTauthparamail"
25797.cindex "authentication" "sender; authenticated"
25798.cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
25799When a client supplied an AUTH= item on a MAIL command, Exim applies
25800the following checks before accepting it as the authenticated sender of the
25801message:
25802
25803.ilist
25804If the connection is not using extended SMTP (that is, HELO was used rather
25805than EHLO), the use of AUTH= is a syntax error.
25806.next
25807If the value of the AUTH= parameter is &"<>"&, it is ignored.
25808.next
25809.vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
25810If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is defined, the ACL it specifies is run. While it is
25811running, the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is set to the value obtained
25812from the AUTH= parameter. If the ACL does not yield &"accept"&, the value of
25813&$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. The &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& ACL may not
25814return &"drop"& or &"discard"&. If it defers, a temporary error code (451) is
25815given for the MAIL command.
25816.next
25817If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is not defined, the value of the AUTH= parameter
25818is accepted and placed in &$authenticated_sender$& only if the client has
25819authenticated.
25820.next
25821If the AUTH= value was accepted by either of the two previous rules, and
25822the client has authenticated, and the authenticator has a setting for the
25823&%server_mail_auth_condition%&, the condition is checked at this point. The
25824valued that was saved from the authenticator is expanded. If the expansion
25825fails, or yields an empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the value of
25826&$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. If the expansion yields any other value,
25827the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is retained and passed on with the
25828message.
25829.endlist
25830
25831
25832When &$authenticated_sender$& is set for a message, it is passed on to other
25833hosts to which Exim authenticates as a client. Do not confuse this value with
25834&$authenticated_id$&, which is a string obtained from the authentication
25835process, and which is not usually a complete email address.
25836
25837.vindex "&$sender_address$&"
25838Whenever an AUTH= value is ignored, the incident is logged. The ACL for
25839MAIL, if defined, is run after AUTH= is accepted or ignored. It can
25840therefore make use of &$authenticated_sender$&. The converse is not true: the
25841value of &$sender_address$& is not yet set up when the &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&
25842ACL is run.
25843
25844
25845
25846.section "Authentication on an Exim server" "SECTauthexiser"
25847.cindex "authentication" "on an Exim server"
25848When Exim receives an EHLO command, it advertises the public names of those
25849authenticators that are configured as servers, subject to the following
25850conditions:
25851
25852.ilist
25853The client host must match &%auth_advertise_hosts%& (default *).
25854.next
25855It the &%server_advertise_condition%& option is set, its expansion must not
25856yield the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&.
25857.endlist
25858
25859The order in which the authenticators are defined controls the order in which
25860the mechanisms are advertised.
25861
25862Some mail clients (for example, some versions of Netscape) require the user to
25863provide a name and password for authentication whenever AUTH is advertised,
25864even though authentication may not in fact be needed (for example, Exim may be
25865set up to allow unconditional relaying from the client by an IP address check).
25866You can make such clients more friendly by not advertising AUTH to them.
25867For example, if clients on the 10.9.8.0/24 network are permitted (by the ACL
25868that runs for RCPT) to relay without authentication, you should set
25869.code
25870auth_advertise_hosts = ! 10.9.8.0/24
25871.endd
25872so that no authentication mechanisms are advertised to them.
25873
25874The &%server_advertise_condition%& controls the advertisement of individual
25875authentication mechanisms. For example, it can be used to restrict the
25876advertisement of a particular mechanism to encrypted connections, by a setting
25877such as:
25878.code
25879server_advertise_condition = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{no}{yes}}
25880.endd
25881.vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
25882If the session is encrypted, &$tls_in_cipher$& is not empty, and so the expansion
25883yields &"yes"&, which allows the advertisement to happen.
25884
25885When an Exim server receives an AUTH command from a client, it rejects it
25886immediately if AUTH was not advertised in response to an earlier EHLO
25887command. This is the case if
25888
25889.ilist
25890The client host does not match &%auth_advertise_hosts%&; or
25891.next
25892No authenticators are configured with server options; or
25893.next
25894Expansion of &%server_advertise_condition%& blocked the advertising of all the
25895server authenticators.
25896.endlist
25897
25898
25899Otherwise, Exim runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_auth%& in order
25900to decide whether to accept the command. If &%acl_smtp_auth%& is not set,
25901AUTH is accepted from any client host.
25902
25903If AUTH is not rejected by the ACL, Exim searches its configuration for a
25904server authentication mechanism that was advertised in response to EHLO and
25905that matches the one named in the AUTH command. If it finds one, it runs
25906the appropriate authentication protocol, and authentication either succeeds or
25907fails. If there is no matching advertised mechanism, the AUTH command is
25908rejected with a 504 error.
25909
25910.vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
25911.vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
25912When a message is received from an authenticated host, the value of
25913&$received_protocol$& is set to &"esmtpa"& or &"esmtpsa"& instead of &"esmtp"&
25914or &"esmtps"&, and &$sender_host_authenticated$& contains the name (not the
25915public name) of the authenticator driver that successfully authenticated the
25916client from which the message was received. This variable is empty if there was
25917no successful authentication.
25918
25919
25920
25921
25922.section "Testing server authentication" "SECID169"
25923.cindex "authentication" "testing a server"
25924.cindex "AUTH" "testing a server"
25925.cindex "base64 encoding" "creating authentication test data"
25926Exim's &%-bh%& option can be useful for testing server authentication
25927configurations. The data for the AUTH command has to be sent using base64
25928encoding. A quick way to produce such data for testing is the following Perl
25929script:
25930.code
25931use MIME::Base64;
25932printf ("%s", encode_base64(eval "\"$ARGV[0]\""));
25933.endd
25934.cindex "binary zero" "in authentication data"
25935This interprets its argument as a Perl string, and then encodes it. The
25936interpretation as a Perl string allows binary zeros, which are required for
25937some kinds of authentication, to be included in the data. For example, a
25938command line to run this script on such data might be
25939.code
25940encode '\0user\0password'
25941.endd
25942Note the use of single quotes to prevent the shell interpreting the
25943backslashes, so that they can be interpreted by Perl to specify characters
25944whose code value is zero.
25945
25946&*Warning 1*&: If either of the user or password strings starts with an octal
25947digit, you must use three zeros instead of one after the leading backslash. If
25948you do not, the octal digit that starts your string will be incorrectly
25949interpreted as part of the code for the first character.
25950
25951&*Warning 2*&: If there are characters in the strings that Perl interprets
25952specially, you must use a Perl escape to prevent them being misinterpreted. For
25953example, a command such as
25954.code
25955encode '\0user@domain.com\0pas$$word'
25956.endd
25957gives an incorrect answer because of the unescaped &"@"& and &"$"& characters.
25958
25959If you have the &%mimencode%& command installed, another way to do produce
25960base64-encoded strings is to run the command
25961.code
25962echo -e -n `\0user\0password' | mimencode
25963.endd
25964The &%-e%& option of &%echo%& enables the interpretation of backslash escapes
25965in the argument, and the &%-n%& option specifies no newline at the end of its
25966output. However, not all versions of &%echo%& recognize these options, so you
25967should check your version before relying on this suggestion.
25968
25969
25970
25971.section "Authentication by an Exim client" "SECID170"
25972.cindex "authentication" "on an Exim client"
25973The &(smtp)& transport has two options called &%hosts_require_auth%& and
25974&%hosts_try_auth%&. When the &(smtp)& transport connects to a server that
25975announces support for authentication, and the host matches an entry in either
25976of these options, Exim (as a client) tries to authenticate as follows:
25977
25978.ilist
25979For each authenticator that is configured as a client, in the order in which
25980they are defined in the configuration, it searches the authentication
25981mechanisms announced by the server for one whose name matches the public name
25982of the authenticator.
25983.next
25984.vindex "&$host$&"
25985.vindex "&$host_address$&"
25986When it finds one that matches, it runs the authenticator's client code. The
25987variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available for any string expansions
25988that the client might do. They are set to the server's name and IP address. If
25989any expansion is forced to fail, the authentication attempt is abandoned, and
25990Exim moves on to the next authenticator. Otherwise an expansion failure causes
25991delivery to be deferred.
25992.next
25993If the result of the authentication attempt is a temporary error or a timeout,
25994Exim abandons trying to send the message to the host for the moment. It will
25995try again later. If there are any backup hosts available, they are tried in the
25996usual way.
25997.next
25998If the response to authentication is a permanent error (5&'xx'& code), Exim
25999carries on searching the list of authenticators and tries another one if
26000possible. If all authentication attempts give permanent errors, or if there are
26001no attempts because no mechanisms match (or option expansions force failure),
26002what happens depends on whether the host matches &%hosts_require_auth%& or
26003&%hosts_try_auth%&. In the first case, a temporary error is generated, and
26004delivery is deferred. The error can be detected in the retry rules, and thereby
26005turned into a permanent error if you wish. In the second case, Exim tries to
26006deliver the message unauthenticated.
26007.endlist
26008
26009Note that the hostlist test for whether to do authentication can be
26010confused if name-IP lookups change between the time the peer is decided
26011on and the transport running. For example, with a manualroute
26012router given a host name, and DNS "round-robin" use by that name: if
26013the local resolver cache times out between the router and the transport
26014running, the transport may get an IP for the name for its authentication
26015check which does not match the connection peer IP.
26016No authentication will then be done, despite the names being identical.
26017
26018For such cases use a separate transport which always authenticates.
26019
26020.cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
26021When Exim has authenticated itself to a remote server, it adds the AUTH
26022parameter to the MAIL commands it sends, if it has an authenticated sender for
26023the message. If the message came from a remote host, the authenticated sender
26024is the one that was receiving on an incoming MAIL command, provided that the
26025incoming connection was authenticated and the &%server_mail_auth%& condition
26026allowed the authenticated sender to be retained. If a local process calls Exim
26027to send a message, the sender address that is built from the login name and
26028&%qualify_domain%& is treated as authenticated. However, if the
26029&%authenticated_sender%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it overrides
26030the authenticated sender that was received with the message.
26031.ecindex IIDauthconf1
26032.ecindex IIDauthconf2
26033
26034
26035
26036
26037
26038
26039. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26040. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26041
26042.chapter "The plaintext authenticator" "CHAPplaintext"
26043.scindex IIDplaiauth1 "&(plaintext)& authenticator"
26044.scindex IIDplaiauth2 "authenticators" "&(plaintext)&"
26045The &(plaintext)& authenticator can be configured to support the PLAIN and
26046LOGIN authentication mechanisms, both of which transfer authentication data as
26047plain (unencrypted) text (though base64 encoded). The use of plain text is a
26048security risk; you are strongly advised to insist on the use of SMTP encryption
26049(see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&) if you use the PLAIN or LOGIN mechanisms. If you do
26050use unencrypted plain text, you should not use the same passwords for SMTP
26051connections as you do for login accounts.
26052
26053.section "Plaintext options" "SECID171"
26054.cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (server)"
26055When configured as a server, &(plaintext)& uses the following options:
26056
26057.option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
26058This is actually a global authentication option, but it must be set in order to
26059configure the &(plaintext)& driver as a server. Its use is described below.
26060
26061.option server_prompts plaintext string&!! unset
26062The contents of this option, after expansion, must be a colon-separated list of
26063prompt strings. If expansion fails, a temporary authentication rejection is
26064given.
26065
26066.section "Using plaintext in a server" "SECTplainserver"
26067.cindex "AUTH" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26068.cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26069.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
26070 "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26071.vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
26072.cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26073
26074When running as a server, &(plaintext)& performs the authentication test by
26075expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
26076response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
26077values when decoded. If any data is supplied with the command, it is treated as
26078a list of strings, separated by NULs (binary zeros), the first three of which
26079are placed in the expansion variables &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, and &$auth3$&
26080(neither LOGIN nor PLAIN uses more than three strings).
26081
26082For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the values are also placed in
26083the expansion variables &$1$&, &$2$&, and &$3$&. However, the use of these
26084variables for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
26085string expansions that also use them for other things.
26086
26087If there are more strings in &%server_prompts%& than the number of strings
26088supplied with the AUTH command, the remaining prompts are used to obtain more
26089data. Each response from the client may be a list of NUL-separated strings.
26090
26091.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
26092Once a sufficient number of data strings have been received,
26093&%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
26094authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
26095to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
26096&"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
26097expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
26098generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
26099For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
26100string as the error text
26101
26102&*Warning*&: If you use a lookup in the expansion to find the user's
26103password, be sure to make the authentication fail if the user is unknown.
26104There are good and bad examples at the end of the next section.
26105
26106
26107
26108.section "The PLAIN authentication mechanism" "SECID172"
26109.cindex "PLAIN authentication mechanism"
26110.cindex "authentication" "PLAIN mechanism"
26111.cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26112The PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) specifies that three strings be
26113sent as one item of data (that is, one combined string containing two NUL
26114separators). The data is sent either as part of the AUTH command, or
26115subsequently in response to an empty prompt from the server.
26116
26117The second and third strings are a user name and a corresponding password.
26118Using a single fixed user name and password as an example, this could be
26119configured as follows:
26120.code
26121fixed_plain:
26122 driver = plaintext
26123 public_name = PLAIN
26124 server_prompts = :
26125 server_condition = \
26126 ${if and {{eq{$auth2}{username}}{eq{$auth3}{mysecret}}}}
26127 server_set_id = $auth2
26128.endd
26129Note that the default result strings from &%if%& (&"true"& or an empty string)
26130are exactly what we want here, so they need not be specified. Obviously, if the
26131password contains expansion-significant characters such as dollar, backslash,
26132or closing brace, they have to be escaped.
26133
26134The &%server_prompts%& setting specifies a single, empty prompt (empty items at
26135the end of a string list are ignored). If all the data comes as part of the
26136AUTH command, as is commonly the case, the prompt is not used. This
26137authenticator is advertised in the response to EHLO as
26138.code
26139250-AUTH PLAIN
26140.endd
26141and a client host can authenticate itself by sending the command
26142.code
26143AUTH PLAIN AHVzZXJuYW1lAG15c2VjcmV0
26144.endd
26145As this contains three strings (more than the number of prompts), no further
26146data is required from the client. Alternatively, the client may just send
26147.code
26148AUTH PLAIN
26149.endd
26150to initiate authentication, in which case the server replies with an empty
26151prompt. The client must respond with the combined data string.
26152
26153The data string is base64 encoded, as required by the RFC. This example,
26154when decoded, is <&'NUL'&>&`username`&<&'NUL'&>&`mysecret`&, where <&'NUL'&>
26155represents a zero byte. This is split up into three strings, the first of which
26156is empty. The &%server_condition%& option in the authenticator checks that the
26157second two are &`username`& and &`mysecret`& respectively.
26158
26159Having just one fixed user name and password, as in this example, is not very
26160realistic, though for a small organization with only a handful of
26161authenticating clients it could make sense.
26162
26163A more sophisticated instance of this authenticator could use the user name in
26164&$auth2$& to look up a password in a file or database, and maybe do an encrypted
26165comparison (see &%crypteq%& in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). Here is a example of
26166this approach, where the passwords are looked up in a DBM file. &*Warning*&:
26167This is an incorrect example:
26168.code
26169server_condition = \
26170 ${if eq{$auth3}{${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}}}}
26171.endd
26172The expansion uses the user name (&$auth2$&) as the key to look up a password,
26173which it then compares to the supplied password (&$auth3$&). Why is this example
26174incorrect? It works fine for existing users, but consider what happens if a
26175non-existent user name is given. The lookup fails, but as no success/failure
26176strings are given for the lookup, it yields an empty string. Thus, to defeat
26177the authentication, all a client has to do is to supply a non-existent user
26178name and an empty password. The correct way of writing this test is:
26179.code
26180server_condition = ${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}\
26181 {${if eq{$value}{$auth3}}} {false}}
26182.endd
26183In this case, if the lookup succeeds, the result is checked; if the lookup
26184fails, &"false"& is returned and authentication fails. If &%crypteq%& is being
26185used instead of &%eq%&, the first example is in fact safe, because &%crypteq%&
26186always fails if its second argument is empty. However, the second way of
26187writing the test makes the logic clearer.
26188
26189
26190.section "The LOGIN authentication mechanism" "SECID173"
26191.cindex "LOGIN authentication mechanism"
26192.cindex "authentication" "LOGIN mechanism"
26193The LOGIN authentication mechanism is not documented in any RFC, but is in use
26194in a number of programs. No data is sent with the AUTH command. Instead, a
26195user name and password are supplied separately, in response to prompts. The
26196plaintext authenticator can be configured to support this as in this example:
26197.code
26198fixed_login:
26199 driver = plaintext
26200 public_name = LOGIN
26201 server_prompts = User Name : Password
26202 server_condition = \
26203 ${if and {{eq{$auth1}{username}}{eq{$auth2}{mysecret}}}}
26204 server_set_id = $auth1
26205.endd
26206Because of the way plaintext operates, this authenticator accepts data supplied
26207with the AUTH command (in contravention of the specification of LOGIN), but
26208if the client does not supply it (as is the case for LOGIN clients), the prompt
26209strings are used to obtain two data items.
26210
26211Some clients are very particular about the precise text of the prompts. For
26212example, Outlook Express is reported to recognize only &"Username:"& and
26213&"Password:"&. Here is an example of a LOGIN authenticator that uses those
26214strings. It uses the &%ldapauth%& expansion condition to check the user
26215name and password by binding to an LDAP server:
26216.code
26217login:
26218 driver = plaintext
26219 public_name = LOGIN
26220 server_prompts = Username:: : Password::
26221 server_condition = ${if and{{ \
26222 !eq{}{$auth1} }{ \
26223 ldapauth{\
26224 user="uid=${quote_ldap_dn:$auth1},ou=people,o=example.org" \
26225 pass=${quote:$auth2} \
26226 ldap://ldap.example.org/} }} }
26227 server_set_id = uid=$auth1,ou=people,o=example.org
26228.endd
26229We have to check that the username is not empty before using it, because LDAP
26230does not permit empty DN components. We must also use the &%quote_ldap_dn%&
26231operator to correctly quote the DN for authentication. However, the basic
26232&%quote%& operator, rather than any of the LDAP quoting operators, is the
26233correct one to use for the password, because quoting is needed only to make
26234the password conform to the Exim syntax. At the LDAP level, the password is an
26235uninterpreted string.
26236
26237
26238.section "Support for different kinds of authentication" "SECID174"
26239A number of string expansion features are provided for the purpose of
26240interfacing to different ways of user authentication. These include checking
26241traditionally encrypted passwords from &_/etc/passwd_& (or equivalent), PAM,
26242Radius, &%ldapauth%&, &'pwcheck'&, and &'saslauthd'&. For details see section
26243&<<SECTexpcond>>&.
26244
26245
26246
26247
26248.section "Using plaintext in a client" "SECID175"
26249.cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (client)"
26250The &(plaintext)& authenticator has two client options:
26251
26252.option client_ignore_invalid_base64 plaintext boolean false
26253If the client receives a server prompt that is not a valid base64 string,
26254authentication is abandoned by default. However, if this option is set true,
26255the error in the challenge is ignored and the client sends the response as
26256usual.
26257
26258.option client_send plaintext string&!! unset
26259The string is a colon-separated list of authentication data strings. Each
26260string is independently expanded before being sent to the server. The first
26261string is sent with the AUTH command; any more strings are sent in response
26262to prompts from the server. Before each string is expanded, the value of the
26263most recent prompt is placed in the next &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable, starting
26264with &$auth1$& for the first prompt. Up to three prompts are stored in this
26265way. Thus, the prompt that is received in response to sending the first string
26266(with the AUTH command) can be used in the expansion of the second string, and
26267so on. If an invalid base64 string is received when
26268&%client_ignore_invalid_base64%& is set, an empty string is put in the
26269&$auth$&<&'n'&> variable.
26270
26271&*Note*&: You cannot use expansion to create multiple strings, because
26272splitting takes priority and happens first.
26273
26274Because the PLAIN authentication mechanism requires NUL (binary zero) bytes in
26275the data, further processing is applied to each string before it is sent. If
26276there are any single circumflex characters in the string, they are converted to
26277NULs. Should an actual circumflex be required as data, it must be doubled in
26278the string.
26279
26280This is an example of a client configuration that implements the PLAIN
26281authentication mechanism with a fixed user name and password:
26282.code
26283fixed_plain:
26284 driver = plaintext
26285 public_name = PLAIN
26286 client_send = ^username^mysecret
26287.endd
26288The lack of colons means that the entire text is sent with the AUTH
26289command, with the circumflex characters converted to NULs. A similar example
26290that uses the LOGIN mechanism is:
26291.code
26292fixed_login:
26293 driver = plaintext
26294 public_name = LOGIN
26295 client_send = : username : mysecret
26296.endd
26297The initial colon means that the first string is empty, so no data is sent with
26298the AUTH command itself. The remaining strings are sent in response to
26299prompts.
26300.ecindex IIDplaiauth1
26301.ecindex IIDplaiauth2
26302
26303
26304
26305
26306. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26307. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26308
26309.chapter "The cram_md5 authenticator" "CHID9"
26310.scindex IIDcramauth1 "&(cram_md5)& authenticator"
26311.scindex IIDcramauth2 "authenticators" "&(cram_md5)&"
26312.cindex "CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism"
26313.cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5 mechanism"
26314The CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism is described in RFC 2195. The server
26315sends a challenge string to the client, and the response consists of a user
26316name and the CRAM-MD5 digest of the challenge string combined with a secret
26317string (password) which is known to both server and client. Thus, the secret
26318is not sent over the network as plain text, which makes this authenticator more
26319secure than &(plaintext)&. However, the downside is that the secret has to be
26320available in plain text at either end.
26321
26322
26323.section "Using cram_md5 as a server" "SECID176"
26324.cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (server)"
26325This authenticator has one server option, which must be set to configure the
26326authenticator as a server:
26327
26328.option server_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
26329.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(cram_md5)& authenticator"
26330When the server receives the client's response, the user name is placed in
26331the expansion variable &$auth1$&, and &%server_secret%& is expanded to
26332obtain the password for that user. The server then computes the CRAM-MD5 digest
26333that the client should have sent, and checks that it received the correct
26334string. If the expansion of &%server_secret%& is forced to fail, authentication
26335fails. If the expansion fails for some other reason, a temporary error code is
26336returned to the client.
26337
26338For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed
26339in &$1$&. However, the use of this variables for this purpose is now
26340deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use
26341numeric variables for other things.
26342
26343For example, the following authenticator checks that the user name given by the
26344client is &"ph10"&, and if so, uses &"secret"& as the password. For any other
26345user name, authentication fails.
26346.code
26347fixed_cram:
26348 driver = cram_md5
26349 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26350 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret}fail}
26351 server_set_id = $auth1
26352.endd
26353.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
26354If authentication succeeds, the setting of &%server_set_id%& preserves the user
26355name in &$authenticated_id$&. A more typical configuration might look up the
26356secret string in a file, using the user name as the key. For example:
26357.code
26358lookup_cram:
26359 driver = cram_md5
26360 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26361 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/authpwd}\
26362 {$value}fail}
26363 server_set_id = $auth1
26364.endd
26365Note that this expansion explicitly forces failure if the lookup fails
26366because &$auth1$& contains an unknown user name.
26367
26368As another example, if you wish to re-use a Cyrus SASL sasldb2 file without
26369using the relevant libraries, you need to know the realm to specify in the
26370lookup and then ask for the &"userPassword"& attribute for that user in that
26371realm, with:
26372.code
26373cyrusless_crammd5:
26374 driver = cram_md5
26375 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26376 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1:mail.example.org:userPassword}\
26377 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
26378 server_set_id = $auth1
26379.endd
26380
26381.section "Using cram_md5 as a client" "SECID177"
26382.cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (client)"
26383When used as a client, the &(cram_md5)& authenticator has two options:
26384
26385
26386
26387.option client_name cram_md5 string&!! "the primary host name"
26388This string is expanded, and the result used as the user name data when
26389computing the response to the server's challenge.
26390
26391
26392.option client_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
26393This option must be set for the authenticator to work as a client. Its value is
26394expanded and the result used as the secret string when computing the response.
26395
26396
26397.vindex "&$host$&"
26398.vindex "&$host_address$&"
26399Different user names and secrets can be used for different servers by referring
26400to &$host$& or &$host_address$& in the options. Forced failure of either
26401expansion string is treated as an indication that this authenticator is not
26402prepared to handle this case. Exim moves on to the next configured client
26403authenticator. Any other expansion failure causes Exim to give up trying to
26404send the message to the current server.
26405
26406A simple example configuration of a &(cram_md5)& authenticator, using fixed
26407strings, is:
26408.code
26409fixed_cram:
26410 driver = cram_md5
26411 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26412 client_name = ph10
26413 client_secret = secret
26414.endd
26415.ecindex IIDcramauth1
26416.ecindex IIDcramauth2
26417
26418
26419
26420. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26421. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26422
26423.chapter "The cyrus_sasl authenticator" "CHID10"
26424.scindex IIDcyrauth1 "&(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator"
26425.scindex IIDcyrauth2 "authenticators" "&(cyrus_sasl)&"
26426.cindex "Cyrus" "SASL library"
26427.cindex "Kerberos"
26428The code for this authenticator was provided by Matthew Byng-Maddick of A L
26429Digital Ltd (&url(http://www.aldigital.co.uk)).
26430
26431The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides server support for the Cyrus SASL
26432library implementation of the RFC 2222 (&"Simple Authentication and Security
26433Layer"&). This library supports a number of authentication mechanisms,
26434including PLAIN and LOGIN, but also several others that Exim does not support
26435directly. In particular, there is support for Kerberos authentication.
26436
26437The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides a gatewaying mechanism directly to
26438the Cyrus interface, so if your Cyrus library can do, for example, CRAM-MD5,
26439then so can the &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator. By default it uses the public
26440name of the driver to determine which mechanism to support.
26441
26442Where access to some kind of secret file is required, for example in GSSAPI
26443or CRAM-MD5, it is worth noting that the authenticator runs as the Exim
26444user, and that the Cyrus SASL library has no way of escalating privileges
26445by default. You may also find you need to set environment variables,
26446depending on the driver you are using.
26447
26448The application name provided by Exim is &"exim"&, so various SASL options may
26449be set in &_exim.conf_& in your SASL directory. If you are using GSSAPI for
26450Kerberos, note that because of limitations in the GSSAPI interface,
26451changing the server keytab might need to be communicated down to the Kerberos
26452layer independently. The mechanism for doing so is dependent upon the Kerberos
26453implementation.
26454
26455For example, for older releases of Heimdal, the environment variable KRB5_KTNAME
26456may be set to point to an alternative keytab file. Exim will pass this
26457variable through from its own inherited environment when started as root or the
26458Exim user. The keytab file needs to be readable by the Exim user.
26459With newer releases of Heimdal, a setuid Exim may cause Heimdal to discard the
26460environment variable. In practice, for those releases, the Cyrus authenticator
26461is not a suitable interface for GSSAPI (Kerberos) support. Instead, consider
26462the &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator, described in chapter &<<CHAPheimdalgss>>&
26463
26464
26465.section "Using cyrus_sasl as a server" "SECID178"
26466The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator has four private options. It puts the username
26467(on a successful authentication) into &$auth1$&. For compatibility with
26468previous releases of Exim, the username is also placed in &$1$&. However, the
26469use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to
26470confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables for other
26471things.
26472
26473
26474.option server_hostname cyrus_sasl string&!! "see below"
26475This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
26476library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&. It is up to the underlying
26477SASL plug-in what it does with this data.
26478
26479
26480.option server_mech cyrus_sasl string "see below"
26481This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
26482default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
26483you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
26484example:
26485.code
26486sasl:
26487 driver = cyrus_sasl
26488 public_name = X-ANYTHING
26489 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
26490 server_set_id = $auth1
26491.endd
26492
26493.option server_realm cyrus_sasl string&!! unset
26494This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
26495
26496
26497.option server_service cyrus_sasl string &`smtp`&
26498This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
26499
26500
26501For straightforward cases, you do not need to set any of the authenticator's
26502private options. All you need to do is to specify an appropriate mechanism as
26503the public name. Thus, if you have a SASL library that supports CRAM-MD5 and
26504PLAIN, you could have two authenticators as follows:
26505.code
26506sasl_cram_md5:
26507 driver = cyrus_sasl
26508 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26509 server_set_id = $auth1
26510
26511sasl_plain:
26512 driver = cyrus_sasl
26513 public_name = PLAIN
26514 server_set_id = $auth2
26515.endd
26516Cyrus SASL does implement the LOGIN authentication method, even though it is
26517not a standard method. It is disabled by default in the source distribution,
26518but it is present in many binary distributions.
26519.ecindex IIDcyrauth1
26520.ecindex IIDcyrauth2
26521
26522
26523
26524
26525. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26526. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26527.chapter "The dovecot authenticator" "CHAPdovecot"
26528.scindex IIDdcotauth1 "&(dovecot)& authenticator"
26529.scindex IIDdcotauth2 "authenticators" "&(dovecot)&"
26530This authenticator is an interface to the authentication facility of the
26531Dovecot POP/IMAP server, which can support a number of authentication methods.
26532Note that Dovecot must be configured to use auth-client not auth-userdb.
26533If you are using Dovecot to authenticate POP/IMAP clients, it might be helpful
26534to use the same mechanisms for SMTP authentication. This is a server
26535authenticator only. There is only one option:
26536
26537.option server_socket dovecot string unset
26538
26539This option must specify the socket that is the interface to Dovecot
26540authentication. The &%public_name%& option must specify an authentication
26541mechanism that Dovecot is configured to support. You can have several
26542authenticators for different mechanisms. For example:
26543.code
26544dovecot_plain:
26545 driver = dovecot
26546 public_name = PLAIN
26547 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
26548 server_set_id = $auth1
26549
26550dovecot_ntlm:
26551 driver = dovecot
26552 public_name = NTLM
26553 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
26554 server_set_id = $auth1
26555.endd
26556If the SMTP connection is encrypted, or if &$sender_host_address$& is equal to
26557&$received_ip_address$& (that is, the connection is local), the &"secured"&
26558option is passed in the Dovecot authentication command. If, for a TLS
26559connection, a client certificate has been verified, the &"valid-client-cert"&
26560option is passed. When authentication succeeds, the identity of the user
26561who authenticated is placed in &$auth1$&.
26562.ecindex IIDdcotauth1
26563.ecindex IIDdcotauth2
26564
26565
26566. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26567. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26568.chapter "The gsasl authenticator" "CHAPgsasl"
26569.scindex IIDgsaslauth1 "&(gsasl)& authenticator"
26570.scindex IIDgsaslauth2 "authenticators" "&(gsasl)&"
26571.cindex "authentication" "GNU SASL"
26572.cindex "authentication" "SASL"
26573.cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
26574.cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
26575.cindex "authentication" "PLAIN"
26576.cindex "authentication" "LOGIN"
26577.cindex "authentication" "DIGEST-MD5"
26578.cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5"
26579.cindex "authentication" "SCRAM-SHA-1"
26580The &(gsasl)& authenticator provides server integration for the GNU SASL
26581library and the mechanisms it provides. This is new as of the 4.80 release
26582and there are a few areas where the library does not let Exim smoothly
26583scale to handle future authentication mechanisms, so no guarantee can be
26584made that any particular new authentication mechanism will be supported
26585without code changes in Exim.
26586
26587
26588.option server_channelbinding gsasl boolean false
26589Some authentication mechanisms are able to use external context at both ends
26590of the session to bind the authentication to that context, and fail the
26591authentication process if that context differs. Specifically, some TLS
26592ciphersuites can provide identifying information about the cryptographic
26593context.
26594
26595This means that certificate identity and verification becomes a non-issue,
26596as a man-in-the-middle attack will cause the correct client and server to
26597see different identifiers and authentication will fail.
26598
26599This is currently only supported when using the GnuTLS library. This is
26600only usable by mechanisms which support "channel binding"; at time of
26601writing, that's the SCRAM family.
26602
26603This defaults off to ensure smooth upgrade across Exim releases, in case
26604this option causes some clients to start failing. Some future release
26605of Exim may switch the default to be true.
26606
26607
26608.option server_hostname gsasl string&!! "see below"
26609This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
26610library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
26611Some mechanisms will use this data.
26612
26613
26614.option server_mech gsasl string "see below"
26615This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
26616default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
26617you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
26618example:
26619.code
26620sasl:
26621 driver = gsasl
26622 public_name = X-ANYTHING
26623 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
26624 server_set_id = $auth1
26625.endd
26626
26627
26628.option server_password gsasl string&!! unset
26629Various mechanisms need access to the cleartext password on the server, so
26630that proof-of-possession can be demonstrated on the wire, without sending
26631the password itself.
26632
26633The data available for lookup varies per mechanism.
26634In all cases, &$auth1$& is set to the &'authentication id'&.
26635The &$auth2$& variable will always be the &'authorization id'& (&'authz'&)
26636if available, else the empty string.
26637The &$auth3$& variable will always be the &'realm'& if available,
26638else the empty string.
26639
26640A forced failure will cause authentication to defer.
26641
26642If using this option, it may make sense to set the &%server_condition%&
26643option to be simply "true".
26644
26645
26646.option server_realm gsasl string&!! unset
26647This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
26648Some mechanisms will use this data.
26649
26650
26651.option server_scram_iter gsasl string&!! unset
26652This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
26653&$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
26654(This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
26655
26656
26657.option server_scram_salt gsasl string&!! unset
26658This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
26659&$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
26660(This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
26661
26662
26663.option server_service gsasl string &`smtp`&
26664This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
26665Some mechanisms will use this data.
26666
26667
26668.section "&(gsasl)& auth variables" "SECTgsaslauthvar"
26669.vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
26670These may be set when evaluating specific options, as detailed above.
26671They will also be set when evaluating &%server_condition%&.
26672
26673Unless otherwise stated below, the &(gsasl)& integration will use the following
26674meanings for these variables:
26675
26676.ilist
26677.vindex "&$auth1$&"
26678&$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&
26679.next
26680.vindex "&$auth2$&"
26681&$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&
26682.next
26683.vindex "&$auth3$&"
26684&$auth3$&: the &'realm'&
26685.endlist
26686
26687On a per-mechanism basis:
26688
26689.ilist
26690.cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
26691EXTERNAL: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'authorization id'&;
26692the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
26693.next
26694.cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
26695ANONYMOUS: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'anonymous token'&;
26696the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
26697.next
26698.cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
26699GSSAPI: &$auth1$& will be set to the &'GSSAPI Display Name'&;
26700&$auth2$& will be set to the &'authorization id'&,
26701the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
26702.endlist
26703
26704An &'anonymous token'& is something passed along as an unauthenticated
26705identifier; this is analogous to FTP anonymous authentication passing an
26706email address, or software-identifier@, as the "password".
26707
26708
26709An example showing the password having the realm specified in the callback
26710and demonstrating a Cyrus SASL to GSASL migration approach is:
26711.code
26712gsasl_cyrusless_crammd5:
26713 driver = gsasl
26714 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26715 server_realm = imap.example.org
26716 server_password = ${lookup{$auth1:$auth3:userPassword}\
26717 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
26718 server_set_id = ${quote:$auth1}
26719 server_condition = yes
26720.endd
26721
26722
26723. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26724. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26725
26726.chapter "The heimdal_gssapi authenticator" "CHAPheimdalgss"
26727.scindex IIDheimdalgssauth1 "&(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator"
26728.scindex IIDheimdalgssauth2 "authenticators" "&(heimdal_gssapi)&"
26729.cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
26730.cindex "authentication" "Kerberos"
26731The &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator provides server integration for the
26732Heimdal GSSAPI/Kerberos library, permitting Exim to set a keytab pathname
26733reliably.
26734
26735.option server_hostname heimdal_gssapi string&!! "see below"
26736This option selects the hostname that is used, with &%server_service%&,
26737for constructing the GSS server name, as a &'GSS_C_NT_HOSTBASED_SERVICE'&
26738identifier. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
26739
26740.option server_keytab heimdal_gssapi string&!! unset
26741If set, then Heimdal will not use the system default keytab (typically
26742&_/etc/krb5.keytab_&) but instead the pathname given in this option.
26743The value should be a pathname, with no &"file:"& prefix.
26744
26745.option server_service heimdal_gssapi string&!! "smtp"
26746This option specifies the service identifier used, in conjunction with
26747&%server_hostname%&, for building the identifier for finding credentials
26748from the keytab.
26749
26750
26751.section "&(heimdal_gssapi)& auth variables" "SECTheimdalgssauthvar"
26752Beware that these variables will typically include a realm, thus will appear
26753to be roughly like an email address already. The &'authzid'& in &$auth2$& is
26754not verified, so a malicious client can set it to anything.
26755
26756The &$auth1$& field should be safely trustable as a value from the Key
26757Distribution Center. Note that these are not quite email addresses.
26758Each identifier is for a role, and so the left-hand-side may include a
26759role suffix. For instance, &"joe/admin@EXAMPLE.ORG"&.
26760
26761.vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
26762.ilist
26763.vindex "&$auth1$&"
26764&$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&, set to the GSS Display Name.
26765.next
26766.vindex "&$auth2$&"
26767&$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&, sent within SASL encapsulation after
26768authentication. If that was empty, this will also be set to the
26769GSS Display Name.
26770.endlist
26771
26772
26773. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26774. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26775
26776.chapter "The spa authenticator" "CHAPspa"
26777.scindex IIDspaauth1 "&(spa)& authenticator"
26778.scindex IIDspaauth2 "authenticators" "&(spa)&"
26779.cindex "authentication" "Microsoft Secure Password"
26780.cindex "authentication" "NTLM"
26781.cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
26782.cindex "NTLM authentication"
26783The &(spa)& authenticator provides client support for Microsoft's &'Secure
26784Password Authentication'& mechanism,
26785which is also sometimes known as NTLM (NT LanMan). The code for client side of
26786this authenticator was contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux, and much of it is
26787taken from the Samba project (&url(http://www.samba.org)). The code for the
26788server side was subsequently contributed by Tom Kistner. The mechanism works as
26789follows:
26790
26791.ilist
26792After the AUTH command has been accepted, the client sends an SPA
26793authentication request based on the user name and optional domain.
26794.next
26795The server sends back a challenge.
26796.next
26797The client builds a challenge response which makes use of the user's password
26798and sends it to the server, which then accepts or rejects it.
26799.endlist
26800
26801Encryption is used to protect the password in transit.
26802
26803
26804
26805.section "Using spa as a server" "SECID179"
26806.cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (server)"
26807The &(spa)& authenticator has just one server option:
26808
26809.option server_password spa string&!! unset
26810.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(spa)& authenticator"
26811This option is expanded, and the result must be the cleartext password for the
26812authenticating user, whose name is at this point in &$auth1$&. For
26813compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed in
26814&$1$&. However, the use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as
26815it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables
26816for other things. For example:
26817.code
26818spa:
26819 driver = spa
26820 public_name = NTLM
26821 server_password = \
26822 ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/exim/spa_clearpass}{$value}fail}
26823.endd
26824If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
26825failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
26826
26827
26828
26829
26830
26831.section "Using spa as a client" "SECID180"
26832.cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (client)"
26833The &(spa)& authenticator has the following client options:
26834
26835
26836
26837.option client_domain spa string&!! unset
26838This option specifies an optional domain for the authentication.
26839
26840
26841.option client_password spa string&!! unset
26842This option specifies the user's password, and must be set.
26843
26844
26845.option client_username spa string&!! unset
26846This option specifies the user name, and must be set. Here is an example of a
26847configuration of this authenticator for use with the mail servers at
26848&'msn.com'&:
26849.code
26850msn:
26851 driver = spa
26852 public_name = MSN
26853 client_username = msn/msn_username
26854 client_password = msn_plaintext_password
26855 client_domain = DOMAIN_OR_UNSET
26856.endd
26857.ecindex IIDspaauth1
26858.ecindex IIDspaauth2
26859
26860
26861
26862
26863
26864. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26865. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26866
26867.chapter "The tls authenticator" "CHAPtlsauth"
26868.scindex IIDtlsauth1 "&(tls)& authenticator"
26869.scindex IIDtlsauth2 "authenticators" "&(tls)&"
26870.cindex "authentication" "Client Certificate"
26871.cindex "authentication" "X509"
26872.cindex "Certificate-based authentication"
26873The &(tls)& authenticator provides server support for
26874authentication based on client certificates.
26875
26876It is not an SMTP authentication mechanism and is not
26877advertised by the server as part of the SMTP EHLO response.
26878It is an Exim authenticator in the sense that it affects
26879the protocol element of the log line, can be tested for
26880by the &%authenticated%& ACL condition, and can set
26881the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
26882
26883The client must present a verifiable certificate,
26884for which it must have been requested via the
26885&%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& main options
26886(see &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
26887
26888If an authenticator of this type is configured it is
26889run before any SMTP-level communication is done,
26890and can authenticate the connection.
26891If it does, SMTP authentication is not offered.
26892
26893A maximum of one authenticator of this type may be present.
26894
26895
26896.cindex "options" "&(tls)& authenticator (server)"
26897The &(tls)& authenticator has three server options:
26898
26899.option server_param1 tls string&!! unset
26900.cindex "variables (&$auth1$& &$auth2$& etc)" "in &(tls)& authenticator"
26901This option is expanded after the TLS negotiation and
26902the result is placed in &$auth1$&.
26903If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
26904failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
26905
26906.option server_param2 tls string&!! unset
26907.option server_param3 tls string&!! unset
26908As above, for &$auth2$& and &$auth3$&.
26909
26910&%server_param1%& may also be spelled &%server_param%&.
26911
26912
26913Example:
26914.code
26915tls:
26916 driver = tls
26917 server_param1 = ${certextract {subj_altname,mail,>:} \
26918 {$tls_in_peercert}}
26919 server_condition = ${if forany {$auth1} \
26920 {!= {0} \
26921 {${lookup ldap{ldap:///\
26922 mailname=${quote_ldap_dn:${lc:$item}},\
26923 ou=users,LDAP_DC?mailid} {$value}{0} \
26924 } } } }
26925 server_set_id = ${if = {1}{${listcount:$auth1}} {$auth1}{}}
26926.endd
26927This accepts a client certificate that is verifiable against any
26928of your configured trust-anchors
26929(which usually means the full set of public CAs)
26930and which has a SAN with a good account name.
26931Note that the client cert is on the wire in-clear, including the SAN,
26932whereas a plaintext SMTP AUTH done inside TLS is not.
26933
26934. An alternative might use
26935. .code
26936. server_param1 = ${sha256:$tls_in_peercert}
26937. .endd
26938. to require one of a set of specific certs that define a given account
26939. (the verification is still required, but mostly irrelevant).
26940. This would help for per-device use.
26941.
26942. However, for the future we really need support for checking a
26943. user cert in LDAP - which probably wants a base-64 DER.
26944
26945.ecindex IIDtlsauth1
26946.ecindex IIDtlsauth2
26947
26948
26949Note that because authentication is traditionally an SMTP operation,
26950the &%authenticated%& ACL condition cannot be used in
26951a connect- or helo-ACL.
26952
26953
26954
26955. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26956. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26957
26958.chapter "Encrypted SMTP connections using TLS/SSL" "CHAPTLS" &&&
26959 "Encrypted SMTP connections"
26960.scindex IIDencsmtp1 "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
26961.scindex IIDencsmtp2 "SMTP" "encryption"
26962.cindex "TLS" "on SMTP connection"
26963.cindex "OpenSSL"
26964.cindex "GnuTLS"
26965Support for TLS (Transport Layer Security), formerly known as SSL (Secure
26966Sockets Layer), is implemented by making use of the OpenSSL library or the
26967GnuTLS library (Exim requires GnuTLS release 1.0 or later). There is no
26968cryptographic code in the Exim distribution itself for implementing TLS. In
26969order to use this feature you must install OpenSSL or GnuTLS, and then build a
26970version of Exim that includes TLS support (see section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&).
26971You also need to understand the basic concepts of encryption at a managerial
26972level, and in particular, the way that public keys, private keys, and
26973certificates are used.
26974
26975RFC 3207 defines how SMTP connections can make use of encryption. Once a
26976connection is established, the client issues a STARTTLS command. If the
26977server accepts this, the client and the server negotiate an encryption
26978mechanism. If the negotiation succeeds, the data that subsequently passes
26979between them is encrypted.
26980
26981Exim's ACLs can detect whether the current SMTP session is encrypted or not,
26982and if so, what cipher suite is in use, whether the client supplied a
26983certificate, and whether or not that certificate was verified. This makes it
26984possible for an Exim server to deny or accept certain commands based on the
26985encryption state.
26986
26987&*Warning*&: Certain types of firewall and certain anti-virus products can
26988disrupt TLS connections. You need to turn off SMTP scanning for these products
26989in order to get TLS to work.
26990
26991
26992
26993.section "Support for the legacy &""ssmtp""& (aka &""smtps""&) protocol" &&&
26994 "SECID284"
26995.cindex "ssmtp protocol"
26996.cindex "smtps protocol"
26997.cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
26998.cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
26999Early implementations of encrypted SMTP used a different TCP port from normal
27000SMTP, and expected an encryption negotiation to start immediately, instead of
27001waiting for a STARTTLS command from the client using the standard SMTP
27002port. The protocol was called &"ssmtp"& or &"smtps"&, and port 465 was
27003allocated for this purpose.
27004
27005This approach was abandoned when encrypted SMTP was standardized, but there are
27006still some legacy clients that use it. Exim supports these clients by means of
27007the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& global option. Its value must be a list of port
27008numbers; the most common use is expected to be:
27009.code
27010tls_on_connect_ports = 465
27011.endd
27012The port numbers specified by this option apply to all SMTP connections, both
27013via the daemon and via &'inetd'&. You still need to specify all the ports that
27014the daemon uses (by setting &%daemon_smtp_ports%& or &%local_interfaces%& or
27015the &%-oX%& command line option) because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not add
27016an extra port &-- rather, it specifies different behaviour on a port that is
27017defined elsewhere.
27018
27019There is also a &%-tls-on-connect%& command line option. This overrides
27020&%tls_on_connect_ports%&; it forces the legacy behaviour for all ports.
27021
27022
27023
27024
27025
27026
27027.section "OpenSSL vs GnuTLS" "SECTopenvsgnu"
27028.cindex "TLS" "OpenSSL &'vs'& GnuTLS"
27029The first TLS support in Exim was implemented using OpenSSL. Support for GnuTLS
27030followed later, when the first versions of GnuTLS were released. To build Exim
27031to use GnuTLS, you need to set
27032.code
27033USE_GNUTLS=yes
27034.endd
27035in Local/Makefile, in addition to
27036.code
27037SUPPORT_TLS=yes
27038.endd
27039You must also set TLS_LIBS and TLS_INCLUDE appropriately, so that the
27040include files and libraries for GnuTLS can be found.
27041
27042There are some differences in usage when using GnuTLS instead of OpenSSL:
27043
27044.ilist
27045The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option
27046cannot be the path of a directory
27047for GnuTLS versions before 3.3.6
27048(for later versions, or OpenSSL, it can be either).
27049.next
27050The default value for &%tls_dhparam%& differs for historical reasons.
27051.next
27052.vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
27053.vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
27054Distinguished Name (DN) strings reported by the OpenSSL library use a slash for
27055separating fields; GnuTLS uses commas, in accordance with RFC 2253. This
27056affects the value of the &$tls_in_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables.
27057.next
27058OpenSSL identifies cipher suites using hyphens as separators, for example:
27059DES-CBC3-SHA. GnuTLS historically used underscores, for example:
27060RSA_ARCFOUR_SHA. What is more, OpenSSL complains if underscores are present
27061in a cipher list. To make life simpler, Exim changes underscores to hyphens
27062for OpenSSL and passes the string unchanged to GnuTLS (expecting the library
27063to handle its own older variants) when processing lists of cipher suites in the
27064&%tls_require_ciphers%& options (the global option and the &(smtp)& transport
27065option).
27066.next
27067The &%tls_require_ciphers%& options operate differently, as described in the
27068sections &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
27069.next
27070The &%tls_dh_min_bits%& SMTP transport option is only honoured by GnuTLS.
27071When using OpenSSL, this option is ignored.
27072(If an API is found to let OpenSSL be configured in this way,
27073let the Exim Maintainers know and we'll likely use it).
27074.next
27075Some other recently added features may only be available in one or the other.
27076This should be documented with the feature. If the documentation does not
27077explicitly state that the feature is infeasible in the other TLS
27078implementation, then patches are welcome.
27079.endlist
27080
27081
27082.section "GnuTLS parameter computation" "SECTgnutlsparam"
27083This section only applies if &%tls_dhparam%& is set to &`historic`& or to
27084an explicit path; if the latter, then the text about generation still applies,
27085but not the chosen filename.
27086By default, as of Exim 4.80 a hard-coded D-H prime is used.
27087See the documentation of &%tls_dhparam%& for more information.
27088
27089GnuTLS uses D-H parameters that may take a substantial amount of time
27090to compute. It is unreasonable to re-compute them for every TLS session.
27091Therefore, Exim keeps this data in a file in its spool directory, called
27092&_gnutls-params-NNNN_& for some value of NNNN, corresponding to the number
27093of bits requested.
27094The file is owned by the Exim user and is readable only by
27095its owner. Every Exim process that start up GnuTLS reads the D-H
27096parameters from this file. If the file does not exist, the first Exim process
27097that needs it computes the data and writes it to a temporary file which is
27098renamed once it is complete. It does not matter if several Exim processes do
27099this simultaneously (apart from wasting a few resources). Once a file is in
27100place, new Exim processes immediately start using it.
27101
27102For maximum security, the parameters that are stored in this file should be
27103recalculated periodically, the frequency depending on your paranoia level.
27104If you are avoiding using the fixed D-H primes published in RFCs, then you
27105are concerned about some advanced attacks and will wish to do this; if you do
27106not regenerate then you might as well stick to the standard primes.
27107
27108Arranging this is easy in principle; just delete the file when you want new
27109values to be computed. However, there may be a problem. The calculation of new
27110parameters needs random numbers, and these are obtained from &_/dev/random_&.
27111If the system is not very active, &_/dev/random_& may delay returning data
27112until enough randomness (entropy) is available. This may cause Exim to hang for
27113a substantial amount of time, causing timeouts on incoming connections.
27114
27115The solution is to generate the parameters externally to Exim. They are stored
27116in &_gnutls-params-N_& in PEM format, which means that they can be
27117generated externally using the &(certtool)& command that is part of GnuTLS.
27118
27119To replace the parameters with new ones, instead of deleting the file
27120and letting Exim re-create it, you can generate new parameters using
27121&(certtool)& and, when this has been done, replace Exim's cache file by
27122renaming. The relevant commands are something like this:
27123.code
27124# ls
27125[ look for file; assume gnutls-params-2236 is the most recent ]
27126# rm -f new-params
27127# touch new-params
27128# chown exim:exim new-params
27129# chmod 0600 new-params
27130# certtool --generate-dh-params --bits 2236 >>new-params
27131# openssl dhparam -noout -text -in new-params | head
27132[ check the first line, make sure it's not more than 2236;
27133 if it is, then go back to the start ("rm") and repeat
27134 until the size generated is at most the size requested ]
27135# chmod 0400 new-params
27136# mv new-params gnutls-params-2236
27137.endd
27138If Exim never has to generate the parameters itself, the possibility of
27139stalling is removed.
27140
27141The filename changed in Exim 4.80, to gain the -bits suffix. The value which
27142Exim will choose depends upon the version of GnuTLS in use. For older GnuTLS,
27143the value remains hard-coded in Exim as 1024. As of GnuTLS 2.12.x, there is
27144a way for Exim to ask for the "normal" number of bits for D-H public-key usage,
27145and Exim does so. This attempt to remove Exim from TLS policy decisions
27146failed, as GnuTLS 2.12 returns a value higher than the current hard-coded limit
27147of the NSS library. Thus Exim gains the &%tls_dh_max_bits%& global option,
27148which applies to all D-H usage, client or server. If the value returned by
27149GnuTLS is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then the value will be clamped down
27150to &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. The default value has been set at the current NSS
27151limit, which is still much higher than Exim historically used.
27152
27153The filename and bits used will change as the GnuTLS maintainers change the
27154value for their parameter &`GNUTLS_SEC_PARAM_NORMAL`&, as clamped by
27155&%tls_dh_max_bits%&. At the time of writing (mid 2012), GnuTLS 2.12 recommends
271562432 bits, while NSS is limited to 2236 bits.
27157
27158In fact, the requested value will be *lower* than &%tls_dh_max_bits%&, to
27159increase the chance of the generated prime actually being within acceptable
27160bounds, as GnuTLS has been observed to overshoot. Note the check step in the
27161procedure above. There is no sane procedure available to Exim to double-check
27162the size of the generated prime, so it might still be too large.
27163
27164
27165.section "Requiring specific ciphers in OpenSSL" "SECTreqciphssl"
27166.cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers (OpenSSL)"
27167.oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "OpenSSL"
27168There is a function in the OpenSSL library that can be passed a list of cipher
27169suites before the cipher negotiation takes place. This specifies which ciphers
27170are acceptable. The list is colon separated and may contain names like
27171DES-CBC3-SHA. Exim passes the expanded value of &%tls_require_ciphers%&
27172directly to this function call.
27173Many systems will install the OpenSSL manual-pages, so you may have
27174&'ciphers(1)'& available to you.
27175The following quotation from the OpenSSL
27176documentation specifies what forms of item are allowed in the cipher string:
27177
27178.ilist
27179It can consist of a single cipher suite such as RC4-SHA.
27180.next
27181It can represent a list of cipher suites containing a certain algorithm,
27182or cipher suites of a certain type. For example SHA1 represents all
27183ciphers suites using the digest algorithm SHA1 and SSLv3 represents all
27184SSL v3 algorithms.
27185.next
27186Lists of cipher suites can be combined in a single cipher string using
27187the + character. This is used as a logical and operation. For example
27188SHA1+DES represents all cipher suites containing the SHA1 and the DES
27189algorithms.
27190.endlist
27191
27192Each cipher string can be optionally preceded by one of the characters &`!`&,
27193&`-`& or &`+`&.
27194.ilist
27195If &`!`& is used, the ciphers are permanently deleted from the list. The
27196ciphers deleted can never reappear in the list even if they are explicitly
27197stated.
27198.next
27199If &`-`& is used, the ciphers are deleted from the list, but some or all
27200of the ciphers can be added again by later options.
27201.next
27202If &`+`& is used, the ciphers are moved to the end of the list. This
27203option does not add any new ciphers; it just moves matching existing ones.
27204.endlist
27205
27206If none of these characters is present, the string is interpreted as
27207a list of ciphers to be appended to the current preference list. If the list
27208includes any ciphers already present they will be ignored: that is, they will
27209not be moved to the end of the list.
27210.endlist
27211
27212The OpenSSL &'ciphers(1)'& command may be used to test the results of a given
27213string:
27214.code
27215# note single-quotes to get ! past any shell history expansion
27216$ openssl ciphers 'HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1'
27217.endd
27218
27219This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
27220there's probably no identity verification anyway, but ups the ante on the
27221submission ports where the administrator might have some influence on the
27222choice of clients used:
27223.code
27224# OpenSSL variant; see man ciphers(1)
27225tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
27226 {DEFAULT}\
27227 {HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1}}
27228.endd
27229
27230
27231
27232.section "Requiring specific ciphers or other parameters in GnuTLS" &&&
27233 "SECTreqciphgnu"
27234.cindex "GnuTLS" "specifying parameters for"
27235.cindex "TLS" "specifying ciphers (GnuTLS)"
27236.cindex "TLS" "specifying key exchange methods (GnuTLS)"
27237.cindex "TLS" "specifying MAC algorithms (GnuTLS)"
27238.cindex "TLS" "specifying protocols (GnuTLS)"
27239.cindex "TLS" "specifying priority string (GnuTLS)"
27240.oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "GnuTLS"
27241The GnuTLS library allows the caller to provide a "priority string", documented
27242as part of the &[gnutls_priority_init]& function. This is very similar to the
27243ciphersuite specification in OpenSSL.
27244
27245The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is treated as the GnuTLS priority string
27246and controls both protocols and ciphers.
27247
27248The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is available both as an global option,
27249controlling how Exim behaves as a server, and also as an option of the
27250&(smtp)& transport, controlling how Exim behaves as a client. In both cases
27251the value is string expanded. The resulting string is not an Exim list and
27252the string is given to the GnuTLS library, so that Exim does not need to be
27253aware of future feature enhancements of GnuTLS.
27254
27255Documentation of the strings accepted may be found in the GnuTLS manual, under
27256"Priority strings". This is online as
27257&url(http://www.gnutls.org/manual/html_node/Priority-Strings.html),
27258but beware that this relates to GnuTLS 3, which may be newer than the version
27259installed on your system. If you are using GnuTLS 3,
27260then the example code
27261&url(http://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Listing-the-ciphersuites-in-a-priority-string)
27262on that site can be used to test a given string.
27263
27264For example:
27265.code
27266# Disable older versions of protocols
27267tls_require_ciphers = NORMAL:%LATEST_RECORD_VERSION:-VERS-SSL3.0
27268.endd
27269
27270Prior to Exim 4.80, an older API of GnuTLS was used, and Exim supported three
27271additional options, "&%gnutls_require_kx%&", "&%gnutls_require_mac%&" and
27272"&%gnutls_require_protocols%&". &%tls_require_ciphers%& was an Exim list.
27273
27274This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
27275there's probably no identity verification anyway, and lowers security further
27276by increasing compatibility; but this ups the ante on the submission ports
27277where the administrator might have some influence on the choice of clients
27278used:
27279.code
27280# GnuTLS variant
27281tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
27282 {NORMAL:%COMPAT}\
27283 {SECURE128}}
27284.endd
27285
27286
27287.section "Configuring an Exim server to use TLS" "SECID182"
27288.cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim server"
27289When Exim has been built with TLS support, it advertises the availability of
27290the STARTTLS command to client hosts that match &%tls_advertise_hosts%&,
27291but not to any others. The default value of this option is *, which means
27292that STARTTLS is alway advertised. Set it to blank to never advertise;
27293this is reasonble for systems that want to use TLS only as a client.
27294
27295If STARTTLS is to be used you
27296need to set some other options in order to make TLS available.
27297
27298If a client issues a STARTTLS command and there is some configuration
27299problem in the server, the command is rejected with a 454 error. If the client
27300persists in trying to issue SMTP commands, all except QUIT are rejected
27301with the error
27302.code
27303554 Security failure
27304.endd
27305If a STARTTLS command is issued within an existing TLS session, it is
27306rejected with a 554 error code.
27307
27308To enable TLS operations on a server, the &%tls_advertise_hosts%& option
27309must be set to match some hosts. The default is * which matches all hosts.
27310
27311If this is all you do, TLS encryption will be enabled but not authentication -
27312meaning that the peer has no assurance it is actually you he is talking to.
27313You gain protection from a passive sniffer listening on the wire but not
27314from someone able to intercept the communication.
27315
27316Further protection requires some further configuration at the server end.
27317
27318It is rumoured that all existing clients that support TLS/SSL use RSA
27319encryption. To make this work you need to set, in the server,
27320.code
27321tls_certificate = /some/file/name
27322tls_privatekey = /some/file/name
27323.endd
27324These options are, in fact, expanded strings, so you can make them depend on
27325the identity of the client that is connected if you wish. The first file
27326contains the server's X509 certificate, and the second contains the private key
27327that goes with it. These files need to be
27328PEM format and readable by the Exim user, and must
27329always be given as full path names.
27330The key must not be password-protected.
27331They can be the same file if both the
27332certificate and the key are contained within it. If &%tls_privatekey%& is not
27333set, or if its expansion is forced to fail or results in an empty string, this
27334is assumed to be the case. The certificate file may also contain intermediate
27335certificates that need to be sent to the client to enable it to authenticate
27336the server's certificate.
27337
27338If you do not understand about certificates and keys, please try to find a
27339source of this background information, which is not Exim-specific. (There are a
27340few comments below in section &<<SECTcerandall>>&.)
27341
27342&*Note*&: These options do not apply when Exim is operating as a client &--
27343they apply only in the case of a server. If you need to use a certificate in an
27344Exim client, you must set the options of the same names in an &(smtp)&
27345transport.
27346
27347With just these options, an Exim server will be able to use TLS. It does not
27348require the client to have a certificate (but see below for how to insist on
27349this). There is one other option that may be needed in other situations. If
27350.code
27351tls_dhparam = /some/file/name
27352.endd
27353is set, the SSL library is initialized for the use of Diffie-Hellman ciphers
27354with the parameters contained in the file.
27355Set this to &`none`& to disable use of DH entirely, by making no prime
27356available:
27357.code
27358tls_dhparam = none
27359.endd
27360This may also be set to a string identifying a standard prime to be used for
27361DH; if it is set to &`default`& or, for OpenSSL, is unset, then the prime
27362used is &`ike23`&. There are a few standard primes available, see the
27363documentation for &%tls_dhparam%& for the complete list.
27364
27365See the command
27366.code
27367openssl dhparam
27368.endd
27369for a way of generating file data.
27370
27371The strings supplied for these three options are expanded every time a client
27372host connects. It is therefore possible to use different certificates and keys
27373for different hosts, if you so wish, by making use of the client's IP address
27374in &$sender_host_address$& to control the expansion. If a string expansion is
27375forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the option is not set.
27376
27377.cindex "cipher" "logging"
27378.cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
27379.vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
27380The variable &$tls_in_cipher$& is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated for
27381an incoming TLS connection. It is included in the &'Received:'& header of an
27382incoming message (by default &-- you can, of course, change this), and it is
27383also included in the log line that records a message's arrival, keyed by
27384&"X="&, unless the &%tls_cipher%& log selector is turned off. The &%encrypted%&
27385condition can be used to test for specific cipher suites in ACLs.
27386
27387Once TLS has been established, the ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands
27388can check the name of the cipher suite and vary their actions accordingly. The
27389cipher suite names vary, depending on which TLS library is being used. For
27390example, OpenSSL uses the name DES-CBC3-SHA for the cipher suite which in other
27391contexts is known as TLS_RSA_WITH_3DES_EDE_CBC_SHA. Check the OpenSSL or GnuTLS
27392documentation for more details.
27393
27394For outgoing SMTP deliveries, &$tls_out_cipher$& is used and logged
27395(again depending on the &%tls_cipher%& log selector).
27396
27397
27398.section "Requesting and verifying client certificates" "SECID183"
27399.cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
27400.cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
27401If you want an Exim server to request a certificate when negotiating a TLS
27402session with a client, you must set either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or
27403&%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. You can, of course, set either of them to * to
27404apply to all TLS connections. For any host that matches one of these options,
27405Exim requests a certificate as part of the setup of the TLS session. The
27406contents of the certificate are verified by comparing it with a list of
27407expected certificates.
27408These may be the system default set (depending on library version),
27409an explicit file or,
27410depending on library version, a directory, identified by
27411&%tls_verify_certificates%&.
27412
27413A file can contain multiple certificates, concatenated end to end. If a
27414directory is used
27415(OpenSSL only),
27416each certificate must be in a separate file, with a name (or a symbolic link)
27417of the form <&'hash'&>.0, where <&'hash'&> is a hash value constructed from the
27418certificate. You can compute the relevant hash by running the command
27419.code
27420openssl x509 -hash -noout -in /cert/file
27421.endd
27422where &_/cert/file_& contains a single certificate.
27423
27424The difference between &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is
27425what happens if the client does not supply a certificate, or if the certificate
27426does not match any of the certificates in the collection named by
27427&%tls_verify_certificates%&. If the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&, the
27428attempt to set up a TLS session is aborted, and the incoming connection is
27429dropped. If the client matches &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, the (encrypted) SMTP
27430session continues. ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands can detect the
27431fact that no certificate was verified, and vary their actions accordingly. For
27432example, you can insist on a certificate before accepting a message for
27433relaying, but not when the message is destined for local delivery.
27434
27435.vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
27436When a client supplies a certificate (whether it verifies or not), the value of
27437the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the variable
27438&$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing of the message.
27439
27440.cindex "log" "distinguished name"
27441Because it is often a long text string, it is not included in the log line or
27442&'Received:'& header by default. You can arrange for it to be logged, keyed by
27443&"DN="&, by setting the &%tls_peerdn%& log selector, and you can use
27444&%received_header_text%& to change the &'Received:'& header. When no
27445certificate is supplied, &$tls_in_peerdn$& is empty.
27446
27447
27448.section "Revoked certificates" "SECID184"
27449.cindex "TLS" "revoked certificates"
27450.cindex "revocation list"
27451.cindex "certificate" "revocation list"
27452.cindex "OCSP" "stapling"
27453Certificate issuing authorities issue Certificate Revocation Lists (CRLs) when
27454certificates are revoked. If you have such a list, you can pass it to an Exim
27455server using the global option called &%tls_crl%& and to an Exim client using
27456an identically named option for the &(smtp)& transport. In each case, the value
27457of the option is expanded and must then be the name of a file that contains a
27458CRL in PEM format.
27459The downside is that clients have to periodically re-download a potentially huge
27460file from every certificate authority they know of.
27461
27462The way with most moving parts at query time is Online Certificate
27463Status Protocol (OCSP), where the client verifies the certificate
27464against an OCSP server run by the CA. This lets the CA track all
27465usage of the certs. It requires running software with access to the
27466private key of the CA, to sign the responses to the OCSP queries. OCSP
27467is based on HTTP and can be proxied accordingly.
27468
27469The only widespread OCSP server implementation (known to this writer)
27470comes as part of OpenSSL and aborts on an invalid request, such as
27471connecting to the port and then disconnecting. This requires
27472re-entering the passphrase each time some random client does this.
27473
27474The third way is OCSP Stapling; in this, the server using a certificate
27475issued by the CA periodically requests an OCSP proof of validity from
27476the OCSP server, then serves it up inline as part of the TLS
27477negotiation. This approach adds no extra round trips, does not let the
27478CA track users, scales well with number of certs issued by the CA and is
27479resilient to temporary OCSP server failures, as long as the server
27480starts retrying to fetch an OCSP proof some time before its current
27481proof expires. The downside is that it requires server support.
27482
27483Unless Exim is built with the support disabled,
27484or with GnuTLS earlier than version 3.3.16 / 3.4.8
27485support for OCSP stapling is included.
27486
27487There is a global option called &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
27488The file specified therein is expected to be in DER format, and contain
27489an OCSP proof. Exim will serve it as part of the TLS handshake. This
27490option will be re-expanded for SNI, if the &%tls_certificate%& option
27491contains &`tls_in_sni`&, as per other TLS options.
27492
27493Exim does not at this time implement any support for fetching a new OCSP
27494proof. The burden is on the administrator to handle this, outside of
27495Exim. The file specified should be replaced atomically, so that the
27496contents are always valid. Exim will expand the &%tls_ocsp_file%& option
27497on each connection, so a new file will be handled transparently on the
27498next connection.
27499
27500When built with OpenSSL Exim will check for a valid next update timestamp
27501in the OCSP proof; if not present, or if the proof has expired, it will be
27502ignored.
27503
27504For the client to be able to verify the stapled OCSP the server must
27505also supply, in its stapled information, any intermediate
27506certificates for the chain leading to the OCSP proof from the signer
27507of the server certificate. There may be zero or one such. These
27508intermediate certificates should be added to the server OCSP stapling
27509file named by &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
27510
27511Note that the proof only covers the terminal server certificate,
27512not any of the chain from CA to it.
27513
27514There is no current way to staple a proof for a client certificate.
27515
27516.code
27517 A helper script "ocsp_fetch.pl" for fetching a proof from a CA
27518 OCSP server is supplied. The server URL may be included in the
27519 server certificate, if the CA is helpful.
27520
27521 One failure mode seen was the OCSP Signer cert expiring before the end
27522 of validity of the OCSP proof. The checking done by Exim/OpenSSL
27523 noted this as invalid overall, but the re-fetch script did not.
27524.endd
27525
27526
27527
27528
27529.section "Configuring an Exim client to use TLS" "SECID185"
27530.cindex "cipher" "logging"
27531.cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
27532.cindex "log" "distinguished name"
27533.cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim client"
27534The &%tls_cipher%& and &%tls_peerdn%& log selectors apply to outgoing SMTP
27535deliveries as well as to incoming, the latter one causing logging of the
27536server certificate's DN. The remaining client configuration for TLS is all
27537within the &(smtp)& transport.
27538
27539It is not necessary to set any options to have TLS work in the &(smtp)&
27540transport. If Exim is built with TLS support, and TLS is advertised by a
27541server, the &(smtp)& transport always tries to start a TLS session. However,
27542this can be prevented by setting &%hosts_avoid_tls%& (an option of the
27543transport) to a list of server hosts for which TLS should not be used.
27544
27545If you do not want Exim to attempt to send messages unencrypted when an attempt
27546to set up an encrypted connection fails in any way, you can set
27547&%hosts_require_tls%& to a list of hosts for which encryption is mandatory. For
27548those hosts, delivery is always deferred if an encrypted connection cannot be
27549set up. If there are any other hosts for the address, they are tried in the
27550usual way.
27551
27552When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, Exim may try to deliver
27553the message unencrypted. It always does this if the response to STARTTLS is
27554a 5&'xx'& code. For a temporary error code, or for a failure to negotiate a TLS
27555session after a success response code, what happens is controlled by the
27556&%tls_tempfail_tryclear%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. If it is false,
27557delivery to this host is deferred, and other hosts (if available) are tried. If
27558it is true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'& response to
27559STARTTLS, and if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent TLS
27560negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
27561unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
27562unencrypted.
27563
27564The &%tls_certificate%& and &%tls_privatekey%& options of the &(smtp)&
27565transport provide the client with a certificate, which is passed to the server
27566if it requests it. If the server is Exim, it will request a certificate only if
27567&%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& matches the client.
27568
27569If the &%tls_verify_certificates%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it
27570specifies a collection of expected server certificates.
27571These may be the system default set (depending on library version),
27572a file or,
27573depending on library version, a directory,
27574must name a file or,
27575for OpenSSL only (not GnuTLS), a directory.
27576The client verifies the server's certificate
27577against this collection, taking into account any revoked certificates that are
27578in the list defined by &%tls_crl%&.
27579Failure to verify fails the TLS connection unless either of the
27580&%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options are set.
27581
27582The &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options restrict
27583certificate verification to the listed servers. Verification either must
27584or need not succeed respectively.
27585
27586The &(smtp)& transport has two OCSP-related options:
27587&%hosts_require_ocsp%&; a host-list for which a Certificate Status
27588is requested and required for the connection to proceed. The default
27589value is empty.
27590&%hosts_request_ocsp%&; a host-list for which (additionally)
27591a Certificate Status is requested (but not necessarily verified). The default
27592value is "*" meaning that requests are made unless configured
27593otherwise.
27594
27595The host(s) should also be in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and
27596&%tls_verify_certificates%& configured for the transport,
27597for OCSP to be relevant.
27598
27599If
27600&%tls_require_ciphers%& is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it must contain a
27601list of permitted cipher suites. If either of these checks fails, delivery to
27602the current host is abandoned, and the &(smtp)& transport tries to deliver to
27603alternative hosts, if any.
27604
27605 &*Note*&:
27606These options must be set in the &(smtp)& transport for Exim to use TLS when it
27607is operating as a client. Exim does not assume that a server certificate (set
27608by the global options of the same name) should also be used when operating as a
27609client.
27610
27611.vindex "&$host$&"
27612.vindex "&$host_address$&"
27613All the TLS options in the &(smtp)& transport are expanded before use, with
27614&$host$& and &$host_address$& containing the name and address of the server to
27615which the client is connected. Forced failure of an expansion causes Exim to
27616behave as if the relevant option were unset.
27617
27618.vindex &$tls_out_bits$&
27619.vindex &$tls_out_cipher$&
27620.vindex &$tls_out_peerdn$&
27621.vindex &$tls_out_sni$&
27622Before an SMTP connection is established, the
27623&$tls_out_bits$&, &$tls_out_cipher$&, &$tls_out_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_sni$&
27624variables are emptied. (Until the first connection, they contain the values
27625that were set when the message was received.) If STARTTLS is subsequently
27626successfully obeyed, these variables are set to the relevant values for the
27627outgoing connection.
27628
27629
27630
27631.section "Use of TLS Server Name Indication" "SECTtlssni"
27632.cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
27633.vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
27634.oindex "&%tls_in_sni%&"
27635With TLS1.0 or above, there is an extension mechanism by which extra
27636information can be included at various points in the protocol. One of these
27637extensions, documented in RFC 6066 (and before that RFC 4366) is
27638&"Server Name Indication"&, commonly &"SNI"&. This extension is sent by the
27639client in the initial handshake, so that the server can examine the servername
27640within and possibly choose to use different certificates and keys (and more)
27641for this session.
27642
27643This is analogous to HTTP's &"Host:"& header, and is the main mechanism by
27644which HTTPS-enabled web-sites can be virtual-hosted, many sites to one IP
27645address.
27646
27647With SMTP to MX, there are the same problems here as in choosing the identity
27648against which to validate a certificate: you can't rely on insecure DNS to
27649provide the identity which you then cryptographically verify. So this will
27650be of limited use in that environment.
27651
27652With SMTP to Submission, there is a well-defined hostname which clients are
27653connecting to and can validate certificates against. Thus clients &*can*&
27654choose to include this information in the TLS negotiation. If this becomes
27655wide-spread, then hosters can choose to present different certificates to
27656different clients. Or even negotiate different cipher suites.
27657
27658The &%tls_sni%& option on an SMTP transport is an expanded string; the result,
27659if not empty, will be sent on a TLS session as part of the handshake. There's
27660nothing more to it. Choosing a sensible value not derived insecurely is the
27661only point of caution. The &$tls_out_sni$& variable will be set to this string
27662for the lifetime of the client connection (including during authentication).
27663
27664Except during SMTP client sessions, if &$tls_in_sni$& is set then it is a string
27665received from a client.
27666It can be logged with the &%log_selector%& item &`+tls_sni`&.
27667
27668If the string &`tls_in_sni`& appears in the main section's &%tls_certificate%&
27669option (prior to expansion) then the following options will be re-expanded
27670during TLS session handshake, to permit alternative values to be chosen:
27671
27672.ilist
27673.vindex "&%tls_certificate%&"
27674&%tls_certificate%&
27675.next
27676.vindex "&%tls_crl%&"
27677&%tls_crl%&
27678.next
27679.vindex "&%tls_privatekey%&"
27680&%tls_privatekey%&
27681.next
27682.vindex "&%tls_verify_certificates%&"
27683&%tls_verify_certificates%&
27684.next
27685.vindex "&%tls_ocsp_file%&"
27686&%tls_ocsp_file%&
27687.endlist
27688
27689Great care should be taken to deal with matters of case, various injection
27690attacks in the string (&`../`& or SQL), and ensuring that a valid filename
27691can always be referenced; it is important to remember that &$tls_in_sni$& is
27692arbitrary unverified data provided prior to authentication.
27693Further, the initial certificate is loaded before SNI is arrived, so
27694an expansion for &%tls_certificate%& must have a default which is used
27695when &$tls_in_sni$& is empty.
27696
27697The Exim developers are proceeding cautiously and so far no other TLS options
27698are re-expanded.
27699
27700When Exim is built against OpenSSL, OpenSSL must have been built with support
27701for TLS Extensions. This holds true for OpenSSL 1.0.0+ and 0.9.8+ with
27702enable-tlsext in EXTRACONFIGURE. If you invoke &(openssl s_client -h)& and
27703see &`-servername`& in the output, then OpenSSL has support.
27704
27705When Exim is built against GnuTLS, SNI support is available as of GnuTLS
277060.5.10. (Its presence predates the current API which Exim uses, so if Exim
27707built, then you have SNI support).
27708
27709
27710
27711.section "Multiple messages on the same encrypted TCP/IP connection" &&&
27712 "SECTmulmessam"
27713.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries with TLS"
27714.cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
27715.new
27716Exim sends multiple messages down the same TCP/IP connection by starting up
27717an entirely new delivery process for each message, passing the socket from
27718one process to the next. This implementation does not fit well with the use
27719of TLS, because there is quite a lot of state information associated with a TLS
27720connection, not just a socket identification. Passing all the state information
27721to a new process is not feasible. Consequently, for sending using TLS Exim
27722starts an additional proxy process for handling the encryption, piping the
27723unencrypted data stream from and to the delivery processes.
27724
27725An older mode of operation can be enabled on a per-host basis by the
27726&%hosts_noproxy_tls%& option on the &(smtp)& transport. If the host matches
27727this list the proxy process descibed above is not used; instead Exim
27728.wen
27729shuts down an existing TLS session being run by the delivery process
27730before passing the socket to a new process. The new process may then
27731try to start a new TLS session, and if successful, may try to re-authenticate
27732if AUTH is in use, before sending the next message.
27733
27734The RFC is not clear as to whether or not an SMTP session continues in clear
27735after TLS has been shut down, or whether TLS may be restarted again later, as
27736just described. However, if the server is Exim, this shutdown and
27737reinitialization works. It is not known which (if any) other servers operate
27738successfully if the client closes a TLS session and continues with unencrypted
27739SMTP, but there are certainly some that do not work. For such servers, Exim
27740should not pass the socket to another process, because the failure of the
27741subsequent attempt to use it would cause Exim to record a temporary host error,
27742and delay other deliveries to that host.
27743
27744To test for this case, Exim sends an EHLO command to the server after
27745closing down the TLS session. If this fails in any way, the connection is
27746closed instead of being passed to a new delivery process, but no retry
27747information is recorded.
27748
27749There is also a manual override; you can set &%hosts_nopass_tls%& on the
27750&(smtp)& transport to match those hosts for which Exim should not pass
27751connections to new processes if TLS has been used.
27752
27753
27754
27755
27756.section "Certificates and all that" "SECTcerandall"
27757.cindex "certificate" "references to discussion"
27758In order to understand fully how TLS works, you need to know about
27759certificates, certificate signing, and certificate authorities. This is not the
27760place to give a tutorial, especially as I do not know very much about it
27761myself. Some helpful introduction can be found in the FAQ for the SSL addition
27762to Apache, currently at
27763.display
27764&url(http://www.modssl.org/docs/2.7/ssl_faq.html#ToC24)
27765.endd
27766Other parts of the &'modssl'& documentation are also helpful, and have
27767links to further files.
27768Eric Rescorla's book, &'SSL and TLS'&, published by Addison-Wesley (ISBN
277690-201-61598-3), contains both introductory and more in-depth descriptions.
27770Some sample programs taken from the book are available from
27771.display
27772&url(http://www.rtfm.com/openssl-examples/)
27773.endd
27774
27775
27776.section "Certificate chains" "SECID186"
27777The file named by &%tls_certificate%& may contain more than one
27778certificate. This is useful in the case where the certificate that is being
27779sent is validated by an intermediate certificate which the other end does
27780not have. Multiple certificates must be in the correct order in the file.
27781First the host's certificate itself, then the first intermediate
27782certificate to validate the issuer of the host certificate, then the next
27783intermediate certificate to validate the issuer of the first intermediate
27784certificate, and so on, until finally (optionally) the root certificate.
27785The root certificate must already be trusted by the recipient for
27786validation to succeed, of course, but if it's not preinstalled, sending the
27787root certificate along with the rest makes it available for the user to
27788install if the receiving end is a client MUA that can interact with a user.
27789
27790Note that certificates using MD5 are unlikely to work on today's Internet;
27791even if your libraries allow loading them for use in Exim when acting as a
27792server, increasingly clients will not accept such certificates. The error
27793diagnostics in such a case can be frustratingly vague.
27794
27795
27796
27797.section "Self-signed certificates" "SECID187"
27798.cindex "certificate" "self-signed"
27799You can create a self-signed certificate using the &'req'& command provided
27800with OpenSSL, like this:
27801. ==== Do not shorten the duration here without reading and considering
27802. ==== the text below. Please leave it at 9999 days.
27803.code
27804openssl req -x509 -newkey rsa:1024 -keyout file1 -out file2 \
27805 -days 9999 -nodes
27806.endd
27807&_file1_& and &_file2_& can be the same file; the key and the certificate are
27808delimited and so can be identified independently. The &%-days%& option
27809specifies a period for which the certificate is valid. The &%-nodes%& option is
27810important: if you do not set it, the key is encrypted with a passphrase
27811that you are prompted for, and any use that is made of the key causes more
27812prompting for the passphrase. This is not helpful if you are going to use
27813this certificate and key in an MTA, where prompting is not possible.
27814
27815. ==== I expect to still be working 26 years from now. The less technical
27816. ==== debt I create, in terms of storing up trouble for my later years, the
27817. ==== happier I will be then. We really have reached the point where we
27818. ==== should start, at the very least, provoking thought and making folks
27819. ==== pause before proceeding, instead of leaving all the fixes until two
27820. ==== years before 2^31 seconds after the 1970 Unix epoch.
27821. ==== -pdp, 2012
27822NB: we are now past the point where 9999 days takes us past the 32-bit Unix
27823epoch. If your system uses unsigned time_t (most do) and is 32-bit, then
27824the above command might produce a date in the past. Think carefully about
27825the lifetime of the systems you're deploying, and either reduce the duration
27826of the certificate or reconsider your platform deployment. (At time of
27827writing, reducing the duration is the most likely choice, but the inexorable
27828progression of time takes us steadily towards an era where this will not
27829be a sensible resolution).
27830
27831A self-signed certificate made in this way is sufficient for testing, and
27832may be adequate for all your requirements if you are mainly interested in
27833encrypting transfers, and not in secure identification.
27834
27835However, many clients require that the certificate presented by the server be a
27836user (also called &"leaf"& or &"site"&) certificate, and not a self-signed
27837certificate. In this situation, the self-signed certificate described above
27838must be installed on the client host as a trusted root &'certification
27839authority'& (CA), and the certificate used by Exim must be a user certificate
27840signed with that self-signed certificate.
27841
27842For information on creating self-signed CA certificates and using them to sign
27843user certificates, see the &'General implementation overview'& chapter of the
27844Open-source PKI book, available online at
27845&url(http://ospkibook.sourceforge.net/).
27846.ecindex IIDencsmtp1
27847.ecindex IIDencsmtp2
27848
27849
27850
27851. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27852. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27853
27854.chapter "Access control lists" "CHAPACL"
27855.scindex IIDacl "&ACL;" "description"
27856.cindex "control of incoming mail"
27857.cindex "message" "controlling incoming"
27858.cindex "policy control" "access control lists"
27859Access Control Lists (ACLs) are defined in a separate section of the run time
27860configuration file, headed by &"begin acl"&. Each ACL definition starts with a
27861name, terminated by a colon. Here is a complete ACL section that contains just
27862one very small ACL:
27863.code
27864begin acl
27865small_acl:
27866 accept hosts = one.host.only
27867.endd
27868You can have as many lists as you like in the ACL section, and the order in
27869which they appear does not matter. The lists are self-terminating.
27870
27871The majority of ACLs are used to control Exim's behaviour when it receives
27872certain SMTP commands. This applies both to incoming TCP/IP connections, and
27873when a local process submits a message using SMTP by specifying the &%-bs%&
27874option. The most common use is for controlling which recipients are accepted
27875in incoming messages. In addition, you can define an ACL that is used to check
27876local non-SMTP messages. The default configuration file contains an example of
27877a realistic ACL for checking RCPT commands. This is discussed in chapter
27878&<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
27879
27880
27881.section "Testing ACLs" "SECID188"
27882The &%-bh%& command line option provides a way of testing your ACL
27883configuration locally by running a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
27884
27885
27886.section "Specifying when ACLs are used" "SECID189"
27887.cindex "&ACL;" "options for specifying"
27888In order to cause an ACL to be used, you have to name it in one of the relevant
27889options in the main part of the configuration. These options are:
27890.cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
27891.cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
27892.cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
27893.cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
27894.cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
27895.cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
27896.cindex "DKIM" "ACL for"
27897.cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
27898.cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
27899.cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
27900.cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
27901.cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
27902.cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
27903.cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
27904.cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
27905.cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
27906
27907.table2 140pt
27908.irow &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
27909.irow &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
27910.irow &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL at start of non-SMTP message"
27911.irow &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
27912.irow &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for start of SMTP connection"
27913.irow &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL after DATA is complete"
27914.irow &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for each recipient, after DATA is complete"
27915.irow &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for each DKIM signer"
27916.irow &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
27917.irow &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
27918.irow &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for HELO or EHLO"
27919.irow &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
27920.irow &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL"
27921.irow &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for content-scanning MIME parts"
27922.irow &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
27923.irow &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL at start of DATA command"
27924.irow &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
27925.irow &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
27926.irow &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
27927.irow &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
27928.endtable
27929
27930For example, if you set
27931.code
27932acl_smtp_rcpt = small_acl
27933.endd
27934the little ACL defined above is used whenever Exim receives a RCPT command
27935in an SMTP dialogue. The majority of policy tests on incoming messages can be
27936done when RCPT commands arrive. A rejection of RCPT should cause the
27937sending MTA to give up on the recipient address contained in the RCPT
27938command, whereas rejection at other times may cause the client MTA to keep on
27939trying to deliver the message. It is therefore recommended that you do as much
27940testing as possible at RCPT time.
27941
27942
27943.section "The non-SMTP ACLs" "SECID190"
27944.cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
27945The non-SMTP ACLs apply to all non-interactive incoming messages, that is, they
27946apply to batched SMTP as well as to non-SMTP messages. (Batched SMTP is not
27947really SMTP.) Many of the ACL conditions (for example, host tests, and tests on
27948the state of the SMTP connection such as encryption and authentication) are not
27949relevant and are forbidden in these ACLs. However, the sender and recipients
27950are known, so the &%senders%& and &%sender_domains%& conditions and the
27951&$sender_address$& and &$recipients$& variables can be used. Variables such as
27952&$authenticated_sender$& are also available. You can specify added header lines
27953in any of these ACLs.
27954
27955The &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACL is run right at the start of receiving a
27956non-SMTP message, before any of the message has been read. (This is the
27957analogue of the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL for SMTP input.) In the case of
27958batched SMTP input, it runs after the DATA command has been reached. The
27959result of this ACL is ignored; it cannot be used to reject a message. If you
27960really need to, you could set a value in an ACL variable here and reject based
27961on that in the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL. However, this ACL can be used to set
27962controls, and in particular, it can be used to set
27963.code
27964control = suppress_local_fixups
27965.endd
27966This cannot be used in the other non-SMTP ACLs because by the time they are
27967run, it is too late.
27968
27969The &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with the
27970content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
27971
27972The &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL is run just before the &[local_scan()]& function. Any
27973kind of rejection is treated as permanent, because there is no way of sending a
27974temporary error for these kinds of message.
27975
27976
27977.section "The SMTP connect ACL" "SECID191"
27978.cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
27979.oindex &%smtp_banner%&
27980The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& happens at the start of an SMTP
27981session, after the test specified by &%host_reject_connection%& (which is now
27982an anomaly) and any TCP Wrappers testing (if configured). If the connection is
27983accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%& modifier, the contents of
27984the message override the banner message that is otherwise specified by the
27985&%smtp_banner%& option.
27986
27987
27988.section "The EHLO/HELO ACL" "SECID192"
27989.cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
27990.cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
27991The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_helo%& happens when the client issues an
27992EHLO or HELO command, after the tests specified by &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%&,
27993&%helo_allow_chars%&, &%helo_verify_hosts%&, and &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&.
27994Note that a client may issue more than one EHLO or HELO command in an SMTP
27995session, and indeed is required to issue a new EHLO or HELO after successfully
27996setting up encryption following a STARTTLS command.
27997
27998Note also that a deny neither forces the client to go away nor means that
27999mail will be refused on the connection. Consider checking for
28000&$sender_helo_name$& being defined in a MAIL or RCPT ACL to do that.
28001
28002If the command is accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%&
28003modifier, the message may not contain more than one line (it will be truncated
28004at the first newline and a panic logged if it does). Such a message cannot
28005affect the EHLO options that are listed on the second and subsequent lines of
28006an EHLO response.
28007
28008
28009.section "The DATA ACLs" "SECID193"
28010.cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
28011Two ACLs are associated with the DATA command, because it is two-stage
28012command, with two responses being sent to the client.
28013When the DATA command is received, the ACL defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&
28014is obeyed. This gives you control after all the RCPT commands, but before
28015the message itself is received. It offers the opportunity to give a negative
28016response to the DATA command before the data is transmitted. Header lines
28017added by MAIL or RCPT ACLs are not visible at this time, but any that
28018are defined here are visible when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run.
28019
28020You cannot test the contents of the message, for example, to verify addresses
28021in the headers, at RCPT time or when the DATA command is received. Such
28022tests have to appear in the ACL that is run after the message itself has been
28023received, before the final response to the DATA command is sent. This is
28024the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%&, which is the second ACL that is
28025associated with the DATA command.
28026
28027.cindex CHUNKING "BDAT command"
28028.cindex BDAT "SMTP command"
28029.cindex "RFC 3030" CHUNKING
28030If CHUNKING was advertised and a BDAT command sequence is received,
28031the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL is not run.
28032. XXX why not? It should be possible, for the first BDAT.
28033The &%acl_smtp_data%& is run after the last BDAT command and all of
28034the data specified is received.
28035
28036For both of these ACLs, it is not possible to reject individual recipients. An
28037error response rejects the entire message. Unfortunately, it is known that some
28038MTAs do not treat hard (5&'xx'&) responses to the DATA command (either
28039before or after the data) correctly &-- they keep the message on their queues
28040and try again later, but that is their problem, though it does waste some of
28041your resources.
28042
28043The &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run after
28044the &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%&,
28045the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&
28046and the &%acl_smtp_mime%& ACLs.
28047
28048.section "The SMTP DKIM ACL" "SECTDKIMACL"
28049The &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with DKIM support
28050enabled (which is the default).
28051
28052The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_dkim%& happens after a message has been
28053received, and is executed for each DKIM signature found in a message. If not
28054otherwise specified, the default action is to accept.
28055
28056This ACL is evaluated before &%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&.
28057
28058For details on the operation of DKIM, see chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
28059
28060
28061.section "The SMTP MIME ACL" "SECID194"
28062The &%acl_smtp_mime%& option is available only when Exim is compiled with the
28063content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
28064
28065This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
28066
28067
28068.section "The SMTP PRDR ACL" "SECTPRDRACL"
28069.cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
28070.oindex "&%prdr_enable%&"
28071The &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled
28072with PRDR support enabled (which is the default).
28073It becomes active only when the PRDR feature is negotiated between
28074client and server for a message, and more than one recipient
28075has been accepted.
28076
28077The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& happens after a message
28078has been received, and is executed once for each recipient of the message
28079with &$local_part$& and &$domain$& valid.
28080The test may accept, defer or deny for individual recipients.
28081The &%acl_smtp_data%& will still be called after this ACL and
28082can reject the message overall, even if this ACL has accepted it
28083for some or all recipients.
28084
28085PRDR may be used to support per-user content filtering. Without it
28086one must defer any recipient after the first that has a different
28087content-filter configuration. With PRDR, the RCPT-time check
28088.cindex "PRDR" "variable for"
28089for this can be disabled when the variable &$prdr_requested$&
28090is &"yes"&.
28091Any required difference in behaviour of the main DATA-time
28092ACL should however depend on the PRDR-time ACL having run, as Exim
28093will avoid doing so in some situations (e.g. single-recipient mails).
28094
28095See also the &%prdr_enable%& global option
28096and the &%hosts_try_prdr%& smtp transport option.
28097
28098This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
28099If the ACL is not defined, processing completes as if
28100the feature was not requested by the client.
28101
28102.section "The QUIT ACL" "SECTQUITACL"
28103.cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
28104The ACL for the SMTP QUIT command is anomalous, in that the outcome of the ACL
28105does not affect the response code to QUIT, which is always 221. Thus, the ACL
28106does not in fact control any access.
28107For this reason, it may only accept
28108or warn as its final result.
28109
28110This ACL can be used for tasks such as custom logging at the end of an SMTP
28111session. For example, you can use ACL variables in other ACLs to count
28112messages, recipients, etc., and log the totals at QUIT time using one or
28113more &%logwrite%& modifiers on a &%warn%& verb.
28114
28115&*Warning*&: Only the &$acl_c$&&'x'& variables can be used for this, because
28116the &$acl_m$&&'x'& variables are reset at the end of each incoming message.
28117
28118You do not need to have a final &%accept%&, but if you do, you can use a
28119&%message%& modifier to specify custom text that is sent as part of the 221
28120response to QUIT.
28121
28122This ACL is run only for a &"normal"& QUIT. For certain kinds of disastrous
28123failure (for example, failure to open a log file, or when Exim is bombing out
28124because it has detected an unrecoverable error), all SMTP commands from the
28125client are given temporary error responses until QUIT is received or the
28126connection is closed. In these special cases, the QUIT ACL does not run.
28127
28128
28129.section "The not-QUIT ACL" "SECTNOTQUITACL"
28130.vindex &$acl_smtp_notquit$&
28131The not-QUIT ACL, specified by &%acl_smtp_notquit%&, is run in most cases when
28132an SMTP session ends without sending QUIT. However, when Exim itself is in bad
28133trouble, such as being unable to write to its log files, this ACL is not run,
28134because it might try to do things (such as write to log files) that make the
28135situation even worse.
28136
28137Like the QUIT ACL, this ACL is provided to make it possible to do customized
28138logging or to gather statistics, and its outcome is ignored. The &%delay%&
28139modifier is forbidden in this ACL, and the only permitted verbs are &%accept%&
28140and &%warn%&.
28141
28142.vindex &$smtp_notquit_reason$&
28143When the not-QUIT ACL is running, the variable &$smtp_notquit_reason$& is set
28144to a string that indicates the reason for the termination of the SMTP
28145connection. The possible values are:
28146.table2
28147.irow &`acl-drop`& "Another ACL issued a &%drop%& command"
28148.irow &`bad-commands`& "Too many unknown or non-mail commands"
28149.irow &`command-timeout`& "Timeout while reading SMTP commands"
28150.irow &`connection-lost`& "The SMTP connection has been lost"
28151.irow &`data-timeout`& "Timeout while reading message data"
28152.irow &`local-scan-error`& "The &[local_scan()]& function crashed"
28153.irow &`local-scan-timeout`& "The &[local_scan()]& function timed out"
28154.irow &`signal-exit`& "SIGTERM or SIGINT"
28155.irow &`synchronization-error`& "SMTP synchronization error"
28156.irow &`tls-failed`& "TLS failed to start"
28157.endtable
28158In most cases when an SMTP connection is closed without having received QUIT,
28159Exim sends an SMTP response message before actually closing the connection.
28160With the exception of the &`acl-drop`& case, the default message can be
28161overridden by the &%message%& modifier in the not-QUIT ACL. In the case of a
28162&%drop%& verb in another ACL, it is the message from the other ACL that is
28163used.
28164
28165
28166.section "Finding an ACL to use" "SECID195"
28167.cindex "&ACL;" "finding which to use"
28168The value of an &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& option is expanded before use, so
28169you can use different ACLs in different circumstances. For example,
28170.code
28171acl_smtp_rcpt = ${if ={25}{$interface_port} \
28172 {acl_check_rcpt} {acl_check_rcpt_submit} }
28173.endd
28174In the default configuration file there are some example settings for
28175providing an RFC 4409 message submission service on port 587 and a
28176non-standard &"smtps"& service on port 465. You can use a string
28177expansion like this to choose an ACL for MUAs on these ports which is
28178more appropriate for this purpose than the default ACL on port 25.
28179
28180The expanded string does not have to be the name of an ACL in the
28181configuration file; there are other possibilities. Having expanded the
28182string, Exim searches for an ACL as follows:
28183
28184.ilist
28185If the string begins with a slash, Exim uses it as a file name, and reads its
28186contents as an ACL. The lines are processed in the same way as lines in the
28187Exim configuration file. In particular, continuation lines are supported, blank
28188lines are ignored, as are lines whose first non-whitespace character is &"#"&.
28189If the file does not exist or cannot be read, an error occurs (typically
28190causing a temporary failure of whatever caused the ACL to be run). For example:
28191.code
28192acl_smtp_data = /etc/acls/\
28193 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch\
28194 {/etc/acllist}{$value}{default}}
28195.endd
28196This looks up an ACL file to use on the basis of the host's IP address, falling
28197back to a default if the lookup fails. If an ACL is successfully read from a
28198file, it is retained in memory for the duration of the Exim process, so that it
28199can be re-used without having to re-read the file.
28200.next
28201If the string does not start with a slash, and does not contain any spaces,
28202Exim searches the ACL section of the configuration for an ACL whose name
28203matches the string.
28204.next
28205If no named ACL is found, or if the string contains spaces, Exim parses
28206the string as an inline ACL. This can save typing in cases where you just
28207want to have something like
28208.code
28209acl_smtp_vrfy = accept
28210.endd
28211in order to allow free use of the VRFY command. Such a string may contain
28212newlines; it is processed in the same way as an ACL that is read from a file.
28213.endlist
28214
28215
28216
28217
28218.section "ACL return codes" "SECID196"
28219.cindex "&ACL;" "return codes"
28220Except for the QUIT ACL, which does not affect the SMTP return code (see
28221section &<<SECTQUITACL>>& above), the result of running an ACL is either
28222&"accept"& or &"deny"&, or, if some test cannot be completed (for example, if a
28223database is down), &"defer"&. These results cause 2&'xx'&, 5&'xx'&, and 4&'xx'&
28224return codes, respectively, to be used in the SMTP dialogue. A fourth return,
28225&"error"&, occurs when there is an error such as invalid syntax in the ACL.
28226This also causes a 4&'xx'& return code.
28227
28228For the non-SMTP ACL, &"defer"& and &"error"& are treated in the same way as
28229&"deny"&, because there is no mechanism for passing temporary errors to the
28230submitters of non-SMTP messages.
28231
28232
28233ACLs that are relevant to message reception may also return &"discard"&. This
28234has the effect of &"accept"&, but causes either the entire message or an
28235individual recipient address to be discarded. In other words, it is a
28236blackholing facility. Use it with care.
28237
28238If the ACL for MAIL returns &"discard"&, all recipients are discarded, and no
28239ACL is run for subsequent RCPT commands. The effect of &"discard"& in a
28240RCPT ACL is to discard just the one recipient address. If there are no
28241recipients left when the message's data is received, the DATA ACL is not
28242run. A &"discard"& return from the DATA or the non-SMTP ACL discards all the
28243remaining recipients. The &"discard"& return is not permitted for the
28244&%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL.
28245
28246If the ACL for VRFY returns &"accept"&, a recipient verify (without callout)
28247is done on the address and the result determines the SMTP response.
28248
28249
28250.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "when all recipients discarded"
28251The &[local_scan()]& function is always run, even if there are no remaining
28252recipients; it may create new recipients.
28253
28254
28255
28256.section "Unset ACL options" "SECID197"
28257.cindex "&ACL;" "unset options"
28258The default actions when any of the &%acl_%&&'xxx'& options are unset are not
28259all the same. &*Note*&: These defaults apply only when the relevant ACL is
28260not defined at all. For any defined ACL, the default action when control
28261reaches the end of the ACL statements is &"deny"&.
28262
28263For &%acl_smtp_quit%& and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& there is no default because
28264these two are ACLs that are used only for their side effects. They cannot be
28265used to accept or reject anything.
28266
28267For &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_smtp_auth%&, &%acl_smtp_connect%&,
28268&%acl_smtp_data%&, &%acl_smtp_helo%&, &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&,
28269&%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, and &%acl_smtp_starttls%&, the action
28270when the ACL is not defined is &"accept"&.
28271
28272For the others (&%acl_smtp_etrn%&, &%acl_smtp_expn%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, and
28273&%acl_smtp_vrfy%&), the action when the ACL is not defined is &"deny"&.
28274This means that &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& must be defined in order to receive any
28275messages over an SMTP connection. For an example, see the ACL in the default
28276configuration file.
28277
28278
28279
28280
28281.section "Data for message ACLs" "SECID198"
28282.cindex "&ACL;" "data for message ACL"
28283.vindex &$domain$&
28284.vindex &$local_part$&
28285.vindex &$sender_address$&
28286.vindex &$sender_host_address$&
28287.vindex &$smtp_command$&
28288When a MAIL or RCPT ACL, or either of the DATA ACLs, is running, the variables
28289that contain information about the host and the message's sender (for example,
28290&$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_address$&) are set, and can be used in ACL
28291statements. In the case of RCPT (but not MAIL or DATA), &$domain$& and
28292&$local_part$& are set from the argument address. The entire SMTP command
28293is available in &$smtp_command$&.
28294
28295When an ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL is running, the variables that
28296contain information about the host are set, but &$sender_address$& is not yet
28297set. Section &<<SECTauthparamail>>& contains a discussion of this parameter and
28298how it is used.
28299
28300.vindex "&$message_size$&"
28301The &$message_size$& variable is set to the value of the SIZE parameter on
28302the MAIL command at MAIL, RCPT and pre-data time, or to -1 if
28303that parameter is not given. The value is updated to the true message size by
28304the time the final DATA ACL is run (after the message data has been
28305received).
28306
28307.vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
28308.vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
28309The &$rcpt_count$& variable increases by one for each RCPT command received.
28310The &$recipients_count$& variable increases by one each time a RCPT command is
28311accepted, so while an ACL for RCPT is being processed, it contains the number
28312of previously accepted recipients. At DATA time (for both the DATA ACLs),
28313&$rcpt_count$& contains the total number of RCPT commands, and
28314&$recipients_count$& contains the total number of accepted recipients.
28315
28316
28317
28318
28319
28320.section "Data for non-message ACLs" "SECTdatfornon"
28321.cindex "&ACL;" "data for non-message ACL"
28322.vindex &$smtp_command_argument$&
28323.vindex &$smtp_command$&
28324When an ACL is being run for AUTH, EHLO, ETRN, EXPN, HELO, STARTTLS, or VRFY,
28325the remainder of the SMTP command line is placed in &$smtp_command_argument$&,
28326and the entire SMTP command is available in &$smtp_command$&.
28327These variables can be tested using a &%condition%& condition. For example,
28328here is an ACL for use with AUTH, which insists that either the session is
28329encrypted, or the CRAM-MD5 authentication method is used. In other words, it
28330does not permit authentication methods that use cleartext passwords on
28331unencrypted connections.
28332.code
28333acl_check_auth:
28334 accept encrypted = *
28335 accept condition = ${if eq{${uc:$smtp_command_argument}}\
28336 {CRAM-MD5}}
28337 deny message = TLS encryption or CRAM-MD5 required
28338.endd
28339(Another way of applying this restriction is to arrange for the authenticators
28340that use cleartext passwords not to be advertised when the connection is not
28341encrypted. You can use the generic &%server_advertise_condition%& authenticator
28342option to do this.)
28343
28344
28345
28346.section "Format of an ACL" "SECID199"
28347.cindex "&ACL;" "format of"
28348.cindex "&ACL;" "verbs, definition of"
28349An individual ACL consists of a number of statements. Each statement starts
28350with a verb, optionally followed by a number of conditions and &"modifiers"&.
28351Modifiers can change the way the verb operates, define error and log messages,
28352set variables, insert delays, and vary the processing of accepted messages.
28353
28354If all the conditions are met, the verb is obeyed. The same condition may be
28355used (with different arguments) more than once in the same statement. This
28356provides a means of specifying an &"and"& conjunction between conditions. For
28357example:
28358.code
28359deny dnslists = list1.example
28360 dnslists = list2.example
28361.endd
28362If there are no conditions, the verb is always obeyed. Exim stops evaluating
28363the conditions and modifiers when it reaches a condition that fails. What
28364happens then depends on the verb (and in one case, on a special modifier). Not
28365all the conditions make sense at every testing point. For example, you cannot
28366test a sender address in the ACL that is run for a VRFY command.
28367
28368
28369.section "ACL verbs" "SECID200"
28370The ACL verbs are as follows:
28371
28372.ilist
28373.cindex "&%accept%& ACL verb"
28374&%accept%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"accept"&. If any
28375of the conditions are not met, what happens depends on whether &%endpass%&
28376appears among the conditions (for syntax see below). If the failing condition
28377is before &%endpass%&, control is passed to the next ACL statement; if it is
28378after &%endpass%&, the ACL returns &"deny"&. Consider this statement, used to
28379check a RCPT command:
28380.code
28381accept domains = +local_domains
28382 endpass
28383 verify = recipient
28384.endd
28385If the recipient domain does not match the &%domains%& condition, control
28386passes to the next statement. If it does match, the recipient is verified, and
28387the command is accepted if verification succeeds. However, if verification
28388fails, the ACL yields &"deny"&, because the failing condition is after
28389&%endpass%&.
28390
28391The &%endpass%& feature has turned out to be confusing to many people, so its
28392use is not recommended nowadays. It is always possible to rewrite an ACL so
28393that &%endpass%& is not needed, and it is no longer used in the default
28394configuration.
28395
28396.cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier" "with &%accept%&"
28397If a &%message%& modifier appears on an &%accept%& statement, its action
28398depends on whether or not &%endpass%& is present. In the absence of &%endpass%&
28399(when an &%accept%& verb either accepts or passes control to the next
28400statement), &%message%& can be used to vary the message that is sent when an
28401SMTP command is accepted. For example, in a RCPT ACL you could have:
28402.display
28403&`accept `&<&'some conditions'&>
28404&` message = OK, I will allow you through today`&
28405.endd
28406You can specify an SMTP response code, optionally followed by an &"extended
28407response code"& at the start of the message, but the first digit must be the
28408same as would be sent by default, which is 2 for an &%accept%& verb.
28409
28410If &%endpass%& is present in an &%accept%& statement, &%message%& specifies
28411an error message that is used when access is denied. This behaviour is retained
28412for backward compatibility, but current &"best practice"& is to avoid the use
28413of &%endpass%&.
28414
28415
28416.next
28417.cindex "&%defer%& ACL verb"
28418&%defer%&: If all the conditions are true, the ACL returns &"defer"& which, in
28419an SMTP session, causes a 4&'xx'& response to be given. For a non-SMTP ACL,
28420&%defer%& is the same as &%deny%&, because there is no way of sending a
28421temporary error. For a RCPT command, &%defer%& is much the same as using a
28422&(redirect)& router and &`:defer:`& while verifying, but the &%defer%& verb can
28423be used in any ACL, and even for a recipient it might be a simpler approach.
28424
28425
28426.next
28427.cindex "&%deny%& ACL verb"
28428&%deny%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. If any of
28429the conditions are not met, control is passed to the next ACL statement. For
28430example,
28431.code
28432deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
28433.endd
28434rejects commands from hosts that are on a DNS black list.
28435
28436
28437.next
28438.cindex "&%discard%& ACL verb"
28439&%discard%&: This verb behaves like &%accept%&, except that it returns
28440&"discard"& from the ACL instead of &"accept"&. It is permitted only on ACLs
28441that are concerned with receiving messages. When all the conditions are true,
28442the sending entity receives a &"success"& response. However, &%discard%& causes
28443recipients to be discarded. If it is used in an ACL for RCPT, just the one
28444recipient is discarded; if used for MAIL, DATA or in the non-SMTP ACL, all the
28445message's recipients are discarded. Recipients that are discarded before DATA
28446do not appear in the log line when the &%received_recipients%& log selector is set.
28447
28448If the &%log_message%& modifier is set when &%discard%& operates,
28449its contents are added to the line that is automatically written to the log.
28450The &%message%& modifier operates exactly as it does for &%accept%&.
28451
28452
28453.next
28454.cindex "&%drop%& ACL verb"
28455&%drop%&: This verb behaves like &%deny%&, except that an SMTP connection is
28456forcibly closed after the 5&'xx'& error message has been sent. For example:
28457.code
28458drop message = I don't take more than 20 RCPTs
28459 condition = ${if > {$rcpt_count}{20}}
28460.endd
28461There is no difference between &%deny%& and &%drop%& for the connect-time ACL.
28462The connection is always dropped after sending a 550 response.
28463
28464.next
28465.cindex "&%require%& ACL verb"
28466&%require%&: If all the conditions are met, control is passed to the next ACL
28467statement. If any of the conditions are not met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. For
28468example, when checking a RCPT command,
28469.code
28470require message = Sender did not verify
28471 verify = sender
28472.endd
28473passes control to subsequent statements only if the message's sender can be
28474verified. Otherwise, it rejects the command. Note the positioning of the
28475&%message%& modifier, before the &%verify%& condition. The reason for this is
28476discussed in section &<<SECTcondmodproc>>&.
28477
28478.next
28479.cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
28480&%warn%&: If all the conditions are true, a line specified by the
28481&%log_message%& modifier is written to Exim's main log. Control always passes
28482to the next ACL statement. If any condition is false, the log line is not
28483written. If an identical log line is requested several times in the same
28484message, only one copy is actually written to the log. If you want to force
28485duplicates to be written, use the &%logwrite%& modifier instead.
28486
28487If &%log_message%& is not present, a &%warn%& verb just checks its conditions
28488and obeys any &"immediate"& modifiers (such as &%control%&, &%set%&,
28489&%logwrite%&, &%add_header%&, and &%remove_header%&) that appear before the
28490first failing condition. There is more about adding header lines in section
28491&<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
28492
28493If any condition on a &%warn%& statement cannot be completed (that is, there is
28494some sort of defer), the log line specified by &%log_message%& is not written.
28495This does not include the case of a forced failure from a lookup, which
28496is considered to be a successful completion. After a defer, no further
28497conditions or modifiers in the &%warn%& statement are processed. The incident
28498is logged, and the ACL continues to be processed, from the next statement
28499onwards.
28500
28501
28502.vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
28503When one of the &%warn%& conditions is an address verification that fails, the
28504text of the verification failure message is in &$acl_verify_message$&. If you
28505want this logged, you must set it up explicitly. For example:
28506.code
28507warn !verify = sender
28508 log_message = sender verify failed: $acl_verify_message
28509.endd
28510.endlist
28511
28512At the end of each ACL there is an implicit unconditional &%deny%&.
28513
28514As you can see from the examples above, the conditions and modifiers are
28515written one to a line, with the first one on the same line as the verb, and
28516subsequent ones on following lines. If you have a very long condition, you can
28517continue it onto several physical lines by the usual backslash continuation
28518mechanism. It is conventional to align the conditions vertically.
28519
28520
28521
28522.section "ACL variables" "SECTaclvariables"
28523.cindex "&ACL;" "variables"
28524There are some special variables that can be set during ACL processing. They
28525can be used to pass information between different ACLs, different invocations
28526of the same ACL in the same SMTP connection, and between ACLs and the routers,
28527transports, and filters that are used to deliver a message. The names of these
28528variables must begin with &$acl_c$& or &$acl_m$&, followed either by a digit or
28529an underscore, but the remainder of the name can be any sequence of
28530alphanumeric characters and underscores that you choose. There is no limit on
28531the number of ACL variables. The two sets act as follows:
28532.ilist
28533The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_c$& persist
28534throughout an SMTP connection. They are never reset. Thus, a value that is set
28535while receiving one message is still available when receiving the next message
28536on the same SMTP connection.
28537.next
28538The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_m$& persist only
28539while a message is being received. They are reset afterwards. They are also
28540reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting up a TLS session.
28541.endlist
28542
28543When a message is accepted, the current values of all the ACL variables are
28544preserved with the message and are subsequently made available at delivery
28545time. The ACL variables are set by a modifier called &%set%&. For example:
28546.code
28547accept hosts = whatever
28548 set acl_m4 = some value
28549accept authenticated = *
28550 set acl_c_auth = yes
28551.endd
28552&*Note*&: A leading dollar sign is not used when naming a variable that is to
28553be set. If you want to set a variable without taking any action, you can use a
28554&%warn%& verb without any other modifiers or conditions.
28555
28556.oindex &%strict_acl_vars%&
28557What happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL variable is
28558referenced depends on the setting of the &%strict_acl_vars%& option. If it is
28559false (the default), an empty string is substituted; if it is true, an
28560error is generated.
28561
28562Versions of Exim before 4.64 have a limited set of numbered variables, but
28563their names are compatible, so there is no problem with upgrading.
28564
28565
28566.section "Condition and modifier processing" "SECTcondmodproc"
28567.cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; processing"
28568.cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; processing"
28569An exclamation mark preceding a condition negates its result. For example:
28570.code
28571deny domains = *.dom.example
28572 !verify = recipient
28573.endd
28574causes the ACL to return &"deny"& if the recipient domain ends in
28575&'dom.example'& and the recipient address cannot be verified. Sometimes
28576negation can be used on the right-hand side of a condition. For example, these
28577two statements are equivalent:
28578.code
28579deny hosts = !192.168.3.4
28580deny !hosts = 192.168.3.4
28581.endd
28582However, for many conditions (&%verify%& being a good example), only left-hand
28583side negation of the whole condition is possible.
28584
28585The arguments of conditions and modifiers are expanded. A forced failure
28586of an expansion causes a condition to be ignored, that is, it behaves as if the
28587condition is true. Consider these two statements:
28588.code
28589accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
28590 {/some/file}{$value}fail}
28591accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
28592 {/some/file}{$value}{}}
28593.endd
28594Each attempts to look up a list of acceptable senders. If the lookup succeeds,
28595the returned list is searched, but if the lookup fails the behaviour is
28596different in the two cases. The &%fail%& in the first statement causes the
28597condition to be ignored, leaving no further conditions. The &%accept%& verb
28598therefore succeeds. The second statement, however, generates an empty list when
28599the lookup fails. No sender can match an empty list, so the condition fails,
28600and therefore the &%accept%& also fails.
28601
28602ACL modifiers appear mixed in with conditions in ACL statements. Some of them
28603specify actions that are taken as the conditions for a statement are checked;
28604others specify text for messages that are used when access is denied or a
28605warning is generated. The &%control%& modifier affects the way an incoming
28606message is handled.
28607
28608The positioning of the modifiers in an ACL statement is important, because the
28609processing of a verb ceases as soon as its outcome is known. Only those
28610modifiers that have already been encountered will take effect. For example,
28611consider this use of the &%message%& modifier:
28612.code
28613require message = Can't verify sender
28614 verify = sender
28615 message = Can't verify recipient
28616 verify = recipient
28617 message = This message cannot be used
28618.endd
28619If sender verification fails, Exim knows that the result of the statement is
28620&"deny"&, so it goes no further. The first &%message%& modifier has been seen,
28621so its text is used as the error message. If sender verification succeeds, but
28622recipient verification fails, the second message is used. If recipient
28623verification succeeds, the third message becomes &"current"&, but is never used
28624because there are no more conditions to cause failure.
28625
28626For the &%deny%& verb, on the other hand, it is always the last &%message%&
28627modifier that is used, because all the conditions must be true for rejection to
28628happen. Specifying more than one &%message%& modifier does not make sense, and
28629the message can even be specified after all the conditions. For example:
28630.code
28631deny hosts = ...
28632 !senders = *@my.domain.example
28633 message = Invalid sender from client host
28634.endd
28635The &"deny"& result does not happen until the end of the statement is reached,
28636by which time Exim has set up the message.
28637
28638
28639
28640.section "ACL modifiers" "SECTACLmodi"
28641.cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; list of"
28642The ACL modifiers are as follows:
28643
28644.vlist
28645.vitem &*add_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28646This modifier specifies one or more header lines that are to be added to an
28647incoming message, assuming, of course, that the message is ultimately
28648accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
28649
28650.vitem &*continue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28651.cindex "&%continue%& ACL modifier"
28652.cindex "database" "updating in ACL"
28653This modifier does nothing of itself, and processing of the ACL always
28654continues with the next condition or modifier. The value of &%continue%& is in
28655the side effects of expanding its argument. Typically this could be used to
28656update a database. It is really just a syntactic tidiness, to avoid having to
28657write rather ugly lines like this:
28658.display
28659&`condition = ${if eq{0}{`&<&'some expansion'&>&`}{true}{true}}`&
28660.endd
28661Instead, all you need is
28662.display
28663&`continue = `&<&'some expansion'&>
28664.endd
28665
28666.vitem &*control*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28667.cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
28668This modifier affects the subsequent processing of the SMTP connection or of an
28669incoming message that is accepted. The effect of the first type of control
28670lasts for the duration of the connection, whereas the effect of the second type
28671lasts only until the current message has been received. The message-specific
28672controls always apply to the whole message, not to individual recipients,
28673even if the &%control%& modifier appears in a RCPT ACL.
28674
28675As there are now quite a few controls that can be applied, they are described
28676separately in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. The &%control%& modifier can be used
28677in several different ways. For example:
28678
28679. ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
28680. ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. That comment applies only
28681. ==== when xmlto and fop are used; formatting with sdop gets it right either
28682. ==== way.
28683
28684.ilist
28685It can be at the end of an &%accept%& statement:
28686.code
28687 accept ...some conditions
28688 control = queue_only
28689.endd
28690In this case, the control is applied when this statement yields &"accept"&, in
28691other words, when the conditions are all true.
28692
28693.next
28694It can be in the middle of an &%accept%& statement:
28695.code
28696 accept ...some conditions...
28697 control = queue_only
28698 ...some more conditions...
28699.endd
28700If the first set of conditions are true, the control is applied, even if the
28701statement does not accept because one of the second set of conditions is false.
28702In this case, some subsequent statement must yield &"accept"& for the control
28703to be relevant.
28704
28705.next
28706It can be used with &%warn%& to apply the control, leaving the
28707decision about accepting or denying to a subsequent verb. For
28708example:
28709.code
28710 warn ...some conditions...
28711 control = freeze
28712 accept ...
28713.endd
28714This example of &%warn%& does not contain &%message%&, &%log_message%&, or
28715&%logwrite%&, so it does not add anything to the message and does not write a
28716log entry.
28717
28718.next
28719If you want to apply a control unconditionally, you can use it with a
28720&%require%& verb. For example:
28721.code
28722 require control = no_multiline_responses
28723.endd
28724.endlist
28725
28726.vitem &*delay*&&~=&~<&'time'&>
28727.cindex "&%delay%& ACL modifier"
28728.oindex "&%-bh%&"
28729This modifier may appear in any ACL except notquit. It causes Exim to wait for
28730the time interval before proceeding. However, when testing Exim using the
28731&%-bh%& option, the delay is not actually imposed (an appropriate message is
28732output instead). The time is given in the usual Exim notation, and the delay
28733happens as soon as the modifier is processed. In an SMTP session, pending
28734output is flushed before the delay is imposed.
28735
28736Like &%control%&, &%delay%& can be used with &%accept%& or &%deny%&, for
28737example:
28738.code
28739deny ...some conditions...
28740 delay = 30s
28741.endd
28742The delay happens if all the conditions are true, before the statement returns
28743&"deny"&. Compare this with:
28744.code
28745deny delay = 30s
28746 ...some conditions...
28747.endd
28748which waits for 30s before processing the conditions. The &%delay%& modifier
28749can also be used with &%warn%& and together with &%control%&:
28750.code
28751warn ...some conditions...
28752 delay = 2m
28753 control = freeze
28754accept ...
28755.endd
28756
28757If &%delay%& is encountered when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use,
28758responses to several commands are no longer buffered and sent in one packet (as
28759they would normally be) because all output is flushed before imposing the
28760delay. This optimization is disabled so that a number of small delays do not
28761appear to the client as one large aggregated delay that might provoke an
28762unwanted timeout. You can, however, disable output flushing for &%delay%& by
28763using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_delay_flush%&.
28764
28765
28766.vitem &*endpass*&
28767.cindex "&%endpass%& ACL modifier"
28768This modifier, which has no argument, is recognized only in &%accept%& and
28769&%discard%& statements. It marks the boundary between the conditions whose
28770failure causes control to pass to the next statement, and the conditions whose
28771failure causes the ACL to return &"deny"&. This concept has proved to be
28772confusing to some people, so the use of &%endpass%& is no longer recommended as
28773&"best practice"&. See the description of &%accept%& above for more details.
28774
28775
28776.vitem &*log_message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28777.cindex "&%log_message%& ACL modifier"
28778This modifier sets up a message that is used as part of the log message if the
28779ACL denies access or a &%warn%& statement's conditions are true. For example:
28780.code
28781require log_message = wrong cipher suite $tls_in_cipher
28782 encrypted = DES-CBC3-SHA
28783.endd
28784&%log_message%& is also used when recipients are discarded by &%discard%&. For
28785example:
28786.display
28787&`discard `&<&'some conditions'&>
28788&` log_message = Discarded $local_part@$domain because...`&
28789.endd
28790When access is denied, &%log_message%& adds to any underlying error message
28791that may exist because of a condition failure. For example, while verifying a
28792recipient address, a &':fail:'& redirection might have already set up a
28793message.
28794
28795The message may be defined before the conditions to which it applies, because
28796the string expansion does not happen until Exim decides that access is to be
28797denied. This means that any variables that are set by the condition are
28798available for inclusion in the message. For example, the &$dnslist_$&<&'xxx'&>
28799variables are set after a DNS black list lookup succeeds. If the expansion of
28800&%log_message%& fails, or if the result is an empty string, the modifier is
28801ignored.
28802
28803.vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
28804If you want to use a &%warn%& statement to log the result of an address
28805verification, you can use &$acl_verify_message$& to include the verification
28806error message.
28807
28808If &%log_message%& is used with a &%warn%& statement, &"Warning:"& is added to
28809the start of the logged message. If the same warning log message is requested
28810more than once while receiving a single email message, only one copy is
28811actually logged. If you want to log multiple copies, use &%logwrite%& instead
28812of &%log_message%&. In the absence of &%log_message%& and &%logwrite%&, nothing
28813is logged for a successful &%warn%& statement.
28814
28815If &%log_message%& is not present and there is no underlying error message (for
28816example, from the failure of address verification), but &%message%& is present,
28817the &%message%& text is used for logging rejections. However, if any text for
28818logging contains newlines, only the first line is logged. In the absence of
28819both &%log_message%& and &%message%&, a default built-in message is used for
28820logging rejections.
28821
28822
28823.vitem "&*log_reject_target*&&~=&~<&'log name list'&>"
28824.cindex "&%log_reject_target%& ACL modifier"
28825.cindex "logging in ACL" "specifying which log"
28826This modifier makes it possible to specify which logs are used for messages
28827about ACL rejections. Its argument is a colon-separated list of words that can
28828be &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"&. The default is &`main:reject`&. The list
28829may be empty, in which case a rejection is not logged at all. For example, this
28830ACL fragment writes no logging information when access is denied:
28831.display
28832&`deny `&<&'some conditions'&>
28833&` log_reject_target =`&
28834.endd
28835This modifier can be used in SMTP and non-SMTP ACLs. It applies to both
28836permanent and temporary rejections. Its effect lasts for the rest of the
28837current ACL.
28838
28839
28840.vitem &*logwrite*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28841.cindex "&%logwrite%& ACL modifier"
28842.cindex "logging in ACL" "immediate"
28843This modifier writes a message to a log file as soon as it is encountered when
28844processing an ACL. (Compare &%log_message%&, which, except in the case of
28845&%warn%& and &%discard%&, is used only if the ACL statement denies
28846access.) The &%logwrite%& modifier can be used to log special incidents in
28847ACLs. For example:
28848.display
28849&`accept `&<&'some special conditions'&>
28850&` control = freeze`&
28851&` logwrite = froze message because ...`&
28852.endd
28853By default, the message is written to the main log. However, it may begin
28854with a colon, followed by a comma-separated list of log names, and then
28855another colon, to specify exactly which logs are to be written. For
28856example:
28857.code
28858logwrite = :main,reject: text for main and reject logs
28859logwrite = :panic: text for panic log only
28860.endd
28861
28862
28863.vitem &*message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28864.cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier"
28865This modifier sets up a text string that is expanded and used as a response
28866message when an ACL statement terminates the ACL with an &"accept"&, &"deny"&,
28867or &"defer"& response. (In the case of the &%accept%& and &%discard%& verbs,
28868there is some complication if &%endpass%& is involved; see the description of
28869&%accept%& for details.)
28870
28871The expansion of the message happens at the time Exim decides that the ACL is
28872to end, not at the time it processes &%message%&. If the expansion fails, or
28873generates an empty string, the modifier is ignored. Here is an example where
28874&%message%& must be specified first, because the ACL ends with a rejection if
28875the &%hosts%& condition fails:
28876.code
28877require message = Host not recognized
28878 hosts = 10.0.0.0/8
28879.endd
28880(Once a condition has failed, no further conditions or modifiers are
28881processed.)
28882
28883.cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
28884.oindex "&%smtp_banner%&
28885For ACLs that are triggered by SMTP commands, the message is returned as part
28886of the SMTP response. The use of &%message%& with &%accept%& (or &%discard%&)
28887is meaningful only for SMTP, as no message is returned when a non-SMTP message
28888is accepted. In the case of the connect ACL, accepting with a message modifier
28889overrides the value of &%smtp_banner%&. For the EHLO/HELO ACL, a customized
28890accept message may not contain more than one line (otherwise it will be
28891truncated at the first newline and a panic logged), and it cannot affect the
28892EHLO options.
28893
28894When SMTP is involved, the message may begin with an overriding response code,
28895consisting of three digits optionally followed by an &"extended response code"&
28896of the form &'n.n.n'&, each code being followed by a space. For example:
28897.code
28898deny message = 599 1.2.3 Host not welcome
28899 hosts = 192.168.34.0/24
28900.endd
28901The first digit of the supplied response code must be the same as would be sent
28902by default. A panic occurs if it is not. Exim uses a 550 code when it denies
28903access, but for the predata ACL, note that the default success code is 354, not
289042&'xx'&.
28905
28906Notwithstanding the previous paragraph, for the QUIT ACL, unlike the others,
28907the message modifier cannot override the 221 response code.
28908
28909The text in a &%message%& modifier is literal; any quotes are taken as
28910literals, but because the string is expanded, backslash escapes are processed
28911anyway. If the message contains newlines, this gives rise to a multi-line SMTP
28912response.
28913
28914.vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
28915For ACLs that are called by an &%acl =%& ACL condition, the message is
28916stored in &$acl_verify_message$&, from which the calling ACL may use it.
28917
28918If &%message%& is used on a statement that verifies an address, the message
28919specified overrides any message that is generated by the verification process.
28920However, the original message is available in the variable
28921&$acl_verify_message$&, so you can incorporate it into your message if you
28922wish. In particular, if you want the text from &%:fail:%& items in &(redirect)&
28923routers to be passed back as part of the SMTP response, you should either not
28924use a &%message%& modifier, or make use of &$acl_verify_message$&.
28925
28926For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, a &%message%& modifier that
28927is used with a &%warn%& verb behaves in a similar way to the &%add_header%&
28928modifier, but this usage is now deprecated. However, &%message%& acts only when
28929all the conditions are true, wherever it appears in an ACL command, whereas
28930&%add_header%& acts as soon as it is encountered. If &%message%& is used with
28931&%warn%& in an ACL that is not concerned with receiving a message, it has no
28932effect.
28933
28934
28935.vitem &*queue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28936This modifier specifies the use of a named queue for spool files
28937for the message.
28938It can only be used before the message is received (i.e. not in
28939the DATA ACL).
28940This could be used, for example, for known high-volume burst sources
28941of traffic, or for quarantine of messages.
28942Separate queue-runner processes will be needed for named queues.
28943If the text after expansion is empty, the default queue is used.
28944
28945
28946.vitem &*remove_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28947This modifier specifies one or more header names in a colon-separated list
28948 that are to be removed from an incoming message, assuming, of course, that
28949the message is ultimately accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTremoveheadacl>>&.
28950
28951
28952.vitem &*set*&&~<&'acl_name'&>&~=&~<&'value'&>
28953.cindex "&%set%& ACL modifier"
28954This modifier puts a value into one of the ACL variables (see section
28955&<<SECTaclvariables>>&).
28956
28957
28958.vitem &*udpsend*&&~=&~<&'parameters'&>
28959This modifier sends a UDP packet, for purposes such as statistics
28960collection or behaviour monitoring. The parameters are expanded, and
28961the result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list consisting
28962of a destination server, port number, and the packet contents. The
28963server can be specified as a host name or IPv4 or IPv6 address. The
28964separator can be changed with the usual angle bracket syntax. For
28965example, you might want to collect information on which hosts connect
28966when:
28967.code
28968udpsend = <; 2001:dB8::dead:beef ; 1234 ;\
28969 $tod_zulu $sender_host_address
28970.endd
28971.endlist
28972
28973
28974
28975
28976.section "Use of the control modifier" "SECTcontrols"
28977.cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
28978The &%control%& modifier supports the following settings:
28979
28980.vlist
28981.vitem &*control&~=&~allow_auth_unadvertised*&
28982This modifier allows a client host to use the SMTP AUTH command even when it
28983has not been advertised in response to EHLO. Furthermore, because there are
28984apparently some really broken clients that do this, Exim will accept AUTH after
28985HELO (rather than EHLO) when this control is set. It should be used only if you
28986really need it, and you should limit its use to those broken clients that do
28987not work without it. For example:
28988.code
28989warn hosts = 192.168.34.25
28990 control = allow_auth_unadvertised
28991.endd
28992Normally, when an Exim server receives an AUTH command, it checks the name of
28993the authentication mechanism that is given in the command to ensure that it
28994matches an advertised mechanism. When this control is set, the check that a
28995mechanism has been advertised is bypassed. Any configured mechanism can be used
28996by the client. This control is permitted only in the connection and HELO ACLs.
28997
28998
28999.vitem &*control&~=&~caseful_local_part*& &&&
29000 &*control&~=&~caselower_local_part*&
29001.cindex "&ACL;" "case of local part in"
29002.cindex "case of local parts"
29003.vindex "&$local_part$&"
29004These two controls are permitted only in the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
29005(that is, during RCPT processing). By default, the contents of &$local_part$&
29006are lower cased before ACL processing. If &"caseful_local_part"& is specified,
29007any uppercase letters in the original local part are restored in &$local_part$&
29008for the rest of the ACL, or until a control that sets &"caselower_local_part"&
29009is encountered.
29010
29011These controls affect only the current recipient. Moreover, they apply only to
29012local part handling that takes place directly in the ACL (for example, as a key
29013in lookups). If a test to verify the recipient is obeyed, the case-related
29014handling of the local part during the verification is controlled by the router
29015configuration (see the &%caseful_local_part%& generic router option).
29016
29017This facility could be used, for example, to add a spam score to local parts
29018containing upper case letters. For example, using &$acl_m4$& to accumulate the
29019spam score:
29020.code
29021warn control = caseful_local_part
29022 set acl_m4 = ${eval:\
29023 $acl_m4 + \
29024 ${if match{$local_part}{[A-Z]}{1}{0}}\
29025 }
29026 control = caselower_local_part
29027.endd
29028Notice that we put back the lower cased version afterwards, assuming that
29029is what is wanted for subsequent tests.
29030
29031
29032.vitem &*control&~=&~cutthrough_delivery/*&<&'options'&>
29033.cindex "&ACL;" "cutthrough routing"
29034.cindex "cutthrough" "requesting"
29035This option requests delivery be attempted while the item is being received.
29036
29037The option is usable in the RCPT ACL.
29038If enabled for a message received via smtp and routed to an smtp transport,
29039and only one transport, interface, destination host and port combination
29040is used for all recipients of the message,
29041then the delivery connection is made while the receiving connection is open
29042and data is copied from one to the other.
29043
29044An attempt to set this option for any recipient but the first
29045for a mail will be quietly ignored.
29046If a recipient-verify callout
29047(with use_sender)
29048connection is subsequently
29049requested in the same ACL it is held open and used for
29050any subsequent recipients and the data,
29051otherwise one is made after the initial RCPT ACL completes.
29052
29053Note that routers are used in verify mode,
29054and cannot depend on content of received headers.
29055Note also that headers cannot be
29056modified by any of the post-data ACLs (DATA, MIME and DKIM).
29057Headers may be modified by routers (subject to the above) and transports.
29058.new
29059The Received-By: header is generated as soon as the body reception starts,
29060rather than the traditional time after the full message is received;
29061this will affect the timestamp.
29062.wen
29063
29064All the usual ACLs are called; if one results in the message being
29065rejected, all effort spent in delivery (including the costs on
29066the ultimate destination) will be wasted.
29067Note that in the case of data-time ACLs this includes the entire
29068message body.
29069
29070Cutthrough delivery is not supported via transport-filters or when DKIM signing
29071of outgoing messages is done, because it sends data to the ultimate destination
29072before the entire message has been received from the source.
29073It is not supported for messages received with the SMTP PRDR
29074or CHUNKING
29075options in use.
29076
29077Should the ultimate destination system positively accept or reject the mail,
29078a corresponding indication is given to the source system and nothing is queued.
29079If the item is successfully delivered in cutthrough mode
29080the delivery log lines are tagged with ">>" rather than "=>" and appear
29081before the acceptance "<=" line.
29082
29083If there is a temporary error the item is queued for later delivery in the
29084usual fashion.
29085This behaviour can be adjusted by appending the option &*defer=*&<&'value'&>
29086to the control; the default value is &"spool"& and the alternate value
29087&"pass"& copies an SMTP defer response from the target back to the initiator
29088and does not queue the message.
29089Note that this is independent of any recipient verify conditions in the ACL.
29090
29091Delivery in this mode avoids the generation of a bounce mail to a
29092(possibly faked)
29093sender when the destination system is doing content-scan based rejection.
29094
29095
29096.vitem &*control&~=&~debug/*&<&'options'&>
29097.cindex "&ACL;" "enabling debug logging"
29098.cindex "debugging" "enabling from an ACL"
29099This control turns on debug logging, almost as though Exim had been invoked
29100with &`-d`&, with the output going to a new logfile in the usual logs directory,
29101by default called &'debuglog'&.
29102The filename can be adjusted with the &'tag'& option, which
29103may access any variables already defined. The logging may be adjusted with
29104the &'opts'& option, which takes the same values as the &`-d`& command-line
29105option.
29106Logging started this way may be stopped, and the file removed,
29107with the &'kill'& option.
29108Some examples (which depend on variables that don't exist in all
29109contexts):
29110.code
29111 control = debug
29112 control = debug/tag=.$sender_host_address
29113 control = debug/opts=+expand+acl
29114 control = debug/tag=.$message_exim_id/opts=+expand
29115 control = debug/kill
29116.endd
29117
29118
29119.vitem &*control&~=&~dkim_disable_verify*&
29120.cindex "disable DKIM verify"
29121.cindex "DKIM" "disable verify"
29122This control turns off DKIM verification processing entirely. For details on
29123the operation and configuration of DKIM, see chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
29124
29125
29126.vitem &*control&~=&~dscp/*&<&'value'&>
29127.cindex "&ACL;" "setting DSCP value"
29128.cindex "DSCP" "inbound"
29129This option causes the DSCP value associated with the socket for the inbound
29130connection to be adjusted to a given value, given as one of a number of fixed
29131strings or to numeric value.
29132The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
29133Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
29134&`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
29135
29136The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
29137(for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
29138that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
29139equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
29140Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
29141
29142
29143.vitem &*control&~=&~enforce_sync*& &&&
29144 &*control&~=&~no_enforce_sync*&
29145.cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
29146.cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
29147These controls make it possible to be selective about when SMTP synchronization
29148is enforced. The global option &%smtp_enforce_sync%& specifies the initial
29149state of the switch (it is true by default). See the description of this option
29150in chapter &<<CHAPmainconfig>>& for details of SMTP synchronization checking.
29151
29152The effect of these two controls lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
29153connection. They can appear in any ACL except the one for the non-SMTP
29154messages. The most straightforward place to put them is in the ACL defined by
29155&%acl_smtp_connect%&, which is run at the start of an incoming SMTP connection,
29156before the first synchronization check. The expected use is to turn off the
29157synchronization checks for badly-behaved hosts that you nevertheless need to
29158work with.
29159
29160
29161.vitem &*control&~=&~fakedefer/*&<&'message'&>
29162.cindex "fake defer"
29163.cindex "defer, fake"
29164This control works in exactly the same way as &%fakereject%& (described below)
29165except that it causes an SMTP 450 response after the message data instead of a
29166550 response. You must take care when using &%fakedefer%& because it causes the
29167messages to be duplicated when the sender retries. Therefore, you should not
29168use &%fakedefer%& if the message is to be delivered normally.
29169
29170.vitem &*control&~=&~fakereject/*&<&'message'&>
29171.cindex "fake rejection"
29172.cindex "rejection, fake"
29173This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and DATA ACLs, in other
29174words, only when an SMTP message is being received. If Exim accepts the
29175message, instead the final 250 response, a 550 rejection message is sent.
29176However, Exim proceeds to deliver the message as normal. The control applies
29177only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
29178the same SMTP connection.
29179
29180The text for the 550 response is taken from the &%control%& modifier. If no
29181message is supplied, the following is used:
29182.code
29183550-Your message has been rejected but is being
29184550-kept for evaluation.
29185550-If it was a legitimate message, it may still be
29186550 delivered to the target recipient(s).
29187.endd
29188This facility should be used with extreme caution.
29189
29190.vitem &*control&~=&~freeze*&
29191.cindex "frozen messages" "forcing in ACL"
29192This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
29193other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
29194it is placed on Exim's queue and frozen. The control applies only to the
29195current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the same
29196SMTP connection.
29197
29198This modifier can optionally be followed by &`/no_tell`&. If the global option
29199&%freeze_tell%& is set, it is ignored for the current message (that is, nobody
29200is told about the freezing), provided all the &*control=freeze*& modifiers that
29201are obeyed for the current message have the &`/no_tell`& option.
29202
29203.vitem &*control&~=&~no_delay_flush*&
29204.cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for delay"
29205Exim normally flushes SMTP output before implementing a delay in an ACL, to
29206avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
29207use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%delay%& modifier,
29208disables such output flushing.
29209
29210.vitem &*control&~=&~no_callout_flush*&
29211.cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
29212Exim normally flushes SMTP output before performing a callout in an ACL, to
29213avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
29214use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%verify%& condition
29215that causes the callout, disables such output flushing.
29216
29217.vitem &*control&~=&~no_mbox_unspool*&
29218This control is available when Exim is compiled with the content scanning
29219extension. Content scanning may require a copy of the current message, or parts
29220of it, to be written in &"mbox format"& to a spool file, for passing to a virus
29221or spam scanner. Normally, such copies are deleted when they are no longer
29222needed. If this control is set, the copies are not deleted. The control applies
29223only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
29224the same SMTP connection. It is provided for debugging purposes and is unlikely
29225to be useful in production.
29226
29227.vitem &*control&~=&~no_multiline_responses*&
29228.cindex "multiline responses, suppressing"
29229This control is permitted for any ACL except the one for non-SMTP messages.
29230It seems that there are broken clients in use that cannot handle multiline
29231SMTP responses, despite the fact that RFC 821 defined them over 20 years ago.
29232
29233If this control is set, multiline SMTP responses from ACL rejections are
29234suppressed. One way of doing this would have been to put out these responses as
29235one long line. However, RFC 2821 specifies a maximum of 512 bytes per response
29236(&"use multiline responses for more"& it says &-- ha!), and some of the
29237responses might get close to that. So this facility, which is after all only a
29238sop to broken clients, is implemented by doing two very easy things:
29239
29240.ilist
29241Extra information that is normally output as part of a rejection caused by
29242sender verification failure is omitted. Only the final line (typically &"sender
29243verification failed"&) is sent.
29244.next
29245If a &%message%& modifier supplies a multiline response, only the first
29246line is output.
29247.endlist
29248
29249The setting of the switch can, of course, be made conditional on the
29250calling host. Its effect lasts until the end of the SMTP connection.
29251
29252.vitem &*control&~=&~no_pipelining*&
29253.cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
29254This control turns off the advertising of the PIPELINING extension to SMTP in
29255the current session. To be useful, it must be obeyed before Exim sends its
29256response to an EHLO command. Therefore, it should normally appear in an ACL
29257controlled by &%acl_smtp_connect%& or &%acl_smtp_helo%&. See also
29258&%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
29259
29260.vitem &*control&~=&~queue_only*&
29261.oindex "&%queue_only%&"
29262.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
29263This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
29264other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
29265it is placed on Exim's queue and left there for delivery by a subsequent queue
29266runner. No immediate delivery process is started. In other words, it has the
29267effect as the &%queue_only%& global option. However, the control applies only
29268to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the
29269same SMTP connection.
29270
29271.vitem &*control&~=&~submission/*&<&'options'&>
29272.cindex "message" "submission"
29273.cindex "submission mode"
29274This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and start of data ACLs (the
29275latter is the one defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&). Setting it tells Exim that
29276the current message is a submission from a local MUA. In this case, Exim
29277operates in &"submission mode"&, and applies certain fixups to the message if
29278necessary. For example, it adds a &'Date:'& header line if one is not present.
29279This control is not permitted in the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL, because that is too
29280late (the message has already been created).
29281
29282Chapter &<<CHAPmsgproc>>& describes the processing that Exim applies to
29283messages. Section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>& covers the processing that happens in
29284submission mode; the available options for this control are described there.
29285The control applies only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones
29286that may be received in the same SMTP connection.
29287
29288.vitem &*control&~=&~suppress_local_fixups*&
29289.cindex "submission fixups, suppressing"
29290This control applies to locally submitted (non TCP/IP) messages, and is the
29291complement of &`control = submission`&. It disables the fixups that are
29292normally applied to locally-submitted messages. Specifically:
29293
29294.ilist
29295Any &'Sender:'& header line is left alone (in this respect, it is a
29296dynamic version of &%local_sender_retain%&).
29297.next
29298No &'Message-ID:'&, &'From:'&, or &'Date:'& header lines are added.
29299.next
29300There is no check that &'From:'& corresponds to the actual sender.
29301.endlist ilist
29302
29303This control may be useful when a remotely-originated message is accepted,
29304passed to some scanning program, and then re-submitted for delivery. It can be
29305used only in the &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
29306and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs, because it has to be set before the message's
29307data is read.
29308
29309&*Note:*& This control applies only to the current message, not to any others
29310that are being submitted at the same time using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.
29311
29312.vitem &*control&~=&~utf8_downconvert*&
29313This control enables conversion of UTF-8 in message addresses
29314to a-label form.
29315For details see section &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
29316.endlist vlist
29317
29318
29319.section "Summary of message fixup control" "SECTsummesfix"
29320All four possibilities for message fixups can be specified:
29321
29322.ilist
29323Locally submitted, fixups applied: the default.
29324.next
29325Locally submitted, no fixups applied: use
29326&`control = suppress_local_fixups`&.
29327.next
29328Remotely submitted, no fixups applied: the default.
29329.next
29330Remotely submitted, fixups applied: use &`control = submission`&.
29331.endlist
29332
29333
29334
29335.section "Adding header lines in ACLs" "SECTaddheadacl"
29336.cindex "header lines" "adding in an ACL"
29337.cindex "header lines" "position of added lines"
29338.cindex "&%add_header%& ACL modifier"
29339The &%add_header%& modifier can be used to add one or more extra header lines
29340to an incoming message, as in this example:
29341.code
29342warn dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
29343 dialup.mail-abuse.org
29344 add_header = X-blacklisted-at: $dnslist_domain
29345.endd
29346The &%add_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
29347MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
29348receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
29349&%add_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%add_header%& with
29350any ACL verb, including &%deny%& (though this is potentially useful only in a
29351RCPT ACL).
29352
29353Headers will not be added to the message if the modifier is used in
29354DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for a message delivered by cutthrough routing.
29355
29356Leading and trailing newlines are removed from
29357the data for the &%add_header%& modifier; if it then
29358contains one or more newlines that
29359are not followed by a space or a tab, it is assumed to contain multiple header
29360lines. Each one is checked for valid syntax; &`X-ACL-Warn:`& is added to the
29361front of any line that is not a valid header line.
29362
29363Added header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
29364They are added to the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
29365However, if an identical header line is requested more than once, only one copy
29366is actually added to the message. Further header lines may be accumulated
29367during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are added to the message, again
29368with duplicates suppressed. Thus, it is possible to add two identical header
29369lines to an SMTP message, but only if one is added before DATA and one after.
29370In the case of non-SMTP messages, new headers are accumulated during the
29371non-SMTP ACLs, and are added to the message after all the ACLs have run. If a
29372message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP ACL, all added header lines
29373are included in the entry that is written to the reject log.
29374
29375.cindex "header lines" "added; visibility of"
29376Header lines are not visible in string expansions
29377of message headers
29378until they are added to the
29379message. It follows that header lines defined in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata
29380ACLs are not visible until the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs are run. Similarly,
29381header lines that are added by the DATA or MIME ACLs are not visible in those
29382ACLs. Because of this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of
29383passing data between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do
29384this, you can use ACL variables, as described in section
29385&<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
29386
29387The list of headers yet to be added is given by the &%$headers_added%& variable.
29388
29389The &%add_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
29390processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
29391.display
29392&`accept add_header = ADDED: some text`&
29393&` `&<&'some condition'&>
29394
29395&`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
29396&` add_header = ADDED: some text`&
29397.endd
29398In the first case, the header line is always added, whether or not the
29399condition is true. In the second case, the header line is added only if the
29400condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%add_header%& may occur in the same
29401ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails are
29402honoured.
29403
29404.cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
29405For compatibility with previous versions of Exim, a &%message%& modifier for a
29406&%warn%& verb acts in the same way as &%add_header%&, except that it takes
29407effect only if all the conditions are true, even if it appears before some of
29408them. Furthermore, only the last occurrence of &%message%& is honoured. This
29409usage of &%message%& is now deprecated. If both &%add_header%& and &%message%&
29410are present on a &%warn%& verb, both are processed according to their
29411specifications.
29412
29413By default, new header lines are added to a message at the end of the existing
29414header lines. However, you can specify that any particular header line should
29415be added right at the start (before all the &'Received:'& lines), immediately
29416after the first block of &'Received:'& lines, or immediately before any line
29417that is not a &'Received:'& or &'Resent-something:'& header.
29418
29419This is done by specifying &":at_start:"&, &":after_received:"&, or
29420&":at_start_rfc:"& (or, for completeness, &":at_end:"&) before the text of the
29421header line, respectively. (Header text cannot start with a colon, as there has
29422to be a header name first.) For example:
29423.code
29424warn add_header = \
29425 :after_received:X-My-Header: something or other...
29426.endd
29427If more than one header line is supplied in a single &%add_header%& modifier,
29428each one is treated independently and can therefore be placed differently. If
29429you add more than one line at the start, or after the Received: block, they end
29430up in reverse order.
29431
29432&*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
29433added in an ACL. It does NOT work for header lines that are added in a
29434system filter or in a router or transport.
29435
29436
29437
29438.section "Removing header lines in ACLs" "SECTremoveheadacl"
29439.cindex "header lines" "removing in an ACL"
29440.cindex "header lines" "position of removed lines"
29441.cindex "&%remove_header%& ACL modifier"
29442The &%remove_header%& modifier can be used to remove one or more header lines
29443from an incoming message, as in this example:
29444.code
29445warn message = Remove internal headers
29446 remove_header = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
29447.endd
29448The &%remove_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
29449MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
29450receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
29451&%remove_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%remove_header%&
29452with any ACL verb, including &%deny%&, though this is really not useful for
29453any verb that doesn't result in a delivered message.
29454
29455Headers will not be removed from the message if the modifier is used in
29456DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for a message delivered by cutthrough routing.
29457
29458More than one header can be removed at the same time by using a colon separated
29459list of header names. The header matching is case insensitive. Wildcards are
29460not permitted, nor is list expansion performed, so you cannot use hostlists to
29461create a list of headers, however both connection and message variable expansion
29462are performed (&%$acl_c_*%& and &%$acl_m_*%&), illustrated in this example:
29463.code
29464warn hosts = +internal_hosts
29465 set acl_c_ihdrs = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
29466warn message = Remove internal headers
29467 remove_header = $acl_c_ihdrs
29468.endd
29469Removed header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
29470They are removed from the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
29471There is no harm in attempting to remove the same header twice nor is removing
29472a non-existent header. Further header lines to be removed may be accumulated
29473during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are removed from the message,
29474if present. In the case of non-SMTP messages, headers to be removed are
29475accumulated during the non-SMTP ACLs, and are removed from the message after
29476all the ACLs have run. If a message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP
29477ACL, there really is no effect because there is no logging of what headers
29478would have been removed.
29479
29480.cindex "header lines" "removed; visibility of"
29481Header lines are not visible in string expansions until the DATA phase when it
29482is received. Any header lines removed in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs are
29483not visible in the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs. Similarly, header lines that are
29484removed by the DATA or MIME ACLs are still visible in those ACLs. Because of
29485this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of controlling data
29486passed between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do this,
29487you should instead use ACL variables, as described in section
29488&<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
29489
29490The &%remove_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
29491processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
29492.display
29493&`accept remove_header = X-Internal`&
29494&` `&<&'some condition'&>
29495
29496&`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
29497&` remove_header = X-Internal`&
29498.endd
29499In the first case, the header line is always removed, whether or not the
29500condition is true. In the second case, the header line is removed only if the
29501condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%remove_header%& may occur in the
29502same ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails
29503are honoured.
29504
29505&*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
29506present during ACL processing. It does NOT remove header lines that are added
29507in a system filter or in a router or transport.
29508
29509
29510
29511
29512.section "ACL conditions" "SECTaclconditions"
29513.cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; list of"
29514Some of the conditions listed in this section are available only when Exim is
29515compiled with the content-scanning extension. They are included here briefly
29516for completeness. More detailed descriptions can be found in the discussion on
29517content scanning in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29518
29519Not all conditions are relevant in all circumstances. For example, testing
29520senders and recipients does not make sense in an ACL that is being run as the
29521result of the arrival of an ETRN command, and checks on message headers can be
29522done only in the ACLs specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& and &%acl_not_smtp%&. You
29523can use the same condition (with different parameters) more than once in the
29524same ACL statement. This provides a way of specifying an &"and"& conjunction.
29525The conditions are as follows:
29526
29527
29528.vlist
29529.vitem &*acl&~=&~*&<&'name&~of&~acl&~or&~ACL&~string&~or&~file&~name&~'&>
29530.cindex "&ACL;" "nested"
29531.cindex "&ACL;" "indirect"
29532.cindex "&ACL;" "arguments"
29533.cindex "&%acl%& ACL condition"
29534The possible values of the argument are the same as for the
29535&%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& options. The named or inline ACL is run. If it returns
29536&"accept"& the condition is true; if it returns &"deny"& the condition is
29537false. If it returns &"defer"&, the current ACL returns &"defer"& unless the
29538condition is on a &%warn%& verb. In that case, a &"defer"& return makes the
29539condition false. This means that further processing of the &%warn%& verb
29540ceases, but processing of the ACL continues.
29541
29542If the argument is a named ACL, up to nine space-separated optional values
29543can be appended; they appear within the called ACL in $acl_arg1 to $acl_arg9,
29544and $acl_narg is set to the count of values.
29545Previous values of these variables are restored after the call returns.
29546The name and values are expanded separately.
29547Note that spaces in complex expansions which are used as arguments
29548will act as argument separators.
29549
29550If the nested &%acl%& returns &"drop"& and the outer condition denies access,
29551the connection is dropped. If it returns &"discard"&, the verb must be
29552&%accept%& or &%discard%&, and the action is taken immediately &-- no further
29553conditions are tested.
29554
29555ACLs may be nested up to 20 deep; the limit exists purely to catch runaway
29556loops. This condition allows you to use different ACLs in different
29557circumstances. For example, different ACLs can be used to handle RCPT commands
29558for different local users or different local domains.
29559
29560.vitem &*authenticated&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
29561.cindex "&%authenticated%& ACL condition"
29562.cindex "authentication" "ACL checking"
29563.cindex "&ACL;" "testing for authentication"
29564If the SMTP connection is not authenticated, the condition is false. Otherwise,
29565the name of the authenticator is tested against the list. To test for
29566authentication by any authenticator, you can set
29567.code
29568authenticated = *
29569.endd
29570
29571.vitem &*condition&~=&~*&<&'string'&>
29572.cindex "&%condition%& ACL condition"
29573.cindex "customizing" "ACL condition"
29574.cindex "&ACL;" "customized test"
29575.cindex "&ACL;" "testing, customized"
29576This feature allows you to make up custom conditions. If the result of
29577expanding the string is an empty string, the number zero, or one of the strings
29578&"no"& or &"false"&, the condition is false. If the result is any non-zero
29579number, or one of the strings &"yes"& or &"true"&, the condition is true. For
29580any other value, some error is assumed to have occurred, and the ACL returns
29581&"defer"&. However, if the expansion is forced to fail, the condition is
29582ignored. The effect is to treat it as true, whether it is positive or
29583negative.
29584
29585.vitem &*decode&~=&~*&<&'location'&>
29586.cindex "&%decode%& ACL condition"
29587This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29588content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
29589&%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be decoded into a file.
29590If all goes well, the condition is true. It is false only if there are
29591problems such as a syntax error or a memory shortage. For more details, see
29592chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29593
29594.vitem &*dnslists&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~domain&~names&~and&~other&~data'&>
29595.cindex "&%dnslists%& ACL condition"
29596.cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
29597.cindex "black list (DNS)"
29598.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
29599This condition checks for entries in DNS black lists. These are also known as
29600&"RBL lists"&, after the original Realtime Blackhole List, but note that the
29601use of the lists at &'mail-abuse.org'& now carries a charge. There are too many
29602different variants of this condition to describe briefly here. See sections
29603&<<SECTmorednslists>>&&--&<<SECTmorednslistslast>>& for details.
29604
29605.vitem &*domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
29606.cindex "&%domains%& ACL condition"
29607.cindex "domain" "ACL checking"
29608.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient domain"
29609.vindex "&$domain_data$&"
29610This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the domain
29611of the recipient address is in the domain list. If percent-hack processing is
29612enabled, it is done before this test is done. If the check succeeds with a
29613lookup, the result of the lookup is placed in &$domain_data$& until the next
29614&%domains%& test.
29615
29616&*Note carefully*& (because many people seem to fall foul of this): you cannot
29617use &%domains%& in a DATA ACL.
29618
29619
29620.vitem &*encrypted&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
29621.cindex "&%encrypted%& ACL condition"
29622.cindex "encryption" "checking in an ACL"
29623.cindex "&ACL;" "testing for encryption"
29624If the SMTP connection is not encrypted, the condition is false. Otherwise, the
29625name of the cipher suite in use is tested against the list. To test for
29626encryption without testing for any specific cipher suite(s), set
29627.code
29628encrypted = *
29629.endd
29630
29631
29632.vitem &*hosts&~=&~*&<&'host&~list'&>
29633.cindex "&%hosts%& ACL condition"
29634.cindex "host" "ACL checking"
29635.cindex "&ACL;" "testing the client host"
29636This condition tests that the calling host matches the host list. If you have
29637name lookups or wildcarded host names and IP addresses in the same host list,
29638you should normally put the IP addresses first. For example, you could have:
29639.code
29640accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
29641.endd
29642The lookup in this example uses the host name for its key. This is implied by
29643the lookup type &"dbm"&. (For a host address lookup you would use &"net-dbm"&
29644and it wouldn't matter which way round you had these two items.)
29645
29646The reason for the problem with host names lies in the left-to-right way that
29647Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses without doing any DNS lookups,
29648but when it reaches an item that requires a host name, it fails if it cannot
29649find a host name to compare with the pattern. If the above list is given in the
29650opposite order, the &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be
29651found, even if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
29652
29653If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
29654address even if the name lookup fails, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
29655.code
29656accept hosts = dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
29657accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
29658.endd
29659The default action on failing to find the host name is to assume that the host
29660is not in the list, so the first &%accept%& statement fails. The second
29661statement can then check the IP address.
29662
29663.vindex "&$host_data$&"
29664If a &%hosts%& condition is satisfied by means of a lookup, the result
29665of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
29666allows you, for example, to set up a statement like this:
29667.code
29668deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
29669message = $host_data
29670.endd
29671which gives a custom error message for each denied host.
29672
29673.vitem &*local_parts&~=&~*&<&'local&~part&~list'&>
29674.cindex "&%local_parts%& ACL condition"
29675.cindex "local part" "ACL checking"
29676.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a local part"
29677.vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
29678This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the local
29679part of the recipient address is in the list. If percent-hack processing is
29680enabled, it is done before this test. If the check succeeds with a lookup, the
29681result of the lookup is placed in &$local_part_data$&, which remains set until
29682the next &%local_parts%& test.
29683
29684.vitem &*malware&~=&~*&<&'option'&>
29685.cindex "&%malware%& ACL condition"
29686.cindex "&ACL;" "virus scanning"
29687.cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for viruses"
29688This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29689content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for
29690viruses. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29691
29692.vitem &*mime_regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
29693.cindex "&%mime_regex%& ACL condition"
29694.cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
29695This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29696content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
29697&%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be scanned for a match
29698with any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter
29699&<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29700
29701.vitem &*ratelimit&~=&~*&<&'parameters'&>
29702.cindex "rate limiting"
29703This condition can be used to limit the rate at which a user or host submits
29704messages. Details are given in section &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
29705
29706.vitem &*recipients&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
29707.cindex "&%recipients%& ACL condition"
29708.cindex "recipient" "ACL checking"
29709.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient"
29710This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks the entire
29711recipient address against a list of recipients.
29712
29713.vitem &*regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
29714.cindex "&%regex%& ACL condition"
29715.cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
29716This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29717content-scanning extension, and is available only in the DATA, MIME, and
29718non-SMTP ACLs. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for a match with
29719any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29720
29721.vitem &*sender_domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
29722.cindex "&%sender_domains%& ACL condition"
29723.cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
29724.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender domain"
29725.vindex "&$domain$&"
29726.vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
29727This condition tests the domain of the sender of the message against the given
29728domain list. &*Note*&: The domain of the sender address is in
29729&$sender_address_domain$&. It is &'not'& put in &$domain$& during the testing
29730of this condition. This is an exception to the general rule for testing domain
29731lists. It is done this way so that, if this condition is used in an ACL for a
29732RCPT command, the recipient's domain (which is in &$domain$&) can be used to
29733influence the sender checking.
29734
29735&*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
29736relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
29737
29738.vitem &*senders&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
29739.cindex "&%senders%& ACL condition"
29740.cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
29741.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender"
29742This condition tests the sender of the message against the given list. To test
29743for a bounce message, which has an empty sender, set
29744.code
29745senders = :
29746.endd
29747&*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
29748relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
29749
29750.vitem &*spam&~=&~*&<&'username'&>
29751.cindex "&%spam%& ACL condition"
29752.cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for spam"
29753This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29754content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned by
29755SpamAssassin. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29756
29757.vitem &*verify&~=&~certificate*&
29758.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29759.cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
29760.cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
29761.cindex "&ACL;" "certificate verification"
29762.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a TLS certificate"
29763This condition is true in an SMTP session if the session is encrypted, and a
29764certificate was received from the client, and the certificate was verified. The
29765server requests a certificate only if the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&
29766or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
29767
29768.vitem &*verify&~=&~csa*&
29769.cindex "CSA verification"
29770This condition checks whether the sending host (the client) is authorized to
29771send email. Details of how this works are given in section
29772&<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
29773
29774.vitem &*verify&~=&~header_names_ascii*&
29775.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29776.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header names only ASCII"
29777.cindex "header lines" "verifying header names only ASCII"
29778.cindex "verifying" "header names only ASCII"
29779This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
29780received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
29781&%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks all header names (not the content) to make sure
29782there are no non-ASCII characters, also excluding control characters. The
29783allowable characters are decimal ASCII values 33 through 126.
29784
29785Exim itself will handle headers with non-ASCII characters, but it can cause
29786problems for downstream applications, so this option will allow their
29787detection and rejection in the DATA ACL's.
29788
29789.vitem &*verify&~=&~header_sender/*&<&'options'&>
29790.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29791.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender in the header"
29792.cindex "header lines" "verifying the sender in"
29793.cindex "sender" "verifying in header"
29794.cindex "verifying" "sender in header"
29795This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
29796received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
29797&%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks that there is a verifiable address in at least one
29798of the &'Sender:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, or &'From:'& header lines. Such an address
29799is loosely thought of as a &"sender"& address (hence the name of the test).
29800However, an address that appears in one of these headers need not be an address
29801that accepts bounce messages; only sender addresses in envelopes are required
29802to accept bounces. Therefore, if you use the callout option on this check, you
29803might want to arrange for a non-empty address in the MAIL command.
29804
29805Details of address verification and the options are given later, starting at
29806section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& (callouts are described in section
29807&<<SECTcallver>>&). You can combine this condition with the &%senders%&
29808condition to restrict it to bounce messages only:
29809.code
29810deny senders = :
29811 message = A valid sender header is required for bounces
29812 !verify = header_sender
29813.endd
29814
29815.vitem &*verify&~=&~header_syntax*&
29816.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29817.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header syntax"
29818.cindex "header lines" "verifying syntax"
29819.cindex "verifying" "header syntax"
29820This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
29821received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
29822&%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks the syntax of all header lines that can contain
29823lists of addresses (&'Sender:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&,
29824and &'Bcc:'&), returning true if there are no problems.
29825Unqualified addresses (local parts without domains) are
29826permitted only in locally generated messages and from hosts that match
29827&%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
29828appropriate.
29829
29830Note that this condition is a syntax check only. However, a common spamming
29831ploy used to be to send syntactically invalid headers such as
29832.code
29833To: @
29834.endd
29835and this condition can be used to reject such messages, though they are not as
29836common as they used to be.
29837
29838.vitem &*verify&~=&~helo*&
29839.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29840.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying HELO/EHLO"
29841.cindex "HELO" "verifying"
29842.cindex "EHLO" "verifying"
29843.cindex "verifying" "EHLO"
29844.cindex "verifying" "HELO"
29845This condition is true if a HELO or EHLO command has been received from the
29846client host, and its contents have been verified. If there has been no previous
29847attempt to verify the HELO/EHLO contents, it is carried out when this
29848condition is encountered. See the description of the &%helo_verify_hosts%& and
29849&%helo_try_verify_hosts%& options for details of how to request verification
29850independently of this condition.
29851
29852For SMTP input that does not come over TCP/IP (the &%-bs%& command line
29853option), this condition is always true.
29854
29855
29856.vitem &*verify&~=&~not_blind*&
29857.cindex "verifying" "not blind"
29858.cindex "bcc recipients, verifying none"
29859This condition checks that there are no blind (bcc) recipients in the message.
29860Every envelope recipient must appear either in a &'To:'& header line or in a
29861&'Cc:'& header line for this condition to be true. Local parts are checked
29862case-sensitively; domains are checked case-insensitively. If &'Resent-To:'& or
29863&'Resent-Cc:'& header lines exist, they are also checked. This condition can be
29864used only in a DATA or non-SMTP ACL.
29865
29866There are, of course, many legitimate messages that make use of blind (bcc)
29867recipients. This check should not be used on its own for blocking messages.
29868
29869
29870.vitem &*verify&~=&~recipient/*&<&'options'&>
29871.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29872.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying recipient"
29873.cindex "recipient" "verifying"
29874.cindex "verifying" "recipient"
29875.vindex "&$address_data$&"
29876This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It verifies the current
29877recipient. Details of address verification are given later, starting at section
29878&<<SECTaddressverification>>&. After a recipient has been verified, the value
29879of &$address_data$& is the last value that was set while routing the address.
29880This applies even if the verification fails. When an address that is being
29881verified is redirected to a single address, verification continues with the new
29882address, and in that case, the subsequent value of &$address_data$& is the
29883value for the child address.
29884
29885.vitem &*verify&~=&~reverse_host_lookup/*&<&'options'&>
29886.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29887.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying host reverse lookup"
29888.cindex "host" "verifying reverse lookup"
29889This condition ensures that a verified host name has been looked up from the IP
29890address of the client host. (This may have happened already if the host name
29891was needed for checking a host list, or if the host matched &%host_lookup%&.)
29892Verification ensures that the host name obtained from a reverse DNS lookup, or
29893one of its aliases, does, when it is itself looked up in the DNS, yield the
29894original IP address.
29895
29896There is one possible option, &`defer_ok`&. If this is present and a
29897DNS operation returns a temporary error, the verify condition succeeds.
29898
29899If this condition is used for a locally generated message (that is, when there
29900is no client host involved), it always succeeds.
29901
29902.vitem &*verify&~=&~sender/*&<&'options'&>
29903.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29904.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender"
29905.cindex "sender" "verifying"
29906.cindex "verifying" "sender"
29907This condition is relevant only after a MAIL or RCPT command, or after a
29908message has been received (the &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs). If
29909the message's sender is empty (that is, this is a bounce message), the
29910condition is true. Otherwise, the sender address is verified.
29911
29912.vindex "&$address_data$&"
29913.vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
29914If there is data in the &$address_data$& variable at the end of routing, its
29915value is placed in &$sender_address_data$& at the end of verification. This
29916value can be used in subsequent conditions and modifiers in the same ACL
29917statement. It does not persist after the end of the current statement. If you
29918want to preserve the value for longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
29919
29920Details of verification are given later, starting at section
29921&<<SECTaddressverification>>&. Exim caches the result of sender verification,
29922to avoid doing it more than once per message.
29923
29924.vitem &*verify&~=&~sender=*&<&'address'&>&*/*&<&'options'&>
29925.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29926This is a variation of the previous option, in which a modified address is
29927verified as a sender.
29928
29929Note that '/' is legal in local-parts; if the address may have such
29930(eg. is generated from the received message)
29931they must be protected from the options parsing by doubling:
29932.code
29933verify = sender=${sg{${address:$h_sender:}}{/}{//}}
29934.endd
29935.endlist
29936
29937
29938
29939.section "Using DNS lists" "SECTmorednslists"
29940.cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
29941.cindex "black list (DNS)"
29942.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
29943In its simplest form, the &%dnslists%& condition tests whether the calling host
29944is on at least one of a number of DNS lists by looking up the inverted IP
29945address in one or more DNS domains. (Note that DNS list domains are not mail
29946domains, so the &`+`& syntax for named lists doesn't work - it is used for
29947special options instead.) For example, if the calling host's IP
29948address is 192.168.62.43, and the ACL statement is
29949.code
29950deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org : \
29951 dialups.mail-abuse.org
29952.endd
29953the following records are looked up:
29954.code
2995543.62.168.192.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
2995643.62.168.192.dialups.mail-abuse.org
29957.endd
29958As soon as Exim finds an existing DNS record, processing of the list stops.
29959Thus, multiple entries on the list provide an &"or"& conjunction. If you want
29960to test that a host is on more than one list (an &"and"& conjunction), you can
29961use two separate conditions:
29962.code
29963deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
29964 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
29965.endd
29966If a DNS lookup times out or otherwise fails to give a decisive answer, Exim
29967behaves as if the host does not match the list item, that is, as if the DNS
29968record does not exist. If there are further items in the DNS list, they are
29969processed.
29970
29971This is usually the required action when &%dnslists%& is used with &%deny%&
29972(which is the most common usage), because it prevents a DNS failure from
29973blocking mail. However, you can change this behaviour by putting one of the
29974following special items in the list:
29975.display
29976&`+include_unknown `& behave as if the item is on the list
29977&`+exclude_unknown `& behave as if the item is not on the list (default)
29978&`+defer_unknown `& give a temporary error
29979.endd
29980.cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
29981.cindex "&`+exclude_unknown`&"
29982.cindex "&`+defer_unknown`&"
29983Each of these applies to any subsequent items on the list. For example:
29984.code
29985deny dnslists = +defer_unknown : foo.bar.example
29986.endd
29987Testing the list of domains stops as soon as a match is found. If you want to
29988warn for one list and block for another, you can use two different statements:
29989.code
29990deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
29991warn message = X-Warn: sending host is on dialups list
29992 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
29993.endd
29994.cindex caching "of dns lookup"
29995.cindex DNS TTL
29996DNS list lookups are cached by Exim for the duration of the SMTP session
29997(but limited by the DNS return TTL value),
29998so a lookup based on the IP address is done at most once for any incoming
29999connection (assuming long-enough TTL).
30000Exim does not share information between multiple incoming
30001connections (but your local name server cache should be active).
30002
30003
30004
30005.section "Specifying the IP address for a DNS list lookup" "SECID201"
30006.cindex "DNS list" "keyed by explicit IP address"
30007By default, the IP address that is used in a DNS list lookup is the IP address
30008of the calling host. However, you can specify another IP address by listing it
30009after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example:
30010.code
30011deny dnslists = black.list.tld/192.168.1.2
30012.endd
30013This feature is not very helpful with explicit IP addresses; it is intended for
30014use with IP addresses that are looked up, for example, the IP addresses of the
30015MX hosts or nameservers of an email sender address. For an example, see section
30016&<<SECTmulkeyfor>>& below.
30017
30018
30019
30020
30021.section "DNS lists keyed on domain names" "SECID202"
30022.cindex "DNS list" "keyed by domain name"
30023There are some lists that are keyed on domain names rather than inverted IP
30024addresses (see for example the &'domain based zones'& link at
30025&url(http://www.rfc-ignorant.org/)). No reversing of components is used
30026with these lists. You can change the name that is looked up in a DNS list by
30027listing it after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example,
30028.code
30029deny message = Sender's domain is listed at $dnslist_domain
30030 dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
30031.endd
30032This particular example is useful only in ACLs that are obeyed after the
30033RCPT or DATA commands, when a sender address is available. If (for
30034example) the message's sender is &'user@tld.example'& the name that is looked
30035up by this example is
30036.code
30037tld.example.dsn.rfc-ignorant.org
30038.endd
30039A single &%dnslists%& condition can contain entries for both names and IP
30040addresses. For example:
30041.code
30042deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
30043 dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
30044.endd
30045The first item checks the sending host's IP address; the second checks a domain
30046name. The whole condition is true if either of the DNS lookups succeeds.
30047
30048
30049
30050
30051.section "Multiple explicit keys for a DNS list" "SECTmulkeyfor"
30052.cindex "DNS list" "multiple keys for"
30053The syntax described above for looking up explicitly-defined values (either
30054names or IP addresses) in a DNS blacklist is a simplification. After the domain
30055name for the DNS list, what follows the slash can in fact be a list of items.
30056As with all lists in Exim, the default separator is a colon. However, because
30057this is a sublist within the list of DNS blacklist domains, it is necessary
30058either to double the separators like this:
30059.code
30060dnslists = black.list.tld/name.1::name.2
30061.endd
30062or to change the separator character, like this:
30063.code
30064dnslists = black.list.tld/<;name.1;name.2
30065.endd
30066If an item in the list is an IP address, it is inverted before the DNS
30067blacklist domain is appended. If it is not an IP address, no inversion
30068occurs. Consider this condition:
30069.code
30070dnslists = black.list.tld/<;192.168.1.2;a.domain
30071.endd
30072The DNS lookups that occur are:
30073.code
300742.1.168.192.black.list.tld
30075a.domain.black.list.tld
30076.endd
30077Once a DNS record has been found (that matches a specific IP return
30078address, if specified &-- see section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>&), no further lookups
30079are done. If there is a temporary DNS error, the rest of the sublist of domains
30080or IP addresses is tried. A temporary error for the whole dnslists item occurs
30081only if no other DNS lookup in this sublist succeeds. In other words, a
30082successful lookup for any of the items in the sublist overrides a temporary
30083error for a previous item.
30084
30085The ability to supply a list of items after the slash is in some sense just a
30086syntactic convenience. These two examples have the same effect:
30087.code
30088dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain : black.list.tld/b.domain
30089dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain::b.domain
30090.endd
30091However, when the data for the list is obtained from a lookup, the second form
30092is usually much more convenient. Consider this example:
30093.code
30094deny message = The mail servers for the domain \
30095 $sender_address_domain \
30096 are listed at $dnslist_domain ($dnslist_value); \
30097 see $dnslist_text.
30098 dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|${lookup dnsdb {>|a=<|\
30099 ${lookup dnsdb {>|mxh=\
30100 $sender_address_domain} }} }
30101.endd
30102Note the use of &`>|`& in the dnsdb lookup to specify the separator for
30103multiple DNS records. The inner dnsdb lookup produces a list of MX hosts
30104and the outer dnsdb lookup finds the IP addresses for these hosts. The result
30105of expanding the condition might be something like this:
30106.code
30107dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|192.168.2.3|192.168.5.6|...
30108.endd
30109Thus, this example checks whether or not the IP addresses of the sender
30110domain's mail servers are on the Spamhaus black list.
30111
30112The key that was used for a successful DNS list lookup is put into the variable
30113&$dnslist_matched$& (see section &<<SECID204>>&).
30114
30115
30116
30117
30118.section "Data returned by DNS lists" "SECID203"
30119.cindex "DNS list" "data returned from"
30120DNS lists are constructed using address records in the DNS. The original RBL
30121just used the address 127.0.0.1 on the right hand side of each record, but the
30122RBL+ list and some other lists use a number of values with different meanings.
30123The values used on the RBL+ list are:
30124.display
30125127.1.0.1 RBL
30126127.1.0.2 DUL
30127127.1.0.3 DUL and RBL
30128127.1.0.4 RSS
30129127.1.0.5 RSS and RBL
30130127.1.0.6 RSS and DUL
30131127.1.0.7 RSS and DUL and RBL
30132.endd
30133Section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>& below describes how you can distinguish between
30134different values. Some DNS lists may return more than one address record;
30135see section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>& for details of how they are checked.
30136
30137
30138.section "Variables set from DNS lists" "SECID204"
30139.cindex "expansion" "variables, set from DNS list"
30140.cindex "DNS list" "variables set from"
30141.vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
30142.vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
30143.vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
30144.vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
30145When an entry is found in a DNS list, the variable &$dnslist_domain$& contains
30146the name of the overall domain that matched (for example,
30147&`spamhaus.example`&), &$dnslist_matched$& contains the key within that domain
30148(for example, &`192.168.5.3`&), and &$dnslist_value$& contains the data from
30149the DNS record. When the key is an IP address, it is not reversed in
30150&$dnslist_matched$& (though it is, of course, in the actual lookup). In simple
30151cases, for example:
30152.code
30153deny dnslists = spamhaus.example
30154.endd
30155the key is also available in another variable (in this case,
30156&$sender_host_address$&). In more complicated cases, however, this is not true.
30157For example, using a data lookup (as described in section &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>&)
30158might generate a dnslists lookup like this:
30159.code
30160deny dnslists = spamhaus.example/<|192.168.1.2|192.168.6.7|...
30161.endd
30162If this condition succeeds, the value in &$dnslist_matched$& might be
30163&`192.168.6.7`& (for example).
30164
30165If more than one address record is returned by the DNS lookup, all the IP
30166addresses are included in &$dnslist_value$&, separated by commas and spaces.
30167The variable &$dnslist_text$& contains the contents of any associated TXT
30168record. For lists such as RBL+ the TXT record for a merged entry is often not
30169very meaningful. See section &<<SECTmordetinf>>& for a way of obtaining more
30170information.
30171
30172You can use the DNS list variables in &%message%& or &%log_message%& modifiers
30173&-- although these appear before the condition in the ACL, they are not
30174expanded until after it has failed. For example:
30175.code
30176deny hosts = !+local_networks
30177 message = $sender_host_address is listed \
30178 at $dnslist_domain
30179 dnslists = rbl-plus.mail-abuse.example
30180.endd
30181
30182
30183
30184.section "Additional matching conditions for DNS lists" "SECTaddmatcon"
30185.cindex "DNS list" "matching specific returned data"
30186You can add an equals sign and an IP address after a &%dnslists%& domain name
30187in order to restrict its action to DNS records with a matching right hand side.
30188For example,
30189.code
30190deny dnslists = rblplus.mail-abuse.org=127.0.0.2
30191.endd
30192rejects only those hosts that yield 127.0.0.2. Without this additional data,
30193any address record is considered to be a match. For the moment, we assume
30194that the DNS lookup returns just one record. Section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>&
30195describes how multiple records are handled.
30196
30197More than one IP address may be given for checking, using a comma as a
30198separator. These are alternatives &-- if any one of them matches, the
30199&%dnslists%& condition is true. For example:
30200.code
30201deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
30202.endd
30203If you want to specify a constraining address list and also specify names or IP
30204addresses to be looked up, the constraining address list must be specified
30205first. For example:
30206.code
30207deny dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org\
30208 =127.0.0.2/$sender_address_domain
30209.endd
30210
30211If the character &`&&`& is used instead of &`=`&, the comparison for each
30212listed IP address is done by a bitwise &"and"& instead of by an equality test.
30213In other words, the listed addresses are used as bit masks. The comparison is
30214true if all the bits in the mask are present in the address that is being
30215tested. For example:
30216.code
30217dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.3
30218.endd
30219matches if the address is &'x.x.x.'&3, &'x.x.x.'&7, &'x.x.x.'&11, etc. If you
30220want to test whether one bit or another bit is present (as opposed to both
30221being present), you must use multiple values. For example:
30222.code
30223dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
30224.endd
30225matches if the final component of the address is an odd number or two times
30226an odd number.
30227
30228
30229
30230.section "Negated DNS matching conditions" "SECID205"
30231You can supply a negative list of IP addresses as part of a &%dnslists%&
30232condition. Whereas
30233.code
30234deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
30235.endd
30236means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
30237IP address yielded by the list is either 127.0.0.2 or 127.0.0.3"&,
30238.code
30239deny dnslists = a.b.c!=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
30240.endd
30241means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
30242IP address yielded by the list is not 127.0.0.2 and not 127.0.0.3"&. In other
30243words, the result of the test is inverted if an exclamation mark appears before
30244the &`=`& (or the &`&&`&) sign.
30245
30246&*Note*&: This kind of negation is not the same as negation in a domain,
30247host, or address list (which is why the syntax is different).
30248
30249If you are using just one list, the negation syntax does not gain you much. The
30250previous example is precisely equivalent to
30251.code
30252deny dnslists = a.b.c
30253 !dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
30254.endd
30255However, if you are using multiple lists, the negation syntax is clearer.
30256Consider this example:
30257.code
30258deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
30259 list.dsbl.org : \
30260 dnsbl.njabl.org!=127.0.0.3 : \
30261 relays.ordb.org
30262.endd
30263Using only positive lists, this would have to be:
30264.code
30265deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
30266 list.dsbl.org
30267deny dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org
30268 !dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org=127.0.0.3
30269deny dnslists = relays.ordb.org
30270.endd
30271which is less clear, and harder to maintain.
30272
30273
30274
30275
30276.section "Handling multiple DNS records from a DNS list" "SECThanmuldnsrec"
30277A DNS lookup for a &%dnslists%& condition may return more than one DNS record,
30278thereby providing more than one IP address. When an item in a &%dnslists%& list
30279is followed by &`=`& or &`&&`& and a list of IP addresses, in order to restrict
30280the match to specific results from the DNS lookup, there are two ways in which
30281the checking can be handled. For example, consider the condition:
30282.code
30283dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.1
30284.endd
30285What happens if the DNS lookup for the incoming IP address yields both
30286127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2 by means of two separate DNS records? Is the
30287condition true because at least one given value was found, or is it false
30288because at least one of the found values was not listed? And how does this
30289affect negated conditions? Both possibilities are provided for with the help of
30290additional separators &`==`& and &`=&&`&.
30291
30292.ilist
30293If &`=`& or &`&&`& is used, the condition is true if any one of the looked up
30294IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. For the example above, the
30295condition is true because 127.0.0.1 matches.
30296.next
30297If &`==`& or &`=&&`& is used, the condition is true only if every one of the
30298looked up IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. If the condition is
30299changed to:
30300.code
30301dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1
30302.endd
30303and the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
30304false because 127.0.0.2 is not listed. You would need to have:
30305.code
30306dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1,127.0.0.2
30307.endd
30308for the condition to be true.
30309.endlist
30310
30311When &`!`& is used to negate IP address matching, it inverts the result, giving
30312the precise opposite of the behaviour above. Thus:
30313.ilist
30314If &`!=`& or &`!&&`& is used, the condition is true if none of the looked up IP
30315addresses matches one of the listed addresses. Consider:
30316.code
30317dnslists = a.b.c!&0.0.0.1
30318.endd
30319If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
30320false because 127.0.0.1 matches.
30321.next
30322If &`!==`& or &`!=&&`& is used, the condition is true if there is at least one
30323looked up IP address that does not match. Consider:
30324.code
30325dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1
30326.endd
30327If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
30328true, because 127.0.0.2 does not match. You would need to have:
30329.code
30330dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
30331.endd
30332for the condition to be false.
30333.endlist
30334When the DNS lookup yields only a single IP address, there is no difference
30335between &`=`& and &`==`& and between &`&&`& and &`=&&`&.
30336
30337
30338
30339
30340.section "Detailed information from merged DNS lists" "SECTmordetinf"
30341.cindex "DNS list" "information from merged"
30342When the facility for restricting the matching IP values in a DNS list is used,
30343the text from the TXT record that is set in &$dnslist_text$& may not reflect
30344the true reason for rejection. This happens when lists are merged and the IP
30345address in the A record is used to distinguish them; unfortunately there is
30346only one TXT record. One way round this is not to use merged lists, but that
30347can be inefficient because it requires multiple DNS lookups where one would do
30348in the vast majority of cases when the host of interest is not on any of the
30349lists.
30350
30351A less inefficient way of solving this problem is available. If
30352two domain names, comma-separated, are given, the second is used first to
30353do an initial check, making use of any IP value restrictions that are set.
30354If there is a match, the first domain is used, without any IP value
30355restrictions, to get the TXT record. As a byproduct of this, there is also
30356a check that the IP being tested is indeed on the first list. The first
30357domain is the one that is put in &$dnslist_domain$&. For example:
30358.code
30359reject message = \
30360 rejected because $sender_host_address is blacklisted \
30361 at $dnslist_domain\n$dnslist_text
30362 dnslists = \
30363 sbl.spamhaus.org,sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org=127.0.0.2 : \
30364 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
30365.endd
30366For the first blacklist item, this starts by doing a lookup in
30367&'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'& and testing for a 127.0.0.2 return. If there is a
30368match, it then looks in &'sbl.spamhaus.org'&, without checking the return
30369value, and as long as something is found, it looks for the corresponding TXT
30370record. If there is no match in &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'&, nothing more is done.
30371The second blacklist item is processed similarly.
30372
30373If you are interested in more than one merged list, the same list must be
30374given several times, but because the results of the DNS lookups are cached,
30375the DNS calls themselves are not repeated. For example:
30376.code
30377reject dnslists = \
30378 http.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.2 : \
30379 socks.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.3 : \
30380 misc.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.4 : \
30381 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
30382.endd
30383In this case there is one lookup in &'dnsbl.sorbs.net'&, and if none of the IP
30384values matches (or if no record is found), this is the only lookup that is
30385done. Only if there is a match is one of the more specific lists consulted.
30386
30387
30388
30389.section "DNS lists and IPv6" "SECTmorednslistslast"
30390.cindex "IPv6" "DNS black lists"
30391.cindex "DNS list" "IPv6 usage"
30392If Exim is asked to do a dnslist lookup for an IPv6 address, it inverts it
30393nibble by nibble. For example, if the calling host's IP address is
303943ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031, Exim might look up
30395.code
303961.3.0.c.a.0.0.2.0.0.8.0.a.0.0.0.0.0.a.0.f.6.3.8.
30397 f.f.f.f.e.f.f.3.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
30398.endd
30399(split over two lines here to fit on the page). Unfortunately, some of the DNS
30400lists contain wildcard records, intended for IPv4, that interact badly with
30401IPv6. For example, the DNS entry
30402.code
30403*.3.some.list.example. A 127.0.0.1
30404.endd
30405is probably intended to put the entire 3.0.0.0/8 IPv4 network on the list.
30406Unfortunately, it also matches the entire 3::/4 IPv6 network.
30407
30408You can exclude IPv6 addresses from DNS lookups by making use of a suitable
30409&%condition%& condition, as in this example:
30410.code
30411deny condition = ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}}
30412 dnslists = some.list.example
30413.endd
30414
30415If an explicit key is being used for a DNS lookup and it may be an IPv6
30416address you should specify alternate list separators for both the outer
30417(DNS list name) list and inner (lookup keys) list:
30418.code
30419 dnslists = <; dnsbl.example.com/<|$acl_m_addrslist
30420.endd
30421
30422.section "Rate limiting incoming messages" "SECTratelimiting"
30423.cindex "rate limiting" "client sending"
30424.cindex "limiting client sending rates"
30425.oindex "&%smtp_ratelimit_*%&"
30426The &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can be used to measure and control the rate at
30427which clients can send email. This is more powerful than the
30428&%smtp_ratelimit_*%& options, because those options control the rate of
30429commands in a single SMTP session only, whereas the &%ratelimit%& condition
30430works across all connections (concurrent and sequential) from the same client
30431host. The syntax of the &%ratelimit%& condition is:
30432.display
30433&`ratelimit =`& <&'m'&> &`/`& <&'p'&> &`/`& <&'options'&> &`/`& <&'key'&>
30434.endd
30435If the average client sending rate is less than &'m'& messages per time
30436period &'p'& then the condition is false; otherwise it is true.
30437
30438As a side-effect, the &%ratelimit%& condition sets the expansion variable
30439&$sender_rate$& to the client's computed rate, &$sender_rate_limit$& to the
30440configured value of &'m'&, and &$sender_rate_period$& to the configured value
30441of &'p'&.
30442
30443The parameter &'p'& is the smoothing time constant, in the form of an Exim
30444time interval, for example, &`8h`& for eight hours. A larger time constant
30445means that it takes Exim longer to forget a client's past behaviour. The
30446parameter &'m'& is the maximum number of messages that a client is permitted to
30447send in each time interval. It also specifies the number of messages permitted
30448in a fast burst. By increasing both &'m'& and &'p'& but keeping &'m/p'&
30449constant, you can allow a client to send more messages in a burst without
30450changing its long-term sending rate limit. Conversely, if &'m'& and &'p'& are
30451both small, messages must be sent at an even rate.
30452
30453There is a script in &_util/ratelimit.pl_& which extracts sending rates from
30454log files, to assist with choosing appropriate settings for &'m'& and &'p'&
30455when deploying the &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. The script prints usage
30456instructions when it is run with no arguments.
30457
30458The key is used to look up the data for calculating the client's average
30459sending rate. This data is stored in Exim's spool directory, alongside the
30460retry and other hints databases. The default key is &$sender_host_address$&,
30461which means Exim computes the sending rate of each client host IP address.
30462By changing the key you can change how Exim identifies clients for the purpose
30463of ratelimiting. For example, to limit the sending rate of each authenticated
30464user, independent of the computer they are sending from, set the key to
30465&$authenticated_id$&. You must ensure that the lookup key is meaningful; for
30466example, &$authenticated_id$& is only meaningful if the client has
30467authenticated (which you can check with the &%authenticated%& ACL condition).
30468
30469The lookup key does not have to identify clients: If you want to limit the
30470rate at which a recipient receives messages, you can use the key
30471&`$local_part@$domain`& with the &%per_rcpt%& option (see below) in a RCPT
30472ACL.
30473
30474Each &%ratelimit%& condition can have up to four options. A &%per_*%& option
30475specifies what Exim measures the rate of, for example messages or recipients
30476or bytes. You can adjust the measurement using the &%unique=%& and/or
30477&%count=%& options. You can also control when Exim updates the recorded rate
30478using a &%strict%&, &%leaky%&, or &%readonly%& option. The options are
30479separated by a slash, like the other parameters. They may appear in any order.
30480
30481Internally, Exim appends the smoothing constant &'p'& onto the lookup key with
30482any options that alter the meaning of the stored data. The limit &'m'& is not
30483stored, so you can alter the configured maximum rate and Exim will still
30484remember clients' past behaviour. If you change the &%per_*%& mode or add or
30485remove the &%unique=%& option, the lookup key changes so Exim will forget past
30486behaviour. The lookup key is not affected by changes to the update mode and
30487the &%count=%& option.
30488
30489
30490.section "Ratelimit options for what is being measured" "ratoptmea"
30491.cindex "rate limiting" "per_* options"
30492The &%per_conn%& option limits the client's connection rate. It is not
30493normally used in the &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&, or
30494&%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs.
30495
30496The &%per_mail%& option limits the client's rate of sending messages. This is
30497the default if none of the &%per_*%& options is specified. It can be used in
30498&%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_mime%&,
30499&%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_not_smtp%&.
30500
30501The &%per_byte%& option limits the sender's email bandwidth. It can be used in
30502the same ACLs as the &%per_mail%& option, though it is best to use this option
30503in the &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs; if it is
30504used in an earlier ACL, Exim relies on the SIZE parameter given by the client
30505in its MAIL command, which may be inaccurate or completely missing. You can
30506follow the limit &'m'& in the configuration with K, M, or G to specify limits
30507in kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, respectively.
30508
30509The &%per_rcpt%& option causes Exim to limit the rate at which recipients are
30510accepted. It can be used in the &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
30511&%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& ACLs. In
30512&%acl_smtp_rcpt%& the rate is updated one recipient at a time; in the other
30513ACLs the rate is updated with the total (accepted) recipient count in one go. Note that
30514in either case the rate limiting engine will see a message with many
30515recipients as a large high-speed burst.
30516
30517The &%per_addr%& option is like the &%per_rcpt%& option, except it counts the
30518number of different recipients that the client has sent messages to in the
30519last time period. That is, if the client repeatedly sends messages to the same
30520recipient, its measured rate is not increased. This option can only be used in
30521&%acl_smtp_rcpt%&.
30522
30523The &%per_cmd%& option causes Exim to recompute the rate every time the
30524condition is processed. This can be used to limit the rate of any SMTP
30525command. If it is used in multiple ACLs it can limit the aggregate rate of
30526multiple different commands.
30527
30528The &%count=%& option can be used to alter how much Exim adds to the client's
30529measured rate. For example, the &%per_byte%& option is equivalent to
30530&`per_mail/count=$message_size`&. If there is no &%count=%& option, Exim
30531increases the measured rate by one (except for the &%per_rcpt%& option in ACLs
30532other than &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&). The count does not have to be an integer.
30533
30534The &%unique=%& option is described in section &<<ratoptuniq>>& below.
30535
30536
30537.section "Ratelimit update modes" "ratoptupd"
30538.cindex "rate limiting" "reading data without updating"
30539You can specify one of three options with the &%ratelimit%& condition to
30540control when its database is updated. This section describes the &%readonly%&
30541mode, and the next section describes the &%strict%& and &%leaky%& modes.
30542
30543If the &%ratelimit%& condition is used in &%readonly%& mode, Exim looks up a
30544previously-computed rate to check against the limit.
30545
30546For example, you can test the client's sending rate and deny it access (when
30547it is too fast) in the connect ACL. If the client passes this check then it
30548can go on to send a message, in which case its recorded rate will be updated
30549in the MAIL ACL. Subsequent connections from the same client will check this
30550new rate.
30551.code
30552acl_check_connect:
30553 deny ratelimit = 100 / 5m / readonly
30554 log_message = RATE CHECK: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
30555 (max $sender_rate_limit)
30556# ...
30557acl_check_mail:
30558 warn ratelimit = 100 / 5m / strict
30559 log_message = RATE UPDATE: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
30560 (max $sender_rate_limit)
30561.endd
30562
30563If Exim encounters multiple &%ratelimit%& conditions with the same key when
30564processing a message then it may increase the client's measured rate more than
30565it should. For example, this will happen if you check the &%per_rcpt%& option
30566in both &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&. However it's OK to check the
30567same &%ratelimit%& condition multiple times in the same ACL. You can avoid any
30568multiple update problems by using the &%readonly%& option on later ratelimit
30569checks.
30570
30571The &%per_*%& options described above do not make sense in some ACLs. If you
30572use a &%per_*%& option in an ACL where it is not normally permitted then the
30573update mode defaults to &%readonly%& and you cannot specify the &%strict%& or
30574&%leaky%& modes. In other ACLs the default update mode is &%leaky%& (see the
30575next section) so you must specify the &%readonly%& option explicitly.
30576
30577
30578.section "Ratelimit options for handling fast clients" "ratoptfast"
30579.cindex "rate limiting" "strict and leaky modes"
30580If a client's average rate is greater than the maximum, the rate limiting
30581engine can react in two possible ways, depending on the presence of the
30582&%strict%& or &%leaky%& update modes. This is independent of the other
30583counter-measures (such as rejecting the message) that may be specified by the
30584rest of the ACL.
30585
30586The &%leaky%& (default) option means that the client's recorded rate is not
30587updated if it is above the limit. The effect of this is that Exim measures the
30588client's average rate of successfully sent email, which cannot be greater than
30589the maximum allowed. If the client is over the limit it may suffer some
30590counter-measures (as specified in the ACL), but it will still be able to send
30591email at the configured maximum rate, whatever the rate of its attempts. This
30592is generally the better choice if you have clients that retry automatically.
30593For example, it does not prevent a sender with an over-aggressive retry rate
30594from getting any email through.
30595
30596The &%strict%& option means that the client's recorded rate is always
30597updated. The effect of this is that Exim measures the client's average rate
30598of attempts to send email, which can be much higher than the maximum it is
30599actually allowed. If the client is over the limit it may be subjected to
30600counter-measures by the ACL. It must slow down and allow sufficient time to
30601pass that its computed rate falls below the maximum before it can send email
30602again. The time (the number of smoothing periods) it must wait and not
30603attempt to send mail can be calculated with this formula:
30604.code
30605 ln(peakrate/maxrate)
30606.endd
30607
30608
30609.section "Limiting the rate of different events" "ratoptuniq"
30610.cindex "rate limiting" "counting unique events"
30611The &%ratelimit%& &%unique=%& option controls a mechanism for counting the
30612rate of different events. For example, the &%per_addr%& option uses this
30613mechanism to count the number of different recipients that the client has
30614sent messages to in the last time period; it is equivalent to
30615&`per_rcpt/unique=$local_part@$domain`&. You could use this feature to
30616measure the rate that a client uses different sender addresses with the
30617options &`per_mail/unique=$sender_address`&.
30618
30619For each &%ratelimit%& key Exim stores the set of &%unique=%& values that it
30620has seen for that key. The whole set is thrown away when it is older than the
30621rate smoothing period &'p'&, so each different event is counted at most once
30622per period. In the &%leaky%& update mode, an event that causes the client to
30623go over the limit is not added to the set, in the same way that the client's
30624recorded rate is not updated in the same situation.
30625
30626When you combine the &%unique=%& and &%readonly%& options, the specific
30627&%unique=%& value is ignored, and Exim just retrieves the client's stored
30628rate.
30629
30630The &%unique=%& mechanism needs more space in the ratelimit database than the
30631other &%ratelimit%& options in order to store the event set. The number of
30632unique values is potentially as large as the rate limit, so the extra space
30633required increases with larger limits.
30634
30635The uniqueification is not perfect: there is a small probability that Exim
30636will think a new event has happened before. If the sender's rate is less than
30637the limit, Exim should be more than 99.9% correct. However in &%strict%& mode
30638the measured rate can go above the limit, in which case Exim may under-count
30639events by a significant margin. Fortunately, if the rate is high enough (2.7
30640times the limit) that the false positive rate goes above 9%, then Exim will
30641throw away the over-full event set before the measured rate falls below the
30642limit. Therefore the only harm should be that exceptionally high sending rates
30643are logged incorrectly; any countermeasures you configure will be as effective
30644as intended.
30645
30646
30647.section "Using rate limiting" "useratlim"
30648Exim's other ACL facilities are used to define what counter-measures are taken
30649when the rate limit is exceeded. This might be anything from logging a warning
30650(for example, while measuring existing sending rates in order to define
30651policy), through time delays to slow down fast senders, up to rejecting the
30652message. For example:
30653.code
30654# Log all senders' rates
30655warn ratelimit = 0 / 1h / strict
30656 log_message = Sender rate $sender_rate / $sender_rate_period
30657
30658# Slow down fast senders; note the need to truncate $sender_rate
30659# at the decimal point.
30660warn ratelimit = 100 / 1h / per_rcpt / strict
30661 delay = ${eval: ${sg{$sender_rate}{[.].*}{}} - \
30662 $sender_rate_limit }s
30663
30664# Keep authenticated users under control
30665deny authenticated = *
30666 ratelimit = 100 / 1d / strict / $authenticated_id
30667
30668# System-wide rate limit
30669defer message = Sorry, too busy. Try again later.
30670 ratelimit = 10 / 1s / $primary_hostname
30671
30672# Restrict incoming rate from each host, with a default
30673# set using a macro and special cases looked up in a table.
30674defer message = Sender rate exceeds $sender_rate_limit \
30675 messages per $sender_rate_period
30676 ratelimit = ${lookup {$sender_host_address} \
30677 cdb {DB/ratelimits.cdb} \
30678 {$value} {RATELIMIT} }
30679.endd
30680&*Warning*&: If you have a busy server with a lot of &%ratelimit%& tests,
30681especially with the &%per_rcpt%& option, you may suffer from a performance
30682bottleneck caused by locking on the ratelimit hints database. Apart from
30683making your ACLs less complicated, you can reduce the problem by using a
30684RAM disk for Exim's hints directory (usually &_/var/spool/exim/db/_&). However
30685this means that Exim will lose its hints data after a reboot (including retry
30686hints, the callout cache, and ratelimit data).
30687
30688
30689
30690.section "Address verification" "SECTaddressverification"
30691.cindex "verifying address" "options for"
30692.cindex "policy control" "address verification"
30693Several of the &%verify%& conditions described in section
30694&<<SECTaclconditions>>& cause addresses to be verified. Section
30695&<<SECTsenaddver>>& discusses the reporting of sender verification failures.
30696The verification conditions can be followed by options that modify the
30697verification process. The options are separated from the keyword and from each
30698other by slashes, and some of them contain parameters. For example:
30699.code
30700verify = sender/callout
30701verify = recipient/defer_ok/callout=10s,defer_ok
30702.endd
30703The first stage of address verification, which always happens, is to run the
30704address through the routers, in &"verify mode"&. Routers can detect the
30705difference between verification and routing for delivery, and their actions can
30706be varied by a number of generic options such as &%verify%& and &%verify_only%&
30707(see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). If routing fails, verification fails.
30708The available options are as follows:
30709
30710.ilist
30711If the &%callout%& option is specified, successful routing to one or more
30712remote hosts is followed by a &"callout"& to those hosts as an additional
30713check. Callouts and their sub-options are discussed in the next section.
30714.next
30715If there is a defer error while doing verification routing, the ACL
30716normally returns &"defer"&. However, if you include &%defer_ok%& in the
30717options, the condition is forced to be true instead. Note that this is a main
30718verification option as well as a suboption for callouts.
30719.next
30720The &%no_details%& option is covered in section &<<SECTsenaddver>>&, which
30721discusses the reporting of sender address verification failures.
30722.next
30723The &%success_on_redirect%& option causes verification always to succeed
30724immediately after a successful redirection. By default, if a redirection
30725generates just one address, that address is also verified. See further
30726discussion in section &<<SECTredirwhilveri>>&.
30727.endlist
30728
30729.cindex "verifying address" "differentiating failures"
30730.vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
30731.vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
30732.vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
30733After an address verification failure, &$acl_verify_message$& contains the
30734error message that is associated with the failure. It can be preserved by
30735coding like this:
30736.code
30737warn !verify = sender
30738 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
30739.endd
30740If you are writing your own custom rejection message or log message when
30741denying access, you can use this variable to include information about the
30742verification failure.
30743
30744In addition, &$sender_verify_failure$& or &$recipient_verify_failure$& (as
30745appropriate) contains one of the following words:
30746
30747.ilist
30748&%qualify%&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
30749was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
30750.next
30751&%route%&: Routing failed.
30752.next
30753&%mail%&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection
30754occurred at or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial
30755connection, HELO, or MAIL).
30756.next
30757&%recipient%&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
30758.next
30759&%postmaster%&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
30760.endlist
30761
30762The main use of these variables is expected to be to distinguish between
30763rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT in callouts.
30764
30765
30766
30767
30768.section "Callout verification" "SECTcallver"
30769.cindex "verifying address" "by callout"
30770.cindex "callout" "verification"
30771.cindex "SMTP" "callout verification"
30772For non-local addresses, routing verifies the domain, but is unable to do any
30773checking of the local part. There are situations where some means of verifying
30774the local part is desirable. One way this can be done is to make an SMTP
30775&'callback'& to a delivery host for the sender address or a &'callforward'& to
30776a subsequent host for a recipient address, to see if the host accepts the
30777address. We use the term &'callout'& to cover both cases. Note that for a
30778sender address, the callback is not to the client host that is trying to
30779deliver the message, but to one of the hosts that accepts incoming mail for the
30780sender's domain.
30781
30782Exim does not do callouts by default. If you want them to happen, you must
30783request them by setting appropriate options on the &%verify%& condition, as
30784described below. This facility should be used with care, because it can add a
30785lot of resource usage to the cost of verifying an address. However, Exim does
30786cache the results of callouts, which helps to reduce the cost. Details of
30787caching are in section &<<SECTcallvercache>>&.
30788
30789Recipient callouts are usually used only between hosts that are controlled by
30790the same administration. For example, a corporate gateway host could use
30791callouts to check for valid recipients on an internal mailserver. A successful
30792callout does not guarantee that a real delivery to the address would succeed;
30793on the other hand, a failing callout does guarantee that a delivery would fail.
30794
30795If the &%callout%& option is present on a condition that verifies an address, a
30796second stage of verification occurs if the address is successfully routed to
30797one or more remote hosts. The usual case is routing by a &(dnslookup)& or a
30798&(manualroute)& router, where the router specifies the hosts. However, if a
30799router that does not set up hosts routes to an &(smtp)& transport with a
30800&%hosts%& setting, the transport's hosts are used. If an &(smtp)& transport has
30801&%hosts_override%& set, its hosts are always used, whether or not the router
30802supplies a host list.
30803Callouts are only supported on &(smtp)& transports.
30804
30805The port that is used is taken from the transport, if it is specified and is a
30806remote transport. (For routers that do verification only, no transport need be
30807specified.) Otherwise, the default SMTP port is used. If a remote transport
30808specifies an outgoing interface, this is used; otherwise the interface is not
30809specified. Likewise, the text that is used for the HELO command is taken from
30810the transport's &%helo_data%& option; if there is no transport, the value of
30811&$smtp_active_hostname$& is used.
30812
30813For a sender callout check, Exim makes SMTP connections to the remote hosts, to
30814test whether a bounce message could be delivered to the sender address. The
30815following SMTP commands are sent:
30816.display
30817&`HELO `&<&'local host name'&>
30818&`MAIL FROM:<>`&
30819&`RCPT TO:`&<&'the address to be tested'&>
30820&`QUIT`&
30821.endd
30822LHLO is used instead of HELO if the transport's &%protocol%& option is
30823set to &"lmtp"&.
30824
30825The callout may use EHLO, AUTH and/or STARTTLS given appropriate option
30826settings.
30827
30828A recipient callout check is similar. By default, it also uses an empty address
30829for the sender. This default is chosen because most hosts do not make use of
30830the sender address when verifying a recipient. Using the same address means
30831that a single cache entry can be used for each recipient. Some sites, however,
30832do make use of the sender address when verifying. These are catered for by the
30833&%use_sender%& and &%use_postmaster%& options, described in the next section.
30834
30835If the response to the RCPT command is a 2&'xx'& code, the verification
30836succeeds. If it is 5&'xx'&, the verification fails. For any other condition,
30837Exim tries the next host, if any. If there is a problem with all the remote
30838hosts, the ACL yields &"defer"&, unless the &%defer_ok%& parameter of the
30839&%callout%& option is given, in which case the condition is forced to succeed.
30840
30841.cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
30842A callout may take a little time. For this reason, Exim normally flushes SMTP
30843output before performing a callout in an ACL, to avoid unexpected timeouts in
30844clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use. The flushing can be
30845disabled by using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_callout_flush%&.
30846
30847
30848
30849
30850.section "Additional parameters for callouts" "CALLaddparcall"
30851.cindex "callout" "additional parameters for"
30852The &%callout%& option can be followed by an equals sign and a number of
30853optional parameters, separated by commas. For example:
30854.code
30855verify = recipient/callout=10s,defer_ok
30856.endd
30857The old syntax, which had &%callout_defer_ok%& and &%check_postmaster%& as
30858separate verify options, is retained for backwards compatibility, but is now
30859deprecated. The additional parameters for &%callout%& are as follows:
30860
30861
30862.vlist
30863.vitem <&'a&~time&~interval'&>
30864.cindex "callout" "timeout, specifying"
30865This specifies the timeout that applies for the callout attempt to each host.
30866For example:
30867.code
30868verify = sender/callout=5s
30869.endd
30870The default is 30 seconds. The timeout is used for each response from the
30871remote host. It is also used for the initial connection, unless overridden by
30872the &%connect%& parameter.
30873
30874
30875.vitem &*connect&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
30876.cindex "callout" "connection timeout, specifying"
30877This parameter makes it possible to set a different (usually smaller) timeout
30878for making the SMTP connection. For example:
30879.code
30880verify = sender/callout=5s,connect=1s
30881.endd
30882If not specified, this timeout defaults to the general timeout value.
30883
30884.vitem &*defer_ok*&
30885.cindex "callout" "defer, action on"
30886When this parameter is present, failure to contact any host, or any other kind
30887of temporary error, is treated as success by the ACL. However, the cache is not
30888updated in this circumstance.
30889
30890.vitem &*fullpostmaster*&
30891.cindex "callout" "full postmaster check"
30892This operates like the &%postmaster%& option (see below), but if the check for
30893&'postmaster@domain'& fails, it tries just &'postmaster'&, without a domain, in
30894accordance with the specification in RFC 2821. The RFC states that the
30895unqualified address &'postmaster'& should be accepted.
30896
30897
30898.vitem &*mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
30899.cindex "callout" "sender when verifying header"
30900When verifying addresses in header lines using the &%header_sender%&
30901verification option, Exim behaves by default as if the addresses are envelope
30902sender addresses from a message. Callout verification therefore tests to see
30903whether a bounce message could be delivered, by using an empty address in the
30904MAIL command. However, it is arguable that these addresses might never be used
30905as envelope senders, and could therefore justifiably reject bounce messages
30906(empty senders). The &%mailfrom%& callout parameter allows you to specify what
30907address to use in the MAIL command. For example:
30908.code
30909require verify = header_sender/callout=mailfrom=abcd@x.y.z
30910.endd
30911This parameter is available only for the &%header_sender%& verification option.
30912
30913
30914.vitem &*maxwait&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
30915.cindex "callout" "overall timeout, specifying"
30916This parameter sets an overall timeout for performing a callout verification.
30917For example:
30918.code
30919verify = sender/callout=5s,maxwait=30s
30920.endd
30921This timeout defaults to four times the callout timeout for individual SMTP
30922commands. The overall timeout applies when there is more than one host that can
30923be tried. The timeout is checked before trying the next host. This prevents
30924very long delays if there are a large number of hosts and all are timing out
30925(for example, when network connections are timing out).
30926
30927
30928.vitem &*no_cache*&
30929.cindex "callout" "cache, suppressing"
30930.cindex "caching callout, suppressing"
30931When this parameter is given, the callout cache is neither read nor updated.
30932
30933.vitem &*postmaster*&
30934.cindex "callout" "postmaster; checking"
30935When this parameter is set, a successful callout check is followed by a similar
30936check for the local part &'postmaster'& at the same domain. If this address is
30937rejected, the callout fails (but see &%fullpostmaster%& above). The result of
30938the postmaster check is recorded in a cache record; if it is a failure, this is
30939used to fail subsequent callouts for the domain without a connection being
30940made, until the cache record expires.
30941
30942.vitem &*postmaster_mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
30943The postmaster check uses an empty sender in the MAIL command by default.
30944You can use this parameter to do a postmaster check using a different address.
30945For example:
30946.code
30947require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=abc@x.y.z
30948.endd
30949If both &%postmaster%& and &%postmaster_mailfrom%& are present, the rightmost
30950one overrides. The &%postmaster%& parameter is equivalent to this example:
30951.code
30952require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=
30953.endd
30954&*Warning*&: The caching arrangements for postmaster checking do not take
30955account of the sender address. It is assumed that either the empty address or
30956a fixed non-empty address will be used. All that Exim remembers is that the
30957postmaster check for the domain succeeded or failed.
30958
30959
30960.vitem &*random*&
30961.cindex "callout" "&""random""& check"
30962When this parameter is set, before doing the normal callout check, Exim does a
30963check for a &"random"& local part at the same domain. The local part is not
30964really random &-- it is defined by the expansion of the option
30965&%callout_random_local_part%&, which defaults to
30966.code
30967$primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
30968.endd
30969The idea here is to try to determine whether the remote host accepts all local
30970parts without checking. If it does, there is no point in doing callouts for
30971specific local parts. If the &"random"& check succeeds, the result is saved in
30972a cache record, and used to force the current and subsequent callout checks to
30973succeed without a connection being made, until the cache record expires.
30974
30975.vitem &*use_postmaster*&
30976.cindex "callout" "sender for recipient check"
30977This parameter applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
30978.code
30979deny !verify = recipient/callout=use_postmaster
30980.endd
30981.vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
30982It causes a non-empty postmaster address to be used in the MAIL command when
30983performing the callout for the recipient, and also for a &"random"& check if
30984that is configured. The local part of the address is &`postmaster`& and the
30985domain is the contents of &$qualify_domain$&.
30986
30987.vitem &*use_sender*&
30988This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
30989.code
30990require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender
30991.endd
30992It causes the message's actual sender address to be used in the MAIL
30993command when performing the callout, instead of an empty address. There is no
30994need to use this option unless you know that the called hosts make use of the
30995sender when checking recipients. If used indiscriminately, it reduces the
30996usefulness of callout caching.
30997
30998.new
30999.vitem &*hold*&
31000This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
31001.code
31002require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender,hold
31003.endd
31004It causes the connection to be helod open and used for any further recipients
31005and for eventual delivery (should that be done quickly).
31006Doing this saves on TCP and SMTP startup costs, and TLS costs also
31007when that is used for the connections.
31008The advantage is only gained if there are no callout cache hits
31009(which could be enforced by the no_cache option),
31010if the use_sender option is used,
31011if neither the random nor the use_postmaster option is used,
31012and if no other callouts intervene.
31013.wen
31014.endlist
31015
31016If you use any of the parameters that set a non-empty sender for the MAIL
31017command (&%mailfrom%&, &%postmaster_mailfrom%&, &%use_postmaster%&, or
31018&%use_sender%&), you should think about possible loops. Recipient checking is
31019usually done between two hosts that are under the same management, and the host
31020that receives the callouts is not normally configured to do callouts itself.
31021Therefore, it is normally safe to use &%use_postmaster%& or &%use_sender%& in
31022these circumstances.
31023
31024However, if you use a non-empty sender address for a callout to an arbitrary
31025host, there is the likelihood that the remote host will itself initiate a
31026callout check back to your host. As it is checking what appears to be a message
31027sender, it is likely to use an empty address in MAIL, thus avoiding a
31028callout loop. However, to be on the safe side it would be best to set up your
31029own ACLs so that they do not do sender verification checks when the recipient
31030is the address you use for header sender or postmaster callout checking.
31031
31032Another issue to think about when using non-empty senders for callouts is
31033caching. When you set &%mailfrom%& or &%use_sender%&, the cache record is keyed
31034by the sender/recipient combination; thus, for any given recipient, many more
31035actual callouts are performed than when an empty sender or postmaster is used.
31036
31037
31038
31039
31040.section "Callout caching" "SECTcallvercache"
31041.cindex "hints database" "callout cache"
31042.cindex "callout" "cache, description of"
31043.cindex "caching" "callout"
31044Exim caches the results of callouts in order to reduce the amount of resources
31045used, unless you specify the &%no_cache%& parameter with the &%callout%&
31046option. A hints database called &"callout"& is used for the cache. Two
31047different record types are used: one records the result of a callout check for
31048a specific address, and the other records information that applies to the
31049entire domain (for example, that it accepts the local part &'postmaster'&).
31050
31051When an original callout fails, a detailed SMTP error message is given about
31052the failure. However, for subsequent failures use the cache data, this message
31053is not available.
31054
31055The expiry times for negative and positive address cache records are
31056independent, and can be set by the global options &%callout_negative_expire%&
31057(default 2h) and &%callout_positive_expire%& (default 24h), respectively.
31058
31059If a host gives a negative response to an SMTP connection, or rejects any
31060commands up to and including
31061.code
31062MAIL FROM:<>
31063.endd
31064(but not including the MAIL command with a non-empty address),
31065any callout attempt is bound to fail. Exim remembers such failures in a
31066domain cache record, which it uses to fail callouts for the domain without
31067making new connections, until the domain record times out. There are two
31068separate expiry times for domain cache records:
31069&%callout_domain_negative_expire%& (default 3h) and
31070&%callout_domain_positive_expire%& (default 7d).
31071
31072Domain records expire when the negative expiry time is reached if callouts
31073cannot be made for the domain, or if the postmaster check failed.
31074Otherwise, they expire when the positive expiry time is reached. This
31075ensures that, for example, a host that stops accepting &"random"& local parts
31076will eventually be noticed.
31077
31078The callout caching mechanism is based on the domain of the address that is
31079being tested. If the domain routes to several hosts, it is assumed that their
31080behaviour will be the same.
31081
31082
31083
31084.section "Sender address verification reporting" "SECTsenaddver"
31085.cindex "verifying" "suppressing error details"
31086See section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& for a general discussion of
31087verification. When sender verification fails in an ACL, the details of the
31088failure are given as additional output lines before the 550 response to the
31089relevant SMTP command (RCPT or DATA). For example, if sender callout is in use,
31090you might see:
31091.code
31092MAIL FROM:<xyz@abc.example>
31093250 OK
31094RCPT TO:<pqr@def.example>
31095550-Verification failed for <xyz@abc.example>
31096550-Called: 192.168.34.43
31097550-Sent: RCPT TO:<xyz@abc.example>
31098550-Response: 550 Unknown local part xyz in <xyz@abc.example>
31099550 Sender verification failed
31100.endd
31101If more than one RCPT command fails in the same way, the details are given
31102only for the first of them. However, some administrators do not want to send
31103out this much information. You can suppress the details by adding
31104&`/no_details`& to the ACL statement that requests sender verification. For
31105example:
31106.code
31107verify = sender/no_details
31108.endd
31109
31110.section "Redirection while verifying" "SECTredirwhilveri"
31111.cindex "verifying" "redirection while"
31112.cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
31113A dilemma arises when a local address is redirected by aliasing or forwarding
31114during verification: should the generated addresses themselves be verified,
31115or should the successful expansion of the original address be enough to verify
31116it? By default, Exim takes the following pragmatic approach:
31117
31118.ilist
31119When an incoming address is redirected to just one child address, verification
31120continues with the child address, and if that fails to verify, the original
31121verification also fails.
31122.next
31123When an incoming address is redirected to more than one child address,
31124verification does not continue. A success result is returned.
31125.endlist
31126
31127This seems the most reasonable behaviour for the common use of aliasing as a
31128way of redirecting different local parts to the same mailbox. It means, for
31129example, that a pair of alias entries of the form
31130.code
31131A.Wol: aw123
31132aw123: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
31133.endd
31134work as expected, with both local parts causing verification failure. When a
31135redirection generates more than one address, the behaviour is more like a
31136mailing list, where the existence of the alias itself is sufficient for
31137verification to succeed.
31138
31139It is possible, however, to change the default behaviour so that all successful
31140redirections count as successful verifications, however many new addresses are
31141generated. This is specified by the &%success_on_redirect%& verification
31142option. For example:
31143.code
31144require verify = recipient/success_on_redirect/callout=10s
31145.endd
31146In this example, verification succeeds if a router generates a new address, and
31147the callout does not occur, because no address was routed to a remote host.
31148
31149When verification is being tested via the &%-bv%& option, the treatment of
31150redirections is as just described, unless the &%-v%& or any debugging option is
31151also specified. In that case, full verification is done for every generated
31152address and a report is output for each of them.
31153
31154
31155
31156.section "Client SMTP authorization (CSA)" "SECTverifyCSA"
31157.cindex "CSA" "verifying"
31158Client SMTP Authorization is a system that allows a site to advertise
31159which machines are and are not permitted to send email. This is done by placing
31160special SRV records in the DNS; these are looked up using the client's HELO
31161domain. At the time of writing, CSA is still an Internet Draft. Client SMTP
31162Authorization checks in Exim are performed by the ACL condition:
31163.code
31164verify = csa
31165.endd
31166This fails if the client is not authorized. If there is a DNS problem, or if no
31167valid CSA SRV record is found, or if the client is authorized, the condition
31168succeeds. These three cases can be distinguished using the expansion variable
31169&$csa_status$&, which can take one of the values &"fail"&, &"defer"&,
31170&"unknown"&, or &"ok"&. The condition does not itself defer because that would
31171be likely to cause problems for legitimate email.
31172
31173The error messages produced by the CSA code include slightly more
31174detail. If &$csa_status$& is &"defer"&, this may be because of problems
31175looking up the CSA SRV record, or problems looking up the CSA target
31176address record. There are four reasons for &$csa_status$& being &"fail"&:
31177
31178.ilist
31179The client's host name is explicitly not authorized.
31180.next
31181The client's IP address does not match any of the CSA target IP addresses.
31182.next
31183The client's host name is authorized but it has no valid target IP addresses
31184(for example, the target's addresses are IPv6 and the client is using IPv4).
31185.next
31186The client's host name has no CSA SRV record but a parent domain has asserted
31187that all subdomains must be explicitly authorized.
31188.endlist
31189
31190The &%csa%& verification condition can take an argument which is the domain to
31191use for the DNS query. The default is:
31192.code
31193verify = csa/$sender_helo_name
31194.endd
31195This implementation includes an extension to CSA. If the query domain
31196is an address literal such as [192.0.2.95], or if it is a bare IP
31197address, Exim searches for CSA SRV records in the reverse DNS as if
31198the HELO domain was (for example) &'95.2.0.192.in-addr.arpa'&. Therefore it is
31199meaningful to say:
31200.code
31201verify = csa/$sender_host_address
31202.endd
31203In fact, this is the check that Exim performs if the client does not say HELO.
31204This extension can be turned off by setting the main configuration option
31205&%dns_csa_use_reverse%& to be false.
31206
31207If a CSA SRV record is not found for the domain itself, a search
31208is performed through its parent domains for a record which might be
31209making assertions about subdomains. The maximum depth of this search is limited
31210using the main configuration option &%dns_csa_search_limit%&, which is 5 by
31211default. Exim does not look for CSA SRV records in a top level domain, so the
31212default settings handle HELO domains as long as seven
31213(&'hostname.five.four.three.two.one.com'&). This encompasses the vast majority
31214of legitimate HELO domains.
31215
31216The &'dnsdb'& lookup also has support for CSA. Although &'dnsdb'& also supports
31217direct SRV lookups, this is not sufficient because of the extra parent domain
31218search behaviour of CSA, and (as with PTR lookups) &'dnsdb'& also turns IP
31219addresses into lookups in the reverse DNS space. The result of a successful
31220lookup such as:
31221.code
31222${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
31223.endd
31224has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
31225The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
31226authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
31227
31228
31229
31230
31231.section "Bounce address tag validation" "SECTverifyPRVS"
31232.cindex "BATV, verifying"
31233Bounce address tag validation (BATV) is a scheme whereby the envelope senders
31234of outgoing messages have a cryptographic, timestamped &"tag"& added to them.
31235Genuine incoming bounce messages should therefore always be addressed to
31236recipients that have a valid tag. This scheme is a way of detecting unwanted
31237bounce messages caused by sender address forgeries (often called &"collateral
31238spam"&), because the recipients of such messages do not include valid tags.
31239
31240There are two expansion items to help with the implementation of the BATV
31241&"prvs"& (private signature) scheme in an Exim configuration. This scheme signs
31242the original envelope sender address by using a simple key to add a hash of the
31243address and some time-based randomizing information. The &%prvs%& expansion
31244item creates a signed address, and the &%prvscheck%& expansion item checks one.
31245The syntax of these expansion items is described in section
31246&<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
31247
31248As an example, suppose the secret per-address keys are stored in an MySQL
31249database. A query to look up the key for an address could be defined as a macro
31250like this:
31251.code
31252PRVSCHECK_SQL = ${lookup mysql{SELECT secret FROM batv_prvs \
31253 WHERE sender='${quote_mysql:$prvscheck_address}'\
31254 }{$value}}
31255.endd
31256Suppose also that the senders who make use of BATV are defined by an address
31257list called &%batv_senders%&. Then, in the ACL for RCPT commands, you could
31258use this:
31259.code
31260# Bounces: drop unsigned addresses for BATV senders
31261deny message = This address does not send an unsigned reverse path
31262 senders = :
31263 recipients = +batv_senders
31264
31265# Bounces: In case of prvs-signed address, check signature.
31266deny message = Invalid reverse path signature.
31267 senders = :
31268 condition = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}\
31269 {PRVSCHECK_SQL}{1}}
31270 !condition = $prvscheck_result
31271.endd
31272The first statement rejects recipients for bounce messages that are addressed
31273to plain BATV sender addresses, because it is known that BATV senders do not
31274send out messages with plain sender addresses. The second statement rejects
31275recipients that are prvs-signed, but with invalid signatures (either because
31276the key is wrong, or the signature has timed out).
31277
31278A non-prvs-signed address is not rejected by the second statement, because the
31279&%prvscheck%& expansion yields an empty string if its first argument is not a
31280prvs-signed address, thus causing the &%condition%& condition to be false. If
31281the first argument is a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the yield is
31282the third string (in this case &"1"&), whether or not the cryptographic and
31283timeout checks succeed. The &$prvscheck_result$& variable contains the result
31284of the checks (empty for failure, &"1"& for success).
31285
31286There is one more issue you must consider when implementing prvs-signing:
31287you have to ensure that the routers accept prvs-signed addresses and
31288deliver them correctly. The easiest way to handle this is to use a &(redirect)&
31289router to remove the signature with a configuration along these lines:
31290.code
31291batv_redirect:
31292 driver = redirect
31293 data = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}{PRVSCHECK_SQL}}
31294.endd
31295This works because, if the third argument of &%prvscheck%& is empty, the result
31296of the expansion of a prvs-signed address is the decoded value of the original
31297address. This router should probably be the first of your routers that handles
31298local addresses.
31299
31300To create BATV-signed addresses in the first place, a transport of this form
31301can be used:
31302.code
31303external_smtp_batv:
31304 driver = smtp
31305 return_path = ${prvs {$return_path} \
31306 {${lookup mysql{SELECT \
31307 secret FROM batv_prvs WHERE \
31308 sender='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'} \
31309 {$value}fail}}}
31310.endd
31311If no key can be found for the existing return path, no signing takes place.
31312
31313
31314
31315.section "Using an ACL to control relaying" "SECTrelaycontrol"
31316.cindex "&ACL;" "relay control"
31317.cindex "relaying" "control by ACL"
31318.cindex "policy control" "relay control"
31319An MTA is said to &'relay'& a message if it receives it from some host and
31320delivers it directly to another host as a result of a remote address contained
31321within it. Redirecting a local address via an alias or forward file and then
31322passing the message on to another host is not relaying,
31323.cindex "&""percent hack""&"
31324but a redirection as a result of the &"percent hack"& is.
31325
31326Two kinds of relaying exist, which are termed &"incoming"& and &"outgoing"&.
31327A host which is acting as a gateway or an MX backup is concerned with incoming
31328relaying from arbitrary hosts to a specific set of domains. On the other hand,
31329a host which is acting as a smart host for a number of clients is concerned
31330with outgoing relaying from those clients to the Internet at large. Often the
31331same host is fulfilling both functions,
31332. ///
31333. as illustrated in the diagram below,
31334. ///
31335but in principle these two kinds of relaying are entirely independent. What is
31336not wanted is the transmission of mail from arbitrary remote hosts through your
31337system to arbitrary domains.
31338
31339
31340You can implement relay control by means of suitable statements in the ACL that
31341runs for each RCPT command. For convenience, it is often easiest to use
31342Exim's named list facility to define the domains and hosts involved. For
31343example, suppose you want to do the following:
31344
31345.ilist
31346Deliver a number of domains to mailboxes on the local host (or process them
31347locally in some other way). Let's say these are &'my.dom1.example'& and
31348&'my.dom2.example'&.
31349.next
31350Relay mail for a number of other domains for which you are the secondary MX.
31351These might be &'friend1.example'& and &'friend2.example'&.
31352.next
31353Relay mail from the hosts on your local LAN, to whatever domains are involved.
31354Suppose your LAN is 192.168.45.0/24.
31355.endlist
31356
31357
31358In the main part of the configuration, you put the following definitions:
31359.code
31360domainlist local_domains = my.dom1.example : my.dom2.example
31361domainlist relay_to_domains = friend1.example : friend2.example
31362hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.45.0/24
31363.endd
31364Now you can use these definitions in the ACL that is run for every RCPT
31365command:
31366.code
31367acl_check_rcpt:
31368 accept domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
31369 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
31370.endd
31371The first statement accepts any RCPT command that contains an address in
31372the local or relay domains. For any other domain, control passes to the second
31373statement, which accepts the command only if it comes from one of the relay
31374hosts. In practice, you will probably want to make your ACL more sophisticated
31375than this, for example, by including sender and recipient verification. The
31376default configuration includes a more comprehensive example, which is described
31377in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
31378
31379
31380
31381.section "Checking a relay configuration" "SECTcheralcon"
31382.cindex "relaying" "checking control of"
31383You can check the relay characteristics of your configuration in the same way
31384that you can test any ACL behaviour for an incoming SMTP connection, by using
31385the &%-bh%& option to run a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
31386.ecindex IIDacl
31387
31388
31389
31390. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31391. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31392
31393.chapter "Content scanning at ACL time" "CHAPexiscan"
31394.scindex IIDcosca "content scanning" "at ACL time"
31395The extension of Exim to include content scanning at ACL time, formerly known
31396as &"exiscan"&, was originally implemented as a patch by Tom Kistner. The code
31397was integrated into the main source for Exim release 4.50, and Tom continues to
31398maintain it. Most of the wording of this chapter is taken from Tom's
31399specification.
31400
31401It is also possible to scan the content of messages at other times. The
31402&[local_scan()]& function (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) allows for content
31403scanning after all the ACLs have run. A transport filter can be used to scan
31404messages at delivery time (see the &%transport_filter%& option, described in
31405chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
31406
31407If you want to include the ACL-time content-scanning features when you compile
31408Exim, you need to arrange for WITH_CONTENT_SCAN to be defined in your
31409&_Local/Makefile_&. When you do that, the Exim binary is built with:
31410
31411.ilist
31412Two additional ACLs (&%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&) that are run
31413for all MIME parts for SMTP and non-SMTP messages, respectively.
31414.next
31415Additional ACL conditions and modifiers: &%decode%&, &%malware%&,
31416&%mime_regex%&, &%regex%&, and &%spam%&. These can be used in the ACL that is
31417run at the end of message reception (the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL).
31418.next
31419An additional control feature (&"no_mbox_unspool"&) that saves spooled copies
31420of messages, or parts of messages, for debugging purposes.
31421.next
31422Additional expansion variables that are set in the new ACL and by the new
31423conditions.
31424.next
31425Two new main configuration options: &%av_scanner%& and &%spamd_address%&.
31426.endlist
31427
31428Content-scanning is continually evolving, and new features are still being
31429added. While such features are still unstable and liable to incompatible
31430changes, they are made available in Exim by setting options whose names begin
31431EXPERIMENTAL_ in &_Local/Makefile_&. Such features are not documented in
31432this manual. You can find out about them by reading the file called
31433&_doc/experimental.txt_&.
31434
31435All the content-scanning facilities work on a MBOX copy of the message that is
31436temporarily created in a file called:
31437.display
31438<&'spool_directory'&>&`/scan/`&<&'message_id'&>/<&'message_id'&>&`.eml`&
31439.endd
31440The &_.eml_& extension is a friendly hint to virus scanners that they can
31441expect an MBOX-like structure inside that file. The file is created when the
31442first content scanning facility is called. Subsequent calls to content
31443scanning conditions open the same file again. The directory is recursively
31444removed when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL has finished running, unless
31445.code
31446control = no_mbox_unspool
31447.endd
31448has been encountered. When the MIME ACL decodes files, they are put into the
31449same directory by default.
31450
31451
31452
31453.section "Scanning for viruses" "SECTscanvirus"
31454.cindex "virus scanning"
31455.cindex "content scanning" "for viruses"
31456.cindex "content scanning" "the &%malware%& condition"
31457The &%malware%& ACL condition lets you connect virus scanner software to Exim.
31458It supports a &"generic"& interface to scanners called via the shell, and
31459specialized interfaces for &"daemon"& type virus scanners, which are resident
31460in memory and thus are much faster.
31461
31462A timeout of 2 minutes is applied to a scanner call (by default);
31463if it expires then a defer action is taken.
31464
31465.oindex "&%av_scanner%&"
31466You can set the &%av_scanner%& option in the main part of the configuration
31467to specify which scanner to use, together with any additional options that
31468are needed. The basic syntax is as follows:
31469.display
31470&`av_scanner = <`&&'scanner-type'&&`>:<`&&'option1'&&`>:<`&&'option2'&&`>:[...]`&
31471.endd
31472If you do not set &%av_scanner%&, it defaults to
31473.code
31474av_scanner = sophie:/var/run/sophie
31475.endd
31476If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
31477before use.
31478The usual list-parsing of the content (see &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&) applies.
31479The following scanner types are supported in this release:
31480
31481.vlist
31482.vitem &%avast%&
31483.cindex "virus scanners" "avast"
31484This is the scanner daemon of Avast. It has been tested with Avast Core
31485Security (currently at version 1.1.7).
31486You can get a trial version at &url(http://www.avast.com) or for Linux
31487at &url(http://www.avast.com/linux-server-antivirus).
31488This scanner type takes one option,
31489which can be either a full path to a UNIX socket,
31490or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
31491The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
31492single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
31493Any further options are given, on separate lines,
31494to the daemon as options before the main scan command.
31495For example:
31496.code
31497av_scanner = avast:/var/run/avast/scan.sock:FLAGS -fullfiles:SENSITIVITY -pup
31498av_scanner = avast:192.168.2.22 5036
31499.endd
31500If you omit the argument, the default path
31501&_/var/run/avast/scan.sock_&
31502is used.
31503If you use a remote host,
31504you need to make Exim's spool directory available to it,
31505as the scanner is passed a file path, not file contents.
31506For information about available commands and their options you may use
31507.code
31508$ socat UNIX:/var/run/avast/scan.sock STDIO:
31509 FLAGS
31510 SENSITIVITY
31511 PACK
31512.endd
31513
31514
31515.vitem &%aveserver%&
31516.cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
31517This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 5. You can get a trial version
31518at &url(http://www.kaspersky.com). This scanner type takes one option,
31519which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket. The default is shown in this
31520example:
31521.code
31522av_scanner = aveserver:/var/run/aveserver
31523.endd
31524
31525
31526.vitem &%clamd%&
31527.cindex "virus scanners" "clamd"
31528This daemon-type scanner is GPL and free. You can get it at
31529&url(http://www.clamav.net/). Some older versions of clamd do not seem to
31530unpack MIME containers, so it used to be recommended to unpack MIME attachments
31531in the MIME ACL. This is no longer believed to be necessary.
31532
31533The options are a list of server specifiers, which may be
31534a UNIX socket specification,
31535a TCP socket specification,
31536or a (global) option.
31537
31538A socket specification consists of a space-separated list.
31539For a Unix socket the first element is a full path for the socket,
31540for a TCP socket the first element is the IP address
31541and the second a port number,
31542Any further elements are per-server (non-global) options.
31543These per-server options are supported:
31544.code
31545retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
31546.endd
31547
31548The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
31549a failed connect is made. The default is to not retry.
31550
31551If a Unix socket file is specified, only one server is supported.
31552
31553Examples:
31554.code
31555av_scanner = clamd:/opt/clamd/socket
31556av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234
31557av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234:local
31558av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 retry=10s
31559av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 : 192.0.2.4 1234
31560.endd
31561If the value of av_scanner points to a UNIX socket file or contains the
31562&`local`&
31563option, then the ClamAV interface will pass a filename containing the data
31564to be scanned, which will should normally result in less I/O happening and be
31565more efficient. Normally in the TCP case, the data is streamed to ClamAV as
31566Exim does not assume that there is a common filesystem with the remote host.
31567There is an option WITH_OLD_CLAMAV_STREAM in &_src/EDITME_& available, should
31568you be running a version of ClamAV prior to 0.95.
31569
31570The final example shows that multiple TCP targets can be specified. Exim will
31571randomly use one for each incoming email (i.e. it load balances them). Note
31572that only TCP targets may be used if specifying a list of scanners; a UNIX
31573socket cannot be mixed in with TCP targets. If one of the servers becomes
31574unavailable, Exim will try the remaining one(s) until it finds one that works.
31575When a clamd server becomes unreachable, Exim will log a message. Exim does
31576not keep track of scanner state between multiple messages, and the scanner
31577selection is random, so the message will get logged in the mainlog for each
31578email that the down scanner gets chosen first (message wrapped to be readable):
31579.code
315802013-10-09 14:30:39 1VTumd-0000Y8-BQ malware acl condition:
31581 clamd: connection to localhost, port 3310 failed
31582 (Connection refused)
31583.endd
31584
31585If the option is unset, the default is &_/tmp/clamd_&. Thanks to David Saez for
31586contributing the code for this scanner.
31587
31588.vitem &%cmdline%&
31589.cindex "virus scanners" "command line interface"
31590This is the keyword for the generic command line scanner interface. It can be
31591used to attach virus scanners that are invoked from the shell. This scanner
31592type takes 3 mandatory options:
31593
31594.olist
31595The full path and name of the scanner binary, with all command line options,
31596and a placeholder (&`%s`&) for the directory to scan.
31597
31598.next
31599A regular expression to match against the STDOUT and STDERR output of the
31600virus scanner. If the expression matches, a virus was found. You must make
31601absolutely sure that this expression matches on &"virus found"&. This is called
31602the &"trigger"& expression.
31603
31604.next
31605Another regular expression, containing exactly one pair of parentheses, to
31606match the name of the virus found in the scanners output. This is called the
31607&"name"& expression.
31608.endlist olist
31609
31610For example, Sophos Sweep reports a virus on a line like this:
31611.code
31612Virus 'W32/Magistr-B' found in file ./those.bat
31613.endd
31614For the trigger expression, we can match the phrase &"found in file"&. For the
31615name expression, we want to extract the W32/Magistr-B string, so we can match
31616for the single quotes left and right of it. Altogether, this makes the
31617configuration setting:
31618.code
31619av_scanner = cmdline:\
31620 /path/to/sweep -ss -all -rec -archive %s:\
31621 found in file:'(.+)'
31622.endd
31623.vitem &%drweb%&
31624.cindex "virus scanners" "DrWeb"
31625The DrWeb daemon scanner (&url(http://www.sald.com/)) interface
31626takes one option,
31627either a full path to a UNIX socket,
31628or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
31629The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
31630single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
31631For example:
31632.code
31633av_scanner = drweb:/var/run/drwebd.sock
31634av_scanner = drweb:192.168.2.20 31337
31635.endd
31636If you omit the argument, the default path &_/usr/local/drweb/run/drwebd.sock_&
31637is used. Thanks to Alex Miller for contributing the code for this scanner.
31638
31639.vitem &%f-protd%&
31640.cindex "virus scanners" "f-protd"
31641The f-protd scanner is accessed via HTTP over TCP.
31642One argument is taken, being a space-separated hostname and port number
31643(or port-range).
31644For example:
31645.code
31646av_scanner = f-protd:localhost 10200-10204
31647.endd
31648If you omit the argument, the default values show above are used.
31649
31650.new
31651.vitem &%f-prot6d%&
31652.cindex "virus scanners" "f-prot6d"
31653The f-prot6d scanner is accessed using the FPSCAND protocol over TCP.
31654One argument is taken, being a space-separated hostname and port number.
31655For example:
31656.code
31657av_scanner = f-prot6d:localhost 10200
31658.endd
31659If you omit the argument, the default values show above are used.
31660.wen
31661
31662.vitem &%fsecure%&
31663.cindex "virus scanners" "F-Secure"
31664The F-Secure daemon scanner (&url(http://www.f-secure.com)) takes one
31665argument which is the path to a UNIX socket. For example:
31666.code
31667av_scanner = fsecure:/path/to/.fsav
31668.endd
31669If no argument is given, the default is &_/var/run/.fsav_&. Thanks to Johan
31670Thelmen for contributing the code for this scanner.
31671
31672.vitem &%kavdaemon%&
31673.cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
31674This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 4. This version of the
31675Kaspersky scanner is outdated. Please upgrade (see &%aveserver%& above). This
31676scanner type takes one option, which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket.
31677For example:
31678.code
31679av_scanner = kavdaemon:/opt/AVP/AvpCtl
31680.endd
31681The default path is &_/var/run/AvpCtl_&.
31682
31683.vitem &%mksd%&
31684.cindex "virus scanners" "mksd"
31685This is a daemon type scanner that is aimed mainly at Polish users, though some
31686parts of documentation are now available in English. You can get it at
31687&url(http://linux.mks.com.pl/). The only option for this scanner type is
31688the maximum number of processes used simultaneously to scan the attachments,
31689provided that mksd has
31690been run with at least the same number of child processes. For example:
31691.code
31692av_scanner = mksd:2
31693.endd
31694You can safely omit this option (the default value is 1).
31695
31696.vitem &%sock%&
31697.cindex "virus scanners" "simple socket-connected"
31698This is a general-purpose way of talking to simple scanner daemons
31699running on the local machine.
31700There are four options:
31701an address (which may be an IP address and port, or the path of a Unix socket),
31702a commandline to send (may include a single %s which will be replaced with
31703the path to the mail file to be scanned),
31704an RE to trigger on from the returned data,
31705an RE to extract malware_name from the returned data.
31706For example:
31707.code
31708av_scanner = sock:127.0.0.1 6001:%s:(SPAM|VIRUS):(.*)\$
31709.endd
31710Default for the socket specifier is &_/tmp/malware.sock_&.
31711Default for the commandline is &_%s\n_&.
31712Both regular-expressions are required.
31713
31714.vitem &%sophie%&
31715.cindex "virus scanners" "Sophos and Sophie"
31716Sophie is a daemon that uses Sophos' &%libsavi%& library to scan for viruses.
31717You can get Sophie at &url(http://www.clanfield.info/sophie/). The only option
31718for this scanner type is the path to the UNIX socket that Sophie uses for
31719client communication. For example:
31720.code
31721av_scanner = sophie:/tmp/sophie
31722.endd
31723The default path is &_/var/run/sophie_&, so if you are using this, you can omit
31724the option.
31725.endlist
31726
31727When &%av_scanner%& is correctly set, you can use the &%malware%& condition in
31728the DATA ACL. &*Note*&: You cannot use the &%malware%& condition in the MIME
31729ACL.
31730
31731The &%av_scanner%& option is expanded each time &%malware%& is called. This
31732makes it possible to use different scanners. See further below for an example.
31733The &%malware%& condition caches its results, so when you use it multiple times
31734for the same message, the actual scanning process is only carried out once.
31735However, using expandable items in &%av_scanner%& disables this caching, in
31736which case each use of the &%malware%& condition causes a new scan of the
31737message.
31738
31739The &%malware%& condition takes a right-hand argument that is expanded before
31740use and taken as a list, slash-separated by default.
31741The first element can then be one of
31742
31743.ilist
31744&"true"&, &"*"&, or &"1"&, in which case the message is scanned for viruses.
31745The condition succeeds if a virus was found, and fail otherwise. This is the
31746recommended usage.
31747.next
31748&"false"& or &"0"& or an empty string, in which case no scanning is done and
31749the condition fails immediately.
31750.next
31751A regular expression, in which case the message is scanned for viruses. The
31752condition succeeds if a virus is found and its name matches the regular
31753expression. This allows you to take special actions on certain types of virus.
31754Note that &"/"& characters in the RE must be doubled due to the list-processing,
31755unless the separator is changed (in the usual way).
31756.endlist
31757
31758You can append a &`defer_ok`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to accept
31759messages even if there is a problem with the virus scanner.
31760Otherwise, such a problem causes the ACL to defer.
31761
31762You can append a &`tmo=<val>`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to
31763specify a non-default timeout. The default is two minutes.
31764For example:
31765.code
31766malware = * / defer_ok / tmo=10s
31767.endd
31768A timeout causes the ACL to defer.
31769
31770.vindex "&$callout_address$&"
31771When a connection is made to the scanner the expansion variable &$callout_address$&
31772is set to record the actual address used.
31773
31774.vindex "&$malware_name$&"
31775When a virus is found, the condition sets up an expansion variable called
31776&$malware_name$& that contains the name of the virus. You can use it in a
31777&%message%& modifier that specifies the error returned to the sender, and/or in
31778logging data.
31779
31780Beware the interaction of Exim's &%message_size_limit%& with any size limits
31781imposed by your anti-virus scanner.
31782
31783Here is a very simple scanning example:
31784.code
31785deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
31786 malware = *
31787.endd
31788The next example accepts messages when there is a problem with the scanner:
31789.code
31790deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
31791 malware = */defer_ok
31792.endd
31793The next example shows how to use an ACL variable to scan with both sophie and
31794aveserver. It assumes you have set:
31795.code
31796av_scanner = $acl_m0
31797.endd
31798in the main Exim configuration.
31799.code
31800deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
31801 set acl_m0 = sophie
31802 malware = *
31803
31804deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
31805 set acl_m0 = aveserver
31806 malware = *
31807.endd
31808
31809
31810.section "Scanning with SpamAssassin and Rspamd" "SECTscanspamass"
31811.cindex "content scanning" "for spam"
31812.cindex "spam scanning"
31813.cindex "SpamAssassin"
31814.cindex "Rspamd"
31815The &%spam%& ACL condition calls SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon to get a spam
31816score and a report for the message.
31817Support is also provided for Rspamd.
31818
31819For more information about installation and configuration of SpamAssassin or
31820Rspamd refer to their respective websites at
31821&url(http://spamassassin.apache.org) and &url(http://www.rspamd.com)
31822
31823SpamAssassin can be installed with CPAN by running:
31824.code
31825perl -MCPAN -e 'install Mail::SpamAssassin'
31826.endd
31827SpamAssassin has its own set of configuration files. Please review its
31828documentation to see how you can tweak it. The default installation should work
31829nicely, however.
31830
31831.oindex "&%spamd_address%&"
31832By default, SpamAssassin listens on 127.0.0.1, TCP port 783 and if you
31833intend to use an instance running on the local host you do not need to set
31834&%spamd_address%&. If you intend to use another host or port for SpamAssassin,
31835you must set the &%spamd_address%& option in the global part of the Exim
31836configuration as follows (example):
31837.code
31838spamd_address = 192.168.99.45 387
31839.endd
31840The SpamAssassin protocol relies on a TCP half-close from the client.
31841If your SpamAssassin client side is running a Linux system with an
31842iptables firewall, consider setting
31843&%net.netfilter.nf_conntrack_tcp_timeout_close_wait%& to at least the
31844timeout, Exim uses when waiting for a response from the SpamAssassin
31845server (currently defaulting to 120s). With a lower value the Linux
31846connection tracking may consider your half-closed connection as dead too
31847soon.
31848
31849
31850To use Rspamd (which by default listens on all local addresses
31851on TCP port 11333)
31852you should add &%variant=rspamd%& after the address/port pair, for example:
31853.code
31854spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 11333 variant=rspamd
31855.endd
31856
31857As of version 2.60, &%SpamAssassin%& also supports communication over UNIX
31858sockets. If you want to us these, supply &%spamd_address%& with an absolute
31859file name instead of an address/port pair:
31860.code
31861spamd_address = /var/run/spamd_socket
31862.endd
31863You can have multiple &%spamd%& servers to improve scalability. These can
31864reside on other hardware reachable over the network. To specify multiple
31865&%spamd%& servers, put multiple address/port pairs in the &%spamd_address%&
31866option, separated with colons (the separator can be changed in the usual way):
31867.code
31868spamd_address = 192.168.2.10 783 : \
31869 192.168.2.11 783 : \
31870 192.168.2.12 783
31871.endd
31872Up to 32 &%spamd%& servers are supported.
31873When a server fails to respond to the connection attempt, all other
31874servers are tried until one succeeds. If no server responds, the &%spam%&
31875condition defers.
31876
31877Unix and TCP socket specifications may be mixed in any order.
31878Each element of the list is a list itself, space-separated by default
31879and changeable in the usual way; take care to not double the separator.
31880
31881For TCP socket specifications a host name or IP (v4 or v6, but
31882subject to list-separator quoting rules) address can be used,
31883and the port can be one or a dash-separated pair.
31884In the latter case, the range is tried in strict order.
31885
31886Elements after the first for Unix sockets, or second for TCP socket,
31887are options.
31888The supported options are:
31889.code
31890pri=<priority> Selection priority
31891weight=<value> Selection bias
31892time=<start>-<end> Use only between these times of day
31893retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
31894tmo=<timespec> Connection time limit
31895variant=rspamd Use Rspamd rather than SpamAssassin protocol
31896.endd
31897
31898The &`pri`& option specifies a priority for the server within the list,
31899higher values being tried first.
31900The default priority is 1.
31901
31902The &`weight`& option specifies a selection bias.
31903Within a priority set
31904servers are queried in a random fashion, weighted by this value.
31905The default value for selection bias is 1.
31906
31907Time specifications for the &`time`& option are <hour>.<minute>.<second>
31908in the local time zone; each element being one or more digits.
31909Either the seconds or both minutes and seconds, plus the leading &`.`&
31910characters, may be omitted and will be taken as zero.
31911
31912Timeout specifications for the &`retry`& and &`tmo`& options
31913are the usual Exim time interval standard, e.g. &`20s`& or &`1m`&.
31914
31915The &`tmo`& option specifies an overall timeout for communication.
31916The default value is two minutes.
31917
31918The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
31919a failed connect is made.
31920The default is to not retry.
31921
31922The &%spamd_address%& variable is expanded before use if it starts with
31923a dollar sign. In this case, the expansion may return a string that is
31924used as the list so that multiple spamd servers can be the result of an
31925expansion.
31926
31927.vindex "&$callout_address$&"
31928When a connection is made to the server the expansion variable &$callout_address$&
31929is set to record the actual address used.
31930
31931.section "Calling SpamAssassin from an Exim ACL" "SECID206"
31932Here is a simple example of the use of the &%spam%& condition in a DATA ACL:
31933.code
31934deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
31935 spam = joe
31936.endd
31937The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition specifies a name. This is
31938relevant if you have set up multiple SpamAssassin profiles. If you do not want
31939to scan using a specific profile, but rather use the SpamAssassin system-wide
31940default profile, you can scan for an unknown name, or simply use &"nobody"&.
31941Rspamd does not use this setting. However, you must put something on the
31942right-hand side.
31943
31944The name allows you to use per-domain or per-user antispam profiles in
31945principle, but this is not straightforward in practice, because a message may
31946have multiple recipients, not necessarily all in the same domain. Because the
31947&%spam%& condition has to be called from a DATA-time ACL in order to be able to
31948read the contents of the message, the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$&
31949are not set.
31950Careful enforcement of single-recipient messages
31951(e.g. by responding with defer in the recipient ACL for all recipients
31952after the first),
31953or the use of PRDR,
31954.cindex "PRDR" "use for per-user SpamAssassin profiles"
31955are needed to use this feature.
31956
31957The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition is expanded before being used, so
31958you can put lookups or conditions there. When the right-hand side evaluates to
31959&"0"& or &"false"&, no scanning is done and the condition fails immediately.
31960
31961
31962Scanning with SpamAssassin uses a lot of resources. If you scan every message,
31963large ones may cause significant performance degradation. As most spam messages
31964are quite small, it is recommended that you do not scan the big ones. For
31965example:
31966.code
31967deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
31968 condition = ${if < {$message_size}{10K}}
31969 spam = nobody
31970.endd
31971
31972The &%spam%& condition returns true if the threshold specified in the user's
31973SpamAssassin profile has been matched or exceeded. If you want to use the
31974&%spam%& condition for its side effects (see the variables below), you can make
31975it always return &"true"& by appending &`:true`& to the username.
31976
31977.cindex "spam scanning" "returned variables"
31978When the &%spam%& condition is run, it sets up a number of expansion
31979variables.
31980Except for &$spam_report$&,
31981these variables are saved with the received message so are
31982available for use at delivery time.
31983
31984.vlist
31985.vitem &$spam_score$&
31986The spam score of the message, for example &"3.4"& or &"30.5"&. This is useful
31987for inclusion in log or reject messages.
31988
31989.vitem &$spam_score_int$&
31990The spam score of the message, multiplied by ten, as an integer value. For
31991example &"34"& or &"305"&. It may appear to disagree with &$spam_score$&
31992because &$spam_score$& is rounded and &$spam_score_int$& is truncated.
31993The integer value is useful for numeric comparisons in conditions.
31994
31995.vitem &$spam_bar$&
31996A string consisting of a number of &"+"& or &"-"& characters, representing the
31997integer part of the spam score value. A spam score of 4.4 would have a
31998&$spam_bar$& value of &"++++"&. This is useful for inclusion in warning
31999headers, since MUAs can match on such strings. The maximum length of the
32000spam bar is 50 characters.
32001
32002.vitem &$spam_report$&
32003A multiline text table, containing the full SpamAssassin report for the
32004message. Useful for inclusion in headers or reject messages.
32005This variable is only usable in a DATA-time ACL.
32006Beware that SpamAssassin may return non-ASCII characters, especially
32007when running in country-specific locales, which are not legal
32008unencoded in headers.
32009
32010.vitem &$spam_action$&
32011For SpamAssassin either 'reject' or 'no action' depending on the
32012spam score versus threshold.
32013For Rspamd, the recommended action.
32014
32015.endlist
32016
32017The &%spam%& condition caches its results unless expansion in
32018spamd_address was used. If you call it again with the same user name, it
32019does not scan again, but rather returns the same values as before.
32020
32021The &%spam%& condition returns DEFER if there is any error while running
32022the message through SpamAssassin or if the expansion of spamd_address
32023failed. If you want to treat DEFER as FAIL (to pass on to the next ACL
32024statement block), append &`/defer_ok`& to the right-hand side of the
32025spam condition, like this:
32026.code
32027deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
32028 spam = joe/defer_ok
32029.endd
32030This causes messages to be accepted even if there is a problem with &%spamd%&.
32031
32032Here is a longer, commented example of the use of the &%spam%&
32033condition:
32034.code
32035# put headers in all messages (no matter if spam or not)
32036warn spam = nobody:true
32037 add_header = X-Spam-Score: $spam_score ($spam_bar)
32038 add_header = X-Spam-Report: $spam_report
32039
32040# add second subject line with *SPAM* marker when message
32041# is over threshold
32042warn spam = nobody
32043 add_header = Subject: *SPAM* $h_Subject:
32044
32045# reject spam at high scores (> 12)
32046deny message = This message scored $spam_score spam points.
32047 spam = nobody:true
32048 condition = ${if >{$spam_score_int}{120}{1}{0}}
32049.endd
32050
32051
32052
32053.section "Scanning MIME parts" "SECTscanmimepart"
32054.cindex "content scanning" "MIME parts"
32055.cindex "MIME content scanning"
32056.oindex "&%acl_smtp_mime%&"
32057.oindex "&%acl_not_smtp_mime%&"
32058The &%acl_smtp_mime%& global option specifies an ACL that is called once for
32059each MIME part of an SMTP message, including multipart types, in the sequence
32060of their position in the message. Similarly, the &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& option
32061specifies an ACL that is used for the MIME parts of non-SMTP messages. These
32062options may both refer to the same ACL if you want the same processing in both
32063cases.
32064
32065These ACLs are called (possibly many times) just before the &%acl_smtp_data%&
32066ACL in the case of an SMTP message, or just before the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL in
32067the case of a non-SMTP message. However, a MIME ACL is called only if the
32068message contains a &'Content-Type:'& header line. When a call to a MIME
32069ACL does not yield &"accept"&, ACL processing is aborted and the appropriate
32070result code is sent to the client. In the case of an SMTP message, the
32071&%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is not called when this happens.
32072
32073You cannot use the &%malware%& or &%spam%& conditions in a MIME ACL; these can
32074only be used in the DATA or non-SMTP ACLs. However, you can use the &%regex%&
32075condition to match against the raw MIME part. You can also use the
32076&%mime_regex%& condition to match against the decoded MIME part (see section
32077&<<SECTscanregex>>&).
32078
32079At the start of a MIME ACL, a number of variables are set from the header
32080information for the relevant MIME part. These are described below. The contents
32081of the MIME part are not by default decoded into a disk file except for MIME
32082parts whose content-type is &"message/rfc822"&. If you want to decode a MIME
32083part into a disk file, you can use the &%decode%& condition. The general
32084syntax is:
32085.display
32086&`decode = [/`&<&'path'&>&`/]`&<&'filename'&>
32087.endd
32088The right hand side is expanded before use. After expansion,
32089the value can be:
32090
32091.olist
32092&"0"& or &"false"&, in which case no decoding is done.
32093.next
32094The string &"default"&. In that case, the file is put in the temporary
32095&"default"& directory <&'spool_directory'&>&_/scan/_&<&'message_id'&>&_/_& with
32096a sequential file name consisting of the message id and a sequence number. The
32097full path and name is available in &$mime_decoded_filename$& after decoding.
32098.next
32099A full path name starting with a slash. If the full name is an existing
32100directory, it is used as a replacement for the default directory. The filename
32101is then sequentially assigned. If the path does not exist, it is used as
32102the full path and file name.
32103.next
32104If the string does not start with a slash, it is used as the
32105filename, and the default path is then used.
32106.endlist
32107The &%decode%& condition normally succeeds. It is only false for syntax
32108errors or unusual circumstances such as memory shortages. You can easily decode
32109a file with its original, proposed filename using
32110.code
32111decode = $mime_filename
32112.endd
32113However, you should keep in mind that &$mime_filename$& might contain
32114anything. If you place files outside of the default path, they are not
32115automatically unlinked.
32116
32117For RFC822 attachments (these are messages attached to messages, with a
32118content-type of &"message/rfc822"&), the ACL is called again in the same manner
32119as for the primary message, only that the &$mime_is_rfc822$& expansion
32120variable is set (see below). Attached messages are always decoded to disk
32121before being checked, and the files are unlinked once the check is done.
32122
32123The MIME ACL supports the &%regex%& and &%mime_regex%& conditions. These can be
32124used to match regular expressions against raw and decoded MIME parts,
32125respectively. They are described in section &<<SECTscanregex>>&.
32126
32127.cindex "MIME content scanning" "returned variables"
32128The following list describes all expansion variables that are
32129available in the MIME ACL:
32130
32131.vlist
32132.vitem &$mime_boundary$&
32133If the current part is a multipart (see &$mime_is_multipart$&) below, it should
32134have a boundary string, which is stored in this variable. If the current part
32135has no boundary parameter in the &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable
32136contains the empty string.
32137
32138.vitem &$mime_charset$&
32139This variable contains the character set identifier, if one was found in the
32140&'Content-Type:'& header. Examples for charset identifiers are:
32141.code
32142us-ascii
32143gb2312 (Chinese)
32144iso-8859-1
32145.endd
32146Please note that this value is not normalized, so you should do matches
32147case-insensitively.
32148
32149.vitem &$mime_content_description$&
32150This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Description:'&
32151header. It can contain a human-readable description of the parts content. Some
32152implementations repeat the filename for attachments here, but they are usually
32153only used for display purposes.
32154
32155.vitem &$mime_content_disposition$&
32156This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Disposition:'&
32157header. You can expect strings like &"attachment"& or &"inline"& here.
32158
32159.vitem &$mime_content_id$&
32160This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-ID:'& header.
32161This is a unique ID that can be used to reference a part from another part.
32162
32163.vitem &$mime_content_size$&
32164This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
32165successfully run. It contains the size of the decoded part in kilobytes. The
32166size is always rounded up to full kilobytes, so only a completely empty part
32167has a &$mime_content_size$& of zero.
32168
32169.vitem &$mime_content_transfer_encoding$&
32170This variable contains the normalized content of the
32171&'Content-transfer-encoding:'& header. This is a symbolic name for an encoding
32172type. Typical values are &"base64"& and &"quoted-printable"&.
32173
32174.vitem &$mime_content_type$&
32175If the MIME part has a &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains its
32176value, lowercased, and without any options (like &"name"& or &"charset"&). Here
32177are some examples of popular MIME types, as they may appear in this variable:
32178.code
32179text/plain
32180text/html
32181application/octet-stream
32182image/jpeg
32183audio/midi
32184.endd
32185If the MIME part has no &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains the
32186empty string.
32187
32188.vitem &$mime_decoded_filename$&
32189This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
32190successfully run. It contains the full path and file name of the file
32191containing the decoded data.
32192.endlist
32193
32194.cindex "RFC 2047"
32195.vlist
32196.vitem &$mime_filename$&
32197This is perhaps the most important of the MIME variables. It contains a
32198proposed filename for an attachment, if one was found in either the
32199&'Content-Type:'& or &'Content-Disposition:'& headers. The filename will be
32200RFC2047
32201or RFC2231
32202decoded, but no additional sanity checks are done.
32203 If no filename was
32204found, this variable contains the empty string.
32205
32206.vitem &$mime_is_coverletter$&
32207This variable attempts to differentiate the &"cover letter"& of an e-mail from
32208attached data. It can be used to clamp down on flashy or unnecessarily encoded
32209content in the cover letter, while not restricting attachments at all.
32210
32211The variable contains 1 (true) for a MIME part believed to be part of the
32212cover letter, and 0 (false) for an attachment. At present, the algorithm is as
32213follows:
32214
32215.olist
32216The outermost MIME part of a message is always a cover letter.
32217
32218.next
32219If a multipart/alternative or multipart/related MIME part is a cover letter,
32220so are all MIME subparts within that multipart.
32221
32222.next
32223If any other multipart is a cover letter, the first subpart is a cover letter,
32224and the rest are attachments.
32225
32226.next
32227All parts contained within an attachment multipart are attachments.
32228.endlist olist
32229
32230As an example, the following will ban &"HTML mail"& (including that sent with
32231alternative plain text), while allowing HTML files to be attached. HTML
32232coverletter mail attached to non-HMTL coverletter mail will also be allowed:
32233.code
32234deny message = HTML mail is not accepted here
32235!condition = $mime_is_rfc822
32236condition = $mime_is_coverletter
32237condition = ${if eq{$mime_content_type}{text/html}{1}{0}}
32238.endd
32239.vitem &$mime_is_multipart$&
32240This variable has the value 1 (true) when the current part has the main type
32241&"multipart"&, for example &"multipart/alternative"& or &"multipart/mixed"&.
32242Since multipart entities only serve as containers for other parts, you may not
32243want to carry out specific actions on them.
32244
32245.vitem &$mime_is_rfc822$&
32246This variable has the value 1 (true) if the current part is not a part of the
32247checked message itself, but part of an attached message. Attached message
32248decoding is fully recursive.
32249
32250.vitem &$mime_part_count$&
32251This variable is a counter that is raised for each processed MIME part. It
32252starts at zero for the very first part (which is usually a multipart). The
32253counter is per-message, so it is reset when processing RFC822 attachments (see
32254&$mime_is_rfc822$&). The counter stays set after &%acl_smtp_mime%& is
32255complete, so you can use it in the DATA ACL to determine the number of MIME
32256parts of a message. For non-MIME messages, this variable contains the value -1.
32257.endlist
32258
32259
32260
32261.section "Scanning with regular expressions" "SECTscanregex"
32262.cindex "content scanning" "with regular expressions"
32263.cindex "regular expressions" "content scanning with"
32264You can specify your own custom regular expression matches on the full body of
32265the message, or on individual MIME parts.
32266
32267The &%regex%& condition takes one or more regular expressions as arguments and
32268matches them against the full message (when called in the DATA ACL) or a raw
32269MIME part (when called in the MIME ACL). The &%regex%& condition matches
32270linewise, with a maximum line length of 32K characters. That means you cannot
32271have multiline matches with the &%regex%& condition.
32272
32273The &%mime_regex%& condition can be called only in the MIME ACL. It matches up
32274to 32K of decoded content (the whole content at once, not linewise). If the
32275part has not been decoded with the &%decode%& modifier earlier in the ACL, it
32276is decoded automatically when &%mime_regex%& is executed (using default path
32277and filename values). If the decoded data is larger than 32K, only the first
3227832K characters are checked.
32279
32280The regular expressions are passed as a colon-separated list. To include a
32281literal colon, you must double it. Since the whole right-hand side string is
32282expanded before being used, you must also escape dollar signs and backslashes
32283with more backslashes, or use the &`\N`& facility to disable expansion.
32284Here is a simple example that contains two regular expressions:
32285.code
32286deny message = contains blacklisted regex ($regex_match_string)
32287 regex = [Mm]ortgage : URGENT BUSINESS PROPOSAL
32288.endd
32289The conditions returns true if any one of the regular expressions matches. The
32290&$regex_match_string$& expansion variable is then set up and contains the
32291matching regular expression.
32292The expansion variables &$regex1$& &$regex2$& etc
32293are set to any substrings captured by the regular expression.
32294
32295&*Warning*&: With large messages, these conditions can be fairly
32296CPU-intensive.
32297
32298.ecindex IIDcosca
32299
32300
32301
32302
32303. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32304. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32305
32306.chapter "Adding a local scan function to Exim" "CHAPlocalscan" &&&
32307 "Local scan function"
32308.scindex IIDlosca "&[local_scan()]& function" "description of"
32309.cindex "customizing" "input scan using C function"
32310.cindex "policy control" "by local scan function"
32311In these days of email worms, viruses, and ever-increasing spam, some sites
32312want to apply a lot of checking to messages before accepting them.
32313
32314The content scanning extension (chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&) has facilities for
32315passing messages to external virus and spam scanning software. You can also do
32316a certain amount in Exim itself through string expansions and the &%condition%&
32317condition in the ACL that runs after the SMTP DATA command or the ACL for
32318non-SMTP messages (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), but this has its limitations.
32319
32320To allow for further customization to a site's own requirements, there is the
32321possibility of linking Exim with a private message scanning function, written
32322in C. If you want to run code that is written in something other than C, you
32323can of course use a little C stub to call it.
32324
32325The local scan function is run once for every incoming message, at the point
32326when Exim is just about to accept the message.
32327It can therefore be used to control non-SMTP messages from local processes as
32328well as messages arriving via SMTP.
32329
32330Exim applies a timeout to calls of the local scan function, and there is an
32331option called &%local_scan_timeout%& for setting it. The default is 5 minutes.
32332Zero means &"no timeout"&.
32333Exim also sets up signal handlers for SIGSEGV, SIGILL, SIGFPE, and SIGBUS
32334before calling the local scan function, so that the most common types of crash
32335are caught. If the timeout is exceeded or one of those signals is caught, the
32336incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP message.
32337For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a non-zero
32338code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
32339
32340
32341
32342.section "Building Exim to use a local scan function" "SECID207"
32343.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "building Exim to use"
32344To make use of the local scan function feature, you must tell Exim where your
32345function is before building Exim, by setting LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE in your
32346&_Local/Makefile_&. A recommended place to put it is in the &_Local_&
32347directory, so you might set
32348.code
32349LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE=Local/local_scan.c
32350.endd
32351for example. The function must be called &[local_scan()]&. It is called by
32352Exim after it has received a message, when the success return code is about to
32353be sent. This is after all the ACLs have been run. The return code from your
32354function controls whether the message is actually accepted or not. There is a
32355commented template function (that just accepts the message) in the file
32356_src/local_scan.c_.
32357
32358If you want to make use of Exim's run time configuration file to set options
32359for your &[local_scan()]& function, you must also set
32360.code
32361LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
32362.endd
32363in &_Local/Makefile_& (see section &<<SECTconoptloc>>& below).
32364
32365
32366
32367
32368.section "API for local_scan()" "SECTapiforloc"
32369.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "API description"
32370You must include this line near the start of your code:
32371.code
32372#include "local_scan.h"
32373.endd
32374This header file defines a number of variables and other values, and the
32375prototype for the function itself. Exim is coded to use unsigned char values
32376almost exclusively, and one of the things this header defines is a shorthand
32377for &`unsigned char`& called &`uschar`&.
32378It also contains the following macro definitions, to simplify casting character
32379strings and pointers to character strings:
32380.code
32381#define CS (char *)
32382#define CCS (const char *)
32383#define CSS (char **)
32384#define US (unsigned char *)
32385#define CUS (const unsigned char *)
32386#define USS (unsigned char **)
32387.endd
32388The function prototype for &[local_scan()]& is:
32389.code
32390extern int local_scan(int fd, uschar **return_text);
32391.endd
32392The arguments are as follows:
32393
32394.ilist
32395&%fd%& is a file descriptor for the file that contains the body of the message
32396(the -D file). The file is open for reading and writing, but updating it is not
32397recommended. &*Warning*&: You must &'not'& close this file descriptor.
32398
32399The descriptor is positioned at character 19 of the file, which is the first
32400character of the body itself, because the first 19 characters are the message
32401id followed by &`-D`& and a newline. If you rewind the file, you should use the
32402macro SPOOL_DATA_START_OFFSET to reset to the start of the data, just in
32403case this changes in some future version.
32404.next
32405&%return_text%& is an address which you can use to return a pointer to a text
32406string at the end of the function. The value it points to on entry is NULL.
32407.endlist
32408
32409The function must return an &%int%& value which is one of the following macros:
32410
32411.vlist
32412.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&
32413.vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
32414The message is accepted. If you pass back a string of text, it is saved with
32415the message, and made available in the variable &$local_scan_data$&. No
32416newlines are permitted (if there are any, they are turned into spaces) and the
32417maximum length of text is 1000 characters.
32418
32419.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_FREEZE`&
32420This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
32421queued without immediate delivery, and is frozen.
32422
32423.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_QUEUE`&
32424This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
32425queued without immediate delivery.
32426
32427.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT`&
32428The message is rejected; the returned text is used as an error message which is
32429passed back to the sender and which is also logged. Newlines are permitted &--
32430they cause a multiline response for SMTP rejections, but are converted to
32431&`\n`& in log lines. If no message is given, &"Administrative prohibition"& is
32432used.
32433
32434.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT`&
32435The message is temporarily rejected; the returned text is used as an error
32436message as for LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT. If no message is given, &"Temporary local
32437problem"& is used.
32438
32439.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
32440This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, except that the header of the rejected
32441message is not written to the reject log. It has the effect of unsetting the
32442&%rejected_header%& log selector for just this rejection. If
32443&%rejected_header%& is already unset (see the discussion of the
32444&%log_selection%& option in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&), this code is the
32445same as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
32446
32447.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
32448This code is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT in the same way that
32449LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
32450.endlist
32451
32452If the message is not being received by interactive SMTP, rejections are
32453reported by writing to &%stderr%& or by sending an email, as configured by the
32454&%-oe%& command line options.
32455
32456
32457
32458.section "Configuration options for local_scan()" "SECTconoptloc"
32459.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "configuration options"
32460It is possible to have option settings in the main configuration file
32461that set values in static variables in the &[local_scan()]& module. If you
32462want to do this, you must have the line
32463.code
32464LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
32465.endd
32466in your &_Local/Makefile_& when you build Exim. (This line is in
32467&_OS/Makefile-Default_&, commented out). Then, in the &[local_scan()]& source
32468file, you must define static variables to hold the option values, and a table
32469to define them.
32470
32471The table must be a vector called &%local_scan_options%&, of type
32472&`optionlist`&. Each entry is a triplet, consisting of a name, an option type,
32473and a pointer to the variable that holds the value. The entries must appear in
32474alphabetical order. Following &%local_scan_options%& you must also define a
32475variable called &%local_scan_options_count%& that contains the number of
32476entries in the table. Here is a short example, showing two kinds of option:
32477.code
32478static int my_integer_option = 42;
32479static uschar *my_string_option = US"a default string";
32480
32481optionlist local_scan_options[] = {
32482 { "my_integer", opt_int, &my_integer_option },
32483 { "my_string", opt_stringptr, &my_string_option }
32484};
32485
32486int local_scan_options_count =
32487 sizeof(local_scan_options)/sizeof(optionlist);
32488.endd
32489The values of the variables can now be changed from Exim's runtime
32490configuration file by including a local scan section as in this example:
32491.code
32492begin local_scan
32493my_integer = 99
32494my_string = some string of text...
32495.endd
32496The available types of option data are as follows:
32497
32498.vlist
32499.vitem &*opt_bool*&
32500This specifies a boolean (true/false) option. The address should point to a
32501variable of type &`BOOL`&, which will be set to TRUE or FALSE, which are macros
32502that are defined as &"1"& and &"0"&, respectively. If you want to detect
32503whether such a variable has been set at all, you can initialize it to
32504TRUE_UNSET. (BOOL variables are integers underneath, so can hold more than two
32505values.)
32506
32507.vitem &*opt_fixed*&
32508This specifies a fixed point number, such as is used for load averages.
32509The address should point to a variable of type &`int`&. The value is stored
32510multiplied by 1000, so, for example, 1.4142 is truncated and stored as 1414.
32511
32512.vitem &*opt_int*&
32513This specifies an integer; the address should point to a variable of type
32514&`int`&. The value may be specified in any of the integer formats accepted by
32515Exim.
32516
32517.vitem &*opt_mkint*&
32518This is the same as &%opt_int%&, except that when such a value is output in a
32519&%-bP%& listing, if it is an exact number of kilobytes or megabytes, it is
32520printed with the suffix K or M.
32521
32522.vitem &*opt_octint*&
32523This also specifies an integer, but the value is always interpreted as an
32524octal integer, whether or not it starts with the digit zero, and it is
32525always output in octal.
32526
32527.vitem &*opt_stringptr*&
32528This specifies a string value; the address must be a pointer to a
32529variable that points to a string (for example, of type &`uschar *`&).
32530
32531.vitem &*opt_time*&
32532This specifies a time interval value. The address must point to a variable of
32533type &`int`&. The value that is placed there is a number of seconds.
32534.endlist
32535
32536If the &%-bP%& command line option is followed by &`local_scan`&, Exim prints
32537out the values of all the &[local_scan()]& options.
32538
32539
32540
32541.section "Available Exim variables" "SECID208"
32542.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim variables"
32543The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of C variables. These
32544are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to release.
32545Note, however, that you can obtain the value of any Exim expansion variable,
32546including &$recipients$&, by calling &'expand_string()'&. The exported
32547C variables are as follows:
32548
32549.vlist
32550.vitem &*int&~body_linecount*&
32551This variable contains the number of lines in the message's body.
32552.new
32553It is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
32554.wen
32555
32556.vitem &*int&~body_zerocount*&
32557This variable contains the number of binary zero bytes in the message's body.
32558.new
32559It is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
32560.wen
32561
32562.vitem &*unsigned&~int&~debug_selector*&
32563This variable is set to zero when no debugging is taking place. Otherwise, it
32564is a bitmap of debugging selectors. Two bits are identified for use in
32565&[local_scan()]&; they are defined as macros:
32566
32567.ilist
32568The &`D_v`& bit is set when &%-v%& was present on the command line. This is a
32569testing option that is not privileged &-- any caller may set it. All the
32570other selector bits can be set only by admin users.
32571
32572.next
32573The &`D_local_scan`& bit is provided for use by &[local_scan()]&; it is set
32574by the &`+local_scan`& debug selector. It is not included in the default set
32575of debugging bits.
32576.endlist ilist
32577
32578Thus, to write to the debugging output only when &`+local_scan`& has been
32579selected, you should use code like this:
32580.code
32581if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
32582 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
32583.endd
32584.vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string_message*&
32585After a failing call to &'expand_string()'& (returned value NULL), the
32586variable &%expand_string_message%& contains the error message, zero-terminated.
32587
32588.vitem &*header_line&~*header_list*&
32589A pointer to a chain of header lines. The &%header_line%& structure is
32590discussed below.
32591
32592.vitem &*header_line&~*header_last*&
32593A pointer to the last of the header lines.
32594
32595.vitem &*uschar&~*headers_charset*&
32596The value of the &%headers_charset%& configuration option.
32597
32598.vitem &*BOOL&~host_checking*&
32599This variable is TRUE during a host checking session that is initiated by the
32600&%-bh%& command line option.
32601
32602.vitem &*uschar&~*interface_address*&
32603The IP address of the interface that received the message, as a string. This
32604is NULL for locally submitted messages.
32605
32606.vitem &*int&~interface_port*&
32607The port on which this message was received. When testing with the &%-bh%&
32608command line option, the value of this variable is -1 unless a port has been
32609specified via the &%-oMi%& option.
32610
32611.vitem &*uschar&~*message_id*&
32612This variable contains Exim's message id for the incoming message (the value of
32613&$message_exim_id$&) as a zero-terminated string.
32614
32615.vitem &*uschar&~*received_protocol*&
32616The name of the protocol by which the message was received.
32617
32618.vitem &*int&~recipients_count*&
32619The number of accepted recipients.
32620
32621.vitem &*recipient_item&~*recipients_list*&
32622.cindex "recipient" "adding in local scan"
32623.cindex "recipient" "removing in local scan"
32624The list of accepted recipients, held in a vector of length
32625&%recipients_count%&. The &%recipient_item%& structure is discussed below. You
32626can add additional recipients by calling &'receive_add_recipient()'& (see
32627below). You can delete recipients by removing them from the vector and
32628adjusting the value in &%recipients_count%&. In particular, by setting
32629&%recipients_count%& to zero you remove all recipients. If you then return the
32630value &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&, the message is accepted, but immediately
32631blackholed. To replace the recipients, you can set &%recipients_count%& to zero
32632and then call &'receive_add_recipient()'& as often as needed.
32633
32634.vitem &*uschar&~*sender_address*&
32635The envelope sender address. For bounce messages this is the empty string.
32636
32637.vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_address*&
32638The IP address of the sending host, as a string. This is NULL for
32639locally-submitted messages.
32640
32641.vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_authenticated*&
32642The name of the authentication mechanism that was used, or NULL if the message
32643was not received over an authenticated SMTP connection.
32644
32645.vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_name*&
32646The name of the sending host, if known.
32647
32648.vitem &*int&~sender_host_port*&
32649The port on the sending host.
32650
32651.vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_input*&
32652This variable is TRUE for all SMTP input, including BSMTP.
32653
32654.vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_batched_input*&
32655This variable is TRUE for BSMTP input.
32656
32657.vitem &*int&~store_pool*&
32658The contents of this variable control which pool of memory is used for new
32659requests. See section &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& for details.
32660.endlist
32661
32662
32663.section "Structure of header lines" "SECID209"
32664The &%header_line%& structure contains the members listed below.
32665You can add additional header lines by calling the &'header_add()'& function
32666(see below). You can cause header lines to be ignored (deleted) by setting
32667their type to *.
32668
32669
32670.vlist
32671.vitem &*struct&~header_line&~*next*&
32672A pointer to the next header line, or NULL for the last line.
32673
32674.vitem &*int&~type*&
32675A code identifying certain headers that Exim recognizes. The codes are printing
32676characters, and are documented in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>& of this manual.
32677Notice in particular that any header line whose type is * is not transmitted
32678with the message. This flagging is used for header lines that have been
32679rewritten, or are to be removed (for example, &'Envelope-sender:'& header
32680lines.) Effectively, * means &"deleted"&.
32681
32682.vitem &*int&~slen*&
32683The number of characters in the header line, including the terminating and any
32684internal newlines.
32685
32686.vitem &*uschar&~*text*&
32687A pointer to the text of the header. It always ends with a newline, followed by
32688a zero byte. Internal newlines are preserved.
32689.endlist
32690
32691
32692
32693.section "Structure of recipient items" "SECID210"
32694The &%recipient_item%& structure contains these members:
32695
32696.vlist
32697.vitem &*uschar&~*address*&
32698This is a pointer to the recipient address as it was received.
32699
32700.vitem &*int&~pno*&
32701This is used in later Exim processing when top level addresses are created by
32702the &%one_time%& option. It is not relevant at the time &[local_scan()]& is run
32703and must always contain -1 at this stage.
32704
32705.vitem &*uschar&~*errors_to*&
32706If this value is not NULL, bounce messages caused by failing to deliver to the
32707recipient are sent to the address it contains. In other words, it overrides the
32708envelope sender for this one recipient. (Compare the &%errors_to%& generic
32709router option.) If a &[local_scan()]& function sets an &%errors_to%& field to
32710an unqualified address, Exim qualifies it using the domain from
32711&%qualify_recipient%&. When &[local_scan()]& is called, the &%errors_to%& field
32712is NULL for all recipients.
32713.endlist
32714
32715
32716
32717.section "Available Exim functions" "SECID211"
32718.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim functions"
32719The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of Exim functions.
32720These are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to
32721release:
32722
32723.vlist
32724.vitem "&*pid_t&~child_open(uschar&~**argv,&~uschar&~**envp,&~int&~newumask,&&&
32725 &~int&~*infdptr,&~int&~*outfdptr, &~&~BOOL&~make_leader)*&"
32726
32727This function creates a child process that runs the command specified by
32728&%argv%&. The environment for the process is specified by &%envp%&, which can
32729be NULL if no environment variables are to be passed. A new umask is supplied
32730for the process in &%newumask%&.
32731
32732Pipes to the standard input and output of the new process are set up
32733and returned to the caller via the &%infdptr%& and &%outfdptr%& arguments. The
32734standard error is cloned to the standard output. If there are any file
32735descriptors &"in the way"& in the new process, they are closed. If the final
32736argument is TRUE, the new process is made into a process group leader.
32737
32738The function returns the pid of the new process, or -1 if things go wrong.
32739
32740.vitem &*int&~child_close(pid_t&~pid,&~int&~timeout)*&
32741This function waits for a child process to terminate, or for a timeout (in
32742seconds) to expire. A timeout value of zero means wait as long as it takes. The
32743return value is as follows:
32744
32745.ilist
32746>= 0
32747
32748The process terminated by a normal exit and the value is the process
32749ending status.
32750
32751.next
32752< 0 and > &--256
32753
32754The process was terminated by a signal and the value is the negation of the
32755signal number.
32756
32757.next
32758&--256
32759
32760The process timed out.
32761.next
32762&--257
32763
32764The was some other error in wait(); &%errno%& is still set.
32765.endlist
32766
32767.vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim(int&~*fd)*&
32768This function provide you with a means of submitting a new message to
32769Exim. (Of course, you can also call &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& yourself if you
32770want, but this packages it all up for you.) The function creates a pipe,
32771forks a subprocess that is running
32772.code
32773exim -t -oem -oi -f <>
32774.endd
32775and returns to you (via the &`int *`& argument) a file descriptor for the pipe
32776that is connected to the standard input. The yield of the function is the PID
32777of the subprocess. You can then write a message to the file descriptor, with
32778recipients in &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and/or &'Bcc:'& header lines.
32779
32780When you have finished, call &'child_close()'& to wait for the process to
32781finish and to collect its ending status. A timeout value of zero is usually
32782fine in this circumstance. Unless you have made a mistake with the recipient
32783addresses, you should get a return code of zero.
32784
32785
32786.vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim2(int&~*fd,&~uschar&~*sender,&~uschar&~&&&
32787 *sender_authentication)*&
32788This function is a more sophisticated version of &'child_open()'&. The command
32789that it runs is:
32790.display
32791&`exim -t -oem -oi -f `&&'sender'&&` -oMas `&&'sender_authentication'&
32792.endd
32793The third argument may be NULL, in which case the &%-oMas%& option is omitted.
32794
32795
32796.vitem &*void&~debug_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
32797This is Exim's debugging function, with arguments as for &'(printf()'&. The
32798output is written to the standard error stream. If no debugging is selected,
32799calls to &'debug_printf()'& have no effect. Normally, you should make calls
32800conditional on the &`local_scan`& debug selector by coding like this:
32801.code
32802if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
32803 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
32804.endd
32805
32806.vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string(uschar&~*string)*&
32807This is an interface to Exim's string expansion code. The return value is the
32808expanded string, or NULL if there was an expansion failure.
32809The C variable &%expand_string_message%& contains an error message after an
32810expansion failure. If expansion does not change the string, the return value is
32811the pointer to the input string. Otherwise, the return value points to a new
32812block of memory that was obtained by a call to &'store_get()'&. See section
32813&<<SECTmemhanloc>>& below for a discussion of memory handling.
32814
32815.vitem &*void&~header_add(int&~type,&~char&~*format,&~...)*&
32816This function allows you to an add additional header line at the end of the
32817existing ones. The first argument is the type, and should normally be a space
32818character. The second argument is a format string and any number of
32819substitution arguments as for &[sprintf()]&. You may include internal newlines
32820if you want, and you must ensure that the string ends with a newline.
32821
32822.vitem "&*void&~header_add_at_position(BOOL&~after,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
32823 BOOL&~topnot,&~int&~type,&~char&~*format, &~&~...)*&"
32824This function adds a new header line at a specified point in the header
32825chain. The header itself is specified as for &'header_add()'&.
32826
32827If &%name%& is NULL, the new header is added at the end of the chain if
32828&%after%& is true, or at the start if &%after%& is false. If &%name%& is not
32829NULL, the header lines are searched for the first non-deleted header that
32830matches the name. If one is found, the new header is added before it if
32831&%after%& is false. If &%after%& is true, the new header is added after the
32832found header and any adjacent subsequent ones with the same name (even if
32833marked &"deleted"&). If no matching non-deleted header is found, the &%topnot%&
32834option controls where the header is added. If it is true, addition is at the
32835top; otherwise at the bottom. Thus, to add a header after all the &'Received:'&
32836headers, or at the top if there are no &'Received:'& headers, you could use
32837.code
32838header_add_at_position(TRUE, US"Received", TRUE,
32839 ' ', "X-xxx: ...");
32840.endd
32841Normally, there is always at least one non-deleted &'Received:'& header, but
32842there may not be if &%received_header_text%& expands to an empty string.
32843
32844
32845.vitem &*void&~header_remove(int&~occurrence,&~uschar&~*name)*&
32846This function removes header lines. If &%occurrence%& is zero or negative, all
32847occurrences of the header are removed. If occurrence is greater than zero, that
32848particular instance of the header is removed. If no header(s) can be found that
32849match the specification, the function does nothing.
32850
32851
32852.vitem "&*BOOL&~header_testname(header_line&~*hdr,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
32853 int&~length,&~BOOL&~notdel)*&"
32854This function tests whether the given header has the given name. It is not just
32855a string comparison, because white space is permitted between the name and the
32856colon. If the &%notdel%& argument is true, a false return is forced for all
32857&"deleted"& headers; otherwise they are not treated specially. For example:
32858.code
32859if (header_testname(h, US"X-Spam", 6, TRUE)) ...
32860.endd
32861.vitem &*uschar&~*lss_b64encode(uschar&~*cleartext,&~int&~length)*&
32862.cindex "base64 encoding" "functions for &[local_scan()]& use"
32863This function base64-encodes a string, which is passed by address and length.
32864The text may contain bytes of any value, including zero. The result is passed
32865back in dynamic memory that is obtained by calling &'store_get()'&. It is
32866zero-terminated.
32867
32868.vitem &*int&~lss_b64decode(uschar&~*codetext,&~uschar&~**cleartext)*&
32869This function decodes a base64-encoded string. Its arguments are a
32870zero-terminated base64-encoded string and the address of a variable that is set
32871to point to the result, which is in dynamic memory. The length of the decoded
32872string is the yield of the function. If the input is invalid base64 data, the
32873yield is -1. A zero byte is added to the end of the output string to make it
32874easy to interpret as a C string (assuming it contains no zeros of its own). The
32875added zero byte is not included in the returned count.
32876
32877.vitem &*int&~lss_match_domain(uschar&~*domain,&~uschar&~*list)*&
32878This function checks for a match in a domain list. Domains are always
32879matched caselessly. The return value is one of the following:
32880.display
32881&`OK `& match succeeded
32882&`FAIL `& match failed
32883&`DEFER `& match deferred
32884.endd
32885DEFER is usually caused by some kind of lookup defer, such as the
32886inability to contact a database.
32887
32888.vitem "&*int&~lss_match_local_part(uschar&~*localpart,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
32889 BOOL&~caseless)*&"
32890This function checks for a match in a local part list. The third argument
32891controls case-sensitivity. The return values are as for
32892&'lss_match_domain()'&.
32893
32894.vitem "&*int&~lss_match_address(uschar&~*address,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
32895 BOOL&~caseless)*&"
32896This function checks for a match in an address list. The third argument
32897controls the case-sensitivity of the local part match. The domain is always
32898matched caselessly. The return values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&.
32899
32900.vitem "&*int&~lss_match_host(uschar&~*host_name,&~uschar&~*host_address,&~&&&
32901 uschar&~*list)*&"
32902This function checks for a match in a host list. The most common usage is
32903expected to be
32904.code
32905lss_match_host(sender_host_name, sender_host_address, ...)
32906.endd
32907.vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
32908An empty address field matches an empty item in the host list. If the host name
32909is NULL, the name corresponding to &$sender_host_address$& is automatically
32910looked up if a host name is required to match an item in the list. The return
32911values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&, but in addition, &'lss_match_host()'&
32912returns ERROR in the case when it had to look up a host name, but the lookup
32913failed.
32914
32915.vitem "&*void&~log_write(unsigned&~int&~selector,&~int&~which,&~char&~&&&
32916 *format,&~...)*&"
32917This function writes to Exim's log files. The first argument should be zero (it
32918is concerned with &%log_selector%&). The second argument can be &`LOG_MAIN`& or
32919&`LOG_REJECT`& or &`LOG_PANIC`& or the inclusive &"or"& of any combination of
32920them. It specifies to which log or logs the message is written. The remaining
32921arguments are a format and relevant insertion arguments. The string should not
32922contain any newlines, not even at the end.
32923
32924
32925.vitem &*void&~receive_add_recipient(uschar&~*address,&~int&~pno)*&
32926This function adds an additional recipient to the message. The first argument
32927is the recipient address. If it is unqualified (has no domain), it is qualified
32928with the &%qualify_recipient%& domain. The second argument must always be -1.
32929
32930This function does not allow you to specify a private &%errors_to%& address (as
32931described with the structure of &%recipient_item%& above), because it pre-dates
32932the addition of that field to the structure. However, it is easy to add such a
32933value afterwards. For example:
32934.code
32935 receive_add_recipient(US"monitor@mydom.example", -1);
32936 recipients_list[recipients_count-1].errors_to =
32937 US"postmaster@mydom.example";
32938.endd
32939
32940.vitem &*BOOL&~receive_remove_recipient(uschar&~*recipient)*&
32941This is a convenience function to remove a named recipient from the list of
32942recipients. It returns true if a recipient was removed, and false if no
32943matching recipient could be found. The argument must be a complete email
32944address.
32945.endlist
32946
32947
32948.cindex "RFC 2047"
32949.vlist
32950.vitem "&*uschar&~rfc2047_decode(uschar&~*string,&~BOOL&~lencheck,&&&
32951 &~uschar&~*target,&~int&~zeroval,&~int&~*lenptr, &~&~uschar&~**error)*&"
32952This function decodes strings that are encoded according to RFC 2047. Typically
32953these are the contents of header lines. First, each &"encoded word"& is decoded
32954from the Q or B encoding into a byte-string. Then, if provided with the name of
32955a charset encoding, and if the &[iconv()]& function is available, an attempt is
32956made to translate the result to the named character set. If this fails, the
32957binary string is returned with an error message.
32958
32959The first argument is the string to be decoded. If &%lencheck%& is TRUE, the
32960maximum MIME word length is enforced. The third argument is the target
32961encoding, or NULL if no translation is wanted.
32962
32963.cindex "binary zero" "in RFC 2047 decoding"
32964.cindex "RFC 2047" "binary zero in"
32965If a binary zero is encountered in the decoded string, it is replaced by the
32966contents of the &%zeroval%& argument. For use with Exim headers, the value must
32967not be 0 because header lines are handled as zero-terminated strings.
32968
32969The function returns the result of processing the string, zero-terminated; if
32970&%lenptr%& is not NULL, the length of the result is set in the variable to
32971which it points. When &%zeroval%& is 0, &%lenptr%& should not be NULL.
32972
32973If an error is encountered, the function returns NULL and uses the &%error%&
32974argument to return an error message. The variable pointed to by &%error%& is
32975set to NULL if there is no error; it may be set non-NULL even when the function
32976returns a non-NULL value if decoding was successful, but there was a problem
32977with translation.
32978
32979
32980.vitem &*int&~smtp_fflush(void)*&
32981This function is used in conjunction with &'smtp_printf()'&, as described
32982below.
32983
32984.vitem &*void&~smtp_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
32985The arguments of this function are like &[printf()]&; it writes to the SMTP
32986output stream. You should use this function only when there is an SMTP output
32987stream, that is, when the incoming message is being received via interactive
32988SMTP. This is the case when &%smtp_input%& is TRUE and &%smtp_batched_input%&
32989is FALSE. If you want to test for an incoming message from another host (as
32990opposed to a local process that used the &%-bs%& command line option), you can
32991test the value of &%sender_host_address%&, which is non-NULL when a remote host
32992is involved.
32993
32994If an SMTP TLS connection is established, &'smtp_printf()'& uses the TLS
32995output function, so it can be used for all forms of SMTP connection.
32996
32997Strings that are written by &'smtp_printf()'& from within &[local_scan()]&
32998must start with an appropriate response code: 550 if you are going to return
32999LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, 451 if you are going to return
33000LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT, and 250 otherwise. Because you are writing the
33001initial lines of a multi-line response, the code must be followed by a hyphen
33002to indicate that the line is not the final response line. You must also ensure
33003that the lines you write terminate with CRLF. For example:
33004.code
33005smtp_printf("550-this is some extra info\r\n");
33006return LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT;
33007.endd
33008Note that you can also create multi-line responses by including newlines in
33009the data returned via the &%return_text%& argument. The added value of using
33010&'smtp_printf()'& is that, for instance, you could introduce delays between
33011multiple output lines.
33012
33013The &'smtp_printf()'& function does not return any error indication, because it
33014does not automatically flush pending output, and therefore does not test
33015the state of the stream. (In the main code of Exim, flushing and error
33016detection is done when Exim is ready for the next SMTP input command.) If
33017you want to flush the output and check for an error (for example, the
33018dropping of a TCP/IP connection), you can call &'smtp_fflush()'&, which has no
33019arguments. It flushes the output stream, and returns a non-zero value if there
33020is an error.
33021
33022.vitem &*void&~*store_get(int)*&
33023This function accesses Exim's internal store (memory) manager. It gets a new
33024chunk of memory whose size is given by the argument. Exim bombs out if it ever
33025runs out of memory. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
33026
33027.vitem &*void&~*store_get_perm(int)*&
33028This function is like &'store_get()'&, but it always gets memory from the
33029permanent pool. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
33030
33031.vitem &*uschar&~*string_copy(uschar&~*string)*&
33032See below.
33033
33034.vitem &*uschar&~*string_copyn(uschar&~*string,&~int&~length)*&
33035See below.
33036
33037.vitem &*uschar&~*string_sprintf(char&~*format,&~...)*&
33038These three functions create strings using Exim's dynamic memory facilities.
33039The first makes a copy of an entire string. The second copies up to a maximum
33040number of characters, indicated by the second argument. The third uses a format
33041and insertion arguments to create a new string. In each case, the result is a
33042pointer to a new string in the current memory pool. See the next section for
33043more discussion.
33044.endlist
33045
33046
33047
33048.section "More about Exim's memory handling" "SECTmemhanloc"
33049.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "memory handling"
33050No function is provided for freeing memory, because that is never needed.
33051The dynamic memory that Exim uses when receiving a message is automatically
33052recycled if another message is received by the same process (this applies only
33053to incoming SMTP connections &-- other input methods can supply only one
33054message at a time). After receiving the last message, a reception process
33055terminates.
33056
33057Because it is recycled, the normal dynamic memory cannot be used for holding
33058data that must be preserved over a number of incoming messages on the same SMTP
33059connection. However, Exim in fact uses two pools of dynamic memory; the second
33060one is not recycled, and can be used for this purpose.
33061
33062If you want to allocate memory that remains available for subsequent messages
33063in the same SMTP connection, you should set
33064.code
33065store_pool = POOL_PERM
33066.endd
33067before calling the function that does the allocation. There is no need to
33068restore the value if you do not need to; however, if you do want to revert to
33069the normal pool, you can either restore the previous value of &%store_pool%& or
33070set it explicitly to POOL_MAIN.
33071
33072The pool setting applies to all functions that get dynamic memory, including
33073&'expand_string()'&, &'store_get()'&, and the &'string_xxx()'& functions.
33074There is also a convenience function called &'store_get_perm()'& that gets a
33075block of memory from the permanent pool while preserving the value of
33076&%store_pool%&.
33077.ecindex IIDlosca
33078
33079
33080
33081
33082. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33083. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33084
33085.chapter "System-wide message filtering" "CHAPsystemfilter"
33086.scindex IIDsysfil1 "filter" "system filter"
33087.scindex IIDsysfil2 "filtering all mail"
33088.scindex IIDsysfil3 "system filter"
33089The previous chapters (on ACLs and the local scan function) describe checks
33090that can be applied to messages before they are accepted by a host. There is
33091also a mechanism for checking messages once they have been received, but before
33092they are delivered. This is called the &'system filter'&.
33093
33094The system filter operates in a similar manner to users' filter files, but it
33095is run just once per message (however many recipients the message has).
33096It should not normally be used as a substitute for routing, because &%deliver%&
33097commands in a system router provide new envelope recipient addresses.
33098The system filter must be an Exim filter. It cannot be a Sieve filter.
33099
33100The system filter is run at the start of a delivery attempt, before any routing
33101is done. If a message fails to be completely delivered at the first attempt,
33102the system filter is run again at the start of every retry.
33103If you want your filter to do something only once per message, you can make use
33104of the &%first_delivery%& condition in an &%if%& command in the filter to
33105prevent it happening on retries.
33106
33107.vindex "&$domain$&"
33108.vindex "&$local_part$&"
33109&*Warning*&: Because the system filter runs just once, variables that are
33110specific to individual recipient addresses, such as &$local_part$& and
33111&$domain$&, are not set, and the &"personal"& condition is not meaningful. If
33112you want to run a centrally-specified filter for each recipient address
33113independently, you can do so by setting up a suitable &(redirect)& router, as
33114described in section &<<SECTperaddfil>>& below.
33115
33116
33117.section "Specifying a system filter" "SECID212"
33118.cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
33119.cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
33120The name of the file that contains the system filter must be specified by
33121setting &%system_filter%&. If you want the filter to run under a uid and gid
33122other than root, you must also set &%system_filter_user%& and
33123&%system_filter_group%& as appropriate. For example:
33124.code
33125system_filter = /etc/mail/exim.filter
33126system_filter_user = exim
33127.endd
33128If a system filter generates any deliveries directly to files or pipes (via the
33129&%save%& or &%pipe%& commands), transports to handle these deliveries must be
33130specified by setting &%system_filter_file_transport%& and
33131&%system_filter_pipe_transport%&, respectively. Similarly,
33132&%system_filter_reply_transport%& must be set to handle any messages generated
33133by the &%reply%& command.
33134
33135
33136.section "Testing a system filter" "SECID213"
33137You can run simple tests of a system filter in the same way as for a user
33138filter, but you should use &%-bF%& rather than &%-bf%&, so that features that
33139are permitted only in system filters are recognized.
33140
33141If you want to test the combined effect of a system filter and a user filter,
33142you can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command line.
33143
33144
33145
33146.section "Contents of a system filter" "SECID214"
33147The language used to specify system filters is the same as for users' filter
33148files. It is described in the separate end-user document &'Exim's interface to
33149mail filtering'&. However, there are some additional features that are
33150available only in system filters; these are described in subsequent sections.
33151If they are encountered in a user's filter file or when testing with &%-bf%&,
33152they cause errors.
33153
33154.cindex "frozen messages" "manual thaw; testing in filter"
33155There are two special conditions which, though available in users' filter
33156files, are designed for use in system filters. The condition &%first_delivery%&
33157is true only for the first attempt at delivering a message, and
33158&%manually_thawed%& is true only if the message has been frozen, and
33159subsequently thawed by an admin user. An explicit forced delivery counts as a
33160manual thaw, but thawing as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& setting does not.
33161
33162&*Warning*&: If a system filter uses the &%first_delivery%& condition to
33163specify an &"unseen"& (non-significant) delivery, and that delivery does not
33164succeed, it will not be tried again.
33165If you want Exim to retry an unseen delivery until it succeeds, you should
33166arrange to set it up every time the filter runs.
33167
33168When a system filter finishes running, the values of the variables &$n0$& &--
33169&$n9$& are copied into &$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$& and are thereby made available to
33170users' filter files. Thus a system filter can, for example, set up &"scores"&
33171to which users' filter files can refer.
33172
33173
33174
33175.section "Additional variable for system filters" "SECID215"
33176.vindex "&$recipients$&"
33177The expansion variable &$recipients$&, containing a list of all the recipients
33178of the message (separated by commas and white space), is available in system
33179filters. It is not available in users' filters for privacy reasons.
33180
33181
33182
33183.section "Defer, freeze, and fail commands for system filters" "SECID216"
33184.cindex "freezing messages"
33185.cindex "message" "freezing"
33186.cindex "message" "forced failure"
33187.cindex "&%fail%&" "in system filter"
33188.cindex "&%freeze%& in system filter"
33189.cindex "&%defer%& in system filter"
33190There are three extra commands (&%defer%&, &%freeze%& and &%fail%&) which are
33191always available in system filters, but are not normally enabled in users'
33192filters. (See the &%allow_defer%&, &%allow_freeze%& and &%allow_fail%& options
33193for the &(redirect)& router.) These commands can optionally be followed by the
33194word &%text%& and a string containing an error message, for example:
33195.code
33196fail text "this message looks like spam to me"
33197.endd
33198The keyword &%text%& is optional if the next character is a double quote.
33199
33200The &%defer%& command defers delivery of the original recipients of the
33201message. The &%fail%& command causes all the original recipients to be failed,
33202and a bounce message to be created. The &%freeze%& command suspends all
33203delivery attempts for the original recipients. In all cases, any new deliveries
33204that are specified by the filter are attempted as normal after the filter has
33205run.
33206
33207The &%freeze%& command is ignored if the message has been manually unfrozen and
33208not manually frozen since. This means that automatic freezing by a system
33209filter can be used as a way of checking out suspicious messages. If a message
33210is found to be all right, manually unfreezing it allows it to be delivered.
33211
33212.cindex "log" "&%fail%& command log line"
33213.cindex "&%fail%&" "log line; reducing"
33214The text given with a fail command is used as part of the bounce message as
33215well as being written to the log. If the message is quite long, this can fill
33216up a lot of log space when such failures are common. To reduce the size of the
33217log message, Exim interprets the text in a special way if it starts with the
33218two characters &`<<`& and contains &`>>`& later. The text between these two
33219strings is written to the log, and the rest of the text is used in the bounce
33220message. For example:
33221.code
33222fail "<<filter test 1>>Your message is rejected \
33223 because it contains attachments that we are \
33224 not prepared to receive."
33225.endd
33226
33227.cindex "loop" "caused by &%fail%&"
33228Take great care with the &%fail%& command when basing the decision to fail on
33229the contents of the message, because the bounce message will of course include
33230the contents of the original message and will therefore trigger the &%fail%&
33231command again (causing a mail loop) unless steps are taken to prevent this.
33232Testing the &%error_message%& condition is one way to prevent this. You could
33233use, for example
33234.code
33235if $message_body contains "this is spam" and not error_message
33236then fail text "spam is not wanted here" endif
33237.endd
33238though of course that might let through unwanted bounce messages. The
33239alternative is clever checking of the body and/or headers to detect bounces
33240generated by the filter.
33241
33242The interpretation of a system filter file ceases after a
33243&%defer%&,
33244&%freeze%&, or &%fail%& command is obeyed. However, any deliveries that were
33245set up earlier in the filter file are honoured, so you can use a sequence such
33246as
33247.code
33248mail ...
33249freeze
33250.endd
33251to send a specified message when the system filter is freezing (or deferring or
33252failing) a message. The normal deliveries for the message do not, of course,
33253take place.
33254
33255
33256
33257.section "Adding and removing headers in a system filter" "SECTaddremheasys"
33258.cindex "header lines" "adding; in system filter"
33259.cindex "header lines" "removing; in system filter"
33260.cindex "filter" "header lines; adding/removing"
33261Two filter commands that are available only in system filters are:
33262.code
33263headers add <string>
33264headers remove <string>
33265.endd
33266The argument for the &%headers add%& is a string that is expanded and then
33267added to the end of the message's headers. It is the responsibility of the
33268filter maintainer to make sure it conforms to RFC 2822 syntax. Leading white
33269space is ignored, and if the string is otherwise empty, or if the expansion is
33270forced to fail, the command has no effect.
33271
33272You can use &"\n"& within the string, followed by white space, to specify
33273continued header lines. More than one header may be added in one command by
33274including &"\n"& within the string without any following white space. For
33275example:
33276.code
33277headers add "X-header-1: ....\n \
33278 continuation of X-header-1 ...\n\
33279 X-header-2: ...."
33280.endd
33281Note that the header line continuation white space after the first newline must
33282be placed before the backslash that continues the input string, because white
33283space after input continuations is ignored.
33284
33285The argument for &%headers remove%& is a colon-separated list of header names.
33286This command applies only to those headers that are stored with the message;
33287those that are added at delivery time (such as &'Envelope-To:'& and
33288&'Return-Path:'&) cannot be removed by this means. If there is more than one
33289header with the same name, they are all removed.
33290
33291The &%headers%& command in a system filter makes an immediate change to the set
33292of header lines that was received with the message (with possible additions
33293from ACL processing). Subsequent commands in the system filter operate on the
33294modified set, which also forms the basis for subsequent message delivery.
33295Unless further modified during routing or transporting, this set of headers is
33296used for all recipients of the message.
33297
33298During routing and transporting, the variables that refer to the contents of
33299header lines refer only to those lines that are in this set. Thus, header lines
33300that are added by a system filter are visible to users' filter files and to all
33301routers and transports. This contrasts with the manipulation of header lines by
33302routers and transports, which is not immediate, but which instead is saved up
33303until the message is actually being written (see section
33304&<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&).
33305
33306If the message is not delivered at the first attempt, header lines that were
33307added by the system filter are stored with the message, and so are still
33308present at the next delivery attempt. Header lines that were removed are still
33309present, but marked &"deleted"& so that they are not transported with the
33310message. For this reason, it is usual to make the &%headers%& command
33311conditional on &%first_delivery%& so that the set of header lines is not
33312modified more than once.
33313
33314Because header modification in a system filter acts immediately, you have to
33315use an indirect approach if you want to modify the contents of a header line.
33316For example:
33317.code
33318headers add "Old-Subject: $h_subject:"
33319headers remove "Subject"
33320headers add "Subject: new subject (was: $h_old-subject:)"
33321headers remove "Old-Subject"
33322.endd
33323
33324
33325
33326.section "Setting an errors address in a system filter" "SECID217"
33327.cindex "envelope sender"
33328In a system filter, if a &%deliver%& command is followed by
33329.code
33330errors_to <some address>
33331.endd
33332in order to change the envelope sender (and hence the error reporting) for that
33333delivery, any address may be specified. (In a user filter, only the current
33334user's address can be set.) For example, if some mail is being monitored, you
33335might use
33336.code
33337unseen deliver monitor@spying.example errors_to root@local.example
33338.endd
33339to take a copy which would not be sent back to the normal error reporting
33340address if its delivery failed.
33341
33342
33343
33344.section "Per-address filtering" "SECTperaddfil"
33345.vindex "&$domain$&"
33346.vindex "&$local_part$&"
33347In contrast to the system filter, which is run just once per message for each
33348delivery attempt, it is also possible to set up a system-wide filtering
33349operation that runs once for each recipient address. In this case, variables
33350such as &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used, and indeed, the choice of
33351filter file could be made dependent on them. This is an example of a router
33352which implements such a filter:
33353.code
33354central_filter:
33355 check_local_user
33356 driver = redirect
33357 domains = +local_domains
33358 file = /central/filters/$local_part
33359 no_verify
33360 allow_filter
33361 allow_freeze
33362.endd
33363The filter is run in a separate process under its own uid. Therefore, either
33364&%check_local_user%& must be set (as above), in which case the filter is run as
33365the local user, or the &%user%& option must be used to specify which user to
33366use. If both are set, &%user%& overrides.
33367
33368Care should be taken to ensure that none of the commands in the filter file
33369specify a significant delivery if the message is to go on to be delivered to
33370its intended recipient. The router will not then claim to have dealt with the
33371address, so it will be passed on to subsequent routers to be delivered in the
33372normal way.
33373.ecindex IIDsysfil1
33374.ecindex IIDsysfil2
33375.ecindex IIDsysfil3
33376
33377
33378
33379
33380
33381
33382. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33383. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33384
33385.chapter "Message processing" "CHAPmsgproc"
33386.scindex IIDmesproc "message" "general processing"
33387Exim performs various transformations on the sender and recipient addresses of
33388all messages that it handles, and also on the messages' header lines. Some of
33389these are optional and configurable, while others always take place. All of
33390this processing, except rewriting as a result of routing, and the addition or
33391removal of header lines while delivering, happens when a message is received,
33392before it is placed on Exim's queue.
33393
33394Some of the automatic processing takes place by default only for
33395&"locally-originated"& messages. This adjective is used to describe messages
33396that are not received over TCP/IP, but instead are passed to an Exim process on
33397its standard input. This includes the interactive &"local SMTP"& case that is
33398set up by the &%-bs%& command line option.
33399
33400&*Note*&: Messages received over TCP/IP on the loopback interface (127.0.0.1
33401or ::1) are not considered to be locally-originated. Exim does not treat the
33402loopback interface specially in any way.
33403
33404If you want the loopback interface to be treated specially, you must ensure
33405that there are appropriate entries in your ACLs.
33406
33407
33408
33409
33410.section "Submission mode for non-local messages" "SECTsubmodnon"
33411.cindex "message" "submission"
33412.cindex "submission mode"
33413Processing that happens automatically for locally-originated messages (unless
33414&%suppress_local_fixups%& is set) can also be requested for messages that are
33415received over TCP/IP. The term &"submission mode"& is used to describe this
33416state. Submission mode is set by the modifier
33417.code
33418control = submission
33419.endd
33420in a MAIL, RCPT, or pre-data ACL for an incoming message (see sections
33421&<<SECTACLmodi>>& and &<<SECTcontrols>>&). This makes Exim treat the message as
33422a local submission, and is normally used when the source of the message is
33423known to be an MUA running on a client host (as opposed to an MTA). For
33424example, to set submission mode for messages originating on the IPv4 loopback
33425interface, you could include the following in the MAIL ACL:
33426.code
33427warn hosts = 127.0.0.1
33428 control = submission
33429.endd
33430.cindex "&%sender_retain%& submission option"
33431There are some options that can be used when setting submission mode. A slash
33432is used to separate options. For example:
33433.code
33434control = submission/sender_retain
33435.endd
33436Specifying &%sender_retain%& has the effect of setting &%local_sender_retain%&
33437true and &%local_from_check%& false for the current incoming message. The first
33438of these allows an existing &'Sender:'& header in the message to remain, and
33439the second suppresses the check to ensure that &'From:'& matches the
33440authenticated sender. With this setting, Exim still fixes up messages by adding
33441&'Date:'& and &'Message-ID:'& header lines if they are missing, but makes no
33442attempt to check sender authenticity in header lines.
33443
33444When &%sender_retain%& is not set, a submission mode setting may specify a
33445domain to be used when generating a &'From:'& or &'Sender:'& header line. For
33446example:
33447.code
33448control = submission/domain=some.domain
33449.endd
33450The domain may be empty. How this value is used is described in sections
33451&<<SECTthefrohea>>& and &<<SECTthesenhea>>&. There is also a &%name%& option
33452that allows you to specify the user's full name for inclusion in a created
33453&'Sender:'& or &'From:'& header line. For example:
33454.code
33455accept authenticated = *
33456 control = submission/domain=wonderland.example/\
33457 name=${lookup {$authenticated_id} \
33458 lsearch {/etc/exim/namelist}}
33459.endd
33460Because the name may contain any characters, including slashes, the &%name%&
33461option must be given last. The remainder of the string is used as the name. For
33462the example above, if &_/etc/exim/namelist_& contains:
33463.code
33464bigegg: Humpty Dumpty
33465.endd
33466then when the sender has authenticated as &'bigegg'&, the generated &'Sender:'&
33467line would be:
33468.code
33469Sender: Humpty Dumpty <bigegg@wonderland.example>
33470.endd
33471.cindex "return path" "in submission mode"
33472By default, submission mode forces the return path to the same address as is
33473used to create the &'Sender:'& header. However, if &%sender_retain%& is
33474specified, the return path is also left unchanged.
33475
33476&*Note*&: The changes caused by submission mode take effect after the predata
33477ACL. This means that any sender checks performed before the fix-ups use the
33478untrusted sender address specified by the user, not the trusted sender address
33479specified by submission mode. Although this might be slightly unexpected, it
33480does mean that you can configure ACL checks to spot that a user is trying to
33481spoof another's address.
33482
33483.section "Line endings" "SECTlineendings"
33484.cindex "line endings"
33485.cindex "carriage return"
33486.cindex "linefeed"
33487RFC 2821 specifies that CRLF (two characters: carriage-return, followed by
33488linefeed) is the line ending for messages transmitted over the Internet using
33489SMTP over TCP/IP. However, within individual operating systems, different
33490conventions are used. For example, Unix-like systems use just LF, but others
33491use CRLF or just CR.
33492
33493Exim was designed for Unix-like systems, and internally, it stores messages
33494using the system's convention of a single LF as a line terminator. When
33495receiving a message, all line endings are translated to this standard format.
33496Originally, it was thought that programs that passed messages directly to an
33497MTA within an operating system would use that system's convention. Experience
33498has shown that this is not the case; for example, there are Unix applications
33499that use CRLF in this circumstance. For this reason, and for compatibility with
33500other MTAs, the way Exim handles line endings for all messages is now as
33501follows:
33502
33503.ilist
33504LF not preceded by CR is treated as a line ending.
33505.next
33506CR is treated as a line ending; if it is immediately followed by LF, the LF
33507is ignored.
33508.next
33509The sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate an incoming SMTP message,
33510nor a local message in the state where a line containing only a dot is a
33511terminator.
33512.next
33513If a bare CR is encountered within a header line, an extra space is added after
33514the line terminator so as not to end the header line. The reasoning behind this
33515is that bare CRs in header lines are most likely either to be mistakes, or
33516people trying to play silly games.
33517.next
33518If the first header line received in a message ends with CRLF, a subsequent
33519bare LF in a header line is treated in the same way as a bare CR in a header
33520line.
33521.endlist
33522
33523
33524
33525
33526
33527.section "Unqualified addresses" "SECID218"
33528.cindex "unqualified addresses"
33529.cindex "address" "qualification"
33530By default, Exim expects every envelope address it receives from an external
33531host to be fully qualified. Unqualified addresses cause negative responses to
33532SMTP commands. However, because SMTP is used as a means of transporting
33533messages from MUAs running on personal workstations, there is sometimes a
33534requirement to accept unqualified addresses from specific hosts or IP networks.
33535
33536Exim has two options that separately control which hosts may send unqualified
33537sender or recipient addresses in SMTP commands, namely
33538&%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&. In both
33539cases, if an unqualified address is accepted, it is qualified by adding the
33540value of &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate.
33541
33542.oindex "&%qualify_domain%&"
33543.oindex "&%qualify_recipient%&"
33544Unqualified addresses in header lines are automatically qualified for messages
33545that are locally originated, unless the &%-bnq%& option is given on the command
33546line. For messages received over SMTP, unqualified addresses in header lines
33547are qualified only if unqualified addresses are permitted in SMTP commands. In
33548other words, such qualification is also controlled by
33549&%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
33550
33551
33552
33553
33554.section "The UUCP From line" "SECID219"
33555.cindex "&""From""& line"
33556.cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
33557.cindex "sender" "address"
33558.oindex "&%uucp_from_pattern%&"
33559.oindex "&%uucp_from_sender%&"
33560.cindex "envelope sender"
33561.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
33562Messages that have come from UUCP (and some other applications) often begin
33563with a line containing the envelope sender and a timestamp, following the word
33564&"From"&. Examples of two common formats are:
33565.code
33566From a.oakley@berlin.mus Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
33567From f.butler@berlin.mus Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
33568.endd
33569This line precedes the RFC 2822 header lines. For compatibility with Sendmail,
33570Exim recognizes such lines at the start of messages that are submitted to it
33571via the command line (that is, on the standard input). It does not recognize
33572such lines in incoming SMTP messages, unless the sending host matches
33573&%ignore_fromline_hosts%& or the &%-bs%& option was used for a local message
33574and &%ignore_fromline_local%& is set. The recognition is controlled by a
33575regular expression that is defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%& option, whose
33576default value matches the two common cases shown above and puts the address
33577that follows &"From"& into &$1$&.
33578
33579.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &""From ""& line handling"
33580When the caller of Exim for a non-SMTP message that contains a &"From"& line is
33581a trusted user, the message's sender address is constructed by expanding the
33582contents of &%uucp_sender_address%&, whose default value is &"$1"&. This is
33583then parsed as an RFC 2822 address. If there is no domain, the local part is
33584qualified with &%qualify_domain%& unless it is the empty string. However, if
33585the command line &%-f%& option is used, it overrides the &"From"& line.
33586
33587If the caller of Exim is not trusted, the &"From"& line is recognized, but the
33588sender address is not changed. This is also the case for incoming SMTP messages
33589that are permitted to contain &"From"& lines.
33590
33591Only one &"From"& line is recognized. If there is more than one, the second is
33592treated as a data line that starts the body of the message, as it is not valid
33593as a header line. This also happens if a &"From"& line is present in an
33594incoming SMTP message from a source that is not permitted to send them.
33595
33596
33597
33598.section "Resent- header lines" "SECID220"
33599.cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines"
33600.cindex "header lines" "Resent-"
33601RFC 2822 makes provision for sets of header lines starting with the string
33602&`Resent-`& to be added to a message when it is resent by the original
33603recipient to somebody else. These headers are &'Resent-Date:'&,
33604&'Resent-From:'&, &'Resent-Sender:'&, &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&,
33605&'Resent-Bcc:'& and &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The RFC says:
33606
33607.blockquote
33608&'Resent fields are strictly informational. They MUST NOT be used in the normal
33609processing of replies or other such automatic actions on messages.'&
33610.endblockquote
33611
33612This leaves things a bit vague as far as other processing actions such as
33613address rewriting are concerned. Exim treats &%Resent-%& header lines as
33614follows:
33615
33616.ilist
33617A &'Resent-From:'& line that just contains the login id of the submitting user
33618is automatically rewritten in the same way as &'From:'& (see below).
33619.next
33620If there's a rewriting rule for a particular header line, it is also applied to
33621&%Resent-%& header lines of the same type. For example, a rule that rewrites
33622&'From:'& also rewrites &'Resent-From:'&.
33623.next
33624For local messages, if &'Sender:'& is removed on input, &'Resent-Sender:'& is
33625also removed.
33626.next
33627For a locally-submitted message,
33628if there are any &%Resent-%& header lines but no &'Resent-Date:'&,
33629&'Resent-From:'&, or &'Resent-Message-Id:'&, they are added as necessary. It is
33630the contents of &'Resent-Message-Id:'& (rather than &'Message-Id:'&) which are
33631included in log lines in this case.
33632.next
33633The logic for adding &'Sender:'& is duplicated for &'Resent-Sender:'& when any
33634&%Resent-%& header lines are present.
33635.endlist
33636
33637
33638
33639
33640.section "The Auto-Submitted: header line" "SECID221"
33641Whenever Exim generates an autoreply, a bounce, or a delay warning message, it
33642includes the header line:
33643.code
33644Auto-Submitted: auto-replied
33645.endd
33646
33647.section "The Bcc: header line" "SECID222"
33648.cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
33649If Exim is called with the &%-t%& option, to take recipient addresses from a
33650message's header, it removes any &'Bcc:'& header line that may exist (after
33651extracting its addresses). If &%-t%& is not present on the command line, any
33652existing &'Bcc:'& is not removed.
33653
33654
33655.section "The Date: header line" "SECID223"
33656.cindex "&'Date:'& header line"
33657.cindex "header lines" "Date:"
33658If a locally-generated or submission-mode message has no &'Date:'& header line,
33659Exim adds one, using the current date and time, unless the
33660&%suppress_local_fixups%& control has been specified.
33661
33662.section "The Delivery-date: header line" "SECID224"
33663.cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
33664.oindex "&%delivery_date_remove%&"
33665&'Delivery-date:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header
33666set. Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See
33667the generic &%delivery_date_add%& transport option.) They should not be present
33668in messages in transit. If the &%delivery_date_remove%& configuration option is
33669set (the default), Exim removes &'Delivery-date:'& header lines from incoming
33670messages.
33671
33672
33673.section "The Envelope-to: header line" "SECID225"
33674.cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
33675.cindex "header lines" "Envelope-to:"
33676.oindex "&%envelope_to_remove%&"
33677&'Envelope-to:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header set.
33678Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See the
33679generic &%envelope_to_add%& transport option.) They should not be present in
33680messages in transit. If the &%envelope_to_remove%& configuration option is set
33681(the default), Exim removes &'Envelope-to:'& header lines from incoming
33682messages.
33683
33684
33685.section "The From: header line" "SECTthefrohea"
33686.cindex "&'From:'& header line"
33687.cindex "header lines" "From:"
33688.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
33689.cindex "message" "submission"
33690.cindex "submission mode"
33691If a submission-mode message does not contain a &'From:'& header line, Exim
33692adds one if either of the following conditions is true:
33693
33694.ilist
33695The envelope sender address is not empty (that is, this is not a bounce
33696message). The added header line copies the envelope sender address.
33697.next
33698.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
33699The SMTP session is authenticated and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty.
33700.olist
33701.vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
33702If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
33703&$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
33704.next
33705If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local
33706part is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
33707.next
33708If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
33709&$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
33710.endlist
33711.endlist
33712
33713A non-empty envelope sender takes precedence.
33714
33715If a locally-generated incoming message does not contain a &'From:'& header
33716line, and the &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds one
33717containing the sender's address. The calling user's login name and full name
33718are used to construct the address, as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
33719They are obtained from the password data by calling &[getpwuid()]& (but see the
33720&%unknown_login%& configuration option). The address is qualified with
33721&%qualify_domain%&.
33722
33723For compatibility with Sendmail, if an incoming, non-SMTP message has a
33724&'From:'& header line containing just the unqualified login name of the calling
33725user, this is replaced by an address containing the user's login name and full
33726name as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
33727
33728
33729.section "The Message-ID: header line" "SECID226"
33730.cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
33731.cindex "header lines" "Message-ID:"
33732.cindex "message" "submission"
33733.oindex "&%message_id_header_text%&"
33734If a locally-generated or submission-mode incoming message does not contain a
33735&'Message-ID:'& or &'Resent-Message-ID:'& header line, and the
33736&%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds a suitable header line
33737to the message. If there are any &'Resent-:'& headers in the message, it
33738creates &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The id is constructed from Exim's internal
33739message id, preceded by the letter E to ensure it starts with a letter, and
33740followed by @ and the primary host name. Additional information can be included
33741in this header line by setting the &%message_id_header_text%& and/or
33742&%message_id_header_domain%& options.
33743
33744
33745.section "The Received: header line" "SECID227"
33746.cindex "&'Received:'& header line"
33747.cindex "header lines" "Received:"
33748A &'Received:'& header line is added at the start of every message. The
33749contents are defined by the &%received_header_text%& configuration option, and
33750Exim automatically adds a semicolon and a timestamp to the configured string.
33751
33752The &'Received:'& header is generated as soon as the message's header lines
33753have been received. At this stage, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header
33754line is the time that the message started to be received. This is the value
33755that is seen by the DATA ACL and by the &[local_scan()]& function.
33756
33757Once a message is accepted, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header line is
33758changed to the time of acceptance, which is (apart from a small delay while the
33759-H spool file is written) the earliest time at which delivery could start.
33760
33761
33762.section "The References: header line" "SECID228"
33763.cindex "&'References:'& header line"
33764.cindex "header lines" "References:"
33765Messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport include a &'References:'&
33766header line. This is constructed according to the rules that are described in
33767section 3.64 of RFC 2822 (which states that replies should contain such a
33768header line), and section 3.14 of RFC 3834 (which states that automatic
33769responses are not different in this respect). However, because some mail
33770processing software does not cope well with very long header lines, no more
33771than 12 message IDs are copied from the &'References:'& header line in the
33772incoming message. If there are more than 12, the first one and then the final
3377311 are copied, before adding the message ID of the incoming message.
33774
33775
33776
33777.section "The Return-path: header line" "SECID229"
33778.cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
33779.cindex "header lines" "Return-path:"
33780.oindex "&%return_path_remove%&"
33781&'Return-path:'& header lines are defined as something an MTA may insert when
33782it does the final delivery of messages. (See the generic &%return_path_add%&
33783transport option.) Therefore, they should not be present in messages in
33784transit. If the &%return_path_remove%& configuration option is set (the
33785default), Exim removes &'Return-path:'& header lines from incoming messages.
33786
33787
33788
33789.section "The Sender: header line" "SECTthesenhea"
33790.cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
33791.cindex "message" "submission"
33792.cindex "header lines" "Sender:"
33793For a locally-originated message from an untrusted user, Exim may remove an
33794existing &'Sender:'& header line, and it may add a new one. You can modify
33795these actions by setting the &%local_sender_retain%& option true, the
33796&%local_from_check%& option false, or by using the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
33797control setting.
33798
33799When a local message is received from an untrusted user and
33800&%local_from_check%& is true (the default), and the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
33801control has not been set, a check is made to see if the address given in the
33802&'From:'& header line is the correct (local) sender of the message. The address
33803that is expected has the login name as the local part and the value of
33804&%qualify_domain%& as the domain. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part can
33805be permitted by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%&
33806appropriately. If &'From:'& does not contain the correct sender, a &'Sender:'&
33807line is added to the message.
33808
33809If you set &%local_from_check%& false, this checking does not occur. However,
33810the removal of an existing &'Sender:'& line still happens, unless you also set
33811&%local_sender_retain%& to be true. It is not possible to set both of these
33812options true at the same time.
33813
33814.cindex "submission mode"
33815By default, no processing of &'Sender:'& header lines is done for messages
33816received over TCP/IP or for messages submitted by trusted users. However, when
33817a message is received over TCP/IP in submission mode, and &%sender_retain%& is
33818not specified on the submission control, the following processing takes place:
33819
33820.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
33821First, any existing &'Sender:'& lines are removed. Then, if the SMTP session is
33822authenticated, and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty, a sender address is
33823created as follows:
33824
33825.ilist
33826.vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
33827If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
33828&$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
33829.next
33830If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local part
33831is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
33832.next
33833If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
33834&$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
33835.endlist
33836
33837This address is compared with the address in the &'From:'& header line. If they
33838are different, a &'Sender:'& header line containing the created address is
33839added. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part in &'From:'& can be permitted
33840by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& appropriately.
33841
33842.cindex "return path" "created from &'Sender:'&"
33843&*Note*&: Whenever a &'Sender:'& header line is created, the return path for
33844the message (the envelope sender address) is changed to be the same address,
33845except in the case of submission mode when &%sender_retain%& is specified.
33846
33847
33848
33849.section "Adding and removing header lines in routers and transports" &&&
33850 "SECTheadersaddrem"
33851.cindex "header lines" "adding; in router or transport"
33852.cindex "header lines" "removing; in router or transport"
33853When a message is delivered, the addition and removal of header lines can be
33854specified in a system filter, or on any of the routers and transports that
33855process the message. Section &<<SECTaddremheasys>>& contains details about
33856modifying headers in a system filter. Header lines can also be added in an ACL
33857as a message is received (see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
33858
33859In contrast to what happens in a system filter, header modifications that are
33860specified on routers and transports apply only to the particular recipient
33861addresses that are being processed by those routers and transports. These
33862changes do not actually take place until a copy of the message is being
33863transported. Therefore, they do not affect the basic set of header lines, and
33864they do not affect the values of the variables that refer to header lines.
33865
33866&*Note*&: In particular, this means that any expansions in the configuration of
33867the transport cannot refer to the modified header lines, because such
33868expansions all occur before the message is actually transported.
33869
33870For both routers and transports, the argument of a &%headers_add%&
33871option must be in the form of one or more RFC 2822 header lines, separated by
33872newlines (coded as &"\n"&). For example:
33873.code
33874headers_add = X-added-header: added by $primary_hostname\n\
33875 X-added-second: another added header line
33876.endd
33877Exim does not check the syntax of these added header lines.
33878
33879Multiple &%headers_add%& options for a single router or transport can be
33880specified; the values will append to a single list of header lines.
33881Each header-line is separately expanded.
33882
33883The argument of a &%headers_remove%& option must consist of a colon-separated
33884list of header names. This is confusing, because header names themselves are
33885often terminated by colons. In this case, the colons are the list separators,
33886not part of the names. For example:
33887.code
33888headers_remove = return-receipt-to:acknowledge-to
33889.endd
33890
33891Multiple &%headers_remove%& options for a single router or transport can be
33892specified; the arguments will append to a single header-names list.
33893Each item is separately expanded.
33894Note that colons in complex expansions which are used to
33895form all or part of a &%headers_remove%& list
33896will act as list separators.
33897
33898When &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%& is specified on a router,
33899items are expanded at routing time,
33900and then associated with all addresses that are
33901accepted by that router, and also with any new addresses that it generates. If
33902an address passes through several routers as a result of aliasing or
33903forwarding, the changes are cumulative.
33904
33905.oindex "&%unseen%&"
33906However, this does not apply to multiple routers that result from the use of
33907the &%unseen%& option. Any header modifications that were specified by the
33908&"unseen"& router or its predecessors apply only to the &"unseen"& delivery.
33909
33910Addresses that end up with different &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%&
33911settings cannot be delivered together in a batch, so a transport is always
33912dealing with a set of addresses that have the same header-processing
33913requirements.
33914
33915The transport starts by writing the original set of header lines that arrived
33916with the message, possibly modified by the system filter. As it writes out
33917these lines, it consults the list of header names that were attached to the
33918recipient address(es) by &%headers_remove%& options in routers, and it also
33919consults the transport's own &%headers_remove%& option. Header lines whose
33920names are on either of these lists are not written out. If there are multiple
33921instances of any listed header, they are all skipped.
33922
33923After the remaining original header lines have been written, new header
33924lines that were specified by routers' &%headers_add%& options are written, in
33925the order in which they were attached to the address. These are followed by any
33926header lines specified by the transport's &%headers_add%& option.
33927
33928This way of handling header line modifications in routers and transports has
33929the following consequences:
33930
33931.ilist
33932The original set of header lines, possibly modified by the system filter,
33933remains &"visible"&, in the sense that the &$header_$&&'xxx'& variables refer
33934to it, at all times.
33935.next
33936Header lines that are added by a router's
33937&%headers_add%& option are not accessible by means of the &$header_$&&'xxx'&
33938expansion syntax in subsequent routers or the transport.
33939.next
33940Conversely, header lines that are specified for removal by &%headers_remove%&
33941in a router remain visible to subsequent routers and the transport.
33942.next
33943Headers added to an address by &%headers_add%& in a router cannot be removed by
33944a later router or by a transport.
33945.next
33946An added header can refer to the contents of an original header that is to be
33947removed, even it has the same name as the added header. For example:
33948.code
33949headers_remove = subject
33950headers_add = Subject: new subject (was: $h_subject:)
33951.endd
33952.endlist
33953
33954&*Warning*&: The &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& options cannot be used
33955for a &(redirect)& router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
33956
33957
33958
33959
33960
33961.section "Constructed addresses" "SECTconstr"
33962.cindex "address" "constructed"
33963.cindex "constructed address"
33964When Exim constructs a sender address for a locally-generated message, it uses
33965the form
33966.display
33967<&'user name'&>&~&~<&'login'&&`@`&&'qualify_domain'&>
33968.endd
33969For example:
33970.code
33971Zaphod Beeblebrox <zaphod@end.univ.example>
33972.endd
33973The user name is obtained from the &%-F%& command line option if set, or
33974otherwise by looking up the calling user by &[getpwuid()]& and extracting the
33975&"gecos"& field from the password entry. If the &"gecos"& field contains an
33976ampersand character, this is replaced by the login name with the first letter
33977upper cased, as is conventional in a number of operating systems. See the
33978&%gecos_name%& option for a way to tailor the handling of the &"gecos"& field.
33979The &%unknown_username%& option can be used to specify user names in cases when
33980there is no password file entry.
33981
33982.cindex "RFC 2047"
33983In all cases, the user name is made to conform to RFC 2822 by quoting all or
33984parts of it if necessary. In addition, if it contains any non-printing
33985characters, it is encoded as described in RFC 2047, which defines a way of
33986including non-ASCII characters in header lines. The value of the
33987&%headers_charset%& option specifies the name of the encoding that is used (the
33988characters are assumed to be in this encoding). The setting of
33989&%print_topbitchars%& controls whether characters with the top bit set (that
33990is, with codes greater than 127) count as printing characters or not.
33991
33992
33993
33994.section "Case of local parts" "SECID230"
33995.cindex "case of local parts"
33996.cindex "local part" "case of"
33997RFC 2822 states that the case of letters in the local parts of addresses cannot
33998be assumed to be non-significant. Exim preserves the case of local parts of
33999addresses, but by default it uses a lower-cased form when it is routing,
34000because on most Unix systems, usernames are in lower case and case-insensitive
34001routing is required. However, any particular router can be made to use the
34002original case for local parts by setting the &%caseful_local_part%& generic
34003router option.
34004
34005.cindex "mixed-case login names"
34006If you must have mixed-case user names on your system, the best way to proceed,
34007assuming you want case-independent handling of incoming email, is to set up
34008your first router to convert incoming local parts in your domains to the
34009correct case by means of a file lookup. For example:
34010.code
34011correct_case:
34012 driver = redirect
34013 domains = +local_domains
34014 data = ${lookup{$local_part}cdb\
34015 {/etc/usercased.cdb}{$value}fail}\
34016 @$domain
34017.endd
34018For this router, the local part is forced to lower case by the default action
34019(&%caseful_local_part%& is not set). The lower-cased local part is used to look
34020up a new local part in the correct case. If you then set &%caseful_local_part%&
34021on any subsequent routers which process your domains, they will operate on
34022local parts with the correct case in a case-sensitive manner.
34023
34024
34025
34026.section "Dots in local parts" "SECID231"
34027.cindex "dot" "in local part"
34028.cindex "local part" "dots in"
34029RFC 2822 forbids empty components in local parts. That is, an unquoted local
34030part may not begin or end with a dot, nor have two consecutive dots in the
34031middle. However, it seems that many MTAs do not enforce this, so Exim permits
34032empty components for compatibility.
34033
34034
34035
34036.section "Rewriting addresses" "SECID232"
34037.cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
34038Rewriting of sender and recipient addresses, and addresses in headers, can
34039happen automatically, or as the result of configuration options, as described
34040in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. The headers that may be affected by this are
34041&'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&.
34042
34043Automatic rewriting includes qualification, as mentioned above. The other case
34044in which it can happen is when an incomplete non-local domain is given. The
34045routing process may cause this to be expanded into the full domain name. For
34046example, a header such as
34047.code
34048To: hare@teaparty
34049.endd
34050might get rewritten as
34051.code
34052To: hare@teaparty.wonderland.fict.example
34053.endd
34054Rewriting as a result of routing is the one kind of message processing that
34055does not happen at input time, as it cannot be done until the address has
34056been routed.
34057
34058Strictly, one should not do &'any'& deliveries of a message until all its
34059addresses have been routed, in case any of the headers get changed as a
34060result of routing. However, doing this in practice would hold up many
34061deliveries for unreasonable amounts of time, just because one address could not
34062immediately be routed. Exim therefore does not delay other deliveries when
34063routing of one or more addresses is deferred.
34064.ecindex IIDmesproc
34065
34066
34067
34068. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34069. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34070
34071.chapter "SMTP processing" "CHAPSMTP"
34072.scindex IIDsmtpproc1 "SMTP" "processing details"
34073.scindex IIDsmtpproc2 "LMTP" "processing details"
34074Exim supports a number of different ways of using the SMTP protocol, and its
34075LMTP variant, which is an interactive protocol for transferring messages into a
34076closed mail store application. This chapter contains details of how SMTP is
34077processed. For incoming mail, the following are available:
34078
34079.ilist
34080SMTP over TCP/IP (Exim daemon or &'inetd'&);
34081.next
34082SMTP over the standard input and output (the &%-bs%& option);
34083.next
34084Batched SMTP on the standard input (the &%-bS%& option).
34085.endlist
34086
34087For mail delivery, the following are available:
34088
34089.ilist
34090SMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport);
34091.next
34092LMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport with the &%protocol%& option set to
34093&"lmtp"&);
34094.next
34095LMTP over a pipe to a process running in the local host (the &(lmtp)&
34096transport);
34097.next
34098Batched SMTP to a file or pipe (the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports with
34099the &%use_bsmtp%& option set).
34100.endlist
34101
34102&'Batched SMTP'& is the name for a process in which batches of messages are
34103stored in or read from files (or pipes), in a format in which SMTP commands are
34104used to contain the envelope information.
34105
34106
34107
34108.section "Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP" "SECToutSMTPTCP"
34109.cindex "SMTP" "outgoing over TCP/IP"
34110.cindex "outgoing SMTP over TCP/IP"
34111.cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
34112.cindex "outgoing LMTP over TCP/IP"
34113.cindex "EHLO"
34114.cindex "HELO"
34115.cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
34116Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP is implemented by the &(smtp)& transport.
34117The &%protocol%& option selects which protocol is to be used, but the actual
34118processing is the same in both cases.
34119
34120If, in response to its EHLO command, Exim is told that the SIZE
34121parameter is supported, it adds SIZE=<&'n'&> to each subsequent MAIL
34122command. The value of <&'n'&> is the message size plus the value of the
34123&%size_addition%& option (default 1024) to allow for additions to the message
34124such as per-transport header lines, or changes made in a
34125.cindex "transport" "filter"
34126.cindex "filter" "transport filter"
34127transport filter. If &%size_addition%& is set negative, the use of SIZE is
34128suppressed.
34129
34130If the remote server advertises support for PIPELINING, Exim uses the
34131pipelining extension to SMTP (RFC 2197) to reduce the number of TCP/IP packets
34132required for the transaction.
34133
34134If the remote server advertises support for the STARTTLS command, and Exim
34135was built to support TLS encryption, it tries to start a TLS session unless the
34136server matches &%hosts_avoid_tls%&. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for more details.
34137Either a match in that or &%hosts_verify_avoid_tls%& apply when the transport
34138is called for verification.
34139
34140If the remote server advertises support for the AUTH command, Exim scans
34141the authenticators configuration for any suitable client settings, as described
34142in chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&.
34143
34144.cindex "carriage return"
34145.cindex "linefeed"
34146Responses from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
34147LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters, so in
34148order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
34149line terminator.
34150
34151If a message contains a number of different addresses, all those with the same
34152characteristics (for example, the same envelope sender) that resolve to the
34153same set of hosts, in the same order, are sent in a single SMTP transaction,
34154even if they are for different domains, unless there are more than the setting
34155of the &%max_rcpt%&s option in the &(smtp)& transport allows, in which case
34156they are split into groups containing no more than &%max_rcpt%&s addresses
34157each. If &%remote_max_parallel%& is greater than one, such groups may be sent
34158in parallel sessions. The order of hosts with identical MX values is not
34159significant when checking whether addresses can be batched in this way.
34160
34161When the &(smtp)& transport suffers a temporary failure that is not
34162message-related, Exim updates its transport-specific database, which contains
34163records indexed by host name that remember which messages are waiting for each
34164particular host. It also updates the retry database with new retry times.
34165
34166.cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
34167Exim's retry hints are based on host name plus IP address, so if one address of
34168a multi-homed host is broken, it will soon be skipped most of the time.
34169See the next section for more detail about error handling.
34170
34171.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
34172.cindex "SMTP" "batching over TCP/IP"
34173When a message is successfully delivered over a TCP/IP SMTP connection, Exim
34174looks in the hints database for the transport to see if there are any queued
34175messages waiting for the host to which it is connected. If it finds one, it
34176creates a new Exim process using the &%-MC%& option (which can only be used by
34177a process running as root or the Exim user) and passes the TCP/IP socket to it
34178so that it can deliver another message using the same socket. The new process
34179does only those deliveries that are routed to the connected host, and may in
34180turn pass the socket on to a third process, and so on.
34181
34182The &%connection_max_messages%& option of the &(smtp)& transport can be used to
34183limit the number of messages sent down a single TCP/IP connection.
34184
34185.cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
34186The second and subsequent messages delivered down an existing connection are
34187identified in the main log by the addition of an asterisk after the closing
34188square bracket of the IP address.
34189
34190
34191
34192
34193.section "Errors in outgoing SMTP" "SECToutSMTPerr"
34194.cindex "error" "in outgoing SMTP"
34195.cindex "SMTP" "errors in outgoing"
34196.cindex "host" "error"
34197Three different kinds of error are recognized for outgoing SMTP: host errors,
34198message errors, and recipient errors.
34199
34200.vlist
34201.vitem "&*Host errors*&"
34202A host error is not associated with a particular message or with a
34203particular recipient of a message. The host errors are:
34204
34205.ilist
34206Connection refused or timed out,
34207.next
34208Any error response code on connection,
34209.next
34210Any error response code to EHLO or HELO,
34211.next
34212Loss of connection at any time, except after &"."&,
34213.next
34214I/O errors at any time,
34215.next
34216Timeouts during the session, other than in response to MAIL, RCPT or
34217the &"."& at the end of the data.
34218.endlist ilist
34219
34220For a host error, a permanent error response on connection, or in response to
34221EHLO, causes all addresses routed to the host to be failed. Any other host
34222error causes all addresses to be deferred, and retry data to be created for the
34223host. It is not tried again, for any message, until its retry time arrives. If
34224the current set of addresses are not all delivered in this run (to some
34225alternative host), the message is added to the list of those waiting for this
34226host, so if it is still undelivered when a subsequent successful delivery is
34227made to the host, it will be sent down the same SMTP connection.
34228
34229.vitem "&*Message errors*&"
34230.cindex "message" "error"
34231A message error is associated with a particular message when sent to a
34232particular host, but not with a particular recipient of the message. The
34233message errors are:
34234
34235.ilist
34236Any error response code to MAIL, DATA, or the &"."& that terminates
34237the data,
34238.next
34239Timeout after MAIL,
34240.next
34241Timeout or loss of connection after the &"."& that terminates the data. A
34242timeout after the DATA command itself is treated as a host error, as is loss of
34243connection at any other time.
34244.endlist ilist
34245
34246For a message error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes all addresses
34247to be failed, and a delivery error report to be returned to the sender. A
34248temporary error response (4&'xx'&), or one of the timeouts, causes all
34249addresses to be deferred. Retry data is not created for the host, but instead,
34250a retry record for the combination of host plus message id is created. The
34251message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. This ensures
34252that the failing message will not be sent to this host again until the retry
34253time arrives. However, other messages that are routed to the host are not
34254affected, so if it is some property of the message that is causing the error,
34255it will not stop the delivery of other mail.
34256
34257If the remote host specified support for the SIZE parameter in its response
34258to EHLO, Exim adds SIZE=&'nnn'& to the MAIL command, so an
34259over-large message will cause a message error because the error arrives as a
34260response to MAIL.
34261
34262.vitem "&*Recipient errors*&"
34263.cindex "recipient" "error"
34264A recipient error is associated with a particular recipient of a message. The
34265recipient errors are:
34266
34267.ilist
34268Any error response to RCPT,
34269.next
34270Timeout after RCPT.
34271.endlist
34272
34273For a recipient error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes the
34274recipient address to be failed, and a bounce message to be returned to the
34275sender. A temporary error response (4&'xx'&) or a timeout causes the failing
34276address to be deferred, and routing retry data to be created for it. This is
34277used to delay processing of the address in subsequent queue runs, until its
34278routing retry time arrives. This applies to all messages, but because it
34279operates only in queue runs, one attempt will be made to deliver a new message
34280to the failing address before the delay starts to operate. This ensures that,
34281if the failure is really related to the message rather than the recipient
34282(&"message too big for this recipient"& is a possible example), other messages
34283have a chance of getting delivered. If a delivery to the address does succeed,
34284the retry information gets cleared, so all stuck messages get tried again, and
34285the retry clock is reset.
34286
34287The message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. Use of the
34288host for other messages is unaffected, and except in the case of a timeout,
34289other recipients are processed independently, and may be successfully delivered
34290in the current SMTP session. After a timeout it is of course impossible to
34291proceed with the session, so all addresses get deferred. However, those other
34292than the one that failed do not suffer any subsequent retry delays. Therefore,
34293if one recipient is causing trouble, the others have a chance of getting
34294through when a subsequent delivery attempt occurs before the failing
34295recipient's retry time.
34296.endlist
34297
34298In all cases, if there are other hosts (or IP addresses) available for the
34299current set of addresses (for example, from multiple MX records), they are
34300tried in this run for any undelivered addresses, subject of course to their
34301own retry data. In other words, recipient error retry data does not take effect
34302until the next delivery attempt.
34303
34304Some hosts have been observed to give temporary error responses to every
34305MAIL command at certain times (&"insufficient space"& has been seen). It
34306would be nice if such circumstances could be recognized, and defer data for the
34307host itself created, but this is not possible within the current Exim design.
34308What actually happens is that retry data for every (host, message) combination
34309is created.
34310
34311The reason that timeouts after MAIL and RCPT are treated specially is that
34312these can sometimes arise as a result of the remote host's verification
34313procedures. Exim makes this assumption, and treats them as if a temporary error
34314response had been received. A timeout after &"."& is treated specially because
34315it is known that some broken implementations fail to recognize the end of the
34316message if the last character of the last line is a binary zero. Thus, it is
34317helpful to treat this case as a message error.
34318
34319Timeouts at other times are treated as host errors, assuming a problem with the
34320host, or the connection to it. If a timeout after MAIL, RCPT,
34321or &"."& is really a connection problem, the assumption is that at the next try
34322the timeout is likely to occur at some other point in the dialogue, causing it
34323then to be treated as a host error.
34324
34325There is experimental evidence that some MTAs drop the connection after the
34326terminating &"."& if they do not like the contents of the message for some
34327reason, in contravention of the RFC, which indicates that a 5&'xx'& response
34328should be given. That is why Exim treats this case as a message rather than a
34329host error, in order not to delay other messages to the same host.
34330
34331
34332
34333
34334.section "Incoming SMTP messages over TCP/IP" "SECID233"
34335.cindex "SMTP" "incoming over TCP/IP"
34336.cindex "incoming SMTP over TCP/IP"
34337.cindex "inetd"
34338.cindex "daemon"
34339Incoming SMTP messages can be accepted in one of two ways: by running a
34340listening daemon, or by using &'inetd'&. In the latter case, the entry in
34341&_/etc/inetd.conf_& should be like this:
34342.code
34343smtp stream tcp nowait exim /opt/exim/bin/exim in.exim -bs
34344.endd
34345Exim distinguishes between this case and the case of a locally running user
34346agent using the &%-bs%& option by checking whether or not the standard input is
34347a socket. When it is, either the port must be privileged (less than 1024), or
34348the caller must be root or the Exim user. If any other user passes a socket
34349with an unprivileged port number, Exim prints a message on the standard error
34350stream and exits with an error code.
34351
34352By default, Exim does not make a log entry when a remote host connects or
34353disconnects (either via the daemon or &'inetd'&), unless the disconnection is
34354unexpected. It can be made to write such log entries by setting the
34355&%smtp_connection%& log selector.
34356
34357.cindex "carriage return"
34358.cindex "linefeed"
34359Commands from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
34360LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters. In
34361order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
34362line terminator.
34363Furthermore, because common code is used for receiving messages from all
34364sources, a CR on its own is also interpreted as a line terminator. However, the
34365sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate incoming SMTP data.
34366
34367.cindex "EHLO" "invalid data"
34368.cindex "HELO" "invalid data"
34369One area that sometimes gives rise to problems concerns the EHLO or
34370HELO commands. Some clients send syntactically invalid versions of these
34371commands, which Exim rejects by default. (This is nothing to do with verifying
34372the data that is sent, so &%helo_verify_hosts%& is not relevant.) You can tell
34373Exim not to apply a syntax check by setting &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& to
34374match the broken hosts that send invalid commands.
34375
34376.cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
34377.cindex "MAIL" "SIZE option"
34378The amount of disk space available is checked whenever SIZE is received on
34379a MAIL command, independently of whether &%message_size_limit%& or
34380&%check_spool_space%& is configured, unless &%smtp_check_spool_space%& is set
34381false. A temporary error is given if there is not enough space. If
34382&%check_spool_space%& is set, the check is for that amount of space plus the
34383value given with SIZE, that is, it checks that the addition of the incoming
34384message will not reduce the space below the threshold.
34385
34386When a message is successfully received, Exim includes the local message id in
34387its response to the final &"."& that terminates the data. If the remote host
34388logs this text it can help with tracing what has happened to a message.
34389
34390The Exim daemon can limit the number of simultaneous incoming connections it is
34391prepared to handle (see the &%smtp_accept_max%& option). It can also limit the
34392number of simultaneous incoming connections from a single remote host (see the
34393&%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& option). Additional connection attempts are
34394rejected using the SMTP temporary error code 421.
34395
34396The Exim daemon does not rely on the SIGCHLD signal to detect when a
34397subprocess has finished, as this can get lost at busy times. Instead, it looks
34398for completed subprocesses every time it wakes up. Provided there are other
34399things happening (new incoming calls, starts of queue runs), completed
34400processes will be noticed and tidied away. On very quiet systems you may
34401sometimes see a &"defunct"& Exim process hanging about. This is not a problem;
34402it will be noticed when the daemon next wakes up.
34403
34404When running as a daemon, Exim can reserve some SMTP slots for specific hosts,
34405and can also be set up to reject SMTP calls from non-reserved hosts at times of
34406high system load &-- for details see the &%smtp_accept_reserve%&,
34407&%smtp_load_reserve%&, and &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& options. The load check
34408applies in both the daemon and &'inetd'& cases.
34409
34410Exim normally starts a delivery process for each message received, though this
34411can be varied by means of the &%-odq%& command line option and the
34412&%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_file%&, and &%queue_only_load%& options. The
34413number of simultaneously running delivery processes started in this way from
34414SMTP input can be limited by the &%smtp_accept_queue%& and
34415&%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& options. When either limit is reached,
34416subsequently received messages are just put on the input queue without starting
34417a delivery process.
34418
34419The controls that involve counts of incoming SMTP calls (&%smtp_accept_max%&,
34420&%smtp_accept_queue%&, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&) are not available when Exim is
34421started up from the &'inetd'& daemon, because in that case each connection is
34422handled by an entirely independent Exim process. Control by load average is,
34423however, available with &'inetd'&.
34424
34425Exim can be configured to verify addresses in incoming SMTP commands as they
34426are received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details. It can also be configured
34427to rewrite addresses at this time &-- before any syntax checking is done. See
34428section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&.
34429
34430Exim can also be configured to limit the rate at which a client host submits
34431MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session. See the
34432&%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& option.
34433
34434
34435
34436.section "Unrecognized SMTP commands" "SECID234"
34437.cindex "SMTP" "unrecognized commands"
34438If Exim receives more than &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& unrecognized SMTP
34439commands during a single SMTP connection, it drops the connection after sending
34440the error response to the last command. The default value for
34441&%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& is 3. This is a defence against some kinds of
34442abuse that subvert web servers into making connections to SMTP ports; in these
34443circumstances, a number of non-SMTP lines are sent first.
34444
34445
34446.section "Syntax and protocol errors in SMTP commands" "SECID235"
34447.cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors"
34448.cindex "SMTP" "protocol errors"
34449A syntax error is detected if an SMTP command is recognized, but there is
34450something syntactically wrong with its data, for example, a malformed email
34451address in a RCPT command. Protocol errors include invalid command
34452sequencing such as RCPT before MAIL. If Exim receives more than
34453&%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& such commands during a single SMTP connection, it
34454drops the connection after sending the error response to the last command. The
34455default value for &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& is 3. This is a defence against
34456broken clients that loop sending bad commands (yes, it has been seen).
34457
34458
34459
34460.section "Use of non-mail SMTP commands" "SECID236"
34461.cindex "SMTP" "non-mail commands"
34462The &"non-mail"& SMTP commands are those other than MAIL, RCPT, and
34463DATA. Exim counts such commands, and drops the connection if there are too
34464many of them in a single SMTP session. This action catches some
34465denial-of-service attempts and things like repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
34466client looping sending EHLO. The global option &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
34467defines what &"too many"& means. Its default value is 10.
34468
34469When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
34470allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
34471but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
34472or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
34473starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
34474counted.
34475
34476The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately following
34477STARTTLS is also not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than MAIL,
34478RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
34479
34480You can control which hosts are subject to the limit set by
34481&%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& by setting
34482&%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&. The default value is &`*`&, which makes
34483the limit apply to all hosts. This option means that you can exclude any
34484specific badly-behaved hosts that you have to live with.
34485
34486
34487
34488
34489.section "The VRFY and EXPN commands" "SECID237"
34490When Exim receives a VRFY or EXPN command on a TCP/IP connection, it
34491runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& or &%acl_smtp_expn%& (as
34492appropriate) in order to decide whether the command should be accepted or not.
34493
34494.cindex "VRFY" "processing"
34495When no ACL is defined for VRFY, or if it rejects without
34496setting an explicit response code, the command is accepted
34497(with a 252 SMTP response code)
34498in order to support awkward clients that do a VRFY before every RCPT.
34499When VRFY is accepted, it runs exactly the same code as when Exim is
34500called with the &%-bv%& option, and returns 250/451/550
34501SMTP response codes.
34502
34503.cindex "EXPN" "processing"
34504If no ACL for EXPN is defined, the command is rejected.
34505When EXPN is accepted, a single-level expansion of the address is done.
34506EXPN is treated as an &"address test"& (similar to the &%-bt%& option) rather
34507than a verification (the &%-bv%& option). If an unqualified local part is given
34508as the argument to EXPN, it is qualified with &%qualify_domain%&. Rejections
34509of VRFY and EXPN commands are logged on the main and reject logs, and
34510VRFY verification failures are logged on the main log for consistency with
34511RCPT failures.
34512
34513
34514
34515.section "The ETRN command" "SECTETRN"
34516.cindex "ETRN" "processing"
34517RFC 1985 describes an SMTP command called ETRN that is designed to
34518overcome the security problems of the TURN command (which has fallen into
34519disuse). When Exim receives an ETRN command on a TCP/IP connection, it runs
34520the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_etrn%& in order to decide whether the command
34521should be accepted or not. If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
34522
34523The ETRN command is concerned with &"releasing"& messages that are awaiting
34524delivery to certain hosts. As Exim does not organize its message queue by host,
34525the only form of ETRN that is supported by default is the one where the
34526text starts with the &"#"& prefix, in which case the remainder of the text is
34527specific to the SMTP server. A valid ETRN command causes a run of Exim with
34528the &%-R%& option to happen, with the remainder of the ETRN text as its
34529argument. For example,
34530.code
34531ETRN #brigadoon
34532.endd
34533runs the command
34534.code
34535exim -R brigadoon
34536.endd
34537which causes a delivery attempt on all messages with undelivered addresses
34538containing the text &"brigadoon"&. When &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set (the
34539default), Exim prevents the simultaneous execution of more than one queue run
34540for the same argument string as a result of an ETRN command. This stops
34541a misbehaving client from starting more than one queue runner at once.
34542
34543.cindex "hints database" "ETRN serialization"
34544Exim implements the serialization by means of a hints database in which a
34545record is written whenever a process is started by ETRN, and deleted when
34546the process completes. However, Exim does not keep the SMTP session waiting for
34547the ETRN process to complete. Once ETRN is accepted, the client is sent
34548a &"success"& return code. Obviously there is scope for hints records to get
34549left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To guard against this,
34550Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
34551
34552.oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
34553For more control over what ETRN does, the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option can
34554used. This specifies a command that is run whenever ETRN is received,
34555whatever the form of its argument. For
34556example:
34557.code
34558smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
34559 $sender_host_address
34560.endd
34561.vindex "&$domain$&"
34562The string is split up into arguments which are independently expanded. The
34563expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the argument of the ETRN command,
34564and no syntax checking is done on the contents of this argument. Exim does not
34565wait for the command to complete, so its status code is not checked. Exim runs
34566under its own uid and gid when receiving incoming SMTP, so it is not possible
34567for it to change them before running the command.
34568
34569
34570
34571.section "Incoming local SMTP" "SECID238"
34572.cindex "SMTP" "local incoming"
34573Some user agents use SMTP to pass messages to their local MTA using the
34574standard input and output, as opposed to passing the envelope on the command
34575line and writing the message to the standard input. This is supported by the
34576&%-bs%& option. This form of SMTP is handled in the same way as incoming
34577messages over TCP/IP (including the use of ACLs), except that the envelope
34578sender given in a MAIL command is ignored unless the caller is trusted. In
34579an ACL you can detect this form of SMTP input by testing for an empty host
34580identification. It is common to have this as the first line in the ACL that
34581runs for RCPT commands:
34582.code
34583accept hosts = :
34584.endd
34585This accepts SMTP messages from local processes without doing any other tests.
34586
34587
34588
34589.section "Outgoing batched SMTP" "SECTbatchSMTP"
34590.cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing"
34591.cindex "batched SMTP output"
34592Both the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports can be used for handling
34593batched SMTP. Each has an option called &%use_bsmtp%& which causes messages to
34594be output in BSMTP format. No SMTP responses are possible for this form of
34595delivery. All it is doing is using SMTP commands as a way of transmitting the
34596envelope along with the message.
34597
34598The message is written to the file or pipe preceded by the SMTP commands
34599MAIL and RCPT, and followed by a line containing a single dot. Lines in
34600the message that start with a dot have an extra dot added. The SMTP command
34601HELO is not normally used. If it is required, the &%message_prefix%& option
34602can be used to specify it.
34603
34604Because &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& are both local transports, they accept only
34605one recipient address at a time by default. However, you can arrange for them
34606to handle several addresses at once by setting the &%batch_max%& option. When
34607this is done for BSMTP, messages may contain multiple RCPT commands. See
34608chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>& for more details.
34609
34610.vindex "&$host$&"
34611When one or more addresses are routed to a BSMTP transport by a router that
34612sets up a host list, the name of the first host on the list is available to the
34613transport in the variable &$host$&. Here is an example of such a transport and
34614router:
34615.code
34616begin routers
34617route_append:
34618 driver = manualroute
34619 transport = smtp_appendfile
34620 route_list = domain.example batch.host.example
34621
34622begin transports
34623smtp_appendfile:
34624 driver = appendfile
34625 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
34626 batch_max = 1000
34627 use_bsmtp
34628 user = exim
34629.endd
34630This causes messages addressed to &'domain.example'& to be written in BSMTP
34631format to &_/var/bsmtp/batch.host.example_&, with only a single copy of each
34632message (unless there are more than 1000 recipients).
34633
34634
34635
34636.section "Incoming batched SMTP" "SECTincomingbatchedSMTP"
34637.cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
34638.cindex "batched SMTP input"
34639The &%-bS%& command line option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by
34640reading SMTP on the standard input, but to generate no responses. If the caller
34641is trusted, the senders in the MAIL commands are believed; otherwise the
34642sender is always the caller of Exim. Unqualified senders and receivers are not
34643rejected (there seems little point) but instead just get qualified. HELO
34644and EHLO act as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN and HELP, act
34645as NOOP; QUIT quits.
34646
34647Minimal policy checking is done for BSMTP input. Only the non-SMTP
34648ACL is run in the same way as for non-SMTP local input.
34649
34650If an error is detected while reading a message, including a missing &"."& at
34651the end, Exim gives up immediately. It writes details of the error to the
34652standard output in a stylized way that the calling program should be able to
34653make some use of automatically, for example:
34654.code
34655554 Unexpected end of file
34656Transaction started in line 10
34657Error detected in line 14
34658.endd
34659It writes a more verbose version, for human consumption, to the standard error
34660file, for example:
34661.code
34662An error was detected while processing a file of BSMTP input.
34663The error message was:
34664
34665501 '>' missing at end of address
34666
34667The SMTP transaction started in line 10.
34668The error was detected in line 12.
34669The SMTP command at fault was:
34670
34671rcpt to:<malformed@in.com.plete
34672
346731 previous message was successfully processed.
34674The rest of the batch was abandoned.
34675.endd
34676The return code from Exim is zero only if there were no errors. It is 1 if some
34677messages were accepted before an error was detected, and 2 if no messages were
34678accepted.
34679.ecindex IIDsmtpproc1
34680.ecindex IIDsmtpproc2
34681
34682
34683
34684. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34685. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34686
34687.chapter "Customizing bounce and warning messages" "CHAPemsgcust" &&&
34688 "Customizing messages"
34689When a message fails to be delivered, or remains on the queue for more than a
34690configured amount of time, Exim sends a message to the original sender, or
34691to an alternative configured address. The text of these messages is built into
34692the code of Exim, but it is possible to change it, either by adding a single
34693string, or by replacing each of the paragraphs by text supplied in a file.
34694
34695The &'From:'& and &'To:'& header lines are automatically generated; you can
34696cause a &'Reply-To:'& line to be added by setting the &%errors_reply_to%&
34697option. Exim also adds the line
34698.code
34699Auto-Submitted: auto-generated
34700.endd
34701to all warning and bounce messages,
34702
34703
34704.section "Customizing bounce messages" "SECID239"
34705.cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
34706.cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
34707If &%bounce_message_text%& is set, its contents are included in the default
34708message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
34709delivery software."& The string is not expanded. It is not used if
34710&%bounce_message_file%& is set.
34711
34712When &%bounce_message_file%& is set, it must point to a template file for
34713constructing error messages. The file consists of a series of text items,
34714separated by lines consisting of exactly four asterisks. If the file cannot be
34715opened, default text is used and a message is written to the main and panic
34716logs. If any text item in the file is empty, default text is used for that
34717item.
34718
34719.vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
34720.vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
34721Each item of text that is read from the file is expanded, and there are two
34722expansion variables which can be of use here: &$bounce_recipient$& is set to
34723the recipient of an error message while it is being created, and
34724&$bounce_return_size_limit$& contains the value of the &%return_size_limit%&
34725option, rounded to a whole number.
34726
34727The items must appear in the file in the following order:
34728
34729.ilist
34730The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
34731&'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
34732.next
34733The second item forms the start of the error message. After it, Exim lists the
34734failing addresses with their error messages.
34735.next
34736The third item is used to introduce any text from pipe transports that is to be
34737returned to the sender. It is omitted if there is no such text.
34738.next
34739The fourth, fifth and sixth items will be ignored and may be empty.
34740The fields exist for back-compatibility
34741.endlist
34742
34743The default state (&%bounce_message_file%& unset) is equivalent to the
34744following file, in which the sixth item is empty. The &'Subject:'& and some
34745other lines have been split in order to fit them on the page:
34746.code
34747Subject: Mail delivery failed
34748 ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
34749 {: returning message to sender}}
34750****
34751This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
34752
34753A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
34754 {that you sent }{sent by
34755
34756<$sender_address>
34757
34758}}could not be delivered to all of its recipients.
34759This is a permanent error. The following address(es) failed:
34760****
34761The following text was generated during the delivery attempt(s):
34762****
34763------ This is a copy of the message, including all the headers.
34764 ------
34765****
34766------ The body of the message is $message_size characters long;
34767 only the first
34768------ $bounce_return_size_limit or so are included here.
34769****
34770.endd
34771.section "Customizing warning messages" "SECTcustwarn"
34772.cindex "customizing" "warning message"
34773.cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
34774The option &%warn_message_file%& can be pointed at a template file for use when
34775warnings about message delays are created. In this case there are only three
34776text sections:
34777
34778.ilist
34779The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
34780&'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
34781.next
34782The second item forms the start of the warning message. After it, Exim lists
34783the delayed addresses.
34784.next
34785The third item then ends the message.
34786.endlist
34787
34788The default state is equivalent to the following file, except that some lines
34789have been split here, in order to fit them on the page:
34790.code
34791Subject: Warning: message $message_exim_id delayed
34792 $warn_message_delay
34793****
34794This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
34795
34796A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$warn_message_recipients}
34797{that you sent }{sent by
34798
34799<$sender_address>
34800
34801}}has not been delivered to all of its recipients after
34802more than $warn_message_delay on the queue on $primary_hostname.
34803
34804The message identifier is: $message_exim_id
34805The subject of the message is: $h_subject
34806The date of the message is: $h_date
34807
34808The following address(es) have not yet been delivered:
34809****
34810No action is required on your part. Delivery attempts will
34811continue for some time, and this warning may be repeated at
34812intervals if the message remains undelivered. Eventually the
34813mail delivery software will give up, and when that happens,
34814the message will be returned to you.
34815.endd
34816.vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
34817.vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
34818However, in the default state the subject and date lines are omitted if no
34819appropriate headers exist. During the expansion of this file,
34820&$warn_message_delay$& is set to the delay time in one of the forms &"<&'n'&>
34821minutes"& or &"<&'n'&> hours"&, and &$warn_message_recipients$& contains a list
34822of recipients for the warning message. There may be more than one if there are
34823multiple addresses with different &%errors_to%& settings on the routers that
34824handled them.
34825
34826
34827
34828
34829. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34830. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34831
34832.chapter "Some common configuration settings" "CHAPcomconreq"
34833This chapter discusses some configuration settings that seem to be fairly
34834common. More examples and discussion can be found in the Exim book.
34835
34836
34837
34838.section "Sending mail to a smart host" "SECID240"
34839.cindex "smart host" "example router"
34840If you want to send all mail for non-local domains to a &"smart host"&, you
34841should replace the default &(dnslookup)& router with a router which does the
34842routing explicitly:
34843.code
34844send_to_smart_host:
34845 driver = manualroute
34846 route_list = !+local_domains smart.host.name
34847 transport = remote_smtp
34848.endd
34849You can use the smart host's IP address instead of the name if you wish.
34850If you are using Exim only to submit messages to a smart host, and not for
34851receiving incoming messages, you can arrange for it to do the submission
34852synchronously by setting the &%mua_wrapper%& option (see chapter
34853&<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&).
34854
34855
34856
34857
34858.section "Using Exim to handle mailing lists" "SECTmailinglists"
34859.cindex "mailing lists"
34860Exim can be used to run simple mailing lists, but for large and/or complicated
34861requirements, the use of additional specialized mailing list software such as
34862Majordomo or Mailman is recommended.
34863
34864The &(redirect)& router can be used to handle mailing lists where each list
34865is maintained in a separate file, which can therefore be managed by an
34866independent manager. The &%domains%& router option can be used to run these
34867lists in a separate domain from normal mail. For example:
34868.code
34869lists:
34870 driver = redirect
34871 domains = lists.example
34872 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
34873 forbid_pipe
34874 forbid_file
34875 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
34876 no_more
34877.endd
34878This router is skipped for domains other than &'lists.example'&. For addresses
34879in that domain, it looks for a file that matches the local part. If there is no
34880such file, the router declines, but because &%no_more%& is set, no subsequent
34881routers are tried, and so the whole delivery fails.
34882
34883The &%forbid_pipe%& and &%forbid_file%& options prevent a local part from being
34884expanded into a file name or a pipe delivery, which is usually inappropriate in
34885a mailing list.
34886
34887.oindex "&%errors_to%&"
34888The &%errors_to%& option specifies that any delivery errors caused by addresses
34889taken from a mailing list are to be sent to the given address rather than the
34890original sender of the message. However, before acting on this, Exim verifies
34891the error address, and ignores it if verification fails.
34892
34893For example, using the configuration above, mail sent to
34894&'dicts@lists.example'& is passed on to those addresses contained in
34895&_/usr/lists/dicts_&, with error reports directed to
34896&'dicts-request@lists.example'&, provided that this address can be verified.
34897There could be a file called &_/usr/lists/dicts-request_& containing
34898the address(es) of this particular list's manager(s), but other approaches,
34899such as setting up an earlier router (possibly using the &%local_part_prefix%&
34900or &%local_part_suffix%& options) to handle addresses of the form
34901&%owner-%&&'xxx'& or &%xxx-%&&'request'&, are also possible.
34902
34903
34904
34905.section "Syntax errors in mailing lists" "SECID241"
34906.cindex "mailing lists" "syntax errors in"
34907If an entry in redirection data contains a syntax error, Exim normally defers
34908delivery of the original address. That means that a syntax error in a mailing
34909list holds up all deliveries to the list. This may not be appropriate when a
34910list is being maintained automatically from data supplied by users, and the
34911addresses are not rigorously checked.
34912
34913If the &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is set, the &(redirect)& router just skips
34914entries that fail to parse, noting the incident in the log. If in addition
34915&%syntax_errors_to%& is set to a verifiable address, a message is sent to it
34916whenever a broken address is skipped. It is usually appropriate to set
34917&%syntax_errors_to%& to the same address as &%errors_to%&.
34918
34919
34920
34921.section "Re-expansion of mailing lists" "SECID242"
34922.cindex "mailing lists" "re-expansion of"
34923Exim remembers every individual address to which a message has been delivered,
34924in order to avoid duplication, but it normally stores only the original
34925recipient addresses with a message. If all the deliveries to a mailing list
34926cannot be done at the first attempt, the mailing list is re-expanded when the
34927delivery is next tried. This means that alterations to the list are taken into
34928account at each delivery attempt, so addresses that have been added to
34929the list since the message arrived will therefore receive a copy of the
34930message, even though it pre-dates their subscription.
34931
34932If this behaviour is felt to be undesirable, the &%one_time%& option can be set
34933on the &(redirect)& router. If this is done, any addresses generated by the
34934router that fail to deliver at the first attempt are added to the message as
34935&"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
34936&"delivered"&. Thus, expansion of the mailing list does not happen again at the
34937subsequent delivery attempts. The disadvantage of this is that if any of the
34938failing addresses are incorrect, correcting them in the file has no effect on
34939pre-existing messages.
34940
34941The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
34942addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
34943addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if the
34944&%all_parents%& selector is set, but for mailing lists there is normally only
34945one level of expansion anyway.
34946
34947
34948
34949.section "Closed mailing lists" "SECID243"
34950.cindex "mailing lists" "closed"
34951The examples so far have assumed open mailing lists, to which anybody may
34952send mail. It is also possible to set up closed lists, where mail is accepted
34953from specified senders only. This is done by making use of the generic
34954&%senders%& option to restrict the router that handles the list.
34955
34956The following example uses the same file as a list of recipients and as a list
34957of permitted senders. It requires three routers:
34958.code
34959lists_request:
34960 driver = redirect
34961 domains = lists.example
34962 local_part_suffix = -request
34963 file = /usr/lists/$local_part$local_part_suffix
34964 no_more
34965
34966lists_post:
34967 driver = redirect
34968 domains = lists.example
34969 senders = ${if exists {/usr/lists/$local_part}\
34970 {lsearch;/usr/lists/$local_part}{*}}
34971 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
34972 forbid_pipe
34973 forbid_file
34974 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
34975 no_more
34976
34977lists_closed:
34978 driver = redirect
34979 domains = lists.example
34980 allow_fail
34981 data = :fail: $local_part@lists.example is a closed mailing list
34982.endd
34983All three routers have the same &%domains%& setting, so for any other domains,
34984they are all skipped. The first router runs only if the local part ends in
34985&%-request%&. It handles messages to the list manager(s) by means of an open
34986mailing list.
34987
34988The second router runs only if the &%senders%& precondition is satisfied. It
34989checks for the existence of a list that corresponds to the local part, and then
34990checks that the sender is on the list by means of a linear search. It is
34991necessary to check for the existence of the file before trying to search it,
34992because otherwise Exim thinks there is a configuration error. If the file does
34993not exist, the expansion of &%senders%& is *, which matches all senders. This
34994means that the router runs, but because there is no list, declines, and
34995&%no_more%& ensures that no further routers are run. The address fails with an
34996&"unrouteable address"& error.
34997
34998The third router runs only if the second router is skipped, which happens when
34999a mailing list exists, but the sender is not on it. This router forcibly fails
35000the address, giving a suitable error message.
35001
35002
35003
35004
35005.section "Variable Envelope Return Paths (VERP)" "SECTverp"
35006.cindex "VERP"
35007.cindex "Variable Envelope Return Paths"
35008.cindex "envelope sender"
35009Variable Envelope Return Paths &-- see &url(http://cr.yp.to/proto/verp.txt) &--
35010are a way of helping mailing list administrators discover which subscription
35011address is the cause of a particular delivery failure. The idea is to encode
35012the original recipient address in the outgoing envelope sender address, so that
35013if the message is forwarded by another host and then subsequently bounces, the
35014original recipient can be extracted from the recipient address of the bounce.
35015
35016.oindex &%errors_to%&
35017.oindex &%return_path%&
35018Envelope sender addresses can be modified by Exim using two different
35019facilities: the &%errors_to%& option on a router (as shown in previous mailing
35020list examples), or the &%return_path%& option on a transport. The second of
35021these is effective only if the message is successfully delivered to another
35022host; it is not used for errors detected on the local host (see the description
35023of &%return_path%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&). Here is an example
35024of the use of &%return_path%& to implement VERP on an &(smtp)& transport:
35025.code
35026verp_smtp:
35027 driver = smtp
35028 max_rcpt = 1
35029 return_path = \
35030 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
35031 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
35032.endd
35033This has the effect of rewriting the return path (envelope sender) on outgoing
35034SMTP messages, if the local part of the original return path ends in
35035&"-request"&, and the domain is &'your.dom.example'&. The rewriting inserts the
35036local part and domain of the recipient into the return path. Suppose, for
35037example, that a message whose return path has been set to
35038&'somelist-request@your.dom.example'& is sent to
35039&'subscriber@other.dom.example'&. In the transport, the return path is
35040rewritten as
35041.code
35042somelist-request+subscriber=other.dom.example@your.dom.example
35043.endd
35044.vindex "&$local_part$&"
35045For this to work, you must tell Exim to send multiple copies of messages that
35046have more than one recipient, so that each copy has just one recipient. This is
35047achieved by setting &%max_rcpt%& to 1. Without this, a single copy of a message
35048might be sent to several different recipients in the same domain, in which case
35049&$local_part$& is not available in the transport, because it is not unique.
35050
35051Unless your host is doing nothing but mailing list deliveries, you should
35052probably use a separate transport for the VERP deliveries, so as not to use
35053extra resources in making one-per-recipient copies for other deliveries. This
35054can easily be done by expanding the &%transport%& option in the router:
35055.code
35056dnslookup:
35057 driver = dnslookup
35058 domains = ! +local_domains
35059 transport = \
35060 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
35061 {verp_smtp}{remote_smtp}}
35062 no_more
35063.endd
35064If you want to change the return path using &%errors_to%& in a router instead
35065of using &%return_path%& in the transport, you need to set &%errors_to%& on all
35066routers that handle mailing list addresses. This will ensure that all delivery
35067errors, including those detected on the local host, are sent to the VERP
35068address.
35069
35070On a host that does no local deliveries and has no manual routing, only the
35071&(dnslookup)& router needs to be changed. A special transport is not needed for
35072SMTP deliveries. Every mailing list recipient has its own return path value,
35073and so Exim must hand them to the transport one at a time. Here is an example
35074of a &(dnslookup)& router that implements VERP:
35075.code
35076verp_dnslookup:
35077 driver = dnslookup
35078 domains = ! +local_domains
35079 transport = remote_smtp
35080 errors_to = \
35081 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}}
35082 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
35083 no_more
35084.endd
35085Before you start sending out messages with VERPed return paths, you must also
35086configure Exim to accept the bounce messages that come back to those paths.
35087Typically this is done by setting a &%local_part_suffix%& option for a
35088router, and using this to route the messages to wherever you want to handle
35089them.
35090
35091The overhead incurred in using VERP depends very much on the size of the
35092message, the number of recipient addresses that resolve to the same remote
35093host, and the speed of the connection over which the message is being sent. If
35094a lot of addresses resolve to the same host and the connection is slow, sending
35095a separate copy of the message for each address may take substantially longer
35096than sending a single copy with many recipients (for which VERP cannot be
35097used).
35098
35099
35100
35101
35102
35103
35104.section "Virtual domains" "SECTvirtualdomains"
35105.cindex "virtual domains"
35106.cindex "domain" "virtual"
35107The phrase &'virtual domain'& is unfortunately used with two rather different
35108meanings:
35109
35110.ilist
35111A domain for which there are no real mailboxes; all valid local parts are
35112aliases for other email addresses. Common examples are organizational
35113top-level domains and &"vanity"& domains.
35114.next
35115One of a number of independent domains that are all handled by the same host,
35116with mailboxes on that host, but where the mailbox owners do not necessarily
35117have login accounts on that host.
35118.endlist
35119
35120The first usage is probably more common, and does seem more &"virtual"& than
35121the second. This kind of domain can be handled in Exim with a straightforward
35122aliasing router. One approach is to create a separate alias file for each
35123virtual domain. Exim can test for the existence of the alias file to determine
35124whether the domain exists. The &(dsearch)& lookup type is useful here, leading
35125to a router of this form:
35126.code
35127virtual:
35128 driver = redirect
35129 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/virtual
35130 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/mail/virtual/$domain}}
35131 no_more
35132.endd
35133The &%domains%& option specifies that the router is to be skipped, unless there
35134is a file in the &_/etc/mail/virtual_& directory whose name is the same as the
35135domain that is being processed. When the router runs, it looks up the local
35136part in the file to find a new address (or list of addresses). The &%no_more%&
35137setting ensures that if the lookup fails (leading to &%data%& being an empty
35138string), Exim gives up on the address without trying any subsequent routers.
35139
35140This one router can handle all the virtual domains because the alias file names
35141follow a fixed pattern. Permissions can be arranged so that appropriate people
35142can edit the different alias files. A successful aliasing operation results in
35143a new envelope recipient address, which is then routed from scratch.
35144
35145The other kind of &"virtual"& domain can also be handled in a straightforward
35146way. One approach is to create a file for each domain containing a list of
35147valid local parts, and use it in a router like this:
35148.code
35149my_domains:
35150 driver = accept
35151 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/domains
35152 local_parts = lsearch;/etc/mail/domains/$domain
35153 transport = my_mailboxes
35154.endd
35155The address is accepted if there is a file for the domain, and the local part
35156can be found in the file. The &%domains%& option is used to check for the
35157file's existence because &%domains%& is tested before the &%local_parts%&
35158option (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). You cannot use &%require_files%&,
35159because that option is tested after &%local_parts%&. The transport is as
35160follows:
35161.code
35162my_mailboxes:
35163 driver = appendfile
35164 file = /var/mail/$domain/$local_part
35165 user = mail
35166.endd
35167This uses a directory of mailboxes for each domain. The &%user%& setting is
35168required, to specify which uid is to be used for writing to the mailboxes.
35169
35170The configuration shown here is just one example of how you might support this
35171requirement. There are many other ways this kind of configuration can be set
35172up, for example, by using a database instead of separate files to hold all the
35173information about the domains.
35174
35175
35176
35177.section "Multiple user mailboxes" "SECTmulbox"
35178.cindex "multiple mailboxes"
35179.cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
35180.cindex "local part" "prefix"
35181.cindex "local part" "suffix"
35182Heavy email users often want to operate with multiple mailboxes, into which
35183incoming mail is automatically sorted. A popular way of handling this is to
35184allow users to use multiple sender addresses, so that replies can easily be
35185identified. Users are permitted to add prefixes or suffixes to their local
35186parts for this purpose. The wildcard facility of the generic router options
35187&%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& can be used for this. For
35188example, consider this router:
35189.code
35190userforward:
35191 driver = redirect
35192 check_local_user
35193 file = $home/.forward
35194 local_part_suffix = -*
35195 local_part_suffix_optional
35196 allow_filter
35197.endd
35198.vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
35199It runs a user's &_.forward_& file for all local parts of the form
35200&'username-*'&. Within the filter file the user can distinguish different
35201cases by testing the variable &$local_part_suffix$&. For example:
35202.code
35203if $local_part_suffix contains -special then
35204save /home/$local_part/Mail/special
35205endif
35206.endd
35207If the filter file does not exist, or does not deal with such addresses, they
35208fall through to subsequent routers, and, assuming no subsequent use of the
35209&%local_part_suffix%& option is made, they presumably fail. Thus, users have
35210control over which suffixes are valid.
35211
35212Alternatively, a suffix can be used to trigger the use of a different
35213&_.forward_& file &-- which is the way a similar facility is implemented in
35214another MTA:
35215.code
35216userforward:
35217 driver = redirect
35218 check_local_user
35219 file = $home/.forward$local_part_suffix
35220 local_part_suffix = -*
35221 local_part_suffix_optional
35222 allow_filter
35223.endd
35224If there is no suffix, &_.forward_& is used; if the suffix is &'-special'&, for
35225example, &_.forward-special_& is used. Once again, if the appropriate file
35226does not exist, or does not deal with the address, it is passed on to
35227subsequent routers, which could, if required, look for an unqualified
35228&_.forward_& file to use as a default.
35229
35230
35231
35232.section "Simplified vacation processing" "SECID244"
35233.cindex "vacation processing"
35234The traditional way of running the &'vacation'& program is for a user to set up
35235a pipe command in a &_.forward_& file
35236(see section &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for syntax details).
35237This is prone to error by inexperienced users. There are two features of Exim
35238that can be used to make this process simpler for users:
35239
35240.ilist
35241A local part prefix such as &"vacation-"& can be specified on a router which
35242can cause the message to be delivered directly to the &'vacation'& program, or
35243alternatively can use Exim's &(autoreply)& transport. The contents of a user's
35244&_.forward_& file are then much simpler. For example:
35245.code
35246spqr, vacation-spqr
35247.endd
35248.next
35249The &%require_files%& generic router option can be used to trigger a
35250vacation delivery by checking for the existence of a certain file in the
35251user's home directory. The &%unseen%& generic option should also be used, to
35252ensure that the original delivery also proceeds. In this case, all the user has
35253to do is to create a file called, say, &_.vacation_&, containing a vacation
35254message.
35255.endlist
35256
35257Another advantage of both these methods is that they both work even when the
35258use of arbitrary pipes by users is locked out.
35259
35260
35261
35262.section "Taking copies of mail" "SECID245"
35263.cindex "message" "copying every"
35264Some installations have policies that require archive copies of all messages to
35265be made. A single copy of each message can easily be taken by an appropriate
35266command in a system filter, which could, for example, use a different file for
35267each day's messages.
35268
35269There is also a shadow transport mechanism that can be used to take copies of
35270messages that are successfully delivered by local transports, one copy per
35271delivery. This could be used, &'inter alia'&, to implement automatic
35272notification of delivery by sites that insist on doing such things.
35273
35274
35275
35276.section "Intermittently connected hosts" "SECID246"
35277.cindex "intermittently connected hosts"
35278It has become quite common (because it is cheaper) for hosts to connect to the
35279Internet periodically rather than remain connected all the time. The normal
35280arrangement is that mail for such hosts accumulates on a system that is
35281permanently connected.
35282
35283Exim was designed for use on permanently connected hosts, and so it is not
35284particularly well-suited to use in an intermittently connected environment.
35285Nevertheless there are some features that can be used.
35286
35287
35288.section "Exim on the upstream server host" "SECID247"
35289It is tempting to arrange for incoming mail for the intermittently connected
35290host to remain on Exim's queue until the client connects. However, this
35291approach does not scale very well. Two different kinds of waiting message are
35292being mixed up in the same queue &-- those that cannot be delivered because of
35293some temporary problem, and those that are waiting for their destination host
35294to connect. This makes it hard to manage the queue, as well as wasting
35295resources, because each queue runner scans the entire queue.
35296
35297A better approach is to separate off those messages that are waiting for an
35298intermittently connected host. This can be done by delivering these messages
35299into local files in batch SMTP, &"mailstore"&, or other envelope-preserving
35300format, from where they are transmitted by other software when their
35301destination connects. This makes it easy to collect all the mail for one host
35302in a single directory, and to apply local timeout rules on a per-message basis
35303if required.
35304
35305On a very small scale, leaving the mail on Exim's queue can be made to work. If
35306you are doing this, you should configure Exim with a long retry period for the
35307intermittent host. For example:
35308.code
35309cheshire.wonderland.fict.example * F,5d,24h
35310.endd
35311This stops a lot of failed delivery attempts from occurring, but Exim remembers
35312which messages it has queued up for that host. Once the intermittent host comes
35313online, forcing delivery of one message (either by using the &%-M%& or &%-R%&
35314options, or by using the ETRN SMTP command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&)
35315causes all the queued up messages to be delivered, often down a single SMTP
35316connection. While the host remains connected, any new messages get delivered
35317immediately.
35318
35319If the connecting hosts do not have fixed IP addresses, that is, if a host is
35320issued with a different IP address each time it connects, Exim's retry
35321mechanisms on the holding host get confused, because the IP address is normally
35322used as part of the key string for holding retry information. This can be
35323avoided by unsetting &%retry_include_ip_address%& on the &(smtp)& transport.
35324Since this has disadvantages for permanently connected hosts, it is best to
35325arrange a separate transport for the intermittently connected ones.
35326
35327
35328
35329.section "Exim on the intermittently connected client host" "SECID248"
35330The value of &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& should probably be
35331increased, or even set to zero (that is, disabled) on the intermittently
35332connected host, so that all incoming messages down a single connection get
35333delivered immediately.
35334
35335.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
35336.cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
35337.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
35338Mail waiting to be sent from an intermittently connected host will probably
35339not have been routed, because without a connection DNS lookups are not
35340possible. This means that if a normal queue run is done at connection time,
35341each message is likely to be sent in a separate SMTP session. This can be
35342avoided by starting the queue run with a command line option beginning with
35343&%-qq%& instead of &%-q%&. In this case, the queue is scanned twice. In the
35344first pass, routing is done but no deliveries take place. The second pass is a
35345normal queue run; since all the messages have been previously routed, those
35346destined for the same host are likely to get sent as multiple deliveries in a
35347single SMTP connection.
35348
35349
35350
35351. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35352. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35353
35354.chapter "Using Exim as a non-queueing client" "CHAPnonqueueing" &&&
35355 "Exim as a non-queueing client"
35356.cindex "client, non-queueing"
35357.cindex "smart host" "suppressing queueing"
35358On a personal computer, it is a common requirement for all
35359email to be sent to a &"smart host"&. There are plenty of MUAs that can be
35360configured to operate that way, for all the popular operating systems.
35361However, there are some MUAs for Unix-like systems that cannot be so
35362configured: they submit messages using the command line interface of
35363&_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. Furthermore, utility programs such as &'cron'& submit
35364messages this way.
35365
35366If the personal computer runs continuously, there is no problem, because it can
35367run a conventional MTA that handles delivery to the smart host, and deal with
35368any delays via its queueing mechanism. However, if the computer does not run
35369continuously or runs different operating systems at different times, queueing
35370email is not desirable.
35371
35372There is therefore a requirement for something that can provide the
35373&_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& interface but deliver messages to a smart host without
35374any queueing or retrying facilities. Furthermore, the delivery to the smart
35375host should be synchronous, so that if it fails, the sending MUA is immediately
35376informed. In other words, we want something that extends an MUA that submits
35377to a local MTA via the command line so that it behaves like one that submits
35378to a remote smart host using TCP/SMTP.
35379
35380There are a number of applications (for example, there is one called &'ssmtp'&)
35381that do this job. However, people have found them to be lacking in various
35382ways. For instance, you might want to allow aliasing and forwarding to be done
35383before sending a message to the smart host.
35384
35385Exim already had the necessary infrastructure for doing this job. Just a few
35386tweaks were needed to make it behave as required, though it is somewhat of an
35387overkill to use a fully-featured MTA for this purpose.
35388
35389.oindex "&%mua_wrapper%&"
35390There is a Boolean global option called &%mua_wrapper%&, defaulting false.
35391Setting &%mua_wrapper%& true causes Exim to run in a special mode where it
35392assumes that it is being used to &"wrap"& a command-line MUA in the manner
35393just described. As well as setting &%mua_wrapper%&, you also need to provide a
35394compatible router and transport configuration. Typically there will be just one
35395router and one transport, sending everything to a smart host.
35396
35397When run in MUA wrapping mode, the behaviour of Exim changes in the
35398following ways:
35399
35400.ilist
35401A daemon cannot be run, nor will Exim accept incoming messages from &'inetd'&.
35402In other words, the only way to submit messages is via the command line.
35403.next
35404Each message is synchronously delivered as soon as it is received (&%-odi%& is
35405assumed). All queueing options (&%queue_only%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
35406&%control%& in an ACL, etc.) are quietly ignored. The Exim reception process
35407does not finish until the delivery attempt is complete. If the delivery is
35408successful, a zero return code is given.
35409.next
35410Address redirection is permitted, but the final routing for all addresses must
35411be to the same remote transport, and to the same list of hosts. Furthermore,
35412the return address (envelope sender) must be the same for all recipients, as
35413must any added or deleted header lines. In other words, it must be possible to
35414deliver the message in a single SMTP transaction, however many recipients there
35415are.
35416.next
35417If these conditions are not met, or if routing any address results in a
35418failure or defer status, or if Exim is unable to deliver all the recipients
35419successfully to one of the smart hosts, delivery of the entire message fails.
35420.next
35421Because no queueing is allowed, all failures are treated as permanent; there
35422is no distinction between 4&'xx'& and 5&'xx'& SMTP response codes from the
35423smart host. Furthermore, because only a single yes/no response can be given to
35424the caller, it is not possible to deliver to some recipients and not others. If
35425there is an error (temporary or permanent) for any recipient, all are failed.
35426.next
35427If more than one smart host is listed, Exim will try another host after a
35428connection failure or a timeout, in the normal way. However, if this kind of
35429failure happens for all the hosts, the delivery fails.
35430.next
35431When delivery fails, an error message is written to the standard error stream
35432(as well as to Exim's log), and Exim exits to the caller with a return code
35433value 1. The message is expunged from Exim's spool files. No bounce messages
35434are ever generated.
35435.next
35436No retry data is maintained, and any retry rules are ignored.
35437.next
35438A number of Exim options are overridden: &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced
35439true, &%max_rcpt%& in the &(smtp)& transport is forced to &"unlimited"&,
35440&%remote_max_parallel%& is forced to one, and fallback hosts are ignored.
35441.endlist
35442
35443The overall effect is that Exim makes a single synchronous attempt to deliver
35444the message, failing if there is any kind of problem. Because no local
35445deliveries are done and no daemon can be run, Exim does not need root
35446privilege. It should be possible to run it setuid to &'exim'& instead of setuid
35447to &'root'&. See section &<<SECTrunexiwitpri>>& for a general discussion about
35448the advantages and disadvantages of running without root privilege.
35449
35450
35451
35452
35453. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35454. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35455
35456.chapter "Log files" "CHAPlog"
35457.scindex IIDloggen "log" "general description"
35458.cindex "log" "types of"
35459Exim writes three different logs, referred to as the main log, the reject log,
35460and the panic log:
35461
35462.ilist
35463.cindex "main log"
35464The main log records the arrival of each message and each delivery in a single
35465line in each case. The format is as compact as possible, in an attempt to keep
35466down the size of log files. Two-character flag sequences make it easy to pick
35467out these lines. A number of other events are recorded in the main log. Some of
35468them are optional, in which case the &%log_selector%& option controls whether
35469they are included or not. A Perl script called &'eximstats'&, which does simple
35470analysis of main log files, is provided in the Exim distribution (see section
35471&<<SECTmailstat>>&).
35472.next
35473.cindex "reject log"
35474The reject log records information from messages that are rejected as a result
35475of a configuration option (that is, for policy reasons).
35476The first line of each rejection is a copy of the line that is also written to
35477the main log. Then, if the message's header has been read at the time the log
35478is written, its contents are written to this log. Only the original header
35479lines are available; header lines added by ACLs are not logged. You can use the
35480reject log to check that your policy controls are working correctly; on a busy
35481host this may be easier than scanning the main log for rejection messages. You
35482can suppress the writing of the reject log by setting &%write_rejectlog%&
35483false.
35484.next
35485.cindex "panic log"
35486.cindex "system log"
35487When certain serious errors occur, Exim writes entries to its panic log. If the
35488error is sufficiently disastrous, Exim bombs out afterwards. Panic log entries
35489are usually written to the main log as well, but can get lost amid the mass of
35490other entries. The panic log should be empty under normal circumstances. It is
35491therefore a good idea to check it (or to have a &'cron'& script check it)
35492regularly, in order to become aware of any problems. When Exim cannot open its
35493panic log, it tries as a last resort to write to the system log (syslog). This
35494is opened with LOG_PID+LOG_CONS and the facility code of LOG_MAIL. The
35495message itself is written at priority LOG_CRIT.
35496.endlist
35497
35498Every log line starts with a timestamp, in the format shown in the following
35499example. Note that many of the examples shown in this chapter are line-wrapped.
35500In the log file, this would be all on one line:
35501.code
355022001-09-16 16:09:47 SMTP connection from [127.0.0.1] closed
35503 by QUIT
35504.endd
35505By default, the timestamps are in the local timezone. There are two
35506ways of changing this:
35507
35508.ilist
35509You can set the &%timezone%& option to a different time zone; in particular, if
35510you set
35511.code
35512timezone = UTC
35513.endd
35514the timestamps will be in UTC (aka GMT).
35515.next
35516If you set &%log_timezone%& true, the time zone is added to the timestamp, for
35517example:
35518.code
355192003-04-25 11:17:07 +0100 Start queue run: pid=12762
35520.endd
35521.endlist
35522
35523.cindex "log" "process ids in"
35524.cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
35525Exim does not include its process id in log lines by default, but you can
35526request that it does so by specifying the &`pid`& log selector (see section
35527&<<SECTlogselector>>&). When this is set, the process id is output, in square
35528brackets, immediately after the time and date.
35529
35530
35531
35532
35533.section "Where the logs are written" "SECTwhelogwri"
35534.cindex "log" "destination"
35535.cindex "log" "to file"
35536.cindex "log" "to syslog"
35537.cindex "syslog"
35538The logs may be written to local files, or to syslog, or both. However, it
35539should be noted that many syslog implementations use UDP as a transport, and
35540are therefore unreliable in the sense that messages are not guaranteed to
35541arrive at the loghost, nor is the ordering of messages necessarily maintained.
35542It has also been reported that on large log files (tens of megabytes) you may
35543need to tweak syslog to prevent it syncing the file with each write &-- on
35544Linux this has been seen to make syslog take 90% plus of CPU time.
35545
35546The destination for Exim's logs is configured by setting LOG_FILE_PATH in
35547&_Local/Makefile_& or by setting &%log_file_path%& in the run time
35548configuration. This latter string is expanded, so it can contain, for example,
35549references to the host name:
35550.code
35551log_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim_%slog
35552.endd
35553It is generally advisable, however, to set the string in &_Local/Makefile_&
35554rather than at run time, because then the setting is available right from the
35555start of Exim's execution. Otherwise, if there's something it wants to log
35556before it has read the configuration file (for example, an error in the
35557configuration file) it will not use the path you want, and may not be able to
35558log at all.
35559
35560The value of LOG_FILE_PATH or &%log_file_path%& is a colon-separated
35561list, currently limited to at most two items. This is one option where the
35562facility for changing a list separator may not be used. The list must always be
35563colon-separated. If an item in the list is &"syslog"& then syslog is used;
35564otherwise the item must either be an absolute path, containing &`%s`& at the
35565point where &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"& is to be inserted, or be empty,
35566implying the use of a default path.
35567
35568When Exim encounters an empty item in the list, it searches the list defined by
35569LOG_FILE_PATH, and uses the first item it finds that is neither empty nor
35570&"syslog"&. This means that an empty item in &%log_file_path%& can be used to
35571mean &"use the path specified at build time"&. It no such item exists, log
35572files are written in the &_log_& subdirectory of the spool directory. This is
35573equivalent to the setting:
35574.code
35575log_file_path = $spool_directory/log/%slog
35576.endd
35577If you do not specify anything at build time or run time,
35578or if you unset the option at run time (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&),
35579that is where the logs are written.
35580
35581A log file path may also contain &`%D`& or &`%M`& if datestamped log file names
35582are in use &-- see section &<<SECTdatlogfil>>& below.
35583
35584Here are some examples of possible settings:
35585.display
35586&`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog `& syslog only
35587&`LOG_FILE_PATH=:syslog `& syslog and default path
35588&`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog : /usr/log/exim_%s `& syslog and specified path
35589&`LOG_FILE_PATH=/usr/log/exim_%s `& specified path only
35590.endd
35591If there are more than two paths in the list, the first is used and a panic
35592error is logged.
35593
35594
35595
35596.section "Logging to local files that are periodically &""cycled""&" "SECID285"
35597.cindex "log" "cycling local files"
35598.cindex "cycling logs"
35599.cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
35600.cindex "log" "local files; writing to"
35601Some operating systems provide centralized and standardized methods for cycling
35602log files. For those that do not, a utility script called &'exicyclog'& is
35603provided (see section &<<SECTcyclogfil>>&). This renames and compresses the
35604main and reject logs each time it is called. The maximum number of old logs to
35605keep can be set. It is suggested this script is run as a daily &'cron'& job.
35606
35607An Exim delivery process opens the main log when it first needs to write to it,
35608and it keeps the file open in case subsequent entries are required &-- for
35609example, if a number of different deliveries are being done for the same
35610message. However, remote SMTP deliveries can take a long time, and this means
35611that the file may be kept open long after it is renamed if &'exicyclog'& or
35612something similar is being used to rename log files on a regular basis. To
35613ensure that a switch of log files is noticed as soon as possible, Exim calls
35614&[stat()]& on the main log's name before reusing an open file, and if the file
35615does not exist, or its inode has changed, the old file is closed and Exim
35616tries to open the main log from scratch. Thus, an old log file may remain open
35617for quite some time, but no Exim processes should write to it once it has been
35618renamed.
35619
35620
35621
35622.section "Datestamped log files" "SECTdatlogfil"
35623.cindex "log" "datestamped files"
35624Instead of cycling the main and reject log files by renaming them
35625periodically, some sites like to use files whose names contain a datestamp,
35626for example, &_mainlog-20031225_&. The datestamp is in the form &_yyyymmdd_& or
35627&_yyyymm_&. Exim has support for this way of working. It is enabled by setting
35628the &%log_file_path%& option to a path that includes &`%D`& or &`%M`& at the
35629point where the datestamp is required. For example:
35630.code
35631log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%slog-%D
35632log_file_path = /var/log/exim-%s-%D.log
35633log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%D-%slog
35634log_file_path = /var/log/exim/%s.%M
35635.endd
35636As before, &`%s`& is replaced by &"main"& or &"reject"&; the following are
35637examples of names generated by the above examples:
35638.code
35639/var/spool/exim/log/mainlog-20021225
35640/var/log/exim-reject-20021225.log
35641/var/spool/exim/log/20021225-mainlog
35642/var/log/exim/main.200212
35643.endd
35644When this form of log file is specified, Exim automatically switches to new
35645files at midnight. It does not make any attempt to compress old logs; you
35646will need to write your own script if you require this. You should not
35647run &'exicyclog'& with this form of logging.
35648
35649The location of the panic log is also determined by &%log_file_path%&, but it
35650is not datestamped, because rotation of the panic log does not make sense.
35651When generating the name of the panic log, &`%D`& or &`%M`& are removed from
35652the string. In addition, if it immediately follows a slash, a following
35653non-alphanumeric character is removed; otherwise a preceding non-alphanumeric
35654character is removed. Thus, the four examples above would give these panic
35655log names:
35656.code
35657/var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
35658/var/log/exim-panic.log
35659/var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
35660/var/log/exim/panic
35661.endd
35662
35663
35664.section "Logging to syslog" "SECID249"
35665.cindex "log" "syslog; writing to"
35666The use of syslog does not change what Exim logs or the format of its messages,
35667except in one respect. If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on
35668Exim's log lines are omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. Apart from
35669that, the same strings are written to syslog as to log files. The syslog
35670&"facility"& is set to LOG_MAIL, and the program name to &"exim"&
35671by default, but you can change these by setting the &%syslog_facility%& and
35672&%syslog_processname%& options, respectively. If Exim was compiled with
35673SYSLOG_LOG_PID set in &_Local/Makefile_& (this is the default in
35674&_src/EDITME_&), then, on systems that permit it (all except ULTRIX), the
35675LOG_PID flag is set so that the &[syslog()]& call adds the pid as well as
35676the time and host name to each line.
35677The three log streams are mapped onto syslog priorities as follows:
35678
35679.ilist
35680&'mainlog'& is mapped to LOG_INFO
35681.next
35682&'rejectlog'& is mapped to LOG_NOTICE
35683.next
35684&'paniclog'& is mapped to LOG_ALERT
35685.endlist
35686
35687Many log lines are written to both &'mainlog'& and &'rejectlog'&, and some are
35688written to both &'mainlog'& and &'paniclog'&, so there will be duplicates if
35689these are routed by syslog to the same place. You can suppress this duplication
35690by setting &%syslog_duplication%& false.
35691
35692Exim's log lines can sometimes be very long, and some of its &'rejectlog'&
35693entries contain multiple lines when headers are included. To cope with both
35694these cases, entries written to syslog are split into separate &[syslog()]&
35695calls at each internal newline, and also after a maximum of
35696870 data characters. (This allows for a total syslog line length of 1024, when
35697additions such as timestamps are added.) If you are running a syslog
35698replacement that can handle lines longer than the 1024 characters allowed by
35699RFC 3164, you should set
35700.code
35701SYSLOG_LONG_LINES=yes
35702.endd
35703in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. That stops Exim from splitting long
35704lines, but it still splits at internal newlines in &'reject'& log entries.
35705
35706To make it easy to re-assemble split lines later, each component of a split
35707entry starts with a string of the form [<&'n'&>/<&'m'&>] or [<&'n'&>\<&'m'&>]
35708where <&'n'&> is the component number and <&'m'&> is the total number of
35709components in the entry. The / delimiter is used when the line was split
35710because it was too long; if it was split because of an internal newline, the \
35711delimiter is used. For example, supposing the length limit to be 50 instead of
35712870, the following would be the result of a typical rejection message to
35713&'mainlog'& (LOG_INFO), each line in addition being preceded by the time, host
35714name, and pid as added by syslog:
35715.code
35716[1/5] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected from
35717[2/5] [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' header
35718[3/5] when scanning for sender: missing or malformed lo
35719[4/5] cal part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam.exa
35720[5/5] mple>)
35721.endd
35722The same error might cause the following lines to be written to &"rejectlog"&
35723(LOG_NOTICE):
35724.code
35725[1/18] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected fro
35726[2/18] m [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' head
35727[3/18] er when scanning for sender: missing or malformed
35728[4/18] local part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam
35729[5\18] .example>)
35730[6\18] Recipients: ph10@some.domain.cam.example
35731[7\18] P Received: from [127.0.0.1] (ident=ph10)
35732[8\18] by xxxxx.cam.example with smtp (Exim 4.00)
35733[9\18] id 16RdAL-0006pc-00
35734[10/18] for ph10@cam.example; Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:
35735[11\18] 09:43 +0100
35736[12\18] F From: <>
35737[13\18] Subject: this is a test header
35738[18\18] X-something: this is another header
35739[15/18] I Message-Id: <E16RdAL-0006pc-00@xxxxx.cam.examp
35740[16\18] le>
35741[17\18] B Bcc:
35742[18/18] Date: Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:09:43 +0100
35743.endd
35744Log lines that are neither too long nor contain newlines are written to syslog
35745without modification.
35746
35747If only syslog is being used, the Exim monitor is unable to provide a log tail
35748display, unless syslog is routing &'mainlog'& to a file on the local host and
35749the environment variable EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set to tell the monitor
35750where it is.
35751
35752
35753
35754.section "Log line flags" "SECID250"
35755One line is written to the main log for each message received, and for each
35756successful, unsuccessful, and delayed delivery. These lines can readily be
35757picked out by the distinctive two-character flags that immediately follow the
35758timestamp. The flags are:
35759.display
35760&`<=`& message arrival
35761&`(=`& message fakereject
35762&`=>`& normal message delivery
35763&`->`& additional address in same delivery
35764&`>>`& cutthrough message delivery
35765&`*>`& delivery suppressed by &%-N%&
35766&`**`& delivery failed; address bounced
35767&`==`& delivery deferred; temporary problem
35768.endd
35769
35770
35771.section "Logging message reception" "SECID251"
35772.cindex "log" "reception line"
35773The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
35774message received is shown in the basic example below, which is split over
35775several lines in order to fit it on the page:
35776.code
357772002-10-31 08:57:53 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 <= kryten@dwarf.fict.example
35778 H=mailer.fict.example [192.168.123.123] U=exim
35779 P=smtp S=5678 id=<incoming message id>
35780.endd
35781The address immediately following &"<="& is the envelope sender address. A
35782bounce message is shown with the sender address &"<>"&, and if it is locally
35783generated, this is followed by an item of the form
35784.code
35785R=<message id>
35786.endd
35787which is a reference to the message that caused the bounce to be sent.
35788
35789.cindex "HELO"
35790.cindex "EHLO"
35791For messages from other hosts, the H and U fields identify the remote host and
35792record the RFC 1413 identity of the user that sent the message, if one was
35793received. The number given in square brackets is the IP address of the sending
35794host. If there is a single, unparenthesized host name in the H field, as
35795above, it has been verified to correspond to the IP address (see the
35796&%host_lookup%& option). If the name is in parentheses, it was the name quoted
35797by the remote host in the SMTP HELO or EHLO command, and has not been
35798verified. If verification yields a different name to that given for HELO or
35799EHLO, the verified name appears first, followed by the HELO or EHLO
35800name in parentheses.
35801
35802Misconfigured hosts (and mail forgers) sometimes put an IP address, with or
35803without brackets, in the HELO or EHLO command, leading to entries in
35804the log containing text like these examples:
35805.code
35806H=(10.21.32.43) [192.168.8.34]
35807H=([10.21.32.43]) [192.168.8.34]
35808.endd
35809This can be confusing. Only the final address in square brackets can be relied
35810on.
35811
35812For locally generated messages (that is, messages not received over TCP/IP),
35813the H field is omitted, and the U field contains the login name of the caller
35814of Exim.
35815
35816.cindex "authentication" "logging"
35817.cindex "AUTH" "logging"
35818For all messages, the P field specifies the protocol used to receive the
35819message. This is the value that is stored in &$received_protocol$&. In the case
35820of incoming SMTP messages, the value indicates whether or not any SMTP
35821extensions (ESMTP), encryption, or authentication were used. If the SMTP
35822session was encrypted, there is an additional X field that records the cipher
35823suite that was used.
35824
35825.cindex log protocol
35826The protocol is set to &"esmtpsa"& or &"esmtpa"& for messages received from
35827hosts that have authenticated themselves using the SMTP AUTH command. The first
35828value is used when the SMTP connection was encrypted (&"secure"&). In this case
35829there is an additional item A= followed by the name of the authenticator that
35830was used. If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's
35831&%server_set_id%& option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the
35832authenticator name.
35833
35834.cindex "size" "of message"
35835The id field records the existing message id, if present. The size of the
35836received message is given by the S field. When the message is delivered,
35837headers may be removed or added, so that the size of delivered copies of the
35838message may not correspond with this value (and indeed may be different to each
35839other).
35840
35841The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
35842data when a message is received. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
35843
35844
35845
35846.section "Logging deliveries" "SECID252"
35847.cindex "log" "delivery line"
35848The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
35849delivery is shown in one of the examples below, for local and remote
35850deliveries, respectively. Each example has been split into multiple lines in order
35851to fit it on the page:
35852.code
358532002-10-31 08:59:13 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 => marv
35854 <marv@hitch.fict.example> R=localuser T=local_delivery
358552002-10-31 09:00:10 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 =>
35856 monk@holistic.fict.example R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp
35857 H=holistic.fict.example [192.168.234.234]
35858.endd
35859For ordinary local deliveries, the original address is given in angle brackets
35860after the final delivery address, which might be a pipe or a file. If
35861intermediate address(es) exist between the original and the final address, the
35862last of these is given in parentheses after the final address. The R and T
35863fields record the router and transport that were used to process the address.
35864
35865If SMTP AUTH was used for the delivery there is an additional item A=
35866followed by the name of the authenticator that was used.
35867If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's &%client_set_id%&
35868option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the authenticator name.
35869
35870If a shadow transport was run after a successful local delivery, the log line
35871for the successful delivery has an item added on the end, of the form
35872.display
35873&`ST=<`&&'shadow transport name'&&`>`&
35874.endd
35875If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
35876parentheses afterwards.
35877
35878.cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
35879When more than one address is included in a single delivery (for example, two
35880SMTP RCPT commands in one transaction) the second and subsequent addresses are
35881flagged with &`->`& instead of &`=>`&. When two or more messages are delivered
35882down a single SMTP connection, an asterisk follows the IP address in the log
35883lines for the second and subsequent messages.
35884.new
35885When two or more messages are delivered down a single TLS connection, the
35886DNS and some TLS-related information logged for the first message delivered
35887will not be present in the log lines for the second and subsequent messages.
35888TLS cipher information is still available.
35889.wen
35890
35891.cindex "delivery" "cutthrough; logging"
35892.cindex "cutthrough" "logging"
35893When delivery is done in cutthrough mode it is flagged with &`>>`& and the log
35894line precedes the reception line, since cutthrough waits for a possible
35895rejection from the destination in case it can reject the sourced item.
35896
35897The generation of a reply message by a filter file gets logged as a
35898&"delivery"& to the addressee, preceded by &">"&.
35899
35900The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
35901data when a message is delivered. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
35902
35903
35904.section "Discarded deliveries" "SECID253"
35905.cindex "discarded messages"
35906.cindex "message" "discarded"
35907.cindex "delivery" "discarded; logging"
35908When a message is discarded as a result of the command &"seen finish"& being
35909obeyed in a filter file which generates no deliveries, a log entry of the form
35910.code
359112002-12-10 00:50:49 16auJc-0001UB-00 => discarded
35912 <low.club@bridge.example> R=userforward
35913.endd
35914is written, to record why no deliveries are logged. When a message is discarded
35915because it is aliased to &":blackhole:"& the log line is like this:
35916.code
359171999-03-02 09:44:33 10HmaX-0005vi-00 => :blackhole:
35918 <hole@nowhere.example> R=blackhole_router
35919.endd
35920
35921
35922.section "Deferred deliveries" "SECID254"
35923When a delivery is deferred, a line of the following form is logged:
35924.code
359252002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 == marvin@endrest.example
35926 R=dnslookup T=smtp defer (146): Connection refused
35927.endd
35928In the case of remote deliveries, the error is the one that was given for the
35929last IP address that was tried. Details of individual SMTP failures are also
35930written to the log, so the above line would be preceded by something like
35931.code
359322002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 Failed to connect to
35933 mail1.endrest.example [192.168.239.239]: Connection refused
35934.endd
35935When a deferred address is skipped because its retry time has not been reached,
35936a message is written to the log, but this can be suppressed by setting an
35937appropriate value in &%log_selector%&.
35938
35939
35940
35941.section "Delivery failures" "SECID255"
35942.cindex "delivery" "failure; logging"
35943If a delivery fails because an address cannot be routed, a line of the
35944following form is logged:
35945.code
359461995-12-19 16:20:23 0tRiQz-0002Q5-00 ** jim@trek99.example
35947 <jim@trek99.example>: unknown mail domain
35948.endd
35949If a delivery fails at transport time, the router and transport are shown, and
35950the response from the remote host is included, as in this example:
35951.code
359522002-07-11 07:14:17 17SXDU-000189-00 ** ace400@pb.example
35953 R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp: SMTP error from remote mailer
35954 after pipelined RCPT TO:<ace400@pb.example>: host
35955 pbmail3.py.example [192.168.63.111]: 553 5.3.0
35956 <ace400@pb.example>...Addressee unknown
35957.endd
35958The word &"pipelined"& indicates that the SMTP PIPELINING extension was being
35959used. See &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%& in the &(smtp)& transport for a way of
35960disabling PIPELINING. The log lines for all forms of delivery failure are
35961flagged with &`**`&.
35962
35963
35964
35965.section "Fake deliveries" "SECID256"
35966.cindex "delivery" "fake; logging"
35967If a delivery does not actually take place because the &%-N%& option has been
35968used to suppress it, a normal delivery line is written to the log, except that
35969&"=>"& is replaced by &"*>"&.
35970
35971
35972
35973.section "Completion" "SECID257"
35974A line of the form
35975.code
359762002-10-31 09:00:11 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 Completed
35977.endd
35978is written to the main log when a message is about to be removed from the spool
35979at the end of its processing.
35980
35981
35982
35983
35984.section "Summary of Fields in Log Lines" "SECID258"
35985.cindex "log" "summary of fields"
35986A summary of the field identifiers that are used in log lines is shown in
35987the following table:
35988.display
35989&`A `& authenticator name (and optional id and sender)
35990&`C `& SMTP confirmation on delivery
35991&` `& command list for &"no mail in SMTP session"&
35992&`CV `& certificate verification status
35993&`D `& duration of &"no mail in SMTP session"&
35994&`DN `& distinguished name from peer certificate
35995&`DS `& DNSSEC secured lookups
35996&`DT `& on &`=>`& lines: time taken for a delivery
35997&`F `& sender address (on delivery lines)
35998&`H `& host name and IP address
35999&`I `& local interface used
36000&`K `& CHUNKING extension used
36001&`id `& message id for incoming message
36002&`M8S `& 8BITMIME status for incoming message
36003&`P `& on &`<=`& lines: protocol used
36004&` `& on &`=>`& and &`**`& lines: return path
36005&`PRDR`& PRDR extension used
36006&`PRX `& on &`<=`& and &`=>`& lines: proxy address
36007&`Q `& alternate queue name
36008&`QT `& on &`=>`& lines: time spent on queue so far
36009&` `& on &"Completed"& lines: time spent on queue
36010&`R `& on &`<=`& lines: reference for local bounce
36011&` `& on &`=>`& &`>>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: router name
36012&`S `& size of message in bytes
36013&`SNI `& server name indication from TLS client hello
36014&`ST `& shadow transport name
36015&`T `& on &`<=`& lines: message subject (topic)
36016&` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: transport name
36017&`U `& local user or RFC 1413 identity
36018&`X `& TLS cipher suite
36019.endd
36020
36021
36022.section "Other log entries" "SECID259"
36023Various other types of log entry are written from time to time. Most should be
36024self-explanatory. Among the more common are:
36025
36026.ilist
36027.cindex "retry" "time not reached"
36028&'retry time not reached'&&~&~An address previously suffered a temporary error
36029during routing or local delivery, and the time to retry has not yet arrived.
36030This message is not written to an individual message log file unless it happens
36031during the first delivery attempt.
36032.next
36033&'retry time not reached for any host'&&~&~An address previously suffered
36034temporary errors during remote delivery, and the retry time has not yet arrived
36035for any of the hosts to which it is routed.
36036.next
36037.cindex "spool directory" "file locked"
36038&'spool file locked'&&~&~An attempt to deliver a message cannot proceed because
36039some other Exim process is already working on the message. This can be quite
36040common if queue running processes are started at frequent intervals. The
36041&'exiwhat'& utility script can be used to find out what Exim processes are
36042doing.
36043.next
36044.cindex "error" "ignored"
36045&'error ignored'&&~&~There are several circumstances that give rise to this
36046message:
36047.olist
36048Exim failed to deliver a bounce message whose age was greater than
36049&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. The bounce was discarded.
36050.next
36051A filter file set up a delivery using the &"noerror"& option, and the delivery
36052failed. The delivery was discarded.
36053.next
36054A delivery set up by a router configured with
36055. ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
36056. ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
36057.code
36058 errors_to = <>
36059.endd
36060failed. The delivery was discarded.
36061.endlist olist
36062.endlist ilist
36063
36064
36065
36066
36067
36068.section "Reducing or increasing what is logged" "SECTlogselector"
36069.cindex "log" "selectors"
36070By setting the &%log_selector%& global option, you can disable some of Exim's
36071default logging, or you can request additional logging. The value of
36072&%log_selector%& is made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. For
36073example:
36074.code
36075log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
36076.endd
36077The list of optional log items is in the following table, with the default
36078selection marked by asterisks:
36079.display
36080&` 8bitmime `& received 8BITMIME status
36081&`*acl_warn_skipped `& skipped &%warn%& statement in ACL
36082&` address_rewrite `& address rewriting
36083&` all_parents `& all parents in => lines
36084&` arguments `& command line arguments
36085&`*connection_reject `& connection rejections
36086&`*delay_delivery `& immediate delivery delayed
36087&` deliver_time `& time taken to perform delivery
36088&` delivery_size `& add &`S=`&&'nnn'& to => lines
36089&`*dnslist_defer `& defers of DNS list (aka RBL) lookups
36090&` dnssec `& DNSSEC secured lookups
36091&`*etrn `& ETRN commands
36092&`*host_lookup_failed `& as it says
36093&` ident_timeout `& timeout for ident connection
36094&` incoming_interface `& local interface on <= and => lines
36095&` incoming_port `& remote port on <= lines
36096&`*lost_incoming_connection `& as it says (includes timeouts)
36097&` outgoing_interface `& local interface on => lines
36098&` outgoing_port `& add remote port to => lines
36099&`*queue_run `& start and end queue runs
36100&` queue_time `& time on queue for one recipient
36101&` queue_time_overall `& time on queue for whole message
36102&` pid `& Exim process id
36103&` proxy `& proxy address on <= and => lines
36104&` received_recipients `& recipients on <= lines
36105&` received_sender `& sender on <= lines
36106&`*rejected_header `& header contents on reject log
36107&`*retry_defer `& &"retry time not reached"&
36108&` return_path_on_delivery `& put return path on => and ** lines
36109&` sender_on_delivery `& add sender to => lines
36110&`*sender_verify_fail `& sender verification failures
36111&`*size_reject `& rejection because too big
36112&`*skip_delivery `& delivery skipped in a queue run
36113&`*smtp_confirmation `& SMTP confirmation on => lines
36114&` smtp_connection `& incoming SMTP connections
36115&` smtp_incomplete_transaction`& incomplete SMTP transactions
36116&` smtp_mailauth `& AUTH argument to MAIL commands
36117&` smtp_no_mail `& session with no MAIL commands
36118&` smtp_protocol_error `& SMTP protocol errors
36119&` smtp_syntax_error `& SMTP syntax errors
36120&` subject `& contents of &'Subject:'& on <= lines
36121&`*tls_certificate_verified `& certificate verification status
36122&`*tls_cipher `& TLS cipher suite on <= and => lines
36123&` tls_peerdn `& TLS peer DN on <= and => lines
36124&` tls_sni `& TLS SNI on <= lines
36125&` unknown_in_list `& DNS lookup failed in list match
36126
36127&` all `& all of the above
36128.endd
36129See also the &%slow_lookup_log%& main configuration option,
36130section &<<SECID99>>&
36131
36132More details on each of these items follows:
36133
36134.ilist
36135.cindex "8BITMIME"
36136.cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
36137&%8bitmime%&: This causes Exim to log any 8BITMIME status of received messages,
36138which may help in tracking down interoperability issues with ancient MTAs
36139that are not 8bit clean. This is added to the &"<="& line, tagged with
36140&`M8S=`& and a value of &`0`&, &`7`& or &`8`&, corresponding to "not given",
36141&`7BIT`& and &`8BITMIME`& respectively.
36142.next
36143.cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb" "log when skipping"
36144&%acl_warn_skipped%&: When an ACL &%warn%& statement is skipped because one of
36145its conditions cannot be evaluated, a log line to this effect is written if
36146this log selector is set.
36147.next
36148.cindex "log" "rewriting"
36149.cindex "rewriting" "logging"
36150&%address_rewrite%&: This applies both to global rewrites and per-transport
36151rewrites, but not to rewrites in filters run as an unprivileged user (because
36152such users cannot access the log).
36153.next
36154.cindex "log" "full parentage"
36155&%all_parents%&: Normally only the original and final addresses are logged on
36156delivery lines; with this selector, intermediate parents are given in
36157parentheses between them.
36158.next
36159.cindex "log" "Exim arguments"
36160.cindex "Exim arguments, logging"
36161&%arguments%&: This causes Exim to write the arguments with which it was called
36162to the main log, preceded by the current working directory. This is a debugging
36163feature, added to make it easier to find out how certain MUAs call
36164&_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. The logging does not happen if Exim has given up root
36165privilege because it was called with the &%-C%& or &%-D%& options. Arguments
36166that are empty or that contain white space are quoted. Non-printing characters
36167are shown as escape sequences. This facility cannot log unrecognized arguments,
36168because the arguments are checked before the configuration file is read. The
36169only way to log such cases is to interpose a script such as &_util/logargs.sh_&
36170between the caller and Exim.
36171.next
36172.cindex "log" "connection rejections"
36173&%connection_reject%&: A log entry is written whenever an incoming SMTP
36174connection is rejected, for whatever reason.
36175.next
36176.cindex "log" "delayed delivery"
36177.cindex "delayed delivery, logging"
36178&%delay_delivery%&: A log entry is written whenever a delivery process is not
36179started for an incoming message because the load is too high or too many
36180messages were received on one connection. Logging does not occur if no delivery
36181process is started because &%queue_only%& is set or &%-odq%& was used.
36182.next
36183.cindex "log" "delivery duration"
36184&%deliver_time%&: For each delivery, the amount of real time it has taken to
36185perform the actual delivery is logged as DT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`DT=1s`&.
36186.next
36187.cindex "log" "message size on delivery"
36188.cindex "size" "of message"
36189&%delivery_size%&: For each delivery, the size of message delivered is added to
36190the &"=>"& line, tagged with S=.
36191.next
36192.cindex "log" "dnslist defer"
36193.cindex "DNS list" "logging defer"
36194.cindex "black list (DNS)"
36195&%dnslist_defer%&: A log entry is written if an attempt to look up a host in a
36196DNS black list suffers a temporary error.
36197.next
36198.cindex log dnssec
36199.cindex dnssec logging
36200&%dnssec%&: For message acceptance and (attempted) delivery log lines, when
36201dns lookups gave secure results a tag of DS is added.
36202For acceptance this covers the reverse and forward lookups for host name verification.
36203It does not cover helo-name verification.
36204For delivery this covers the SRV, MX, A and/or AAAA lookups.
36205.next
36206.cindex "log" "ETRN commands"
36207.cindex "ETRN" "logging"
36208&%etrn%&: Every valid ETRN command that is received is logged, before the ACL
36209is run to determine whether or not it is actually accepted. An invalid ETRN
36210command, or one received within a message transaction is not logged by this
36211selector (see &%smtp_syntax_error%& and &%smtp_protocol_error%&).
36212.next
36213.cindex "log" "host lookup failure"
36214&%host_lookup_failed%&: When a lookup of a host's IP addresses fails to find
36215any addresses, or when a lookup of an IP address fails to find a host name, a
36216log line is written. This logging does not apply to direct DNS lookups when
36217routing email addresses, but it does apply to &"byname"& lookups.
36218.next
36219.cindex "log" "ident timeout"
36220.cindex "RFC 1413" "logging timeout"
36221&%ident_timeout%&: A log line is written whenever an attempt to connect to a
36222client's ident port times out.
36223.next
36224.cindex "log" "incoming interface"
36225.cindex "log" "local interface"
36226.cindex "log" "local address and port"
36227.cindex "TCP/IP" "logging local address and port"
36228.cindex "interface" "logging"
36229&%incoming_interface%&: The interface on which a message was received is added
36230to the &"<="& line as an IP address in square brackets, tagged by I= and
36231followed by a colon and the port number. The local interface and port are also
36232added to other SMTP log lines, for example &"SMTP connection from"&, to
36233rejection lines, and (despite the name) to outgoing &"=>"& and &"->"& lines.
36234The latter can be disabled by turning off the &%outgoing_interface%& option.
36235.next
36236.cindex log "incoming proxy address"
36237.cindex proxy "logging proxy address"
36238.cindex "TCP/IP" "logging proxy address"
36239&%proxy%&: The internal (closest to the system running Exim) IP address
36240of the proxy, tagged by PRX=, on the &"<="& line for a message accepted
36241on a proxied connection
36242or the &"=>"& line for a message delivered on a proxied connection.
36243See &<<SECTproxyInbound>>& for more information.
36244.next
36245.cindex "log" "incoming remote port"
36246.cindex "port" "logging remote"
36247.cindex "TCP/IP" "logging incoming remote port"
36248.vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
36249.vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
36250&%incoming_port%&: The remote port number from which a message was received is
36251added to log entries and &'Received:'& header lines, following the IP address
36252in square brackets, and separated from it by a colon. This is implemented by
36253changing the value that is put in the &$sender_fullhost$& and
36254&$sender_rcvhost$& variables. Recording the remote port number has become more
36255important with the widening use of NAT (see RFC 2505).
36256.next
36257.cindex "log" "dropped connection"
36258&%lost_incoming_connection%&: A log line is written when an incoming SMTP
36259connection is unexpectedly dropped.
36260.next
36261.cindex "log" "outgoing interface"
36262.cindex "log" "local interface"
36263.cindex "log" "local address and port"
36264.cindex "TCP/IP" "logging local address and port"
36265.cindex "interface" "logging"
36266&%outgoing_interface%&: If &%incoming_interface%& is turned on, then the
36267interface on which a message was sent is added to delivery lines as an I= tag
36268followed by IP address in square brackets. You can disable this by turning
36269off the &%outgoing_interface%& option.
36270.next
36271.cindex "log" "outgoing remote port"
36272.cindex "port" "logging outgoint remote"
36273.cindex "TCP/IP" "logging outgoing remote port"
36274&%outgoing_port%&: The remote port number is added to delivery log lines (those
36275containing => tags) following the IP address.
36276The local port is also added if &%incoming_interface%& and
36277&%outgoing_interface%& are both enabled.
36278This option is not included in the default setting, because for most ordinary
36279configurations, the remote port number is always 25 (the SMTP port), and the
36280local port is a random ephemeral port.
36281.next
36282.cindex "log" "process ids in"
36283.cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
36284&%pid%&: The current process id is added to every log line, in square brackets,
36285immediately after the time and date.
36286.next
36287.cindex "log" "queue run"
36288.cindex "queue runner" "logging"
36289&%queue_run%&: The start and end of every queue run are logged.
36290.next
36291.cindex "log" "queue time"
36292&%queue_time%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on the
36293local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on delivery (&`=>`&) lines, for example,
36294&`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the message, so it
36295includes reception time as well as the delivery time for the current address.
36296This means that it may be longer than the difference between the arrival and
36297delivery log line times, because the arrival log line is not written until the
36298message has been successfully received.
36299.next
36300&%queue_time_overall%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on
36301the local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on &"Completed"& lines, for
36302example, &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the
36303message, so it includes reception time as well as the total delivery time.
36304.next
36305.cindex "log" "recipients"
36306&%received_recipients%&: The recipients of a message are listed in the main log
36307as soon as the message is received. The list appears at the end of the log line
36308that is written when a message is received, preceded by the word &"for"&. The
36309addresses are listed after they have been qualified, but before any rewriting
36310has taken place.
36311Recipients that were discarded by an ACL for MAIL or RCPT do not appear
36312in the list.
36313.next
36314.cindex "log" "sender reception"
36315&%received_sender%&: The unrewritten original sender of a message is added to
36316the end of the log line that records the message's arrival, after the word
36317&"from"& (before the recipients if &%received_recipients%& is also set).
36318.next
36319.cindex "log" "header lines for rejection"
36320&%rejected_header%&: If a message's header has been received at the time a
36321rejection is written to the reject log, the complete header is added to the
36322log. Header logging can be turned off individually for messages that are
36323rejected by the &[local_scan()]& function (see section &<<SECTapiforloc>>&).
36324.next
36325.cindex "log" "retry defer"
36326&%retry_defer%&: A log line is written if a delivery is deferred because a
36327retry time has not yet been reached. However, this &"retry time not reached"&
36328message is always omitted from individual message logs after the first delivery
36329attempt.
36330.next
36331.cindex "log" "return path"
36332&%return_path_on_delivery%&: The return path that is being transmitted with
36333the message is included in delivery and bounce lines, using the tag P=.
36334This is omitted if no delivery actually happens, for example, if routing fails,
36335or if delivery is to &_/dev/null_& or to &`:blackhole:`&.
36336.next
36337.cindex "log" "sender on delivery"
36338&%sender_on_delivery%&: The message's sender address is added to every delivery
36339and bounce line, tagged by F= (for &"from"&).
36340This is the original sender that was received with the message; it is not
36341necessarily the same as the outgoing return path.
36342.next
36343.cindex "log" "sender verify failure"
36344&%sender_verify_fail%&: If this selector is unset, the separate log line that
36345gives details of a sender verification failure is not written. Log lines for
36346the rejection of SMTP commands contain just &"sender verify failed"&, so some
36347detail is lost.
36348.next
36349.cindex "log" "size rejection"
36350&%size_reject%&: A log line is written whenever a message is rejected because
36351it is too big.
36352.next
36353.cindex "log" "frozen messages; skipped"
36354.cindex "frozen messages" "logging skipping"
36355&%skip_delivery%&: A log line is written whenever a message is skipped during a
36356queue run because it is frozen or because another process is already delivering
36357it.
36358.cindex "&""spool file is locked""&"
36359The message that is written is &"spool file is locked"&.
36360.next
36361.cindex "log" "smtp confirmation"
36362.cindex "SMTP" "logging confirmation"
36363.cindex "LMTP" "logging confirmation"
36364&%smtp_confirmation%&: The response to the final &"."& in the SMTP or LMTP dialogue for
36365outgoing messages is added to delivery log lines in the form &`C=`&<&'text'&>.
36366A number of MTAs (including Exim) return an identifying string in this
36367response.
36368.next
36369.cindex "log" "SMTP connections"
36370.cindex "SMTP" "logging connections"
36371&%smtp_connection%&: A log line is written whenever an incoming SMTP connection is
36372established or closed, unless the connection is from a host that matches
36373&%hosts_connection_nolog%&. (In contrast, &%lost_incoming_connection%& applies
36374only when the closure is unexpected.) This applies to connections from local
36375processes that use &%-bs%& as well as to TCP/IP connections. If a connection is
36376dropped in the middle of a message, a log line is always written, whether or
36377not this selector is set, but otherwise nothing is written at the start and end
36378of connections unless this selector is enabled.
36379
36380For TCP/IP connections to an Exim daemon, the current number of connections is
36381included in the log message for each new connection, but note that the count is
36382reset if the daemon is restarted.
36383Also, because connections are closed (and the closure is logged) in
36384subprocesses, the count may not include connections that have been closed but
36385whose termination the daemon has not yet noticed. Thus, while it is possible to
36386match up the opening and closing of connections in the log, the value of the
36387logged counts may not be entirely accurate.
36388.next
36389.cindex "log" "SMTP transaction; incomplete"
36390.cindex "SMTP" "logging incomplete transactions"
36391&%smtp_incomplete_transaction%&: When a mail transaction is aborted by
36392RSET, QUIT, loss of connection, or otherwise, the incident is logged,
36393and the message sender plus any accepted recipients are included in the log
36394line. This can provide evidence of dictionary attacks.
36395.next
36396.cindex "log" "non-MAIL SMTP sessions"
36397.cindex "MAIL" "logging session without"
36398&%smtp_no_mail%&: A line is written to the main log whenever an accepted SMTP
36399connection terminates without having issued a MAIL command. This includes both
36400the case when the connection is dropped, and the case when QUIT is used. It
36401does not include cases where the connection is rejected right at the start (by
36402an ACL, or because there are too many connections, or whatever). These cases
36403already have their own log lines.
36404
36405The log line that is written contains the identity of the client in the usual
36406way, followed by D= and a time, which records the duration of the connection.
36407If the connection was authenticated, this fact is logged exactly as it is for
36408an incoming message, with an A= item. If the connection was encrypted, CV=,
36409DN=, and X= items may appear as they do for an incoming message, controlled by
36410the same logging options.
36411
36412Finally, if any SMTP commands were issued during the connection, a C= item
36413is added to the line, listing the commands that were used. For example,
36414.code
36415C=EHLO,QUIT
36416.endd
36417shows that the client issued QUIT straight after EHLO. If there were fewer
36418than 20 commands, they are all listed. If there were more than 20 commands,
36419the last 20 are listed, preceded by &"..."&. However, with the default
36420setting of 10 for &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&, the connection will in any case
36421have been aborted before 20 non-mail commands are processed.
36422.next
36423&%smtp_mailauth%&: A third subfield with the authenticated sender,
36424colon-separated, is appended to the A= item for a message arrival or delivery
36425log line, if an AUTH argument to the SMTP MAIL command (see &<<SECTauthparamail>>&)
36426was accepted or used.
36427.next
36428.cindex "log" "SMTP protocol error"
36429.cindex "SMTP" "logging protocol error"
36430&%smtp_protocol_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP protocol error
36431encountered. Exim does not have perfect detection of all protocol errors
36432because of transmission delays and the use of pipelining. If PIPELINING has
36433been advertised to a client, an Exim server assumes that the client will use
36434it, and therefore it does not count &"expected"& errors (for example, RCPT
36435received after rejecting MAIL) as protocol errors.
36436.next
36437.cindex "SMTP" "logging syntax errors"
36438.cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors; logging"
36439.cindex "SMTP" "unknown command; logging"
36440.cindex "log" "unknown SMTP command"
36441.cindex "log" "SMTP syntax error"
36442&%smtp_syntax_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP syntax error
36443encountered. An unrecognized command is treated as a syntax error. For an
36444external connection, the host identity is given; for an internal connection
36445using &%-bs%& the sender identification (normally the calling user) is given.
36446.next
36447.cindex "log" "subject"
36448.cindex "subject, logging"
36449&%subject%&: The subject of the message is added to the arrival log line,
36450preceded by &"T="& (T for &"topic"&, since S is already used for &"size"&).
36451Any MIME &"words"& in the subject are decoded. The &%print_topbitchars%& option
36452specifies whether characters with values greater than 127 should be logged
36453unchanged, or whether they should be rendered as escape sequences.
36454.next
36455.cindex "log" "certificate verification"
36456&%tls_certificate_verified%&: An extra item is added to <= and => log lines
36457when TLS is in use. The item is &`CV=yes`& if the peer's certificate was
36458verified, and &`CV=no`& if not.
36459.next
36460.cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
36461.cindex "TLS" "logging cipher"
36462&%tls_cipher%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
36463connection, the cipher suite used is added to the log line, preceded by X=.
36464.next
36465.cindex "log" "TLS peer DN"
36466.cindex "TLS" "logging peer DN"
36467&%tls_peerdn%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
36468connection, and a certificate is supplied by the remote host, the peer DN is
36469added to the log line, preceded by DN=.
36470.next
36471.cindex "log" "TLS SNI"
36472.cindex "TLS" "logging SNI"
36473&%tls_sni%&: When a message is received over an encrypted connection, and
36474the remote host provided the Server Name Indication extension, the SNI is
36475added to the log line, preceded by SNI=.
36476.next
36477.cindex "log" "DNS failure in list"
36478&%unknown_in_list%&: This setting causes a log entry to be written when the
36479result of a list match is failure because a DNS lookup failed.
36480.endlist
36481
36482
36483.section "Message log" "SECID260"
36484.cindex "message" "log file for"
36485.cindex "log" "message log; description of"
36486.cindex "&_msglog_& directory"
36487.oindex "&%preserve_message_logs%&"
36488In addition to the general log files, Exim writes a log file for each message
36489that it handles. The names of these per-message logs are the message ids, and
36490they are kept in the &_msglog_& sub-directory of the spool directory. Each
36491message log contains copies of the log lines that apply to the message. This
36492makes it easier to inspect the status of an individual message without having
36493to search the main log. A message log is deleted when processing of the message
36494is complete, unless &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, but this should be used
36495only with great care because they can fill up your disk very quickly.
36496
36497On a heavily loaded system, it may be desirable to disable the use of
36498per-message logs, in order to reduce disk I/O. This can be done by setting the
36499&%message_logs%& option false.
36500.ecindex IIDloggen
36501
36502
36503
36504
36505. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36506. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36507
36508.chapter "Exim utilities" "CHAPutils"
36509.scindex IIDutils "utilities"
36510A number of utility scripts and programs are supplied with Exim and are
36511described in this chapter. There is also the Exim Monitor, which is covered in
36512the next chapter. The utilities described here are:
36513
36514.itable none 0 0 3 7* left 15* left 40* left
36515.irow &<<SECTfinoutwha>>& &'exiwhat'& &&&
36516 "list what Exim processes are doing"
36517.irow &<<SECTgreptheque>>& &'exiqgrep'& "grep the queue"
36518.irow &<<SECTsumtheque>>& &'exiqsumm'& "summarize the queue"
36519.irow &<<SECTextspeinf>>& &'exigrep'& "search the main log"
36520.irow &<<SECTexipick>>& &'exipick'& "select messages on &&&
36521 various criteria"
36522.irow &<<SECTcyclogfil>>& &'exicyclog'& "cycle (rotate) log files"
36523.irow &<<SECTmailstat>>& &'eximstats'& &&&
36524 "extract statistics from the log"
36525.irow &<<SECTcheckaccess>>& &'exim_checkaccess'& &&&
36526 "check address acceptance from given IP"
36527.irow &<<SECTdbmbuild>>& &'exim_dbmbuild'& "build a DBM file"
36528.irow &<<SECTfinindret>>& &'exinext'& "extract retry information"
36529.irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_dumpdb'& "dump a hints database"
36530.irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_tidydb'& "clean up a hints database"
36531.irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_fixdb'& "patch a hints database"
36532.irow &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>& &'exim_lock'& "lock a mailbox file"
36533.endtable
36534
36535Another utility that might be of use to sites with many MTAs is Tom Kistner's
36536&'exilog'&. It provides log visualizations across multiple Exim servers. See
36537&url(http://duncanthrax.net/exilog/) for details.
36538
36539
36540
36541
36542.section "Finding out what Exim processes are doing (exiwhat)" "SECTfinoutwha"
36543.cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
36544.cindex "process, querying"
36545.cindex "SIGUSR1"
36546On operating systems that can restart a system call after receiving a signal
36547(most modern OS), an Exim process responds to the SIGUSR1 signal by writing
36548a line describing what it is doing to the file &_exim-process.info_& in the
36549Exim spool directory. The &'exiwhat'& script sends the signal to all Exim
36550processes it can find, having first emptied the file. It then waits for one
36551second to allow the Exim processes to react before displaying the results. In
36552order to run &'exiwhat'& successfully you have to have sufficient privilege to
36553send the signal to the Exim processes, so it is normally run as root.
36554
36555&*Warning*&: This is not an efficient process. It is intended for occasional
36556use by system administrators. It is not sensible, for example, to set up a
36557script that sends SIGUSR1 signals to Exim processes at short intervals.
36558
36559
36560Unfortunately, the &'ps'& command that &'exiwhat'& uses to find Exim processes
36561varies in different operating systems. Not only are different options used,
36562but the format of the output is different. For this reason, there are some
36563system configuration options that configure exactly how &'exiwhat'& works. If
36564it doesn't seem to be working for you, check the following compile-time
36565options:
36566.display
36567&`EXIWHAT_PS_CMD `& the command for running &'ps'&
36568&`EXIWHAT_PS_ARG `& the argument for &'ps'&
36569&`EXIWHAT_EGREP_ARG `& the argument for &'egrep'& to select from &'ps'& output
36570&`EXIWHAT_KILL_ARG `& the argument for the &'kill'& command
36571.endd
36572An example of typical output from &'exiwhat'& is
36573.code
36574164 daemon: -q1h, listening on port 25
3657510483 running queue: waiting for 0tAycK-0002ij-00 (10492)
3657610492 delivering 0tAycK-0002ij-00 to mail.ref.example
36577 [10.19.42.42] (editor@ref.example)
3657810592 handling incoming call from [192.168.243.242]
3657910628 accepting a local non-SMTP message
36580.endd
36581The first number in the output line is the process number. The third line has
36582been split here, in order to fit it on the page.
36583
36584
36585
36586.section "Selective queue listing (exiqgrep)" "SECTgreptheque"
36587.cindex "&'exiqgrep'&"
36588.cindex "queue" "grepping"
36589This utility is a Perl script contributed by Matt Hubbard. It runs
36590.code
36591exim -bpu
36592.endd
36593or (in case &*-a*& switch is specified)
36594.code
36595exim -bp
36596.endd
36597The &*-C*& option is used to specify an alternate &_exim.conf_& which might
36598contain alternate exim configuration the queue management might be using.
36599
36600to obtain a queue listing, and then greps the output to select messages
36601that match given criteria. The following selection options are available:
36602
36603.vlist
36604.vitem &*-f*&&~<&'regex'&>
36605Match the sender address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
36606tested is enclosed in angle brackets, so you can test for bounce messages with
36607.code
36608exiqgrep -f '^<>$'
36609.endd
36610.vitem &*-r*&&~<&'regex'&>
36611Match a recipient address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
36612tested is not enclosed in angle brackets.
36613
36614.vitem &*-s*&&~<&'regex'&>
36615Match against the size field.
36616
36617.vitem &*-y*&&~<&'seconds'&>
36618Match messages that are younger than the given time.
36619
36620.vitem &*-o*&&~<&'seconds'&>
36621Match messages that are older than the given time.
36622
36623.vitem &*-z*&
36624Match only frozen messages.
36625
36626.vitem &*-x*&
36627Match only non-frozen messages.
36628.endlist
36629
36630The following options control the format of the output:
36631
36632.vlist
36633.vitem &*-c*&
36634Display only the count of matching messages.
36635
36636.vitem &*-l*&
36637Long format &-- display the full message information as output by Exim. This is
36638the default.
36639
36640.vitem &*-i*&
36641Display message ids only.
36642
36643.vitem &*-b*&
36644Brief format &-- one line per message.
36645
36646.vitem &*-R*&
36647Display messages in reverse order.
36648
36649.vitem &*-a*&
36650Include delivered recipients in queue listing.
36651.endlist
36652
36653There is one more option, &%-h%&, which outputs a list of options.
36654
36655
36656
36657.section "Summarizing the queue (exiqsumm)" "SECTsumtheque"
36658.cindex "&'exiqsumm'&"
36659.cindex "queue" "summary"
36660The &'exiqsumm'& utility is a Perl script which reads the output of &`exim
36661-bp`& and produces a summary of the messages on the queue. Thus, you use it by
36662running a command such as
36663.code
36664exim -bp | exiqsumm
36665.endd
36666The output consists of one line for each domain that has messages waiting for
36667it, as in the following example:
36668.code
366693 2322 74m 66m msn.com.example
36670.endd
36671Each line lists the number of pending deliveries for a domain, their total
36672volume, and the length of time that the oldest and the newest messages have
36673been waiting. Note that the number of pending deliveries is greater than the
36674number of messages when messages have more than one recipient.
36675
36676A summary line is output at the end. By default the output is sorted on the
36677domain name, but &'exiqsumm'& has the options &%-a%& and &%-c%&, which cause
36678the output to be sorted by oldest message and by count of messages,
36679respectively. There are also three options that split the messages for each
36680domain into two or more subcounts: &%-b%& separates bounce messages, &%-f%&
36681separates frozen messages, and &%-s%& separates messages according to their
36682sender.
36683
36684The output of &'exim -bp'& contains the original addresses in the message, so
36685this also applies to the output from &'exiqsumm'&. No domains from addresses
36686generated by aliasing or forwarding are included (unless the &%one_time%&
36687option of the &(redirect)& router has been used to convert them into &"top
36688level"& addresses).
36689
36690
36691
36692
36693.section "Extracting specific information from the log (exigrep)" &&&
36694 "SECTextspeinf"
36695.cindex "&'exigrep'&"
36696.cindex "log" "extracts; grepping for"
36697The &'exigrep'& utility is a Perl script that searches one or more main log
36698files for entries that match a given pattern. When it finds a match, it
36699extracts all the log entries for the relevant message, not just those that
36700match the pattern. Thus, &'exigrep'& can extract complete log entries for a
36701given message, or all mail for a given user, or for a given host, for example.
36702The input files can be in Exim log format or syslog format.
36703If a matching log line is not associated with a specific message, it is
36704included in &'exigrep'&'s output without any additional lines. The usage is:
36705.display
36706&`exigrep [-t<`&&'n'&&`>] [-I] [-l] [-M] [-v] <`&&'pattern'&&`> [<`&&'log file'&&`>] ...`&
36707.endd
36708If no log file names are given on the command line, the standard input is read.
36709
36710The &%-t%& argument specifies a number of seconds. It adds an additional
36711condition for message selection. Messages that are complete are shown only if
36712they spent more than <&'n'&> seconds on the queue.
36713
36714By default, &'exigrep'& does case-insensitive matching. The &%-I%& option
36715makes it case-sensitive. This may give a performance improvement when searching
36716large log files. Without &%-I%&, the Perl pattern matches use Perl's &`/i`&
36717option; with &%-I%& they do not. In both cases it is possible to change the
36718case sensitivity within the pattern by using &`(?i)`& or &`(?-i)`&.
36719
36720The &%-l%& option means &"literal"&, that is, treat all characters in the
36721pattern as standing for themselves. Otherwise the pattern must be a Perl
36722regular expression.
36723
36724The &%-v%& option inverts the matching condition. That is, a line is selected
36725if it does &'not'& match the pattern.
36726
36727The &%-M%& options means &"related messages"&. &'exigrep'& will show messages
36728that are generated as a result/response to a message that &'exigrep'& matched
36729normally.
36730
36731Example of &%-M%&:
36732user_a sends a message to user_b, which generates a bounce back to user_b. If
36733&'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_a"&, only the first message will be
36734displayed. But if &'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_b"&, the first and
36735the second (bounce) message will be displayed. Using &%-M%& with &'exigrep'&
36736when searching for &"user_a"& will show both messages since the bounce is
36737&"related"& to or a &"result"& of the first message that was found by the
36738search term.
36739
36740If the location of a &'zcat'& command is known from the definition of
36741ZCAT_COMMAND in &_Local/Makefile_&, &'exigrep'& automatically passes any file
36742whose name ends in COMPRESS_SUFFIX through &'zcat'& as it searches it.
36743If the ZCAT_COMMAND is not executable, &'exigrep'& tries to use
36744autodetection of some well known compression extensions.
36745
36746
36747.section "Selecting messages by various criteria (exipick)" "SECTexipick"
36748.cindex "&'exipick'&"
36749John Jetmore's &'exipick'& utility is included in the Exim distribution. It
36750lists messages from the queue according to a variety of criteria. For details
36751of &'exipick'&'s facilities, run &'exipick'& with
36752the &%--help%& option.
36753
36754
36755.section "Cycling log files (exicyclog)" "SECTcyclogfil"
36756.cindex "log" "cycling local files"
36757.cindex "cycling logs"
36758.cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
36759The &'exicyclog'& script can be used to cycle (rotate) &'mainlog'& and
36760&'rejectlog'& files. This is not necessary if only syslog is being used, or if
36761you are using log files with datestamps in their names (see section
36762&<<SECTdatlogfil>>&). Some operating systems have their own standard mechanisms
36763for log cycling, and these can be used instead of &'exicyclog'& if preferred.
36764There are two command line options for &'exicyclog'&:
36765.ilist
36766&%-k%& <&'count'&> specifies the number of log files to keep, overriding the
36767default that is set when Exim is built. The default default is 10.
36768.next
36769&%-l%& <&'path'&> specifies the log file path, in the same format as Exim's
36770&%log_file_path%& option (for example, &`/var/log/exim_%slog`&), again
36771overriding the script's default, which is to find the setting from Exim's
36772configuration.
36773.endlist
36774
36775Each time &'exicyclog'& is run the file names get &"shuffled down"& by one. If
36776the main log file name is &_mainlog_& (the default) then when &'exicyclog'& is
36777run &_mainlog_& becomes &_mainlog.01_&, the previous &_mainlog.01_& becomes
36778&_mainlog.02_& and so on, up to the limit that is set in the script or by the
36779&%-k%& option. Log files whose numbers exceed the limit are discarded. Reject
36780logs are handled similarly.
36781
36782If the limit is greater than 99, the script uses 3-digit numbers such as
36783&_mainlog.001_&, &_mainlog.002_&, etc. If you change from a number less than 99
36784to one that is greater, or &'vice versa'&, you will have to fix the names of
36785any existing log files.
36786
36787If no &_mainlog_& file exists, the script does nothing. Files that &"drop off"&
36788the end are deleted. All files with numbers greater than 01 are compressed,
36789using a compression command which is configured by the COMPRESS_COMMAND
36790setting in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is usual to run &'exicyclog'& daily from a
36791root &%crontab%& entry of the form
36792.code
367931 0 * * * su exim -c /usr/exim/bin/exicyclog
36794.endd
36795assuming you have used the name &"exim"& for the Exim user. You can run
36796&'exicyclog'& as root if you wish, but there is no need.
36797
36798
36799
36800.section "Mail statistics (eximstats)" "SECTmailstat"
36801.cindex "statistics"
36802.cindex "&'eximstats'&"
36803A Perl script called &'eximstats'& is provided for extracting statistical
36804information from log files. The output is either plain text, or HTML.
36805Exim log files are also supported by the &'Lire'& system produced by the
36806LogReport Foundation &url(http://www.logreport.org).
36807
36808The &'eximstats'& script has been hacked about quite a bit over time. The
36809latest version is the result of some extensive revision by Steve Campbell. A
36810lot of information is given by default, but there are options for suppressing
36811various parts of it. Following any options, the arguments to the script are a
36812list of files, which should be main log files. For example:
36813.code
36814eximstats -nr /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog.01
36815.endd
36816By default, &'eximstats'& extracts information about the number and volume of
36817messages received from or delivered to various hosts. The information is sorted
36818both by message count and by volume, and the top fifty hosts in each category
36819are listed on the standard output. Similar information, based on email
36820addresses or domains instead of hosts can be requested by means of various
36821options. For messages delivered and received locally, similar statistics are
36822also produced per user.
36823
36824The output also includes total counts and statistics about delivery errors, and
36825histograms showing the number of messages received and deliveries made in each
36826hour of the day. A delivery with more than one address in its envelope (for
36827example, an SMTP transaction with more than one RCPT command) is counted
36828as a single delivery by &'eximstats'&.
36829
36830Though normally more deliveries than receipts are reported (as messages may
36831have multiple recipients), it is possible for &'eximstats'& to report more
36832messages received than delivered, even though the queue is empty at the start
36833and end of the period in question. If an incoming message contains no valid
36834recipients, no deliveries are recorded for it. A bounce message is handled as
36835an entirely separate message.
36836
36837&'eximstats'& always outputs a grand total summary giving the volume and number
36838of messages received and deliveries made, and the number of hosts involved in
36839each case. It also outputs the number of messages that were delayed (that is,
36840not completely delivered at the first attempt), and the number that had at
36841least one address that failed.
36842
36843The remainder of the output is in sections that can be independently disabled
36844or modified by various options. It consists of a summary of deliveries by
36845transport, histograms of messages received and delivered per time interval
36846(default per hour), information about the time messages spent on the queue,
36847a list of relayed messages, lists of the top fifty sending hosts, local
36848senders, destination hosts, and destination local users by count and by volume,
36849and a list of delivery errors that occurred.
36850
36851The relay information lists messages that were actually relayed, that is, they
36852came from a remote host and were directly delivered to some other remote host,
36853without being processed (for example, for aliasing or forwarding) locally.
36854
36855There are quite a few options for &'eximstats'& to control exactly what it
36856outputs. These are documented in the Perl script itself, and can be extracted
36857by running the command &(perldoc)& on the script. For example:
36858.code
36859perldoc /usr/exim/bin/eximstats
36860.endd
36861
36862.section "Checking access policy (exim_checkaccess)" "SECTcheckaccess"
36863.cindex "&'exim_checkaccess'&"
36864.cindex "policy control" "checking access"
36865.cindex "checking access"
36866The &%-bh%& command line argument allows you to run a fake SMTP session with
36867debugging output, in order to check what Exim is doing when it is applying
36868policy controls to incoming SMTP mail. However, not everybody is sufficiently
36869familiar with the SMTP protocol to be able to make full use of &%-bh%&, and
36870sometimes you just want to answer the question &"Does this address have
36871access?"& without bothering with any further details.
36872
36873The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%&. It takes
36874two arguments, an IP address and an email address:
36875.code
36876exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example
36877.endd
36878The utility runs a call to Exim with the &%-bh%& option, to test whether the
36879given email address would be accepted in a RCPT command in a TCP/IP
36880connection from the host with the given IP address. The output of the utility
36881is either the word &"accepted"&, or the SMTP error response, for example:
36882.code
36883Rejected:
36884550 Relay not permitted
36885.endd
36886When running this test, the utility uses &`<>`& as the envelope sender address
36887for the MAIL command, but you can change this by providing additional
36888options. These are passed directly to the Exim command. For example, to specify
36889that the test is to be run with the sender address &'himself@there.example'&
36890you can use:
36891.code
36892exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example \
36893 -f himself@there.example
36894.endd
36895Note that these additional Exim command line items must be given after the two
36896mandatory arguments.
36897
36898Because the &%exim_checkaccess%& uses &%-bh%&, it does not perform callouts
36899while running its checks. You can run checks that include callouts by using
36900&%-bhc%&, but this is not yet available in a &"packaged"& form.
36901
36902
36903
36904.section "Making DBM files (exim_dbmbuild)" "SECTdbmbuild"
36905.cindex "DBM" "building dbm files"
36906.cindex "building DBM files"
36907.cindex "&'exim_dbmbuild'&"
36908.cindex "lower casing"
36909.cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
36910The &'exim_dbmbuild'& program reads an input file containing keys and data in
36911the format used by the &(lsearch)& lookup (see section
36912&<<SECTsinglekeylookups>>&). It writes a DBM file using the lower-cased alias
36913names as keys and the remainder of the information as data. The lower-casing
36914can be prevented by calling the program with the &%-nolc%& option.
36915
36916A terminating zero is included as part of the key string. This is expected by
36917the &(dbm)& lookup type. However, if the option &%-nozero%& is given,
36918&'exim_dbmbuild'& creates files without terminating zeroes in either the key
36919strings or the data strings. The &(dbmnz)& lookup type can be used with such
36920files.
36921
36922The program requires two arguments: the name of the input file (which can be a
36923single hyphen to indicate the standard input), and the name of the output file.
36924It creates the output under a temporary name, and then renames it if all went
36925well.
36926
36927.cindex "USE_DB"
36928If the native DB interface is in use (USE_DB is set in a compile-time
36929configuration file &-- this is common in free versions of Unix) the two file
36930names must be different, because in this mode the Berkeley DB functions create
36931a single output file using exactly the name given. For example,
36932.code
36933exim_dbmbuild /etc/aliases /etc/aliases.db
36934.endd
36935reads the system alias file and creates a DBM version of it in
36936&_/etc/aliases.db_&.
36937
36938In systems that use the &'ndbm'& routines (mostly proprietary versions of
36939Unix), two files are used, with the suffixes &_.dir_& and &_.pag_&. In this
36940environment, the suffixes are added to the second argument of
36941&'exim_dbmbuild'&, so it can be the same as the first. This is also the case
36942when the Berkeley functions are used in compatibility mode (though this is not
36943recommended), because in that case it adds a &_.db_& suffix to the file name.
36944
36945If a duplicate key is encountered, the program outputs a warning, and when it
36946finishes, its return code is 1 rather than zero, unless the &%-noduperr%&
36947option is used. By default, only the first of a set of duplicates is used &--
36948this makes it compatible with &(lsearch)& lookups. There is an option
36949&%-lastdup%& which causes it to use the data for the last duplicate instead.
36950There is also an option &%-nowarn%&, which stops it listing duplicate keys to
36951&%stderr%&. For other errors, where it doesn't actually make a new file, the
36952return code is 2.
36953
36954
36955
36956
36957.section "Finding individual retry times (exinext)" "SECTfinindret"
36958.cindex "retry" "times"
36959.cindex "&'exinext'&"
36960A utility called &'exinext'& (mostly a Perl script) provides the ability to
36961fish specific information out of the retry database. Given a mail domain (or a
36962complete address), it looks up the hosts for that domain, and outputs any retry
36963information for the hosts or for the domain. At present, the retry information
36964is obtained by running &'exim_dumpdb'& (see below) and post-processing the
36965output. For example:
36966.code
36967$ exinext piglet@milne.fict.example
36968kanga.milne.example:192.168.8.1 error 146: Connection refused
36969 first failed: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
36970 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
36971 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 15:02:34
36972roo.milne.example:192.168.8.3 error 146: Connection refused
36973 first failed: 20-Jan-1996 13:12:08
36974 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 11:42:03
36975 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 19:42:03
36976 past final cutoff time
36977.endd
36978You can also give &'exinext'& a local part, without a domain, and it
36979will give any retry information for that local part in your default domain.
36980A message id can be used to obtain retry information pertaining to a specific
36981message. This exists only when an attempt to deliver a message to a remote host
36982suffers a message-specific error (see section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>&).
36983&'exinext'& is not particularly efficient, but then it is not expected to be
36984run very often.
36985
36986The &'exinext'& utility calls Exim to find out information such as the location
36987of the spool directory. The utility has &%-C%& and &%-D%& options, which are
36988passed on to the &'exim'& commands. The first specifies an alternate Exim
36989configuration file, and the second sets macros for use within the configuration
36990file. These features are mainly to help in testing, but might also be useful in
36991environments where more than one configuration file is in use.
36992
36993
36994
36995.section "Hints database maintenance" "SECThindatmai"
36996.cindex "hints database" "maintenance"
36997.cindex "maintaining Exim's hints database"
36998Three utility programs are provided for maintaining the DBM files that Exim
36999uses to contain its delivery hint information. Each program requires two
37000arguments. The first specifies the name of Exim's spool directory, and the
37001second is the name of the database it is to operate on. These are as follows:
37002
37003.ilist
37004&'retry'&: the database of retry information
37005.next
37006&'wait-'&<&'transport name'&>: databases of information about messages waiting
37007for remote hosts
37008.next
37009&'callout'&: the callout cache
37010.next
37011&'ratelimit'&: the data for implementing the ratelimit ACL condition
37012.next
37013&'misc'&: other hints data
37014.endlist
37015
37016The &'misc'& database is used for
37017
37018.ilist
37019Serializing ETRN runs (when &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set)
37020.next
37021Serializing delivery to a specific host (when &%serialize_hosts%& is set in an
37022&(smtp)& transport)
37023.next
37024Limiting the concurrency of specific transports (when &%max_parallel%& is set
37025in a transport)
37026.endlist
37027
37028
37029
37030.section "exim_dumpdb" "SECID261"
37031.cindex "&'exim_dumpdb'&"
37032The entire contents of a database are written to the standard output by the
37033&'exim_dumpdb'& program, which has no options or arguments other than the
37034spool and database names. For example, to dump the retry database:
37035.code
37036exim_dumpdb /var/spool/exim retry
37037.endd
37038Two lines of output are produced for each entry:
37039.code
37040T:mail.ref.example:192.168.242.242 146 77 Connection refused
3704131-Oct-1995 12:00:12 02-Nov-1995 12:21:39 02-Nov-1995 20:21:39 *
37042.endd
37043The first item on the first line is the key of the record. It starts with one
37044of the letters R, or T, depending on whether it refers to a routing or
37045transport retry. For a local delivery, the next part is the local address; for
37046a remote delivery it is the name of the remote host, followed by its failing IP
37047address (unless &%retry_include_ip_address%& is set false on the &(smtp)&
37048transport). If the remote port is not the standard one (port 25), it is added
37049to the IP address. Then there follows an error code, an additional error code,
37050and a textual description of the error.
37051
37052The three times on the second line are the time of first failure, the time of
37053the last delivery attempt, and the computed time for the next attempt. The line
37054ends with an asterisk if the cutoff time for the last retry rule has been
37055exceeded.
37056
37057Each output line from &'exim_dumpdb'& for the &'wait-xxx'& databases
37058consists of a host name followed by a list of ids for messages that are or were
37059waiting to be delivered to that host. If there are a very large number for any
37060one host, continuation records, with a sequence number added to the host name,
37061may be seen. The data in these records is often out of date, because a message
37062may be routed to several alternative hosts, and Exim makes no effort to keep
37063cross-references.
37064
37065
37066
37067.section "exim_tidydb" "SECID262"
37068.cindex "&'exim_tidydb'&"
37069The &'exim_tidydb'& utility program is used to tidy up the contents of a hints
37070database. If run with no options, it removes all records that are more than 30
37071days old. The age is calculated from the date and time that the record was last
37072updated. Note that, in the case of the retry database, it is &'not'& the time
37073since the first delivery failure. Information about a host that has been down
37074for more than 30 days will remain in the database, provided that the record is
37075updated sufficiently often.
37076
37077The cutoff date can be altered by means of the &%-t%& option, which must be
37078followed by a time. For example, to remove all records older than a week from
37079the retry database:
37080.code
37081exim_tidydb -t 7d /var/spool/exim retry
37082.endd
37083Both the &'wait-xxx'& and &'retry'& databases contain items that involve
37084message ids. In the former these appear as data in records keyed by host &--
37085they were messages that were waiting for that host &-- and in the latter they
37086are the keys for retry information for messages that have suffered certain
37087types of error. When &'exim_tidydb'& is run, a check is made to ensure that
37088message ids in database records are those of messages that are still on the
37089queue. Message ids for messages that no longer exist are removed from
37090&'wait-xxx'& records, and if this leaves any records empty, they are deleted.
37091For the &'retry'& database, records whose keys are non-existent message ids are
37092removed. The &'exim_tidydb'& utility outputs comments on the standard output
37093whenever it removes information from the database.
37094
37095Certain records are automatically removed by Exim when they are no longer
37096needed, but others are not. For example, if all the MX hosts for a domain are
37097down, a retry record is created for each one. If the primary MX host comes back
37098first, its record is removed when Exim successfully delivers to it, but the
37099records for the others remain because Exim has not tried to use those hosts.
37100
37101It is important, therefore, to run &'exim_tidydb'& periodically on all the
37102hints databases. You should do this at a quiet time of day, because it requires
37103a database to be locked (and therefore inaccessible to Exim) while it does its
37104work. Removing records from a DBM file does not normally make the file smaller,
37105but all the common DBM libraries are able to re-use the space that is released.
37106After an initial phase of increasing in size, the databases normally reach a
37107point at which they no longer get any bigger, as long as they are regularly
37108tidied.
37109
37110&*Warning*&: If you never run &'exim_tidydb'&, the space used by the hints
37111databases is likely to keep on increasing.
37112
37113
37114
37115
37116.section "exim_fixdb" "SECID263"
37117.cindex "&'exim_fixdb'&"
37118The &'exim_fixdb'& program is a utility for interactively modifying databases.
37119Its main use is for testing Exim, but it might also be occasionally useful for
37120getting round problems in a live system. It has no options, and its interface
37121is somewhat crude. On entry, it prompts for input with a right angle-bracket. A
37122key of a database record can then be entered, and the data for that record is
37123displayed.
37124
37125If &"d"& is typed at the next prompt, the entire record is deleted. For all
37126except the &'retry'& database, that is the only operation that can be carried
37127out. For the &'retry'& database, each field is output preceded by a number, and
37128data for individual fields can be changed by typing the field number followed
37129by new data, for example:
37130.code
37131> 4 951102:1000
37132.endd
37133resets the time of the next delivery attempt. Time values are given as a
37134sequence of digit pairs for year, month, day, hour, and minute. Colons can be
37135used as optional separators.
37136
37137
37138
37139
37140.section "Mailbox maintenance (exim_lock)" "SECTmailboxmaint"
37141.cindex "mailbox" "maintenance"
37142.cindex "&'exim_lock'&"
37143.cindex "locking mailboxes"
37144The &'exim_lock'& utility locks a mailbox file using the same algorithm as
37145Exim. For a discussion of locking issues, see section &<<SECTopappend>>&.
37146&'Exim_lock'& can be used to prevent any modification of a mailbox by Exim or
37147a user agent while investigating a problem. The utility requires the name of
37148the file as its first argument. If the locking is successful, the second
37149argument is run as a command (using C's &[system()]& function); if there is no
37150second argument, the value of the SHELL environment variable is used; if this
37151is unset or empty, &_/bin/sh_& is run. When the command finishes, the mailbox
37152is unlocked and the utility ends. The following options are available:
37153
37154.vlist
37155.vitem &%-fcntl%&
37156Use &[fcntl()]& locking on the open mailbox.
37157
37158.vitem &%-flock%&
37159Use &[flock()]& locking on the open mailbox, provided the operating system
37160supports it.
37161
37162.vitem &%-interval%&
37163This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets the
37164interval to sleep between retries (default 3).
37165
37166.vitem &%-lockfile%&
37167Create a lock file before opening the mailbox.
37168
37169.vitem &%-mbx%&
37170Lock the mailbox using MBX rules.
37171
37172.vitem &%-q%&
37173Suppress verification output.
37174
37175.vitem &%-retries%&
37176This must be followed by a number; it sets the number of times to try to get
37177the lock (default 10).
37178
37179.vitem &%-restore_time%&
37180This option causes &%exim_lock%& to restore the modified and read times to the
37181locked file before exiting. This allows you to access a locked mailbox (for
37182example, to take a backup copy) without disturbing the times that the user
37183subsequently sees.
37184
37185.vitem &%-timeout%&
37186This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets a
37187timeout to be used with a blocking &[fcntl()]& lock. If it is not set (the
37188default), a non-blocking call is used.
37189
37190.vitem &%-v%&
37191Generate verbose output.
37192.endlist
37193
37194If none of &%-fcntl%&, &%-flock%&, &%-lockfile%& or &%-mbx%& are given, the
37195default is to create a lock file and also to use &[fcntl()]& locking on the
37196mailbox, which is the same as Exim's default. The use of &%-flock%& or
37197&%-fcntl%& requires that the file be writeable; the use of &%-lockfile%&
37198requires that the directory containing the file be writeable. Locking by lock
37199file does not last for ever; Exim assumes that a lock file is expired if it is
37200more than 30 minutes old.
37201
37202The &%-mbx%& option can be used with either or both of &%-fcntl%& or
37203&%-flock%&. It assumes &%-fcntl%& by default. MBX locking causes a shared lock
37204to be taken out on the open mailbox, and an exclusive lock on the file
37205&_/tmp/.n.m_& where &'n'& and &'m'& are the device number and inode
37206number of the mailbox file. When the locking is released, if an exclusive lock
37207can be obtained for the mailbox, the file in &_/tmp_& is deleted.
37208
37209The default output contains verification of the locking that takes place. The
37210&%-v%& option causes some additional information to be given. The &%-q%& option
37211suppresses all output except error messages.
37212
37213A command such as
37214.code
37215exim_lock /var/spool/mail/spqr
37216.endd
37217runs an interactive shell while the file is locked, whereas
37218.display
37219&`exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr <<End`&
37220<&'some commands'&>
37221&`End`&
37222.endd
37223runs a specific non-interactive sequence of commands while the file is locked,
37224suppressing all verification output. A single command can be run by a command
37225such as
37226.code
37227exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr \
37228 "cp /var/spool/mail/spqr /some/where"
37229.endd
37230Note that if a command is supplied, it must be entirely contained within the
37231second argument &-- hence the quotes.
37232.ecindex IIDutils
37233
37234
37235. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37236. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37237
37238.chapter "The Exim monitor" "CHAPeximon"
37239.scindex IIDeximon "Exim monitor" "description"
37240.cindex "X-windows"
37241.cindex "&'eximon'&"
37242.cindex "Local/eximon.conf"
37243.cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
37244The Exim monitor is an application which displays in an X window information
37245about the state of Exim's queue and what Exim is doing. An admin user can
37246perform certain operations on messages from this GUI interface; however all
37247such facilities are also available from the command line, and indeed, the
37248monitor itself makes use of the command line to perform any actions requested.
37249
37250
37251
37252.section "Running the monitor" "SECID264"
37253The monitor is started by running the script called &'eximon'&. This is a shell
37254script that sets up a number of environment variables, and then runs the
37255binary called &_eximon.bin_&. The default appearance of the monitor window can
37256be changed by editing the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file created by editing
37257&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&. Comments in that file describe what the various
37258parameters are for.
37259
37260The parameters that get built into the &'eximon'& script can be overridden for
37261a particular invocation by setting up environment variables of the same names,
37262preceded by &`EXIMON_`&. For example, a shell command such as
37263.code
37264EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH=400 eximon
37265.endd
37266(in a Bourne-compatible shell) runs &'eximon'& with an overriding setting of
37267the LOG_DEPTH parameter. If EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set in the environment, it
37268overrides the Exim log file configuration. This makes it possible to have
37269&'eximon'& tailing log data that is written to syslog, provided that MAIL.INFO
37270syslog messages are routed to a file on the local host.
37271
37272X resources can be used to change the appearance of the window in the normal
37273way. For example, a resource setting of the form
37274.code
37275Eximon*background: gray94
37276.endd
37277changes the colour of the background to light grey rather than white. The
37278stripcharts are drawn with both the data lines and the reference lines in
37279black. This means that the reference lines are not visible when on top of the
37280data. However, their colour can be changed by setting a resource called
37281&"highlight"& (an odd name, but that's what the Athena stripchart widget uses).
37282For example, if your X server is running Unix, you could set up lighter
37283reference lines in the stripcharts by obeying
37284.code
37285xrdb -merge <<End
37286Eximon*highlight: gray
37287End
37288.endd
37289.cindex "admin user"
37290In order to see the contents of messages on the queue, and to operate on them,
37291&'eximon'& must either be run as root or by an admin user.
37292
37293The command-line parameters of &'eximon'& are passed to &_eximon.bin_& and may
37294contain X11 resource parameters interpreted by the X11 library. In addition,
37295if the first parameter starts with the string "gdb" then it is removed and the
37296binary is invoked under gdb (the parameter is used as the gdb command-name, so
37297versioned variants of gdb can be invoked).
37298
37299The monitor's window is divided into three parts. The first contains one or
37300more stripcharts and two action buttons, the second contains a &"tail"& of the
37301main log file, and the third is a display of the queue of messages awaiting
37302delivery, with two more action buttons. The following sections describe these
37303different parts of the display.
37304
37305
37306
37307
37308.section "The stripcharts" "SECID265"
37309.cindex "stripchart"
37310The first stripchart is always a count of messages on the queue. Its name can
37311be configured by setting QUEUE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
37312&_Local/eximon.conf_& file. The remaining stripcharts are defined in the
37313configuration script by regular expression matches on log file entries, making
37314it possible to display, for example, counts of messages delivered to certain
37315hosts or using certain transports. The supplied defaults display counts of
37316received and delivered messages, and of local and SMTP deliveries. The default
37317period between stripchart updates is one minute; this can be adjusted by a
37318parameter in the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
37319
37320The stripchart displays rescale themselves automatically as the value they are
37321displaying changes. There are always 10 horizontal lines in each chart; the
37322title string indicates the value of each division when it is greater than one.
37323For example, &"x2"& means that each division represents a value of 2.
37324
37325It is also possible to have a stripchart which shows the percentage fullness of
37326a particular disk partition, which is useful when local deliveries are confined
37327to a single partition.
37328
37329.cindex "&%statvfs%& function"
37330This relies on the availability of the &[statvfs()]& function or equivalent in
37331the operating system. Most, but not all versions of Unix that support Exim have
37332this. For this particular stripchart, the top of the chart always represents
37333100%, and the scale is given as &"x10%"&. This chart is configured by setting
37334SIZE_STRIPCHART and (optionally) SIZE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
37335&_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
37336
37337
37338
37339
37340.section "Main action buttons" "SECID266"
37341.cindex "size" "of monitor window"
37342.cindex "Exim monitor" "window size"
37343.cindex "window size"
37344Below the stripcharts there is an action button for quitting the monitor. Next
37345to this is another button marked &"Size"&. They are placed here so that
37346shrinking the window to its default minimum size leaves just the queue count
37347stripchart and these two buttons visible. Pressing the &"Size"& button causes
37348the window to expand to its maximum size, unless it is already at the maximum,
37349in which case it is reduced to its minimum.
37350
37351When expanding to the maximum, if the window cannot be fully seen where it
37352currently is, it is moved back to where it was the last time it was at full
37353size. When it is expanding from its minimum size, the old position is
37354remembered, and next time it is reduced to the minimum it is moved back there.
37355
37356The idea is that you can keep a reduced window just showing one or two
37357stripcharts at a convenient place on your screen, easily expand it to show
37358the full window when required, and just as easily put it back to what it was.
37359The idea is copied from what the &'twm'& window manager does for its
37360&'f.fullzoom'& action. The minimum size of the window can be changed by setting
37361the MIN_HEIGHT and MIN_WIDTH values in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
37362
37363Normally, the monitor starts up with the window at its full size, but it can be
37364built so that it starts up with the window at its smallest size, by setting
37365START_SMALL=yes in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
37366
37367
37368
37369.section "The log display" "SECID267"
37370.cindex "log" "tail of; in monitor"
37371The second section of the window is an area in which a display of the tail of
37372the main log is maintained.
37373To save space on the screen, the timestamp on each log line is shortened by
37374removing the date and, if &%log_timezone%& is set, the timezone.
37375The log tail is not available when the only destination for logging data is
37376syslog, unless the syslog lines are routed to a local file whose name is passed
37377to &'eximon'& via the EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH environment variable.
37378
37379The log sub-window has a scroll bar at its lefthand side which can be used to
37380move back to look at earlier text, and the up and down arrow keys also have a
37381scrolling effect. The amount of log that is kept depends on the setting of
37382LOG_BUFFER in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, which specifies the amount of memory
37383to use. When this is full, the earlier 50% of data is discarded &-- this is
37384much more efficient than throwing it away line by line. The sub-window also has
37385a horizontal scroll bar for accessing the ends of long log lines. This is the
37386only means of horizontal scrolling; the right and left arrow keys are not
37387available. Text can be cut from this part of the window using the mouse in the
37388normal way. The size of this subwindow is controlled by parameters in the
37389configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
37390
37391Searches of the text in the log window can be carried out by means of the ^R
37392and ^S keystrokes, which default to a reverse and a forward search,
37393respectively. The search covers only the text that is displayed in the window.
37394It cannot go further back up the log.
37395
37396The point from which the search starts is indicated by a caret marker. This is
37397normally at the end of the text in the window, but can be positioned explicitly
37398by pointing and clicking with the left mouse button, and is moved automatically
37399by a successful search. If new text arrives in the window when it is scrolled
37400back, the caret remains where it is, but if the window is not scrolled back,
37401the caret is moved to the end of the new text.
37402
37403Pressing ^R or ^S pops up a window into which the search text can be typed.
37404There are buttons for selecting forward or reverse searching, for carrying out
37405the search, and for cancelling. If the &"Search"& button is pressed, the search
37406happens and the window remains so that further searches can be done. If the
37407&"Return"& key is pressed, a single search is done and the window is closed. If
37408^C is typed the search is cancelled.
37409
37410The searching facility is implemented using the facilities of the Athena text
37411widget. By default this pops up a window containing both &"search"& and
37412&"replace"& options. In order to suppress the unwanted &"replace"& portion for
37413eximon, a modified version of the &%TextPop%& widget is distributed with Exim.
37414However, the linkers in BSDI and HP-UX seem unable to handle an externally
37415provided version of &%TextPop%& when the remaining parts of the text widget
37416come from the standard libraries. The compile-time option EXIMON_TEXTPOP can be
37417unset to cut out the modified &%TextPop%&, making it possible to build Eximon
37418on these systems, at the expense of having unwanted items in the search popup
37419window.
37420
37421
37422
37423.section "The queue display" "SECID268"
37424.cindex "queue" "display in monitor"
37425The bottom section of the monitor window contains a list of all messages that
37426are on the queue, which includes those currently being received or delivered,
37427as well as those awaiting delivery. The size of this subwindow is controlled by
37428parameters in the configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&, and the frequency
37429at which it is updated is controlled by another parameter in the same file &--
37430the default is 5 minutes, since queue scans can be quite expensive. However,
37431there is an &"Update"& action button just above the display which can be used
37432to force an update of the queue display at any time.
37433
37434When a host is down for some time, a lot of pending mail can build up for it,
37435and this can make it hard to deal with other messages on the queue. To help
37436with this situation there is a button next to &"Update"& called &"Hide"&. If
37437pressed, a dialogue box called &"Hide addresses ending with"& is put up. If you
37438type anything in here and press &"Return"&, the text is added to a chain of
37439such texts, and if every undelivered address in a message matches at least one
37440of the texts, the message is not displayed.
37441
37442If there is an address that does not match any of the texts, all the addresses
37443are displayed as normal. The matching happens on the ends of addresses so, for
37444example, &'cam.ac.uk'& specifies all addresses in Cambridge, while
37445&'xxx@foo.com.example'& specifies just one specific address. When any hiding
37446has been set up, a button called &"Unhide"& is displayed. If pressed, it
37447cancels all hiding. Also, to ensure that hidden messages do not get forgotten,
37448a hide request is automatically cancelled after one hour.
37449
37450While the dialogue box is displayed, you can't press any buttons or do anything
37451else to the monitor window. For this reason, if you want to cut text from the
37452queue display to use in the dialogue box, you have to do the cutting before
37453pressing the &"Hide"& button.
37454
37455The queue display contains, for each unhidden queued message, the length of
37456time it has been on the queue, the size of the message, the message id, the
37457message sender, and the first undelivered recipient, all on one line. If it is
37458a bounce message, the sender is shown as &"<>"&. If there is more than one
37459recipient to which the message has not yet been delivered, subsequent ones are
37460listed on additional lines, up to a maximum configured number, following which
37461an ellipsis is displayed. Recipients that have already received the message are
37462not shown.
37463
37464.cindex "frozen messages" "display"
37465If a message is frozen, an asterisk is displayed at the left-hand side.
37466
37467The queue display has a vertical scroll bar, and can also be scrolled by means
37468of the arrow keys. Text can be cut from it using the mouse in the normal way.
37469The text searching facilities, as described above for the log window, are also
37470available, but the caret is always moved to the end of the text when the queue
37471display is updated.
37472
37473
37474
37475.section "The queue menu" "SECID269"
37476.cindex "queue" "menu in monitor"
37477If the &%shift%& key is held down and the left button is clicked when the mouse
37478pointer is over the text for any message, an action menu pops up, and the first
37479line of the queue display for the message is highlighted. This does not affect
37480any selected text.
37481
37482If you want to use some other event for popping up the menu, you can set the
37483MENU_EVENT parameter in &_Local/eximon.conf_& to change the default, or
37484set EXIMON_MENU_EVENT in the environment before starting the monitor. The
37485value set in this parameter is a standard X event description. For example, to
37486run eximon using &%ctrl%& rather than &%shift%& you could use
37487.code
37488EXIMON_MENU_EVENT='Ctrl<Btn1Down>' eximon
37489.endd
37490The title of the menu is the message id, and it contains entries which act as
37491follows:
37492
37493.ilist
37494&'message log'&: The contents of the message log for the message are displayed
37495in a new text window.
37496.next
37497&'headers'&: Information from the spool file that contains the envelope
37498information and headers is displayed in a new text window. See chapter
37499&<<CHAPspool>>& for a description of the format of spool files.
37500.next
37501&'body'&: The contents of the spool file containing the body of the message are
37502displayed in a new text window. There is a default limit of 20,000 bytes to the
37503amount of data displayed. This can be changed by setting the BODY_MAX
37504option at compile time, or the EXIMON_BODY_MAX option at run time.
37505.next
37506&'deliver message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-M%& option to request
37507delivery of the message. This causes an automatic thaw if the message is
37508frozen. The &%-v%& option is also set, and the output from Exim is displayed in
37509a new text window. The delivery is run in a separate process, to avoid holding
37510up the monitor while the delivery proceeds.
37511.next
37512&'freeze message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mf%& option to request
37513that the message be frozen.
37514.next
37515.cindex "thawing messages"
37516.cindex "unfreezing messages"
37517.cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
37518&'thaw message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mt%& option to request
37519that the message be thawed.
37520.next
37521.cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
37522&'give up on msg'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mg%& option to request
37523that Exim gives up trying to deliver the message. A bounce message is generated
37524for any remaining undelivered addresses.
37525.next
37526&'remove message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mrm%& option to request
37527that the message be deleted from the system without generating a bounce
37528message.
37529.next
37530&'add recipient'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address can
37531be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
37532is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
37533Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
37534causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mar%& option to request that an
37535additional recipient be added to the message, unless the entry box is empty, in
37536which case no action is taken.
37537.next
37538&'mark delivered'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address
37539can be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
37540is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
37541Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
37542causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mmd%& option to mark the given
37543recipient address as already delivered, unless the entry box is empty, in which
37544case no action is taken.
37545.next
37546&'mark all delivered'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mmad%& option to
37547mark all recipient addresses as already delivered.
37548.next
37549&'edit sender'&: A dialog box is displayed initialized with the current
37550sender's address. Pressing RETURN causes a call to Exim to be made using the
37551&%-Mes%& option to replace the sender address, unless the entry box is empty,
37552in which case no action is taken. If you want to set an empty sender (as in
37553bounce messages), you must specify it as &"<>"&. Otherwise, if the address is
37554not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&,
37555the address is qualified with that domain.
37556.endlist
37557
37558When a delivery is forced, a window showing the &%-v%& output is displayed. In
37559other cases when a call to Exim is made, if there is any output from Exim (in
37560particular, if the command fails) a window containing the command and the
37561output is displayed. Otherwise, the results of the action are normally apparent
37562from the log and queue displays. However, if you set ACTION_OUTPUT=yes in
37563&_Local/eximon.conf_&, a window showing the Exim command is always opened, even
37564if no output is generated.
37565
37566The queue display is automatically updated for actions such as freezing and
37567thawing, unless ACTION_QUEUE_UPDATE=no has been set in
37568&_Local/eximon.conf_&. In this case the &"Update"& button has to be used to
37569force an update of the display after one of these actions.
37570
37571In any text window that is displayed as result of a menu action, the normal
37572cut-and-paste facility is available, and searching can be carried out using ^R
37573and ^S, as described above for the log tail window.
37574.ecindex IIDeximon
37575
37576
37577
37578
37579
37580. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37581. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37582
37583.chapter "Security considerations" "CHAPsecurity"
37584.scindex IIDsecurcon "security" "discussion of"
37585This chapter discusses a number of issues concerned with security, some of
37586which are also covered in other parts of this manual.
37587
37588For reasons that this author does not understand, some people have promoted
37589Exim as a &"particularly secure"& mailer. Perhaps it is because of the
37590existence of this chapter in the documentation. However, the intent of the
37591chapter is simply to describe the way Exim works in relation to certain
37592security concerns, not to make any specific claims about the effectiveness of
37593its security as compared with other MTAs.
37594
37595What follows is a description of the way Exim is supposed to be. Best efforts
37596have been made to try to ensure that the code agrees with the theory, but an
37597absence of bugs can never be guaranteed. Any that are reported will get fixed
37598as soon as possible.
37599
37600
37601.section "Building a more &""hardened""& Exim" "SECID286"
37602.cindex "security" "build-time features"
37603There are a number of build-time options that can be set in &_Local/Makefile_&
37604to create Exim binaries that are &"harder"& to attack, in particular by a rogue
37605Exim administrator who does not have the root password, or by someone who has
37606penetrated the Exim (but not the root) account. These options are as follows:
37607
37608.ilist
37609ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be set to a string that is required to match the
37610start of any file names used with the &%-C%& option. When it is set, these file
37611names are also not allowed to contain the sequence &"/../"&. (However, if the
37612value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of CONFIGURE_FILE in
37613&_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as usual.) There is no
37614default setting for &%ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX%&.
37615
37616If the permitted configuration files are confined to a directory to
37617which only root has access, this guards against someone who has broken
37618into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
37619configuration file, and using it to break into other accounts.
37620.next
37621
37622If a non-trusted configuration file (i.e. not the default configuration file
37623or one which is trusted by virtue of being listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST
37624file) is specified with &%-C%&, or if macros are given with &%-D%& (but see
37625the next item), then root privilege is retained only if the caller of Exim is
37626root. This locks out the possibility of testing a configuration using &%-C%&
37627right through message reception and delivery, even if the caller is root. The
37628reception works, but by that time, Exim is running as the Exim user, so when
37629it re-execs to regain privilege for the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes
37630privilege to be lost. However, root can test reception and delivery using two
37631separate commands.
37632
37633.next
37634The WHITELIST_D_MACROS build option declares some macros to be safe to override
37635with &%-D%& if the real uid is one of root, the Exim run-time user or the
37636CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined. The potential impact of this option is limited by
37637requiring the run-time value supplied to &%-D%& to match a regex that errs on
37638the restrictive side. Requiring build-time selection of safe macros is onerous
37639but this option is intended solely as a transition mechanism to permit
37640previously-working configurations to continue to work after release 4.73.
37641.next
37642If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined, the use of the &%-D%& command line option
37643is disabled.
37644.next
37645FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a colon-separated list of users that are
37646never to be used for any deliveries. This is like the &%never_users%& runtime
37647option, but it cannot be overridden; the runtime option adds additional users
37648to the list. The default setting is &"root"&; this prevents a non-root user who
37649is permitted to modify the runtime file from using Exim as a way to get root.
37650.endlist
37651
37652
37653
37654.section "Root privilege" "SECID270"
37655.cindex "setuid"
37656.cindex "root privilege"
37657The Exim binary is normally setuid to root, which means that it gains root
37658privilege (runs as root) when it starts execution. In some special cases (for
37659example, when the daemon is not in use and there are no local deliveries), it
37660may be possible to run Exim setuid to some user other than root. This is
37661discussed in the next section. However, in most installations, root privilege
37662is required for two things:
37663
37664.ilist
37665To set up a socket connected to the standard SMTP port (25) when initialising
37666the listening daemon. If Exim is run from &'inetd'&, this privileged action is
37667not required.
37668.next
37669To be able to change uid and gid in order to read users' &_.forward_& files and
37670perform local deliveries as the receiving user or as specified in the
37671configuration.
37672.endlist
37673
37674It is not necessary to be root to do any of the other things Exim does, such as
37675receiving messages and delivering them externally over SMTP, and it is
37676obviously more secure if Exim does not run as root except when necessary.
37677For this reason, a user and group for Exim to use must be defined in
37678&_Local/Makefile_&. These are known as &"the Exim user"& and &"the Exim
37679group"&. Their values can be changed by the run time configuration, though this
37680is not recommended. Often a user called &'exim'& is used, but some sites use
37681&'mail'& or another user name altogether.
37682
37683Exim uses &[setuid()]& whenever it gives up root privilege. This is a permanent
37684abdication; the process cannot regain root afterwards. Prior to release 4.00,
37685&[seteuid()]& was used in some circumstances, but this is no longer the case.
37686
37687After a new Exim process has interpreted its command line options, it changes
37688uid and gid in the following cases:
37689
37690.ilist
37691.oindex "&%-C%&"
37692.oindex "&%-D%&"
37693If the &%-C%& option is used to specify an alternate configuration file, or if
37694the &%-D%& option is used to define macro values for the configuration, and the
37695calling process is not running as root, the uid and gid are changed to those of
37696the calling process.
37697However, if DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the &%-D%&
37698option may not be used at all.
37699If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, then some macro values
37700can be supplied if the calling process is running as root, the Exim run-time
37701user or CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined.
37702.next
37703.oindex "&%-be%&"
37704.oindex "&%-bf%&"
37705.oindex "&%-bF%&"
37706If the expansion test option (&%-be%&) or one of the filter testing options
37707(&%-bf%& or &%-bF%&) are used, the uid and gid are changed to those of the
37708calling process.
37709.next
37710If the process is not a daemon process or a queue runner process or a delivery
37711process or a process for testing address routing (started with &%-bt%&), the
37712uid and gid are changed to the Exim user and group. This means that Exim always
37713runs under its own uid and gid when receiving messages. This also applies when
37714testing address verification
37715.oindex "&%-bv%&"
37716.oindex "&%-bh%&"
37717(the &%-bv%& option) and testing incoming message policy controls (the &%-bh%&
37718option).
37719.next
37720For a daemon, queue runner, delivery, or address testing process, the uid
37721remains as root at this stage, but the gid is changed to the Exim group.
37722.endlist
37723
37724The processes that initially retain root privilege behave as follows:
37725
37726.ilist
37727A daemon process changes the gid to the Exim group and the uid to the Exim
37728user after setting up one or more listening sockets. The &[initgroups()]&
37729function is called, so that if the Exim user is in any additional groups, they
37730will be used during message reception.
37731.next
37732A queue runner process retains root privilege throughout its execution. Its
37733job is to fork a controlled sequence of delivery processes.
37734.next
37735A delivery process retains root privilege throughout most of its execution,
37736but any actual deliveries (that is, the transports themselves) are run in
37737subprocesses which always change to a non-root uid and gid. For local
37738deliveries this is typically the uid and gid of the owner of the mailbox; for
37739remote deliveries, the Exim uid and gid are used. Once all the delivery
37740subprocesses have been run, a delivery process changes to the Exim uid and gid
37741while doing post-delivery tidying up such as updating the retry database and
37742generating bounce and warning messages.
37743
37744While the recipient addresses in a message are being routed, the delivery
37745process runs as root. However, if a user's filter file has to be processed,
37746this is done in a subprocess that runs under the individual user's uid and
37747gid. A system filter is run as root unless &%system_filter_user%& is set.
37748.next
37749A process that is testing addresses (the &%-bt%& option) runs as root so that
37750the routing is done in the same environment as a message delivery.
37751.endlist
37752
37753
37754
37755
37756.section "Running Exim without privilege" "SECTrunexiwitpri"
37757.cindex "privilege, running without"
37758.cindex "unprivileged running"
37759.cindex "root privilege" "running without"
37760Some installations like to run Exim in an unprivileged state for more of its
37761operation, for added security. Support for this mode of operation is provided
37762by the global option &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. When this is set, the uid and
37763gid are changed to the Exim user and group at the start of a delivery process
37764(and also queue runner and address testing processes). This means that address
37765routing is no longer run as root, and the deliveries themselves cannot change
37766to any other uid.
37767
37768.cindex SIGHUP
37769.cindex "daemon" "restarting"
37770Leaving the binary setuid to root, but setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%& means
37771that the daemon can still be started in the usual way, and it can respond
37772correctly to SIGHUP because the re-invocation regains root privilege.
37773
37774An alternative approach is to make Exim setuid to the Exim user and also setgid
37775to the Exim group. If you do this, the daemon must be started from a root
37776process. (Calling Exim from a root process makes it behave in the way it does
37777when it is setuid root.) However, the daemon cannot restart itself after a
37778SIGHUP signal because it cannot regain privilege.
37779
37780It is still useful to set &%deliver_drop_privilege%& in this case, because it
37781stops Exim from trying to re-invoke itself to do a delivery after a message has
37782been received. Such a re-invocation is a waste of resources because it has no
37783effect.
37784
37785If restarting the daemon is not an issue (for example, if &%mua_wrapper%& is
37786set, or &'inetd'& is being used instead of a daemon), having the binary setuid
37787to the Exim user seems a clean approach, but there is one complication:
37788
37789In this style of operation, Exim is running with the real uid and gid set to
37790those of the calling process, and the effective uid/gid set to Exim's values.
37791Ideally, any association with the calling process' uid/gid should be dropped,
37792that is, the real uid/gid should be reset to the effective values so as to
37793discard any privileges that the caller may have. While some operating systems
37794have a function that permits this action for a non-root effective uid, quite a
37795number of them do not. Because of this lack of standardization, Exim does not
37796address this problem at this time.
37797
37798For this reason, the recommended approach for &"mostly unprivileged"& running
37799is to keep the Exim binary setuid to root, and to set
37800&%deliver_drop_privilege%&. This also has the advantage of allowing a daemon to
37801be used in the most straightforward way.
37802
37803If you configure Exim not to run delivery processes as root, there are a
37804number of restrictions on what you can do:
37805
37806.ilist
37807You can deliver only as the Exim user/group. You should explicitly use the
37808&%user%& and &%group%& options to override routers or local transports that
37809normally deliver as the recipient. This makes sure that configurations that
37810work in this mode function the same way in normal mode. Any implicit or
37811explicit specification of another user causes an error.
37812.next
37813Use of &_.forward_& files is severely restricted, such that it is usually
37814not worthwhile to include them in the configuration.
37815.next
37816Users who wish to use &_.forward_& would have to make their home directory and
37817the file itself accessible to the Exim user. Pipe and append-to-file entries,
37818and their equivalents in Exim filters, cannot be used. While they could be
37819enabled in the Exim user's name, that would be insecure and not very useful.
37820.next
37821Unless the local user mailboxes are all owned by the Exim user (possible in
37822some POP3 or IMAP-only environments):
37823
37824.olist
37825They must be owned by the Exim group and be writeable by that group. This
37826implies you must set &%mode%& in the appendfile configuration, as well as the
37827mode of the mailbox files themselves.
37828.next
37829You must set &%no_check_owner%&, since most or all of the files will not be
37830owned by the Exim user.
37831.next
37832You must set &%file_must_exist%&, because Exim cannot set the owner correctly
37833on a newly created mailbox when unprivileged. This also implies that new
37834mailboxes need to be created manually.
37835.endlist olist
37836.endlist ilist
37837
37838
37839These restrictions severely restrict what can be done in local deliveries.
37840However, there are no restrictions on remote deliveries. If you are running a
37841gateway host that does no local deliveries, setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%&
37842gives more security at essentially no cost.
37843
37844If you are using the &%mua_wrapper%& facility (see chapter
37845&<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&), &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced to be true.
37846
37847
37848
37849
37850.section "Delivering to local files" "SECID271"
37851Full details of the checks applied by &(appendfile)& before it writes to a file
37852are given in chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
37853
37854
37855
37856.section "Running local commands" "SECTsecconslocalcmds"
37857.cindex "security" "local commands"
37858.cindex "security" "command injection attacks"
37859There are a number of ways in which an administrator can configure Exim to run
37860commands based upon received, untrustworthy, data. Further, in some
37861configurations a user who can control a &_.forward_& file can also arrange to
37862run commands. Configuration to check includes, but is not limited to:
37863
37864.ilist
37865Use of &%use_shell%& in the pipe transport: various forms of shell command
37866injection may be possible with this option present. It is dangerous and should
37867be used only with considerable caution. Consider constraints which whitelist
37868allowed characters in a variable which is to be used in a pipe transport that
37869has &%use_shell%& enabled.
37870.next
37871A number of options such as &%forbid_filter_run%&, &%forbid_filter_perl%&,
37872&%forbid_filter_dlfunc%& and so forth which restrict facilities available to
37873&_.forward_& files in a redirect router. If Exim is running on a central mail
37874hub to which ordinary users do not have shell access, but home directories are
37875NFS mounted (for instance) then administrators should review the list of these
37876forbid options available, and should bear in mind that the options that may
37877need forbidding can change as new features are added between releases.
37878.next
37879The &%${run...}%& expansion item does not use a shell by default, but
37880administrators can configure use of &_/bin/sh_& as part of the command.
37881Such invocations should be viewed with prejudicial suspicion.
37882.next
37883Administrators who use embedded Perl are advised to explore how Perl's
37884taint checking might apply to their usage.
37885.next
37886Use of &%${expand...}%& is somewhat analogous to shell's eval builtin and
37887administrators are well advised to view its use with suspicion, in case (for
37888instance) it allows a local-part to contain embedded Exim directives.
37889.next
37890Use of &%${match_local_part...}%& and friends becomes more dangerous if
37891Exim was built with EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS defined: the second string in
37892each can reference arbitrary lists and files, rather than just being a list
37893of opaque strings.
37894The EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option was added and set false by default because of
37895real-world security vulnerabilities caused by its use with untrustworthy data
37896injected in, for SQL injection attacks.
37897Consider the use of the &%inlisti%& expansion condition instead.
37898.endlist
37899
37900
37901
37902
37903.section "Trust in configuration data" "SECTsecconfdata"
37904.cindex "security" "data sources"
37905.cindex "security" "regular expressions"
37906.cindex "regular expressions" "security"
37907.cindex "PCRE" "security"
37908If configuration data for Exim can come from untrustworthy sources, there
37909are some issues to be aware of:
37910
37911.ilist
37912Use of &%${expand...}%& may provide a path for shell injection attacks.
37913.next
37914Letting untrusted data provide a regular expression is unwise.
37915.next
37916Using &%${match...}%& to apply a fixed regular expression against untrusted
37917data may result in pathological behaviour within PCRE. Be aware of what
37918"backtracking" means and consider options for being more strict with a regular
37919expression. Avenues to explore include limiting what can match (avoiding &`.`&
37920when &`[a-z0-9]`& or other character class will do), use of atomic grouping and
37921possessive quantifiers or just not using regular expressions against untrusted
37922data.
37923.next
37924It can be important to correctly use &%${quote:...}%&,
37925&%${quote_local_part:...}%& and &%${quote_%&<&'lookup-type'&>&%:...}%& expansion
37926items to ensure that data is correctly constructed.
37927.next
37928Some lookups might return multiple results, even though normal usage is only
37929expected to yield one result.
37930.endlist
37931
37932
37933
37934
37935.section "IPv4 source routing" "SECID272"
37936.cindex "source routing" "in IP packets"
37937.cindex "IP source routing"
37938Many operating systems suppress IP source-routed packets in the kernel, but
37939some cannot be made to do this, so Exim does its own check. It logs incoming
37940IPv4 source-routed TCP calls, and then drops them. Things are all different in
37941IPv6. No special checking is currently done.
37942
37943
37944
37945.section "The VRFY, EXPN, and ETRN commands in SMTP" "SECID273"
37946Support for these SMTP commands is disabled by default. If required, they can
37947be enabled by defining suitable ACLs.
37948
37949
37950
37951
37952.section "Privileged users" "SECID274"
37953.cindex "trusted users"
37954.cindex "admin user"
37955.cindex "privileged user"
37956.cindex "user" "trusted"
37957.cindex "user" "admin"
37958Exim recognizes two sets of users with special privileges. Trusted users are
37959able to submit new messages to Exim locally, but supply their own sender
37960addresses and information about a sending host. For other users submitting
37961local messages, Exim sets up the sender address from the uid, and doesn't
37962permit a remote host to be specified.
37963
37964.oindex "&%-f%&"
37965However, an untrusted user is permitted to use the &%-f%& command line option
37966in the special form &%-f <>%& to indicate that a delivery failure for the
37967message should not cause an error report. This affects the message's envelope,
37968but it does not affect the &'Sender:'& header. Untrusted users may also be
37969permitted to use specific forms of address with the &%-f%& option by setting
37970the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option.
37971
37972Trusted users are used to run processes that receive mail messages from some
37973other mail domain and pass them on to Exim for delivery either locally, or over
37974the Internet. Exim trusts a caller that is running as root, as the Exim user,
37975as any user listed in the &%trusted_users%& configuration option, or under any
37976group listed in the &%trusted_groups%& option.
37977
37978Admin users are permitted to do things to the messages on Exim's queue. They
37979can freeze or thaw messages, cause them to be returned to their senders, remove
37980them entirely, or modify them in various ways. In addition, admin users can run
37981the Exim monitor and see all the information it is capable of providing, which
37982includes the contents of files on the spool.
37983
37984.oindex "&%-M%&"
37985.oindex "&%-q%&"
37986By default, the use of the &%-M%& and &%-q%& options to cause Exim to attempt
37987delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users. This
37988restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%no_prod_requires_admin%& option.
37989Similarly, the use of &%-bp%& (and its variants) to list the contents of the
37990queue is also restricted to admin users. This restriction can be relaxed by
37991setting &%no_queue_list_requires_admin%&.
37992
37993Exim recognizes an admin user if the calling process is running as root or as
37994the Exim user or if any of the groups associated with the calling process is
37995the Exim group. It is not necessary actually to be running under the Exim
37996group. However, if admin users who are not root or the Exim user are to access
37997the contents of files on the spool via the Exim monitor (which runs
37998unprivileged), Exim must be built to allow group read access to its spool
37999files.
38000
38001.new
38002By default, regular users are trusted to perform basic testing and
38003introspection commands, as themselves. This setting can be tightened by
38004setting the &%commandline_checks_require_admin%& option.
38005This affects most of the checking options,
38006such as &%-be%& and anything else &%-b*%&.
38007.wen
38008
38009
38010.section "Spool files" "SECID275"
38011.cindex "spool directory" "files"
38012Exim's spool directory and everything it contains is owned by the Exim user and
38013set to the Exim group. The mode for spool files is defined in the
38014&_Local/Makefile_& configuration file, and defaults to 0640. This means that
38015any user who is a member of the Exim group can access these files.
38016
38017
38018
38019.section "Use of argv[0]" "SECID276"
38020Exim examines the last component of &%argv[0]%&, and if it matches one of a set
38021of specific strings, Exim assumes certain options. For example, calling Exim
38022with the last component of &%argv[0]%& set to &"rsmtp"& is exactly equivalent
38023to calling it with the option &%-bS%&. There are no security implications in
38024this.
38025
38026
38027
38028.section "Use of %f formatting" "SECID277"
38029The only use made of &"%f"& by Exim is in formatting load average values. These
38030are actually stored in integer variables as 1000 times the load average.
38031Consequently, their range is limited and so therefore is the length of the
38032converted output.
38033
38034
38035
38036.section "Embedded Exim path" "SECID278"
38037Exim uses its own path name, which is embedded in the code, only when it needs
38038to re-exec in order to regain root privilege. Therefore, it is not root when it
38039does so. If some bug allowed the path to get overwritten, it would lead to an
38040arbitrary program's being run as exim, not as root.
38041
38042
38043
38044.section "Dynamic module directory" "SECTdynmoddir"
38045Any dynamically loadable modules must be installed into the directory
38046defined in &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& in &_Local/Makefile_& for Exim to permit
38047loading it.
38048
38049
38050.section "Use of sprintf()" "SECID279"
38051.cindex "&[sprintf()]&"
38052A large number of occurrences of &"sprintf"& in the code are actually calls to
38053&'string_sprintf()'&, a function that returns the result in malloc'd store.
38054The intermediate formatting is done into a large fixed buffer by a function
38055that runs through the format string itself, and checks the length of each
38056conversion before performing it, thus preventing buffer overruns.
38057
38058The remaining uses of &[sprintf()]& happen in controlled circumstances where
38059the output buffer is known to be sufficiently long to contain the converted
38060string.
38061
38062
38063
38064.section "Use of debug_printf() and log_write()" "SECID280"
38065Arbitrary strings are passed to both these functions, but they do their
38066formatting by calling the function &'string_vformat()'&, which runs through
38067the format string itself, and checks the length of each conversion.
38068
38069
38070
38071.section "Use of strcat() and strcpy()" "SECID281"
38072These are used only in cases where the output buffer is known to be large
38073enough to hold the result.
38074.ecindex IIDsecurcon
38075
38076
38077
38078
38079. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38080. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38081
38082.chapter "Format of spool files" "CHAPspool"
38083.scindex IIDforspo1 "format" "spool files"
38084.scindex IIDforspo2 "spool directory" "format of files"
38085.scindex IIDforspo3 "spool files" "format of"
38086.cindex "spool files" "editing"
38087A message on Exim's queue consists of two files, whose names are the message id
38088followed by -D and -H, respectively. The data portion of the message is kept in
38089the -D file on its own. The message's envelope, status, and headers are all
38090kept in the -H file, whose format is described in this chapter. Each of these
38091two files contains the final component of its own name as its first line. This
38092is insurance against disk crashes where the directory is lost but the files
38093themselves are recoverable.
38094
38095Some people are tempted into editing -D files in order to modify messages. You
38096need to be extremely careful if you do this; it is not recommended and you are
38097on your own if you do it. Here are some of the pitfalls:
38098
38099.ilist
38100You must ensure that Exim does not try to deliver the message while you are
38101fiddling with it. The safest way is to take out a write lock on the -D file,
38102which is what Exim itself does, using &[fcntl()]&. If you update the file in
38103place, the lock will be retained. If you write a new file and rename it, the
38104lock will be lost at the instant of rename.
38105.next
38106.vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
38107If you change the number of lines in the file, the value of
38108&$body_linecount$&, which is stored in the -H file, will be incorrect and can
38109cause incomplete transmission of messages or undeliverable messages.
38110.next
38111If the message is in MIME format, you must take care not to break it.
38112.next
38113If the message is cryptographically signed, any change will invalidate the
38114signature.
38115.endlist
38116All in all, modifying -D files is fraught with danger.
38117
38118Files whose names end with -J may also be seen in the &_input_& directory (or
38119its subdirectories when &%split_spool_directory%& is set). These are journal
38120files, used to record addresses to which the message has been delivered during
38121the course of a delivery attempt. If there are still undelivered recipients at
38122the end, the -H file is updated, and the -J file is deleted. If, however, there
38123is some kind of crash (for example, a power outage) before this happens, the -J
38124file remains in existence. When Exim next processes the message, it notices the
38125-J file and uses it to update the -H file before starting the next delivery
38126attempt.
38127
38128.new
38129Files whose names end with -K or .eml may also be seen in the spool.
38130These are temporaries used for DKIM or malware processing, when that is used.
38131They should be tidied up by normal operations; any old ones are probably
38132relics of crashes and can be removed.
38133.wen
38134
38135.section "Format of the -H file" "SECID282"
38136.cindex "uid (user id)" "in spool file"
38137.cindex "gid (group id)" "in spool file"
38138The second line of the -H file contains the login name for the uid of the
38139process that called Exim to read the message, followed by the numerical uid and
38140gid. For a locally generated message, this is normally the user who sent the
38141message. For a message received over TCP/IP via the daemon, it is
38142normally the Exim user.
38143
38144The third line of the file contains the address of the message's sender as
38145transmitted in the envelope, contained in angle brackets. The sender address is
38146empty for bounce messages. For incoming SMTP mail, the sender address is given
38147in the MAIL command. For locally generated mail, the sender address is
38148created by Exim from the login name of the current user and the configured
38149&%qualify_domain%&. However, this can be overridden by the &%-f%& option or a
38150leading &"From&~"& line if the caller is trusted, or if the supplied address is
38151&"<>"& or an address that matches &%untrusted_set_senders%&.
38152
38153The fourth line contains two numbers. The first is the time that the message
38154was received, in the conventional Unix form &-- the number of seconds since the
38155start of the epoch. The second number is a count of the number of messages
38156warning of delayed delivery that have been sent to the sender.
38157
38158There follow a number of lines starting with a hyphen. These can appear in any
38159order, and are omitted when not relevant:
38160
38161.vlist
38162.vitem "&%-acl%&&~<&'number'&>&~<&'length'&>"
38163This item is obsolete, and is not generated from Exim release 4.61 onwards;
38164&%-aclc%& and &%-aclm%& are used instead. However, &%-acl%& is still
38165recognized, to provide backward compatibility. In the old format, a line of
38166this form is present for every ACL variable that is not empty. The number
38167identifies the variable; the &%acl_c%&&*x*& variables are numbered 0&--9 and
38168the &%acl_m%&&*x*& variables are numbered 10&--19. The length is the length of
38169the data string for the variable. The string itself starts at the beginning of
38170the next line, and is followed by a newline character. It may contain internal
38171newlines.
38172
38173.vitem "&%-aclc%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
38174A line of this form is present for every ACL connection variable that is
38175defined. Note that there is a space between &%-aclc%& and the rest of the name.
38176The length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
38177starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
38178character. It may contain internal newlines.
38179
38180.vitem "&%-aclm%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
38181A line of this form is present for every ACL message variable that is defined.
38182Note that there is a space between &%-aclm%& and the rest of the name. The
38183length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
38184starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
38185character. It may contain internal newlines.
38186
38187.vitem "&%-active_hostname%&&~<&'hostname'&>"
38188This is present if, when the message was received over SMTP, the value of
38189&$smtp_active_hostname$& was different to the value of &$primary_hostname$&.
38190
38191.vitem &%-allow_unqualified_recipient%&
38192This is present if unqualified recipient addresses are permitted in header
38193lines (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at
38194transport time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote
38195messages from hosts that match &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
38196
38197.vitem &%-allow_unqualified_sender%&
38198This is present if unqualified sender addresses are permitted in header lines
38199(to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at transport
38200time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote messages from
38201hosts that match &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
38202
38203.vitem "&%-auth_id%&&~<&'text'&>"
38204The id information for a message received on an authenticated SMTP connection
38205&-- the value of the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
38206
38207.vitem "&%-auth_sender%&&~<&'address'&>"
38208The address of an authenticated sender &-- the value of the
38209&$authenticated_sender$& variable.
38210
38211.vitem "&%-body_linecount%&&~<&'number'&>"
38212This records the number of lines in the body of the message, and is
38213present unless &%-spool_file_wireformat%& is.
38214
38215.vitem "&%-body_zerocount%&&~<&'number'&>"
38216This records the number of binary zero bytes in the body of the message, and is
38217present if the number is greater than zero.
38218
38219.vitem &%-deliver_firsttime%&
38220This is written when a new message is first added to the spool. When the spool
38221file is updated after a deferral, it is omitted.
38222
38223.vitem "&%-frozen%&&~<&'time'&>"
38224.cindex "frozen messages" "spool data"
38225The message is frozen, and the freezing happened at <&'time'&>.
38226
38227.vitem "&%-helo_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
38228This records the host name as specified by a remote host in a HELO or EHLO
38229command.
38230
38231.vitem "&%-host_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
38232This records the IP address of the host from which the message was received and
38233the remote port number that was used. It is omitted for locally generated
38234messages.
38235
38236.vitem "&%-host_auth%&&~<&'text'&>"
38237If the message was received on an authenticated SMTP connection, this records
38238the name of the authenticator &-- the value of the
38239&$sender_host_authenticated$& variable.
38240
38241.vitem &%-host_lookup_failed%&
38242This is present if an attempt to look up the sending host's name from its IP
38243address failed. It corresponds to the &$host_lookup_failed$& variable.
38244
38245.vitem "&%-host_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
38246.cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
38247.cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
38248This records the name of the remote host from which the message was received,
38249if the host name was looked up from the IP address when the message was being
38250received. It is not present if no reverse lookup was done.
38251
38252.vitem "&%-ident%&&~<&'text'&>"
38253For locally submitted messages, this records the login of the originating user,
38254unless it was a trusted user and the &%-oMt%& option was used to specify an
38255ident value. For messages received over TCP/IP, this records the ident string
38256supplied by the remote host, if any.
38257
38258.vitem "&%-interface_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
38259This records the IP address of the local interface and the port number through
38260which a message was received from a remote host. It is omitted for locally
38261generated messages.
38262
38263.vitem &%-local%&
38264The message is from a local sender.
38265
38266.vitem &%-localerror%&
38267The message is a locally-generated bounce message.
38268
38269.vitem "&%-local_scan%&&~<&'string'&>"
38270This records the data string that was returned by the &[local_scan()]& function
38271when the message was received &-- the value of the &$local_scan_data$&
38272variable. It is omitted if no data was returned.
38273
38274.vitem &%-manual_thaw%&
38275The message was frozen but has been thawed manually, that is, by an explicit
38276Exim command rather than via the auto-thaw process.
38277
38278.vitem &%-N%&
38279A testing delivery process was started using the &%-N%& option to suppress any
38280actual deliveries, but delivery was deferred. At any further delivery attempts,
38281&%-N%& is assumed.
38282
38283.vitem &%-received_protocol%&
38284This records the value of the &$received_protocol$& variable, which contains
38285the name of the protocol by which the message was received.
38286
38287.vitem &%-sender_set_untrusted%&
38288The envelope sender of this message was set by an untrusted local caller (used
38289to ensure that the caller is displayed in queue listings).
38290
38291.vitem "&%-spam_score_int%&&~<&'number'&>"
38292If a message was scanned by SpamAssassin, this is present. It records the value
38293of &$spam_score_int$&.
38294
38295.new
38296.vitem &%-spool_file_wireformat%&
38297The -D file for this message is in wire-format (for ESMTP CHUNKING)
38298rather than Unix-format.
38299The line-ending is CRLF rather than newline.
38300There is still, however, no leading-dot-stuffing.
38301.wen
38302
38303.vitem &%-tls_certificate_verified%&
38304A TLS certificate was received from the client that sent this message, and the
38305certificate was verified by the server.
38306
38307.vitem "&%-tls_cipher%&&~<&'cipher name'&>"
38308When the message was received over an encrypted connection, this records the
38309name of the cipher suite that was used.
38310
38311.vitem "&%-tls_peerdn%&&~<&'peer DN'&>"
38312When the message was received over an encrypted connection, and a certificate
38313was received from the client, this records the Distinguished Name from that
38314certificate.
38315.endlist
38316
38317Following the options there is a list of those addresses to which the message
38318is not to be delivered. This set of addresses is initialized from the command
38319line when the &%-t%& option is used and &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%&
38320is set; otherwise it starts out empty. Whenever a successful delivery is made,
38321the address is added to this set. The addresses are kept internally as a
38322balanced binary tree, and it is a representation of that tree which is written
38323to the spool file. If an address is expanded via an alias or forward file, the
38324original address is added to the tree when deliveries to all its child
38325addresses are complete.
38326
38327If the tree is empty, there is a single line in the spool file containing just
38328the text &"XX"&. Otherwise, each line consists of two letters, which are either
38329Y or N, followed by an address. The address is the value for the node of the
38330tree, and the letters indicate whether the node has a left branch and/or a
38331right branch attached to it, respectively. If branches exist, they immediately
38332follow. Here is an example of a three-node tree:
38333.code
38334YY darcy@austen.fict.example
38335NN alice@wonderland.fict.example
38336NN editor@thesaurus.ref.example
38337.endd
38338After the non-recipients tree, there is a list of the message's recipients.
38339This is a simple list, preceded by a count. It includes all the original
38340recipients of the message, including those to whom the message has already been
38341delivered. In the simplest case, the list contains one address per line. For
38342example:
38343.code
383444
38345editor@thesaurus.ref.example
38346darcy@austen.fict.example
38347rdo@foundation
38348alice@wonderland.fict.example
38349.endd
38350However, when a child address has been added to the top-level addresses as a
38351result of the use of the &%one_time%& option on a &(redirect)& router, each
38352line is of the following form:
38353.display
38354<&'top-level address'&> <&'errors_to address'&> &&&
38355 <&'length'&>,<&'parent number'&>#<&'flag bits'&>
38356.endd
38357The 01 flag bit indicates the presence of the three other fields that follow
38358the top-level address. Other bits may be used in future to support additional
38359fields. The <&'parent number'&> is the offset in the recipients list of the
38360original parent of the &"one time"& address. The first two fields are the
38361envelope sender that is associated with this address and its length. If the
38362length is zero, there is no special envelope sender (there are then two space
38363characters in the line). A non-empty field can arise from a &(redirect)& router
38364that has an &%errors_to%& setting.
38365
38366
38367A blank line separates the envelope and status information from the headers
38368which follow. A header may occupy several lines of the file, and to save effort
38369when reading it in, each header is preceded by a number and an identifying
38370character. The number is the number of characters in the header, including any
38371embedded newlines and the terminating newline. The character is one of the
38372following:
38373
38374.table2 50pt
38375.row <&'blank'&> "header in which Exim has no special interest"
38376.row &`B`& "&'Bcc:'& header"
38377.row &`C`& "&'Cc:'& header"
38378.row &`F`& "&'From:'& header"
38379.row &`I`& "&'Message-id:'& header"
38380.row &`P`& "&'Received:'& header &-- P for &""postmark""&"
38381.row &`R`& "&'Reply-To:'& header"
38382.row &`S`& "&'Sender:'& header"
38383.row &`T`& "&'To:'& header"
38384.row &`*`& "replaced or deleted header"
38385.endtable
38386
38387Deleted or replaced (rewritten) headers remain in the spool file for debugging
38388purposes. They are not transmitted when the message is delivered. Here is a
38389typical set of headers:
38390.code
38391111P Received: by hobbit.fict.example with local (Exim 4.00)
38392id 14y9EI-00026G-00; Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
38393049 Message-Id: <E14y9EI-00026G-00@hobbit.fict.example>
38394038* X-rewrote-sender: bb@hobbit.fict.example
38395042* From: Bilbo Baggins <bb@hobbit.fict.example>
38396049F From: Bilbo Baggins <B.Baggins@hobbit.fict.example>
38397099* To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation,
38398darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
38399104T To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation.example,
38400darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
38401038 Date: Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
38402.endd
38403The asterisked headers indicate that the envelope sender, &'From:'& header, and
38404&'To:'& header have been rewritten, the last one because routing expanded the
38405unqualified domain &'foundation'&.
38406.ecindex IIDforspo1
38407.ecindex IIDforspo2
38408.ecindex IIDforspo3
38409
38410.new
38411.section "Format of the -D file" "SECID282a"
38412The data file is traditionally in Unix-standard format: lines are ended with
38413an ASCII newline character.
38414However, when the &%spool_wireformat%& main option is used some -D files
38415can have an alternate format.
38416This is flagged by a &%-spool_file_wireformat%& line in the corresponding -H file.
38417The -D file lines (not including the first name-component line) are
38418suitable for direct copying to the wire when transmitting using the
38419ESMTP CHUNKING option, meaning lower processing overhead.
38420Lines are terminated with an ASCII CRLF pair.
38421There is no dot-stuffing (and no dot-termination).
38422.wen
38423
38424. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38425. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38426
38427.chapter "Support for DKIM (DomainKeys Identified Mail)" "CHAPdkim" &&&
38428 "DKIM Support"
38429.cindex "DKIM"
38430
38431DKIM is a mechanism by which messages sent by some entity can be provably
38432linked to a domain which that entity controls. It permits reputation to
38433be tracked on a per-domain basis, rather than merely upon source IP address.
38434DKIM is documented in RFC 4871.
38435
38436DKIM support is compiled into Exim by default if TLS support is present.
38437It can be disabled by setting DISABLE_DKIM=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&.
38438
38439Exim's DKIM implementation allows for
38440.olist
38441Signing outgoing messages: This function is implemented in the SMTP transport.
38442It can co-exist with all other Exim features
38443(including transport filters)
38444except cutthrough delivery.
38445.next
38446Verifying signatures in incoming messages: This is implemented by an additional
38447ACL (acl_smtp_dkim), which can be called several times per message, with
38448different signature contexts.
38449.endlist
38450
38451In typical Exim style, the verification implementation does not include any
38452default "policy". Instead it enables you to build your own policy using
38453Exim's standard controls.
38454
38455Please note that verification of DKIM signatures in incoming mail is turned
38456on by default for logging purposes. For each signature in incoming email,
38457exim will log a line displaying the most important signature details, and the
38458signature status. Here is an example (with line-breaks added for clarity):
38459.code
384602009-09-09 10:22:28 1MlIRf-0003LU-U3 DKIM:
38461 d=facebookmail.com s=q1-2009b
38462 c=relaxed/relaxed a=rsa-sha1
38463 i=@facebookmail.com t=1252484542 [verification succeeded]
38464.endd
38465You might want to turn off DKIM verification processing entirely for internal
38466or relay mail sources. To do that, set the &%dkim_disable_verify%& ACL
38467control modifier. This should typically be done in the RCPT ACL, at points
38468where you accept mail from relay sources (internal hosts or authenticated
38469senders).
38470
38471
38472.section "Signing outgoing messages" "SECDKIMSIGN"
38473.cindex "DKIM" "signing"
38474
38475Signing is enabled by setting private options on the SMTP transport.
38476These options take (expandable) strings as arguments.
38477
38478.option dkim_domain smtp string list&!! unset
38479The domain(s) you want to sign with.
38480.new
38481After expansion, this can be a list.
38482Each element in turn is put into the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion variable
38483while expanding the remaining signing options.
38484.wen
38485If it is empty after expansion, DKIM signing is not done.
38486
38487.option dkim_selector smtp string&!! unset
38488This sets the key selector string.
38489You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion variable to look up a matching selector.
38490The result is put in the expansion
38491variable &%$dkim_selector%& which may be used in the &%dkim_private_key%&
38492option along with &%$dkim_domain%&.
38493If the option is empty after expansion, DKIM signing is not done.
38494
38495.option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
38496This sets the private key to use.
38497You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and
38498&%$dkim_selector%& expansion variables to determine the private key to use.
38499The result can either
38500.ilist
38501be a valid RSA private key in ASCII armor, including line breaks.
38502.next
38503start with a slash, in which case it is treated as a file that contains
38504the private key.
38505.next
38506be "0", "false" or the empty string, in which case the message will not
38507be signed. This case will not result in an error, even if &%dkim_strict%&
38508is set.
38509.endlist
38510If the option is empty after expansion, DKIM signing is not done.
38511
38512.option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
38513This option sets the canonicalization method used when signing a message.
38514The DKIM RFC currently supports two methods: "simple" and "relaxed".
38515The option defaults to "relaxed" when unset. Note: the current implementation
38516only supports using the same canonicalization method for both headers and body.
38517
38518.option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
38519This option defines how Exim behaves when signing a message that
38520should be signed fails for some reason. When the expansion evaluates to
38521either "1" or "true", Exim will defer. Otherwise Exim will send the message
38522unsigned. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and &%$dkim_selector%& expansion
38523variables here.
38524
38525.option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! unset
38526If set, this option must expand to (or be specified as) a colon-separated
38527list of header names. Headers with these names will be included in the message
38528signature.
38529When unspecified, the header names recommended in RFC4871 will be used.
38530
38531
38532.section "Verifying DKIM signatures in incoming mail" "SECID514"
38533.cindex "DKIM" "verification"
38534
38535Verification of DKIM signatures in SMTP incoming email is implemented via the
38536&%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL. By default, this ACL is called once for each
38537syntactically(!) correct signature in the incoming message.
38538A missing ACL definition defaults to accept.
38539If any ACL call does not accept, the message is not accepted.
38540If a cutthrough delivery was in progress for the message it is
38541summarily dropped (having wasted the transmission effort).
38542
38543To evaluate the signature in the ACL a large number of expansion variables
38544containing the signature status and its details are set up during the
38545runtime of the ACL.
38546
38547Calling the ACL only for existing signatures is not sufficient to build
38548more advanced policies. For that reason, the global option
38549&%dkim_verify_signers%&, and a global expansion variable
38550&%$dkim_signers%& exist.
38551
38552The global option &%dkim_verify_signers%& can be set to a colon-separated
38553list of DKIM domains or identities for which the ACL &%acl_smtp_dkim%& is
38554called. It is expanded when the message has been received. At this point,
38555the expansion variable &%$dkim_signers%& already contains a colon-separated
38556list of signer domains and identities for the message. When
38557&%dkim_verify_signers%& is not specified in the main configuration,
38558it defaults as:
38559.code
38560dkim_verify_signers = $dkim_signers
38561.endd
38562This leads to the default behaviour of calling &%acl_smtp_dkim%& for each
38563DKIM signature in the message. Current DKIM verifiers may want to explicitly
38564call the ACL for known domains or identities. This would be achieved as follows:
38565.code
38566dkim_verify_signers = paypal.com:ebay.com:$dkim_signers
38567.endd
38568This would result in &%acl_smtp_dkim%& always being called for "paypal.com"
38569and "ebay.com", plus all domains and identities that have signatures in the message.
38570You can also be more creative in constructing your policy. For example:
38571.code
38572dkim_verify_signers = $sender_address_domain:$dkim_signers
38573.endd
38574
38575If a domain or identity is listed several times in the (expanded) value of
38576&%dkim_verify_signers%&, the ACL is only called once for that domain or identity.
38577
38578
38579Inside the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&, the following expansion variables are
38580available (from most to least important):
38581
38582
38583.vlist
38584.vitem &%$dkim_cur_signer%&
38585The signer that is being evaluated in this ACL run. This can be a domain or
38586an identity. This is one of the list items from the expanded main option
38587&%dkim_verify_signers%& (see above).
38588
38589.vitem &%$dkim_verify_status%&
38590A string describing the general status of the signature. One of
38591.ilist
38592&%none%&: There is no signature in the message for the current domain or
38593identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
38594.next
38595&%invalid%&: The signature could not be verified due to a processing error.
38596More detail is available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
38597.next
38598&%fail%&: Verification of the signature failed. More detail is
38599available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
38600.next
38601&%pass%&: The signature passed verification. It is valid.
38602.endlist
38603
38604.vitem &%$dkim_verify_reason%&
38605A string giving a little bit more detail when &%$dkim_verify_status%& is either
38606"fail" or "invalid". One of
38607.ilist
38608&%pubkey_unavailable%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public
38609key for the domain could not be retrieved. This may be a temporary problem.
38610.next
38611&%pubkey_syntax%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public key
38612record for the domain is syntactically invalid.
38613.next
38614&%bodyhash_mismatch%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The calculated
38615body hash does not match the one specified in the signature header. This
38616means that the message body was modified in transit.
38617.next
38618&%signature_incorrect%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The signature
38619could not be verified. This may mean that headers were modified,
38620re-written or otherwise changed in a way which is incompatible with
38621DKIM verification. It may of course also mean that the signature is forged.
38622.endlist
38623
38624.vitem &%$dkim_domain%&
38625The signing domain. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated if there is
38626an actual signature in the message for the current domain or identity (as
38627reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
38628
38629.vitem &%$dkim_identity%&
38630The signing identity, if present. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated
38631if there is an actual signature in the message for the current domain or
38632identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
38633
38634.vitem &%$dkim_selector%&
38635The key record selector string.
38636
38637.vitem &%$dkim_algo%&
38638The algorithm used. One of 'rsa-sha1' or 'rsa-sha256'.
38639
38640.vitem &%$dkim_canon_body%&
38641The body canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
38642
38643.vitem &%dkim_canon_headers%&
38644The header canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
38645
38646.vitem &%$dkim_copiedheaders%&
38647A transcript of headers and their values which are included in the signature
38648(copied from the 'z=' tag of the signature).
38649Note that RFC6376 requires that verification fail if the From: header is
38650not included in the signature. Exim does not enforce this; sites wishing
38651strict enforcement should code the check explicitly.
38652
38653.vitem &%$dkim_bodylength%&
38654The number of signed body bytes. If zero ("0"), the body is unsigned. If no
38655limit was set by the signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes sure
38656that this variable always expands to an integer value.
38657
38658.vitem &%$dkim_created%&
38659UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signature was created.
38660When this was not specified by the signer, "0" is returned.
38661
38662.vitem &%$dkim_expires%&
38663UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signer wants the
38664signature to be treated as "expired". When this was not specified by the
38665signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes it possible to do useful
38666integer size comparisons against this value.
38667
38668.vitem &%$dkim_headernames%&
38669A colon-separated list of names of headers included in the signature.
38670
38671.vitem &%$dkim_key_testing%&
38672"1" if the key record has the "testing" flag set, "0" if not.
38673
38674.vitem &%$dkim_key_nosubdomains%&
38675"1" if the key record forbids subdomaining, "0" otherwise.
38676
38677.vitem &%$dkim_key_srvtype%&
38678Service type (tag s=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
38679in the key record.
38680
38681.vitem &%$dkim_key_granularity%&
38682Key granularity (tag g=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
38683in the key record.
38684
38685.vitem &%$dkim_key_notes%&
38686Notes from the key record (tag n=).
38687
38688.vitem &%$dkim_key_length%&
38689Number of bits in the key.
38690.endlist
38691
38692In addition, two ACL conditions are provided:
38693
38694.vlist
38695.vitem &%dkim_signers%&
38696ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of domains or identities
38697for a match against the domain or identity that the ACL is currently verifying
38698(reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&). This is typically used to restrict an ACL
38699verb to a group of domains or identities. For example:
38700
38701.code
38702# Warn when Mail purportedly from GMail has no gmail signature
38703warn log_message = GMail sender without gmail.com DKIM signature
38704 sender_domains = gmail.com
38705 dkim_signers = gmail.com
38706 dkim_status = none
38707.endd
38708
38709Note that the above does not check for a total lack of DKIM signing;
38710for that check for empty &$h_DKIM-Signature:$& in the data ACL.
38711
38712.vitem &%dkim_status%&
38713ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of possible DKIM verification
38714results against the actual result of verification. This is typically used
38715to restrict an ACL verb to a list of verification outcomes, for example:
38716
38717.code
38718deny message = Mail from Paypal with invalid/missing signature
38719 sender_domains = paypal.com:paypal.de
38720 dkim_signers = paypal.com:paypal.de
38721 dkim_status = none:invalid:fail
38722.endd
38723
38724The possible status keywords are: 'none','invalid','fail' and 'pass'. Please
38725see the documentation of the &%$dkim_verify_status%& expansion variable above
38726for more information of what they mean.
38727.endlist
38728
38729. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38730. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38731
38732.chapter "Proxies" "CHAPproxies" &&&
38733 "Proxy support"
38734.cindex "proxy support"
38735.cindex "proxy" "access via"
38736
38737A proxy is an intermediate system through which communication is passed.
38738Proxies may provide a security, availability or load-distribution function.
38739
38740
38741.section "Inbound proxies" SECTproxyInbound
38742.cindex proxy inbound
38743.cindex proxy "server side"
38744.cindex proxy "Proxy protocol"
38745.cindex "Proxy protocol" proxy
38746
38747Exim has support for receiving inbound SMTP connections via a proxy
38748that uses &"Proxy Protocol"& to speak to it.
38749To include this support, include &"SUPPORT_PROXY=yes"&
38750in Local/Makefile.
38751
38752It was built on specifications from:
38753(&url(http://haproxy.1wt.eu/download/1.5/doc/proxy-protocol.txt)).
38754That URL was revised in May 2014 to version 2 spec:
38755(&url(http://git.1wt.eu/web?p=haproxy.git;a=commitdiff;h=afb768340c9d7e50d8e)).
38756
38757The purpose of this facility is so that an application load balancer,
38758such as HAProxy, can sit in front of several Exim servers
38759to distribute load.
38760Exim uses the local protocol communication with the proxy to obtain
38761the remote SMTP system IP address and port information.
38762There is no logging if a host passes or
38763fails Proxy Protocol negotiation, but it can easily be determined and
38764recorded in an ACL (example is below).
38765
38766Use of a proxy is enabled by setting the &%hosts_proxy%&
38767main configuration option to a hostlist; connections from these
38768hosts will use Proxy Protocol.
38769Exim supports both version 1 and version 2 of the Proxy Protocol and
38770automatically determines which version is in use.
38771
38772The Proxy Protocol header is the first data received on a TCP connection
38773and is inserted before any TLS-on-connect handshake from the client; Exim
38774negotiates TLS between Exim-as-server and the remote client, not between
38775Exim and the proxy server.
38776
38777The following expansion variables are usable
38778(&"internal"& and &"external"& here refer to the interfaces
38779of the proxy):
38780.display
38781&'proxy_external_address '& IP of host being proxied or IP of remote interface of proxy
38782&'proxy_external_port '& Port of host being proxied or Port on remote interface of proxy
38783&'proxy_local_address '& IP of proxy server inbound or IP of local interface of proxy
38784&'proxy_local_port '& Port of proxy server inbound or Port on local interface of proxy
38785&'proxy_session '& boolean: SMTP connection via proxy
38786.endd
38787If &$proxy_session$& is set but &$proxy_external_address$& is empty
38788there was a protocol error.
38789
38790Since the real connections are all coming from the proxy, and the
38791per host connection tracking is done before Proxy Protocol is
38792evaluated, &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& must be set high enough to
38793handle all of the parallel volume you expect per inbound proxy.
38794With the option set so high, you lose the ability
38795to protect your server from many connections from one IP.
38796In order to prevent your server from overload, you
38797need to add a per connection ratelimit to your connect ACL.
38798A possible solution is:
38799.display
38800 # Set max number of connections per host
38801 LIMIT = 5
38802 # Or do some kind of IP lookup in a flat file or database
38803 # LIMIT = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}iplsearch{/etc/exim/proxy_limits}}
38804
38805 defer message = Too many connections from this IP right now
38806 ratelimit = LIMIT / 5s / per_conn / strict
38807.endd
38808
38809
38810
38811.section "Outbound proxies" SECTproxySOCKS
38812.cindex proxy outbound
38813.cindex proxy "client side"
38814.cindex proxy SOCKS
38815.cindex SOCKS proxy
38816Exim has support for sending outbound SMTP via a proxy
38817using a protocol called SOCKS5 (defined by RFC1928).
38818The support can be optionally included by defining SUPPORT_SOCKS=yes in
38819Local/Makefile.
38820
38821Use of a proxy is enabled by setting the &%socks_proxy%& option
38822on an smtp transport.
38823The option value is expanded and should then be a list
38824(colon-separated by default) of proxy specifiers.
38825Each proxy specifier is a list
38826(space-separated by default) where the initial element
38827is an IP address and any subsequent elements are options.
38828
38829Options are a string <name>=<value>.
38830The list of options is in the following table:
38831.display
38832&'auth '& authentication method
38833&'name '& authentication username
38834&'pass '& authentication password
38835&'port '& tcp port
38836&'tmo '& connection timeout
38837&'pri '& priority
38838&'weight '& selection bias
38839.endd
38840
38841More details on each of these options follows:
38842
38843.ilist
38844.cindex authentication "to proxy"
38845.cindex proxy authentication
38846&%auth%&: Either &"none"& (default) or &"name"&.
38847Using &"name"& selects username/password authentication per RFC 1929
38848for access to the proxy.
38849Default is &"none"&.
38850.next
38851&%name%&: sets the username for the &"name"& authentication method.
38852Default is empty.
38853.next
38854&%pass%&: sets the password for the &"name"& authentication method.
38855Default is empty.
38856.next
38857&%port%&: the TCP port number to use for the connection to the proxy.
38858Default is 1080.
38859.next
38860&%tmo%&: sets a connection timeout in seconds for this proxy.
38861Default is 5.
38862.next
38863&%pri%&: specifies a priority for the proxy within the list,
38864higher values being tried first.
38865The default priority is 1.
38866.next
38867&%weight%&: specifies a selection bias.
38868Within a priority set servers are queried in a random fashion,
38869weighted by this value.
38870The default value for selection bias is 1.
38871.endlist
38872
38873Proxies from the list are tried according to their priority
38874and weight settings until one responds. The timeout for the
38875overall connection applies to the set of proxied attempts.
38876
38877.section Logging SECTproxyLog
38878To log the (local) IP of a proxy in the incoming or delivery logline,
38879add &"+proxy"& to the &%log_selector%& option.
38880This will add a component tagged with &"PRX="& to the line.
38881
38882. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38883. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38884
38885.chapter "Internationalisation" "CHAPi18n" &&&
38886 "Internationalisation""
38887.cindex internationalisation "email address"
38888.cindex EAI
38889.cindex i18n
38890.cindex UTF-8 "mail name handling"
38891
38892Exim has support for Internationalised mail names.
38893To include this it must be built with SUPPORT_I18N and the libidn library.
38894Standards supported are RFCs 2060, 5890, 6530 and 6533.
38895
38896If Exim is built with SUPPORT_I18N_2008 (in addition to SUPPORT_I18N, not
38897instead of it) then IDNA2008 is supported; this adds an extra library
38898requirement, upon libidn2.
38899
38900.section "MTA operations" SECTi18nMTA
38901.cindex SMTPUTF8 "ESMTP option"
38902The main configuration option &%smtputf8_advertise_hosts%& specifies
38903a host list. If this matches the sending host and
38904accept_8bitmime is true (the default) then the ESMTP option
38905SMTPUTF8 will be advertised.
38906
38907If the sender specifies the SMTPUTF8 option on a MAIL command
38908international handling for the message is enabled and
38909the expansion variable &$message_smtputf8$& will have value TRUE.
38910
38911The option &%allow_utf8_domains%& is set to true for this
38912message. All DNS lookups are converted to a-label form
38913whatever the setting of &%allow_utf8_domains%&
38914when Exim is built with SUPPORT_I18N.
38915
38916Both localparts and domain are maintained as the original
38917UTF-8 form internally; any comparison or regular-expression use will
38918require appropriate care. Filenames created, eg. by
38919the appendfile transport, will have UTF-8 names.
38920
38921HELO names sent by the smtp transport will have any UTF-8
38922components expanded to a-label form,
38923and any certificate name checks will be done using the a-label
38924form of the name.
38925
38926.cindex log protocol
38927.cindex SMTPUTF8 logging
38928Log lines and Received-by: header lines will acquire a "utf8"
38929prefix on the protocol element, eg. utf8esmtp.
38930
38931The following expansion operators can be used:
38932.code
38933${utf8_domain_to_alabel:str}
38934${utf8_domain_from_alabel:str}
38935${utf8_localpart_to_alabel:str}
38936${utf8_localpart_from_alabel:str}
38937.endd
38938
38939ACLs may use the following modifier:
38940.display
38941control = utf8_downconvert
38942control = utf8_downconvert/<value>
38943.endd
38944This sets a flag requiring that addresses are converted to
38945a-label form before smtp delivery, for use in a
38946Message Submission Agent context.
38947If a value is appended it may be:
38948.display
38949&`1 `& (default) mandatory downconversion
38950&`0 `& no downconversion
38951&`-1 `& if SMTPUTF8 not supported by destination host
38952.endd
38953
38954If mua_wrapper is set, the utf8_downconvert control
38955is initially set to -1.
38956
38957
38958There is no explicit support for VRFY and EXPN.
38959Configurations supporting these should inspect
38960&$smtp_command_argument$& for an SMTPUTF8 argument.
38961
38962There is no support for LMTP on Unix sockets.
38963Using the "lmtp" protocol option on an smtp transport,
38964for LMTP over TCP, should work as expected.
38965
38966There is no support for DSN unitext handling,
38967and no provision for converting logging from or to UTF-8.
38968
38969
38970
38971.section "MDA operations" SECTi18nMDA
38972To aid in constructing names suitable for IMAP folders
38973the following expansion operator can be used:
38974.code
38975${imapfolder {<string>} {<sep>} {<specials>}}
38976.endd
38977
38978The string is converted from the charset specified by
38979the "headers charset" command (in a filter file)
38980or &%headers_charset%& main configuration option (otherwise),
38981to the
38982modified UTF-7 encoding specified by RFC 2060,
38983with the following exception: All occurences of <sep>
38984(which has to be a single character)
38985are replaced with periods ("."), and all periods and slashes that are not
38986<sep> and are not in the <specials> string are BASE64 encoded.
38987
38988The third argument can be omitted, defaulting to an empty string.
38989The second argument can be omitted, defaulting to "/".
38990
38991This is the encoding used by Courier for Maildir names on disk, and followed
38992by many other IMAP servers.
38993
38994Examples:
38995.display
38996&`${imapfolder {Foo/Bar}} `& yields &`Foo.Bar`&
38997&`${imapfolder {Foo/Bar}{.}{/}} `& yields &`Foo&&AC8-Bar`&
38998&`${imapfolder {Räksmörgås}} `& yields &`R&&AOQ-ksm&&APY-rg&&AOU-s`&
38999.endd
39000
39001Note that the source charset setting is vital, and also that characters
39002must be representable in UTF-16.
39003
39004
39005. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39006. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39007
39008.chapter "Events" "CHAPevents" &&&
39009 "Events"
39010.cindex events
39011
39012The events mechanism in Exim can be used to intercept processing at a number
39013of points. It was originally invented to give a way to do customised logging
39014actions (for example, to a database) but can also be used to modify some
39015processing actions.
39016
39017Most installations will never need to use Events.
39018The support can be left out of a build by defining DISABLE_EVENT=yes
39019in &_Local/Makefile_&.
39020
39021There are two major classes of events: main and transport.
39022The main configuration option &%event_action%& controls reception events;
39023a transport option &%event_action%& controls delivery events.
39024
39025Both options are a string which is expanded when the event fires.
39026An example might look like:
39027.cindex logging custom
39028.code
39029event_action = ${if eq {msg:delivery}{$event_name} \
39030{${lookup pgsql {SELECT * FROM record_Delivery( \
39031 '${quote_pgsql:$sender_address_domain}',\
39032 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$sender_address_local_part}}', \
39033 '${quote_pgsql:$domain}', \
39034 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$local_part}}', \
39035 '${quote_pgsql:$host_address}', \
39036 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$host}}', \
39037 '${quote_pgsql:$message_exim_id}')}} \
39038} {}}
39039.endd
39040
39041Events have names which correspond to the point in process at which they fire.
39042The name is placed in the variable &$event_name$& and the event action
39043expansion must check this, as it will be called for every possible event type.
39044
39045The current list of events is:
39046.display
39047&`msg:complete after main `& per message
39048&`msg:delivery after transport `& per recipient
39049&`msg:rcpt:host:defer after transport `& per recipient per host
39050&`msg:rcpt:defer after transport `& per recipient
39051&`msg:host:defer after transport `& per attempt
39052&`msg:fail:delivery after transport `& per recipient
39053&`msg:fail:internal after main `& per recipient
39054&`tcp:connect before transport `& per connection
39055&`tcp:close after transport `& per connection
39056&`tls:cert before both `& per certificate in verification chain
39057&`smtp:connect after transport `& per connection
39058.endd
39059New event types may be added in future.
39060
39061The event name is a colon-separated list, defining the type of
39062event in a tree of possibilities. It may be used as a list
39063or just matched on as a whole. There will be no spaces in the name.
39064
39065The second column in the table above describes whether the event fires
39066before or after the action is associates with. Those which fire before
39067can be used to affect that action (more on this below).
39068
39069.new
39070The third column in the table above says what section of the configumration
39071should define the event action.
39072.wen
39073
39074An additional variable, &$event_data$&, is filled with information varying
39075with the event type:
39076.display
39077&`msg:delivery `& smtp confirmation message
39078&`msg:rcpt:host:defer `& error string
39079&`msg:rcpt:defer `& error string
39080&`msg:host:defer `& error string
39081&`tls:cert `& verification chain depth
39082&`smtp:connect `& smtp banner
39083.endd
39084
39085The :defer events populate one extra variable: &$event_defer_errno$&.
39086
39087For complex operations an ACL expansion can be used in &%event_action%&
39088however due to the multiple contexts that Exim operates in during
39089the course of its processing:
39090.ilist
39091variables set in transport events will not be visible outside that
39092transport call
39093.next
39094acl_m variables in a server context are lost on a new connection,
39095and after smtp helo/ehlo/mail/starttls/rset commands
39096.endlist
39097Using an ACL expansion with the logwrite modifier can be
39098a useful way of writing to the main log.
39099
39100The expansion of the event_action option should normally
39101return an empty string. Should it return anything else the
39102following will be forced:
39103.display
39104&`msg:delivery `& (ignored)
39105&`msg:host:defer `& (ignored)
39106&`msg:fail:delivery`& (ignored)
39107&`tcp:connect `& do not connect
39108&`tcp:close `& (ignored)
39109&`tls:cert `& refuse verification
39110&`smtp:connect `& close connection
39111.endd
39112No other use is made of the result string.
39113
39114For a tcp:connect event, if the connection is being made to a proxy
39115then the address and port variables will be that of the proxy and not
39116the target system.
39117
39118For tls:cert events, if GnuTLS is in use this will trigger only per
39119chain element received on the connection.
39120For OpenSSL it will trigger for every chain element including those
39121loaded locally.
39122
39123. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39124. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39125
39126.chapter "Adding new drivers or lookup types" "CHID13" &&&
39127 "Adding drivers or lookups"
39128.cindex "adding drivers"
39129.cindex "new drivers, adding"
39130.cindex "drivers" "adding new"
39131The following actions have to be taken in order to add a new router, transport,
39132authenticator, or lookup type to Exim:
39133
39134.olist
39135Choose a name for the driver or lookup type that does not conflict with any
39136existing name; I will use &"newdriver"& in what follows.
39137.next
39138Add to &_src/EDITME_& the line:
39139.display
39140<&'type'&>&`_NEWDRIVER=yes`&
39141.endd
39142where <&'type'&> is ROUTER, TRANSPORT, AUTH, or LOOKUP. If the
39143code is not to be included in the binary by default, comment this line out. You
39144should also add any relevant comments about the driver or lookup type.
39145.next
39146Add to &_src/config.h.defaults_& the line:
39147.code
39148#define <type>_NEWDRIVER
39149.endd
39150.next
39151Edit &_src/drtables.c_&, adding conditional code to pull in the private header
39152and create a table entry as is done for all the other drivers and lookup types.
39153.next
39154Edit &_scripts/lookups-Makefile_& if this is a new lookup; there is a for-loop
39155near the bottom, ranging the &`name_mod`& variable over a list of all lookups.
39156Add your &`NEWDRIVER`& to that list.
39157As long as the dynamic module would be named &_newdriver.so_&, you can use the
39158simple form that most lookups have.
39159.next
39160Edit &_Makefile_& in the appropriate sub-directory (&_src/routers_&,
39161&_src/transports_&, &_src/auths_&, or &_src/lookups_&); add a line for the new
39162driver or lookup type and add it to the definition of OBJ.
39163.next
39164Create &_newdriver.h_& and &_newdriver.c_& in the appropriate sub-directory of
39165&_src_&.
39166.next
39167Edit &_scripts/MakeLinks_& and add commands to link the &_.h_& and &_.c_& files
39168as for other drivers and lookups.
39169.endlist
39170
39171Then all you need to do is write the code! A good way to start is to make a
39172proforma by copying an existing module of the same type, globally changing all
39173occurrences of the name, and cutting out most of the code. Note that any
39174options you create must be listed in alphabetical order, because the tables are
39175searched using a binary chop procedure.
39176
39177There is a &_README_& file in each of the sub-directories of &_src_& describing
39178the interface that is expected.
39179
39180
39181
39182
39183. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39184. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39185
39186. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39187. These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
39188. Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
39189. PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
39190. processors.
39191. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39192
39193.literal xml
39194<?sdop
39195 format="newpage"
39196 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle;"
39197 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle;"
39198?>
39199.literal off
39200
39201.makeindex "Options index" "option"
39202.makeindex "Variables index" "variable"
39203.makeindex "Concept index" "concept"
39204
39205
39206. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39207. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////